blob: 0ef8103a63aff97545a59d9825330eee9bf1a8ba [file] [log] [blame]
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001 ----------------------
Willy Tarreau8317b282014-04-23 01:49:41 +02002 HAProxy
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02003 Configuration Manual
4 ----------------------
Willy Tarreau0e658fb2016-11-25 16:55:50 +01005 version 1.8
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02006 willy tarreau
Willy Tarreauf08137c2017-10-22 10:13:45 +02007 2017/10/22
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02008
9
10This document covers the configuration language as implemented in the version
11specified above. It does not provide any hint, example or advice. For such
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010012documentation, please refer to the Reference Manual or the Architecture Manual.
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020013The summary below is meant to help you search sections by name and navigate
14through the document.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020015
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020016Note to documentation contributors :
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -040017 This document is formatted with 80 columns per line, with even number of
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020018 spaces for indentation and without tabs. Please follow these rules strictly
19 so that it remains easily printable everywhere. If a line needs to be
20 printed verbatim and does not fit, please end each line with a backslash
Willy Tarreau62a36c42010-08-17 15:53:10 +020021 ('\') and continue on next line, indented by two characters. It is also
22 sometimes useful to prefix all output lines (logs, console outs) with 3
23 closing angle brackets ('>>>') in order to help get the difference between
24 inputs and outputs when it can become ambiguous. If you add sections,
25 please update the summary below for easier searching.
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020026
27
28Summary
29-------
30
311. Quick reminder about HTTP
321.1. The HTTP transaction model
331.2. HTTP request
341.2.1. The Request line
351.2.2. The request headers
361.3. HTTP response
371.3.1. The Response line
381.3.2. The response headers
39
402. Configuring HAProxy
412.1. Configuration file format
William Lallemandf9873ba2015-05-05 17:37:14 +0200422.2. Quoting and escaping
William Lallemandb2f07452015-05-12 14:27:13 +0200432.3. Environment variables
442.4. Time format
452.5. Examples
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020046
473. Global parameters
483.1. Process management and security
493.2. Performance tuning
503.3. Debugging
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +0100513.4. Userlists
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +0200523.5. Peers
Cyril Bonté307ee1e2015-09-28 23:16:06 +0200533.6. Mailers
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020054
554. Proxies
564.1. Proxy keywords matrix
574.2. Alphabetically sorted keywords reference
58
Willy Tarreau086fbf52012-09-24 20:34:51 +0200595. Bind and Server options
605.1. Bind options
615.2. Server and default-server options
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +0200625.3. Server DNS resolution
635.3.1. Global overview
645.3.2. The resolvers section
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020065
666. HTTP header manipulation
67
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +0200687. Using ACLs and fetching samples
697.1. ACL basics
707.1.1. Matching booleans
717.1.2. Matching integers
727.1.3. Matching strings
737.1.4. Matching regular expressions (regexes)
747.1.5. Matching arbitrary data blocks
757.1.6. Matching IPv4 and IPv6 addresses
767.2. Using ACLs to form conditions
777.3. Fetching samples
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +0200787.3.1. Converters
797.3.2. Fetching samples from internal states
807.3.3. Fetching samples at Layer 4
817.3.4. Fetching samples at Layer 5
827.3.5. Fetching samples from buffer contents (Layer 6)
837.3.6. Fetching HTTP samples (Layer 7)
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +0200847.4. Pre-defined ACLs
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020085
868. Logging
878.1. Log levels
888.2. Log formats
898.2.1. Default log format
908.2.2. TCP log format
918.2.3. HTTP log format
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +0100928.2.4. Custom log format
Willy Tarreau5f51e1a2012-12-03 18:40:10 +0100938.2.5. Error log format
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200948.3. Advanced logging options
958.3.1. Disabling logging of external tests
968.3.2. Logging before waiting for the session to terminate
978.3.3. Raising log level upon errors
988.3.4. Disabling logging of successful connections
998.4. Timing events
1008.5. Session state at disconnection
1018.6. Non-printable characters
1028.7. Capturing HTTP cookies
1038.8. Capturing HTTP headers
1048.9. Examples of logs
105
Christopher Fauletc3fe5332016-04-07 15:30:10 +02001069. Supported filters
1079.1. Trace
1089.2. HTTP compression
Christopher Fauletf7e4e7e2016-10-27 22:29:49 +02001099.3. Stream Processing Offload Engine (SPOE)
Christopher Fauletc3fe5332016-04-07 15:30:10 +0200110
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200111
1121. Quick reminder about HTTP
113----------------------------
114
115When haproxy is running in HTTP mode, both the request and the response are
116fully analyzed and indexed, thus it becomes possible to build matching criteria
117on almost anything found in the contents.
118
119However, it is important to understand how HTTP requests and responses are
120formed, and how HAProxy decomposes them. It will then become easier to write
121correct rules and to debug existing configurations.
122
123
1241.1. The HTTP transaction model
125-------------------------------
126
127The HTTP protocol is transaction-driven. This means that each request will lead
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +0100128to one and only one response. Traditionally, a TCP connection is established
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200129from the client to the server, a request is sent by the client on the
130connection, the server responds and the connection is closed. A new request
131will involve a new connection :
132
133 [CON1] [REQ1] ... [RESP1] [CLO1] [CON2] [REQ2] ... [RESP2] [CLO2] ...
134
135In this mode, called the "HTTP close" mode, there are as many connection
136establishments as there are HTTP transactions. Since the connection is closed
137by the server after the response, the client does not need to know the content
138length.
139
140Due to the transactional nature of the protocol, it was possible to improve it
141to avoid closing a connection between two subsequent transactions. In this mode
142however, it is mandatory that the server indicates the content length for each
143response so that the client does not wait indefinitely. For this, a special
144header is used: "Content-length". This mode is called the "keep-alive" mode :
145
146 [CON] [REQ1] ... [RESP1] [REQ2] ... [RESP2] [CLO] ...
147
148Its advantages are a reduced latency between transactions, and less processing
149power required on the server side. It is generally better than the close mode,
150but not always because the clients often limit their concurrent connections to
Patrick Mezard9ec2ec42010-06-12 17:02:45 +0200151a smaller value.
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200152
153A last improvement in the communications is the pipelining mode. It still uses
154keep-alive, but the client does not wait for the first response to send the
155second request. This is useful for fetching large number of images composing a
156page :
157
158 [CON] [REQ1] [REQ2] ... [RESP1] [RESP2] [CLO] ...
159
160This can obviously have a tremendous benefit on performance because the network
161latency is eliminated between subsequent requests. Many HTTP agents do not
162correctly support pipelining since there is no way to associate a response with
163the corresponding request in HTTP. For this reason, it is mandatory for the
Cyril Bonté78caf842010-03-10 22:41:43 +0100164server to reply in the exact same order as the requests were received.
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200165
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +0100166By default HAProxy operates in keep-alive mode with regards to persistent
167connections: for each connection it processes each request and response, and
168leaves the connection idle on both sides between the end of a response and the
169start of a new request.
Patrick Mezard9ec2ec42010-06-12 17:02:45 +0200170
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +0100171HAProxy supports 5 connection modes :
172 - keep alive : all requests and responses are processed (default)
173 - tunnel : only the first request and response are processed,
174 everything else is forwarded with no analysis.
175 - passive close : tunnel with "Connection: close" added in both directions.
176 - server close : the server-facing connection is closed after the response.
177 - forced close : the connection is actively closed after end of response.
178
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200179
1801.2. HTTP request
181-----------------
182
183First, let's consider this HTTP request :
184
185 Line Contents
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +0100186 number
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200187 1 GET /serv/login.php?lang=en&profile=2 HTTP/1.1
188 2 Host: www.mydomain.com
189 3 User-agent: my small browser
190 4 Accept: image/jpeg, image/gif
191 5 Accept: image/png
192
193
1941.2.1. The Request line
195-----------------------
196
197Line 1 is the "request line". It is always composed of 3 fields :
198
199 - a METHOD : GET
200 - a URI : /serv/login.php?lang=en&profile=2
201 - a version tag : HTTP/1.1
202
203All of them are delimited by what the standard calls LWS (linear white spaces),
204which are commonly spaces, but can also be tabs or line feeds/carriage returns
205followed by spaces/tabs. The method itself cannot contain any colon (':') and
206is limited to alphabetic letters. All those various combinations make it
207desirable that HAProxy performs the splitting itself rather than leaving it to
208the user to write a complex or inaccurate regular expression.
209
210The URI itself can have several forms :
211
212 - A "relative URI" :
213
214 /serv/login.php?lang=en&profile=2
215
216 It is a complete URL without the host part. This is generally what is
217 received by servers, reverse proxies and transparent proxies.
218
219 - An "absolute URI", also called a "URL" :
220
221 http://192.168.0.12:8080/serv/login.php?lang=en&profile=2
222
223 It is composed of a "scheme" (the protocol name followed by '://'), a host
224 name or address, optionally a colon (':') followed by a port number, then
225 a relative URI beginning at the first slash ('/') after the address part.
226 This is generally what proxies receive, but a server supporting HTTP/1.1
227 must accept this form too.
228
229 - a star ('*') : this form is only accepted in association with the OPTIONS
230 method and is not relayable. It is used to inquiry a next hop's
231 capabilities.
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +0100232
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200233 - an address:port combination : 192.168.0.12:80
234 This is used with the CONNECT method, which is used to establish TCP
235 tunnels through HTTP proxies, generally for HTTPS, but sometimes for
236 other protocols too.
237
238In a relative URI, two sub-parts are identified. The part before the question
239mark is called the "path". It is typically the relative path to static objects
240on the server. The part after the question mark is called the "query string".
241It is mostly used with GET requests sent to dynamic scripts and is very
242specific to the language, framework or application in use.
243
244
2451.2.2. The request headers
246--------------------------
247
248The headers start at the second line. They are composed of a name at the
249beginning of the line, immediately followed by a colon (':'). Traditionally,
250an LWS is added after the colon but that's not required. Then come the values.
251Multiple identical headers may be folded into one single line, delimiting the
252values with commas, provided that their order is respected. This is commonly
253encountered in the "Cookie:" field. A header may span over multiple lines if
254the subsequent lines begin with an LWS. In the example in 1.2, lines 4 and 5
255define a total of 3 values for the "Accept:" header.
256
257Contrary to a common mis-conception, header names are not case-sensitive, and
258their values are not either if they refer to other header names (such as the
259"Connection:" header).
260
261The end of the headers is indicated by the first empty line. People often say
262that it's a double line feed, which is not exact, even if a double line feed
263is one valid form of empty line.
264
265Fortunately, HAProxy takes care of all these complex combinations when indexing
266headers, checking values and counting them, so there is no reason to worry
267about the way they could be written, but it is important not to accuse an
268application of being buggy if it does unusual, valid things.
269
270Important note:
Lukas Tribus23953682017-04-28 13:24:30 +0000271 As suggested by RFC7231, HAProxy normalizes headers by replacing line breaks
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200272 in the middle of headers by LWS in order to join multi-line headers. This
273 is necessary for proper analysis and helps less capable HTTP parsers to work
274 correctly and not to be fooled by such complex constructs.
275
276
2771.3. HTTP response
278------------------
279
280An HTTP response looks very much like an HTTP request. Both are called HTTP
281messages. Let's consider this HTTP response :
282
283 Line Contents
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +0100284 number
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200285 1 HTTP/1.1 200 OK
286 2 Content-length: 350
287 3 Content-Type: text/html
288
Willy Tarreau816b9792009-09-15 21:25:21 +0200289As a special case, HTTP supports so called "Informational responses" as status
290codes 1xx. These messages are special in that they don't convey any part of the
291response, they're just used as sort of a signaling message to ask a client to
Willy Tarreau5843d1a2010-02-01 15:13:32 +0100292continue to post its request for instance. In the case of a status 100 response
293the requested information will be carried by the next non-100 response message
294following the informational one. This implies that multiple responses may be
295sent to a single request, and that this only works when keep-alive is enabled
296(1xx messages are HTTP/1.1 only). HAProxy handles these messages and is able to
297correctly forward and skip them, and only process the next non-100 response. As
298such, these messages are neither logged nor transformed, unless explicitly
299state otherwise. Status 101 messages indicate that the protocol is changing
300over the same connection and that haproxy must switch to tunnel mode, just as
301if a CONNECT had occurred. Then the Upgrade header would contain additional
302information about the type of protocol the connection is switching to.
Willy Tarreau816b9792009-09-15 21:25:21 +0200303
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200304
3051.3.1. The Response line
306------------------------
307
308Line 1 is the "response line". It is always composed of 3 fields :
309
310 - a version tag : HTTP/1.1
311 - a status code : 200
312 - a reason : OK
313
314The status code is always 3-digit. The first digit indicates a general status :
Willy Tarreau816b9792009-09-15 21:25:21 +0200315 - 1xx = informational message to be skipped (eg: 100, 101)
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200316 - 2xx = OK, content is following (eg: 200, 206)
317 - 3xx = OK, no content following (eg: 302, 304)
318 - 4xx = error caused by the client (eg: 401, 403, 404)
319 - 5xx = error caused by the server (eg: 500, 502, 503)
320
Lukas Tribus23953682017-04-28 13:24:30 +0000321Please refer to RFC7231 for the detailed meaning of all such codes. The
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +0100322"reason" field is just a hint, but is not parsed by clients. Anything can be
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200323found there, but it's a common practice to respect the well-established
324messages. It can be composed of one or multiple words, such as "OK", "Found",
325or "Authentication Required".
326
327Haproxy may emit the following status codes by itself :
328
329 Code When / reason
330 200 access to stats page, and when replying to monitoring requests
331 301 when performing a redirection, depending on the configured code
332 302 when performing a redirection, depending on the configured code
333 303 when performing a redirection, depending on the configured code
Willy Tarreaub67fdc42013-03-29 19:28:11 +0100334 307 when performing a redirection, depending on the configured code
335 308 when performing a redirection, depending on the configured code
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200336 400 for an invalid or too large request
337 401 when an authentication is required to perform the action (when
338 accessing the stats page)
339 403 when a request is forbidden by a "block" ACL or "reqdeny" filter
340 408 when the request timeout strikes before the request is complete
341 500 when haproxy encounters an unrecoverable internal error, such as a
342 memory allocation failure, which should never happen
343 502 when the server returns an empty, invalid or incomplete response, or
344 when an "rspdeny" filter blocks the response.
345 503 when no server was available to handle the request, or in response to
346 monitoring requests which match the "monitor fail" condition
347 504 when the response timeout strikes before the server responds
348
349The error 4xx and 5xx codes above may be customized (see "errorloc" in section
3504.2).
351
352
3531.3.2. The response headers
354---------------------------
355
356Response headers work exactly like request headers, and as such, HAProxy uses
357the same parsing function for both. Please refer to paragraph 1.2.2 for more
358details.
359
360
3612. Configuring HAProxy
362----------------------
363
3642.1. Configuration file format
365------------------------------
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200366
367HAProxy's configuration process involves 3 major sources of parameters :
368
369 - the arguments from the command-line, which always take precedence
370 - the "global" section, which sets process-wide parameters
371 - the proxies sections which can take form of "defaults", "listen",
372 "frontend" and "backend".
373
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +0100374The configuration file syntax consists in lines beginning with a keyword
375referenced in this manual, optionally followed by one or several parameters
William Lallemandf9873ba2015-05-05 17:37:14 +0200376delimited by spaces.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +0100377
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200378
William Lallemandf9873ba2015-05-05 17:37:14 +02003792.2. Quoting and escaping
380-------------------------
381
382HAProxy's configuration introduces a quoting and escaping system similar to
383many programming languages. The configuration file supports 3 types: escaping
384with a backslash, weak quoting with double quotes, and strong quoting with
385single quotes.
386
387If spaces have to be entered in strings, then they must be escaped by preceding
388them by a backslash ('\') or by quoting them. Backslashes also have to be
389escaped by doubling or strong quoting them.
390
391Escaping is achieved by preceding a special character by a backslash ('\'):
392
393 \ to mark a space and differentiate it from a delimiter
394 \# to mark a hash and differentiate it from a comment
395 \\ to use a backslash
396 \' to use a single quote and differentiate it from strong quoting
397 \" to use a double quote and differentiate it from weak quoting
398
399Weak quoting is achieved by using double quotes (""). Weak quoting prevents
400the interpretation of:
401
402 space as a parameter separator
403 ' single quote as a strong quoting delimiter
404 # hash as a comment start
405
William Lallemandb2f07452015-05-12 14:27:13 +0200406Weak quoting permits the interpretation of variables, if you want to use a non
407-interpreted dollar within a double quoted string, you should escape it with a
408backslash ("\$"), it does not work outside weak quoting.
409
410Interpretation of escaping and special characters are not prevented by weak
William Lallemandf9873ba2015-05-05 17:37:14 +0200411quoting.
412
413Strong quoting is achieved by using single quotes (''). Inside single quotes,
414nothing is interpreted, it's the efficient way to quote regexes.
415
416Quoted and escaped strings are replaced in memory by their interpreted
417equivalent, it allows you to perform concatenation.
418
419 Example:
420 # those are equivalents:
421 log-format %{+Q}o\ %t\ %s\ %{-Q}r
422 log-format "%{+Q}o %t %s %{-Q}r"
423 log-format '%{+Q}o %t %s %{-Q}r'
424 log-format "%{+Q}o %t"' %s %{-Q}r'
425 log-format "%{+Q}o %t"' %s'\ %{-Q}r
426
427 # those are equivalents:
428 reqrep "^([^\ :]*)\ /static/(.*)" \1\ /\2
429 reqrep "^([^ :]*)\ /static/(.*)" '\1 /\2'
430 reqrep "^([^ :]*)\ /static/(.*)" "\1 /\2"
431 reqrep "^([^ :]*)\ /static/(.*)" "\1\ /\2"
432
433
William Lallemandb2f07452015-05-12 14:27:13 +02004342.3. Environment variables
435--------------------------
436
437HAProxy's configuration supports environment variables. Those variables are
438interpreted only within double quotes. Variables are expanded during the
439configuration parsing. Variable names must be preceded by a dollar ("$") and
440optionally enclosed with braces ("{}") similarly to what is done in Bourne
441shell. Variable names can contain alphanumerical characters or the character
442underscore ("_") but should not start with a digit.
443
444 Example:
445
446 bind "fd@${FD_APP1}"
447
448 log "${LOCAL_SYSLOG}:514" local0 notice # send to local server
449
450 user "$HAPROXY_USER"
451
452
4532.4. Time format
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200454----------------
455
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +0100456Some parameters involve values representing time, such as timeouts. These
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +0100457values are generally expressed in milliseconds (unless explicitly stated
458otherwise) but may be expressed in any other unit by suffixing the unit to the
459numeric value. It is important to consider this because it will not be repeated
460for every keyword. Supported units are :
461
462 - us : microseconds. 1 microsecond = 1/1000000 second
463 - ms : milliseconds. 1 millisecond = 1/1000 second. This is the default.
464 - s : seconds. 1s = 1000ms
465 - m : minutes. 1m = 60s = 60000ms
466 - h : hours. 1h = 60m = 3600s = 3600000ms
467 - d : days. 1d = 24h = 1440m = 86400s = 86400000ms
468
469
Lukas Tribusaa83a312017-03-21 09:25:09 +00004702.5. Examples
Patrick Mezard35da19c2010-06-12 17:02:47 +0200471-------------
472
473 # Simple configuration for an HTTP proxy listening on port 80 on all
474 # interfaces and forwarding requests to a single backend "servers" with a
475 # single server "server1" listening on 127.0.0.1:8000
476 global
477 daemon
478 maxconn 256
479
480 defaults
481 mode http
482 timeout connect 5000ms
483 timeout client 50000ms
484 timeout server 50000ms
485
486 frontend http-in
487 bind *:80
488 default_backend servers
489
490 backend servers
491 server server1 127.0.0.1:8000 maxconn 32
492
493
494 # The same configuration defined with a single listen block. Shorter but
495 # less expressive, especially in HTTP mode.
496 global
497 daemon
498 maxconn 256
499
500 defaults
501 mode http
502 timeout connect 5000ms
503 timeout client 50000ms
504 timeout server 50000ms
505
506 listen http-in
507 bind *:80
508 server server1 127.0.0.1:8000 maxconn 32
509
510
511Assuming haproxy is in $PATH, test these configurations in a shell with:
512
Willy Tarreauccb289d2010-12-11 20:19:38 +0100513 $ sudo haproxy -f configuration.conf -c
Patrick Mezard35da19c2010-06-12 17:02:47 +0200514
515
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02005163. Global parameters
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200517--------------------
518
519Parameters in the "global" section are process-wide and often OS-specific. They
520are generally set once for all and do not need being changed once correct. Some
521of them have command-line equivalents.
522
523The following keywords are supported in the "global" section :
524
525 * Process management and security
Emeric Brunc8e8d122012-10-02 18:42:10 +0200526 - ca-base
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200527 - chroot
Emeric Brunc8e8d122012-10-02 18:42:10 +0200528 - crt-base
Baptiste Assmann3493d0f2015-10-12 20:21:23 +0200529 - cpu-map
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200530 - daemon
Baptiste Assmann3493d0f2015-10-12 20:21:23 +0200531 - description
532 - deviceatlas-json-file
533 - deviceatlas-log-level
534 - deviceatlas-separator
535 - deviceatlas-properties-cookie
Simon Horman98637e52014-06-20 12:30:16 +0900536 - external-check
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200537 - gid
538 - group
Cyril Bonté203ec5a2017-03-23 22:44:13 +0100539 - hard-stop-after
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200540 - log
Baptiste Assmann3493d0f2015-10-12 20:21:23 +0200541 - log-tag
Joe Williamsdf5b38f2010-12-29 17:05:48 +0100542 - log-send-hostname
Baptiste Assmann3493d0f2015-10-12 20:21:23 +0200543 - lua-load
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200544 - nbproc
Christopher Fauletbe0faa22017-08-29 15:37:10 +0200545 - nbthread
Baptiste Assmann3493d0f2015-10-12 20:21:23 +0200546 - node
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200547 - pidfile
Willy Tarreau1d549722016-02-16 12:41:57 +0100548 - presetenv
549 - resetenv
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200550 - uid
551 - ulimit-n
552 - user
Willy Tarreau1d549722016-02-16 12:41:57 +0100553 - setenv
Willy Tarreaufbee7132007-10-18 13:53:22 +0200554 - stats
Baptiste Assmann3493d0f2015-10-12 20:21:23 +0200555 - ssl-default-bind-ciphers
556 - ssl-default-bind-options
557 - ssl-default-server-ciphers
558 - ssl-default-server-options
559 - ssl-dh-param-file
Emeric Brun850efd52014-01-29 12:24:34 +0100560 - ssl-server-verify
Christopher Faulet62519022017-10-16 15:49:32 +0200561 - thread-map
Willy Tarreauceb24bc2010-11-09 12:46:41 +0100562 - unix-bind
Willy Tarreau1d549722016-02-16 12:41:57 +0100563 - unsetenv
Thomas Holmesdb04f192015-05-18 13:21:39 +0100564 - 51degrees-data-file
565 - 51degrees-property-name-list
Dragan Dosen93b38d92015-06-29 16:43:25 +0200566 - 51degrees-property-separator
Dragan Dosenae6d39a2015-06-29 16:43:27 +0200567 - 51degrees-cache-size
scientiamobiled0027ed2016-11-04 10:55:08 +0100568 - wurfl-data-file
569 - wurfl-information-list
570 - wurfl-information-list-separator
571 - wurfl-engine-mode
572 - wurfl-cache-size
573 - wurfl-useragent-priority
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +0100574
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200575 * Performance tuning
Willy Tarreau1746eec2014-04-25 10:46:47 +0200576 - max-spread-checks
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200577 - maxconn
Willy Tarreau81c25d02011-09-07 15:17:21 +0200578 - maxconnrate
William Lallemandd85f9172012-11-09 17:05:39 +0100579 - maxcomprate
William Lallemand072a2bf2012-11-20 17:01:01 +0100580 - maxcompcpuusage
Willy Tarreauff4f82d2009-02-06 11:28:13 +0100581 - maxpipes
Willy Tarreau93e7c002013-10-07 18:51:07 +0200582 - maxsessrate
Willy Tarreau403edff2012-09-06 11:58:37 +0200583 - maxsslconn
Willy Tarreaue43d5322013-10-07 20:01:52 +0200584 - maxsslrate
Baptiste Assmann3493d0f2015-10-12 20:21:23 +0200585 - maxzlibmem
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200586 - noepoll
587 - nokqueue
588 - nopoll
Willy Tarreauff4f82d2009-02-06 11:28:13 +0100589 - nosplice
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +0300590 - nogetaddrinfo
Lukas Tribusa0bcbdc2016-09-12 21:42:20 +0000591 - noreuseport
Willy Tarreaufe255b72007-10-14 23:09:26 +0200592 - spread-checks
Baptiste Assmann5626f482015-08-23 10:00:10 +0200593 - server-state-base
Baptiste Assmannef1f0fc2015-08-23 10:06:39 +0200594 - server-state-file
Grant Zhang872f9c22017-01-21 01:10:18 +0000595 - ssl-engine
Grant Zhangfa6c7ee2017-01-14 01:42:15 +0000596 - ssl-mode-async
Baptiste Assmann3493d0f2015-10-12 20:21:23 +0200597 - tune.buffers.limit
598 - tune.buffers.reserve
Willy Tarreau27a674e2009-08-17 07:23:33 +0200599 - tune.bufsize
Willy Tarreau43961d52010-10-04 20:39:20 +0200600 - tune.chksize
William Lallemandf3747832012-11-09 12:33:10 +0100601 - tune.comp.maxlevel
Willy Tarreau193b8c62012-11-22 00:17:38 +0100602 - tune.http.cookielen
Stéphane Cottin23e9e932017-05-18 08:58:41 +0200603 - tune.http.logurilen
Willy Tarreauac1932d2011-10-24 19:14:41 +0200604 - tune.http.maxhdr
Willy Tarreau7e312732014-02-12 16:35:14 +0100605 - tune.idletimer
Thierry FOURNIER90da1912015-03-05 11:17:06 +0100606 - tune.lua.forced-yield
Willy Tarreau32f61e22015-03-18 17:54:59 +0100607 - tune.lua.maxmem
Thierry FOURNIER90da1912015-03-05 11:17:06 +0100608 - tune.lua.session-timeout
609 - tune.lua.task-timeout
Thierry FOURNIER7dd784b2015-10-01 14:49:33 +0200610 - tune.lua.service-timeout
Willy Tarreaua0250ba2008-01-06 11:22:57 +0100611 - tune.maxaccept
612 - tune.maxpollevents
Willy Tarreau27a674e2009-08-17 07:23:33 +0200613 - tune.maxrewrite
Willy Tarreauf3045d22015-04-29 16:24:50 +0200614 - tune.pattern.cache-size
Willy Tarreaubd9a0a72011-10-23 21:14:29 +0200615 - tune.pipesize
Willy Tarreaue803de22010-01-21 17:43:04 +0100616 - tune.rcvbuf.client
617 - tune.rcvbuf.server
Willy Tarreaub22fc302015-12-14 12:04:35 +0100618 - tune.recv_enough
Willy Tarreaue803de22010-01-21 17:43:04 +0100619 - tune.sndbuf.client
620 - tune.sndbuf.server
Willy Tarreau6ec58db2012-11-16 16:32:15 +0100621 - tune.ssl.cachesize
Willy Tarreaubfd59462013-02-21 07:46:09 +0100622 - tune.ssl.lifetime
Emeric Brun8dc60392014-05-09 13:52:00 +0200623 - tune.ssl.force-private-cache
Willy Tarreaubfd59462013-02-21 07:46:09 +0100624 - tune.ssl.maxrecord
Remi Gacognef46cd6e2014-06-12 14:58:40 +0200625 - tune.ssl.default-dh-param
Christopher Faulet31af49d2015-06-09 17:29:50 +0200626 - tune.ssl.ssl-ctx-cache-size
Thierry FOURNIER5bf77322017-02-25 12:45:22 +0100627 - tune.ssl.capture-cipherlist-size
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +0200628 - tune.vars.global-max-size
Christopher Fauletff2613e2016-11-09 11:36:17 +0100629 - tune.vars.proc-max-size
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +0200630 - tune.vars.reqres-max-size
631 - tune.vars.sess-max-size
632 - tune.vars.txn-max-size
William Lallemanda509e4c2012-11-07 16:54:34 +0100633 - tune.zlib.memlevel
634 - tune.zlib.windowsize
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +0100635
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200636 * Debugging
637 - debug
638 - quiet
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200639
640
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02006413.1. Process management and security
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200642------------------------------------
643
Emeric Brunc8e8d122012-10-02 18:42:10 +0200644ca-base <dir>
645 Assigns a default directory to fetch SSL CA certificates and CRLs from when a
Emeric Brunfd33a262012-10-11 16:28:27 +0200646 relative path is used with "ca-file" or "crl-file" directives. Absolute
647 locations specified in "ca-file" and "crl-file" prevail and ignore "ca-base".
Emeric Brunc8e8d122012-10-02 18:42:10 +0200648
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200649chroot <jail dir>
650 Changes current directory to <jail dir> and performs a chroot() there before
651 dropping privileges. This increases the security level in case an unknown
652 vulnerability would be exploited, since it would make it very hard for the
653 attacker to exploit the system. This only works when the process is started
654 with superuser privileges. It is important to ensure that <jail_dir> is both
655 empty and unwritable to anyone.
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +0100656
Willy Tarreaufc6c0322012-11-16 16:12:27 +0100657cpu-map <"all"|"odd"|"even"|process_num> <cpu-set>...
658 On Linux 2.6 and above, it is possible to bind a process to a specific CPU
659 set. This means that the process will never run on other CPUs. The "cpu-map"
660 directive specifies CPU sets for process sets. The first argument is the
Willy Tarreaua9db57e2013-01-18 11:29:29 +0100661 process number to bind. This process must have a number between 1 and 32 or
662 64, depending on the machine's word size, and any process IDs above nbproc
663 are ignored. It is possible to specify all processes at once using "all",
664 only odd numbers using "odd" or even numbers using "even", just like with the
665 "bind-process" directive. The second and forthcoming arguments are CPU sets.
666 Each CPU set is either a unique number between 0 and 31 or 63 or a range with
667 two such numbers delimited by a dash ('-'). Multiple CPU numbers or ranges
668 may be specified, and the processes will be allowed to bind to all of them.
669 Obviously, multiple "cpu-map" directives may be specified. Each "cpu-map"
670 directive will replace the previous ones when they overlap.
Willy Tarreaufc6c0322012-11-16 16:12:27 +0100671
Emeric Brunc8e8d122012-10-02 18:42:10 +0200672crt-base <dir>
673 Assigns a default directory to fetch SSL certificates from when a relative
674 path is used with "crtfile" directives. Absolute locations specified after
675 "crtfile" prevail and ignore "crt-base".
676
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200677daemon
678 Makes the process fork into background. This is the recommended mode of
679 operation. It is equivalent to the command line "-D" argument. It can be
680 disabled by the command line "-db" argument.
681
David Carlier8167f302015-06-01 13:50:06 +0200682deviceatlas-json-file <path>
683 Sets the path of the DeviceAtlas JSON data file to be loaded by the API.
684 The path must be a valid JSON data file and accessible by Haproxy process.
685
686deviceatlas-log-level <value>
687 Sets the level of informations returned by the API. This directive is
688 optional and set to 0 by default if not set.
689
690deviceatlas-separator <char>
691 Sets the character separator for the API properties results. This directive
692 is optional and set to | by default if not set.
693
Cyril Bonté0306c4a2015-10-26 22:37:38 +0100694deviceatlas-properties-cookie <name>
Cyril Bonté307ee1e2015-09-28 23:16:06 +0200695 Sets the client cookie's name used for the detection if the DeviceAtlas
696 Client-side component was used during the request. This directive is optional
697 and set to DAPROPS by default if not set.
David Carlier29b3ca32015-09-25 14:09:21 +0100698
Simon Horman98637e52014-06-20 12:30:16 +0900699external-check
700 Allows the use of an external agent to perform health checks.
701 This is disabled by default as a security precaution.
702 See "option external-check".
703
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200704gid <number>
705 Changes the process' group ID to <number>. It is recommended that the group
706 ID is dedicated to HAProxy or to a small set of similar daemons. HAProxy must
707 be started with a user belonging to this group, or with superuser privileges.
Michael Schererab012dd2013-01-12 18:35:19 +0100708 Note that if haproxy is started from a user having supplementary groups, it
709 will only be able to drop these groups if started with superuser privileges.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200710 See also "group" and "uid".
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +0100711
Cyril Bonté203ec5a2017-03-23 22:44:13 +0100712hard-stop-after <time>
713 Defines the maximum time allowed to perform a clean soft-stop.
714
715 Arguments :
716 <time> is the maximum time (by default in milliseconds) for which the
717 instance will remain alive when a soft-stop is received via the
718 SIGUSR1 signal.
719
720 This may be used to ensure that the instance will quit even if connections
721 remain opened during a soft-stop (for example with long timeouts for a proxy
722 in tcp mode). It applies both in TCP and HTTP mode.
723
724 Example:
725 global
726 hard-stop-after 30s
727
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200728group <group name>
729 Similar to "gid" but uses the GID of group name <group name> from /etc/group.
730 See also "gid" and "user".
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +0100731
Dragan Dosen7ad31542015-09-28 17:16:47 +0200732log <address> [len <length>] [format <format>] <facility> [max level [min level]]
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200733 Adds a global syslog server. Up to two global servers can be defined. They
734 will receive logs for startups and exits, as well as all logs from proxies
Robert Tsai81ae1952007-12-05 10:47:29 +0100735 configured with "log global".
736
737 <address> can be one of:
738
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +0100739 - An IPv4 address optionally followed by a colon and a UDP port. If
Robert Tsai81ae1952007-12-05 10:47:29 +0100740 no port is specified, 514 is used by default (the standard syslog
741 port).
742
David du Colombier24bb5f52011-03-17 10:40:23 +0100743 - An IPv6 address followed by a colon and optionally a UDP port. If
744 no port is specified, 514 is used by default (the standard syslog
745 port).
746
Robert Tsai81ae1952007-12-05 10:47:29 +0100747 - A filesystem path to a UNIX domain socket, keeping in mind
748 considerations for chroot (be sure the path is accessible inside
749 the chroot) and uid/gid (be sure the path is appropriately
750 writeable).
751
William Lallemandb2f07452015-05-12 14:27:13 +0200752 You may want to reference some environment variables in the address
753 parameter, see section 2.3 about environment variables.
Willy Tarreaudad36a32013-03-11 01:20:04 +0100754
Willy Tarreau18324f52014-06-27 18:10:07 +0200755 <length> is an optional maximum line length. Log lines larger than this value
756 will be truncated before being sent. The reason is that syslog
757 servers act differently on log line length. All servers support the
758 default value of 1024, but some servers simply drop larger lines
759 while others do log them. If a server supports long lines, it may
760 make sense to set this value here in order to avoid truncating long
761 lines. Similarly, if a server drops long lines, it is preferable to
762 truncate them before sending them. Accepted values are 80 to 65535
763 inclusive. The default value of 1024 is generally fine for all
764 standard usages. Some specific cases of long captures or
Stéphane Cottin23e9e932017-05-18 08:58:41 +0200765 JSON-formated logs may require larger values. You may also need to
766 increase "tune.http.logurilen" if your request uris are truncated.
Willy Tarreau18324f52014-06-27 18:10:07 +0200767
Dragan Dosen7ad31542015-09-28 17:16:47 +0200768 <format> is the log format used when generating syslog messages. It may be
769 one of the following :
770
771 rfc3164 The RFC3164 syslog message format. This is the default.
772 (https://tools.ietf.org/html/rfc3164)
773
774 rfc5424 The RFC5424 syslog message format.
775 (https://tools.ietf.org/html/rfc5424)
776
Robert Tsai81ae1952007-12-05 10:47:29 +0100777 <facility> must be one of the 24 standard syslog facilities :
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200778
779 kern user mail daemon auth syslog lpr news
780 uucp cron auth2 ftp ntp audit alert cron2
781 local0 local1 local2 local3 local4 local5 local6 local7
782
783 An optional level can be specified to filter outgoing messages. By default,
Willy Tarreauf7edefa2009-05-10 17:20:05 +0200784 all messages are sent. If a maximum level is specified, only messages with a
785 severity at least as important as this level will be sent. An optional minimum
786 level can be specified. If it is set, logs emitted with a more severe level
787 than this one will be capped to this level. This is used to avoid sending
788 "emerg" messages on all terminals on some default syslog configurations.
789 Eight levels are known :
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200790
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +0200791 emerg alert crit err warning notice info debug
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200792
Joe Williamsdf5b38f2010-12-29 17:05:48 +0100793log-send-hostname [<string>]
794 Sets the hostname field in the syslog header. If optional "string" parameter
795 is set the header is set to the string contents, otherwise uses the hostname
796 of the system. Generally used if one is not relaying logs through an
797 intermediate syslog server or for simply customizing the hostname printed in
798 the logs.
799
Kevinm48936af2010-12-22 16:08:21 +0000800log-tag <string>
801 Sets the tag field in the syslog header to this string. It defaults to the
802 program name as launched from the command line, which usually is "haproxy".
803 Sometimes it can be useful to differentiate between multiple processes
Willy Tarreau094af4e2015-01-07 15:03:42 +0100804 running on the same host. See also the per-proxy "log-tag" directive.
Kevinm48936af2010-12-22 16:08:21 +0000805
Thierry FOURNIER90da1912015-03-05 11:17:06 +0100806lua-load <file>
807 This global directive loads and executes a Lua file. This directive can be
808 used multiple times.
809
William Lallemande202b1e2017-06-01 17:38:56 +0200810master-worker [exit-on-failure]
811 Master-worker mode. It is equivalent to the command line "-W" argument.
812 This mode will launch a "master" which will monitor the "workers". Using
813 this mode, you can reload HAProxy directly by sending a SIGUSR2 signal to
814 the master. The master-worker mode is compatible either with the foreground
815 or daemon mode. It is recommended to use this mode with multiprocess and
816 systemd.
817 The "exit-on-failure" option allows the master to kill every workers and
818 exit when one of the current workers died. It is convenient to combine this
819 option with Restart=on-failure in a systemd unit file in order to relaunch
820 the whole process.
821
822 See alors "-W" in the management guide.
823
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200824nbproc <number>
825 Creates <number> processes when going daemon. This requires the "daemon"
826 mode. By default, only one process is created, which is the recommended mode
827 of operation. For systems limited to small sets of file descriptors per
828 process, it may be needed to fork multiple daemons. USING MULTIPLE PROCESSES
829 IS HARDER TO DEBUG AND IS REALLY DISCOURAGED. See also "daemon".
830
Christopher Fauletbe0faa22017-08-29 15:37:10 +0200831nbthread <number>
832 This setting is only available when support for threads was built in. It
833 creates <number> threads for each created processes. It means if HAProxy is
834 started in foreground, it only creates <number> threads for the first
835 process. FOR NOW, THREADS SUPPORT IN HAPROXY IS HIGHLY EXPERIMENTAL AND IT
836 MUST BE ENABLED WITH CAUTION AND AT YOUR OWN RISK. See also "nbproc".
837
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200838pidfile <pidfile>
839 Writes pids of all daemons into file <pidfile>. This option is equivalent to
840 the "-p" command line argument. The file must be accessible to the user
841 starting the process. See also "daemon".
842
Willy Tarreau1d549722016-02-16 12:41:57 +0100843presetenv <name> <value>
844 Sets environment variable <name> to value <value>. If the variable exists, it
845 is NOT overwritten. The changes immediately take effect so that the next line
846 in the configuration file sees the new value. See also "setenv", "resetenv",
847 and "unsetenv".
848
849resetenv [<name> ...]
850 Removes all environment variables except the ones specified in argument. It
851 allows to use a clean controlled environment before setting new values with
852 setenv or unsetenv. Please note that some internal functions may make use of
853 some environment variables, such as time manipulation functions, but also
854 OpenSSL or even external checks. This must be used with extreme care and only
855 after complete validation. The changes immediately take effect so that the
856 next line in the configuration file sees the new environment. See also
857 "setenv", "presetenv", and "unsetenv".
858
Willy Tarreaua9db57e2013-01-18 11:29:29 +0100859stats bind-process [ all | odd | even | <number 1-64>[-<number 1-64>] ] ...
Willy Tarreau35b7b162012-10-22 23:17:18 +0200860 Limits the stats socket to a certain set of processes numbers. By default the
861 stats socket is bound to all processes, causing a warning to be emitted when
862 nbproc is greater than 1 because there is no way to select the target process
863 when connecting. However, by using this setting, it becomes possible to pin
864 the stats socket to a specific set of processes, typically the first one. The
865 warning will automatically be disabled when this setting is used, whatever
Willy Tarreaua9db57e2013-01-18 11:29:29 +0100866 the number of processes used. The maximum process ID depends on the machine's
Willy Tarreauae302532014-05-07 19:22:24 +0200867 word size (32 or 64). A better option consists in using the "process" setting
868 of the "stats socket" line to force the process on each line.
Willy Tarreau35b7b162012-10-22 23:17:18 +0200869
Baptiste Assmann5626f482015-08-23 10:00:10 +0200870server-state-base <directory>
871 Specifies the directory prefix to be prepended in front of all servers state
Baptiste Assmann01c6cc32015-08-23 11:45:29 +0200872 file names which do not start with a '/'. See also "server-state-file",
873 "load-server-state-from-file" and "server-state-file-name".
Baptiste Assmannef1f0fc2015-08-23 10:06:39 +0200874
875server-state-file <file>
876 Specifies the path to the file containing state of servers. If the path starts
877 with a slash ('/'), it is considered absolute, otherwise it is considered
878 relative to the directory specified using "server-state-base" (if set) or to
879 the current directory. Before reloading HAProxy, it is possible to save the
880 servers' current state using the stats command "show servers state". The
881 output of this command must be written in the file pointed by <file>. When
882 starting up, before handling traffic, HAProxy will read, load and apply state
883 for each server found in the file and available in its current running
Baptiste Assmann01c6cc32015-08-23 11:45:29 +0200884 configuration. See also "server-state-base" and "show servers state",
885 "load-server-state-from-file" and "server-state-file-name"
Baptiste Assmann5626f482015-08-23 10:00:10 +0200886
Willy Tarreau1d549722016-02-16 12:41:57 +0100887setenv <name> <value>
888 Sets environment variable <name> to value <value>. If the variable exists, it
889 is overwritten. The changes immediately take effect so that the next line in
890 the configuration file sees the new value. See also "presetenv", "resetenv",
891 and "unsetenv".
892
Willy Tarreau610f04b2014-02-13 11:36:41 +0100893ssl-default-bind-ciphers <ciphers>
894 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It sets
895 the default string describing the list of cipher algorithms ("cipher suite")
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +0300896 that are negotiated during the SSL/TLS handshake for all "bind" lines which
Willy Tarreau610f04b2014-02-13 11:36:41 +0100897 do not explicitly define theirs. The format of the string is defined in
898 "man 1 ciphers" from OpenSSL man pages, and can be for instance a string such
899 as "AES:ALL:!aNULL:!eNULL:+RC4:@STRENGTH" (without quotes). Please check the
900 "bind" keyword for more information.
901
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +0100902ssl-default-bind-options [<option>]...
903 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It sets
904 default ssl-options to force on all "bind" lines. Please check the "bind"
905 keyword to see available options.
906
907 Example:
908 global
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +0200909 ssl-default-bind-options ssl-min-ver TLSv1.0 no-tls-tickets
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +0100910
Willy Tarreau610f04b2014-02-13 11:36:41 +0100911ssl-default-server-ciphers <ciphers>
912 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
913 sets the default string describing the list of cipher algorithms that are
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +0300914 negotiated during the SSL/TLS handshake with the server, for all "server"
Willy Tarreau610f04b2014-02-13 11:36:41 +0100915 lines which do not explicitly define theirs. The format of the string is
916 defined in "man 1 ciphers". Please check the "server" keyword for more
917 information.
918
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +0100919ssl-default-server-options [<option>]...
920 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It sets
921 default ssl-options to force on all "server" lines. Please check the "server"
922 keyword to see available options.
923
Remi Gacogne47783ef2015-05-29 15:53:22 +0200924ssl-dh-param-file <file>
925 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It sets
926 the default DH parameters that are used during the SSL/TLS handshake when
927 ephemeral Diffie-Hellman (DHE) key exchange is used, for all "bind" lines
928 which do not explicitely define theirs. It will be overridden by custom DH
929 parameters found in a bind certificate file if any. If custom DH parameters
Cyril Bonté307ee1e2015-09-28 23:16:06 +0200930 are not specified either by using ssl-dh-param-file or by setting them
931 directly in the certificate file, pre-generated DH parameters of the size
932 specified by tune.ssl.default-dh-param will be used. Custom parameters are
933 known to be more secure and therefore their use is recommended.
Remi Gacogne47783ef2015-05-29 15:53:22 +0200934 Custom DH parameters may be generated by using the OpenSSL command
935 "openssl dhparam <size>", where size should be at least 2048, as 1024-bit DH
936 parameters should not be considered secure anymore.
937
Emeric Brun850efd52014-01-29 12:24:34 +0100938ssl-server-verify [none|required]
939 The default behavior for SSL verify on servers side. If specified to 'none',
940 servers certificates are not verified. The default is 'required' except if
941 forced using cmdline option '-dV'.
942
Christopher Faulet62519022017-10-16 15:49:32 +0200943
944thread-map <"all"|"odd"|"even"|process_num> <"all"|"odd"|"even"|thread_num> <cpu-set>...
945 This setting is only available when support for threads was built in. It
946 binds a thread to a specific CPU set. The process must be specified to allow
947 different mapping for different processes. For details about the arguments,
948 see "cpu-map" directive. A thread will be bound on the intersection of its
949 mapping and the one of the process on which it is attached. If the
950 intersection is null, no specific bind will be set for the thread.
951
Willy Tarreauabb175f2012-09-24 12:43:26 +0200952stats socket [<address:port>|<path>] [param*]
953 Binds a UNIX socket to <path> or a TCPv4/v6 address to <address:port>.
954 Connections to this socket will return various statistics outputs and even
955 allow some commands to be issued to change some runtime settings. Please
Willy Tarreau1af20c72017-06-23 16:01:14 +0200956 consult section 9.3 "Unix Socket commands" of Management Guide for more
Kevin Decherf949c7202015-10-13 23:26:44 +0200957 details.
Willy Tarreau6162db22009-10-10 17:13:00 +0200958
Willy Tarreauabb175f2012-09-24 12:43:26 +0200959 All parameters supported by "bind" lines are supported, for instance to
960 restrict access to some users or their access rights. Please consult
961 section 5.1 for more information.
Willy Tarreaufbee7132007-10-18 13:53:22 +0200962
963stats timeout <timeout, in milliseconds>
964 The default timeout on the stats socket is set to 10 seconds. It is possible
965 to change this value with "stats timeout". The value must be passed in
Willy Tarreaubefdff12007-12-02 22:27:38 +0100966 milliseconds, or be suffixed by a time unit among { us, ms, s, m, h, d }.
Willy Tarreaufbee7132007-10-18 13:53:22 +0200967
968stats maxconn <connections>
969 By default, the stats socket is limited to 10 concurrent connections. It is
970 possible to change this value with "stats maxconn".
971
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200972uid <number>
973 Changes the process' user ID to <number>. It is recommended that the user ID
974 is dedicated to HAProxy or to a small set of similar daemons. HAProxy must
975 be started with superuser privileges in order to be able to switch to another
976 one. See also "gid" and "user".
977
978ulimit-n <number>
979 Sets the maximum number of per-process file-descriptors to <number>. By
980 default, it is automatically computed, so it is recommended not to use this
981 option.
982
Willy Tarreauceb24bc2010-11-09 12:46:41 +0100983unix-bind [ prefix <prefix> ] [ mode <mode> ] [ user <user> ] [ uid <uid> ]
984 [ group <group> ] [ gid <gid> ]
985
986 Fixes common settings to UNIX listening sockets declared in "bind" statements.
987 This is mainly used to simplify declaration of those UNIX sockets and reduce
988 the risk of errors, since those settings are most commonly required but are
989 also process-specific. The <prefix> setting can be used to force all socket
990 path to be relative to that directory. This might be needed to access another
991 component's chroot. Note that those paths are resolved before haproxy chroots
992 itself, so they are absolute. The <mode>, <user>, <uid>, <group> and <gid>
993 all have the same meaning as their homonyms used by the "bind" statement. If
994 both are specified, the "bind" statement has priority, meaning that the
995 "unix-bind" settings may be seen as process-wide default settings.
996
Willy Tarreau1d549722016-02-16 12:41:57 +0100997unsetenv [<name> ...]
998 Removes environment variables specified in arguments. This can be useful to
999 hide some sensitive information that are occasionally inherited from the
1000 user's environment during some operations. Variables which did not exist are
1001 silently ignored so that after the operation, it is certain that none of
1002 these variables remain. The changes immediately take effect so that the next
1003 line in the configuration file will not see these variables. See also
1004 "setenv", "presetenv", and "resetenv".
1005
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001006user <user name>
1007 Similar to "uid" but uses the UID of user name <user name> from /etc/passwd.
1008 See also "uid" and "group".
1009
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki48cb2ae2009-10-02 22:51:14 +02001010node <name>
1011 Only letters, digits, hyphen and underscore are allowed, like in DNS names.
1012
1013 This statement is useful in HA configurations where two or more processes or
1014 servers share the same IP address. By setting a different node-name on all
1015 nodes, it becomes easy to immediately spot what server is handling the
1016 traffic.
1017
1018description <text>
1019 Add a text that describes the instance.
1020
1021 Please note that it is required to escape certain characters (# for example)
1022 and this text is inserted into a html page so you should avoid using
1023 "<" and ">" characters.
1024
Thomas Holmesdb04f192015-05-18 13:21:39 +0100102551degrees-data-file <file path>
1026 The path of the 51Degrees data file to provide device detection services. The
1027 file should be unzipped and accessible by HAProxy with relevavnt permissions.
1028
Dragan Dosenae6d39a2015-06-29 16:43:27 +02001029 Please note that this option is only available when haproxy has been
Thomas Holmesdb04f192015-05-18 13:21:39 +01001030 compiled with USE_51DEGREES.
1031
Ben Shillitof25e8e52016-12-02 14:25:37 +0000103251degrees-property-name-list [<string> ...]
Thomas Holmesdb04f192015-05-18 13:21:39 +01001033 A list of 51Degrees property names to be load from the dataset. A full list
1034 of names is available on the 51Degrees website:
1035 https://51degrees.com/resources/property-dictionary
1036
Dragan Dosenae6d39a2015-06-29 16:43:27 +02001037 Please note that this option is only available when haproxy has been
Thomas Holmesdb04f192015-05-18 13:21:39 +01001038 compiled with USE_51DEGREES.
1039
Dragan Dosen93b38d92015-06-29 16:43:25 +0200104051degrees-property-separator <char>
Thomas Holmesdb04f192015-05-18 13:21:39 +01001041 A char that will be appended to every property value in a response header
1042 containing 51Degrees results. If not set that will be set as ','.
1043
Dragan Dosenae6d39a2015-06-29 16:43:27 +02001044 Please note that this option is only available when haproxy has been
1045 compiled with USE_51DEGREES.
1046
104751degrees-cache-size <number>
1048 Sets the size of the 51Degrees converter cache to <number> entries. This
1049 is an LRU cache which reminds previous device detections and their results.
1050 By default, this cache is disabled.
1051
1052 Please note that this option is only available when haproxy has been
Thomas Holmesdb04f192015-05-18 13:21:39 +01001053 compiled with USE_51DEGREES.
1054
scientiamobiled0027ed2016-11-04 10:55:08 +01001055wurfl-data-file <file path>
1056 The path of the WURFL data file to provide device detection services. The
1057 file should be accessible by HAProxy with relevant permissions.
1058
1059 Please note that this option is only available when haproxy has been compiled
1060 with USE_WURFL=1.
1061
1062wurfl-information-list [<capability>]*
1063 A space-delimited list of WURFL capabilities, virtual capabilities, property
1064 names we plan to use in injected headers. A full list of capability and
1065 virtual capability names is available on the Scientiamobile website :
1066
1067 https://www.scientiamobile.com/wurflCapability
1068
1069 Valid WURFL properties are:
1070 - wurfl_id Contains the device ID of the matched device.
1071
1072 - wurfl_root_id Contains the device root ID of the matched
1073 device.
1074
1075 - wurfl_isdevroot Tells if the matched device is a root device.
1076 Possible values are "TRUE" or "FALSE".
1077
1078 - wurfl_useragent The original useragent coming with this
1079 particular web request.
1080
1081 - wurfl_api_version Contains a string representing the currently
1082 used Libwurfl API version.
1083
1084 - wurfl_engine_target Contains a string representing the currently
1085 set WURFL Engine Target. Possible values are
1086 "HIGH_ACCURACY", "HIGH_PERFORMANCE", "INVALID".
1087
1088 - wurfl_info A string containing information on the parsed
1089 wurfl.xml and its full path.
1090
1091 - wurfl_last_load_time Contains the UNIX timestamp of the last time
1092 WURFL has been loaded successfully.
1093
1094 - wurfl_normalized_useragent The normalized useragent.
1095
1096 - wurfl_useragent_priority The user agent priority used by WURFL.
1097
1098 Please note that this option is only available when haproxy has been compiled
1099 with USE_WURFL=1.
1100
1101wurfl-information-list-separator <char>
1102 A char that will be used to separate values in a response header containing
1103 WURFL results. If not set that a comma (',') will be used by default.
1104
1105 Please note that this option is only available when haproxy has been compiled
1106 with USE_WURFL=1.
1107
1108wurfl-patch-file [<file path>]
1109 A list of WURFL patch file paths. Note that patches are loaded during startup
1110 thus before the chroot.
1111
1112 Please note that this option is only available when haproxy has been compiled
1113 with USE_WURFL=1.
1114
1115wurfl-engine-mode { accuracy | performance }
1116 Sets the WURFL engine target. You can choose between 'accuracy' or
1117 'performance' targets. In performance mode, desktop web browser detection is
1118 done programmatically without referencing the WURFL data. As a result, most
1119 desktop web browsers are returned as generic_web_browser WURFL ID for
1120 performance. If either performance or accuracy are not defined, performance
1121 mode is enabled by default.
1122
1123 Please note that this option is only available when haproxy has been compiled
1124 with USE_WURFL=1.
1125
1126wurfl-cache-size <U>[,<D>]
1127 Sets the WURFL caching strategy. Here <U> is the Useragent cache size, and
1128 <D> is the internal device cache size. There are three possibilities here :
1129 - "0" : no cache is used.
1130 - <U> : the Single LRU cache is used, the size is expressed in elements.
1131 - <U>,<D> : the Double LRU cache is used, both sizes are in elements. This is
1132 the highest performing option.
1133
1134 Please note that this option is only available when haproxy has been compiled
1135 with USE_WURFL=1.
1136
1137wurfl-useragent-priority { plain | sideloaded_browser }
1138 Tells WURFL if it should prioritize use of the plain user agent ('plain')
1139 over the default sideloaded browser user agent ('sideloaded_browser').
1140
1141 Please note that this option is only available when haproxy has been compiled
1142 with USE_WURFL=1.
1143
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001144
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020011453.2. Performance tuning
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001146-----------------------
1147
Willy Tarreau1746eec2014-04-25 10:46:47 +02001148max-spread-checks <delay in milliseconds>
1149 By default, haproxy tries to spread the start of health checks across the
1150 smallest health check interval of all the servers in a farm. The principle is
1151 to avoid hammering services running on the same server. But when using large
1152 check intervals (10 seconds or more), the last servers in the farm take some
1153 time before starting to be tested, which can be a problem. This parameter is
1154 used to enforce an upper bound on delay between the first and the last check,
1155 even if the servers' check intervals are larger. When servers run with
1156 shorter intervals, their intervals will be respected though.
1157
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001158maxconn <number>
1159 Sets the maximum per-process number of concurrent connections to <number>. It
1160 is equivalent to the command-line argument "-n". Proxies will stop accepting
1161 connections when this limit is reached. The "ulimit-n" parameter is
Willy Tarreau8274e102014-06-19 15:31:25 +02001162 automatically adjusted according to this value. See also "ulimit-n". Note:
1163 the "select" poller cannot reliably use more than 1024 file descriptors on
1164 some platforms. If your platform only supports select and reports "select
1165 FAILED" on startup, you need to reduce maxconn until it works (slightly
Willy Tarreaud0256482015-01-15 21:45:22 +01001166 below 500 in general). If this value is not set, it will default to the value
1167 set in DEFAULT_MAXCONN at build time (reported in haproxy -vv) if no memory
1168 limit is enforced, or will be computed based on the memory limit, the buffer
1169 size, memory allocated to compression, SSL cache size, and use or not of SSL
1170 and the associated maxsslconn (which can also be automatic).
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001171
Willy Tarreau81c25d02011-09-07 15:17:21 +02001172maxconnrate <number>
1173 Sets the maximum per-process number of connections per second to <number>.
1174 Proxies will stop accepting connections when this limit is reached. It can be
1175 used to limit the global capacity regardless of each frontend capacity. It is
1176 important to note that this can only be used as a service protection measure,
1177 as there will not necessarily be a fair share between frontends when the
1178 limit is reached, so it's a good idea to also limit each frontend to some
1179 value close to its expected share. Also, lowering tune.maxaccept can improve
1180 fairness.
1181
William Lallemandd85f9172012-11-09 17:05:39 +01001182maxcomprate <number>
1183 Sets the maximum per-process input compression rate to <number> kilobytes
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03001184 per second. For each session, if the maximum is reached, the compression
William Lallemandd85f9172012-11-09 17:05:39 +01001185 level will be decreased during the session. If the maximum is reached at the
1186 beginning of a session, the session will not compress at all. If the maximum
1187 is not reached, the compression level will be increased up to
1188 tune.comp.maxlevel. A value of zero means there is no limit, this is the
1189 default value.
1190
William Lallemand072a2bf2012-11-20 17:01:01 +01001191maxcompcpuusage <number>
1192 Sets the maximum CPU usage HAProxy can reach before stopping the compression
1193 for new requests or decreasing the compression level of current requests.
1194 It works like 'maxcomprate' but measures CPU usage instead of incoming data
1195 bandwidth. The value is expressed in percent of the CPU used by haproxy. In
1196 case of multiple processes (nbproc > 1), each process manages its individual
1197 usage. A value of 100 disable the limit. The default value is 100. Setting
1198 a lower value will prevent the compression work from slowing the whole
1199 process down and from introducing high latencies.
1200
Willy Tarreauff4f82d2009-02-06 11:28:13 +01001201maxpipes <number>
1202 Sets the maximum per-process number of pipes to <number>. Currently, pipes
1203 are only used by kernel-based tcp splicing. Since a pipe contains two file
1204 descriptors, the "ulimit-n" value will be increased accordingly. The default
1205 value is maxconn/4, which seems to be more than enough for most heavy usages.
1206 The splice code dynamically allocates and releases pipes, and can fall back
1207 to standard copy, so setting this value too low may only impact performance.
1208
Willy Tarreau93e7c002013-10-07 18:51:07 +02001209maxsessrate <number>
1210 Sets the maximum per-process number of sessions per second to <number>.
1211 Proxies will stop accepting connections when this limit is reached. It can be
1212 used to limit the global capacity regardless of each frontend capacity. It is
1213 important to note that this can only be used as a service protection measure,
1214 as there will not necessarily be a fair share between frontends when the
1215 limit is reached, so it's a good idea to also limit each frontend to some
1216 value close to its expected share. Also, lowering tune.maxaccept can improve
1217 fairness.
1218
Willy Tarreau403edff2012-09-06 11:58:37 +02001219maxsslconn <number>
1220 Sets the maximum per-process number of concurrent SSL connections to
1221 <number>. By default there is no SSL-specific limit, which means that the
1222 global maxconn setting will apply to all connections. Setting this limit
1223 avoids having openssl use too much memory and crash when malloc returns NULL
1224 (since it unfortunately does not reliably check for such conditions). Note
1225 that the limit applies both to incoming and outgoing connections, so one
1226 connection which is deciphered then ciphered accounts for 2 SSL connections.
Willy Tarreaud0256482015-01-15 21:45:22 +01001227 If this value is not set, but a memory limit is enforced, this value will be
1228 automatically computed based on the memory limit, maxconn, the buffer size,
1229 memory allocated to compression, SSL cache size, and use of SSL in either
1230 frontends, backends or both. If neither maxconn nor maxsslconn are specified
1231 when there is a memory limit, haproxy will automatically adjust these values
1232 so that 100% of the connections can be made over SSL with no risk, and will
1233 consider the sides where it is enabled (frontend, backend, both).
Willy Tarreau403edff2012-09-06 11:58:37 +02001234
Willy Tarreaue43d5322013-10-07 20:01:52 +02001235maxsslrate <number>
1236 Sets the maximum per-process number of SSL sessions per second to <number>.
1237 SSL listeners will stop accepting connections when this limit is reached. It
1238 can be used to limit the global SSL CPU usage regardless of each frontend
1239 capacity. It is important to note that this can only be used as a service
1240 protection measure, as there will not necessarily be a fair share between
1241 frontends when the limit is reached, so it's a good idea to also limit each
1242 frontend to some value close to its expected share. It is also important to
1243 note that the sessions are accounted before they enter the SSL stack and not
1244 after, which also protects the stack against bad handshakes. Also, lowering
1245 tune.maxaccept can improve fairness.
1246
William Lallemand9d5f5482012-11-07 16:12:57 +01001247maxzlibmem <number>
1248 Sets the maximum amount of RAM in megabytes per process usable by the zlib.
1249 When the maximum amount is reached, future sessions will not compress as long
1250 as RAM is unavailable. When sets to 0, there is no limit.
William Lallemande3a7d992012-11-20 11:25:20 +01001251 The default value is 0. The value is available in bytes on the UNIX socket
1252 with "show info" on the line "MaxZlibMemUsage", the memory used by zlib is
1253 "ZlibMemUsage" in bytes.
1254
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001255noepoll
1256 Disables the use of the "epoll" event polling system on Linux. It is
1257 equivalent to the command-line argument "-de". The next polling system
Willy Tarreaue9f49e72012-11-11 17:42:00 +01001258 used will generally be "poll". See also "nopoll".
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001259
1260nokqueue
1261 Disables the use of the "kqueue" event polling system on BSD. It is
1262 equivalent to the command-line argument "-dk". The next polling system
1263 used will generally be "poll". See also "nopoll".
1264
1265nopoll
1266 Disables the use of the "poll" event polling system. It is equivalent to the
1267 command-line argument "-dp". The next polling system used will be "select".
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001268 It should never be needed to disable "poll" since it's available on all
Willy Tarreaue9f49e72012-11-11 17:42:00 +01001269 platforms supported by HAProxy. See also "nokqueue" and "noepoll".
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001270
Willy Tarreauff4f82d2009-02-06 11:28:13 +01001271nosplice
1272 Disables the use of kernel tcp splicing between sockets on Linux. It is
1273 equivalent to the command line argument "-dS". Data will then be copied
1274 using conventional and more portable recv/send calls. Kernel tcp splicing is
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01001275 limited to some very recent instances of kernel 2.6. Most versions between
Willy Tarreauff4f82d2009-02-06 11:28:13 +01001276 2.6.25 and 2.6.28 are buggy and will forward corrupted data, so they must not
1277 be used. This option makes it easier to globally disable kernel splicing in
1278 case of doubt. See also "option splice-auto", "option splice-request" and
1279 "option splice-response".
1280
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03001281nogetaddrinfo
1282 Disables the use of getaddrinfo(3) for name resolving. It is equivalent to
1283 the command line argument "-dG". Deprecated gethostbyname(3) will be used.
1284
Lukas Tribusa0bcbdc2016-09-12 21:42:20 +00001285noreuseport
1286 Disables the use of SO_REUSEPORT - see socket(7). It is equivalent to the
1287 command line argument "-dR".
1288
Willy Tarreaufe255b72007-10-14 23:09:26 +02001289spread-checks <0..50, in percent>
Simon Hormand60d6912013-11-25 10:46:36 +09001290 Sometimes it is desirable to avoid sending agent and health checks to
1291 servers at exact intervals, for instance when many logical servers are
1292 located on the same physical server. With the help of this parameter, it
1293 becomes possible to add some randomness in the check interval between 0
1294 and +/- 50%. A value between 2 and 5 seems to show good results. The
1295 default value remains at 0.
Willy Tarreaufe255b72007-10-14 23:09:26 +02001296
Grant Zhang872f9c22017-01-21 01:10:18 +00001297ssl-engine <name> [algo <comma-seperated list of algorithms>]
1298 Sets the OpenSSL engine to <name>. List of valid values for <name> may be
1299 obtained using the command "openssl engine". This statement may be used
1300 multiple times, it will simply enable multiple crypto engines. Referencing an
1301 unsupported engine will prevent haproxy from starting. Note that many engines
1302 will lead to lower HTTPS performance than pure software with recent
1303 processors. The optional command "algo" sets the default algorithms an ENGINE
1304 will supply using the OPENSSL function ENGINE_set_default_string(). A value
1305 of "ALL" uses the engine for all cryptographic operations. If no list of
1306 algo is specified then the value of "ALL" is used. A comma-seperated list
1307 of different algorithms may be specified, including: RSA, DSA, DH, EC, RAND,
1308 CIPHERS, DIGESTS, PKEY, PKEY_CRYPTO, PKEY_ASN1. This is the same format that
1309 openssl configuration file uses:
1310 https://www.openssl.org/docs/man1.0.2/apps/config.html
1311
Grant Zhangfa6c7ee2017-01-14 01:42:15 +00001312ssl-mode-async
1313 Adds SSL_MODE_ASYNC mode to the SSL context. This enables asynchronous TLS
Emeric Brun3854e012017-05-17 20:42:48 +02001314 I/O operations if asynchronous capable SSL engines are used. The current
Emeric Brunb5e42a82017-06-06 12:35:14 +00001315 implementation supports a maximum of 32 engines. The Openssl ASYNC API
1316 doesn't support moving read/write buffers and is not compliant with
1317 haproxy's buffer management. So the asynchronous mode is disabled on
1318 read/write operations (it is only enabled during initial and reneg
1319 handshakes).
Grant Zhangfa6c7ee2017-01-14 01:42:15 +00001320
Willy Tarreau33cb0652014-12-23 22:52:37 +01001321tune.buffers.limit <number>
1322 Sets a hard limit on the number of buffers which may be allocated per process.
1323 The default value is zero which means unlimited. The minimum non-zero value
1324 will always be greater than "tune.buffers.reserve" and should ideally always
1325 be about twice as large. Forcing this value can be particularly useful to
1326 limit the amount of memory a process may take, while retaining a sane
1327 behaviour. When this limit is reached, sessions which need a buffer wait for
1328 another one to be released by another session. Since buffers are dynamically
1329 allocated and released, the waiting time is very short and not perceptible
1330 provided that limits remain reasonable. In fact sometimes reducing the limit
1331 may even increase performance by increasing the CPU cache's efficiency. Tests
1332 have shown good results on average HTTP traffic with a limit to 1/10 of the
1333 expected global maxconn setting, which also significantly reduces memory
1334 usage. The memory savings come from the fact that a number of connections
1335 will not allocate 2*tune.bufsize. It is best not to touch this value unless
1336 advised to do so by an haproxy core developer.
1337
Willy Tarreau1058ae72014-12-23 22:40:40 +01001338tune.buffers.reserve <number>
1339 Sets the number of buffers which are pre-allocated and reserved for use only
1340 during memory shortage conditions resulting in failed memory allocations. The
1341 minimum value is 2 and is also the default. There is no reason a user would
1342 want to change this value, it's mostly aimed at haproxy core developers.
1343
Willy Tarreau27a674e2009-08-17 07:23:33 +02001344tune.bufsize <number>
1345 Sets the buffer size to this size (in bytes). Lower values allow more
1346 sessions to coexist in the same amount of RAM, and higher values allow some
1347 applications with very large cookies to work. The default value is 16384 and
1348 can be changed at build time. It is strongly recommended not to change this
1349 from the default value, as very low values will break some services such as
1350 statistics, and values larger than default size will increase memory usage,
1351 possibly causing the system to run out of memory. At least the global maxconn
1352 parameter should be decreased by the same factor as this one is increased.
Dmitry Sivachenkof6f4f7b2012-10-21 18:10:25 +04001353 If HTTP request is larger than (tune.bufsize - tune.maxrewrite), haproxy will
1354 return HTTP 400 (Bad Request) error. Similarly if an HTTP response is larger
1355 than this size, haproxy will return HTTP 502 (Bad Gateway).
Willy Tarreau27a674e2009-08-17 07:23:33 +02001356
Willy Tarreau43961d52010-10-04 20:39:20 +02001357tune.chksize <number>
1358 Sets the check buffer size to this size (in bytes). Higher values may help
1359 find string or regex patterns in very large pages, though doing so may imply
1360 more memory and CPU usage. The default value is 16384 and can be changed at
1361 build time. It is not recommended to change this value, but to use better
1362 checks whenever possible.
1363
William Lallemandf3747832012-11-09 12:33:10 +01001364tune.comp.maxlevel <number>
1365 Sets the maximum compression level. The compression level affects CPU
1366 usage during compression. This value affects CPU usage during compression.
1367 Each session using compression initializes the compression algorithm with
1368 this value. The default value is 1.
1369
Willy Tarreau193b8c62012-11-22 00:17:38 +01001370tune.http.cookielen <number>
1371 Sets the maximum length of captured cookies. This is the maximum value that
1372 the "capture cookie xxx len yyy" will be allowed to take, and any upper value
1373 will automatically be truncated to this one. It is important not to set too
1374 high a value because all cookie captures still allocate this size whatever
1375 their configured value (they share a same pool). This value is per request
1376 per response, so the memory allocated is twice this value per connection.
1377 When not specified, the limit is set to 63 characters. It is recommended not
1378 to change this value.
1379
Stéphane Cottin23e9e932017-05-18 08:58:41 +02001380tune.http.logurilen <number>
1381 Sets the maximum length of request uri in logs. This prevent to truncate long
1382 requests uris with valuable query strings in log lines. This is not related
1383 to syslog limits. If you increase this limit, you may also increase the
1384 'log ... len yyyy' parameter. Your syslog deamon may also need specific
1385 configuration directives too.
1386 The default value is 1024.
1387
Willy Tarreauac1932d2011-10-24 19:14:41 +02001388tune.http.maxhdr <number>
1389 Sets the maximum number of headers in a request. When a request comes with a
1390 number of headers greater than this value (including the first line), it is
1391 rejected with a "400 Bad Request" status code. Similarly, too large responses
1392 are blocked with "502 Bad Gateway". The default value is 101, which is enough
1393 for all usages, considering that the widely deployed Apache server uses the
1394 same limit. It can be useful to push this limit further to temporarily allow
Christopher Faulet50174f32017-06-21 16:31:35 +02001395 a buggy application to work by the time it gets fixed. The accepted range is
1396 1..32767. Keep in mind that each new header consumes 32bits of memory for
1397 each session, so don't push this limit too high.
Willy Tarreauac1932d2011-10-24 19:14:41 +02001398
Willy Tarreau7e312732014-02-12 16:35:14 +01001399tune.idletimer <timeout>
1400 Sets the duration after which haproxy will consider that an empty buffer is
1401 probably associated with an idle stream. This is used to optimally adjust
1402 some packet sizes while forwarding large and small data alternatively. The
1403 decision to use splice() or to send large buffers in SSL is modulated by this
1404 parameter. The value is in milliseconds between 0 and 65535. A value of zero
1405 means that haproxy will not try to detect idle streams. The default is 1000,
1406 which seems to correctly detect end user pauses (eg: read a page before
1407 clicking). There should be not reason for changing this value. Please check
1408 tune.ssl.maxrecord below.
1409
Thierry FOURNIER90da1912015-03-05 11:17:06 +01001410tune.lua.forced-yield <number>
1411 This directive forces the Lua engine to execute a yield each <number> of
Tim Düsterhus4896c442016-11-29 02:15:19 +01001412 instructions executed. This permits interrupting a long script and allows the
Thierry FOURNIER90da1912015-03-05 11:17:06 +01001413 HAProxy scheduler to process other tasks like accepting connections or
1414 forwarding traffic. The default value is 10000 instructions. If HAProxy often
1415 executes some Lua code but more reactivity is required, this value can be
1416 lowered. If the Lua code is quite long and its result is absolutely required
1417 to process the data, the <number> can be increased.
1418
Willy Tarreau32f61e22015-03-18 17:54:59 +01001419tune.lua.maxmem
1420 Sets the maximum amount of RAM in megabytes per process usable by Lua. By
1421 default it is zero which means unlimited. It is important to set a limit to
1422 ensure that a bug in a script will not result in the system running out of
1423 memory.
1424
Thierry FOURNIER90da1912015-03-05 11:17:06 +01001425tune.lua.session-timeout <timeout>
1426 This is the execution timeout for the Lua sessions. This is useful for
Thierry FOURNIER7dd784b2015-10-01 14:49:33 +02001427 preventing infinite loops or spending too much time in Lua. This timeout
1428 counts only the pure Lua runtime. If the Lua does a sleep, the sleep is
1429 not taked in account. The default timeout is 4s.
Thierry FOURNIER90da1912015-03-05 11:17:06 +01001430
1431tune.lua.task-timeout <timeout>
1432 Purpose is the same as "tune.lua.session-timeout", but this timeout is
1433 dedicated to the tasks. By default, this timeout isn't set because a task may
1434 remain alive during of the lifetime of HAProxy. For example, a task used to
1435 check servers.
1436
Thierry FOURNIER7dd784b2015-10-01 14:49:33 +02001437tune.lua.service-timeout <timeout>
1438 This is the execution timeout for the Lua services. This is useful for
1439 preventing infinite loops or spending too much time in Lua. This timeout
1440 counts only the pure Lua runtime. If the Lua does a sleep, the sleep is
1441 not taked in account. The default timeout is 4s.
1442
Willy Tarreaua0250ba2008-01-06 11:22:57 +01001443tune.maxaccept <number>
Willy Tarreau16a21472012-11-19 12:39:59 +01001444 Sets the maximum number of consecutive connections a process may accept in a
1445 row before switching to other work. In single process mode, higher numbers
1446 give better performance at high connection rates. However in multi-process
1447 modes, keeping a bit of fairness between processes generally is better to
1448 increase performance. This value applies individually to each listener, so
1449 that the number of processes a listener is bound to is taken into account.
1450 This value defaults to 64. In multi-process mode, it is divided by twice
1451 the number of processes the listener is bound to. Setting this value to -1
1452 completely disables the limitation. It should normally not be needed to tweak
1453 this value.
Willy Tarreaua0250ba2008-01-06 11:22:57 +01001454
1455tune.maxpollevents <number>
1456 Sets the maximum amount of events that can be processed at once in a call to
1457 the polling system. The default value is adapted to the operating system. It
1458 has been noticed that reducing it below 200 tends to slightly decrease
1459 latency at the expense of network bandwidth, and increasing it above 200
1460 tends to trade latency for slightly increased bandwidth.
1461
Willy Tarreau27a674e2009-08-17 07:23:33 +02001462tune.maxrewrite <number>
1463 Sets the reserved buffer space to this size in bytes. The reserved space is
1464 used for header rewriting or appending. The first reads on sockets will never
1465 fill more than bufsize-maxrewrite. Historically it has defaulted to half of
1466 bufsize, though that does not make much sense since there are rarely large
1467 numbers of headers to add. Setting it too high prevents processing of large
1468 requests or responses. Setting it too low prevents addition of new headers
1469 to already large requests or to POST requests. It is generally wise to set it
1470 to about 1024. It is automatically readjusted to half of bufsize if it is
1471 larger than that. This means you don't have to worry about it when changing
1472 bufsize.
1473
Willy Tarreauf3045d22015-04-29 16:24:50 +02001474tune.pattern.cache-size <number>
1475 Sets the size of the pattern lookup cache to <number> entries. This is an LRU
1476 cache which reminds previous lookups and their results. It is used by ACLs
1477 and maps on slow pattern lookups, namely the ones using the "sub", "reg",
1478 "dir", "dom", "end", "bin" match methods as well as the case-insensitive
1479 strings. It applies to pattern expressions which means that it will be able
1480 to memorize the result of a lookup among all the patterns specified on a
1481 configuration line (including all those loaded from files). It automatically
1482 invalidates entries which are updated using HTTP actions or on the CLI. The
1483 default cache size is set to 10000 entries, which limits its footprint to
1484 about 5 MB on 32-bit systems and 8 MB on 64-bit systems. There is a very low
1485 risk of collision in this cache, which is in the order of the size of the
1486 cache divided by 2^64. Typically, at 10000 requests per second with the
1487 default cache size of 10000 entries, there's 1% chance that a brute force
1488 attack could cause a single collision after 60 years, or 0.1% after 6 years.
1489 This is considered much lower than the risk of a memory corruption caused by
1490 aging components. If this is not acceptable, the cache can be disabled by
1491 setting this parameter to 0.
1492
Willy Tarreaubd9a0a72011-10-23 21:14:29 +02001493tune.pipesize <number>
1494 Sets the kernel pipe buffer size to this size (in bytes). By default, pipes
1495 are the default size for the system. But sometimes when using TCP splicing,
1496 it can improve performance to increase pipe sizes, especially if it is
1497 suspected that pipes are not filled and that many calls to splice() are
1498 performed. This has an impact on the kernel's memory footprint, so this must
1499 not be changed if impacts are not understood.
1500
Willy Tarreaue803de22010-01-21 17:43:04 +01001501tune.rcvbuf.client <number>
1502tune.rcvbuf.server <number>
1503 Forces the kernel socket receive buffer size on the client or the server side
1504 to the specified value in bytes. This value applies to all TCP/HTTP frontends
1505 and backends. It should normally never be set, and the default size (0) lets
1506 the kernel autotune this value depending on the amount of available memory.
1507 However it can sometimes help to set it to very low values (eg: 4096) in
1508 order to save kernel memory by preventing it from buffering too large amounts
1509 of received data. Lower values will significantly increase CPU usage though.
1510
Willy Tarreaub22fc302015-12-14 12:04:35 +01001511tune.recv_enough <number>
1512 Haproxy uses some hints to detect that a short read indicates the end of the
1513 socket buffers. One of them is that a read returns more than <recv_enough>
1514 bytes, which defaults to 10136 (7 segments of 1448 each). This default value
1515 may be changed by this setting to better deal with workloads involving lots
1516 of short messages such as telnet or SSH sessions.
1517
Willy Tarreaue803de22010-01-21 17:43:04 +01001518tune.sndbuf.client <number>
1519tune.sndbuf.server <number>
1520 Forces the kernel socket send buffer size on the client or the server side to
1521 the specified value in bytes. This value applies to all TCP/HTTP frontends
1522 and backends. It should normally never be set, and the default size (0) lets
1523 the kernel autotune this value depending on the amount of available memory.
1524 However it can sometimes help to set it to very low values (eg: 4096) in
1525 order to save kernel memory by preventing it from buffering too large amounts
1526 of received data. Lower values will significantly increase CPU usage though.
1527 Another use case is to prevent write timeouts with extremely slow clients due
1528 to the kernel waiting for a large part of the buffer to be read before
1529 notifying haproxy again.
1530
Willy Tarreau6ec58db2012-11-16 16:32:15 +01001531tune.ssl.cachesize <number>
Emeric Brunaf9619d2012-11-28 18:47:52 +01001532 Sets the size of the global SSL session cache, in a number of blocks. A block
1533 is large enough to contain an encoded session without peer certificate.
1534 An encoded session with peer certificate is stored in multiple blocks
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03001535 depending on the size of the peer certificate. A block uses approximately
Emeric Brunaf9619d2012-11-28 18:47:52 +01001536 200 bytes of memory. The default value may be forced at build time, otherwise
1537 defaults to 20000. When the cache is full, the most idle entries are purged
1538 and reassigned. Higher values reduce the occurrence of such a purge, hence
1539 the number of CPU-intensive SSL handshakes by ensuring that all users keep
1540 their session as long as possible. All entries are pre-allocated upon startup
Emeric Brun22890a12012-12-28 14:41:32 +01001541 and are shared between all processes if "nbproc" is greater than 1. Setting
1542 this value to 0 disables the SSL session cache.
Willy Tarreau6ec58db2012-11-16 16:32:15 +01001543
Emeric Brun8dc60392014-05-09 13:52:00 +02001544tune.ssl.force-private-cache
1545 This boolean disables SSL session cache sharing between all processes. It
1546 should normally not be used since it will force many renegotiations due to
1547 clients hitting a random process. But it may be required on some operating
1548 systems where none of the SSL cache synchronization method may be used. In
1549 this case, adding a first layer of hash-based load balancing before the SSL
1550 layer might limit the impact of the lack of session sharing.
1551
Emeric Brun4f65bff2012-11-16 15:11:00 +01001552tune.ssl.lifetime <timeout>
1553 Sets how long a cached SSL session may remain valid. This time is expressed
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03001554 in seconds and defaults to 300 (5 min). It is important to understand that it
Emeric Brun4f65bff2012-11-16 15:11:00 +01001555 does not guarantee that sessions will last that long, because if the cache is
1556 full, the longest idle sessions will be purged despite their configured
1557 lifetime. The real usefulness of this setting is to prevent sessions from
1558 being used for too long.
1559
Willy Tarreaubfd59462013-02-21 07:46:09 +01001560tune.ssl.maxrecord <number>
1561 Sets the maximum amount of bytes passed to SSL_write() at a time. Default
1562 value 0 means there is no limit. Over SSL/TLS, the client can decipher the
1563 data only once it has received a full record. With large records, it means
1564 that clients might have to download up to 16kB of data before starting to
1565 process them. Limiting the value can improve page load times on browsers
1566 located over high latency or low bandwidth networks. It is suggested to find
1567 optimal values which fit into 1 or 2 TCP segments (generally 1448 bytes over
1568 Ethernet with TCP timestamps enabled, or 1460 when timestamps are disabled),
1569 keeping in mind that SSL/TLS add some overhead. Typical values of 1419 and
1570 2859 gave good results during tests. Use "strace -e trace=write" to find the
Willy Tarreau7e312732014-02-12 16:35:14 +01001571 best value. Haproxy will automatically switch to this setting after an idle
1572 stream has been detected (see tune.idletimer above).
Willy Tarreaubfd59462013-02-21 07:46:09 +01001573
Remi Gacognef46cd6e2014-06-12 14:58:40 +02001574tune.ssl.default-dh-param <number>
1575 Sets the maximum size of the Diffie-Hellman parameters used for generating
1576 the ephemeral/temporary Diffie-Hellman key in case of DHE key exchange. The
1577 final size will try to match the size of the server's RSA (or DSA) key (e.g,
1578 a 2048 bits temporary DH key for a 2048 bits RSA key), but will not exceed
1579 this maximum value. Default value if 1024. Only 1024 or higher values are
1580 allowed. Higher values will increase the CPU load, and values greater than
1581 1024 bits are not supported by Java 7 and earlier clients. This value is not
Remi Gacogne47783ef2015-05-29 15:53:22 +02001582 used if static Diffie-Hellman parameters are supplied either directly
1583 in the certificate file or by using the ssl-dh-param-file parameter.
Remi Gacognef46cd6e2014-06-12 14:58:40 +02001584
Christopher Faulet31af49d2015-06-09 17:29:50 +02001585tune.ssl.ssl-ctx-cache-size <number>
1586 Sets the size of the cache used to store generated certificates to <number>
1587 entries. This is a LRU cache. Because generating a SSL certificate
1588 dynamically is expensive, they are cached. The default cache size is set to
1589 1000 entries.
1590
Thierry FOURNIER5bf77322017-02-25 12:45:22 +01001591tune.ssl.capture-cipherlist-size <number>
1592 Sets the maximum size of the buffer used for capturing client-hello cipher
1593 list. If the value is 0 (default value) the capture is disabled, otherwise
1594 a buffer is allocated for each SSL/TLS connection.
1595
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +02001596tune.vars.global-max-size <size>
Christopher Fauletff2613e2016-11-09 11:36:17 +01001597tune.vars.proc-max-size <size>
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +02001598tune.vars.reqres-max-size <size>
1599tune.vars.sess-max-size <size>
1600tune.vars.txn-max-size <size>
Christopher Fauletff2613e2016-11-09 11:36:17 +01001601 These five tunes help to manage the maximum amount of memory used by the
1602 variables system. "global" limits the overall amount of memory available for
1603 all scopes. "proc" limits the memory for the process scope, "sess" limits the
1604 memory for the session scope, "txn" for the transaction scope, and "reqres"
1605 limits the memory for each request or response processing.
1606 Memory accounting is hierarchical, meaning more coarse grained limits include
1607 the finer grained ones: "proc" includes "sess", "sess" includes "txn", and
1608 "txn" includes "reqres".
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +02001609
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +01001610 For example, when "tune.vars.sess-max-size" is limited to 100,
1611 "tune.vars.txn-max-size" and "tune.vars.reqres-max-size" cannot exceed
1612 100 either. If we create a variable "txn.var" that contains 100 bytes,
1613 all available space is consumed.
1614 Notice that exceeding the limits at runtime will not result in an error
1615 message, but values might be cut off or corrupted. So make sure to accurately
1616 plan for the amount of space needed to store all your variables.
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +02001617
William Lallemanda509e4c2012-11-07 16:54:34 +01001618tune.zlib.memlevel <number>
1619 Sets the memLevel parameter in zlib initialization for each session. It
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03001620 defines how much memory should be allocated for the internal compression
William Lallemanda509e4c2012-11-07 16:54:34 +01001621 state. A value of 1 uses minimum memory but is slow and reduces compression
1622 ratio, a value of 9 uses maximum memory for optimal speed. Can be a value
1623 between 1 and 9. The default value is 8.
1624
1625tune.zlib.windowsize <number>
1626 Sets the window size (the size of the history buffer) as a parameter of the
1627 zlib initialization for each session. Larger values of this parameter result
1628 in better compression at the expense of memory usage. Can be a value between
1629 8 and 15. The default value is 15.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001630
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020016313.3. Debugging
1632--------------
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001633
1634debug
1635 Enables debug mode which dumps to stdout all exchanges, and disables forking
1636 into background. It is the equivalent of the command-line argument "-d". It
1637 should never be used in a production configuration since it may prevent full
1638 system startup.
1639
1640quiet
1641 Do not display any message during startup. It is equivalent to the command-
1642 line argument "-q".
1643
Emeric Brunf099e792010-09-27 12:05:28 +02001644
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +010016453.4. Userlists
1646--------------
1647It is possible to control access to frontend/backend/listen sections or to
1648http stats by allowing only authenticated and authorized users. To do this,
1649it is required to create at least one userlist and to define users.
1650
1651userlist <listname>
Cyril Bonté78caf842010-03-10 22:41:43 +01001652 Creates new userlist with name <listname>. Many independent userlists can be
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01001653 used to store authentication & authorization data for independent customers.
1654
1655group <groupname> [users <user>,<user>,(...)]
Cyril Bonté78caf842010-03-10 22:41:43 +01001656 Adds group <groupname> to the current userlist. It is also possible to
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01001657 attach users to this group by using a comma separated list of names
1658 proceeded by "users" keyword.
1659
Cyril Bontéf0c60612010-02-06 14:44:47 +01001660user <username> [password|insecure-password <password>]
1661 [groups <group>,<group>,(...)]
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01001662 Adds user <username> to the current userlist. Both secure (encrypted) and
1663 insecure (unencrypted) passwords can be used. Encrypted passwords are
Cyril Bonté78caf842010-03-10 22:41:43 +01001664 evaluated using the crypt(3) function so depending of the system's
1665 capabilities, different algorithms are supported. For example modern Glibc
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01001666 based Linux system supports MD5, SHA-256, SHA-512 and of course classic,
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03001667 DES-based method of encrypting passwords.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01001668
1669
1670 Example:
Cyril Bontéf0c60612010-02-06 14:44:47 +01001671 userlist L1
1672 group G1 users tiger,scott
1673 group G2 users xdb,scott
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01001674
Cyril Bontéf0c60612010-02-06 14:44:47 +01001675 user tiger password $6$k6y3o.eP$JlKBx9za9667qe4(...)xHSwRv6J.C0/D7cV91
1676 user scott insecure-password elgato
1677 user xdb insecure-password hello
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01001678
Cyril Bontéf0c60612010-02-06 14:44:47 +01001679 userlist L2
1680 group G1
1681 group G2
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01001682
Cyril Bontéf0c60612010-02-06 14:44:47 +01001683 user tiger password $6$k6y3o.eP$JlKBx(...)xHSwRv6J.C0/D7cV91 groups G1
1684 user scott insecure-password elgato groups G1,G2
1685 user xdb insecure-password hello groups G2
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01001686
1687 Please note that both lists are functionally identical.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001688
Emeric Brunf099e792010-09-27 12:05:28 +02001689
16903.5. Peers
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +02001691----------
Emeric Brun94900952015-06-11 18:25:54 +02001692It is possible to propagate entries of any data-types in stick-tables between
1693several haproxy instances over TCP connections in a multi-master fashion. Each
1694instance pushes its local updates and insertions to remote peers. The pushed
1695values overwrite remote ones without aggregation. Interrupted exchanges are
1696automatically detected and recovered from the last known point.
1697In addition, during a soft restart, the old process connects to the new one
1698using such a TCP connection to push all its entries before the new process
1699tries to connect to other peers. That ensures very fast replication during a
1700reload, it typically takes a fraction of a second even for large tables.
1701Note that Server IDs are used to identify servers remotely, so it is important
1702that configurations look similar or at least that the same IDs are forced on
1703each server on all participants.
Emeric Brunf099e792010-09-27 12:05:28 +02001704
1705peers <peersect>
Jamie Gloudon801a0a32012-08-25 00:18:33 -04001706 Creates a new peer list with name <peersect>. It is an independent section,
Emeric Brunf099e792010-09-27 12:05:28 +02001707 which is referenced by one or more stick-tables.
1708
Willy Tarreau77e4bd12015-05-01 20:02:17 +02001709disabled
1710 Disables a peers section. It disables both listening and any synchronization
1711 related to this section. This is provided to disable synchronization of stick
1712 tables without having to comment out all "peers" references.
1713
1714enable
1715 This re-enables a disabled peers section which was previously disabled.
1716
Emeric Brunf099e792010-09-27 12:05:28 +02001717peer <peername> <ip>:<port>
1718 Defines a peer inside a peers section.
1719 If <peername> is set to the local peer name (by default hostname, or forced
1720 using "-L" command line option), haproxy will listen for incoming remote peer
1721 connection on <ip>:<port>. Otherwise, <ip>:<port> defines where to connect to
1722 to join the remote peer, and <peername> is used at the protocol level to
1723 identify and validate the remote peer on the server side.
1724
1725 During a soft restart, local peer <ip>:<port> is used by the old instance to
1726 connect the new one and initiate a complete replication (teaching process).
1727
1728 It is strongly recommended to have the exact same peers declaration on all
1729 peers and to only rely on the "-L" command line argument to change the local
1730 peer name. This makes it easier to maintain coherent configuration files
1731 across all peers.
1732
William Lallemandb2f07452015-05-12 14:27:13 +02001733 You may want to reference some environment variables in the address
1734 parameter, see section 2.3 about environment variables.
Willy Tarreaudad36a32013-03-11 01:20:04 +01001735
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +02001736 Example:
Emeric Brunf099e792010-09-27 12:05:28 +02001737 peers mypeers
Willy Tarreauf7b30a92010-12-06 22:59:17 +01001738 peer haproxy1 192.168.0.1:1024
1739 peer haproxy2 192.168.0.2:1024
1740 peer haproxy3 10.2.0.1:1024
Emeric Brunf099e792010-09-27 12:05:28 +02001741
1742 backend mybackend
1743 mode tcp
1744 balance roundrobin
1745 stick-table type ip size 20k peers mypeers
1746 stick on src
1747
Willy Tarreauf7b30a92010-12-06 22:59:17 +01001748 server srv1 192.168.0.30:80
1749 server srv2 192.168.0.31:80
Emeric Brunf099e792010-09-27 12:05:28 +02001750
1751
Simon Horman51a1cf62015-02-03 13:00:44 +090017523.6. Mailers
1753------------
1754It is possible to send email alerts when the state of servers changes.
1755If configured email alerts are sent to each mailer that is configured
1756in a mailers section. Email is sent to mailers using SMTP.
1757
Pieter Baauw386a1272015-08-16 15:26:24 +02001758mailers <mailersect>
Simon Horman51a1cf62015-02-03 13:00:44 +09001759 Creates a new mailer list with the name <mailersect>. It is an
1760 independent section which is referenced by one or more proxies.
1761
1762mailer <mailername> <ip>:<port>
1763 Defines a mailer inside a mailers section.
1764
1765 Example:
1766 mailers mymailers
1767 mailer smtp1 192.168.0.1:587
1768 mailer smtp2 192.168.0.2:587
1769
1770 backend mybackend
1771 mode tcp
1772 balance roundrobin
1773
1774 email-alert mailers mymailers
1775 email-alert from test1@horms.org
1776 email-alert to test2@horms.org
1777
1778 server srv1 192.168.0.30:80
1779 server srv2 192.168.0.31:80
1780
Pieter Baauw235fcfc2016-02-13 15:33:40 +01001781timeout mail <time>
1782 Defines the time available for a mail/connection to be made and send to
1783 the mail-server. If not defined the default value is 10 seconds. To allow
1784 for at least two SYN-ACK packets to be send during initial TCP handshake it
1785 is advised to keep this value above 4 seconds.
1786
1787 Example:
1788 mailers mymailers
1789 timeout mail 20s
1790 mailer smtp1 192.168.0.1:587
Simon Horman51a1cf62015-02-03 13:00:44 +09001791
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020017924. Proxies
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001793----------
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001794
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001795Proxy configuration can be located in a set of sections :
William Lallemand6e62fb62015-04-28 16:55:23 +02001796 - defaults [<name>]
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001797 - frontend <name>
1798 - backend <name>
1799 - listen <name>
1800
1801A "defaults" section sets default parameters for all other sections following
1802its declaration. Those default parameters are reset by the next "defaults"
1803section. See below for the list of parameters which can be set in a "defaults"
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001804section. The name is optional but its use is encouraged for better readability.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001805
1806A "frontend" section describes a set of listening sockets accepting client
1807connections.
1808
1809A "backend" section describes a set of servers to which the proxy will connect
1810to forward incoming connections.
1811
1812A "listen" section defines a complete proxy with its frontend and backend
1813parts combined in one section. It is generally useful for TCP-only traffic.
1814
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001815All proxy names must be formed from upper and lower case letters, digits,
1816'-' (dash), '_' (underscore) , '.' (dot) and ':' (colon). ACL names are
1817case-sensitive, which means that "www" and "WWW" are two different proxies.
1818
1819Historically, all proxy names could overlap, it just caused troubles in the
1820logs. Since the introduction of content switching, it is mandatory that two
1821proxies with overlapping capabilities (frontend/backend) have different names.
1822However, it is still permitted that a frontend and a backend share the same
1823name, as this configuration seems to be commonly encountered.
1824
1825Right now, two major proxy modes are supported : "tcp", also known as layer 4,
1826and "http", also known as layer 7. In layer 4 mode, HAProxy simply forwards
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01001827bidirectional traffic between two sides. In layer 7 mode, HAProxy analyzes the
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001828protocol, and can interact with it by allowing, blocking, switching, adding,
1829modifying, or removing arbitrary contents in requests or responses, based on
1830arbitrary criteria.
1831
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +01001832In HTTP mode, the processing applied to requests and responses flowing over
1833a connection depends in the combination of the frontend's HTTP options and
1834the backend's. HAProxy supports 5 connection modes :
1835
1836 - KAL : keep alive ("option http-keep-alive") which is the default mode : all
1837 requests and responses are processed, and connections remain open but idle
1838 between responses and new requests.
1839
1840 - TUN: tunnel ("option http-tunnel") : this was the default mode for versions
1841 1.0 to 1.5-dev21 : only the first request and response are processed, and
1842 everything else is forwarded with no analysis at all. This mode should not
1843 be used as it creates lots of trouble with logging and HTTP processing.
1844
1845 - PCL: passive close ("option httpclose") : exactly the same as tunnel mode,
1846 but with "Connection: close" appended in both directions to try to make
1847 both ends close after the first request/response exchange.
1848
1849 - SCL: server close ("option http-server-close") : the server-facing
1850 connection is closed after the end of the response is received, but the
1851 client-facing connection remains open.
1852
1853 - FCL: forced close ("option forceclose") : the connection is actively closed
1854 after the end of the response.
1855
1856The effective mode that will be applied to a connection passing through a
1857frontend and a backend can be determined by both proxy modes according to the
1858following matrix, but in short, the modes are symmetric, keep-alive is the
1859weakest option and force close is the strongest.
1860
1861 Backend mode
1862
1863 | KAL | TUN | PCL | SCL | FCL
1864 ----+-----+-----+-----+-----+----
1865 KAL | KAL | TUN | PCL | SCL | FCL
1866 ----+-----+-----+-----+-----+----
1867 TUN | TUN | TUN | PCL | SCL | FCL
1868 Frontend ----+-----+-----+-----+-----+----
1869 mode PCL | PCL | PCL | PCL | FCL | FCL
1870 ----+-----+-----+-----+-----+----
1871 SCL | SCL | SCL | FCL | SCL | FCL
1872 ----+-----+-----+-----+-----+----
1873 FCL | FCL | FCL | FCL | FCL | FCL
1874
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001875
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +01001876
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020018774.1. Proxy keywords matrix
1878--------------------------
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001879
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02001880The following list of keywords is supported. Most of them may only be used in a
1881limited set of section types. Some of them are marked as "deprecated" because
1882they are inherited from an old syntax which may be confusing or functionally
1883limited, and there are new recommended keywords to replace them. Keywords
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01001884marked with "(*)" can be optionally inverted using the "no" prefix, eg. "no
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02001885option contstats". This makes sense when the option has been enabled by default
Willy Tarreau3842f002009-06-14 11:39:52 +02001886and must be disabled for a specific instance. Such options may also be prefixed
1887with "default" in order to restore default settings regardless of what has been
1888specified in a previous "defaults" section.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001889
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001890
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01001891 keyword defaults frontend listen backend
1892------------------------------------+----------+----------+---------+---------
1893acl - X X X
Willy Tarreau294d0f02015-08-10 19:40:12 +02001894appsession - - - -
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01001895backlog X X X -
1896balance X - X X
1897bind - X X -
1898bind-process X X X X
Jarno Huuskonen8c8c3492016-12-28 18:50:29 +02001899block (deprecated) - X X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01001900capture cookie - X X -
1901capture request header - X X -
1902capture response header - X X -
1903clitimeout (deprecated) X X X -
William Lallemand82fe75c2012-10-23 10:25:10 +02001904compression X X X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01001905contimeout (deprecated) X - X X
1906cookie X - X X
Thierry FOURNIERa0a1b752015-05-26 17:44:32 +02001907declare capture - X X -
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01001908default-server X - X X
1909default_backend X X X -
1910description - X X X
1911disabled X X X X
1912dispatch - - X X
Simon Horman51a1cf62015-02-03 13:00:44 +09001913email-alert from X X X X
Simon Horman64e34162015-02-06 11:11:57 +09001914email-alert level X X X X
Simon Horman51a1cf62015-02-03 13:00:44 +09001915email-alert mailers X X X X
1916email-alert myhostname X X X X
1917email-alert to X X X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01001918enabled X X X X
1919errorfile X X X X
1920errorloc X X X X
1921errorloc302 X X X X
1922-- keyword -------------------------- defaults - frontend - listen -- backend -
1923errorloc303 X X X X
Cyril Bonté0d4bf012010-04-25 23:21:46 +02001924force-persist - X X X
Christopher Fauletc3fe5332016-04-07 15:30:10 +02001925filter - X X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01001926fullconn X - X X
1927grace X X X X
1928hash-type X - X X
1929http-check disable-on-404 X - X X
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01001930http-check expect - - X X
Willy Tarreau7ab6aff2010-10-12 06:30:16 +02001931http-check send-state X - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01001932http-request - X X X
Willy Tarreaue365c0b2013-06-11 16:06:12 +02001933http-response - X X X
Willy Tarreau30631952015-08-06 15:05:24 +02001934http-reuse X - X X
Baptiste Assmann2c42ef52013-10-09 21:57:02 +02001935http-send-name-header - - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01001936id - X X X
Cyril Bonté0d4bf012010-04-25 23:21:46 +02001937ignore-persist - X X X
Baptiste Assmann01c6cc32015-08-23 11:45:29 +02001938load-server-state-from-file X - X X
William Lallemand0f99e342011-10-12 17:50:54 +02001939log (*) X X X X
Willy Tarreaufb4e7ea2015-01-07 14:55:17 +01001940log-format X X X -
Dragan Dosen7ad31542015-09-28 17:16:47 +02001941log-format-sd X X X -
Willy Tarreau094af4e2015-01-07 15:03:42 +01001942log-tag X X X X
Willy Tarreauc35362a2014-04-25 13:58:37 +02001943max-keep-alive-queue X - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01001944maxconn X X X -
1945mode X X X X
1946monitor fail - X X -
1947monitor-net X X X -
1948monitor-uri X X X -
1949option abortonclose (*) X - X X
1950option accept-invalid-http-request (*) X X X -
1951option accept-invalid-http-response (*) X - X X
1952option allbackups (*) X - X X
1953option checkcache (*) X - X X
1954option clitcpka (*) X X X -
1955option contstats (*) X X X -
1956option dontlog-normal (*) X X X -
1957option dontlognull (*) X X X -
1958option forceclose (*) X X X X
1959-- keyword -------------------------- defaults - frontend - listen -- backend -
1960option forwardfor X X X X
Willy Tarreau9fbe18e2015-05-01 22:42:08 +02001961option http-buffer-request (*) X X X X
Willy Tarreau82649f92015-05-01 22:40:51 +02001962option http-ignore-probes (*) X X X -
Willy Tarreau16bfb022010-01-16 19:48:41 +01001963option http-keep-alive (*) X X X X
Willy Tarreau96e31212011-05-30 18:10:30 +02001964option http-no-delay (*) X X X X
Willy Tarreau8a8e1d92010-04-05 16:15:16 +02001965option http-pretend-keepalive (*) X X X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01001966option http-server-close (*) X X X X
Willy Tarreau02bce8b2014-01-30 00:15:28 +01001967option http-tunnel (*) X X X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01001968option http-use-proxy-header (*) X X X -
1969option httpchk X - X X
1970option httpclose (*) X X X X
1971option httplog X X X X
1972option http_proxy (*) X X X X
Jamie Gloudon801a0a32012-08-25 00:18:33 -04001973option independent-streams (*) X X X X
Gabor Lekenyb4c81e42010-09-29 18:17:05 +02001974option ldap-check X - X X
Simon Horman98637e52014-06-20 12:30:16 +09001975option external-check X - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01001976option log-health-checks (*) X - X X
1977option log-separate-errors (*) X X X -
1978option logasap (*) X X X -
1979option mysql-check X - X X
1980option nolinger (*) X X X X
1981option originalto X X X X
1982option persist (*) X - X X
Baptiste Assmann809e22a2015-10-12 20:22:55 +02001983option pgsql-check X - X X
1984option prefer-last-server (*) X - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01001985option redispatch (*) X - X X
Hervé COMMOWICKec032d62011-08-05 16:23:48 +02001986option redis-check X - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01001987option smtpchk X - X X
1988option socket-stats (*) X X X -
1989option splice-auto (*) X X X X
1990option splice-request (*) X X X X
1991option splice-response (*) X X X X
Christopher Fauletba7bc162016-11-07 21:07:38 +01001992option spop-check - - - X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01001993option srvtcpka (*) X - X X
1994option ssl-hello-chk X - X X
1995-- keyword -------------------------- defaults - frontend - listen -- backend -
Willy Tarreaued179852013-12-16 01:07:00 +01001996option tcp-check X - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01001997option tcp-smart-accept (*) X X X -
1998option tcp-smart-connect (*) X - X X
1999option tcpka X X X X
2000option tcplog X X X X
2001option transparent (*) X - X X
Simon Horman98637e52014-06-20 12:30:16 +09002002external-check command X - X X
2003external-check path X - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01002004persist rdp-cookie X - X X
2005rate-limit sessions X X X -
2006redirect - X X X
2007redisp (deprecated) X - X X
2008redispatch (deprecated) X - X X
2009reqadd - X X X
2010reqallow - X X X
2011reqdel - X X X
2012reqdeny - X X X
2013reqiallow - X X X
2014reqidel - X X X
2015reqideny - X X X
2016reqipass - X X X
2017reqirep - X X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01002018reqitarpit - X X X
2019reqpass - X X X
2020reqrep - X X X
2021-- keyword -------------------------- defaults - frontend - listen -- backend -
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01002022reqtarpit - X X X
2023retries X - X X
2024rspadd - X X X
2025rspdel - X X X
2026rspdeny - X X X
2027rspidel - X X X
2028rspideny - X X X
2029rspirep - X X X
2030rsprep - X X X
2031server - - X X
Baptiste Assmann01c6cc32015-08-23 11:45:29 +02002032server-state-file-name X - X X
Frédéric Lécaillecb4502e2017-04-20 13:36:25 +02002033server-template - - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01002034source X - X X
2035srvtimeout (deprecated) X - X X
Baptiste Assmann5a549212015-10-12 20:30:24 +02002036stats admin - X X X
2037stats auth X X X X
2038stats enable X X X X
2039stats hide-version X X X X
2040stats http-request - X X X
2041stats realm X X X X
2042stats refresh X X X X
2043stats scope X X X X
2044stats show-desc X X X X
2045stats show-legends X X X X
2046stats show-node X X X X
2047stats uri X X X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01002048-- keyword -------------------------- defaults - frontend - listen -- backend -
2049stick match - - X X
2050stick on - - X X
2051stick store-request - - X X
Willy Tarreaud8dc99f2011-07-01 11:33:25 +02002052stick store-response - - X X
Adam Spiers68af3c12017-04-06 16:31:39 +01002053stick-table - X X X
Willy Tarreau938c7fe2014-04-25 14:21:39 +02002054tcp-check connect - - X X
2055tcp-check expect - - X X
2056tcp-check send - - X X
2057tcp-check send-binary - - X X
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02002058tcp-request connection - X X -
2059tcp-request content - X X X
Willy Tarreaua56235c2010-09-14 11:31:36 +02002060tcp-request inspect-delay - X X X
Willy Tarreau4f614292016-10-21 17:49:36 +02002061tcp-request session - X X -
Emeric Brun0a3b67f2010-09-24 15:34:53 +02002062tcp-response content - - X X
2063tcp-response inspect-delay - - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01002064timeout check X - X X
2065timeout client X X X -
Willy Tarreau05cdd962014-05-10 14:30:07 +02002066timeout client-fin X X X -
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01002067timeout clitimeout (deprecated) X X X -
2068timeout connect X - X X
2069timeout contimeout (deprecated) X - X X
2070timeout http-keep-alive X X X X
2071timeout http-request X X X X
2072timeout queue X - X X
2073timeout server X - X X
Willy Tarreau05cdd962014-05-10 14:30:07 +02002074timeout server-fin X - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01002075timeout srvtimeout (deprecated) X - X X
2076timeout tarpit X X X X
Willy Tarreauce887fd2012-05-12 12:50:00 +02002077timeout tunnel X - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01002078transparent (deprecated) X - X X
William Lallemanda73203e2012-03-12 12:48:57 +01002079unique-id-format X X X -
2080unique-id-header X X X -
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01002081use_backend - X X -
Willy Tarreau4a5cade2012-04-05 21:09:48 +02002082use-server - - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01002083------------------------------------+----------+----------+---------+---------
2084 keyword defaults frontend listen backend
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02002085
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002086
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020020874.2. Alphabetically sorted keywords reference
2088---------------------------------------------
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002089
2090This section provides a description of each keyword and its usage.
2091
2092
2093acl <aclname> <criterion> [flags] [operator] <value> ...
2094 Declare or complete an access list.
2095 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
2096 no | yes | yes | yes
2097 Example:
2098 acl invalid_src src 0.0.0.0/7 224.0.0.0/3
2099 acl invalid_src src_port 0:1023
2100 acl local_dst hdr(host) -i localhost
2101
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02002102 See section 7 about ACL usage.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002103
2104
Cyril Bontéb21570a2009-11-29 20:04:48 +01002105appsession <cookie> len <length> timeout <holdtime>
2106 [request-learn] [prefix] [mode <path-parameters|query-string>]
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002107 Define session stickiness on an existing application cookie.
2108 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
2109 no | no | yes | yes
2110 Arguments :
2111 <cookie> this is the name of the cookie used by the application and which
2112 HAProxy will have to learn for each new session.
2113
Cyril Bontéb21570a2009-11-29 20:04:48 +01002114 <length> this is the max number of characters that will be memorized and
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002115 checked in each cookie value.
2116
2117 <holdtime> this is the time after which the cookie will be removed from
2118 memory if unused. If no unit is specified, this time is in
2119 milliseconds.
2120
Cyril Bontébf47aeb2009-10-15 00:15:40 +02002121 request-learn
2122 If this option is specified, then haproxy will be able to learn
2123 the cookie found in the request in case the server does not
2124 specify any in response. This is typically what happens with
2125 PHPSESSID cookies, or when haproxy's session expires before
2126 the application's session and the correct server is selected.
2127 It is recommended to specify this option to improve reliability.
2128
Cyril Bontéb21570a2009-11-29 20:04:48 +01002129 prefix When this option is specified, haproxy will match on the cookie
2130 prefix (or URL parameter prefix). The appsession value is the
2131 data following this prefix.
2132
2133 Example :
2134 appsession ASPSESSIONID len 64 timeout 3h prefix
2135
2136 This will match the cookie ASPSESSIONIDXXXX=XXXXX,
2137 the appsession value will be XXXX=XXXXX.
2138
2139 mode This option allows to change the URL parser mode.
2140 2 modes are currently supported :
2141 - path-parameters :
2142 The parser looks for the appsession in the path parameters
2143 part (each parameter is separated by a semi-colon), which is
2144 convenient for JSESSIONID for example.
2145 This is the default mode if the option is not set.
2146 - query-string :
2147 In this mode, the parser will look for the appsession in the
2148 query string.
2149
Willy Tarreau294d0f02015-08-10 19:40:12 +02002150 As of version 1.6, appsessions was removed. It is more flexible and more
2151 convenient to use stick-tables instead, and stick-tables support multi-master
2152 replication and data conservation across reloads, which appsessions did not.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002153
Cyril Bonté02ff8ef2010-12-14 22:48:49 +01002154 See also : "cookie", "capture cookie", "balance", "stick", "stick-table",
2155 "ignore-persist", "nbproc" and "bind-process".
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002156
2157
Willy Tarreauc73ce2b2008-01-06 10:55:10 +01002158backlog <conns>
2159 Give hints to the system about the approximate listen backlog desired size
2160 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
2161 yes | yes | yes | no
2162 Arguments :
2163 <conns> is the number of pending connections. Depending on the operating
2164 system, it may represent the number of already acknowledged
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +02002165 connections, of non-acknowledged ones, or both.
Willy Tarreauc73ce2b2008-01-06 10:55:10 +01002166
2167 In order to protect against SYN flood attacks, one solution is to increase
2168 the system's SYN backlog size. Depending on the system, sometimes it is just
2169 tunable via a system parameter, sometimes it is not adjustable at all, and
2170 sometimes the system relies on hints given by the application at the time of
2171 the listen() syscall. By default, HAProxy passes the frontend's maxconn value
2172 to the listen() syscall. On systems which can make use of this value, it can
2173 sometimes be useful to be able to specify a different value, hence this
2174 backlog parameter.
2175
2176 On Linux 2.4, the parameter is ignored by the system. On Linux 2.6, it is
2177 used as a hint and the system accepts up to the smallest greater power of
2178 two, and never more than some limits (usually 32768).
2179
2180 See also : "maxconn" and the target operating system's tuning guide.
2181
2182
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002183balance <algorithm> [ <arguments> ]
Willy Tarreau226071e2014-04-10 11:55:45 +02002184balance url_param <param> [check_post]
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002185 Define the load balancing algorithm to be used in a backend.
2186 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
2187 yes | no | yes | yes
2188 Arguments :
2189 <algorithm> is the algorithm used to select a server when doing load
2190 balancing. This only applies when no persistence information
2191 is available, or when a connection is redispatched to another
2192 server. <algorithm> may be one of the following :
2193
2194 roundrobin Each server is used in turns, according to their weights.
2195 This is the smoothest and fairest algorithm when the server's
2196 processing time remains equally distributed. This algorithm
2197 is dynamic, which means that server weights may be adjusted
Willy Tarreau9757a382009-10-03 12:56:50 +02002198 on the fly for slow starts for instance. It is limited by
Godbacha34bdc02013-07-22 07:44:53 +08002199 design to 4095 active servers per backend. Note that in some
Willy Tarreau9757a382009-10-03 12:56:50 +02002200 large farms, when a server becomes up after having been down
2201 for a very short time, it may sometimes take a few hundreds
2202 requests for it to be re-integrated into the farm and start
2203 receiving traffic. This is normal, though very rare. It is
2204 indicated here in case you would have the chance to observe
2205 it, so that you don't worry.
2206
2207 static-rr Each server is used in turns, according to their weights.
2208 This algorithm is as similar to roundrobin except that it is
2209 static, which means that changing a server's weight on the
2210 fly will have no effect. On the other hand, it has no design
2211 limitation on the number of servers, and when a server goes
2212 up, it is always immediately reintroduced into the farm, once
2213 the full map is recomputed. It also uses slightly less CPU to
2214 run (around -1%).
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002215
Willy Tarreau2d2a7f82008-03-17 12:07:56 +01002216 leastconn The server with the lowest number of connections receives the
2217 connection. Round-robin is performed within groups of servers
2218 of the same load to ensure that all servers will be used. Use
2219 of this algorithm is recommended where very long sessions are
2220 expected, such as LDAP, SQL, TSE, etc... but is not very well
2221 suited for protocols using short sessions such as HTTP. This
2222 algorithm is dynamic, which means that server weights may be
2223 adjusted on the fly for slow starts for instance.
2224
Willy Tarreauf09c6602012-02-13 17:12:08 +01002225 first The first server with available connection slots receives the
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03002226 connection. The servers are chosen from the lowest numeric
Willy Tarreauf09c6602012-02-13 17:12:08 +01002227 identifier to the highest (see server parameter "id"), which
2228 defaults to the server's position in the farm. Once a server
Willy Tarreau64559c52012-04-07 09:08:45 +02002229 reaches its maxconn value, the next server is used. It does
Willy Tarreauf09c6602012-02-13 17:12:08 +01002230 not make sense to use this algorithm without setting maxconn.
2231 The purpose of this algorithm is to always use the smallest
2232 number of servers so that extra servers can be powered off
2233 during non-intensive hours. This algorithm ignores the server
2234 weight, and brings more benefit to long session such as RDP
Willy Tarreau64559c52012-04-07 09:08:45 +02002235 or IMAP than HTTP, though it can be useful there too. In
2236 order to use this algorithm efficiently, it is recommended
2237 that a cloud controller regularly checks server usage to turn
2238 them off when unused, and regularly checks backend queue to
2239 turn new servers on when the queue inflates. Alternatively,
2240 using "http-check send-state" may inform servers on the load.
Willy Tarreauf09c6602012-02-13 17:12:08 +01002241
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002242 source The source IP address is hashed and divided by the total
2243 weight of the running servers to designate which server will
2244 receive the request. This ensures that the same client IP
2245 address will always reach the same server as long as no
2246 server goes down or up. If the hash result changes due to the
2247 number of running servers changing, many clients will be
2248 directed to a different server. This algorithm is generally
2249 used in TCP mode where no cookie may be inserted. It may also
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01002250 be used on the Internet to provide a best-effort stickiness
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002251 to clients which refuse session cookies. This algorithm is
Willy Tarreau6b2e11b2009-10-01 07:52:15 +02002252 static by default, which means that changing a server's
2253 weight on the fly will have no effect, but this can be
2254 changed using "hash-type".
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002255
Oskar Stolc8dc41842012-05-19 10:19:54 +01002256 uri This algorithm hashes either the left part of the URI (before
2257 the question mark) or the whole URI (if the "whole" parameter
2258 is present) and divides the hash value by the total weight of
2259 the running servers. The result designates which server will
2260 receive the request. This ensures that the same URI will
2261 always be directed to the same server as long as no server
2262 goes up or down. This is used with proxy caches and
2263 anti-virus proxies in order to maximize the cache hit rate.
2264 Note that this algorithm may only be used in an HTTP backend.
2265 This algorithm is static by default, which means that
2266 changing a server's weight on the fly will have no effect,
2267 but this can be changed using "hash-type".
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002268
Oskar Stolc8dc41842012-05-19 10:19:54 +01002269 This algorithm supports two optional parameters "len" and
Marek Majkowski9c30fc12008-04-27 23:25:55 +02002270 "depth", both followed by a positive integer number. These
2271 options may be helpful when it is needed to balance servers
2272 based on the beginning of the URI only. The "len" parameter
2273 indicates that the algorithm should only consider that many
2274 characters at the beginning of the URI to compute the hash.
2275 Note that having "len" set to 1 rarely makes sense since most
2276 URIs start with a leading "/".
2277
2278 The "depth" parameter indicates the maximum directory depth
2279 to be used to compute the hash. One level is counted for each
2280 slash in the request. If both parameters are specified, the
2281 evaluation stops when either is reached.
2282
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002283 url_param The URL parameter specified in argument will be looked up in
matt.farnsworth@nokia.com1c2ab962008-04-14 20:47:37 +02002284 the query string of each HTTP GET request.
2285
2286 If the modifier "check_post" is used, then an HTTP POST
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +02002287 request entity will be searched for the parameter argument,
2288 when it is not found in a query string after a question mark
Willy Tarreau226071e2014-04-10 11:55:45 +02002289 ('?') in the URL. The message body will only start to be
2290 analyzed once either the advertised amount of data has been
2291 received or the request buffer is full. In the unlikely event
2292 that chunked encoding is used, only the first chunk is
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +02002293 scanned. Parameter values separated by a chunk boundary, may
Willy Tarreau226071e2014-04-10 11:55:45 +02002294 be randomly balanced if at all. This keyword used to support
2295 an optional <max_wait> parameter which is now ignored.
matt.farnsworth@nokia.com1c2ab962008-04-14 20:47:37 +02002296
2297 If the parameter is found followed by an equal sign ('=') and
2298 a value, then the value is hashed and divided by the total
2299 weight of the running servers. The result designates which
2300 server will receive the request.
2301
2302 This is used to track user identifiers in requests and ensure
2303 that a same user ID will always be sent to the same server as
2304 long as no server goes up or down. If no value is found or if
2305 the parameter is not found, then a round robin algorithm is
2306 applied. Note that this algorithm may only be used in an HTTP
Willy Tarreau6b2e11b2009-10-01 07:52:15 +02002307 backend. This algorithm is static by default, which means
2308 that changing a server's weight on the fly will have no
2309 effect, but this can be changed using "hash-type".
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002310
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +02002311 hdr(<name>) The HTTP header <name> will be looked up in each HTTP
2312 request. Just as with the equivalent ACL 'hdr()' function,
2313 the header name in parenthesis is not case sensitive. If the
2314 header is absent or if it does not contain any value, the
2315 roundrobin algorithm is applied instead.
Benoitaffb4812009-03-25 13:02:10 +01002316
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01002317 An optional 'use_domain_only' parameter is available, for
Benoitaffb4812009-03-25 13:02:10 +01002318 reducing the hash algorithm to the main domain part with some
2319 specific headers such as 'Host'. For instance, in the Host
2320 value "haproxy.1wt.eu", only "1wt" will be considered.
2321
Willy Tarreau6b2e11b2009-10-01 07:52:15 +02002322 This algorithm is static by default, which means that
2323 changing a server's weight on the fly will have no effect,
2324 but this can be changed using "hash-type".
2325
Emeric Brun736aa232009-06-30 17:56:00 +02002326 rdp-cookie
Hervé COMMOWICKa3eb39c2011-08-05 18:48:51 +02002327 rdp-cookie(<name>)
Emeric Brun736aa232009-06-30 17:56:00 +02002328 The RDP cookie <name> (or "mstshash" if omitted) will be
2329 looked up and hashed for each incoming TCP request. Just as
2330 with the equivalent ACL 'req_rdp_cookie()' function, the name
2331 is not case-sensitive. This mechanism is useful as a degraded
2332 persistence mode, as it makes it possible to always send the
2333 same user (or the same session ID) to the same server. If the
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01002334 cookie is not found, the normal roundrobin algorithm is
Emeric Brun736aa232009-06-30 17:56:00 +02002335 used instead.
2336
2337 Note that for this to work, the frontend must ensure that an
2338 RDP cookie is already present in the request buffer. For this
2339 you must use 'tcp-request content accept' rule combined with
2340 a 'req_rdp_cookie_cnt' ACL.
2341
Willy Tarreau6b2e11b2009-10-01 07:52:15 +02002342 This algorithm is static by default, which means that
2343 changing a server's weight on the fly will have no effect,
2344 but this can be changed using "hash-type".
2345
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +02002346 See also the rdp_cookie pattern fetch function.
Simon Hormanab814e02011-06-24 14:50:20 +09002347
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002348 <arguments> is an optional list of arguments which may be needed by some
Marek Majkowski9c30fc12008-04-27 23:25:55 +02002349 algorithms. Right now, only "url_param" and "uri" support an
2350 optional argument.
matt.farnsworth@nokia.com1c2ab962008-04-14 20:47:37 +02002351
Willy Tarreau3cd9af22009-03-15 14:06:41 +01002352 The load balancing algorithm of a backend is set to roundrobin when no other
2353 algorithm, mode nor option have been set. The algorithm may only be set once
2354 for each backend.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002355
2356 Examples :
2357 balance roundrobin
2358 balance url_param userid
matt.farnsworth@nokia.com1c2ab962008-04-14 20:47:37 +02002359 balance url_param session_id check_post 64
Benoitaffb4812009-03-25 13:02:10 +01002360 balance hdr(User-Agent)
2361 balance hdr(host)
2362 balance hdr(Host) use_domain_only
matt.farnsworth@nokia.com1c2ab962008-04-14 20:47:37 +02002363
2364 Note: the following caveats and limitations on using the "check_post"
2365 extension with "url_param" must be considered :
2366
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01002367 - all POST requests are eligible for consideration, because there is no way
matt.farnsworth@nokia.com1c2ab962008-04-14 20:47:37 +02002368 to determine if the parameters will be found in the body or entity which
2369 may contain binary data. Therefore another method may be required to
2370 restrict consideration of POST requests that have no URL parameters in
2371 the body. (see acl reqideny http_end)
2372
2373 - using a <max_wait> value larger than the request buffer size does not
2374 make sense and is useless. The buffer size is set at build time, and
2375 defaults to 16 kB.
2376
2377 - Content-Encoding is not supported, the parameter search will probably
2378 fail; and load balancing will fall back to Round Robin.
2379
2380 - Expect: 100-continue is not supported, load balancing will fall back to
2381 Round Robin.
2382
Lukas Tribus23953682017-04-28 13:24:30 +00002383 - Transfer-Encoding (RFC7230 3.3.1) is only supported in the first chunk.
matt.farnsworth@nokia.com1c2ab962008-04-14 20:47:37 +02002384 If the entire parameter value is not present in the first chunk, the
2385 selection of server is undefined (actually, defined by how little
2386 actually appeared in the first chunk).
2387
2388 - This feature does not support generation of a 100, 411 or 501 response.
2389
2390 - In some cases, requesting "check_post" MAY attempt to scan the entire
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01002391 contents of a message body. Scanning normally terminates when linear
matt.farnsworth@nokia.com1c2ab962008-04-14 20:47:37 +02002392 white space or control characters are found, indicating the end of what
2393 might be a URL parameter list. This is probably not a concern with SGML
2394 type message bodies.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002395
Willy Tarreau294d0f02015-08-10 19:40:12 +02002396 See also : "dispatch", "cookie", "transparent", "hash-type" and "http_proxy".
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002397
2398
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +02002399bind [<address>]:<port_range> [, ...] [param*]
2400bind /<path> [, ...] [param*]
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002401 Define one or several listening addresses and/or ports in a frontend.
2402 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
2403 no | yes | yes | no
2404 Arguments :
Willy Tarreaub1e52e82008-01-13 14:49:51 +01002405 <address> is optional and can be a host name, an IPv4 address, an IPv6
2406 address, or '*'. It designates the address the frontend will
2407 listen on. If unset, all IPv4 addresses of the system will be
2408 listened on. The same will apply for '*' or the system's
David du Colombier9c938da2011-03-17 10:40:27 +01002409 special address "0.0.0.0". The IPv6 equivalent is '::'.
Willy Tarreau24709282013-03-10 21:32:12 +01002410 Optionally, an address family prefix may be used before the
2411 address to force the family regardless of the address format,
2412 which can be useful to specify a path to a unix socket with
2413 no slash ('/'). Currently supported prefixes are :
2414 - 'ipv4@' -> address is always IPv4
2415 - 'ipv6@' -> address is always IPv6
2416 - 'unix@' -> address is a path to a local unix socket
Willy Tarreau70f72e02014-07-08 00:37:50 +02002417 - 'abns@' -> address is in abstract namespace (Linux only).
2418 Note: since abstract sockets are not "rebindable", they
2419 do not cope well with multi-process mode during
2420 soft-restart, so it is better to avoid them if
2421 nbproc is greater than 1. The effect is that if the
2422 new process fails to start, only one of the old ones
2423 will be able to rebind to the socket.
Willy Tarreau40aa0702013-03-10 23:51:38 +01002424 - 'fd@<n>' -> use file descriptor <n> inherited from the
2425 parent. The fd must be bound and may or may not already
2426 be listening.
William Lallemandb2f07452015-05-12 14:27:13 +02002427 You may want to reference some environment variables in the
2428 address parameter, see section 2.3 about environment
2429 variables.
Willy Tarreaub1e52e82008-01-13 14:49:51 +01002430
Willy Tarreauc5011ca2010-03-22 11:53:56 +01002431 <port_range> is either a unique TCP port, or a port range for which the
2432 proxy will accept connections for the IP address specified
Willy Tarreauceb24bc2010-11-09 12:46:41 +01002433 above. The port is mandatory for TCP listeners. Note that in
2434 the case of an IPv6 address, the port is always the number
2435 after the last colon (':'). A range can either be :
Willy Tarreauc5011ca2010-03-22 11:53:56 +01002436 - a numerical port (ex: '80')
2437 - a dash-delimited ports range explicitly stating the lower
2438 and upper bounds (ex: '2000-2100') which are included in
2439 the range.
2440
2441 Particular care must be taken against port ranges, because
2442 every <address:port> couple consumes one socket (= a file
2443 descriptor), so it's easy to consume lots of descriptors
2444 with a simple range, and to run out of sockets. Also, each
2445 <address:port> couple must be used only once among all
2446 instances running on a same system. Please note that binding
2447 to ports lower than 1024 generally require particular
Jamie Gloudon801a0a32012-08-25 00:18:33 -04002448 privileges to start the program, which are independent of
Willy Tarreauc5011ca2010-03-22 11:53:56 +01002449 the 'uid' parameter.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002450
Willy Tarreauceb24bc2010-11-09 12:46:41 +01002451 <path> is a UNIX socket path beginning with a slash ('/'). This is
2452 alternative to the TCP listening port. Haproxy will then
2453 receive UNIX connections on the socket located at this place.
2454 The path must begin with a slash and by default is absolute.
2455 It can be relative to the prefix defined by "unix-bind" in
2456 the global section. Note that the total length of the prefix
2457 followed by the socket path cannot exceed some system limits
2458 for UNIX sockets, which commonly are set to 107 characters.
2459
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +02002460 <param*> is a list of parameters common to all sockets declared on the
2461 same line. These numerous parameters depend on OS and build
2462 options and have a complete section dedicated to them. Please
2463 refer to section 5 to for more details.
Willy Tarreaua0ee1d02012-09-10 09:01:23 +02002464
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002465 It is possible to specify a list of address:port combinations delimited by
2466 commas. The frontend will then listen on all of these addresses. There is no
2467 fixed limit to the number of addresses and ports which can be listened on in
2468 a frontend, as well as there is no limit to the number of "bind" statements
2469 in a frontend.
2470
2471 Example :
2472 listen http_proxy
2473 bind :80,:443
2474 bind 10.0.0.1:10080,10.0.0.1:10443
Willy Tarreauceb24bc2010-11-09 12:46:41 +01002475 bind /var/run/ssl-frontend.sock user root mode 600 accept-proxy
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002476
Willy Tarreaua0ee1d02012-09-10 09:01:23 +02002477 listen http_https_proxy
2478 bind :80
Cyril Bonté0d44fc62012-10-09 22:45:33 +02002479 bind :443 ssl crt /etc/haproxy/site.pem
Willy Tarreaua0ee1d02012-09-10 09:01:23 +02002480
Willy Tarreau24709282013-03-10 21:32:12 +01002481 listen http_https_proxy_explicit
2482 bind ipv6@:80
2483 bind ipv4@public_ssl:443 ssl crt /etc/haproxy/site.pem
2484 bind unix@ssl-frontend.sock user root mode 600 accept-proxy
2485
Willy Tarreaudad36a32013-03-11 01:20:04 +01002486 listen external_bind_app1
William Lallemandb2f07452015-05-12 14:27:13 +02002487 bind "fd@${FD_APP1}"
Willy Tarreaudad36a32013-03-11 01:20:04 +01002488
Willy Tarreau55dcaf62015-09-27 15:03:15 +02002489 Note: regarding Linux's abstract namespace sockets, HAProxy uses the whole
2490 sun_path length is used for the address length. Some other programs
2491 such as socat use the string length only by default. Pass the option
2492 ",unix-tightsocklen=0" to any abstract socket definition in socat to
2493 make it compatible with HAProxy's.
2494
Willy Tarreauceb24bc2010-11-09 12:46:41 +01002495 See also : "source", "option forwardfor", "unix-bind" and the PROXY protocol
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +02002496 documentation, and section 5 about bind options.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002497
2498
Willy Tarreaua9db57e2013-01-18 11:29:29 +01002499bind-process [ all | odd | even | <number 1-64>[-<number 1-64>] ] ...
Willy Tarreau0b9c02c2009-02-04 22:05:05 +01002500 Limit visibility of an instance to a certain set of processes numbers.
2501 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
2502 yes | yes | yes | yes
2503 Arguments :
2504 all All process will see this instance. This is the default. It
2505 may be used to override a default value.
2506
Willy Tarreaua9db57e2013-01-18 11:29:29 +01002507 odd This instance will be enabled on processes 1,3,5,...63. This
Willy Tarreau0b9c02c2009-02-04 22:05:05 +01002508 option may be combined with other numbers.
2509
Willy Tarreaua9db57e2013-01-18 11:29:29 +01002510 even This instance will be enabled on processes 2,4,6,...64. This
Willy Tarreau0b9c02c2009-02-04 22:05:05 +01002511 option may be combined with other numbers. Do not use it
2512 with less than 2 processes otherwise some instances might be
2513 missing from all processes.
2514
Willy Tarreau110ecc12012-11-15 17:50:01 +01002515 number The instance will be enabled on this process number or range,
Willy Tarreaua9db57e2013-01-18 11:29:29 +01002516 whose values must all be between 1 and 32 or 64 depending on
Willy Tarreau102df612014-05-07 23:56:38 +02002517 the machine's word size. If a proxy is bound to process
2518 numbers greater than the configured global.nbproc, it will
2519 either be forced to process #1 if a single process was
2520 specified, or to all processes otherwise.
Willy Tarreau0b9c02c2009-02-04 22:05:05 +01002521
2522 This keyword limits binding of certain instances to certain processes. This
2523 is useful in order not to have too many processes listening to the same
2524 ports. For instance, on a dual-core machine, it might make sense to set
2525 'nbproc 2' in the global section, then distributes the listeners among 'odd'
2526 and 'even' instances.
2527
Willy Tarreaua9db57e2013-01-18 11:29:29 +01002528 At the moment, it is not possible to reference more than 32 or 64 processes
2529 using this keyword, but this should be more than enough for most setups.
2530 Please note that 'all' really means all processes regardless of the machine's
2531 word size, and is not limited to the first 32 or 64.
Willy Tarreau0b9c02c2009-02-04 22:05:05 +01002532
Willy Tarreau6ae1ba62014-05-07 19:01:58 +02002533 Each "bind" line may further be limited to a subset of the proxy's processes,
2534 please consult the "process" bind keyword in section 5.1.
2535
Willy Tarreaub369a042014-09-16 13:21:03 +02002536 When a frontend has no explicit "bind-process" line, it tries to bind to all
2537 the processes referenced by its "bind" lines. That means that frontends can
2538 easily adapt to their listeners' processes.
2539
Willy Tarreau0b9c02c2009-02-04 22:05:05 +01002540 If some backends are referenced by frontends bound to other processes, the
2541 backend automatically inherits the frontend's processes.
2542
2543 Example :
2544 listen app_ip1
2545 bind 10.0.0.1:80
Willy Tarreaubfcd3112010-10-23 11:22:08 +02002546 bind-process odd
Willy Tarreau0b9c02c2009-02-04 22:05:05 +01002547
2548 listen app_ip2
2549 bind 10.0.0.2:80
Willy Tarreaubfcd3112010-10-23 11:22:08 +02002550 bind-process even
Willy Tarreau0b9c02c2009-02-04 22:05:05 +01002551
2552 listen management
2553 bind 10.0.0.3:80
Willy Tarreaubfcd3112010-10-23 11:22:08 +02002554 bind-process 1 2 3 4
Willy Tarreau0b9c02c2009-02-04 22:05:05 +01002555
Willy Tarreau110ecc12012-11-15 17:50:01 +01002556 listen management
2557 bind 10.0.0.4:80
2558 bind-process 1-4
2559
Willy Tarreau6ae1ba62014-05-07 19:01:58 +02002560 See also : "nbproc" in global section, and "process" in section 5.1.
Willy Tarreau0b9c02c2009-02-04 22:05:05 +01002561
2562
Jarno Huuskonen8c8c3492016-12-28 18:50:29 +02002563block { if | unless } <condition> (deprecated)
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002564 Block a layer 7 request if/unless a condition is matched
2565 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
2566 no | yes | yes | yes
2567
2568 The HTTP request will be blocked very early in the layer 7 processing
2569 if/unless <condition> is matched. A 403 error will be returned if the request
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02002570 is blocked. The condition has to reference ACLs (see section 7). This is
Willy Tarreau3c92c5f2011-08-28 09:45:47 +02002571 typically used to deny access to certain sensitive resources if some
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002572 conditions are met or not met. There is no fixed limit to the number of
Jarno Huuskonen95b012b2017-04-06 13:59:14 +03002573 "block" statements per instance. To block connections at layer 4 (without
2574 sending a 403 error) see "tcp-request connection reject" and
2575 "tcp-request content reject" rules.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002576
Jarno Huuskonen8c8c3492016-12-28 18:50:29 +02002577 This form is deprecated, do not use it in any new configuration, use the new
2578 "http-request deny" instead.
2579
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002580 Example:
2581 acl invalid_src src 0.0.0.0/7 224.0.0.0/3
2582 acl invalid_src src_port 0:1023
2583 acl local_dst hdr(host) -i localhost
Jarno Huuskonen84c51ec2017-04-03 14:20:34 +03002584 # block is deprecated. Use http-request deny instead:
2585 #block if invalid_src || local_dst
2586 http-request deny if invalid_src || local_dst
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002587
Jarno Huuskonen95b012b2017-04-06 13:59:14 +03002588 See also : section 7 about ACL usage, "http-request deny",
2589 "http-response deny", "tcp-request connection reject" and
2590 "tcp-request content reject".
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002591
2592capture cookie <name> len <length>
2593 Capture and log a cookie in the request and in the response.
2594 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
2595 no | yes | yes | no
2596 Arguments :
2597 <name> is the beginning of the name of the cookie to capture. In order
2598 to match the exact name, simply suffix the name with an equal
2599 sign ('='). The full name will appear in the logs, which is
2600 useful with application servers which adjust both the cookie name
2601 and value (eg: ASPSESSIONXXXXX).
2602
2603 <length> is the maximum number of characters to report in the logs, which
2604 include the cookie name, the equal sign and the value, all in the
2605 standard "name=value" form. The string will be truncated on the
2606 right if it exceeds <length>.
2607
2608 Only the first cookie is captured. Both the "cookie" request headers and the
2609 "set-cookie" response headers are monitored. This is particularly useful to
2610 check for application bugs causing session crossing or stealing between
2611 users, because generally the user's cookies can only change on a login page.
2612
2613 When the cookie was not presented by the client, the associated log column
2614 will report "-". When a request does not cause a cookie to be assigned by the
2615 server, a "-" is reported in the response column.
2616
2617 The capture is performed in the frontend only because it is necessary that
2618 the log format does not change for a given frontend depending on the
2619 backends. This may change in the future. Note that there can be only one
Willy Tarreau193b8c62012-11-22 00:17:38 +01002620 "capture cookie" statement in a frontend. The maximum capture length is set
2621 by the global "tune.http.cookielen" setting and defaults to 63 characters. It
2622 is not possible to specify a capture in a "defaults" section.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002623
2624 Example:
2625 capture cookie ASPSESSION len 32
2626
2627 See also : "capture request header", "capture response header" as well as
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02002628 section 8 about logging.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002629
2630
2631capture request header <name> len <length>
Willy Tarreau4460d032012-11-21 23:37:37 +01002632 Capture and log the last occurrence of the specified request header.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002633 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
2634 no | yes | yes | no
2635 Arguments :
2636 <name> is the name of the header to capture. The header names are not
Willy Tarreaud2a4aa22008-01-31 15:28:22 +01002637 case-sensitive, but it is a common practice to write them as they
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002638 appear in the requests, with the first letter of each word in
2639 upper case. The header name will not appear in the logs, only the
2640 value is reported, but the position in the logs is respected.
2641
2642 <length> is the maximum number of characters to extract from the value and
2643 report in the logs. The string will be truncated on the right if
2644 it exceeds <length>.
2645
Willy Tarreau4460d032012-11-21 23:37:37 +01002646 The complete value of the last occurrence of the header is captured. The
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002647 value will be added to the logs between braces ('{}'). If multiple headers
2648 are captured, they will be delimited by a vertical bar ('|') and will appear
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +01002649 in the same order they were declared in the configuration. Non-existent
2650 headers will be logged just as an empty string. Common uses for request
2651 header captures include the "Host" field in virtual hosting environments, the
2652 "Content-length" when uploads are supported, "User-agent" to quickly
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01002653 differentiate between real users and robots, and "X-Forwarded-For" in proxied
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +01002654 environments to find where the request came from.
2655
2656 Note that when capturing headers such as "User-agent", some spaces may be
2657 logged, making the log analysis more difficult. Thus be careful about what
2658 you log if you know your log parser is not smart enough to rely on the
2659 braces.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002660
Willy Tarreau0900abb2012-11-22 00:21:46 +01002661 There is no limit to the number of captured request headers nor to their
2662 length, though it is wise to keep them low to limit memory usage per session.
2663 In order to keep log format consistent for a same frontend, header captures
2664 can only be declared in a frontend. It is not possible to specify a capture
2665 in a "defaults" section.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002666
2667 Example:
2668 capture request header Host len 15
2669 capture request header X-Forwarded-For len 15
Cyril Bontéd1b0f7c2015-10-26 22:37:39 +01002670 capture request header Referer len 15
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002671
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02002672 See also : "capture cookie", "capture response header" as well as section 8
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002673 about logging.
2674
2675
2676capture response header <name> len <length>
Willy Tarreau4460d032012-11-21 23:37:37 +01002677 Capture and log the last occurrence of the specified response header.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002678 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
2679 no | yes | yes | no
2680 Arguments :
2681 <name> is the name of the header to capture. The header names are not
Willy Tarreaud2a4aa22008-01-31 15:28:22 +01002682 case-sensitive, but it is a common practice to write them as they
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002683 appear in the response, with the first letter of each word in
2684 upper case. The header name will not appear in the logs, only the
2685 value is reported, but the position in the logs is respected.
2686
2687 <length> is the maximum number of characters to extract from the value and
2688 report in the logs. The string will be truncated on the right if
2689 it exceeds <length>.
2690
Willy Tarreau4460d032012-11-21 23:37:37 +01002691 The complete value of the last occurrence of the header is captured. The
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002692 result will be added to the logs between braces ('{}') after the captured
2693 request headers. If multiple headers are captured, they will be delimited by
2694 a vertical bar ('|') and will appear in the same order they were declared in
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +01002695 the configuration. Non-existent headers will be logged just as an empty
2696 string. Common uses for response header captures include the "Content-length"
2697 header which indicates how many bytes are expected to be returned, the
2698 "Location" header to track redirections.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002699
Willy Tarreau0900abb2012-11-22 00:21:46 +01002700 There is no limit to the number of captured response headers nor to their
2701 length, though it is wise to keep them low to limit memory usage per session.
2702 In order to keep log format consistent for a same frontend, header captures
2703 can only be declared in a frontend. It is not possible to specify a capture
2704 in a "defaults" section.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002705
2706 Example:
2707 capture response header Content-length len 9
2708 capture response header Location len 15
2709
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02002710 See also : "capture cookie", "capture request header" as well as section 8
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002711 about logging.
2712
2713
Cyril Bontéf0c60612010-02-06 14:44:47 +01002714clitimeout <timeout> (deprecated)
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002715 Set the maximum inactivity time on the client side.
2716 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
2717 yes | yes | yes | no
2718 Arguments :
2719 <timeout> is the timeout value is specified in milliseconds by default, but
2720 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
2721 as explained at the top of this document.
2722
2723 The inactivity timeout applies when the client is expected to acknowledge or
2724 send data. In HTTP mode, this timeout is particularly important to consider
2725 during the first phase, when the client sends the request, and during the
2726 response while it is reading data sent by the server. The value is specified
2727 in milliseconds by default, but can be in any other unit if the number is
2728 suffixed by the unit, as specified at the top of this document. In TCP mode
2729 (and to a lesser extent, in HTTP mode), it is highly recommended that the
2730 client timeout remains equal to the server timeout in order to avoid complex
Willy Tarreaud2a4aa22008-01-31 15:28:22 +01002731 situations to debug. It is a good practice to cover one or several TCP packet
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002732 losses by specifying timeouts that are slightly above multiples of 3 seconds
2733 (eg: 4 or 5 seconds).
2734
2735 This parameter is specific to frontends, but can be specified once for all in
2736 "defaults" sections. This is in fact one of the easiest solutions not to
2737 forget about it. An unspecified timeout results in an infinite timeout, which
2738 is not recommended. Such a usage is accepted and works but reports a warning
2739 during startup because it may results in accumulation of expired sessions in
2740 the system if the system's timeouts are not configured either.
2741
2742 This parameter is provided for compatibility but is currently deprecated.
2743 Please use "timeout client" instead.
2744
Willy Tarreau036fae02008-01-06 13:24:40 +01002745 See also : "timeout client", "timeout http-request", "timeout server", and
2746 "srvtimeout".
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002747
Cyril Bonté316a8cf2012-11-11 13:38:27 +01002748compression algo <algorithm> ...
2749compression type <mime type> ...
Willy Tarreau70737d12012-10-27 00:34:28 +02002750compression offload
William Lallemand82fe75c2012-10-23 10:25:10 +02002751 Enable HTTP compression.
2752 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
2753 yes | yes | yes | yes
2754 Arguments :
Cyril Bonté316a8cf2012-11-11 13:38:27 +01002755 algo is followed by the list of supported compression algorithms.
2756 type is followed by the list of MIME types that will be compressed.
2757 offload makes haproxy work as a compression offloader only (see notes).
2758
2759 The currently supported algorithms are :
Willy Tarreauc91840a2015-03-28 17:00:39 +01002760 identity this is mostly for debugging, and it was useful for developing
2761 the compression feature. Identity does not apply any change on
2762 data.
Cyril Bonté316a8cf2012-11-11 13:38:27 +01002763
Willy Tarreauc91840a2015-03-28 17:00:39 +01002764 gzip applies gzip compression. This setting is only available when
Baptiste Assmannf085d632015-12-21 17:57:32 +01002765 support for zlib or libslz was built in.
Willy Tarreauc91840a2015-03-28 17:00:39 +01002766
2767 deflate same as "gzip", but with deflate algorithm and zlib format.
2768 Note that this algorithm has ambiguous support on many
2769 browsers and no support at all from recent ones. It is
2770 strongly recommended not to use it for anything else than
2771 experimentation. This setting is only available when support
Baptiste Assmannf085d632015-12-21 17:57:32 +01002772 for zlib or libslz was built in.
Cyril Bonté316a8cf2012-11-11 13:38:27 +01002773
Willy Tarreauc91840a2015-03-28 17:00:39 +01002774 raw-deflate same as "deflate" without the zlib wrapper, and used as an
2775 alternative when the browser wants "deflate". All major
2776 browsers understand it and despite violating the standards,
2777 it is known to work better than "deflate", at least on MSIE
2778 and some versions of Safari. Do not use it in conjunction
2779 with "deflate", use either one or the other since both react
2780 to the same Accept-Encoding token. This setting is only
Baptiste Assmannf085d632015-12-21 17:57:32 +01002781 available when support for zlib or libslz was built in.
Cyril Bonté316a8cf2012-11-11 13:38:27 +01002782
Dmitry Sivachenko87c208b2012-11-22 20:03:26 +04002783 Compression will be activated depending on the Accept-Encoding request
Cyril Bonté316a8cf2012-11-11 13:38:27 +01002784 header. With identity, it does not take care of that header.
Dmitry Sivachenkoc9f3b452012-11-28 17:47:11 +04002785 If backend servers support HTTP compression, these directives
2786 will be no-op: haproxy will see the compressed response and will not
2787 compress again. If backend servers do not support HTTP compression and
2788 there is Accept-Encoding header in request, haproxy will compress the
2789 matching response.
Willy Tarreau70737d12012-10-27 00:34:28 +02002790
2791 The "offload" setting makes haproxy remove the Accept-Encoding header to
2792 prevent backend servers from compressing responses. It is strongly
2793 recommended not to do this because this means that all the compression work
2794 will be done on the single point where haproxy is located. However in some
2795 deployment scenarios, haproxy may be installed in front of a buggy gateway
Dmitry Sivachenkoc9f3b452012-11-28 17:47:11 +04002796 with broken HTTP compression implementation which can't be turned off.
2797 In that case haproxy can be used to prevent that gateway from emitting
2798 invalid payloads. In this case, simply removing the header in the
2799 configuration does not work because it applies before the header is parsed,
2800 so that prevents haproxy from compressing. The "offload" setting should
Willy Tarreauffea9fd2014-07-12 16:37:02 +02002801 then be used for such scenarios. Note: for now, the "offload" setting is
2802 ignored when set in a defaults section.
William Lallemand82fe75c2012-10-23 10:25:10 +02002803
William Lallemand05097442012-11-20 12:14:28 +01002804 Compression is disabled when:
Baptiste Assmann650d53d2013-01-05 15:44:44 +01002805 * the request does not advertise a supported compression algorithm in the
2806 "Accept-Encoding" header
2807 * the response message is not HTTP/1.1
William Lallemandd3002612012-11-26 14:34:47 +01002808 * HTTP status code is not 200
William Lallemand8bb4e342013-12-10 17:28:48 +01002809 * response header "Transfer-Encoding" contains "chunked" (Temporary
2810 Workaround)
Baptiste Assmann650d53d2013-01-05 15:44:44 +01002811 * response contain neither a "Content-Length" header nor a
2812 "Transfer-Encoding" whose last value is "chunked"
2813 * response contains a "Content-Type" header whose first value starts with
2814 "multipart"
2815 * the response contains the "no-transform" value in the "Cache-control"
2816 header
2817 * User-Agent matches "Mozilla/4" unless it is MSIE 6 with XP SP2, or MSIE 7
2818 and later
2819 * The response contains a "Content-Encoding" header, indicating that the
2820 response is already compressed (see compression offload)
William Lallemand05097442012-11-20 12:14:28 +01002821
Baptiste Assmann650d53d2013-01-05 15:44:44 +01002822 Note: The compression does not rewrite Etag headers, and does not emit the
2823 Warning header.
William Lallemand05097442012-11-20 12:14:28 +01002824
William Lallemand82fe75c2012-10-23 10:25:10 +02002825 Examples :
2826 compression algo gzip
2827 compression type text/html text/plain
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002828
Christopher Fauletc3fe5332016-04-07 15:30:10 +02002829
Cyril Bontéf0c60612010-02-06 14:44:47 +01002830contimeout <timeout> (deprecated)
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002831 Set the maximum time to wait for a connection attempt to a server to succeed.
2832 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
2833 yes | no | yes | yes
2834 Arguments :
2835 <timeout> is the timeout value is specified in milliseconds by default, but
2836 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
2837 as explained at the top of this document.
2838
2839 If the server is located on the same LAN as haproxy, the connection should be
Willy Tarreaud2a4aa22008-01-31 15:28:22 +01002840 immediate (less than a few milliseconds). Anyway, it is a good practice to
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +01002841 cover one or several TCP packet losses by specifying timeouts that are
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002842 slightly above multiples of 3 seconds (eg: 4 or 5 seconds). By default, the
2843 connect timeout also presets the queue timeout to the same value if this one
2844 has not been specified. Historically, the contimeout was also used to set the
2845 tarpit timeout in a listen section, which is not possible in a pure frontend.
2846
2847 This parameter is specific to backends, but can be specified once for all in
2848 "defaults" sections. This is in fact one of the easiest solutions not to
2849 forget about it. An unspecified timeout results in an infinite timeout, which
2850 is not recommended. Such a usage is accepted and works but reports a warning
2851 during startup because it may results in accumulation of failed sessions in
2852 the system if the system's timeouts are not configured either.
2853
2854 This parameter is provided for backwards compatibility but is currently
2855 deprecated. Please use "timeout connect", "timeout queue" or "timeout tarpit"
2856 instead.
2857
2858 See also : "timeout connect", "timeout queue", "timeout tarpit",
2859 "timeout server", "contimeout".
2860
2861
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +02002862cookie <name> [ rewrite | insert | prefix ] [ indirect ] [ nocache ]
Willy Tarreau4992dd22012-05-31 21:02:17 +02002863 [ postonly ] [ preserve ] [ httponly ] [ secure ]
2864 [ domain <domain> ]* [ maxidle <idle> ] [ maxlife <life> ]
Olivier Houchard4e694042017-03-14 20:01:29 +01002865 [ dynamic ]
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002866 Enable cookie-based persistence in a backend.
2867 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
2868 yes | no | yes | yes
2869 Arguments :
2870 <name> is the name of the cookie which will be monitored, modified or
2871 inserted in order to bring persistence. This cookie is sent to
2872 the client via a "Set-Cookie" header in the response, and is
2873 brought back by the client in a "Cookie" header in all requests.
2874 Special care should be taken to choose a name which does not
2875 conflict with any likely application cookie. Also, if the same
2876 backends are subject to be used by the same clients (eg:
2877 HTTP/HTTPS), care should be taken to use different cookie names
2878 between all backends if persistence between them is not desired.
2879
2880 rewrite This keyword indicates that the cookie will be provided by the
2881 server and that haproxy will have to modify its value to set the
2882 server's identifier in it. This mode is handy when the management
2883 of complex combinations of "Set-cookie" and "Cache-control"
2884 headers is left to the application. The application can then
2885 decide whether or not it is appropriate to emit a persistence
Lukas Tribusf01a9cd2016-02-03 18:09:37 +01002886 cookie. Since all responses should be monitored, this mode
2887 doesn't work in HTTP tunnel mode. Unless the application
2888 behaviour is very complex and/or broken, it is advised not to
2889 start with this mode for new deployments. This keyword is
2890 incompatible with "insert" and "prefix".
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002891
2892 insert This keyword indicates that the persistence cookie will have to
Willy Tarreaua79094d2010-08-31 22:54:15 +02002893 be inserted by haproxy in server responses if the client did not
Willy Tarreauba4c5be2010-10-23 12:46:42 +02002894
Willy Tarreaua79094d2010-08-31 22:54:15 +02002895 already have a cookie that would have permitted it to access this
Willy Tarreauba4c5be2010-10-23 12:46:42 +02002896 server. When used without the "preserve" option, if the server
2897 emits a cookie with the same name, it will be remove before
2898 processing. For this reason, this mode can be used to upgrade
2899 existing configurations running in the "rewrite" mode. The cookie
2900 will only be a session cookie and will not be stored on the
2901 client's disk. By default, unless the "indirect" option is added,
2902 the server will see the cookies emitted by the client. Due to
2903 caching effects, it is generally wise to add the "nocache" or
2904 "postonly" keywords (see below). The "insert" keyword is not
2905 compatible with "rewrite" and "prefix".
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002906
2907 prefix This keyword indicates that instead of relying on a dedicated
2908 cookie for the persistence, an existing one will be completed.
2909 This may be needed in some specific environments where the client
2910 does not support more than one single cookie and the application
2911 already needs it. In this case, whenever the server sets a cookie
2912 named <name>, it will be prefixed with the server's identifier
2913 and a delimiter. The prefix will be removed from all client
2914 requests so that the server still finds the cookie it emitted.
2915 Since all requests and responses are subject to being modified,
Lukas Tribusf01a9cd2016-02-03 18:09:37 +01002916 this mode doesn't work with tunnel mode. The "prefix" keyword is
Willy Tarreau37229df2011-10-17 12:24:55 +02002917 not compatible with "rewrite" and "insert". Note: it is highly
2918 recommended not to use "indirect" with "prefix", otherwise server
2919 cookie updates would not be sent to clients.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002920
Willy Tarreaua79094d2010-08-31 22:54:15 +02002921 indirect When this option is specified, no cookie will be emitted to a
2922 client which already has a valid one for the server which has
2923 processed the request. If the server sets such a cookie itself,
Willy Tarreauba4c5be2010-10-23 12:46:42 +02002924 it will be removed, unless the "preserve" option is also set. In
2925 "insert" mode, this will additionally remove cookies from the
2926 requests transmitted to the server, making the persistence
2927 mechanism totally transparent from an application point of view.
Willy Tarreau37229df2011-10-17 12:24:55 +02002928 Note: it is highly recommended not to use "indirect" with
2929 "prefix", otherwise server cookie updates would not be sent to
2930 clients.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002931
2932 nocache This option is recommended in conjunction with the insert mode
2933 when there is a cache between the client and HAProxy, as it
2934 ensures that a cacheable response will be tagged non-cacheable if
2935 a cookie needs to be inserted. This is important because if all
2936 persistence cookies are added on a cacheable home page for
2937 instance, then all customers will then fetch the page from an
2938 outer cache and will all share the same persistence cookie,
2939 leading to one server receiving much more traffic than others.
2940 See also the "insert" and "postonly" options.
2941
2942 postonly This option ensures that cookie insertion will only be performed
2943 on responses to POST requests. It is an alternative to the
2944 "nocache" option, because POST responses are not cacheable, so
2945 this ensures that the persistence cookie will never get cached.
2946 Since most sites do not need any sort of persistence before the
2947 first POST which generally is a login request, this is a very
2948 efficient method to optimize caching without risking to find a
2949 persistence cookie in the cache.
2950 See also the "insert" and "nocache" options.
2951
Willy Tarreauba4c5be2010-10-23 12:46:42 +02002952 preserve This option may only be used with "insert" and/or "indirect". It
2953 allows the server to emit the persistence cookie itself. In this
2954 case, if a cookie is found in the response, haproxy will leave it
2955 untouched. This is useful in order to end persistence after a
2956 logout request for instance. For this, the server just has to
2957 emit a cookie with an invalid value (eg: empty) or with a date in
2958 the past. By combining this mechanism with the "disable-on-404"
2959 check option, it is possible to perform a completely graceful
2960 shutdown because users will definitely leave the server after
2961 they logout.
2962
Willy Tarreau4992dd22012-05-31 21:02:17 +02002963 httponly This option tells haproxy to add an "HttpOnly" cookie attribute
2964 when a cookie is inserted. This attribute is used so that a
2965 user agent doesn't share the cookie with non-HTTP components.
2966 Please check RFC6265 for more information on this attribute.
2967
2968 secure This option tells haproxy to add a "Secure" cookie attribute when
2969 a cookie is inserted. This attribute is used so that a user agent
2970 never emits this cookie over non-secure channels, which means
2971 that a cookie learned with this flag will be presented only over
2972 SSL/TLS connections. Please check RFC6265 for more information on
2973 this attribute.
2974
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkiefe3b6f2008-05-23 23:49:32 +02002975 domain This option allows to specify the domain at which a cookie is
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01002976 inserted. It requires exactly one parameter: a valid domain
Willy Tarreau68a897b2009-12-03 23:28:34 +01002977 name. If the domain begins with a dot, the browser is allowed to
2978 use it for any host ending with that name. It is also possible to
2979 specify several domain names by invoking this option multiple
2980 times. Some browsers might have small limits on the number of
2981 domains, so be careful when doing that. For the record, sending
2982 10 domains to MSIE 6 or Firefox 2 works as expected.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkiefe3b6f2008-05-23 23:49:32 +02002983
Willy Tarreau996a92c2010-10-13 19:30:47 +02002984 maxidle This option allows inserted cookies to be ignored after some idle
2985 time. It only works with insert-mode cookies. When a cookie is
2986 sent to the client, the date this cookie was emitted is sent too.
2987 Upon further presentations of this cookie, if the date is older
2988 than the delay indicated by the parameter (in seconds), it will
2989 be ignored. Otherwise, it will be refreshed if needed when the
2990 response is sent to the client. This is particularly useful to
2991 prevent users who never close their browsers from remaining for
2992 too long on the same server (eg: after a farm size change). When
2993 this option is set and a cookie has no date, it is always
2994 accepted, but gets refreshed in the response. This maintains the
2995 ability for admins to access their sites. Cookies that have a
2996 date in the future further than 24 hours are ignored. Doing so
2997 lets admins fix timezone issues without risking kicking users off
2998 the site.
2999
3000 maxlife This option allows inserted cookies to be ignored after some life
3001 time, whether they're in use or not. It only works with insert
3002 mode cookies. When a cookie is first sent to the client, the date
3003 this cookie was emitted is sent too. Upon further presentations
3004 of this cookie, if the date is older than the delay indicated by
3005 the parameter (in seconds), it will be ignored. If the cookie in
3006 the request has no date, it is accepted and a date will be set.
3007 Cookies that have a date in the future further than 24 hours are
3008 ignored. Doing so lets admins fix timezone issues without risking
3009 kicking users off the site. Contrary to maxidle, this value is
3010 not refreshed, only the first visit date counts. Both maxidle and
3011 maxlife may be used at the time. This is particularly useful to
3012 prevent users who never close their browsers from remaining for
3013 too long on the same server (eg: after a farm size change). This
3014 is stronger than the maxidle method in that it forces a
3015 redispatch after some absolute delay.
3016
Olivier Houchard4e694042017-03-14 20:01:29 +01003017 dynamic Activate dynamic cookies. When used, a session cookie is
3018 dynamically created for each server, based on the IP and port
3019 of the server, and a secret key, specified in the
3020 "dynamic-cookie-key" backend directive.
3021 The cookie will be regenerated each time the IP address change,
3022 and is only generated for IPv4/IPv6.
3023
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003024 There can be only one persistence cookie per HTTP backend, and it can be
3025 declared in a defaults section. The value of the cookie will be the value
3026 indicated after the "cookie" keyword in a "server" statement. If no cookie
3027 is declared for a given server, the cookie is not set.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02003028
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003029 Examples :
3030 cookie JSESSIONID prefix
3031 cookie SRV insert indirect nocache
3032 cookie SRV insert postonly indirect
Willy Tarreau996a92c2010-10-13 19:30:47 +02003033 cookie SRV insert indirect nocache maxidle 30m maxlife 8h
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003034
Willy Tarreau294d0f02015-08-10 19:40:12 +02003035 See also : "balance source", "capture cookie", "server" and "ignore-persist".
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003036
Willy Tarreau983e01e2010-01-11 18:42:06 +01003037
Thierry FOURNIERa0a1b752015-05-26 17:44:32 +02003038declare capture [ request | response ] len <length>
3039 Declares a capture slot.
3040 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3041 no | yes | yes | no
3042 Arguments:
3043 <length> is the length allowed for the capture.
3044
3045 This declaration is only available in the frontend or listen section, but the
3046 reserved slot can be used in the backends. The "request" keyword allocates a
3047 capture slot for use in the request, and "response" allocates a capture slot
3048 for use in the response.
3049
3050 See also: "capture-req", "capture-res" (sample converters),
Baptiste Assmann5ac425c2015-10-21 23:13:46 +02003051 "capture.req.hdr", "capture.res.hdr" (sample fetches),
Thierry FOURNIERa0a1b752015-05-26 17:44:32 +02003052 "http-request capture" and "http-response capture".
3053
3054
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic6df0662010-01-05 16:38:49 +01003055default-server [param*]
3056 Change default options for a server in a backend
3057 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3058 yes | no | yes | yes
3059 Arguments:
Willy Tarreau983e01e2010-01-11 18:42:06 +01003060 <param*> is a list of parameters for this server. The "default-server"
3061 keyword accepts an important number of options and has a complete
3062 section dedicated to it. Please refer to section 5 for more
3063 details.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic6df0662010-01-05 16:38:49 +01003064
Willy Tarreau983e01e2010-01-11 18:42:06 +01003065 Example :
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic6df0662010-01-05 16:38:49 +01003066 default-server inter 1000 weight 13
3067
3068 See also: "server" and section 5 about server options
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003069
Willy Tarreau983e01e2010-01-11 18:42:06 +01003070
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003071default_backend <backend>
3072 Specify the backend to use when no "use_backend" rule has been matched.
3073 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3074 yes | yes | yes | no
3075 Arguments :
3076 <backend> is the name of the backend to use.
3077
3078 When doing content-switching between frontend and backends using the
3079 "use_backend" keyword, it is often useful to indicate which backend will be
3080 used when no rule has matched. It generally is the dynamic backend which
3081 will catch all undetermined requests.
3082
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003083 Example :
3084
3085 use_backend dynamic if url_dyn
3086 use_backend static if url_css url_img extension_img
3087 default_backend dynamic
3088
Willy Tarreau98d04852015-05-26 12:18:29 +02003089 See also : "use_backend"
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01003090
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003091
Baptiste Assmann27f51342013-10-09 06:51:49 +02003092description <string>
3093 Describe a listen, frontend or backend.
3094 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3095 no | yes | yes | yes
3096 Arguments : string
3097
3098 Allows to add a sentence to describe the related object in the HAProxy HTML
3099 stats page. The description will be printed on the right of the object name
3100 it describes.
3101 No need to backslash spaces in the <string> arguments.
3102
3103
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003104disabled
3105 Disable a proxy, frontend or backend.
3106 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3107 yes | yes | yes | yes
3108 Arguments : none
3109
3110 The "disabled" keyword is used to disable an instance, mainly in order to
3111 liberate a listening port or to temporarily disable a service. The instance
3112 will still be created and its configuration will be checked, but it will be
3113 created in the "stopped" state and will appear as such in the statistics. It
3114 will not receive any traffic nor will it send any health-checks or logs. It
3115 is possible to disable many instances at once by adding the "disabled"
3116 keyword in a "defaults" section.
3117
3118 See also : "enabled"
3119
3120
Willy Tarreau5ce94572010-06-07 14:35:41 +02003121dispatch <address>:<port>
3122 Set a default server address
3123 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3124 no | no | yes | yes
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +02003125 Arguments :
Willy Tarreau5ce94572010-06-07 14:35:41 +02003126
3127 <address> is the IPv4 address of the default server. Alternatively, a
3128 resolvable hostname is supported, but this name will be resolved
3129 during start-up.
3130
3131 <ports> is a mandatory port specification. All connections will be sent
3132 to this port, and it is not permitted to use port offsets as is
3133 possible with normal servers.
3134
Willy Tarreau787aed52011-04-15 06:45:37 +02003135 The "dispatch" keyword designates a default server for use when no other
Willy Tarreau5ce94572010-06-07 14:35:41 +02003136 server can take the connection. In the past it was used to forward non
3137 persistent connections to an auxiliary load balancer. Due to its simple
3138 syntax, it has also been used for simple TCP relays. It is recommended not to
3139 use it for more clarity, and to use the "server" directive instead.
3140
3141 See also : "server"
3142
Olivier Houchard4e694042017-03-14 20:01:29 +01003143
3144dynamic-cookie-key <string>
3145 Set the dynamic cookie secret key for a backend.
3146 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3147 yes | no | yes | yes
3148 Arguments : The secret key to be used.
3149
3150 When dynamic cookies are enabled (see the "dynamic" directive for cookie),
3151 a dynamic cookie is created for each server (unless one is explicitely
3152 specified on the "server" line), using a hash of the IP address of the
3153 server, the TCP port, and the secret key.
3154 That way, we can ensure session persistence accross multiple load-balancers,
3155 even if servers are dynamically added or removed.
Willy Tarreau5ce94572010-06-07 14:35:41 +02003156
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003157enabled
3158 Enable a proxy, frontend or backend.
3159 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3160 yes | yes | yes | yes
3161 Arguments : none
3162
3163 The "enabled" keyword is used to explicitly enable an instance, when the
3164 defaults has been set to "disabled". This is very rarely used.
3165
3166 See also : "disabled"
3167
3168
3169errorfile <code> <file>
3170 Return a file contents instead of errors generated by HAProxy
3171 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3172 yes | yes | yes | yes
3173 Arguments :
3174 <code> is the HTTP status code. Currently, HAProxy is capable of
Olivier Houchard51a76d82017-10-02 16:12:07 +02003175 generating codes 200, 400, 403, 405, 408, 425, 429, 500, 502,
3176 503, and 504.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003177
3178 <file> designates a file containing the full HTTP response. It is
Willy Tarreaud2a4aa22008-01-31 15:28:22 +01003179 recommended to follow the common practice of appending ".http" to
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003180 the filename so that people do not confuse the response with HTML
Willy Tarreau59140a22009-02-22 12:02:30 +01003181 error pages, and to use absolute paths, since files are read
3182 before any chroot is performed.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003183
3184 It is important to understand that this keyword is not meant to rewrite
3185 errors returned by the server, but errors detected and returned by HAProxy.
3186 This is why the list of supported errors is limited to a small set.
3187
Willy Tarreauae94d4d2011-05-11 16:28:49 +02003188 Code 200 is emitted in response to requests matching a "monitor-uri" rule.
3189
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003190 The files are returned verbatim on the TCP socket. This allows any trick such
3191 as redirections to another URL or site, as well as tricks to clean cookies,
3192 force enable or disable caching, etc... The package provides default error
3193 files returning the same contents as default errors.
3194
Willy Tarreau59140a22009-02-22 12:02:30 +01003195 The files should not exceed the configured buffer size (BUFSIZE), which
3196 generally is 8 or 16 kB, otherwise they will be truncated. It is also wise
3197 not to put any reference to local contents (eg: images) in order to avoid
3198 loops between the client and HAProxy when all servers are down, causing an
3199 error to be returned instead of an image. For better HTTP compliance, it is
3200 recommended that all header lines end with CR-LF and not LF alone.
3201
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003202 The files are read at the same time as the configuration and kept in memory.
3203 For this reason, the errors continue to be returned even when the process is
3204 chrooted, and no file change is considered while the process is running. A
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01003205 simple method for developing those files consists in associating them to the
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003206 403 status code and interrogating a blocked URL.
3207
3208 See also : "errorloc", "errorloc302", "errorloc303"
3209
Willy Tarreau59140a22009-02-22 12:02:30 +01003210 Example :
3211 errorfile 400 /etc/haproxy/errorfiles/400badreq.http
Willy Tarreau989222a2016-01-15 10:26:26 +01003212 errorfile 408 /dev/null # work around Chrome pre-connect bug
Willy Tarreau59140a22009-02-22 12:02:30 +01003213 errorfile 403 /etc/haproxy/errorfiles/403forbid.http
3214 errorfile 503 /etc/haproxy/errorfiles/503sorry.http
3215
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01003216
3217errorloc <code> <url>
3218errorloc302 <code> <url>
3219 Return an HTTP redirection to a URL instead of errors generated by HAProxy
3220 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3221 yes | yes | yes | yes
3222 Arguments :
3223 <code> is the HTTP status code. Currently, HAProxy is capable of
Olivier Houchard51a76d82017-10-02 16:12:07 +02003224 generating codes 200, 400, 403, 405, 408, 425, 429, 500, 502,
3225 503, and 504.
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01003226
3227 <url> it is the exact contents of the "Location" header. It may contain
3228 either a relative URI to an error page hosted on the same site,
3229 or an absolute URI designating an error page on another site.
3230 Special care should be given to relative URIs to avoid redirect
3231 loops if the URI itself may generate the same error (eg: 500).
3232
3233 It is important to understand that this keyword is not meant to rewrite
3234 errors returned by the server, but errors detected and returned by HAProxy.
3235 This is why the list of supported errors is limited to a small set.
3236
Willy Tarreauae94d4d2011-05-11 16:28:49 +02003237 Code 200 is emitted in response to requests matching a "monitor-uri" rule.
3238
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01003239 Note that both keyword return the HTTP 302 status code, which tells the
3240 client to fetch the designated URL using the same HTTP method. This can be
3241 quite problematic in case of non-GET methods such as POST, because the URL
3242 sent to the client might not be allowed for something other than GET. To
Willy Tarreau989222a2016-01-15 10:26:26 +01003243 work around this problem, please use "errorloc303" which send the HTTP 303
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01003244 status code, indicating to the client that the URL must be fetched with a GET
3245 request.
3246
3247 See also : "errorfile", "errorloc303"
3248
3249
3250errorloc303 <code> <url>
3251 Return an HTTP redirection to a URL instead of errors generated by HAProxy
3252 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3253 yes | yes | yes | yes
3254 Arguments :
3255 <code> is the HTTP status code. Currently, HAProxy is capable of
Olivier Houchard51a76d82017-10-02 16:12:07 +02003256 generating codes 200, 400, 403, 405, 408, 425, 429, 500, 502,
3257 503, and 504.
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01003258
3259 <url> it is the exact contents of the "Location" header. It may contain
3260 either a relative URI to an error page hosted on the same site,
3261 or an absolute URI designating an error page on another site.
3262 Special care should be given to relative URIs to avoid redirect
3263 loops if the URI itself may generate the same error (eg: 500).
3264
3265 It is important to understand that this keyword is not meant to rewrite
3266 errors returned by the server, but errors detected and returned by HAProxy.
3267 This is why the list of supported errors is limited to a small set.
3268
Willy Tarreauae94d4d2011-05-11 16:28:49 +02003269 Code 200 is emitted in response to requests matching a "monitor-uri" rule.
3270
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01003271 Note that both keyword return the HTTP 303 status code, which tells the
3272 client to fetch the designated URL using the same HTTP GET method. This
3273 solves the usual problems associated with "errorloc" and the 302 code. It is
3274 possible that some very old browsers designed before HTTP/1.1 do not support
Willy Tarreaud2a4aa22008-01-31 15:28:22 +01003275 it, but no such problem has been reported till now.
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01003276
3277 See also : "errorfile", "errorloc", "errorloc302"
3278
3279
Simon Horman51a1cf62015-02-03 13:00:44 +09003280email-alert from <emailaddr>
3281 Declare the from email address to be used in both the envelope and header
3282 of email alerts. This is the address that email alerts are sent from.
3283 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3284 yes | yes | yes | yes
3285
3286 Arguments :
3287
3288 <emailaddr> is the from email address to use when sending email alerts
3289
3290 Also requires "email-alert mailers" and "email-alert to" to be set
3291 and if so sending email alerts is enabled for the proxy.
3292
Simon Horman64e34162015-02-06 11:11:57 +09003293 See also : "email-alert level", "email-alert mailers",
Cyril Bonté307ee1e2015-09-28 23:16:06 +02003294 "email-alert myhostname", "email-alert to", section 3.6 about
3295 mailers.
Simon Horman64e34162015-02-06 11:11:57 +09003296
3297
3298email-alert level <level>
3299 Declare the maximum log level of messages for which email alerts will be
3300 sent. This acts as a filter on the sending of email alerts.
3301 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3302 yes | yes | yes | yes
3303
3304 Arguments :
3305
3306 <level> One of the 8 syslog levels:
3307 emerg alert crit err warning notice info debug
3308 The above syslog levels are ordered from lowest to highest.
3309
3310 By default level is alert
3311
3312 Also requires "email-alert from", "email-alert mailers" and
3313 "email-alert to" to be set and if so sending email alerts is enabled
3314 for the proxy.
3315
Simon Horman1421e212015-04-30 13:10:35 +09003316 Alerts are sent when :
3317
3318 * An un-paused server is marked as down and <level> is alert or lower
3319 * A paused server is marked as down and <level> is notice or lower
3320 * A server is marked as up or enters the drain state and <level>
3321 is notice or lower
3322 * "option log-health-checks" is enabled, <level> is info or lower,
3323 and a health check status update occurs
3324
Simon Horman64e34162015-02-06 11:11:57 +09003325 See also : "email-alert from", "email-alert mailers",
3326 "email-alert myhostname", "email-alert to",
Simon Horman51a1cf62015-02-03 13:00:44 +09003327 section 3.6 about mailers.
3328
3329
3330email-alert mailers <mailersect>
3331 Declare the mailers to be used when sending email alerts
3332 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3333 yes | yes | yes | yes
3334
3335 Arguments :
3336
3337 <mailersect> is the name of the mailers section to send email alerts.
3338
3339 Also requires "email-alert from" and "email-alert to" to be set
3340 and if so sending email alerts is enabled for the proxy.
3341
Simon Horman64e34162015-02-06 11:11:57 +09003342 See also : "email-alert from", "email-alert level", "email-alert myhostname",
3343 "email-alert to", section 3.6 about mailers.
Simon Horman51a1cf62015-02-03 13:00:44 +09003344
3345
3346email-alert myhostname <hostname>
3347 Declare the to hostname address to be used when communicating with
3348 mailers.
3349 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3350 yes | yes | yes | yes
3351
3352 Arguments :
3353
Baptiste Assmann738bad92015-12-21 15:27:53 +01003354 <hostname> is the hostname to use when communicating with mailers
Simon Horman51a1cf62015-02-03 13:00:44 +09003355
3356 By default the systems hostname is used.
3357
3358 Also requires "email-alert from", "email-alert mailers" and
3359 "email-alert to" to be set and if so sending email alerts is enabled
3360 for the proxy.
3361
Simon Horman64e34162015-02-06 11:11:57 +09003362 See also : "email-alert from", "email-alert level", "email-alert mailers",
3363 "email-alert to", section 3.6 about mailers.
Simon Horman51a1cf62015-02-03 13:00:44 +09003364
3365
3366email-alert to <emailaddr>
3367 Declare both the recipent address in the envelope and to address in the
3368 header of email alerts. This is the address that email alerts are sent to.
3369 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3370 yes | yes | yes | yes
3371
3372 Arguments :
3373
3374 <emailaddr> is the to email address to use when sending email alerts
3375
3376 Also requires "email-alert mailers" and "email-alert to" to be set
3377 and if so sending email alerts is enabled for the proxy.
3378
Simon Horman64e34162015-02-06 11:11:57 +09003379 See also : "email-alert from", "email-alert level", "email-alert mailers",
Simon Horman51a1cf62015-02-03 13:00:44 +09003380 "email-alert myhostname", section 3.6 about mailers.
3381
3382
Willy Tarreau4de91492010-01-22 19:10:05 +01003383force-persist { if | unless } <condition>
3384 Declare a condition to force persistence on down servers
3385 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3386 no | yes | yes | yes
3387
3388 By default, requests are not dispatched to down servers. It is possible to
3389 force this using "option persist", but it is unconditional and redispatches
3390 to a valid server if "option redispatch" is set. That leaves with very little
3391 possibilities to force some requests to reach a server which is artificially
3392 marked down for maintenance operations.
3393
3394 The "force-persist" statement allows one to declare various ACL-based
3395 conditions which, when met, will cause a request to ignore the down status of
3396 a server and still try to connect to it. That makes it possible to start a
3397 server, still replying an error to the health checks, and run a specially
3398 configured browser to test the service. Among the handy methods, one could
3399 use a specific source IP address, or a specific cookie. The cookie also has
3400 the advantage that it can easily be added/removed on the browser from a test
3401 page. Once the service is validated, it is then possible to open the service
3402 to the world by returning a valid response to health checks.
3403
3404 The forced persistence is enabled when an "if" condition is met, or unless an
3405 "unless" condition is met. The final redispatch is always disabled when this
3406 is used.
3407
Cyril Bonté0d4bf012010-04-25 23:21:46 +02003408 See also : "option redispatch", "ignore-persist", "persist",
Cyril Bontéa8e7bbc2010-04-25 22:29:29 +02003409 and section 7 about ACL usage.
Willy Tarreau4de91492010-01-22 19:10:05 +01003410
Christopher Fauletc3fe5332016-04-07 15:30:10 +02003411
3412filter <name> [param*]
3413 Add the filter <name> in the filter list attached to the proxy.
3414 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3415 no | yes | yes | yes
3416 Arguments :
3417 <name> is the name of the filter. Officially supported filters are
3418 referenced in section 9.
3419
Tim Düsterhus4896c442016-11-29 02:15:19 +01003420 <param*> is a list of parameters accepted by the filter <name>. The
Christopher Fauletc3fe5332016-04-07 15:30:10 +02003421 parsing of these parameters are the responsibility of the
Tim Düsterhus4896c442016-11-29 02:15:19 +01003422 filter. Please refer to the documentation of the corresponding
3423 filter (section 9) for all details on the supported parameters.
Christopher Fauletc3fe5332016-04-07 15:30:10 +02003424
3425 Multiple occurrences of the filter line can be used for the same proxy. The
3426 same filter can be referenced many times if needed.
3427
3428 Example:
3429 listen
3430 bind *:80
3431
3432 filter trace name BEFORE-HTTP-COMP
3433 filter compression
3434 filter trace name AFTER-HTTP-COMP
3435
3436 compression algo gzip
3437 compression offload
3438
3439 server srv1 192.168.0.1:80
3440
3441 See also : section 9.
3442
Willy Tarreau4de91492010-01-22 19:10:05 +01003443
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01003444fullconn <conns>
3445 Specify at what backend load the servers will reach their maxconn
3446 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3447 yes | no | yes | yes
3448 Arguments :
3449 <conns> is the number of connections on the backend which will make the
3450 servers use the maximal number of connections.
3451
Willy Tarreau198a7442008-01-17 12:05:32 +01003452 When a server has a "maxconn" parameter specified, it means that its number
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01003453 of concurrent connections will never go higher. Additionally, if it has a
Willy Tarreau198a7442008-01-17 12:05:32 +01003454 "minconn" parameter, it indicates a dynamic limit following the backend's
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01003455 load. The server will then always accept at least <minconn> connections,
3456 never more than <maxconn>, and the limit will be on the ramp between both
3457 values when the backend has less than <conns> concurrent connections. This
3458 makes it possible to limit the load on the servers during normal loads, but
3459 push it further for important loads without overloading the servers during
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01003460 exceptional loads.
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01003461
Willy Tarreaufbb78422011-06-05 15:38:35 +02003462 Since it's hard to get this value right, haproxy automatically sets it to
3463 10% of the sum of the maxconns of all frontends that may branch to this
Bertrand Jacquin702d44f2013-11-19 11:43:06 +01003464 backend (based on "use_backend" and "default_backend" rules). That way it's
3465 safe to leave it unset. However, "use_backend" involving dynamic names are
3466 not counted since there is no way to know if they could match or not.
Willy Tarreaufbb78422011-06-05 15:38:35 +02003467
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01003468 Example :
3469 # The servers will accept between 100 and 1000 concurrent connections each
3470 # and the maximum of 1000 will be reached when the backend reaches 10000
3471 # connections.
3472 backend dynamic
3473 fullconn 10000
3474 server srv1 dyn1:80 minconn 100 maxconn 1000
3475 server srv2 dyn2:80 minconn 100 maxconn 1000
3476
3477 See also : "maxconn", "server"
3478
3479
3480grace <time>
3481 Maintain a proxy operational for some time after a soft stop
3482 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Cyril Bonté99ed3272010-01-24 23:29:44 +01003483 yes | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01003484 Arguments :
3485 <time> is the time (by default in milliseconds) for which the instance
3486 will remain operational with the frontend sockets still listening
3487 when a soft-stop is received via the SIGUSR1 signal.
3488
3489 This may be used to ensure that the services disappear in a certain order.
3490 This was designed so that frontends which are dedicated to monitoring by an
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01003491 external equipment fail immediately while other ones remain up for the time
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01003492 needed by the equipment to detect the failure.
3493
3494 Note that currently, there is very little benefit in using this parameter,
3495 and it may in fact complicate the soft-reconfiguration process more than
3496 simplify it.
3497
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003498
Andrew Rodland17be45e2016-10-25 17:04:12 -04003499hash-balance-factor <factor>
3500 Specify the balancing factor for bounded-load consistent hashing
3501 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3502 yes | no | no | yes
3503 Arguments :
3504 <factor> is the control for the maximum number of concurrent requests to
3505 send to a server, expressed as a percentage of the average number
3506 of concurrent requests across all of the active servers.
3507
3508 Specifying a "hash-balance-factor" for a server with "hash-type consistent"
3509 enables an algorithm that prevents any one server from getting too many
3510 requests at once, even if some hash buckets receive many more requests than
3511 others. Setting <factor> to 0 (the default) disables the feature. Otherwise,
3512 <factor> is a percentage greater than 100. For example, if <factor> is 150,
3513 then no server will be allowed to have a load more than 1.5 times the average.
3514 If server weights are used, they will be respected.
3515
3516 If the first-choice server is disqualified, the algorithm will choose another
3517 server based on the request hash, until a server with additional capacity is
3518 found. A higher <factor> allows more imbalance between the servers, while a
3519 lower <factor> means that more servers will be checked on average, affecting
3520 performance. Reasonable values are from 125 to 200.
3521
3522 See also : "balance" and "hash-type".
3523
3524
Bhaskar Maddalab6c0ac92013-11-05 11:54:02 -05003525hash-type <method> <function> <modifier>
Willy Tarreau6b2e11b2009-10-01 07:52:15 +02003526 Specify a method to use for mapping hashes to servers
3527 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3528 yes | no | yes | yes
3529 Arguments :
Bhaskar98634f02013-10-29 23:30:51 -04003530 <method> is the method used to select a server from the hash computed by
3531 the <function> :
Willy Tarreau6b2e11b2009-10-01 07:52:15 +02003532
Bhaskar98634f02013-10-29 23:30:51 -04003533 map-based the hash table is a static array containing all alive servers.
3534 The hashes will be very smooth, will consider weights, but
3535 will be static in that weight changes while a server is up
3536 will be ignored. This means that there will be no slow start.
3537 Also, since a server is selected by its position in the array,
3538 most mappings are changed when the server count changes. This
3539 means that when a server goes up or down, or when a server is
3540 added to a farm, most connections will be redistributed to
3541 different servers. This can be inconvenient with caches for
3542 instance.
Willy Tarreau798a39c2010-11-24 15:04:29 +01003543
Bhaskar98634f02013-10-29 23:30:51 -04003544 consistent the hash table is a tree filled with many occurrences of each
3545 server. The hash key is looked up in the tree and the closest
3546 server is chosen. This hash is dynamic, it supports changing
3547 weights while the servers are up, so it is compatible with the
3548 slow start feature. It has the advantage that when a server
3549 goes up or down, only its associations are moved. When a
3550 server is added to the farm, only a few part of the mappings
3551 are redistributed, making it an ideal method for caches.
3552 However, due to its principle, the distribution will never be
3553 very smooth and it may sometimes be necessary to adjust a
3554 server's weight or its ID to get a more balanced distribution.
3555 In order to get the same distribution on multiple load
3556 balancers, it is important that all servers have the exact
Bhaskar Maddalab6c0ac92013-11-05 11:54:02 -05003557 same IDs. Note: consistent hash uses sdbm and avalanche if no
3558 hash function is specified.
Bhaskar98634f02013-10-29 23:30:51 -04003559
3560 <function> is the hash function to be used :
3561
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03003562 sdbm this function was created initially for sdbm (a public-domain
Bhaskar98634f02013-10-29 23:30:51 -04003563 reimplementation of ndbm) database library. It was found to do
3564 well in scrambling bits, causing better distribution of the keys
3565 and fewer splits. It also happens to be a good general hashing
Bhaskar Maddalab6c0ac92013-11-05 11:54:02 -05003566 function with good distribution, unless the total server weight
3567 is a multiple of 64, in which case applying the avalanche
3568 modifier may help.
Bhaskar98634f02013-10-29 23:30:51 -04003569
3570 djb2 this function was first proposed by Dan Bernstein many years ago
3571 on comp.lang.c. Studies have shown that for certain workload this
Bhaskar Maddalab6c0ac92013-11-05 11:54:02 -05003572 function provides a better distribution than sdbm. It generally
3573 works well with text-based inputs though it can perform extremely
3574 poorly with numeric-only input or when the total server weight is
3575 a multiple of 33, unless the avalanche modifier is also used.
3576
Willy Tarreaua0f42712013-11-14 14:30:35 +01003577 wt6 this function was designed for haproxy while testing other
3578 functions in the past. It is not as smooth as the other ones, but
3579 is much less sensible to the input data set or to the number of
3580 servers. It can make sense as an alternative to sdbm+avalanche or
3581 djb2+avalanche for consistent hashing or when hashing on numeric
3582 data such as a source IP address or a visitor identifier in a URL
3583 parameter.
3584
Willy Tarreau324f07f2015-01-20 19:44:50 +01003585 crc32 this is the most common CRC32 implementation as used in Ethernet,
3586 gzip, PNG, etc. It is slower than the other ones but may provide
3587 a better distribution or less predictable results especially when
3588 used on strings.
3589
Bhaskar Maddalab6c0ac92013-11-05 11:54:02 -05003590 <modifier> indicates an optional method applied after hashing the key :
3591
3592 avalanche This directive indicates that the result from the hash
3593 function above should not be used in its raw form but that
3594 a 4-byte full avalanche hash must be applied first. The
3595 purpose of this step is to mix the resulting bits from the
3596 previous hash in order to avoid any undesired effect when
3597 the input contains some limited values or when the number of
3598 servers is a multiple of one of the hash's components (64
3599 for SDBM, 33 for DJB2). Enabling avalanche tends to make the
3600 result less predictable, but it's also not as smooth as when
3601 using the original function. Some testing might be needed
3602 with some workloads. This hash is one of the many proposed
3603 by Bob Jenkins.
Willy Tarreau6b2e11b2009-10-01 07:52:15 +02003604
Bhaskar98634f02013-10-29 23:30:51 -04003605 The default hash type is "map-based" and is recommended for most usages. The
3606 default function is "sdbm", the selection of a function should be based on
3607 the range of the values being hashed.
Willy Tarreau6b2e11b2009-10-01 07:52:15 +02003608
Andrew Rodland17be45e2016-10-25 17:04:12 -04003609 See also : "balance", "hash-balance-factor", "server"
Willy Tarreau6b2e11b2009-10-01 07:52:15 +02003610
3611
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003612http-check disable-on-404
3613 Enable a maintenance mode upon HTTP/404 response to health-checks
3614 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01003615 yes | no | yes | yes
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003616 Arguments : none
3617
3618 When this option is set, a server which returns an HTTP code 404 will be
3619 excluded from further load-balancing, but will still receive persistent
3620 connections. This provides a very convenient method for Web administrators
3621 to perform a graceful shutdown of their servers. It is also important to note
3622 that a server which is detected as failed while it was in this mode will not
3623 generate an alert, just a notice. If the server responds 2xx or 3xx again, it
3624 will immediately be reinserted into the farm. The status on the stats page
3625 reports "NOLB" for a server in this mode. It is important to note that this
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01003626 option only works in conjunction with the "httpchk" option. If this option
3627 is used with "http-check expect", then it has precedence over it so that 404
3628 responses will still be considered as soft-stop.
3629
3630 See also : "option httpchk", "http-check expect"
3631
3632
3633http-check expect [!] <match> <pattern>
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -04003634 Make HTTP health checks consider response contents or specific status codes
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01003635 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreau1ee51a62011-08-19 20:04:17 +02003636 yes | no | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01003637 Arguments :
3638 <match> is a keyword indicating how to look for a specific pattern in the
3639 response. The keyword may be one of "status", "rstatus",
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -04003640 "string", or "rstring". The keyword may be preceded by an
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01003641 exclamation mark ("!") to negate the match. Spaces are allowed
3642 between the exclamation mark and the keyword. See below for more
3643 details on the supported keywords.
3644
3645 <pattern> is the pattern to look for. It may be a string or a regular
3646 expression. If the pattern contains spaces, they must be escaped
3647 with the usual backslash ('\').
3648
3649 By default, "option httpchk" considers that response statuses 2xx and 3xx
3650 are valid, and that others are invalid. When "http-check expect" is used,
3651 it defines what is considered valid or invalid. Only one "http-check"
3652 statement is supported in a backend. If a server fails to respond or times
3653 out, the check obviously fails. The available matches are :
3654
3655 status <string> : test the exact string match for the HTTP status code.
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -04003656 A health check response will be considered valid if the
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01003657 response's status code is exactly this string. If the
3658 "status" keyword is prefixed with "!", then the response
3659 will be considered invalid if the status code matches.
3660
3661 rstatus <regex> : test a regular expression for the HTTP status code.
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -04003662 A health check response will be considered valid if the
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01003663 response's status code matches the expression. If the
3664 "rstatus" keyword is prefixed with "!", then the response
3665 will be considered invalid if the status code matches.
3666 This is mostly used to check for multiple codes.
3667
3668 string <string> : test the exact string match in the HTTP response body.
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -04003669 A health check response will be considered valid if the
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01003670 response's body contains this exact string. If the
3671 "string" keyword is prefixed with "!", then the response
3672 will be considered invalid if the body contains this
3673 string. This can be used to look for a mandatory word at
3674 the end of a dynamic page, or to detect a failure when a
3675 specific error appears on the check page (eg: a stack
3676 trace).
3677
3678 rstring <regex> : test a regular expression on the HTTP response body.
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -04003679 A health check response will be considered valid if the
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01003680 response's body matches this expression. If the "rstring"
3681 keyword is prefixed with "!", then the response will be
3682 considered invalid if the body matches the expression.
3683 This can be used to look for a mandatory word at the end
3684 of a dynamic page, or to detect a failure when a specific
3685 error appears on the check page (eg: a stack trace).
3686
3687 It is important to note that the responses will be limited to a certain size
3688 defined by the global "tune.chksize" option, which defaults to 16384 bytes.
3689 Thus, too large responses may not contain the mandatory pattern when using
3690 "string" or "rstring". If a large response is absolutely required, it is
3691 possible to change the default max size by setting the global variable.
3692 However, it is worth keeping in mind that parsing very large responses can
3693 waste some CPU cycles, especially when regular expressions are used, and that
3694 it is always better to focus the checks on smaller resources.
3695
Cyril Bonté32602d22015-01-30 00:07:07 +01003696 Also "http-check expect" doesn't support HTTP keep-alive. Keep in mind that it
3697 will automatically append a "Connection: close" header, meaning that this
3698 header should not be present in the request provided by "option httpchk".
3699
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01003700 Last, if "http-check expect" is combined with "http-check disable-on-404",
3701 then this last one has precedence when the server responds with 404.
3702
3703 Examples :
3704 # only accept status 200 as valid
Willy Tarreau8f2a1e72011-01-06 16:36:10 +01003705 http-check expect status 200
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01003706
3707 # consider SQL errors as errors
Willy Tarreau8f2a1e72011-01-06 16:36:10 +01003708 http-check expect ! string SQL\ Error
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01003709
3710 # consider status 5xx only as errors
Willy Tarreau8f2a1e72011-01-06 16:36:10 +01003711 http-check expect ! rstatus ^5
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01003712
3713 # check that we have a correct hexadecimal tag before /html
Jarno Huuskonene5ae7022017-04-03 14:36:21 +03003714 http-check expect rstring <!--tag:[0-9a-f]*--></html>
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003715
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01003716 See also : "option httpchk", "http-check disable-on-404"
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01003717
3718
Willy Tarreauef781042010-01-27 11:53:01 +01003719http-check send-state
3720 Enable emission of a state header with HTTP health checks
3721 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3722 yes | no | yes | yes
3723 Arguments : none
3724
3725 When this option is set, haproxy will systematically send a special header
3726 "X-Haproxy-Server-State" with a list of parameters indicating to each server
3727 how they are seen by haproxy. This can be used for instance when a server is
3728 manipulated without access to haproxy and the operator needs to know whether
3729 haproxy still sees it up or not, or if the server is the last one in a farm.
3730
3731 The header is composed of fields delimited by semi-colons, the first of which
3732 is a word ("UP", "DOWN", "NOLB"), possibly followed by a number of valid
3733 checks on the total number before transition, just as appears in the stats
3734 interface. Next headers are in the form "<variable>=<value>", indicating in
3735 no specific order some values available in the stats interface :
Joseph Lynch514061c2015-01-15 17:52:59 -08003736 - a variable "address", containing the address of the backend server.
3737 This corresponds to the <address> field in the server declaration. For
3738 unix domain sockets, it will read "unix".
3739
3740 - a variable "port", containing the port of the backend server. This
3741 corresponds to the <port> field in the server declaration. For unix
3742 domain sockets, it will read "unix".
3743
Willy Tarreauef781042010-01-27 11:53:01 +01003744 - a variable "name", containing the name of the backend followed by a slash
3745 ("/") then the name of the server. This can be used when a server is
3746 checked in multiple backends.
3747
3748 - a variable "node" containing the name of the haproxy node, as set in the
3749 global "node" variable, otherwise the system's hostname if unspecified.
3750
3751 - a variable "weight" indicating the weight of the server, a slash ("/")
3752 and the total weight of the farm (just counting usable servers). This
3753 helps to know if other servers are available to handle the load when this
3754 one fails.
3755
3756 - a variable "scur" indicating the current number of concurrent connections
3757 on the server, followed by a slash ("/") then the total number of
3758 connections on all servers of the same backend.
3759
3760 - a variable "qcur" indicating the current number of requests in the
3761 server's queue.
3762
3763 Example of a header received by the application server :
3764 >>> X-Haproxy-Server-State: UP 2/3; name=bck/srv2; node=lb1; weight=1/2; \
3765 scur=13/22; qcur=0
3766
3767 See also : "option httpchk", "http-check disable-on-404"
3768
Jarno Huuskonen800d1762017-03-06 14:56:36 +02003769http-request { allow | auth [realm <realm>] | redirect <rule> |
3770 tarpit [deny_status <status>] | deny [deny_status <status>] |
Willy Tarreauf4c43c12013-06-11 17:01:13 +02003771 add-header <name> <fmt> | set-header <name> <fmt> |
Thierry FOURNIER82bf70d2015-05-26 17:58:29 +02003772 capture <sample> [ len <length> | id <id> ] |
Thierry FOURNIERdad3d1d2014-04-22 18:07:25 +02003773 del-header <name> | set-nice <nice> | set-log-level <level> |
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06003774 replace-header <name> <match-regex> <replace-fmt> |
3775 replace-value <name> <match-regex> <replace-fmt> |
Willy Tarreaua0dc23f2015-01-22 20:46:11 +01003776 set-method <fmt> | set-path <fmt> | set-query <fmt> |
3777 set-uri <fmt> | set-tos <tos> | set-mark <mark> |
Baptiste Assmannfabcbe02014-04-24 22:16:59 +02003778 add-acl(<file name>) <key fmt> |
3779 del-acl(<file name>) <key fmt> |
3780 del-map(<file name>) <key fmt> |
Baptiste Assmannbb7e86a2014-09-03 18:29:47 +02003781 set-map(<file name>) <key fmt> <value fmt> |
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +02003782 set-var(<var name>) <expr> |
Christopher Faulet85d79c92016-11-09 16:54:56 +01003783 unset-var(<var name>) |
Thierry FOURNIER90da1912015-03-05 11:17:06 +01003784 { track-sc0 | track-sc1 | track-sc2 } <key> [table <table>] |
Thierry FOURNIERe0627bd2015-08-04 08:20:33 +02003785 sc-inc-gpc0(<sc-id>) |
Thierry FOURNIER236657b2015-08-19 08:25:14 +02003786 sc-set-gpt0(<sc-id>) <int> |
Willy Tarreau2d392c22015-08-24 01:43:45 +02003787 silent-drop |
Christopher Faulet76c09ef2017-09-21 11:03:52 +02003788 send-spoe-group
Baptiste Assmannfabcbe02014-04-24 22:16:59 +02003789 }
Cyril Bontéf0c60612010-02-06 14:44:47 +01003790 [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01003791 Access control for Layer 7 requests
3792
3793 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3794 no | yes | yes | yes
3795
Willy Tarreau20b0de52012-12-24 15:45:22 +01003796 The http-request statement defines a set of rules which apply to layer 7
3797 processing. The rules are evaluated in their declaration order when they are
3798 met in a frontend, listen or backend section. Any rule may optionally be
3799 followed by an ACL-based condition, in which case it will only be evaluated
3800 if the condition is true.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01003801
Willy Tarreau20b0de52012-12-24 15:45:22 +01003802 The first keyword is the rule's action. Currently supported actions include :
3803 - "allow" : this stops the evaluation of the rules and lets the request
3804 pass the check. No further "http-request" rules are evaluated.
3805
3806 - "deny" : this stops the evaluation of the rules and immediately rejects
Willy Tarreaube1d34d2016-06-26 19:37:59 +02003807 the request and emits an HTTP 403 error, or optionally the status code
3808 specified as an argument to "deny_status". The list of permitted status
3809 codes is limited to those that can be overridden by the "errorfile"
3810 directive. No further "http-request" rules are evaluated.
Willy Tarreau20b0de52012-12-24 15:45:22 +01003811
Willy Tarreauccbcc372012-12-27 12:37:57 +01003812 - "tarpit" : this stops the evaluation of the rules and immediately blocks
3813 the request without responding for a delay specified by "timeout tarpit"
3814 or "timeout connect" if the former is not set. After that delay, if the
Jarno Huuskonen800d1762017-03-06 14:56:36 +02003815 client is still connected, an HTTP error 500 (or optionally the status
3816 code specified as an argument to "deny_status") is returned so that the
Willy Tarreauccbcc372012-12-27 12:37:57 +01003817 client does not suspect it has been tarpitted. Logs will report the flags
3818 "PT". The goal of the tarpit rule is to slow down robots during an attack
3819 when they're limited on the number of concurrent requests. It can be very
3820 efficient against very dumb robots, and will significantly reduce the
3821 load on firewalls compared to a "deny" rule. But when facing "correctly"
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03003822 developed robots, it can make things worse by forcing haproxy and the
Willy Tarreau2d392c22015-08-24 01:43:45 +02003823 front firewall to support insane number of concurrent connections. See
3824 also the "silent-drop" action below.
Willy Tarreauccbcc372012-12-27 12:37:57 +01003825
Willy Tarreau20b0de52012-12-24 15:45:22 +01003826 - "auth" : this stops the evaluation of the rules and immediately responds
3827 with an HTTP 401 or 407 error code to invite the user to present a valid
3828 user name and password. No further "http-request" rules are evaluated. An
3829 optional "realm" parameter is supported, it sets the authentication realm
3830 that is returned with the response (typically the application's name).
3831
Willy Tarreau81499eb2012-12-27 12:19:02 +01003832 - "redirect" : this performs an HTTP redirection based on a redirect rule.
3833 This is exactly the same as the "redirect" statement except that it
3834 inserts a redirect rule which can be processed in the middle of other
Thierry FOURNIERd18cd0f2013-11-29 12:15:45 +01003835 "http-request" rules and that these rules use the "log-format" strings.
3836 See the "redirect" keyword for the rule's syntax.
Willy Tarreau81499eb2012-12-27 12:19:02 +01003837
Willy Tarreau20b0de52012-12-24 15:45:22 +01003838 - "add-header" appends an HTTP header field whose name is specified in
3839 <name> and whose value is defined by <fmt> which follows the log-format
3840 rules (see Custom Log Format in section 8.2.4). This is particularly
3841 useful to pass connection-specific information to the server (eg: the
3842 client's SSL certificate), or to combine several headers into one. This
3843 rule is not final, so it is possible to add other similar rules. Note
3844 that header addition is performed immediately, so one rule might reuse
3845 the resulting header from a previous rule.
3846
3847 - "set-header" does the same as "add-header" except that the header name
3848 is first removed if it existed. This is useful when passing security
3849 information to the server, where the header must not be manipulated by
Willy Tarreau85603282015-01-21 20:39:27 +01003850 external users. Note that the new value is computed before the removal so
3851 it is possible to concatenate a value to an existing header.
Willy Tarreau20b0de52012-12-24 15:45:22 +01003852
Thierry FOURNIERdad3d1d2014-04-22 18:07:25 +02003853 - "del-header" removes all HTTP header fields whose name is specified in
3854 <name>.
3855
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06003856 - "replace-header" matches the regular expression in all occurrences of
3857 header field <name> according to <match-regex>, and replaces them with
3858 the <replace-fmt> argument. Format characters are allowed in replace-fmt
3859 and work like in <fmt> arguments in "add-header". The match is only
3860 case-sensitive. It is important to understand that this action only
3861 considers whole header lines, regardless of the number of values they
3862 may contain. This usage is suited to headers naturally containing commas
3863 in their value, such as If-Modified-Since and so on.
3864
3865 Example:
3866
3867 http-request replace-header Cookie foo=([^;]*);(.*) foo=\1;ip=%bi;\2
3868
3869 applied to:
3870
3871 Cookie: foo=foobar; expires=Tue, 14-Jun-2016 01:40:45 GMT;
3872
3873 outputs:
3874
3875 Cookie: foo=foobar;ip=192.168.1.20; expires=Tue, 14-Jun-2016 01:40:45 GMT;
3876
3877 assuming the backend IP is 192.168.1.20
3878
3879 - "replace-value" works like "replace-header" except that it matches the
3880 regex against every comma-delimited value of the header field <name>
3881 instead of the entire header. This is suited for all headers which are
3882 allowed to carry more than one value. An example could be the Accept
3883 header.
3884
3885 Example:
3886
3887 http-request replace-value X-Forwarded-For ^192\.168\.(.*)$ 172.16.\1
3888
3889 applied to:
3890
3891 X-Forwarded-For: 192.168.10.1, 192.168.13.24, 10.0.0.37
3892
3893 outputs:
3894
3895 X-Forwarded-For: 172.16.10.1, 172.16.13.24, 10.0.0.37
3896
Willy Tarreaua0dc23f2015-01-22 20:46:11 +01003897 - "set-method" rewrites the request method with the result of the
3898 evaluation of format string <fmt>. There should be very few valid reasons
3899 for having to do so as this is more likely to break something than to fix
3900 it.
3901
3902 - "set-path" rewrites the request path with the result of the evaluation of
3903 format string <fmt>. The query string, if any, is left intact. If a
3904 scheme and authority is found before the path, they are left intact as
3905 well. If the request doesn't have a path ("*"), this one is replaced with
3906 the format. This can be used to prepend a directory component in front of
3907 a path for example. See also "set-query" and "set-uri".
3908
3909 Example :
3910 # prepend the host name before the path
3911 http-request set-path /%[hdr(host)]%[path]
3912
3913 - "set-query" rewrites the request's query string which appears after the
3914 first question mark ("?") with the result of the evaluation of format
3915 string <fmt>. The part prior to the question mark is left intact. If the
3916 request doesn't contain a question mark and the new value is not empty,
3917 then one is added at the end of the URI, followed by the new value. If
3918 a question mark was present, it will never be removed even if the value
3919 is empty. This can be used to add or remove parameters from the query
3920 string. See also "set-query" and "set-uri".
3921
3922 Example :
3923 # replace "%3D" with "=" in the query string
3924 http-request set-query %[query,regsub(%3D,=,g)]
3925
3926 - "set-uri" rewrites the request URI with the result of the evaluation of
3927 format string <fmt>. The scheme, authority, path and query string are all
3928 replaced at once. This can be used to rewrite hosts in front of proxies,
3929 or to perform complex modifications to the URI such as moving parts
3930 between the path and the query string. See also "set-path" and
3931 "set-query".
3932
Willy Tarreauf4c43c12013-06-11 17:01:13 +02003933 - "set-nice" sets the "nice" factor of the current request being processed.
3934 It only has effect against the other requests being processed at the same
3935 time. The default value is 0, unless altered by the "nice" setting on the
3936 "bind" line. The accepted range is -1024..1024. The higher the value, the
3937 nicest the request will be. Lower values will make the request more
3938 important than other ones. This can be useful to improve the speed of
3939 some requests, or lower the priority of non-important requests. Using
3940 this setting without prior experimentation can cause some major slowdown.
3941
Willy Tarreau9a355ec2013-06-11 17:45:46 +02003942 - "set-log-level" is used to change the log level of the current request
3943 when a certain condition is met. Valid levels are the 8 syslog levels
3944 (see the "log" keyword) plus the special level "silent" which disables
3945 logging for this request. This rule is not final so the last matching
3946 rule wins. This rule can be useful to disable health checks coming from
3947 another equipment.
3948
Willy Tarreau42cf39e2013-06-11 18:51:32 +02003949 - "set-tos" is used to set the TOS or DSCP field value of packets sent to
3950 the client to the value passed in <tos> on platforms which support this.
3951 This value represents the whole 8 bits of the IP TOS field, and can be
3952 expressed both in decimal or hexadecimal format (prefixed by "0x"). Note
3953 that only the 6 higher bits are used in DSCP or TOS, and the two lower
3954 bits are always 0. This can be used to adjust some routing behaviour on
3955 border routers based on some information from the request. See RFC 2474,
3956 2597, 3260 and 4594 for more information.
3957
Willy Tarreau51347ed2013-06-11 19:34:13 +02003958 - "set-mark" is used to set the Netfilter MARK on all packets sent to the
3959 client to the value passed in <mark> on platforms which support it. This
3960 value is an unsigned 32 bit value which can be matched by netfilter and
3961 by the routing table. It can be expressed both in decimal or hexadecimal
3962 format (prefixed by "0x"). This can be useful to force certain packets to
3963 take a different route (for example a cheaper network path for bulk
3964 downloads). This works on Linux kernels 2.6.32 and above and requires
3965 admin privileges.
3966
Baptiste Assmannfabcbe02014-04-24 22:16:59 +02003967 - "add-acl" is used to add a new entry into an ACL. The ACL must be loaded
3968 from a file (even a dummy empty file). The file name of the ACL to be
3969 updated is passed between parentheses. It takes one argument: <key fmt>,
3970 which follows log-format rules, to collect content of the new entry. It
3971 performs a lookup in the ACL before insertion, to avoid duplicated (or
3972 more) values. This lookup is done by a linear search and can be expensive
3973 with large lists! It is the equivalent of the "add acl" command from the
3974 stats socket, but can be triggered by an HTTP request.
3975
3976 - "del-acl" is used to delete an entry from an ACL. The ACL must be loaded
3977 from a file (even a dummy empty file). The file name of the ACL to be
3978 updated is passed between parentheses. It takes one argument: <key fmt>,
3979 which follows log-format rules, to collect content of the entry to delete.
3980 It is the equivalent of the "del acl" command from the stats socket, but
3981 can be triggered by an HTTP request.
3982
3983 - "del-map" is used to delete an entry from a MAP. The MAP must be loaded
3984 from a file (even a dummy empty file). The file name of the MAP to be
3985 updated is passed between parentheses. It takes one argument: <key fmt>,
3986 which follows log-format rules, to collect content of the entry to delete.
3987 It takes one argument: "file name" It is the equivalent of the "del map"
3988 command from the stats socket, but can be triggered by an HTTP request.
3989
3990 - "set-map" is used to add a new entry into a MAP. The MAP must be loaded
3991 from a file (even a dummy empty file). The file name of the MAP to be
3992 updated is passed between parentheses. It takes 2 arguments: <key fmt>,
3993 which follows log-format rules, used to collect MAP key, and <value fmt>,
3994 which follows log-format rules, used to collect content for the new entry.
3995 It performs a lookup in the MAP before insertion, to avoid duplicated (or
3996 more) values. This lookup is done by a linear search and can be expensive
3997 with large lists! It is the equivalent of the "set map" command from the
3998 stats socket, but can be triggered by an HTTP request.
3999
Thierry FOURNIER82bf70d2015-05-26 17:58:29 +02004000 - capture <sample> [ len <length> | id <id> ] :
Willy Tarreaua9083d02015-05-08 15:27:59 +02004001 captures sample expression <sample> from the request buffer, and converts
4002 it to a string of at most <len> characters. The resulting string is
4003 stored into the next request "capture" slot, so it will possibly appear
4004 next to some captured HTTP headers. It will then automatically appear in
4005 the logs, and it will be possible to extract it using sample fetch rules
4006 to feed it into headers or anything. The length should be limited given
4007 that this size will be allocated for each capture during the whole
4008 session life. Please check section 7.3 (Fetching samples) and "capture
4009 request header" for more information.
4010
Thierry FOURNIER82bf70d2015-05-26 17:58:29 +02004011 If the keyword "id" is used instead of "len", the action tries to store
4012 the captured string in a previously declared capture slot. This is useful
4013 to run captures in backends. The slot id can be declared by a previous
4014 directive "http-request capture" or with the "declare capture" keyword.
Baptiste Assmanne9544932015-11-03 23:31:35 +01004015 If the slot <id> doesn't exist, then HAProxy fails parsing the
4016 configuration to prevent unexpected behavior at run time.
Thierry FOURNIER82bf70d2015-05-26 17:58:29 +02004017
Willy Tarreau09448f72014-06-25 18:12:15 +02004018 - { track-sc0 | track-sc1 | track-sc2 } <key> [table <table>] :
4019 enables tracking of sticky counters from current request. These rules
4020 do not stop evaluation and do not change default action. Three sets of
4021 counters may be simultaneously tracked by the same connection. The first
4022 "track-sc0" rule executed enables tracking of the counters of the
4023 specified table as the first set. The first "track-sc1" rule executed
4024 enables tracking of the counters of the specified table as the second
4025 set. The first "track-sc2" rule executed enables tracking of the
4026 counters of the specified table as the third set. It is a recommended
4027 practice to use the first set of counters for the per-frontend counters
4028 and the second set for the per-backend ones. But this is just a
4029 guideline, all may be used everywhere.
4030
4031 These actions take one or two arguments :
4032 <key> is mandatory, and is a sample expression rule as described
4033 in section 7.3. It describes what elements of the incoming
4034 request or connection will be analysed, extracted, combined,
4035 and used to select which table entry to update the counters.
4036
4037 <table> is an optional table to be used instead of the default one,
4038 which is the stick-table declared in the current proxy. All
4039 the counters for the matches and updates for the key will
4040 then be performed in that table until the session ends.
4041
4042 Once a "track-sc*" rule is executed, the key is looked up in the table
4043 and if it is not found, an entry is allocated for it. Then a pointer to
4044 that entry is kept during all the session's life, and this entry's
4045 counters are updated as often as possible, every time the session's
4046 counters are updated, and also systematically when the session ends.
4047 Counters are only updated for events that happen after the tracking has
4048 been started. As an exception, connection counters and request counters
4049 are systematically updated so that they reflect useful information.
4050
4051 If the entry tracks concurrent connection counters, one connection is
4052 counted for as long as the entry is tracked, and the entry will not
4053 expire during that time. Tracking counters also provides a performance
4054 advantage over just checking the keys, because only one table lookup is
4055 performed for all ACL checks that make use of it.
4056
Thierry FOURNIER236657b2015-08-19 08:25:14 +02004057 - sc-set-gpt0(<sc-id>) <int> :
4058 This action sets the GPT0 tag according to the sticky counter designated
4059 by <sc-id> and the value of <int>. The expected result is a boolean. If
4060 an error occurs, this action silently fails and the actions evaluation
4061 continues.
4062
Thierry FOURNIERe0627bd2015-08-04 08:20:33 +02004063 - sc-inc-gpc0(<sc-id>):
4064 This action increments the GPC0 counter according with the sticky counter
4065 designated by <sc-id>. If an error occurs, this action silently fails and
4066 the actions evaluation continues.
4067
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +02004068 - set-var(<var-name>) <expr> :
4069 Is used to set the contents of a variable. The variable is declared
4070 inline.
4071
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +01004072 <var-name> The name of the variable starts with an indication about
4073 its scope. The scopes allowed are:
Christopher Fauletff2613e2016-11-09 11:36:17 +01004074 "proc" : the variable is shared with the whole process
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +01004075 "sess" : the variable is shared with the whole session
4076 "txn" : the variable is shared with the transaction
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +02004077 (request and response)
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +01004078 "req" : the variable is shared only during request
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +02004079 processing
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +01004080 "res" : the variable is shared only during response
4081 processing
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +02004082 This prefix is followed by a name. The separator is a '.'.
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +01004083 The name may only contain characters 'a-z', 'A-Z', '0-9'
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +02004084 and '_'.
4085
4086 <expr> Is a standard HAProxy expression formed by a sample-fetch
4087 followed by some converters.
4088
4089 Example:
4090
4091 http-request set-var(req.my_var) req.fhdr(user-agent),lower
4092
Christopher Faulet85d79c92016-11-09 16:54:56 +01004093 - unset-var(<var-name>) :
4094 Is used to unset a variable. See above for details about <var-name>.
4095
4096 Example:
4097
4098 http-request unset-var(req.my_var)
4099
Adis Nezirovic2fbcafc2015-07-06 15:44:30 +02004100 - set-src <expr> :
4101 Is used to set the source IP address to the value of specified
4102 expression. Useful when a proxy in front of HAProxy rewrites source IP,
4103 but provides the correct IP in a HTTP header; or you want to mask
4104 source IP for privacy.
4105
4106 <expr> Is a standard HAProxy expression formed by a sample-fetch
4107 followed by some converters.
4108
4109 Example:
4110
4111 http-request set-src hdr(x-forwarded-for)
4112 http-request set-src src,ipmask(24)
4113
Willy Tarreau00005ce2016-10-21 15:07:45 +02004114 When possible, set-src preserves the original source port as long as the
4115 address family allows it, otherwise the source port is set to 0.
Adis Nezirovic2fbcafc2015-07-06 15:44:30 +02004116
William Lallemand44be6402016-05-25 01:51:35 +02004117 - set-src-port <expr> :
4118 Is used to set the source port address to the value of specified
4119 expression.
4120
4121 <expr> Is a standard HAProxy expression formed by a sample-fetch
4122 followed by some converters.
4123
4124 Example:
4125
4126 http-request set-src-port hdr(x-port)
4127 http-request set-src-port int(4000)
4128
Willy Tarreau00005ce2016-10-21 15:07:45 +02004129 When possible, set-src-port preserves the original source address as long
4130 as the address family supports a port, otherwise it forces the source
4131 address to IPv4 "0.0.0.0" before rewriting the port.
William Lallemand44be6402016-05-25 01:51:35 +02004132
William Lallemand13e9b0c2016-05-25 02:34:07 +02004133 - set-dst <expr> :
4134 Is used to set the destination IP address to the value of specified
4135 expression. Useful when a proxy in front of HAProxy rewrites destination
4136 IP, but provides the correct IP in a HTTP header; or you want to mask
4137 the IP for privacy. If you want to connect to the new address/port, use
4138 '0.0.0.0:0' as a server address in the backend.
4139
4140 <expr> Is a standard HAProxy expression formed by a sample-fetch
4141 followed by some converters.
4142
4143 Example:
4144
4145 http-request set-dst hdr(x-dst)
4146 http-request set-dst dst,ipmask(24)
4147
Willy Tarreau00005ce2016-10-21 15:07:45 +02004148 When possible, set-dst preserves the original destination port as long as
4149 the address family allows it, otherwise the destination port is set to 0.
4150
William Lallemand13e9b0c2016-05-25 02:34:07 +02004151 - set-dst-port <expr> :
4152 Is used to set the destination port address to the value of specified
4153 expression. If you want to connect to the new address/port, use
4154 '0.0.0.0:0' as a server address in the backend.
4155
4156 <expr> Is a standard HAProxy expression formed by a sample-fetch
4157 followed by some converters.
4158
4159 Example:
4160
4161 http-request set-dst-port hdr(x-port)
4162 http-request set-dst-port int(4000)
4163
Willy Tarreau00005ce2016-10-21 15:07:45 +02004164 When possible, set-dst-port preserves the original destination address as
4165 long as the address family supports a port, otherwise it forces the
4166 destination address to IPv4 "0.0.0.0" before rewriting the port.
4167
Willy Tarreau2d392c22015-08-24 01:43:45 +02004168 - "silent-drop" : this stops the evaluation of the rules and makes the
4169 client-facing connection suddenly disappear using a system-dependant way
4170 that tries to prevent the client from being notified. The effect it then
4171 that the client still sees an established connection while there's none
4172 on HAProxy. The purpose is to achieve a comparable effect to "tarpit"
4173 except that it doesn't use any local resource at all on the machine
4174 running HAProxy. It can resist much higher loads than "tarpit", and slow
4175 down stronger attackers. It is important to undestand the impact of using
4176 this mechanism. All stateful equipments placed between the client and
4177 HAProxy (firewalls, proxies, load balancers) will also keep the
4178 established connection for a long time and may suffer from this action.
4179 On modern Linux systems running with enough privileges, the TCP_REPAIR
4180 socket option is used to block the emission of a TCP reset. On other
4181 systems, the socket's TTL is reduced to 1 so that the TCP reset doesn't
4182 pass the first router, though it's still delivered to local networks. Do
4183 not use it unless you fully understand how it works.
4184
Christopher Faulet76c09ef2017-09-21 11:03:52 +02004185
Olivier Houchardccaa7de2017-10-02 11:51:03 +02004186 - "wait-for-handshake" : this will delay the processing of the request
4187 until the SSL handshake happened. This is mostly useful to delay
4188 processing early data until we're sure they are valid.
4189
Christopher Faulet76c09ef2017-09-21 11:03:52 +02004190 - send-spoe-group <engine-name> <group-name> :
4191 This action is used to trigger sending of a group of SPOE messages. To do
4192 so, the SPOE engine used to send messages must be defined, as well as the
4193 SPOE group to send. Of course, the SPOE engine must refer to an existing
4194 SPOE filter. If not engine name is provided on the SPOE filter line, the
4195 SPOE agent name must be used.
4196
4197 <engine-name> The SPOE engine name.
4198
4199 <group-name> The SPOE group name as specified in the engine
4200 configuration.
4201
Willy Tarreau20b0de52012-12-24 15:45:22 +01004202 There is no limit to the number of http-request statements per instance.
4203
4204 It is important to know that http-request rules are processed very early in
4205 the HTTP processing, just after "block" rules and before "reqdel" or "reqrep"
Ruoshan Huangeb5a3632015-12-08 21:00:23 +08004206 or "reqadd" rules. That way, headers added by "add-header"/"set-header" are
4207 visible by almost all further ACL rules.
4208
4209 Using "reqadd"/"reqdel"/"reqrep" to manipulate request headers is discouraged
4210 in newer versions (>= 1.5). But if you need to use regular expression to
4211 delete headers, you can still use "reqdel". Also please use
4212 "http-request deny/allow/tarpit" instead of "reqdeny"/"reqpass"/"reqtarpit".
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01004213
4214 Example:
Cyril Bonté78caf842010-03-10 22:41:43 +01004215 acl nagios src 192.168.129.3
4216 acl local_net src 192.168.0.0/16
4217 acl auth_ok http_auth(L1)
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01004218
Cyril Bonté78caf842010-03-10 22:41:43 +01004219 http-request allow if nagios
4220 http-request allow if local_net auth_ok
4221 http-request auth realm Gimme if local_net auth_ok
4222 http-request deny
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01004223
Cyril Bonté78caf842010-03-10 22:41:43 +01004224 Example:
4225 acl auth_ok http_auth_group(L1) G1
Cyril Bonté78caf842010-03-10 22:41:43 +01004226 http-request auth unless auth_ok
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01004227
Willy Tarreau20b0de52012-12-24 15:45:22 +01004228 Example:
4229 http-request set-header X-Haproxy-Current-Date %T
4230 http-request set-header X-SSL %[ssl_fc]
Willy Tarreaufca42612015-08-27 17:15:05 +02004231 http-request set-header X-SSL-Session_ID %[ssl_fc_session_id,hex]
Willy Tarreau20b0de52012-12-24 15:45:22 +01004232 http-request set-header X-SSL-Client-Verify %[ssl_c_verify]
4233 http-request set-header X-SSL-Client-DN %{+Q}[ssl_c_s_dn]
4234 http-request set-header X-SSL-Client-CN %{+Q}[ssl_c_s_dn(cn)]
4235 http-request set-header X-SSL-Issuer %{+Q}[ssl_c_i_dn]
4236 http-request set-header X-SSL-Client-NotBefore %{+Q}[ssl_c_notbefore]
4237 http-request set-header X-SSL-Client-NotAfter %{+Q}[ssl_c_notafter]
4238
Baptiste Assmannfabcbe02014-04-24 22:16:59 +02004239 Example:
4240 acl key req.hdr(X-Add-Acl-Key) -m found
4241 acl add path /addacl
4242 acl del path /delacl
4243
4244 acl myhost hdr(Host) -f myhost.lst
4245
4246 http-request add-acl(myhost.lst) %[req.hdr(X-Add-Acl-Key)] if key add
4247 http-request del-acl(myhost.lst) %[req.hdr(X-Add-Acl-Key)] if key del
4248
4249 Example:
4250 acl value req.hdr(X-Value) -m found
4251 acl setmap path /setmap
4252 acl delmap path /delmap
4253
4254 use_backend bk_appli if { hdr(Host),map_str(map.lst) -m found }
4255
4256 http-request set-map(map.lst) %[src] %[req.hdr(X-Value)] if setmap value
4257 http-request del-map(map.lst) %[src] if delmap
4258
Cyril Bonté2be1b3f2010-09-30 23:46:30 +02004259 See also : "stats http-request", section 3.4 about userlists and section 7
4260 about ACL usage.
Willy Tarreauef781042010-01-27 11:53:01 +01004261
Willy Tarreauf4c43c12013-06-11 17:01:13 +02004262http-response { allow | deny | add-header <name> <fmt> | set-nice <nice> |
Willy Tarreau51d861a2015-05-22 17:30:48 +02004263 capture <sample> id <id> | redirect <rule> |
Thierry FOURNIERdad3d1d2014-04-22 18:07:25 +02004264 set-header <name> <fmt> | del-header <name> |
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06004265 replace-header <name> <regex-match> <replace-fmt> |
4266 replace-value <name> <regex-match> <replace-fmt> |
Robin H. Johnson52f5db22017-01-01 13:10:52 -08004267 set-status <status> [reason <str>] |
Baptiste Assmannfabcbe02014-04-24 22:16:59 +02004268 set-log-level <level> | set-mark <mark> | set-tos <tos> |
4269 add-acl(<file name>) <key fmt> |
4270 del-acl(<file name>) <key fmt> |
4271 del-map(<file name>) <key fmt> |
Thierry FOURNIER90da1912015-03-05 11:17:06 +01004272 set-map(<file name>) <key fmt> <value fmt> |
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +02004273 set-var(<var-name>) <expr> |
Christopher Faulet85d79c92016-11-09 16:54:56 +01004274 unset-var(<var-name>) |
Ruoshan Huange4edc6b2016-07-14 15:07:45 +08004275 { track-sc0 | track-sc1 | track-sc2 } <key> [table <table>] |
Thierry FOURNIERe0627bd2015-08-04 08:20:33 +02004276 sc-inc-gpc0(<sc-id>) |
Thierry FOURNIER236657b2015-08-19 08:25:14 +02004277 sc-set-gpt0(<sc-id>) <int> |
Willy Tarreau2d392c22015-08-24 01:43:45 +02004278 silent-drop |
Christopher Faulet76c09ef2017-09-21 11:03:52 +02004279 send-spoe-group
Baptiste Assmannfabcbe02014-04-24 22:16:59 +02004280 }
Lukas Tribus2dd1d1a2013-06-19 23:34:41 +02004281 [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Willy Tarreaue365c0b2013-06-11 16:06:12 +02004282 Access control for Layer 7 responses
4283
4284 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4285 no | yes | yes | yes
4286
4287 The http-response statement defines a set of rules which apply to layer 7
4288 processing. The rules are evaluated in their declaration order when they are
4289 met in a frontend, listen or backend section. Any rule may optionally be
4290 followed by an ACL-based condition, in which case it will only be evaluated
4291 if the condition is true. Since these rules apply on responses, the backend
4292 rules are applied first, followed by the frontend's rules.
4293
4294 The first keyword is the rule's action. Currently supported actions include :
4295 - "allow" : this stops the evaluation of the rules and lets the response
4296 pass the check. No further "http-response" rules are evaluated for the
4297 current section.
4298
4299 - "deny" : this stops the evaluation of the rules and immediately rejects
4300 the response and emits an HTTP 502 error. No further "http-response"
4301 rules are evaluated.
4302
4303 - "add-header" appends an HTTP header field whose name is specified in
4304 <name> and whose value is defined by <fmt> which follows the log-format
4305 rules (see Custom Log Format in section 8.2.4). This may be used to send
4306 a cookie to a client for example, or to pass some internal information.
4307 This rule is not final, so it is possible to add other similar rules.
4308 Note that header addition is performed immediately, so one rule might
4309 reuse the resulting header from a previous rule.
4310
4311 - "set-header" does the same as "add-header" except that the header name
4312 is first removed if it existed. This is useful when passing security
4313 information to the server, where the header must not be manipulated by
4314 external users.
4315
Thierry FOURNIERdad3d1d2014-04-22 18:07:25 +02004316 - "del-header" removes all HTTP header fields whose name is specified in
4317 <name>.
4318
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06004319 - "replace-header" matches the regular expression in all occurrences of
4320 header field <name> according to <match-regex>, and replaces them with
4321 the <replace-fmt> argument. Format characters are allowed in replace-fmt
4322 and work like in <fmt> arguments in "add-header". The match is only
4323 case-sensitive. It is important to understand that this action only
4324 considers whole header lines, regardless of the number of values they
4325 may contain. This usage is suited to headers naturally containing commas
4326 in their value, such as Set-Cookie, Expires and so on.
4327
4328 Example:
4329
4330 http-response replace-header Set-Cookie (C=[^;]*);(.*) \1;ip=%bi;\2
4331
4332 applied to:
4333
4334 Set-Cookie: C=1; expires=Tue, 14-Jun-2016 01:40:45 GMT
4335
4336 outputs:
4337
4338 Set-Cookie: C=1;ip=192.168.1.20; expires=Tue, 14-Jun-2016 01:40:45 GMT
4339
4340 assuming the backend IP is 192.168.1.20.
4341
4342 - "replace-value" works like "replace-header" except that it matches the
4343 regex against every comma-delimited value of the header field <name>
4344 instead of the entire header. This is suited for all headers which are
4345 allowed to carry more than one value. An example could be the Accept
4346 header.
4347
4348 Example:
4349
4350 http-response replace-value Cache-control ^public$ private
4351
4352 applied to:
4353
4354 Cache-Control: max-age=3600, public
4355
4356 outputs:
4357
4358 Cache-Control: max-age=3600, private
4359
Thierry FOURNIER35d70ef2015-08-26 16:21:56 +02004360 - "set-status" replaces the response status code with <status> which must
Robin H. Johnson52f5db22017-01-01 13:10:52 -08004361 be an integer between 100 and 999. Optionally, a custom reason text can be
4362 provided defined by <str>, or the default reason for the specified code
4363 will be used as a fallback.
Thierry FOURNIER35d70ef2015-08-26 16:21:56 +02004364
4365 Example:
4366
4367 # return "431 Request Header Fields Too Large"
4368 http-response set-status 431
Robin H. Johnson52f5db22017-01-01 13:10:52 -08004369 # return "503 Slow Down", custom reason
4370 http-response set-status 503 reason "Slow Down".
Thierry FOURNIER35d70ef2015-08-26 16:21:56 +02004371
Willy Tarreauf4c43c12013-06-11 17:01:13 +02004372 - "set-nice" sets the "nice" factor of the current request being processed.
4373 It only has effect against the other requests being processed at the same
4374 time. The default value is 0, unless altered by the "nice" setting on the
4375 "bind" line. The accepted range is -1024..1024. The higher the value, the
4376 nicest the request will be. Lower values will make the request more
4377 important than other ones. This can be useful to improve the speed of
4378 some requests, or lower the priority of non-important requests. Using
4379 this setting without prior experimentation can cause some major slowdown.
4380
Willy Tarreau9a355ec2013-06-11 17:45:46 +02004381 - "set-log-level" is used to change the log level of the current request
4382 when a certain condition is met. Valid levels are the 8 syslog levels
4383 (see the "log" keyword) plus the special level "silent" which disables
4384 logging for this request. This rule is not final so the last matching
4385 rule wins. This rule can be useful to disable health checks coming from
4386 another equipment.
4387
Willy Tarreau42cf39e2013-06-11 18:51:32 +02004388 - "set-tos" is used to set the TOS or DSCP field value of packets sent to
4389 the client to the value passed in <tos> on platforms which support this.
4390 This value represents the whole 8 bits of the IP TOS field, and can be
4391 expressed both in decimal or hexadecimal format (prefixed by "0x"). Note
4392 that only the 6 higher bits are used in DSCP or TOS, and the two lower
4393 bits are always 0. This can be used to adjust some routing behaviour on
4394 border routers based on some information from the request. See RFC 2474,
4395 2597, 3260 and 4594 for more information.
4396
Willy Tarreau51347ed2013-06-11 19:34:13 +02004397 - "set-mark" is used to set the Netfilter MARK on all packets sent to the
4398 client to the value passed in <mark> on platforms which support it. This
4399 value is an unsigned 32 bit value which can be matched by netfilter and
4400 by the routing table. It can be expressed both in decimal or hexadecimal
4401 format (prefixed by "0x"). This can be useful to force certain packets to
4402 take a different route (for example a cheaper network path for bulk
4403 downloads). This works on Linux kernels 2.6.32 and above and requires
4404 admin privileges.
4405
Baptiste Assmannfabcbe02014-04-24 22:16:59 +02004406 - "add-acl" is used to add a new entry into an ACL. The ACL must be loaded
4407 from a file (even a dummy empty file). The file name of the ACL to be
4408 updated is passed between parentheses. It takes one argument: <key fmt>,
4409 which follows log-format rules, to collect content of the new entry. It
4410 performs a lookup in the ACL before insertion, to avoid duplicated (or
4411 more) values. This lookup is done by a linear search and can be expensive
4412 with large lists! It is the equivalent of the "add acl" command from the
4413 stats socket, but can be triggered by an HTTP response.
4414
4415 - "del-acl" is used to delete an entry from an ACL. The ACL must be loaded
4416 from a file (even a dummy empty file). The file name of the ACL to be
4417 updated is passed between parentheses. It takes one argument: <key fmt>,
4418 which follows log-format rules, to collect content of the entry to delete.
4419 It is the equivalent of the "del acl" command from the stats socket, but
4420 can be triggered by an HTTP response.
4421
4422 - "del-map" is used to delete an entry from a MAP. The MAP must be loaded
4423 from a file (even a dummy empty file). The file name of the MAP to be
4424 updated is passed between parentheses. It takes one argument: <key fmt>,
4425 which follows log-format rules, to collect content of the entry to delete.
4426 It takes one argument: "file name" It is the equivalent of the "del map"
4427 command from the stats socket, but can be triggered by an HTTP response.
4428
4429 - "set-map" is used to add a new entry into a MAP. The MAP must be loaded
4430 from a file (even a dummy empty file). The file name of the MAP to be
4431 updated is passed between parentheses. It takes 2 arguments: <key fmt>,
4432 which follows log-format rules, used to collect MAP key, and <value fmt>,
4433 which follows log-format rules, used to collect content for the new entry.
4434 It performs a lookup in the MAP before insertion, to avoid duplicated (or
4435 more) values. This lookup is done by a linear search and can be expensive
4436 with large lists! It is the equivalent of the "set map" command from the
4437 stats socket, but can be triggered by an HTTP response.
4438
Thierry FOURNIERe80fada2015-05-26 18:06:31 +02004439 - capture <sample> id <id> :
4440 captures sample expression <sample> from the response buffer, and converts
4441 it to a string. The resulting string is stored into the next request
4442 "capture" slot, so it will possibly appear next to some captured HTTP
4443 headers. It will then automatically appear in the logs, and it will be
4444 possible to extract it using sample fetch rules to feed it into headers or
4445 anything. Please check section 7.3 (Fetching samples) and "capture
4446 response header" for more information.
4447
4448 The keyword "id" is the id of the capture slot which is used for storing
4449 the string. The capture slot must be defined in an associated frontend.
4450 This is useful to run captures in backends. The slot id can be declared by
4451 a previous directive "http-response capture" or with the "declare capture"
4452 keyword.
Baptiste Assmanne9544932015-11-03 23:31:35 +01004453 If the slot <id> doesn't exist, then HAProxy fails parsing the
4454 configuration to prevent unexpected behavior at run time.
Thierry FOURNIERe80fada2015-05-26 18:06:31 +02004455
Willy Tarreau51d861a2015-05-22 17:30:48 +02004456 - "redirect" : this performs an HTTP redirection based on a redirect rule.
4457 This supports a format string similarly to "http-request redirect" rules,
4458 with the exception that only the "location" type of redirect is possible
4459 on the response. See the "redirect" keyword for the rule's syntax. When
4460 a redirect rule is applied during a response, connections to the server
4461 are closed so that no data can be forwarded from the server to the client.
4462
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +02004463 - set-var(<var-name>) expr:
4464 Is used to set the contents of a variable. The variable is declared
4465 inline.
4466
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +01004467 <var-name> The name of the variable starts with an indication about
4468 its scope. The scopes allowed are:
Christopher Fauletff2613e2016-11-09 11:36:17 +01004469 "proc" : the variable is shared with the whole process
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +01004470 "sess" : the variable is shared with the whole session
4471 "txn" : the variable is shared with the transaction
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +02004472 (request and response)
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +01004473 "req" : the variable is shared only during request
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +02004474 processing
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +01004475 "res" : the variable is shared only during response
4476 processing
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +02004477 This prefix is followed by a name. The separator is a '.'.
Christopher Fauletb71557a2016-10-31 10:49:03 +01004478 The name may only contain characters 'a-z', 'A-Z', '0-9',
4479 '.' and '_'.
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +02004480
4481 <expr> Is a standard HAProxy expression formed by a sample-fetch
4482 followed by some converters.
4483
4484 Example:
4485
4486 http-response set-var(sess.last_redir) res.hdr(location)
4487
Christopher Faulet85d79c92016-11-09 16:54:56 +01004488 - unset-var(<var-name>) :
4489 Is used to unset a variable. See above for details about <var-name>.
4490
4491 Example:
4492
4493 http-response unset-var(sess.last_redir)
4494
Ruoshan Huange4edc6b2016-07-14 15:07:45 +08004495 - { track-sc0 | track-sc1 | track-sc2 } <key> [table <table>] :
4496 enables tracking of sticky counters from current response. Please refer to
4497 "http-request track-sc" for a complete description. The only difference
4498 from "http-request track-sc" is the <key> sample expression can only make
4499 use of samples in response (eg. res.*, status etc.) and samples below
4500 Layer 6 (eg. ssl related samples, see section 7.3.4). If the sample is
4501 not supported, haproxy will fail and warn while parsing the config.
4502
Thierry FOURNIER236657b2015-08-19 08:25:14 +02004503 - sc-set-gpt0(<sc-id>) <int> :
4504 This action sets the GPT0 tag according to the sticky counter designated
4505 by <sc-id> and the value of <int>. The expected result is a boolean. If
4506 an error occurs, this action silently fails and the actions evaluation
4507 continues.
4508
Thierry FOURNIERe0627bd2015-08-04 08:20:33 +02004509 - sc-inc-gpc0(<sc-id>):
4510 This action increments the GPC0 counter according with the sticky counter
4511 designated by <sc-id>. If an error occurs, this action silently fails and
4512 the actions evaluation continues.
4513
Willy Tarreau2d392c22015-08-24 01:43:45 +02004514 - "silent-drop" : this stops the evaluation of the rules and makes the
4515 client-facing connection suddenly disappear using a system-dependant way
4516 that tries to prevent the client from being notified. The effect it then
4517 that the client still sees an established connection while there's none
4518 on HAProxy. The purpose is to achieve a comparable effect to "tarpit"
4519 except that it doesn't use any local resource at all on the machine
4520 running HAProxy. It can resist much higher loads than "tarpit", and slow
4521 down stronger attackers. It is important to undestand the impact of using
4522 this mechanism. All stateful equipments placed between the client and
4523 HAProxy (firewalls, proxies, load balancers) will also keep the
4524 established connection for a long time and may suffer from this action.
4525 On modern Linux systems running with enough privileges, the TCP_REPAIR
4526 socket option is used to block the emission of a TCP reset. On other
4527 systems, the socket's TTL is reduced to 1 so that the TCP reset doesn't
4528 pass the first router, though it's still delivered to local networks. Do
4529 not use it unless you fully understand how it works.
4530
Christopher Faulet76c09ef2017-09-21 11:03:52 +02004531 - send-spoe-group <engine-name> <group-name> :
4532 This action is used to trigger sending of a group of SPOE messages. To do
4533 so, the SPOE engine used to send messages must be defined, as well as the
4534 SPOE group to send. Of course, the SPOE engine must refer to an existing
4535 SPOE filter. If not engine name is provided on the SPOE filter line, the
4536 SPOE agent name must be used.
4537
4538 <engine-name> The SPOE engine name.
4539
4540 <group-name> The SPOE group name as specified in the engine
4541 configuration.
4542
Willy Tarreaue365c0b2013-06-11 16:06:12 +02004543 There is no limit to the number of http-response statements per instance.
4544
Godbach09250262013-07-02 01:19:15 +08004545 It is important to know that http-response rules are processed very early in
Ruoshan Huangeb5a3632015-12-08 21:00:23 +08004546 the HTTP processing, before "rspdel" or "rsprep" or "rspadd" rules. That way,
4547 headers added by "add-header"/"set-header" are visible by almost all further ACL
Willy Tarreaue365c0b2013-06-11 16:06:12 +02004548 rules.
4549
Ruoshan Huangeb5a3632015-12-08 21:00:23 +08004550 Using "rspadd"/"rspdel"/"rsprep" to manipulate request headers is discouraged
4551 in newer versions (>= 1.5). But if you need to use regular expression to
4552 delete headers, you can still use "rspdel". Also please use
4553 "http-response deny" instead of "rspdeny".
4554
Baptiste Assmannfabcbe02014-04-24 22:16:59 +02004555 Example:
4556 acl key_acl res.hdr(X-Acl-Key) -m found
4557
4558 acl myhost hdr(Host) -f myhost.lst
4559
4560 http-response add-acl(myhost.lst) %[res.hdr(X-Acl-Key)] if key_acl
4561 http-response del-acl(myhost.lst) %[res.hdr(X-Acl-Key)] if key_acl
4562
4563 Example:
4564 acl value res.hdr(X-Value) -m found
4565
4566 use_backend bk_appli if { hdr(Host),map_str(map.lst) -m found }
4567
4568 http-response set-map(map.lst) %[src] %[res.hdr(X-Value)] if value
4569 http-response del-map(map.lst) %[src] if ! value
4570
Willy Tarreaue365c0b2013-06-11 16:06:12 +02004571 See also : "http-request", section 3.4 about userlists and section 7 about
4572 ACL usage.
4573
Baptiste Assmann5ecb77f2013-10-06 23:24:13 +02004574
Willy Tarreau30631952015-08-06 15:05:24 +02004575http-reuse { never | safe | aggressive | always }
4576 Declare how idle HTTP connections may be shared between requests
4577
4578 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4579 yes | no | yes | yes
4580
4581 By default, a connection established between haproxy and the backend server
4582 belongs to the session that initiated it. The downside is that between the
4583 response and the next request, the connection remains idle and is not used.
4584 In many cases for performance reasons it is desirable to make it possible to
4585 reuse these idle connections to serve other requests from different sessions.
4586 This directive allows to tune this behaviour.
4587
4588 The argument indicates the desired connection reuse strategy :
4589
4590 - "never" : idle connections are never shared between sessions. This is
4591 the default choice. It may be enforced to cancel a different
4592 strategy inherited from a defaults section or for
4593 troubleshooting. For example, if an old bogus application
4594 considers that multiple requests over the same connection come
4595 from the same client and it is not possible to fix the
4596 application, it may be desirable to disable connection sharing
4597 in a single backend. An example of such an application could
4598 be an old haproxy using cookie insertion in tunnel mode and
4599 not checking any request past the first one.
4600
4601 - "safe" : this is the recommended strategy. The first request of a
4602 session is always sent over its own connection, and only
4603 subsequent requests may be dispatched over other existing
4604 connections. This ensures that in case the server closes the
4605 connection when the request is being sent, the browser can
4606 decide to silently retry it. Since it is exactly equivalent to
4607 regular keep-alive, there should be no side effects.
4608
4609 - "aggressive" : this mode may be useful in webservices environments where
4610 all servers are not necessarily known and where it would be
4611 appreciable to deliver most first requests over existing
4612 connections. In this case, first requests are only delivered
4613 over existing connections that have been reused at least once,
4614 proving that the server correctly supports connection reuse.
4615 It should only be used when it's sure that the client can
4616 retry a failed request once in a while and where the benefit
4617 of aggressive connection reuse significantly outweights the
4618 downsides of rare connection failures.
4619
4620 - "always" : this mode is only recommended when the path to the server is
4621 known for never breaking existing connections quickly after
4622 releasing them. It allows the first request of a session to be
4623 sent to an existing connection. This can provide a significant
4624 performance increase over the "safe" strategy when the backend
4625 is a cache farm, since such components tend to show a
4626 consistent behaviour and will benefit from the connection
4627 sharing. It is recommended that the "http-keep-alive" timeout
4628 remains low in this mode so that no dead connections remain
4629 usable. In most cases, this will lead to the same performance
4630 gains as "aggressive" but with more risks. It should only be
4631 used when it improves the situation over "aggressive".
4632
4633 When http connection sharing is enabled, a great care is taken to respect the
4634 connection properties and compatiblities. Specifically :
4635 - connections made with "usesrc" followed by a client-dependant value
4636 ("client", "clientip", "hdr_ip") are marked private and never shared ;
4637
4638 - connections sent to a server with a TLS SNI extension are marked private
4639 and are never shared ;
4640
4641 - connections receiving a status code 401 or 407 expect some authentication
4642 to be sent in return. Due to certain bogus authentication schemes (such
4643 as NTLM) relying on the connection, these connections are marked private
4644 and are never shared ;
4645
4646 No connection pool is involved, once a session dies, the last idle connection
4647 it was attached to is deleted at the same time. This ensures that connections
4648 may not last after all sessions are closed.
4649
4650 Note: connection reuse improves the accuracy of the "server maxconn" setting,
4651 because almost no new connection will be established while idle connections
4652 remain available. This is particularly true with the "always" strategy.
4653
4654 See also : "option http-keep-alive", "server maxconn"
4655
4656
Mark Lamourinec2247f02012-01-04 13:02:01 -05004657http-send-name-header [<header>]
4658 Add the server name to a request. Use the header string given by <header>
4659
4660 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4661 yes | no | yes | yes
4662
4663 Arguments :
4664
4665 <header> The header string to use to send the server name
4666
4667 The "http-send-name-header" statement causes the name of the target
4668 server to be added to the headers of an HTTP request. The name
4669 is added with the header string proved.
4670
4671 See also : "server"
4672
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif58a9622008-02-23 01:19:10 +01004673id <value>
Willy Tarreau53fb4ae2009-10-04 23:04:08 +02004674 Set a persistent ID to a proxy.
4675 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4676 no | yes | yes | yes
4677 Arguments : none
4678
4679 Set a persistent ID for the proxy. This ID must be unique and positive.
4680 An unused ID will automatically be assigned if unset. The first assigned
4681 value will be 1. This ID is currently only returned in statistics.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif58a9622008-02-23 01:19:10 +01004682
4683
Cyril Bonté0d4bf012010-04-25 23:21:46 +02004684ignore-persist { if | unless } <condition>
4685 Declare a condition to ignore persistence
4686 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4687 no | yes | yes | yes
4688
4689 By default, when cookie persistence is enabled, every requests containing
4690 the cookie are unconditionally persistent (assuming the target server is up
4691 and running).
4692
4693 The "ignore-persist" statement allows one to declare various ACL-based
4694 conditions which, when met, will cause a request to ignore persistence.
4695 This is sometimes useful to load balance requests for static files, which
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03004696 often don't require persistence. This can also be used to fully disable
Cyril Bonté0d4bf012010-04-25 23:21:46 +02004697 persistence for a specific User-Agent (for example, some web crawler bots).
4698
Cyril Bonté0d4bf012010-04-25 23:21:46 +02004699 The persistence is ignored when an "if" condition is met, or unless an
4700 "unless" condition is met.
4701
Jarno Huuskonene5ae7022017-04-03 14:36:21 +03004702 Example:
4703 acl url_static path_beg /static /images /img /css
4704 acl url_static path_end .gif .png .jpg .css .js
4705 ignore-persist if url_static
4706
Cyril Bonté0d4bf012010-04-25 23:21:46 +02004707 See also : "force-persist", "cookie", and section 7 about ACL usage.
4708
Baptiste Assmann01c6cc32015-08-23 11:45:29 +02004709load-server-state-from-file { global | local | none }
4710 Allow seamless reload of HAProxy
4711 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4712 yes | no | yes | yes
4713
4714 This directive points HAProxy to a file where server state from previous
4715 running process has been saved. That way, when starting up, before handling
4716 traffic, the new process can apply old states to servers exactly has if no
4717 reload occured. The purpose of the "load-server-state-from-file" directive is
4718 to tell haproxy which file to use. For now, only 2 arguments to either prevent
4719 loading state or load states from a file containing all backends and servers.
4720 The state file can be generated by running the command "show servers state"
4721 over the stats socket and redirect output.
4722
4723 The format of the file is versionned and is very specific. To understand it,
4724 please read the documentation of the "show servers state" command (chapter
Willy Tarreau1af20c72017-06-23 16:01:14 +02004725 9.3 of Management Guide).
Baptiste Assmann01c6cc32015-08-23 11:45:29 +02004726
4727 Arguments:
4728 global load the content of the file pointed by the global directive
4729 named "server-state-file".
4730
4731 local load the content of the file pointed by the directive
4732 "server-state-file-name" if set. If not set, then the backend
4733 name is used as a file name.
4734
4735 none don't load any stat for this backend
4736
4737 Notes:
Willy Tarreaue5a60682016-11-09 14:54:53 +01004738 - server's IP address is preserved across reloads by default, but the
4739 order can be changed thanks to the server's "init-addr" setting. This
4740 means that an IP address change performed on the CLI at run time will
4741 be preserved, and that any change to the local resolver (eg: /etc/hosts)
4742 will possibly not have any effect if the state file is in use.
Baptiste Assmann01c6cc32015-08-23 11:45:29 +02004743
4744 - server's weight is applied from previous running process unless it has
4745 has changed between previous and new configuration files.
4746
Olivier Doucetaa1ea8a2016-08-05 17:15:20 +02004747 Example: Minimal configuration
Baptiste Assmann01c6cc32015-08-23 11:45:29 +02004748
Olivier Doucetaa1ea8a2016-08-05 17:15:20 +02004749 global
4750 stats socket /tmp/socket
4751 server-state-file /tmp/server_state
Baptiste Assmann01c6cc32015-08-23 11:45:29 +02004752
Olivier Doucetaa1ea8a2016-08-05 17:15:20 +02004753 defaults
4754 load-server-state-from-file global
Baptiste Assmann01c6cc32015-08-23 11:45:29 +02004755
Olivier Doucetaa1ea8a2016-08-05 17:15:20 +02004756 backend bk
4757 server s1 127.0.0.1:22 check weight 11
4758 server s2 127.0.0.1:22 check weight 12
Baptiste Assmann01c6cc32015-08-23 11:45:29 +02004759
Baptiste Assmann01c6cc32015-08-23 11:45:29 +02004760
4761 Then one can run :
4762
4763 socat /tmp/socket - <<< "show servers state" > /tmp/server_state
4764
4765 Content of the file /tmp/server_state would be like this:
4766
4767 1
4768 # <field names skipped for the doc example>
4769 1 bk 1 s1 127.0.0.1 2 0 11 11 4 6 3 4 6 0 0
4770 1 bk 2 s2 127.0.0.1 2 0 12 12 4 6 3 4 6 0 0
4771
Olivier Doucetaa1ea8a2016-08-05 17:15:20 +02004772 Example: Minimal configuration
Baptiste Assmann01c6cc32015-08-23 11:45:29 +02004773
4774 global
4775 stats socket /tmp/socket
4776 server-state-base /etc/haproxy/states
4777
4778 defaults
4779 load-server-state-from-file local
4780
4781 backend bk
4782 server s1 127.0.0.1:22 check weight 11
4783 server s2 127.0.0.1:22 check weight 12
4784
Olivier Doucetaa1ea8a2016-08-05 17:15:20 +02004785
Baptiste Assmann01c6cc32015-08-23 11:45:29 +02004786 Then one can run :
4787
4788 socat /tmp/socket - <<< "show servers state bk" > /etc/haproxy/states/bk
4789
4790 Content of the file /etc/haproxy/states/bk would be like this:
4791
4792 1
4793 # <field names skipped for the doc example>
4794 1 bk 1 s1 127.0.0.1 2 0 11 11 4 6 3 4 6 0 0
4795 1 bk 2 s2 127.0.0.1 2 0 12 12 4 6 3 4 6 0 0
4796
4797 See also: "server-state-file", "server-state-file-name", and
4798 "show servers state"
4799
Cyril Bonté0d4bf012010-04-25 23:21:46 +02004800
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01004801log global
Willy Tarreau18324f52014-06-27 18:10:07 +02004802log <address> [len <length>] <facility> [<level> [<minlevel>]]
William Lallemand0f99e342011-10-12 17:50:54 +02004803no log
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01004804 Enable per-instance logging of events and traffic.
4805 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4806 yes | yes | yes | yes
William Lallemand0f99e342011-10-12 17:50:54 +02004807
4808 Prefix :
4809 no should be used when the logger list must be flushed. For example,
4810 if you don't want to inherit from the default logger list. This
4811 prefix does not allow arguments.
4812
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01004813 Arguments :
4814 global should be used when the instance's logging parameters are the
4815 same as the global ones. This is the most common usage. "global"
4816 replaces <address>, <facility> and <level> with those of the log
4817 entries found in the "global" section. Only one "log global"
4818 statement may be used per instance, and this form takes no other
4819 parameter.
4820
4821 <address> indicates where to send the logs. It takes the same format as
4822 for the "global" section's logs, and can be one of :
4823
4824 - An IPv4 address optionally followed by a colon (':') and a UDP
4825 port. If no port is specified, 514 is used by default (the
4826 standard syslog port).
4827
David du Colombier24bb5f52011-03-17 10:40:23 +01004828 - An IPv6 address followed by a colon (':') and optionally a UDP
4829 port. If no port is specified, 514 is used by default (the
4830 standard syslog port).
4831
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01004832 - A filesystem path to a UNIX domain socket, keeping in mind
4833 considerations for chroot (be sure the path is accessible
4834 inside the chroot) and uid/gid (be sure the path is
4835 appropriately writeable).
4836
William Lallemandb2f07452015-05-12 14:27:13 +02004837 You may want to reference some environment variables in the
4838 address parameter, see section 2.3 about environment variables.
Willy Tarreaudad36a32013-03-11 01:20:04 +01004839
Willy Tarreau18324f52014-06-27 18:10:07 +02004840 <length> is an optional maximum line length. Log lines larger than this
4841 value will be truncated before being sent. The reason is that
4842 syslog servers act differently on log line length. All servers
4843 support the default value of 1024, but some servers simply drop
4844 larger lines while others do log them. If a server supports long
4845 lines, it may make sense to set this value here in order to avoid
4846 truncating long lines. Similarly, if a server drops long lines,
4847 it is preferable to truncate them before sending them. Accepted
4848 values are 80 to 65535 inclusive. The default value of 1024 is
4849 generally fine for all standard usages. Some specific cases of
4850 long captures or JSON-formated logs may require larger values.
4851
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01004852 <facility> must be one of the 24 standard syslog facilities :
4853
4854 kern user mail daemon auth syslog lpr news
4855 uucp cron auth2 ftp ntp audit alert cron2
4856 local0 local1 local2 local3 local4 local5 local6 local7
4857
4858 <level> is optional and can be specified to filter outgoing messages. By
4859 default, all messages are sent. If a level is specified, only
4860 messages with a severity at least as important as this level
Willy Tarreauf7edefa2009-05-10 17:20:05 +02004861 will be sent. An optional minimum level can be specified. If it
4862 is set, logs emitted with a more severe level than this one will
4863 be capped to this level. This is used to avoid sending "emerg"
4864 messages on all terminals on some default syslog configurations.
4865 Eight levels are known :
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01004866
4867 emerg alert crit err warning notice info debug
4868
William Lallemand0f99e342011-10-12 17:50:54 +02004869 It is important to keep in mind that it is the frontend which decides what to
4870 log from a connection, and that in case of content switching, the log entries
4871 from the backend will be ignored. Connections are logged at level "info".
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +01004872
4873 However, backend log declaration define how and where servers status changes
4874 will be logged. Level "notice" will be used to indicate a server going up,
4875 "warning" will be used for termination signals and definitive service
4876 termination, and "alert" will be used for when a server goes down.
4877
4878 Note : According to RFC3164, messages are truncated to 1024 bytes before
4879 being emitted.
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01004880
4881 Example :
4882 log global
Willy Tarreauf7edefa2009-05-10 17:20:05 +02004883 log 127.0.0.1:514 local0 notice # only send important events
4884 log 127.0.0.1:514 local0 notice notice # same but limit output level
William Lallemandb2f07452015-05-12 14:27:13 +02004885 log "${LOCAL_SYSLOG}:514" local0 notice # send to local server
Willy Tarreaudad36a32013-03-11 01:20:04 +01004886
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01004887
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +01004888log-format <string>
Willy Tarreaufb4e7ea2015-01-07 14:55:17 +01004889 Specifies the log format string to use for traffic logs
4890 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4891 yes | yes | yes | no
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +01004892
Willy Tarreaufb4e7ea2015-01-07 14:55:17 +01004893 This directive specifies the log format string that will be used for all logs
4894 resulting from traffic passing through the frontend using this line. If the
4895 directive is used in a defaults section, all subsequent frontends will use
4896 the same log format. Please see section 8.2.4 which covers the log format
4897 string in depth.
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +01004898
Guillaume de Lafond29f45602017-03-31 19:52:15 +02004899 "log-format" directive overrides previous "option tcplog", "log-format" and
4900 "option httplog" directives.
4901
Dragan Dosen7ad31542015-09-28 17:16:47 +02004902log-format-sd <string>
4903 Specifies the RFC5424 structured-data log format string
4904 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4905 yes | yes | yes | no
4906
4907 This directive specifies the RFC5424 structured-data log format string that
4908 will be used for all logs resulting from traffic passing through the frontend
4909 using this line. If the directive is used in a defaults section, all
4910 subsequent frontends will use the same log format. Please see section 8.2.4
4911 which covers the log format string in depth.
4912
4913 See https://tools.ietf.org/html/rfc5424#section-6.3 for more information
4914 about the RFC5424 structured-data part.
4915
4916 Note : This log format string will be used only for loggers that have set
4917 log format to "rfc5424".
4918
4919 Example :
4920 log-format-sd [exampleSDID@1234\ bytes=\"%B\"\ status=\"%ST\"]
4921
4922
Willy Tarreau094af4e2015-01-07 15:03:42 +01004923log-tag <string>
4924 Specifies the log tag to use for all outgoing logs
4925 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4926 yes | yes | yes | yes
4927
4928 Sets the tag field in the syslog header to this string. It defaults to the
4929 log-tag set in the global section, otherwise the program name as launched
4930 from the command line, which usually is "haproxy". Sometimes it can be useful
4931 to differentiate between multiple processes running on the same host, or to
4932 differentiate customer instances running in the same process. In the backend,
4933 logs about servers up/down will use this tag. As a hint, it can be convenient
4934 to set a log-tag related to a hosted customer in a defaults section then put
4935 all the frontends and backends for that customer, then start another customer
4936 in a new defaults section. See also the global "log-tag" directive.
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01004937
Willy Tarreauc35362a2014-04-25 13:58:37 +02004938max-keep-alive-queue <value>
4939 Set the maximum server queue size for maintaining keep-alive connections
4940 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4941 yes | no | yes | yes
4942
4943 HTTP keep-alive tries to reuse the same server connection whenever possible,
4944 but sometimes it can be counter-productive, for example if a server has a lot
4945 of connections while other ones are idle. This is especially true for static
4946 servers.
4947
4948 The purpose of this setting is to set a threshold on the number of queued
4949 connections at which haproxy stops trying to reuse the same server and prefers
4950 to find another one. The default value, -1, means there is no limit. A value
4951 of zero means that keep-alive requests will never be queued. For very close
4952 servers which can be reached with a low latency and which are not sensible to
4953 breaking keep-alive, a low value is recommended (eg: local static server can
4954 use a value of 10 or less). For remote servers suffering from a high latency,
4955 higher values might be needed to cover for the latency and/or the cost of
4956 picking a different server.
4957
4958 Note that this has no impact on responses which are maintained to the same
4959 server consecutively to a 401 response. They will still go to the same server
4960 even if they have to be queued.
4961
4962 See also : "option http-server-close", "option prefer-last-server", server
4963 "maxconn" and cookie persistence.
4964
4965
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01004966maxconn <conns>
4967 Fix the maximum number of concurrent connections on a frontend
4968 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4969 yes | yes | yes | no
4970 Arguments :
4971 <conns> is the maximum number of concurrent connections the frontend will
4972 accept to serve. Excess connections will be queued by the system
4973 in the socket's listen queue and will be served once a connection
4974 closes.
4975
4976 If the system supports it, it can be useful on big sites to raise this limit
4977 very high so that haproxy manages connection queues, instead of leaving the
4978 clients with unanswered connection attempts. This value should not exceed the
4979 global maxconn. Also, keep in mind that a connection contains two buffers
Baptiste Assmann79fb45d2016-03-06 23:34:31 +01004980 of tune.bufsize (16kB by default) each, as well as some other data resulting
4981 in about 33 kB of RAM being consumed per established connection. That means
4982 that a medium system equipped with 1GB of RAM can withstand around
4983 20000-25000 concurrent connections if properly tuned.
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01004984
4985 Also, when <conns> is set to large values, it is possible that the servers
4986 are not sized to accept such loads, and for this reason it is generally wise
4987 to assign them some reasonable connection limits.
4988
Vincent Bernat6341be52012-06-27 17:18:30 +02004989 By default, this value is set to 2000.
4990
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01004991 See also : "server", global section's "maxconn", "fullconn"
4992
4993
4994mode { tcp|http|health }
4995 Set the running mode or protocol of the instance
4996 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4997 yes | yes | yes | yes
4998 Arguments :
4999 tcp The instance will work in pure TCP mode. A full-duplex connection
5000 will be established between clients and servers, and no layer 7
5001 examination will be performed. This is the default mode. It
5002 should be used for SSL, SSH, SMTP, ...
5003
5004 http The instance will work in HTTP mode. The client request will be
5005 analyzed in depth before connecting to any server. Any request
5006 which is not RFC-compliant will be rejected. Layer 7 filtering,
5007 processing and switching will be possible. This is the mode which
5008 brings HAProxy most of its value.
5009
5010 health The instance will work in "health" mode. It will just reply "OK"
Willy Tarreau82569f92012-09-27 23:48:56 +02005011 to incoming connections and close the connection. Alternatively,
5012 If the "httpchk" option is set, "HTTP/1.0 200 OK" will be sent
5013 instead. Nothing will be logged in either case. This mode is used
5014 to reply to external components health checks. This mode is
5015 deprecated and should not be used anymore as it is possible to do
5016 the same and even better by combining TCP or HTTP modes with the
5017 "monitor" keyword.
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01005018
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +02005019 When doing content switching, it is mandatory that the frontend and the
5020 backend are in the same mode (generally HTTP), otherwise the configuration
5021 will be refused.
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01005022
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +02005023 Example :
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01005024 defaults http_instances
5025 mode http
5026
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +02005027 See also : "monitor", "monitor-net"
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01005028
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01005029
Cyril Bontéf0c60612010-02-06 14:44:47 +01005030monitor fail { if | unless } <condition>
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01005031 Add a condition to report a failure to a monitor HTTP request.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01005032 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5033 no | yes | yes | no
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01005034 Arguments :
5035 if <cond> the monitor request will fail if the condition is satisfied,
5036 and will succeed otherwise. The condition should describe a
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01005037 combined test which must induce a failure if all conditions
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01005038 are met, for instance a low number of servers both in a
5039 backend and its backup.
5040
5041 unless <cond> the monitor request will succeed only if the condition is
5042 satisfied, and will fail otherwise. Such a condition may be
5043 based on a test on the presence of a minimum number of active
5044 servers in a list of backends.
5045
5046 This statement adds a condition which can force the response to a monitor
5047 request to report a failure. By default, when an external component queries
5048 the URI dedicated to monitoring, a 200 response is returned. When one of the
5049 conditions above is met, haproxy will return 503 instead of 200. This is
5050 very useful to report a site failure to an external component which may base
5051 routing advertisements between multiple sites on the availability reported by
5052 haproxy. In this case, one would rely on an ACL involving the "nbsrv"
Willy Tarreauae94d4d2011-05-11 16:28:49 +02005053 criterion. Note that "monitor fail" only works in HTTP mode. Both status
5054 messages may be tweaked using "errorfile" or "errorloc" if needed.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01005055
5056 Example:
5057 frontend www
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01005058 mode http
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01005059 acl site_dead nbsrv(dynamic) lt 2
5060 acl site_dead nbsrv(static) lt 2
5061 monitor-uri /site_alive
5062 monitor fail if site_dead
5063
Willy Tarreauae94d4d2011-05-11 16:28:49 +02005064 See also : "monitor-net", "monitor-uri", "errorfile", "errorloc"
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01005065
5066
5067monitor-net <source>
5068 Declare a source network which is limited to monitor requests
5069 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5070 yes | yes | yes | no
5071 Arguments :
5072 <source> is the source IPv4 address or network which will only be able to
5073 get monitor responses to any request. It can be either an IPv4
5074 address, a host name, or an address followed by a slash ('/')
5075 followed by a mask.
5076
5077 In TCP mode, any connection coming from a source matching <source> will cause
5078 the connection to be immediately closed without any log. This allows another
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01005079 equipment to probe the port and verify that it is still listening, without
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01005080 forwarding the connection to a remote server.
5081
5082 In HTTP mode, a connection coming from a source matching <source> will be
5083 accepted, the following response will be sent without waiting for a request,
5084 then the connection will be closed : "HTTP/1.0 200 OK". This is normally
5085 enough for any front-end HTTP probe to detect that the service is UP and
Willy Tarreau82569f92012-09-27 23:48:56 +02005086 running without forwarding the request to a backend server. Note that this
5087 response is sent in raw format, without any transformation. This is important
5088 as it means that it will not be SSL-encrypted on SSL listeners.
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01005089
Willy Tarreau82569f92012-09-27 23:48:56 +02005090 Monitor requests are processed very early, just after tcp-request connection
5091 ACLs which are the only ones able to block them. These connections are short
5092 lived and never wait for any data from the client. They cannot be logged, and
5093 it is the intended purpose. They are only used to report HAProxy's health to
5094 an upper component, nothing more. Please note that "monitor fail" rules do
5095 not apply to connections intercepted by "monitor-net".
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01005096
Willy Tarreau95cd2832010-03-04 23:36:33 +01005097 Last, please note that only one "monitor-net" statement can be specified in
5098 a frontend. If more than one is found, only the last one will be considered.
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +02005099
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01005100 Example :
5101 # addresses .252 and .253 are just probing us.
5102 frontend www
5103 monitor-net 192.168.0.252/31
5104
5105 See also : "monitor fail", "monitor-uri"
5106
5107
5108monitor-uri <uri>
5109 Intercept a URI used by external components' monitor requests
5110 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5111 yes | yes | yes | no
5112 Arguments :
5113 <uri> is the exact URI which we want to intercept to return HAProxy's
5114 health status instead of forwarding the request.
5115
5116 When an HTTP request referencing <uri> will be received on a frontend,
5117 HAProxy will not forward it nor log it, but instead will return either
5118 "HTTP/1.0 200 OK" or "HTTP/1.0 503 Service unavailable", depending on failure
5119 conditions defined with "monitor fail". This is normally enough for any
5120 front-end HTTP probe to detect that the service is UP and running without
5121 forwarding the request to a backend server. Note that the HTTP method, the
5122 version and all headers are ignored, but the request must at least be valid
5123 at the HTTP level. This keyword may only be used with an HTTP-mode frontend.
5124
5125 Monitor requests are processed very early. It is not possible to block nor
5126 divert them using ACLs. They cannot be logged either, and it is the intended
5127 purpose. They are only used to report HAProxy's health to an upper component,
5128 nothing more. However, it is possible to add any number of conditions using
5129 "monitor fail" and ACLs so that the result can be adjusted to whatever check
5130 can be imagined (most often the number of available servers in a backend).
5131
5132 Example :
5133 # Use /haproxy_test to report haproxy's status
5134 frontend www
5135 mode http
5136 monitor-uri /haproxy_test
5137
5138 See also : "monitor fail", "monitor-net"
5139
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01005140
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01005141option abortonclose
5142no option abortonclose
5143 Enable or disable early dropping of aborted requests pending in queues.
5144 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5145 yes | no | yes | yes
5146 Arguments : none
5147
5148 In presence of very high loads, the servers will take some time to respond.
5149 The per-instance connection queue will inflate, and the response time will
5150 increase respective to the size of the queue times the average per-session
5151 response time. When clients will wait for more than a few seconds, they will
Willy Tarreau198a7442008-01-17 12:05:32 +01005152 often hit the "STOP" button on their browser, leaving a useless request in
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01005153 the queue, and slowing down other users, and the servers as well, because the
5154 request will eventually be served, then aborted at the first error
5155 encountered while delivering the response.
5156
5157 As there is no way to distinguish between a full STOP and a simple output
5158 close on the client side, HTTP agents should be conservative and consider
5159 that the client might only have closed its output channel while waiting for
5160 the response. However, this introduces risks of congestion when lots of users
5161 do the same, and is completely useless nowadays because probably no client at
5162 all will close the session while waiting for the response. Some HTTP agents
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +01005163 support this behaviour (Squid, Apache, HAProxy), and others do not (TUX, most
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01005164 hardware-based load balancers). So the probability for a closed input channel
Willy Tarreau198a7442008-01-17 12:05:32 +01005165 to represent a user hitting the "STOP" button is close to 100%, and the risk
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01005166 of being the single component to break rare but valid traffic is extremely
5167 low, which adds to the temptation to be able to abort a session early while
5168 still not served and not pollute the servers.
5169
5170 In HAProxy, the user can choose the desired behaviour using the option
5171 "abortonclose". By default (without the option) the behaviour is HTTP
5172 compliant and aborted requests will be served. But when the option is
5173 specified, a session with an incoming channel closed will be aborted while
5174 it is still possible, either pending in the queue for a connection slot, or
5175 during the connection establishment if the server has not yet acknowledged
5176 the connection request. This considerably reduces the queue size and the load
5177 on saturated servers when users are tempted to click on STOP, which in turn
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +01005178 reduces the response time for other users.
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01005179
5180 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
5181 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
5182
5183 See also : "timeout queue" and server's "maxconn" and "maxqueue" parameters
5184
5185
Willy Tarreau4076a152009-04-02 15:18:36 +02005186option accept-invalid-http-request
5187no option accept-invalid-http-request
5188 Enable or disable relaxing of HTTP request parsing
5189 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5190 yes | yes | yes | no
5191 Arguments : none
5192
Willy Tarreau91852eb2015-05-01 13:26:00 +02005193 By default, HAProxy complies with RFC7230 in terms of message parsing. This
Willy Tarreau4076a152009-04-02 15:18:36 +02005194 means that invalid characters in header names are not permitted and cause an
5195 error to be returned to the client. This is the desired behaviour as such
5196 forbidden characters are essentially used to build attacks exploiting server
5197 weaknesses, and bypass security filtering. Sometimes, a buggy browser or
5198 server will emit invalid header names for whatever reason (configuration,
5199 implementation) and the issue will not be immediately fixed. In such a case,
5200 it is possible to relax HAProxy's header name parser to accept any character
Willy Tarreau422246e2012-01-07 23:54:13 +01005201 even if that does not make sense, by specifying this option. Similarly, the
5202 list of characters allowed to appear in a URI is well defined by RFC3986, and
5203 chars 0-31, 32 (space), 34 ('"'), 60 ('<'), 62 ('>'), 92 ('\'), 94 ('^'), 96
5204 ('`'), 123 ('{'), 124 ('|'), 125 ('}'), 127 (delete) and anything above are
5205 not allowed at all. Haproxy always blocks a number of them (0..32, 127). The
Willy Tarreau91852eb2015-05-01 13:26:00 +02005206 remaining ones are blocked by default unless this option is enabled. This
Willy Tarreau13317662015-05-01 13:47:08 +02005207 option also relaxes the test on the HTTP version, it allows HTTP/0.9 requests
5208 to pass through (no version specified) and multiple digits for both the major
5209 and the minor version.
Willy Tarreau4076a152009-04-02 15:18:36 +02005210
5211 This option should never be enabled by default as it hides application bugs
5212 and open security breaches. It should only be deployed after a problem has
5213 been confirmed.
5214
5215 When this option is enabled, erroneous header names will still be accepted in
5216 requests, but the complete request will be captured in order to permit later
Willy Tarreau422246e2012-01-07 23:54:13 +01005217 analysis using the "show errors" request on the UNIX stats socket. Similarly,
5218 requests containing invalid chars in the URI part will be logged. Doing this
Willy Tarreau4076a152009-04-02 15:18:36 +02005219 also helps confirming that the issue has been solved.
5220
5221 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
5222 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
5223
5224 See also : "option accept-invalid-http-response" and "show errors" on the
5225 stats socket.
5226
5227
5228option accept-invalid-http-response
5229no option accept-invalid-http-response
5230 Enable or disable relaxing of HTTP response parsing
5231 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5232 yes | no | yes | yes
5233 Arguments : none
5234
Willy Tarreau91852eb2015-05-01 13:26:00 +02005235 By default, HAProxy complies with RFC7230 in terms of message parsing. This
Willy Tarreau4076a152009-04-02 15:18:36 +02005236 means that invalid characters in header names are not permitted and cause an
5237 error to be returned to the client. This is the desired behaviour as such
5238 forbidden characters are essentially used to build attacks exploiting server
5239 weaknesses, and bypass security filtering. Sometimes, a buggy browser or
5240 server will emit invalid header names for whatever reason (configuration,
5241 implementation) and the issue will not be immediately fixed. In such a case,
5242 it is possible to relax HAProxy's header name parser to accept any character
Willy Tarreau91852eb2015-05-01 13:26:00 +02005243 even if that does not make sense, by specifying this option. This option also
5244 relaxes the test on the HTTP version format, it allows multiple digits for
5245 both the major and the minor version.
Willy Tarreau4076a152009-04-02 15:18:36 +02005246
5247 This option should never be enabled by default as it hides application bugs
5248 and open security breaches. It should only be deployed after a problem has
5249 been confirmed.
5250
5251 When this option is enabled, erroneous header names will still be accepted in
5252 responses, but the complete response will be captured in order to permit
5253 later analysis using the "show errors" request on the UNIX stats socket.
5254 Doing this also helps confirming that the issue has been solved.
5255
5256 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
5257 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
5258
5259 See also : "option accept-invalid-http-request" and "show errors" on the
5260 stats socket.
5261
5262
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01005263option allbackups
5264no option allbackups
5265 Use either all backup servers at a time or only the first one
5266 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5267 yes | no | yes | yes
5268 Arguments : none
5269
5270 By default, the first operational backup server gets all traffic when normal
5271 servers are all down. Sometimes, it may be preferred to use multiple backups
5272 at once, because one will not be enough. When "option allbackups" is enabled,
5273 the load balancing will be performed among all backup servers when all normal
5274 ones are unavailable. The same load balancing algorithm will be used and the
5275 servers' weights will be respected. Thus, there will not be any priority
5276 order between the backup servers anymore.
5277
5278 This option is mostly used with static server farms dedicated to return a
5279 "sorry" page when an application is completely offline.
5280
5281 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
5282 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
5283
5284
5285option checkcache
5286no option checkcache
Godbach7056a352013-12-11 20:01:07 +08005287 Analyze all server responses and block responses with cacheable cookies
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01005288 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5289 yes | no | yes | yes
5290 Arguments : none
5291
5292 Some high-level frameworks set application cookies everywhere and do not
5293 always let enough control to the developer to manage how the responses should
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01005294 be cached. When a session cookie is returned on a cacheable object, there is a
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01005295 high risk of session crossing or stealing between users traversing the same
5296 caches. In some situations, it is better to block the response than to let
Willy Tarreau3c92c5f2011-08-28 09:45:47 +02005297 some sensitive session information go in the wild.
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01005298
5299 The option "checkcache" enables deep inspection of all server responses for
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01005300 strict compliance with HTTP specification in terms of cacheability. It
Willy Tarreau198a7442008-01-17 12:05:32 +01005301 carefully checks "Cache-control", "Pragma" and "Set-cookie" headers in server
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01005302 response to check if there's a risk of caching a cookie on a client-side
5303 proxy. When this option is enabled, the only responses which can be delivered
Willy Tarreau198a7442008-01-17 12:05:32 +01005304 to the client are :
5305 - all those without "Set-Cookie" header ;
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01005306 - all those with a return code other than 200, 203, 206, 300, 301, 410,
Willy Tarreau198a7442008-01-17 12:05:32 +01005307 provided that the server has not set a "Cache-control: public" header ;
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01005308 - all those that come from a POST request, provided that the server has not
5309 set a 'Cache-Control: public' header ;
5310 - those with a 'Pragma: no-cache' header
5311 - those with a 'Cache-control: private' header
5312 - those with a 'Cache-control: no-store' header
5313 - those with a 'Cache-control: max-age=0' header
5314 - those with a 'Cache-control: s-maxage=0' header
5315 - those with a 'Cache-control: no-cache' header
5316 - those with a 'Cache-control: no-cache="set-cookie"' header
5317 - those with a 'Cache-control: no-cache="set-cookie,' header
5318 (allowing other fields after set-cookie)
5319
5320 If a response doesn't respect these requirements, then it will be blocked
Willy Tarreau198a7442008-01-17 12:05:32 +01005321 just as if it was from an "rspdeny" filter, with an "HTTP 502 bad gateway".
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01005322 The session state shows "PH--" meaning that the proxy blocked the response
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01005323 during headers processing. Additionally, an alert will be sent in the logs so
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01005324 that admins are informed that there's something to be fixed.
5325
5326 Due to the high impact on the application, the application should be tested
5327 in depth with the option enabled before going to production. It is also a
Willy Tarreaud2a4aa22008-01-31 15:28:22 +01005328 good practice to always activate it during tests, even if it is not used in
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01005329 production, as it will report potentially dangerous application behaviours.
5330
5331 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
5332 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
5333
5334
5335option clitcpka
5336no option clitcpka
5337 Enable or disable the sending of TCP keepalive packets on the client side
5338 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5339 yes | yes | yes | no
5340 Arguments : none
5341
5342 When there is a firewall or any session-aware component between a client and
5343 a server, and when the protocol involves very long sessions with long idle
5344 periods (eg: remote desktops), there is a risk that one of the intermediate
5345 components decides to expire a session which has remained idle for too long.
5346
5347 Enabling socket-level TCP keep-alives makes the system regularly send packets
5348 to the other end of the connection, leaving it active. The delay between
5349 keep-alive probes is controlled by the system only and depends both on the
5350 operating system and its tuning parameters.
5351
5352 It is important to understand that keep-alive packets are neither emitted nor
5353 received at the application level. It is only the network stacks which sees
5354 them. For this reason, even if one side of the proxy already uses keep-alives
5355 to maintain its connection alive, those keep-alive packets will not be
5356 forwarded to the other side of the proxy.
5357
5358 Please note that this has nothing to do with HTTP keep-alive.
5359
5360 Using option "clitcpka" enables the emission of TCP keep-alive probes on the
5361 client side of a connection, which should help when session expirations are
5362 noticed between HAProxy and a client.
5363
5364 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
5365 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
5366
5367 See also : "option srvtcpka", "option tcpka"
5368
5369
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01005370option contstats
5371 Enable continuous traffic statistics updates
5372 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5373 yes | yes | yes | no
5374 Arguments : none
5375
5376 By default, counters used for statistics calculation are incremented
5377 only when a session finishes. It works quite well when serving small
5378 objects, but with big ones (for example large images or archives) or
5379 with A/V streaming, a graph generated from haproxy counters looks like
Willy Tarreaudef0d222016-11-08 22:03:00 +01005380 a hedgehog. With this option enabled counters get incremented frequently
5381 along the session, typically every 5 seconds, which is often enough to
5382 produce clean graphs. Recounting touches a hotpath directly so it is not
5383 not enabled by default, as it can cause a lot of wakeups for very large
5384 session counts and cause a small performance drop.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01005385
5386
Willy Tarreauc9bd0cc2009-05-10 11:57:02 +02005387option dontlog-normal
5388no option dontlog-normal
5389 Enable or disable logging of normal, successful connections
5390 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5391 yes | yes | yes | no
5392 Arguments : none
5393
5394 There are large sites dealing with several thousand connections per second
5395 and for which logging is a major pain. Some of them are even forced to turn
5396 logs off and cannot debug production issues. Setting this option ensures that
5397 normal connections, those which experience no error, no timeout, no retry nor
5398 redispatch, will not be logged. This leaves disk space for anomalies. In HTTP
5399 mode, the response status code is checked and return codes 5xx will still be
5400 logged.
5401
5402 It is strongly discouraged to use this option as most of the time, the key to
5403 complex issues is in the normal logs which will not be logged here. If you
5404 need to separate logs, see the "log-separate-errors" option instead.
5405
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02005406 See also : "log", "dontlognull", "log-separate-errors" and section 8 about
Willy Tarreauc9bd0cc2009-05-10 11:57:02 +02005407 logging.
5408
5409
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01005410option dontlognull
5411no option dontlognull
5412 Enable or disable logging of null connections
5413 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5414 yes | yes | yes | no
5415 Arguments : none
5416
5417 In certain environments, there are components which will regularly connect to
5418 various systems to ensure that they are still alive. It can be the case from
5419 another load balancer as well as from monitoring systems. By default, even a
5420 simple port probe or scan will produce a log. If those connections pollute
5421 the logs too much, it is possible to enable option "dontlognull" to indicate
5422 that a connection on which no data has been transferred will not be logged,
Willy Tarreau0f228a02015-05-01 15:37:53 +02005423 which typically corresponds to those probes. Note that errors will still be
5424 returned to the client and accounted for in the stats. If this is not what is
5425 desired, option http-ignore-probes can be used instead.
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01005426
5427 It is generally recommended not to use this option in uncontrolled
5428 environments (eg: internet), otherwise scans and other malicious activities
5429 would not be logged.
5430
5431 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
5432 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
5433
Willy Tarreau0f228a02015-05-01 15:37:53 +02005434 See also : "log", "http-ignore-probes", "monitor-net", "monitor-uri", and
5435 section 8 about logging.
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01005436
5437
5438option forceclose
5439no option forceclose
5440 Enable or disable active connection closing after response is transferred.
5441 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreaua31e5df2009-12-30 01:10:35 +01005442 yes | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01005443 Arguments : none
5444
5445 Some HTTP servers do not necessarily close the connections when they receive
5446 the "Connection: close" set by "option httpclose", and if the client does not
5447 close either, then the connection remains open till the timeout expires. This
5448 causes high number of simultaneous connections on the servers and shows high
5449 global session times in the logs.
5450
5451 When this happens, it is possible to use "option forceclose". It will
Willy Tarreau82eeaf22009-12-29 12:09:05 +01005452 actively close the outgoing server channel as soon as the server has finished
Cyril Bonté653dcd62014-02-20 00:13:15 +01005453 to respond and release some resources earlier than with "option httpclose".
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01005454
Willy Tarreau8a8e1d92010-04-05 16:15:16 +02005455 This option may also be combined with "option http-pretend-keepalive", which
5456 will disable sending of the "Connection: close" header, but will still cause
5457 the connection to be closed once the whole response is received.
5458
Cyril Bonté653dcd62014-02-20 00:13:15 +01005459 This option disables and replaces any previous "option httpclose", "option
5460 http-server-close", "option http-keep-alive", or "option http-tunnel".
Willy Tarreau02bce8b2014-01-30 00:15:28 +01005461
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01005462 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
5463 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
5464
Willy Tarreau8a8e1d92010-04-05 16:15:16 +02005465 See also : "option httpclose" and "option http-pretend-keepalive"
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01005466
5467
Willy Tarreau87cf5142011-08-19 22:57:24 +02005468option forwardfor [ except <network> ] [ header <name> ] [ if-none ]
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01005469 Enable insertion of the X-Forwarded-For header to requests sent to servers
5470 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5471 yes | yes | yes | yes
5472 Arguments :
5473 <network> is an optional argument used to disable this option for sources
5474 matching <network>
Ross Westaf72a1d2008-08-03 10:51:45 +02005475 <name> an optional argument to specify a different "X-Forwarded-For"
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +01005476 header name.
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01005477
5478 Since HAProxy works in reverse-proxy mode, the servers see its IP address as
5479 their client address. This is sometimes annoying when the client's IP address
5480 is expected in server logs. To solve this problem, the well-known HTTP header
5481 "X-Forwarded-For" may be added by HAProxy to all requests sent to the server.
5482 This header contains a value representing the client's IP address. Since this
5483 header is always appended at the end of the existing header list, the server
5484 must be configured to always use the last occurrence of this header only. See
Ross Westaf72a1d2008-08-03 10:51:45 +02005485 the server's manual to find how to enable use of this standard header. Note
5486 that only the last occurrence of the header must be used, since it is really
5487 possible that the client has already brought one.
5488
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +01005489 The keyword "header" may be used to supply a different header name to replace
Ross Westaf72a1d2008-08-03 10:51:45 +02005490 the default "X-Forwarded-For". This can be useful where you might already
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +01005491 have a "X-Forwarded-For" header from a different application (eg: stunnel),
5492 and you need preserve it. Also if your backend server doesn't use the
Ross Westaf72a1d2008-08-03 10:51:45 +02005493 "X-Forwarded-For" header and requires different one (eg: Zeus Web Servers
5494 require "X-Cluster-Client-IP").
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01005495
5496 Sometimes, a same HAProxy instance may be shared between a direct client
5497 access and a reverse-proxy access (for instance when an SSL reverse-proxy is
5498 used to decrypt HTTPS traffic). It is possible to disable the addition of the
5499 header for a known source address or network by adding the "except" keyword
5500 followed by the network address. In this case, any source IP matching the
5501 network will not cause an addition of this header. Most common uses are with
5502 private networks or 127.0.0.1.
5503
Willy Tarreau87cf5142011-08-19 22:57:24 +02005504 Alternatively, the keyword "if-none" states that the header will only be
5505 added if it is not present. This should only be used in perfectly trusted
5506 environment, as this might cause a security issue if headers reaching haproxy
5507 are under the control of the end-user.
5508
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01005509 This option may be specified either in the frontend or in the backend. If at
Ross Westaf72a1d2008-08-03 10:51:45 +02005510 least one of them uses it, the header will be added. Note that the backend's
5511 setting of the header subargument takes precedence over the frontend's if
Willy Tarreau87cf5142011-08-19 22:57:24 +02005512 both are defined. In the case of the "if-none" argument, if at least one of
5513 the frontend or the backend does not specify it, it wants the addition to be
5514 mandatory, so it wins.
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01005515
Olivier Doucetaa1ea8a2016-08-05 17:15:20 +02005516 Example :
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01005517 # Public HTTP address also used by stunnel on the same machine
5518 frontend www
5519 mode http
5520 option forwardfor except 127.0.0.1 # stunnel already adds the header
5521
Ross Westaf72a1d2008-08-03 10:51:45 +02005522 # Those servers want the IP Address in X-Client
5523 backend www
5524 mode http
5525 option forwardfor header X-Client
5526
Willy Tarreau87cf5142011-08-19 22:57:24 +02005527 See also : "option httpclose", "option http-server-close",
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +01005528 "option forceclose", "option http-keep-alive"
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01005529
Willy Tarreau8a8e1d92010-04-05 16:15:16 +02005530
Willy Tarreau9fbe18e2015-05-01 22:42:08 +02005531option http-buffer-request
5532no option http-buffer-request
5533 Enable or disable waiting for whole HTTP request body before proceeding
5534 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5535 yes | yes | yes | yes
5536 Arguments : none
5537
5538 It is sometimes desirable to wait for the body of an HTTP request before
5539 taking a decision. This is what is being done by "balance url_param" for
5540 example. The first use case is to buffer requests from slow clients before
5541 connecting to the server. Another use case consists in taking the routing
5542 decision based on the request body's contents. This option placed in a
5543 frontend or backend forces the HTTP processing to wait until either the whole
5544 body is received, or the request buffer is full, or the first chunk is
5545 complete in case of chunked encoding. It can have undesired side effects with
Tim Düsterhus4896c442016-11-29 02:15:19 +01005546 some applications abusing HTTP by expecting unbuffered transmissions between
Willy Tarreau9fbe18e2015-05-01 22:42:08 +02005547 the frontend and the backend, so this should definitely not be used by
5548 default.
5549
Baptiste Assmanneccdf432015-10-28 13:49:01 +01005550 See also : "option http-no-delay", "timeout http-request"
Willy Tarreau9fbe18e2015-05-01 22:42:08 +02005551
5552
Willy Tarreau0f228a02015-05-01 15:37:53 +02005553option http-ignore-probes
5554no option http-ignore-probes
5555 Enable or disable logging of null connections and request timeouts
5556 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5557 yes | yes | yes | no
5558 Arguments : none
5559
5560 Recently some browsers started to implement a "pre-connect" feature
5561 consisting in speculatively connecting to some recently visited web sites
5562 just in case the user would like to visit them. This results in many
5563 connections being established to web sites, which end up in 408 Request
5564 Timeout if the timeout strikes first, or 400 Bad Request when the browser
5565 decides to close them first. These ones pollute the log and feed the error
5566 counters. There was already "option dontlognull" but it's insufficient in
5567 this case. Instead, this option does the following things :
5568 - prevent any 400/408 message from being sent to the client if nothing
5569 was received over a connection before it was closed ;
5570 - prevent any log from being emitted in this situation ;
5571 - prevent any error counter from being incremented
5572
5573 That way the empty connection is silently ignored. Note that it is better
5574 not to use this unless it is clear that it is needed, because it will hide
5575 real problems. The most common reason for not receiving a request and seeing
5576 a 408 is due to an MTU inconsistency between the client and an intermediary
5577 element such as a VPN, which blocks too large packets. These issues are
5578 generally seen with POST requests as well as GET with large cookies. The logs
5579 are often the only way to detect them.
5580
5581 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
5582 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
5583
5584 See also : "log", "dontlognull", "errorfile", and section 8 about logging.
5585
5586
Willy Tarreau16bfb022010-01-16 19:48:41 +01005587option http-keep-alive
5588no option http-keep-alive
5589 Enable or disable HTTP keep-alive from client to server
5590 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5591 yes | yes | yes | yes
5592 Arguments : none
5593
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +01005594 By default HAProxy operates in keep-alive mode with regards to persistent
5595 connections: for each connection it processes each request and response, and
5596 leaves the connection idle on both sides between the end of a response and the
5597 start of a new request. This mode may be changed by several options such as
5598 "option http-server-close", "option forceclose", "option httpclose" or
5599 "option http-tunnel". This option allows to set back the keep-alive mode,
5600 which can be useful when another mode was used in a defaults section.
5601
5602 Setting "option http-keep-alive" enables HTTP keep-alive mode on the client-
5603 and server- sides. This provides the lowest latency on the client side (slow
Willy Tarreau16bfb022010-01-16 19:48:41 +01005604 network) and the fastest session reuse on the server side at the expense
5605 of maintaining idle connections to the servers. In general, it is possible
5606 with this option to achieve approximately twice the request rate that the
5607 "http-server-close" option achieves on small objects. There are mainly two
5608 situations where this option may be useful :
5609
5610 - when the server is non-HTTP compliant and authenticates the connection
5611 instead of requests (eg: NTLM authentication)
5612
5613 - when the cost of establishing the connection to the server is significant
5614 compared to the cost of retrieving the associated object from the server.
5615
5616 This last case can happen when the server is a fast static server of cache.
5617 In this case, the server will need to be properly tuned to support high enough
5618 connection counts because connections will last until the client sends another
5619 request.
5620
5621 If the client request has to go to another backend or another server due to
5622 content switching or the load balancing algorithm, the idle connection will
Willy Tarreau9420b122013-12-15 18:58:25 +01005623 immediately be closed and a new one re-opened. Option "prefer-last-server" is
5624 available to try optimize server selection so that if the server currently
5625 attached to an idle connection is usable, it will be used.
Willy Tarreau16bfb022010-01-16 19:48:41 +01005626
5627 In general it is preferred to use "option http-server-close" with application
5628 servers, and some static servers might benefit from "option http-keep-alive".
5629
5630 At the moment, logs will not indicate whether requests came from the same
5631 session or not. The accept date reported in the logs corresponds to the end
5632 of the previous request, and the request time corresponds to the time spent
5633 waiting for a new request. The keep-alive request time is still bound to the
5634 timeout defined by "timeout http-keep-alive" or "timeout http-request" if
5635 not set.
5636
Cyril Bonté653dcd62014-02-20 00:13:15 +01005637 This option disables and replaces any previous "option httpclose", "option
5638 http-server-close", "option forceclose" or "option http-tunnel". When backend
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +01005639 and frontend options differ, all of these 4 options have precedence over
Cyril Bonté653dcd62014-02-20 00:13:15 +01005640 "option http-keep-alive".
Willy Tarreau16bfb022010-01-16 19:48:41 +01005641
5642 See also : "option forceclose", "option http-server-close",
Willy Tarreau9420b122013-12-15 18:58:25 +01005643 "option prefer-last-server", "option http-pretend-keepalive",
5644 "option httpclose", and "1.1. The HTTP transaction model".
Willy Tarreau16bfb022010-01-16 19:48:41 +01005645
5646
Willy Tarreau96e31212011-05-30 18:10:30 +02005647option http-no-delay
5648no option http-no-delay
5649 Instruct the system to favor low interactive delays over performance in HTTP
5650 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5651 yes | yes | yes | yes
5652 Arguments : none
5653
5654 In HTTP, each payload is unidirectional and has no notion of interactivity.
5655 Any agent is expected to queue data somewhat for a reasonably low delay.
5656 There are some very rare server-to-server applications that abuse the HTTP
5657 protocol and expect the payload phase to be highly interactive, with many
5658 interleaved data chunks in both directions within a single request. This is
5659 absolutely not supported by the HTTP specification and will not work across
5660 most proxies or servers. When such applications attempt to do this through
5661 haproxy, it works but they will experience high delays due to the network
5662 optimizations which favor performance by instructing the system to wait for
5663 enough data to be available in order to only send full packets. Typical
5664 delays are around 200 ms per round trip. Note that this only happens with
5665 abnormal uses. Normal uses such as CONNECT requests nor WebSockets are not
5666 affected.
5667
5668 When "option http-no-delay" is present in either the frontend or the backend
5669 used by a connection, all such optimizations will be disabled in order to
5670 make the exchanges as fast as possible. Of course this offers no guarantee on
5671 the functionality, as it may break at any other place. But if it works via
5672 HAProxy, it will work as fast as possible. This option should never be used
5673 by default, and should never be used at all unless such a buggy application
5674 is discovered. The impact of using this option is an increase of bandwidth
5675 usage and CPU usage, which may significantly lower performance in high
5676 latency environments.
5677
Willy Tarreau9fbe18e2015-05-01 22:42:08 +02005678 See also : "option http-buffer-request"
5679
Willy Tarreau96e31212011-05-30 18:10:30 +02005680
Willy Tarreau8a8e1d92010-04-05 16:15:16 +02005681option http-pretend-keepalive
5682no option http-pretend-keepalive
5683 Define whether haproxy will announce keepalive to the server or not
5684 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5685 yes | yes | yes | yes
5686 Arguments : none
5687
5688 When running with "option http-server-close" or "option forceclose", haproxy
5689 adds a "Connection: close" header to the request forwarded to the server.
5690 Unfortunately, when some servers see this header, they automatically refrain
5691 from using the chunked encoding for responses of unknown length, while this
5692 is totally unrelated. The immediate effect is that this prevents haproxy from
5693 maintaining the client connection alive. A second effect is that a client or
5694 a cache could receive an incomplete response without being aware of it, and
5695 consider the response complete.
5696
5697 By setting "option http-pretend-keepalive", haproxy will make the server
5698 believe it will keep the connection alive. The server will then not fall back
5699 to the abnormal undesired above. When haproxy gets the whole response, it
5700 will close the connection with the server just as it would do with the
5701 "forceclose" option. That way the client gets a normal response and the
5702 connection is correctly closed on the server side.
5703
5704 It is recommended not to enable this option by default, because most servers
5705 will more efficiently close the connection themselves after the last packet,
5706 and release its buffers slightly earlier. Also, the added packet on the
5707 network could slightly reduce the overall peak performance. However it is
5708 worth noting that when this option is enabled, haproxy will have slightly
5709 less work to do. So if haproxy is the bottleneck on the whole architecture,
5710 enabling this option might save a few CPU cycles.
5711
5712 This option may be set both in a frontend and in a backend. It is enabled if
5713 at least one of the frontend or backend holding a connection has it enabled.
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -04005714 This option may be combined with "option httpclose", which will cause
Willy Tarreau22a95342010-09-29 14:31:41 +02005715 keepalive to be announced to the server and close to be announced to the
5716 client. This practice is discouraged though.
Willy Tarreau8a8e1d92010-04-05 16:15:16 +02005717
5718 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
5719 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
5720
Willy Tarreau16bfb022010-01-16 19:48:41 +01005721 See also : "option forceclose", "option http-server-close", and
5722 "option http-keep-alive"
Willy Tarreau8a8e1d92010-04-05 16:15:16 +02005723
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01005724
Willy Tarreaub608feb2010-01-02 22:47:18 +01005725option http-server-close
5726no option http-server-close
5727 Enable or disable HTTP connection closing on the server side
5728 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5729 yes | yes | yes | yes
5730 Arguments : none
5731
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +01005732 By default HAProxy operates in keep-alive mode with regards to persistent
5733 connections: for each connection it processes each request and response, and
5734 leaves the connection idle on both sides between the end of a response and
5735 the start of a new request. This mode may be changed by several options such
5736 as "option http-server-close", "option forceclose", "option httpclose" or
5737 "option http-tunnel". Setting "option http-server-close" enables HTTP
5738 connection-close mode on the server side while keeping the ability to support
5739 HTTP keep-alive and pipelining on the client side. This provides the lowest
5740 latency on the client side (slow network) and the fastest session reuse on
5741 the server side to save server resources, similarly to "option forceclose".
5742 It also permits non-keepalive capable servers to be served in keep-alive mode
Lukas Tribus23953682017-04-28 13:24:30 +00005743 to the clients if they conform to the requirements of RFC7230. Please note
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +01005744 that some servers do not always conform to those requirements when they see
5745 "Connection: close" in the request. The effect will be that keep-alive will
5746 never be used. A workaround consists in enabling "option
5747 http-pretend-keepalive".
Willy Tarreaub608feb2010-01-02 22:47:18 +01005748
5749 At the moment, logs will not indicate whether requests came from the same
5750 session or not. The accept date reported in the logs corresponds to the end
5751 of the previous request, and the request time corresponds to the time spent
5752 waiting for a new request. The keep-alive request time is still bound to the
Willy Tarreaub16a5742010-01-10 14:46:16 +01005753 timeout defined by "timeout http-keep-alive" or "timeout http-request" if
5754 not set.
Willy Tarreaub608feb2010-01-02 22:47:18 +01005755
5756 This option may be set both in a frontend and in a backend. It is enabled if
5757 at least one of the frontend or backend holding a connection has it enabled.
Cyril Bonté653dcd62014-02-20 00:13:15 +01005758 It disables and replaces any previous "option httpclose", "option forceclose",
5759 "option http-tunnel" or "option http-keep-alive". Please check section 4
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +01005760 ("Proxies") to see how this option combines with others when frontend and
5761 backend options differ.
Willy Tarreaub608feb2010-01-02 22:47:18 +01005762
5763 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
5764 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
5765
Patrick Mezard9ec2ec42010-06-12 17:02:45 +02005766 See also : "option forceclose", "option http-pretend-keepalive",
Willy Tarreau16bfb022010-01-16 19:48:41 +01005767 "option httpclose", "option http-keep-alive", and
5768 "1.1. The HTTP transaction model".
Willy Tarreaub608feb2010-01-02 22:47:18 +01005769
5770
Willy Tarreau02bce8b2014-01-30 00:15:28 +01005771option http-tunnel
5772no option http-tunnel
5773 Disable or enable HTTP connection processing after first transaction
5774 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5775 yes | yes | yes | yes
5776 Arguments : none
5777
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +01005778 By default HAProxy operates in keep-alive mode with regards to persistent
5779 connections: for each connection it processes each request and response, and
5780 leaves the connection idle on both sides between the end of a response and
5781 the start of a new request. This mode may be changed by several options such
5782 as "option http-server-close", "option forceclose", "option httpclose" or
5783 "option http-tunnel".
5784
5785 Option "http-tunnel" disables any HTTP processing past the first request and
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03005786 the first response. This is the mode which was used by default in versions
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +01005787 1.0 to 1.5-dev21. It is the mode with the lowest processing overhead, which
5788 is normally not needed anymore unless in very specific cases such as when
5789 using an in-house protocol that looks like HTTP but is not compatible, or
5790 just to log one request per client in order to reduce log size. Note that
5791 everything which works at the HTTP level, including header parsing/addition,
5792 cookie processing or content switching will only work for the first request
5793 and will be ignored after the first response.
Willy Tarreau02bce8b2014-01-30 00:15:28 +01005794
5795 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
5796 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
5797
5798 See also : "option forceclose", "option http-server-close",
5799 "option httpclose", "option http-keep-alive", and
5800 "1.1. The HTTP transaction model".
5801
5802
Willy Tarreau88d349d2010-01-25 12:15:43 +01005803option http-use-proxy-header
Cyril Bontéf0c60612010-02-06 14:44:47 +01005804no option http-use-proxy-header
Willy Tarreau88d349d2010-01-25 12:15:43 +01005805 Make use of non-standard Proxy-Connection header instead of Connection
5806 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5807 yes | yes | yes | no
5808 Arguments : none
5809
Lukas Tribus23953682017-04-28 13:24:30 +00005810 While RFC7230 explicitly states that HTTP/1.1 agents must use the
Willy Tarreau88d349d2010-01-25 12:15:43 +01005811 Connection header to indicate their wish of persistent or non-persistent
5812 connections, both browsers and proxies ignore this header for proxied
5813 connections and make use of the undocumented, non-standard Proxy-Connection
5814 header instead. The issue begins when trying to put a load balancer between
5815 browsers and such proxies, because there will be a difference between what
5816 haproxy understands and what the client and the proxy agree on.
5817
5818 By setting this option in a frontend, haproxy can automatically switch to use
5819 that non-standard header if it sees proxied requests. A proxied request is
Lukas Tribusf01a9cd2016-02-03 18:09:37 +01005820 defined here as one where the URI begins with neither a '/' nor a '*'. This
5821 is incompatible with the HTTP tunnel mode. Note that this option can only be
5822 specified in a frontend and will affect the request along its whole life.
Willy Tarreau88d349d2010-01-25 12:15:43 +01005823
Willy Tarreau844a7e72010-01-31 21:46:18 +01005824 Also, when this option is set, a request which requires authentication will
5825 automatically switch to use proxy authentication headers if it is itself a
5826 proxied request. That makes it possible to check or enforce authentication in
5827 front of an existing proxy.
5828
Willy Tarreau88d349d2010-01-25 12:15:43 +01005829 This option should normally never be used, except in front of a proxy.
5830
5831 See also : "option httpclose", "option forceclose" and "option
5832 http-server-close".
5833
5834
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01005835option httpchk
5836option httpchk <uri>
5837option httpchk <method> <uri>
5838option httpchk <method> <uri> <version>
5839 Enable HTTP protocol to check on the servers health
5840 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5841 yes | no | yes | yes
5842 Arguments :
5843 <method> is the optional HTTP method used with the requests. When not set,
5844 the "OPTIONS" method is used, as it generally requires low server
5845 processing and is easy to filter out from the logs. Any method
5846 may be used, though it is not recommended to invent non-standard
5847 ones.
5848
5849 <uri> is the URI referenced in the HTTP requests. It defaults to " / "
5850 which is accessible by default on almost any server, but may be
5851 changed to any other URI. Query strings are permitted.
5852
5853 <version> is the optional HTTP version string. It defaults to "HTTP/1.0"
5854 but some servers might behave incorrectly in HTTP 1.0, so turning
5855 it to HTTP/1.1 may sometimes help. Note that the Host field is
5856 mandatory in HTTP/1.1, and as a trick, it is possible to pass it
5857 after "\r\n" following the version string.
5858
5859 By default, server health checks only consist in trying to establish a TCP
5860 connection. When "option httpchk" is specified, a complete HTTP request is
5861 sent once the TCP connection is established, and responses 2xx and 3xx are
5862 considered valid, while all other ones indicate a server failure, including
5863 the lack of any response.
5864
5865 The port and interval are specified in the server configuration.
5866
5867 This option does not necessarily require an HTTP backend, it also works with
5868 plain TCP backends. This is particularly useful to check simple scripts bound
5869 to some dedicated ports using the inetd daemon.
5870
5871 Examples :
5872 # Relay HTTPS traffic to Apache instance and check service availability
5873 # using HTTP request "OPTIONS * HTTP/1.1" on port 80.
5874 backend https_relay
5875 mode tcp
5876 option httpchk OPTIONS * HTTP/1.1\r\nHost:\ www
5877 server apache1 192.168.1.1:443 check port 80
5878
Simon Hormanafc47ee2013-11-25 10:46:35 +09005879 See also : "option ssl-hello-chk", "option smtpchk", "option mysql-check",
5880 "option pgsql-check", "http-check" and the "check", "port" and
5881 "inter" server options.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01005882
5883
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01005884option httpclose
5885no option httpclose
5886 Enable or disable passive HTTP connection closing
5887 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5888 yes | yes | yes | yes
5889 Arguments : none
5890
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +01005891 By default HAProxy operates in keep-alive mode with regards to persistent
5892 connections: for each connection it processes each request and response, and
5893 leaves the connection idle on both sides between the end of a response and
5894 the start of a new request. This mode may be changed by several options such
Cyril Bonté653dcd62014-02-20 00:13:15 +01005895 as "option http-server-close", "option forceclose", "option httpclose" or
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +01005896 "option http-tunnel".
5897
5898 If "option httpclose" is set, HAProxy will work in HTTP tunnel mode and check
5899 if a "Connection: close" header is already set in each direction, and will
5900 add one if missing. Each end should react to this by actively closing the TCP
5901 connection after each transfer, thus resulting in a switch to the HTTP close
5902 mode. Any "Connection" header different from "close" will also be removed.
5903 Note that this option is deprecated since what it does is very cheap but not
5904 reliable. Using "option http-server-close" or "option forceclose" is strongly
5905 recommended instead.
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01005906
5907 It seldom happens that some servers incorrectly ignore this header and do not
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -04005908 close the connection even though they reply "Connection: close". For this
Willy Tarreau0dfdf192010-01-05 11:33:11 +01005909 reason, they are not compatible with older HTTP 1.0 browsers. If this happens
5910 it is possible to use the "option forceclose" which actively closes the
5911 request connection once the server responds. Option "forceclose" also
5912 releases the server connection earlier because it does not have to wait for
5913 the client to acknowledge it.
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01005914
5915 This option may be set both in a frontend and in a backend. It is enabled if
5916 at least one of the frontend or backend holding a connection has it enabled.
Cyril Bonté653dcd62014-02-20 00:13:15 +01005917 It disables and replaces any previous "option http-server-close",
5918 "option forceclose", "option http-keep-alive" or "option http-tunnel". Please
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +01005919 check section 4 ("Proxies") to see how this option combines with others when
5920 frontend and backend options differ.
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01005921
5922 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
5923 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
5924
Patrick Mezard9ec2ec42010-06-12 17:02:45 +02005925 See also : "option forceclose", "option http-server-close" and
5926 "1.1. The HTTP transaction model".
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01005927
5928
Emeric Brun3a058f32009-06-30 18:26:00 +02005929option httplog [ clf ]
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01005930 Enable logging of HTTP request, session state and timers
5931 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5932 yes | yes | yes | yes
Emeric Brun3a058f32009-06-30 18:26:00 +02005933 Arguments :
5934 clf if the "clf" argument is added, then the output format will be
5935 the CLF format instead of HAProxy's default HTTP format. You can
5936 use this when you need to feed HAProxy's logs through a specific
5937 log analyser which only support the CLF format and which is not
5938 extensible.
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01005939
5940 By default, the log output format is very poor, as it only contains the
5941 source and destination addresses, and the instance name. By specifying
5942 "option httplog", each log line turns into a much richer format including,
5943 but not limited to, the HTTP request, the connection timers, the session
5944 status, the connections numbers, the captured headers and cookies, the
5945 frontend, backend and server name, and of course the source address and
5946 ports.
5947
5948 This option may be set either in the frontend or the backend.
5949
PiBa-NLbd556bf2014-12-11 21:31:54 +01005950 Specifying only "option httplog" will automatically clear the 'clf' mode
5951 if it was set by default.
Emeric Brun3a058f32009-06-30 18:26:00 +02005952
Guillaume de Lafond29f45602017-03-31 19:52:15 +02005953 "option httplog" overrides any previous "log-format" directive.
5954
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02005955 See also : section 8 about logging.
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01005956
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +02005957
5958option http_proxy
5959no option http_proxy
5960 Enable or disable plain HTTP proxy mode
5961 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5962 yes | yes | yes | yes
5963 Arguments : none
5964
5965 It sometimes happens that people need a pure HTTP proxy which understands
5966 basic proxy requests without caching nor any fancy feature. In this case,
5967 it may be worth setting up an HAProxy instance with the "option http_proxy"
5968 set. In this mode, no server is declared, and the connection is forwarded to
5969 the IP address and port found in the URL after the "http://" scheme.
5970
5971 No host address resolution is performed, so this only works when pure IP
5972 addresses are passed. Since this option's usage perimeter is rather limited,
Lukas Tribusf01a9cd2016-02-03 18:09:37 +01005973 it will probably be used only by experts who know they need exactly it. This
5974 is incompatible with the HTTP tunnel mode.
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +02005975
5976 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
5977 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
5978
5979 Example :
5980 # this backend understands HTTP proxy requests and forwards them directly.
5981 backend direct_forward
5982 option httpclose
5983 option http_proxy
5984
5985 See also : "option httpclose"
5986
Willy Tarreau211ad242009-10-03 21:45:07 +02005987
Jamie Gloudon801a0a32012-08-25 00:18:33 -04005988option independent-streams
5989no option independent-streams
5990 Enable or disable independent timeout processing for both directions
Willy Tarreauf27b5ea2009-10-03 22:01:18 +02005991 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5992 yes | yes | yes | yes
5993 Arguments : none
5994
5995 By default, when data is sent over a socket, both the write timeout and the
5996 read timeout for that socket are refreshed, because we consider that there is
5997 activity on that socket, and we have no other means of guessing if we should
5998 receive data or not.
5999
6000 While this default behaviour is desirable for almost all applications, there
6001 exists a situation where it is desirable to disable it, and only refresh the
6002 read timeout if there are incoming data. This happens on sessions with large
6003 timeouts and low amounts of exchanged data such as telnet session. If the
6004 server suddenly disappears, the output data accumulates in the system's
6005 socket buffers, both timeouts are correctly refreshed, and there is no way
6006 to know the server does not receive them, so we don't timeout. However, when
6007 the underlying protocol always echoes sent data, it would be enough by itself
6008 to detect the issue using the read timeout. Note that this problem does not
6009 happen with more verbose protocols because data won't accumulate long in the
6010 socket buffers.
6011
6012 When this option is set on the frontend, it will disable read timeout updates
6013 on data sent to the client. There probably is little use of this case. When
6014 the option is set on the backend, it will disable read timeout updates on
6015 data sent to the server. Doing so will typically break large HTTP posts from
6016 slow lines, so use it with caution.
6017
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03006018 Note: older versions used to call this setting "option independent-streams"
Jamie Gloudon801a0a32012-08-25 00:18:33 -04006019 with a spelling mistake. This spelling is still supported but
6020 deprecated.
6021
Willy Tarreauce887fd2012-05-12 12:50:00 +02006022 See also : "timeout client", "timeout server" and "timeout tunnel"
Willy Tarreauf27b5ea2009-10-03 22:01:18 +02006023
6024
Gabor Lekenyb4c81e42010-09-29 18:17:05 +02006025option ldap-check
6026 Use LDAPv3 health checks for server testing
6027 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6028 yes | no | yes | yes
6029 Arguments : none
6030
6031 It is possible to test that the server correctly talks LDAPv3 instead of just
6032 testing that it accepts the TCP connection. When this option is set, an
6033 LDAPv3 anonymous simple bind message is sent to the server, and the response
6034 is analyzed to find an LDAPv3 bind response message.
6035
6036 The server is considered valid only when the LDAP response contains success
6037 resultCode (http://tools.ietf.org/html/rfc4511#section-4.1.9).
6038
6039 Logging of bind requests is server dependent see your documentation how to
6040 configure it.
6041
6042 Example :
6043 option ldap-check
6044
6045 See also : "option httpchk"
6046
6047
Simon Horman98637e52014-06-20 12:30:16 +09006048option external-check
6049 Use external processes for server health checks
6050 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6051 yes | no | yes | yes
6052
6053 It is possible to test the health of a server using an external command.
6054 This is achieved by running the executable set using "external-check
6055 command".
6056
6057 Requires the "external-check" global to be set.
6058
6059 See also : "external-check", "external-check command", "external-check path"
6060
6061
Willy Tarreau211ad242009-10-03 21:45:07 +02006062option log-health-checks
6063no option log-health-checks
Willy Tarreaubef1b322014-05-13 21:01:39 +02006064 Enable or disable logging of health checks status updates
Willy Tarreau211ad242009-10-03 21:45:07 +02006065 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6066 yes | no | yes | yes
6067 Arguments : none
6068
Willy Tarreaubef1b322014-05-13 21:01:39 +02006069 By default, failed health check are logged if server is UP and successful
6070 health checks are logged if server is DOWN, so the amount of additional
6071 information is limited.
Willy Tarreau211ad242009-10-03 21:45:07 +02006072
Willy Tarreaubef1b322014-05-13 21:01:39 +02006073 When this option is enabled, any change of the health check status or to
6074 the server's health will be logged, so that it becomes possible to know
6075 that a server was failing occasional checks before crashing, or exactly when
6076 it failed to respond a valid HTTP status, then when the port started to
6077 reject connections, then when the server stopped responding at all.
6078
6079 Note that status changes not caused by health checks (eg: enable/disable on
6080 the CLI) are intentionally not logged by this option.
Willy Tarreau211ad242009-10-03 21:45:07 +02006081
Willy Tarreaubef1b322014-05-13 21:01:39 +02006082 See also: "option httpchk", "option ldap-check", "option mysql-check",
6083 "option pgsql-check", "option redis-check", "option smtpchk",
6084 "option tcp-check", "log" and section 8 about logging.
Willy Tarreau211ad242009-10-03 21:45:07 +02006085
Willy Tarreauc9bd0cc2009-05-10 11:57:02 +02006086
6087option log-separate-errors
6088no option log-separate-errors
6089 Change log level for non-completely successful connections
6090 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6091 yes | yes | yes | no
6092 Arguments : none
6093
6094 Sometimes looking for errors in logs is not easy. This option makes haproxy
6095 raise the level of logs containing potentially interesting information such
6096 as errors, timeouts, retries, redispatches, or HTTP status codes 5xx. The
6097 level changes from "info" to "err". This makes it possible to log them
6098 separately to a different file with most syslog daemons. Be careful not to
6099 remove them from the original file, otherwise you would lose ordering which
6100 provides very important information.
6101
6102 Using this option, large sites dealing with several thousand connections per
6103 second may log normal traffic to a rotating buffer and only archive smaller
6104 error logs.
6105
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02006106 See also : "log", "dontlognull", "dontlog-normal" and section 8 about
Willy Tarreauc9bd0cc2009-05-10 11:57:02 +02006107 logging.
6108
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01006109
6110option logasap
6111no option logasap
6112 Enable or disable early logging of HTTP requests
6113 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6114 yes | yes | yes | no
6115 Arguments : none
6116
6117 By default, HTTP requests are logged upon termination so that the total
6118 transfer time and the number of bytes appear in the logs. When large objects
6119 are being transferred, it may take a while before the request appears in the
6120 logs. Using "option logasap", the request gets logged as soon as the server
6121 sends the complete headers. The only missing information in the logs will be
6122 the total number of bytes which will indicate everything except the amount
6123 of data transferred, and the total time which will not take the transfer
Willy Tarreaud2a4aa22008-01-31 15:28:22 +01006124 time into account. In such a situation, it's a good practice to capture the
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01006125 "Content-Length" response header so that the logs at least indicate how many
6126 bytes are expected to be transferred.
6127
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +01006128 Examples :
6129 listen http_proxy 0.0.0.0:80
6130 mode http
6131 option httplog
6132 option logasap
6133 log 192.168.2.200 local3
6134
6135 >>> Feb 6 12:14:14 localhost \
6136 haproxy[14389]: 10.0.1.2:33317 [06/Feb/2009:12:14:14.655] http-in \
6137 static/srv1 9/10/7/14/+30 200 +243 - - ---- 3/1/1/1/0 1/0 \
6138 "GET /image.iso HTTP/1.0"
6139
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02006140 See also : "option httplog", "capture response header", and section 8 about
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01006141 logging.
6142
6143
Nenad Merdanovic6639a7c2014-05-30 14:26:32 +02006144option mysql-check [ user <username> [ post-41 ] ]
Hervé COMMOWICK8776f1b2010-10-18 15:58:36 +02006145 Use MySQL health checks for server testing
Hervé COMMOWICK698ae002010-01-12 09:25:13 +01006146 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6147 yes | no | yes | yes
Hervé COMMOWICK8776f1b2010-10-18 15:58:36 +02006148 Arguments :
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +02006149 <username> This is the username which will be used when connecting to MySQL
6150 server.
Nenad Merdanovic6639a7c2014-05-30 14:26:32 +02006151 post-41 Send post v4.1 client compatible checks
Hervé COMMOWICK8776f1b2010-10-18 15:58:36 +02006152
6153 If you specify a username, the check consists of sending two MySQL packet,
6154 one Client Authentication packet, and one QUIT packet, to correctly close
6155 MySQL session. We then parse the MySQL Handshake Initialisation packet and/or
6156 Error packet. It is a basic but useful test which does not produce error nor
6157 aborted connect on the server. However, it requires adding an authorization
6158 in the MySQL table, like this :
6159
6160 USE mysql;
6161 INSERT INTO user (Host,User) values ('<ip_of_haproxy>','<username>');
6162 FLUSH PRIVILEGES;
6163
6164 If you don't specify a username (it is deprecated and not recommended), the
6165 check only consists in parsing the Mysql Handshake Initialisation packet or
6166 Error packet, we don't send anything in this mode. It was reported that it
6167 can generate lockout if check is too frequent and/or if there is not enough
6168 traffic. In fact, you need in this case to check MySQL "max_connect_errors"
6169 value as if a connection is established successfully within fewer than MySQL
6170 "max_connect_errors" attempts after a previous connection was interrupted,
6171 the error count for the host is cleared to zero. If HAProxy's server get
6172 blocked, the "FLUSH HOSTS" statement is the only way to unblock it.
6173
6174 Remember that this does not check database presence nor database consistency.
6175 To do this, you can use an external check with xinetd for example.
Hervé COMMOWICK698ae002010-01-12 09:25:13 +01006176
Hervé COMMOWICK212f7782011-06-10 14:05:59 +02006177 The check requires MySQL >=3.22, for older version, please use TCP check.
Hervé COMMOWICK698ae002010-01-12 09:25:13 +01006178
6179 Most often, an incoming MySQL server needs to see the client's IP address for
6180 various purposes, including IP privilege matching and connection logging.
6181 When possible, it is often wise to masquerade the client's IP address when
6182 connecting to the server using the "usesrc" argument of the "source" keyword,
Willy Tarreau29fbe512015-08-20 19:35:14 +02006183 which requires the transparent proxy feature to be compiled in, and the MySQL
6184 server to route the client via the machine hosting haproxy.
Hervé COMMOWICK698ae002010-01-12 09:25:13 +01006185
6186 See also: "option httpchk"
6187
6188
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01006189option nolinger
6190no option nolinger
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01006191 Enable or disable immediate session resource cleaning after close
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01006192 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6193 yes | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01006194 Arguments : none
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01006195
6196 When clients or servers abort connections in a dirty way (eg: they are
6197 physically disconnected), the session timeouts triggers and the session is
6198 closed. But it will remain in FIN_WAIT1 state for some time in the system,
6199 using some resources and possibly limiting the ability to establish newer
6200 connections.
6201
6202 When this happens, it is possible to activate "option nolinger" which forces
6203 the system to immediately remove any socket's pending data on close. Thus,
6204 the session is instantly purged from the system's tables. This usually has
6205 side effects such as increased number of TCP resets due to old retransmits
6206 getting immediately rejected. Some firewalls may sometimes complain about
6207 this too.
6208
6209 For this reason, it is not recommended to use this option when not absolutely
6210 needed. You know that you need it when you have thousands of FIN_WAIT1
6211 sessions on your system (TIME_WAIT ones do not count).
6212
6213 This option may be used both on frontends and backends, depending on the side
6214 where it is required. Use it on the frontend for clients, and on the backend
6215 for servers.
6216
6217 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
6218 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
6219
6220
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +02006221option originalto [ except <network> ] [ header <name> ]
6222 Enable insertion of the X-Original-To header to requests sent to servers
6223 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6224 yes | yes | yes | yes
6225 Arguments :
6226 <network> is an optional argument used to disable this option for sources
6227 matching <network>
6228 <name> an optional argument to specify a different "X-Original-To"
6229 header name.
6230
6231 Since HAProxy can work in transparent mode, every request from a client can
6232 be redirected to the proxy and HAProxy itself can proxy every request to a
6233 complex SQUID environment and the destination host from SO_ORIGINAL_DST will
6234 be lost. This is annoying when you want access rules based on destination ip
6235 addresses. To solve this problem, a new HTTP header "X-Original-To" may be
6236 added by HAProxy to all requests sent to the server. This header contains a
6237 value representing the original destination IP address. Since this must be
6238 configured to always use the last occurrence of this header only. Note that
6239 only the last occurrence of the header must be used, since it is really
6240 possible that the client has already brought one.
6241
6242 The keyword "header" may be used to supply a different header name to replace
6243 the default "X-Original-To". This can be useful where you might already
6244 have a "X-Original-To" header from a different application, and you need
6245 preserve it. Also if your backend server doesn't use the "X-Original-To"
6246 header and requires different one.
6247
6248 Sometimes, a same HAProxy instance may be shared between a direct client
6249 access and a reverse-proxy access (for instance when an SSL reverse-proxy is
6250 used to decrypt HTTPS traffic). It is possible to disable the addition of the
6251 header for a known source address or network by adding the "except" keyword
6252 followed by the network address. In this case, any source IP matching the
6253 network will not cause an addition of this header. Most common uses are with
6254 private networks or 127.0.0.1.
6255
6256 This option may be specified either in the frontend or in the backend. If at
6257 least one of them uses it, the header will be added. Note that the backend's
6258 setting of the header subargument takes precedence over the frontend's if
6259 both are defined.
6260
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +02006261 Examples :
6262 # Original Destination address
6263 frontend www
6264 mode http
6265 option originalto except 127.0.0.1
6266
6267 # Those servers want the IP Address in X-Client-Dst
6268 backend www
6269 mode http
6270 option originalto header X-Client-Dst
6271
Willy Tarreau87cf5142011-08-19 22:57:24 +02006272 See also : "option httpclose", "option http-server-close",
6273 "option forceclose"
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +02006274
6275
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01006276option persist
6277no option persist
6278 Enable or disable forced persistence on down servers
6279 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6280 yes | no | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01006281 Arguments : none
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01006282
6283 When an HTTP request reaches a backend with a cookie which references a dead
6284 server, by default it is redispatched to another server. It is possible to
6285 force the request to be sent to the dead server first using "option persist"
6286 if absolutely needed. A common use case is when servers are under extreme
6287 load and spend their time flapping. In this case, the users would still be
6288 directed to the server they opened the session on, in the hope they would be
6289 correctly served. It is recommended to use "option redispatch" in conjunction
6290 with this option so that in the event it would not be possible to connect to
6291 the server at all (server definitely dead), the client would finally be
6292 redirected to another valid server.
6293
6294 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
6295 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
6296
Willy Tarreau4de91492010-01-22 19:10:05 +01006297 See also : "option redispatch", "retries", "force-persist"
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01006298
6299
Willy Tarreau0c122822013-12-15 18:49:01 +01006300option pgsql-check [ user <username> ]
6301 Use PostgreSQL health checks for server testing
6302 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6303 yes | no | yes | yes
6304 Arguments :
6305 <username> This is the username which will be used when connecting to
6306 PostgreSQL server.
6307
6308 The check sends a PostgreSQL StartupMessage and waits for either
6309 Authentication request or ErrorResponse message. It is a basic but useful
6310 test which does not produce error nor aborted connect on the server.
6311 This check is identical with the "mysql-check".
6312
6313 See also: "option httpchk"
6314
6315
Willy Tarreau9420b122013-12-15 18:58:25 +01006316option prefer-last-server
6317no option prefer-last-server
6318 Allow multiple load balanced requests to remain on the same server
6319 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6320 yes | no | yes | yes
6321 Arguments : none
6322
6323 When the load balancing algorithm in use is not deterministic, and a previous
6324 request was sent to a server to which haproxy still holds a connection, it is
6325 sometimes desirable that subsequent requests on a same session go to the same
6326 server as much as possible. Note that this is different from persistence, as
6327 we only indicate a preference which haproxy tries to apply without any form
6328 of warranty. The real use is for keep-alive connections sent to servers. When
6329 this option is used, haproxy will try to reuse the same connection that is
6330 attached to the server instead of rebalancing to another server, causing a
6331 close of the connection. This can make sense for static file servers. It does
Willy Tarreau068621e2013-12-23 15:11:25 +01006332 not make much sense to use this in combination with hashing algorithms. Note,
6333 haproxy already automatically tries to stick to a server which sends a 401 or
6334 to a proxy which sends a 407 (authentication required). This is mandatory for
6335 use with the broken NTLM authentication challenge, and significantly helps in
6336 troubleshooting some faulty applications. Option prefer-last-server might be
6337 desirable in these environments as well, to avoid redistributing the traffic
6338 after every other response.
Willy Tarreau9420b122013-12-15 18:58:25 +01006339
6340 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
6341 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
6342
6343 See also: "option http-keep-alive"
6344
6345
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki25b501a2008-01-06 16:36:16 +01006346option redispatch
Joseph Lynch726ab712015-05-11 23:25:34 -07006347option redispatch <interval>
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki25b501a2008-01-06 16:36:16 +01006348no option redispatch
6349 Enable or disable session redistribution in case of connection failure
6350 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6351 yes | no | yes | yes
Joseph Lynch726ab712015-05-11 23:25:34 -07006352 Arguments :
6353 <interval> The optional integer value that controls how often redispatches
6354 occur when retrying connections. Positive value P indicates a
6355 redispatch is desired on every Pth retry, and negative value
6356 N indicate a redispath is desired on the Nth retry prior to the
6357 last retry. For example, the default of -1 preserves the
6358 historical behaviour of redispatching on the last retry, a
6359 positive value of 1 would indicate a redispatch on every retry,
6360 and a positive value of 3 would indicate a redispatch on every
6361 third retry. You can disable redispatches with a value of 0.
6362
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki25b501a2008-01-06 16:36:16 +01006363
6364 In HTTP mode, if a server designated by a cookie is down, clients may
6365 definitely stick to it because they cannot flush the cookie, so they will not
6366 be able to access the service anymore.
6367
6368 Specifying "option redispatch" will allow the proxy to break their
6369 persistence and redistribute them to a working server.
6370
Joseph Lynch726ab712015-05-11 23:25:34 -07006371 It also allows to retry connections to another server in case of multiple
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki25b501a2008-01-06 16:36:16 +01006372 connection failures. Of course, it requires having "retries" set to a nonzero
6373 value.
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +01006374
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki25b501a2008-01-06 16:36:16 +01006375 This form is the preferred form, which replaces both the "redispatch" and
6376 "redisp" keywords.
6377
6378 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
6379 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
6380
Willy Tarreau4de91492010-01-22 19:10:05 +01006381 See also : "redispatch", "retries", "force-persist"
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki25b501a2008-01-06 16:36:16 +01006382
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01006383
Hervé COMMOWICKec032d62011-08-05 16:23:48 +02006384option redis-check
6385 Use redis health checks for server testing
6386 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6387 yes | no | yes | yes
6388 Arguments : none
6389
6390 It is possible to test that the server correctly talks REDIS protocol instead
6391 of just testing that it accepts the TCP connection. When this option is set,
6392 a PING redis command is sent to the server, and the response is analyzed to
6393 find the "+PONG" response message.
6394
6395 Example :
6396 option redis-check
6397
Jarno Huuskonene5ae7022017-04-03 14:36:21 +03006398 See also : "option httpchk", "option tcp-check", "tcp-check expect"
Hervé COMMOWICKec032d62011-08-05 16:23:48 +02006399
6400
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01006401option smtpchk
6402option smtpchk <hello> <domain>
6403 Use SMTP health checks for server testing
6404 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6405 yes | no | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +01006406 Arguments :
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01006407 <hello> is an optional argument. It is the "hello" command to use. It can
6408 be either "HELO" (for SMTP) or "EHLO" (for ESTMP). All other
6409 values will be turned into the default command ("HELO").
6410
6411 <domain> is the domain name to present to the server. It may only be
6412 specified (and is mandatory) if the hello command has been
6413 specified. By default, "localhost" is used.
6414
6415 When "option smtpchk" is set, the health checks will consist in TCP
6416 connections followed by an SMTP command. By default, this command is
6417 "HELO localhost". The server's return code is analyzed and only return codes
6418 starting with a "2" will be considered as valid. All other responses,
6419 including a lack of response will constitute an error and will indicate a
6420 dead server.
6421
6422 This test is meant to be used with SMTP servers or relays. Depending on the
6423 request, it is possible that some servers do not log each connection attempt,
6424 so you may want to experiment to improve the behaviour. Using telnet on port
6425 25 is often easier than adjusting the configuration.
6426
6427 Most often, an incoming SMTP server needs to see the client's IP address for
6428 various purposes, including spam filtering, anti-spoofing and logging. When
6429 possible, it is often wise to masquerade the client's IP address when
6430 connecting to the server using the "usesrc" argument of the "source" keyword,
Willy Tarreau29fbe512015-08-20 19:35:14 +02006431 which requires the transparent proxy feature to be compiled in.
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01006432
6433 Example :
6434 option smtpchk HELO mydomain.org
6435
6436 See also : "option httpchk", "source"
6437
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki25b501a2008-01-06 16:36:16 +01006438
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkiaeebf9b2009-10-04 15:43:17 +02006439option socket-stats
6440no option socket-stats
6441
6442 Enable or disable collecting & providing separate statistics for each socket.
6443 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6444 yes | yes | yes | no
6445
6446 Arguments : none
6447
6448
Willy Tarreauff4f82d2009-02-06 11:28:13 +01006449option splice-auto
6450no option splice-auto
6451 Enable or disable automatic kernel acceleration on sockets in both directions
6452 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6453 yes | yes | yes | yes
6454 Arguments : none
6455
6456 When this option is enabled either on a frontend or on a backend, haproxy
6457 will automatically evaluate the opportunity to use kernel tcp splicing to
6458 forward data between the client and the server, in either direction. Haproxy
6459 uses heuristics to estimate if kernel splicing might improve performance or
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01006460 not. Both directions are handled independently. Note that the heuristics used
Willy Tarreauff4f82d2009-02-06 11:28:13 +01006461 are not much aggressive in order to limit excessive use of splicing. This
6462 option requires splicing to be enabled at compile time, and may be globally
6463 disabled with the global option "nosplice". Since splice uses pipes, using it
6464 requires that there are enough spare pipes.
6465
6466 Important note: kernel-based TCP splicing is a Linux-specific feature which
6467 first appeared in kernel 2.6.25. It offers kernel-based acceleration to
6468 transfer data between sockets without copying these data to user-space, thus
6469 providing noticeable performance gains and CPU cycles savings. Since many
6470 early implementations are buggy, corrupt data and/or are inefficient, this
6471 feature is not enabled by default, and it should be used with extreme care.
6472 While it is not possible to detect the correctness of an implementation,
6473 2.6.29 is the first version offering a properly working implementation. In
6474 case of doubt, splicing may be globally disabled using the global "nosplice"
6475 keyword.
6476
6477 Example :
6478 option splice-auto
6479
6480 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
6481 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
6482
6483 See also : "option splice-request", "option splice-response", and global
6484 options "nosplice" and "maxpipes"
6485
6486
6487option splice-request
6488no option splice-request
6489 Enable or disable automatic kernel acceleration on sockets for requests
6490 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6491 yes | yes | yes | yes
6492 Arguments : none
6493
6494 When this option is enabled either on a frontend or on a backend, haproxy
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -04006495 will use kernel tcp splicing whenever possible to forward data going from
Willy Tarreauff4f82d2009-02-06 11:28:13 +01006496 the client to the server. It might still use the recv/send scheme if there
6497 are no spare pipes left. This option requires splicing to be enabled at
6498 compile time, and may be globally disabled with the global option "nosplice".
6499 Since splice uses pipes, using it requires that there are enough spare pipes.
6500
6501 Important note: see "option splice-auto" for usage limitations.
6502
6503 Example :
6504 option splice-request
6505
6506 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
6507 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
6508
6509 See also : "option splice-auto", "option splice-response", and global options
6510 "nosplice" and "maxpipes"
6511
6512
6513option splice-response
6514no option splice-response
6515 Enable or disable automatic kernel acceleration on sockets for responses
6516 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6517 yes | yes | yes | yes
6518 Arguments : none
6519
6520 When this option is enabled either on a frontend or on a backend, haproxy
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -04006521 will use kernel tcp splicing whenever possible to forward data going from
Willy Tarreauff4f82d2009-02-06 11:28:13 +01006522 the server to the client. It might still use the recv/send scheme if there
6523 are no spare pipes left. This option requires splicing to be enabled at
6524 compile time, and may be globally disabled with the global option "nosplice".
6525 Since splice uses pipes, using it requires that there are enough spare pipes.
6526
6527 Important note: see "option splice-auto" for usage limitations.
6528
6529 Example :
6530 option splice-response
6531
6532 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
6533 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
6534
6535 See also : "option splice-auto", "option splice-request", and global options
6536 "nosplice" and "maxpipes"
6537
6538
Christopher Fauletba7bc162016-11-07 21:07:38 +01006539option spop-check
6540 Use SPOP health checks for server testing
6541 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6542 no | no | no | yes
6543 Arguments : none
6544
6545 It is possible to test that the server correctly talks SPOP protocol instead
6546 of just testing that it accepts the TCP connection. When this option is set,
6547 a HELLO handshake is performed between HAProxy and the server, and the
6548 response is analyzed to check no error is reported.
6549
6550 Example :
6551 option spop-check
6552
6553 See also : "option httpchk"
6554
6555
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01006556option srvtcpka
6557no option srvtcpka
6558 Enable or disable the sending of TCP keepalive packets on the server side
6559 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6560 yes | no | yes | yes
6561 Arguments : none
6562
6563 When there is a firewall or any session-aware component between a client and
6564 a server, and when the protocol involves very long sessions with long idle
6565 periods (eg: remote desktops), there is a risk that one of the intermediate
6566 components decides to expire a session which has remained idle for too long.
6567
6568 Enabling socket-level TCP keep-alives makes the system regularly send packets
6569 to the other end of the connection, leaving it active. The delay between
6570 keep-alive probes is controlled by the system only and depends both on the
6571 operating system and its tuning parameters.
6572
6573 It is important to understand that keep-alive packets are neither emitted nor
6574 received at the application level. It is only the network stacks which sees
6575 them. For this reason, even if one side of the proxy already uses keep-alives
6576 to maintain its connection alive, those keep-alive packets will not be
6577 forwarded to the other side of the proxy.
6578
6579 Please note that this has nothing to do with HTTP keep-alive.
6580
6581 Using option "srvtcpka" enables the emission of TCP keep-alive probes on the
6582 server side of a connection, which should help when session expirations are
6583 noticed between HAProxy and a server.
6584
6585 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
6586 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
6587
6588 See also : "option clitcpka", "option tcpka"
6589
6590
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01006591option ssl-hello-chk
6592 Use SSLv3 client hello health checks for server testing
6593 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6594 yes | no | yes | yes
6595 Arguments : none
6596
6597 When some SSL-based protocols are relayed in TCP mode through HAProxy, it is
6598 possible to test that the server correctly talks SSL instead of just testing
6599 that it accepts the TCP connection. When "option ssl-hello-chk" is set, pure
6600 SSLv3 client hello messages are sent once the connection is established to
6601 the server, and the response is analyzed to find an SSL server hello message.
6602 The server is considered valid only when the response contains this server
6603 hello message.
6604
6605 All servers tested till there correctly reply to SSLv3 client hello messages,
6606 and most servers tested do not even log the requests containing only hello
6607 messages, which is appreciable.
6608
Willy Tarreau763a95b2012-10-04 23:15:39 +02006609 Note that this check works even when SSL support was not built into haproxy
6610 because it forges the SSL message. When SSL support is available, it is best
6611 to use native SSL health checks instead of this one.
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01006612
Willy Tarreau763a95b2012-10-04 23:15:39 +02006613 See also: "option httpchk", "check-ssl"
6614
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01006615
Willy Tarreaued179852013-12-16 01:07:00 +01006616option tcp-check
6617 Perform health checks using tcp-check send/expect sequences
6618 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6619 yes | no | yes | yes
6620
6621 This health check method is intended to be combined with "tcp-check" command
6622 lists in order to support send/expect types of health check sequences.
6623
6624 TCP checks currently support 4 modes of operations :
6625 - no "tcp-check" directive : the health check only consists in a connection
6626 attempt, which remains the default mode.
6627
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03006628 - "tcp-check send" or "tcp-check send-binary" only is mentioned : this is
Willy Tarreaued179852013-12-16 01:07:00 +01006629 used to send a string along with a connection opening. With some
6630 protocols, it helps sending a "QUIT" message for example that prevents
6631 the server from logging a connection error for each health check. The
6632 check result will still be based on the ability to open the connection
6633 only.
6634
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03006635 - "tcp-check expect" only is mentioned : this is used to test a banner.
Willy Tarreaued179852013-12-16 01:07:00 +01006636 The connection is opened and haproxy waits for the server to present some
6637 contents which must validate some rules. The check result will be based
6638 on the matching between the contents and the rules. This is suited for
6639 POP, IMAP, SMTP, FTP, SSH, TELNET.
6640
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03006641 - both "tcp-check send" and "tcp-check expect" are mentioned : this is
Willy Tarreaued179852013-12-16 01:07:00 +01006642 used to test a hello-type protocol. Haproxy sends a message, the server
6643 responds and its response is analysed. the check result will be based on
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03006644 the matching between the response contents and the rules. This is often
Willy Tarreaued179852013-12-16 01:07:00 +01006645 suited for protocols which require a binding or a request/response model.
6646 LDAP, MySQL, Redis and SSL are example of such protocols, though they
6647 already all have their dedicated checks with a deeper understanding of
6648 the respective protocols.
6649 In this mode, many questions may be sent and many answers may be
6650 analysed.
6651
Baptiste Assmannd60a9e52015-04-25 16:27:23 +02006652 A fifth mode can be used to insert comments in different steps of the
6653 script.
6654
6655 For each tcp-check rule you create, you can add a "comment" directive,
6656 followed by a string. This string will be reported in the log and stderr
6657 in debug mode. It is useful to make user-friendly error reporting.
6658 The "comment" is of course optional.
6659
6660
Willy Tarreaued179852013-12-16 01:07:00 +01006661 Examples :
6662 # perform a POP check (analyse only server's banner)
6663 option tcp-check
Baptiste Assmannd60a9e52015-04-25 16:27:23 +02006664 tcp-check expect string +OK\ POP3\ ready comment POP\ protocol
Willy Tarreaued179852013-12-16 01:07:00 +01006665
6666 # perform an IMAP check (analyse only server's banner)
6667 option tcp-check
Baptiste Assmannd60a9e52015-04-25 16:27:23 +02006668 tcp-check expect string *\ OK\ IMAP4\ ready comment IMAP\ protocol
Willy Tarreaued179852013-12-16 01:07:00 +01006669
6670 # look for the redis master server after ensuring it speaks well
6671 # redis protocol, then it exits properly.
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03006672 # (send a command then analyse the response 3 times)
Willy Tarreaued179852013-12-16 01:07:00 +01006673 option tcp-check
Baptiste Assmannd60a9e52015-04-25 16:27:23 +02006674 tcp-check comment PING\ phase
Willy Tarreaued179852013-12-16 01:07:00 +01006675 tcp-check send PING\r\n
Baptiste Assmanna3322992015-08-04 10:12:18 +02006676 tcp-check expect string +PONG
Baptiste Assmannd60a9e52015-04-25 16:27:23 +02006677 tcp-check comment role\ check
Willy Tarreaued179852013-12-16 01:07:00 +01006678 tcp-check send info\ replication\r\n
6679 tcp-check expect string role:master
Baptiste Assmannd60a9e52015-04-25 16:27:23 +02006680 tcp-check comment QUIT\ phase
Willy Tarreaued179852013-12-16 01:07:00 +01006681 tcp-check send QUIT\r\n
6682 tcp-check expect string +OK
6683
6684 forge a HTTP request, then analyse the response
6685 (send many headers before analyzing)
6686 option tcp-check
Baptiste Assmannd60a9e52015-04-25 16:27:23 +02006687 tcp-check comment forge\ and\ send\ HTTP\ request
Willy Tarreaued179852013-12-16 01:07:00 +01006688 tcp-check send HEAD\ /\ HTTP/1.1\r\n
6689 tcp-check send Host:\ www.mydomain.com\r\n
6690 tcp-check send User-Agent:\ HAProxy\ tcpcheck\r\n
6691 tcp-check send \r\n
Baptiste Assmannd60a9e52015-04-25 16:27:23 +02006692 tcp-check expect rstring HTTP/1\..\ (2..|3..) comment check\ HTTP\ response
Willy Tarreaued179852013-12-16 01:07:00 +01006693
6694
6695 See also : "tcp-check expect", "tcp-check send"
6696
6697
Willy Tarreau9ea05a72009-06-14 12:07:01 +02006698option tcp-smart-accept
6699no option tcp-smart-accept
6700 Enable or disable the saving of one ACK packet during the accept sequence
6701 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6702 yes | yes | yes | no
6703 Arguments : none
6704
6705 When an HTTP connection request comes in, the system acknowledges it on
6706 behalf of HAProxy, then the client immediately sends its request, and the
6707 system acknowledges it too while it is notifying HAProxy about the new
6708 connection. HAProxy then reads the request and responds. This means that we
6709 have one TCP ACK sent by the system for nothing, because the request could
6710 very well be acknowledged by HAProxy when it sends its response.
6711
6712 For this reason, in HTTP mode, HAProxy automatically asks the system to avoid
6713 sending this useless ACK on platforms which support it (currently at least
6714 Linux). It must not cause any problem, because the system will send it anyway
6715 after 40 ms if the response takes more time than expected to come.
6716
6717 During complex network debugging sessions, it may be desirable to disable
6718 this optimization because delayed ACKs can make troubleshooting more complex
6719 when trying to identify where packets are delayed. It is then possible to
6720 fall back to normal behaviour by specifying "no option tcp-smart-accept".
6721
6722 It is also possible to force it for non-HTTP proxies by simply specifying
6723 "option tcp-smart-accept". For instance, it can make sense with some services
6724 such as SMTP where the server speaks first.
6725
6726 It is recommended to avoid forcing this option in a defaults section. In case
6727 of doubt, consider setting it back to automatic values by prepending the
6728 "default" keyword before it, or disabling it using the "no" keyword.
6729
Willy Tarreaud88edf22009-06-14 15:48:17 +02006730 See also : "option tcp-smart-connect"
6731
6732
6733option tcp-smart-connect
6734no option tcp-smart-connect
6735 Enable or disable the saving of one ACK packet during the connect sequence
6736 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6737 yes | no | yes | yes
6738 Arguments : none
6739
6740 On certain systems (at least Linux), HAProxy can ask the kernel not to
6741 immediately send an empty ACK upon a connection request, but to directly
6742 send the buffer request instead. This saves one packet on the network and
6743 thus boosts performance. It can also be useful for some servers, because they
6744 immediately get the request along with the incoming connection.
6745
6746 This feature is enabled when "option tcp-smart-connect" is set in a backend.
6747 It is not enabled by default because it makes network troubleshooting more
6748 complex.
6749
6750 It only makes sense to enable it with protocols where the client speaks first
6751 such as HTTP. In other situations, if there is no data to send in place of
6752 the ACK, a normal ACK is sent.
6753
6754 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
6755 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
6756
6757 See also : "option tcp-smart-accept"
6758
Willy Tarreau9ea05a72009-06-14 12:07:01 +02006759
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01006760option tcpka
6761 Enable or disable the sending of TCP keepalive packets on both sides
6762 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6763 yes | yes | yes | yes
6764 Arguments : none
6765
6766 When there is a firewall or any session-aware component between a client and
6767 a server, and when the protocol involves very long sessions with long idle
6768 periods (eg: remote desktops), there is a risk that one of the intermediate
6769 components decides to expire a session which has remained idle for too long.
6770
6771 Enabling socket-level TCP keep-alives makes the system regularly send packets
6772 to the other end of the connection, leaving it active. The delay between
6773 keep-alive probes is controlled by the system only and depends both on the
6774 operating system and its tuning parameters.
6775
6776 It is important to understand that keep-alive packets are neither emitted nor
6777 received at the application level. It is only the network stacks which sees
6778 them. For this reason, even if one side of the proxy already uses keep-alives
6779 to maintain its connection alive, those keep-alive packets will not be
6780 forwarded to the other side of the proxy.
6781
6782 Please note that this has nothing to do with HTTP keep-alive.
6783
6784 Using option "tcpka" enables the emission of TCP keep-alive probes on both
6785 the client and server sides of a connection. Note that this is meaningful
6786 only in "defaults" or "listen" sections. If this option is used in a
6787 frontend, only the client side will get keep-alives, and if this option is
6788 used in a backend, only the server side will get keep-alives. For this
6789 reason, it is strongly recommended to explicitly use "option clitcpka" and
6790 "option srvtcpka" when the configuration is split between frontends and
6791 backends.
6792
6793 See also : "option clitcpka", "option srvtcpka"
6794
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01006795
6796option tcplog
6797 Enable advanced logging of TCP connections with session state and timers
6798 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6799 yes | yes | yes | yes
6800 Arguments : none
6801
6802 By default, the log output format is very poor, as it only contains the
6803 source and destination addresses, and the instance name. By specifying
6804 "option tcplog", each log line turns into a much richer format including, but
6805 not limited to, the connection timers, the session status, the connections
6806 numbers, the frontend, backend and server name, and of course the source
6807 address and ports. This option is useful for pure TCP proxies in order to
6808 find which of the client or server disconnects or times out. For normal HTTP
6809 proxies, it's better to use "option httplog" which is even more complete.
6810
6811 This option may be set either in the frontend or the backend.
6812
Guillaume de Lafond29f45602017-03-31 19:52:15 +02006813 "option tcplog" overrides any previous "log-format" directive.
6814
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02006815 See also : "option httplog", and section 8 about logging.
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01006816
6817
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01006818option transparent
6819no option transparent
6820 Enable client-side transparent proxying
6821 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreau4b1f8592008-12-23 23:13:55 +01006822 yes | no | yes | yes
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01006823 Arguments : none
6824
6825 This option was introduced in order to provide layer 7 persistence to layer 3
6826 load balancers. The idea is to use the OS's ability to redirect an incoming
6827 connection for a remote address to a local process (here HAProxy), and let
6828 this process know what address was initially requested. When this option is
6829 used, sessions without cookies will be forwarded to the original destination
6830 IP address of the incoming request (which should match that of another
6831 equipment), while requests with cookies will still be forwarded to the
6832 appropriate server.
6833
6834 Note that contrary to a common belief, this option does NOT make HAProxy
6835 present the client's IP to the server when establishing the connection.
6836
Willy Tarreaua1146052011-03-01 09:51:54 +01006837 See also: the "usesrc" argument of the "source" keyword, and the
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01006838 "transparent" option of the "bind" keyword.
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01006839
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01006840
Simon Horman98637e52014-06-20 12:30:16 +09006841external-check command <command>
6842 Executable to run when performing an external-check
6843 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6844 yes | no | yes | yes
6845
6846 Arguments :
6847 <command> is the external command to run
6848
Simon Horman98637e52014-06-20 12:30:16 +09006849 The arguments passed to the to the command are:
6850
Cyril Bonté777be862014-12-02 21:21:35 +01006851 <proxy_address> <proxy_port> <server_address> <server_port>
Simon Horman98637e52014-06-20 12:30:16 +09006852
Cyril Bonté777be862014-12-02 21:21:35 +01006853 The <proxy_address> and <proxy_port> are derived from the first listener
6854 that is either IPv4, IPv6 or a UNIX socket. In the case of a UNIX socket
6855 listener the proxy_address will be the path of the socket and the
6856 <proxy_port> will be the string "NOT_USED". In a backend section, it's not
6857 possible to determine a listener, and both <proxy_address> and <proxy_port>
6858 will have the string value "NOT_USED".
Simon Horman98637e52014-06-20 12:30:16 +09006859
Cyril Bonté72cda2a2014-12-27 22:28:39 +01006860 Some values are also provided through environment variables.
6861
6862 Environment variables :
6863 HAPROXY_PROXY_ADDR The first bind address if available (or empty if not
6864 applicable, for example in a "backend" section).
6865
6866 HAPROXY_PROXY_ID The backend id.
6867
6868 HAPROXY_PROXY_NAME The backend name.
6869
6870 HAPROXY_PROXY_PORT The first bind port if available (or empty if not
6871 applicable, for example in a "backend" section or
6872 for a UNIX socket).
6873
6874 HAPROXY_SERVER_ADDR The server address.
6875
6876 HAPROXY_SERVER_CURCONN The current number of connections on the server.
6877
6878 HAPROXY_SERVER_ID The server id.
6879
6880 HAPROXY_SERVER_MAXCONN The server max connections.
6881
6882 HAPROXY_SERVER_NAME The server name.
6883
6884 HAPROXY_SERVER_PORT The server port if available (or empty for a UNIX
6885 socket).
6886
6887 PATH The PATH environment variable used when executing
6888 the command may be set using "external-check path".
6889
Simon Horman98637e52014-06-20 12:30:16 +09006890 If the command executed and exits with a zero status then the check is
6891 considered to have passed, otherwise the check is considered to have
6892 failed.
6893
6894 Example :
6895 external-check command /bin/true
6896
6897 See also : "external-check", "option external-check", "external-check path"
6898
6899
6900external-check path <path>
6901 The value of the PATH environment variable used when running an external-check
6902 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6903 yes | no | yes | yes
6904
6905 Arguments :
6906 <path> is the path used when executing external command to run
6907
6908 The default path is "".
6909
6910 Example :
6911 external-check path "/usr/bin:/bin"
6912
6913 See also : "external-check", "option external-check",
6914 "external-check command"
6915
6916
Emeric Brun647caf12009-06-30 17:57:00 +02006917persist rdp-cookie
Hervé COMMOWICKa3eb39c2011-08-05 18:48:51 +02006918persist rdp-cookie(<name>)
Emeric Brun647caf12009-06-30 17:57:00 +02006919 Enable RDP cookie-based persistence
6920 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6921 yes | no | yes | yes
6922 Arguments :
6923 <name> is the optional name of the RDP cookie to check. If omitted, the
Willy Tarreau61e28f22010-05-16 22:31:05 +02006924 default cookie name "msts" will be used. There currently is no
6925 valid reason to change this name.
Emeric Brun647caf12009-06-30 17:57:00 +02006926
6927 This statement enables persistence based on an RDP cookie. The RDP cookie
6928 contains all information required to find the server in the list of known
6929 servers. So when this option is set in the backend, the request is analysed
6930 and if an RDP cookie is found, it is decoded. If it matches a known server
6931 which is still UP (or if "option persist" is set), then the connection is
6932 forwarded to this server.
6933
6934 Note that this only makes sense in a TCP backend, but for this to work, the
6935 frontend must have waited long enough to ensure that an RDP cookie is present
6936 in the request buffer. This is the same requirement as with the "rdp-cookie"
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01006937 load-balancing method. Thus it is highly recommended to put all statements in
Emeric Brun647caf12009-06-30 17:57:00 +02006938 a single "listen" section.
6939
Willy Tarreau61e28f22010-05-16 22:31:05 +02006940 Also, it is important to understand that the terminal server will emit this
6941 RDP cookie only if it is configured for "token redirection mode", which means
6942 that the "IP address redirection" option is disabled.
6943
Emeric Brun647caf12009-06-30 17:57:00 +02006944 Example :
6945 listen tse-farm
6946 bind :3389
6947 # wait up to 5s for an RDP cookie in the request
6948 tcp-request inspect-delay 5s
6949 tcp-request content accept if RDP_COOKIE
6950 # apply RDP cookie persistence
6951 persist rdp-cookie
6952 # if server is unknown, let's balance on the same cookie.
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +02006953 # alternatively, "balance leastconn" may be useful too.
Emeric Brun647caf12009-06-30 17:57:00 +02006954 balance rdp-cookie
6955 server srv1 1.1.1.1:3389
6956 server srv2 1.1.1.2:3389
6957
Simon Hormanab814e02011-06-24 14:50:20 +09006958 See also : "balance rdp-cookie", "tcp-request", the "req_rdp_cookie" ACL and
6959 the rdp_cookie pattern fetch function.
Emeric Brun647caf12009-06-30 17:57:00 +02006960
6961
Willy Tarreau3a7d2072009-03-05 23:48:25 +01006962rate-limit sessions <rate>
6963 Set a limit on the number of new sessions accepted per second on a frontend
6964 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6965 yes | yes | yes | no
6966 Arguments :
6967 <rate> The <rate> parameter is an integer designating the maximum number
6968 of new sessions per second to accept on the frontend.
6969
6970 When the frontend reaches the specified number of new sessions per second, it
6971 stops accepting new connections until the rate drops below the limit again.
6972 During this time, the pending sessions will be kept in the socket's backlog
6973 (in system buffers) and haproxy will not even be aware that sessions are
6974 pending. When applying very low limit on a highly loaded service, it may make
6975 sense to increase the socket's backlog using the "backlog" keyword.
6976
6977 This feature is particularly efficient at blocking connection-based attacks
6978 or service abuse on fragile servers. Since the session rate is measured every
6979 millisecond, it is extremely accurate. Also, the limit applies immediately,
6980 no delay is needed at all to detect the threshold.
6981
6982 Example : limit the connection rate on SMTP to 10 per second max
6983 listen smtp
6984 mode tcp
6985 bind :25
6986 rate-limit sessions 10
Panagiotis Panagiotopoulos7282d8e2016-02-11 16:37:15 +02006987 server smtp1 127.0.0.1:1025
Willy Tarreau3a7d2072009-03-05 23:48:25 +01006988
Willy Tarreaua17c2d92011-07-25 08:16:20 +02006989 Note : when the maximum rate is reached, the frontend's status is not changed
6990 but its sockets appear as "WAITING" in the statistics if the
6991 "socket-stats" option is enabled.
Willy Tarreau3a7d2072009-03-05 23:48:25 +01006992
6993 See also : the "backlog" keyword and the "fe_sess_rate" ACL criterion.
6994
6995
Willy Tarreau2e1dca82012-09-12 08:43:15 +02006996redirect location <loc> [code <code>] <option> [{if | unless} <condition>]
6997redirect prefix <pfx> [code <code>] <option> [{if | unless} <condition>]
6998redirect scheme <sch> [code <code>] <option> [{if | unless} <condition>]
Willy Tarreaub463dfb2008-06-07 23:08:56 +02006999 Return an HTTP redirection if/unless a condition is matched
7000 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7001 no | yes | yes | yes
7002
7003 If/unless the condition is matched, the HTTP request will lead to a redirect
Willy Tarreauf285f542010-01-03 20:03:03 +01007004 response. If no condition is specified, the redirect applies unconditionally.
Willy Tarreaub463dfb2008-06-07 23:08:56 +02007005
Willy Tarreau0140f252008-11-19 21:07:09 +01007006 Arguments :
Willy Tarreau2e1dca82012-09-12 08:43:15 +02007007 <loc> With "redirect location", the exact value in <loc> is placed into
Thierry FOURNIERd18cd0f2013-11-29 12:15:45 +01007008 the HTTP "Location" header. When used in an "http-request" rule,
7009 <loc> value follows the log-format rules and can include some
7010 dynamic values (see Custom Log Format in section 8.2.4).
Willy Tarreau2e1dca82012-09-12 08:43:15 +02007011
7012 <pfx> With "redirect prefix", the "Location" header is built from the
7013 concatenation of <pfx> and the complete URI path, including the
7014 query string, unless the "drop-query" option is specified (see
7015 below). As a special case, if <pfx> equals exactly "/", then
7016 nothing is inserted before the original URI. It allows one to
Thierry FOURNIERd18cd0f2013-11-29 12:15:45 +01007017 redirect to the same URL (for instance, to insert a cookie). When
7018 used in an "http-request" rule, <pfx> value follows the log-format
7019 rules and can include some dynamic values (see Custom Log Format
7020 in section 8.2.4).
Willy Tarreau2e1dca82012-09-12 08:43:15 +02007021
7022 <sch> With "redirect scheme", then the "Location" header is built by
7023 concatenating <sch> with "://" then the first occurrence of the
7024 "Host" header, and then the URI path, including the query string
7025 unless the "drop-query" option is specified (see below). If no
7026 path is found or if the path is "*", then "/" is used instead. If
7027 no "Host" header is found, then an empty host component will be
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03007028 returned, which most recent browsers interpret as redirecting to
Willy Tarreau2e1dca82012-09-12 08:43:15 +02007029 the same host. This directive is mostly used to redirect HTTP to
Thierry FOURNIERd18cd0f2013-11-29 12:15:45 +01007030 HTTPS. When used in an "http-request" rule, <sch> value follows
7031 the log-format rules and can include some dynamic values (see
7032 Custom Log Format in section 8.2.4).
Willy Tarreau0140f252008-11-19 21:07:09 +01007033
7034 <code> The code is optional. It indicates which type of HTTP redirection
Willy Tarreaub67fdc42013-03-29 19:28:11 +01007035 is desired. Only codes 301, 302, 303, 307 and 308 are supported,
7036 with 302 used by default if no code is specified. 301 means
7037 "Moved permanently", and a browser may cache the Location. 302
Baptiste Assmannea849c02015-08-03 11:42:50 +02007038 means "Moved temporarily" and means that the browser should not
Willy Tarreaub67fdc42013-03-29 19:28:11 +01007039 cache the redirection. 303 is equivalent to 302 except that the
7040 browser will fetch the location with a GET method. 307 is just
7041 like 302 but makes it clear that the same method must be reused.
7042 Likewise, 308 replaces 301 if the same method must be used.
Willy Tarreau0140f252008-11-19 21:07:09 +01007043
7044 <option> There are several options which can be specified to adjust the
7045 expected behaviour of a redirection :
7046
7047 - "drop-query"
7048 When this keyword is used in a prefix-based redirection, then the
7049 location will be set without any possible query-string, which is useful
7050 for directing users to a non-secure page for instance. It has no effect
7051 with a location-type redirect.
7052
Willy Tarreau81e3b4f2010-01-10 00:42:19 +01007053 - "append-slash"
7054 This keyword may be used in conjunction with "drop-query" to redirect
7055 users who use a URL not ending with a '/' to the same one with the '/'.
7056 It can be useful to ensure that search engines will only see one URL.
7057 For this, a return code 301 is preferred.
7058
Willy Tarreau0140f252008-11-19 21:07:09 +01007059 - "set-cookie NAME[=value]"
7060 A "Set-Cookie" header will be added with NAME (and optionally "=value")
7061 to the response. This is sometimes used to indicate that a user has
7062 been seen, for instance to protect against some types of DoS. No other
7063 cookie option is added, so the cookie will be a session cookie. Note
7064 that for a browser, a sole cookie name without an equal sign is
7065 different from a cookie with an equal sign.
7066
7067 - "clear-cookie NAME[=]"
7068 A "Set-Cookie" header will be added with NAME (and optionally "="), but
7069 with the "Max-Age" attribute set to zero. This will tell the browser to
7070 delete this cookie. It is useful for instance on logout pages. It is
7071 important to note that clearing the cookie "NAME" will not remove a
7072 cookie set with "NAME=value". You have to clear the cookie "NAME=" for
7073 that, because the browser makes the difference.
Willy Tarreaub463dfb2008-06-07 23:08:56 +02007074
7075 Example: move the login URL only to HTTPS.
7076 acl clear dst_port 80
7077 acl secure dst_port 8080
7078 acl login_page url_beg /login
Willy Tarreau0140f252008-11-19 21:07:09 +01007079 acl logout url_beg /logout
Willy Tarreau79da4692008-11-19 20:03:04 +01007080 acl uid_given url_reg /login?userid=[^&]+
Willy Tarreau0140f252008-11-19 21:07:09 +01007081 acl cookie_set hdr_sub(cookie) SEEN=1
7082
7083 redirect prefix https://mysite.com set-cookie SEEN=1 if !cookie_set
Willy Tarreau79da4692008-11-19 20:03:04 +01007084 redirect prefix https://mysite.com if login_page !secure
7085 redirect prefix http://mysite.com drop-query if login_page !uid_given
7086 redirect location http://mysite.com/ if !login_page secure
Willy Tarreau0140f252008-11-19 21:07:09 +01007087 redirect location / clear-cookie USERID= if logout
Willy Tarreaub463dfb2008-06-07 23:08:56 +02007088
Willy Tarreau81e3b4f2010-01-10 00:42:19 +01007089 Example: send redirects for request for articles without a '/'.
7090 acl missing_slash path_reg ^/article/[^/]*$
7091 redirect code 301 prefix / drop-query append-slash if missing_slash
7092
Willy Tarreau2e1dca82012-09-12 08:43:15 +02007093 Example: redirect all HTTP traffic to HTTPS when SSL is handled by haproxy.
David BERARDe7153042012-11-03 00:11:31 +01007094 redirect scheme https if !{ ssl_fc }
Willy Tarreau2e1dca82012-09-12 08:43:15 +02007095
Thierry FOURNIERd18cd0f2013-11-29 12:15:45 +01007096 Example: append 'www.' prefix in front of all hosts not having it
Coen Rosdorff596659b2016-04-11 11:33:49 +02007097 http-request redirect code 301 location \
7098 http://www.%[hdr(host)]%[capture.req.uri] \
7099 unless { hdr_beg(host) -i www }
Thierry FOURNIERd18cd0f2013-11-29 12:15:45 +01007100
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02007101 See section 7 about ACL usage.
Willy Tarreaub463dfb2008-06-07 23:08:56 +02007102
7103
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki25b501a2008-01-06 16:36:16 +01007104redisp (deprecated)
7105redispatch (deprecated)
7106 Enable or disable session redistribution in case of connection failure
7107 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7108 yes | no | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01007109 Arguments : none
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki25b501a2008-01-06 16:36:16 +01007110
7111 In HTTP mode, if a server designated by a cookie is down, clients may
7112 definitely stick to it because they cannot flush the cookie, so they will not
7113 be able to access the service anymore.
7114
7115 Specifying "redispatch" will allow the proxy to break their persistence and
7116 redistribute them to a working server.
7117
7118 It also allows to retry last connection to another server in case of multiple
7119 connection failures. Of course, it requires having "retries" set to a nonzero
7120 value.
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +01007121
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki25b501a2008-01-06 16:36:16 +01007122 This form is deprecated, do not use it in any new configuration, use the new
7123 "option redispatch" instead.
7124
7125 See also : "option redispatch"
7126
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01007127
Willy Tarreau8abd4cd2010-01-31 14:30:44 +01007128reqadd <string> [{if | unless} <cond>]
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01007129 Add a header at the end of the HTTP request
7130 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7131 no | yes | yes | yes
7132 Arguments :
7133 <string> is the complete line to be added. Any space or known delimiter
7134 must be escaped using a backslash ('\'). Please refer to section
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02007135 6 about HTTP header manipulation for more information.
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01007136
Willy Tarreau8abd4cd2010-01-31 14:30:44 +01007137 <cond> is an optional matching condition built from ACLs. It makes it
7138 possible to ignore this rule when other conditions are not met.
7139
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01007140 A new line consisting in <string> followed by a line feed will be added after
7141 the last header of an HTTP request.
7142
7143 Header transformations only apply to traffic which passes through HAProxy,
7144 and not to traffic generated by HAProxy, such as health-checks or error
7145 responses.
7146
Willy Tarreau8abd4cd2010-01-31 14:30:44 +01007147 Example : add "X-Proto: SSL" to requests coming via port 81
7148 acl is-ssl dst_port 81
7149 reqadd X-Proto:\ SSL if is-ssl
7150
Ruoshan Huangeb5a3632015-12-08 21:00:23 +08007151 See also: "rspadd", "http-request", section 6 about HTTP header manipulation,
7152 and section 7 about ACLs.
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01007153
7154
Willy Tarreau5321c422010-01-28 20:35:13 +01007155reqallow <search> [{if | unless} <cond>]
7156reqiallow <search> [{if | unless} <cond>] (ignore case)
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01007157 Definitely allow an HTTP request if a line matches a regular expression
7158 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7159 no | yes | yes | yes
7160 Arguments :
7161 <search> is the regular expression applied to HTTP headers and to the
7162 request line. This is an extended regular expression. Parenthesis
7163 grouping is supported and no preliminary backslash is required.
7164 Any space or known delimiter must be escaped using a backslash
7165 ('\'). The pattern applies to a full line at a time. The
7166 "reqallow" keyword strictly matches case while "reqiallow"
7167 ignores case.
7168
Willy Tarreau5321c422010-01-28 20:35:13 +01007169 <cond> is an optional matching condition built from ACLs. It makes it
7170 possible to ignore this rule when other conditions are not met.
7171
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01007172 A request containing any line which matches extended regular expression
7173 <search> will mark the request as allowed, even if any later test would
7174 result in a deny. The test applies both to the request line and to request
7175 headers. Keep in mind that URLs in request line are case-sensitive while
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +01007176 header names are not.
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01007177
7178 It is easier, faster and more powerful to use ACLs to write access policies.
7179 Reqdeny, reqallow and reqpass should be avoided in new designs.
7180
7181 Example :
7182 # allow www.* but refuse *.local
7183 reqiallow ^Host:\ www\.
7184 reqideny ^Host:\ .*\.local
7185
Ruoshan Huangeb5a3632015-12-08 21:00:23 +08007186 See also: "reqdeny", "block", "http-request", section 6 about HTTP header
7187 manipulation, and section 7 about ACLs.
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01007188
7189
Willy Tarreau5321c422010-01-28 20:35:13 +01007190reqdel <search> [{if | unless} <cond>]
7191reqidel <search> [{if | unless} <cond>] (ignore case)
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01007192 Delete all headers matching a regular expression in an HTTP request
7193 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7194 no | yes | yes | yes
7195 Arguments :
7196 <search> is the regular expression applied to HTTP headers and to the
7197 request line. This is an extended regular expression. Parenthesis
7198 grouping is supported and no preliminary backslash is required.
7199 Any space or known delimiter must be escaped using a backslash
7200 ('\'). The pattern applies to a full line at a time. The "reqdel"
7201 keyword strictly matches case while "reqidel" ignores case.
7202
Willy Tarreau5321c422010-01-28 20:35:13 +01007203 <cond> is an optional matching condition built from ACLs. It makes it
7204 possible to ignore this rule when other conditions are not met.
7205
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01007206 Any header line matching extended regular expression <search> in the request
7207 will be completely deleted. Most common use of this is to remove unwanted
7208 and/or dangerous headers or cookies from a request before passing it to the
7209 next servers.
7210
7211 Header transformations only apply to traffic which passes through HAProxy,
7212 and not to traffic generated by HAProxy, such as health-checks or error
7213 responses. Keep in mind that header names are not case-sensitive.
7214
7215 Example :
7216 # remove X-Forwarded-For header and SERVER cookie
7217 reqidel ^X-Forwarded-For:.*
7218 reqidel ^Cookie:.*SERVER=
7219
Ruoshan Huangeb5a3632015-12-08 21:00:23 +08007220 See also: "reqadd", "reqrep", "rspdel", "http-request", section 6 about
7221 HTTP header manipulation, and section 7 about ACLs.
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01007222
7223
Willy Tarreau5321c422010-01-28 20:35:13 +01007224reqdeny <search> [{if | unless} <cond>]
7225reqideny <search> [{if | unless} <cond>] (ignore case)
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01007226 Deny an HTTP request if a line matches a regular expression
7227 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7228 no | yes | yes | yes
7229 Arguments :
7230 <search> is the regular expression applied to HTTP headers and to the
7231 request line. This is an extended regular expression. Parenthesis
7232 grouping is supported and no preliminary backslash is required.
7233 Any space or known delimiter must be escaped using a backslash
7234 ('\'). The pattern applies to a full line at a time. The
7235 "reqdeny" keyword strictly matches case while "reqideny" ignores
7236 case.
7237
Willy Tarreau5321c422010-01-28 20:35:13 +01007238 <cond> is an optional matching condition built from ACLs. It makes it
7239 possible to ignore this rule when other conditions are not met.
7240
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01007241 A request containing any line which matches extended regular expression
7242 <search> will mark the request as denied, even if any later test would
7243 result in an allow. The test applies both to the request line and to request
7244 headers. Keep in mind that URLs in request line are case-sensitive while
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +01007245 header names are not.
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01007246
Willy Tarreauced27012008-01-17 20:35:34 +01007247 A denied request will generate an "HTTP 403 forbidden" response once the
Willy Tarreaud2a4aa22008-01-31 15:28:22 +01007248 complete request has been parsed. This is consistent with what is practiced
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +01007249 using ACLs.
Willy Tarreauced27012008-01-17 20:35:34 +01007250
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01007251 It is easier, faster and more powerful to use ACLs to write access policies.
7252 Reqdeny, reqallow and reqpass should be avoided in new designs.
7253
7254 Example :
7255 # refuse *.local, then allow www.*
7256 reqideny ^Host:\ .*\.local
7257 reqiallow ^Host:\ www\.
7258
Ruoshan Huangeb5a3632015-12-08 21:00:23 +08007259 See also: "reqallow", "rspdeny", "block", "http-request", section 6 about
7260 HTTP header manipulation, and section 7 about ACLs.
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01007261
7262
Willy Tarreau5321c422010-01-28 20:35:13 +01007263reqpass <search> [{if | unless} <cond>]
7264reqipass <search> [{if | unless} <cond>] (ignore case)
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01007265 Ignore any HTTP request line matching a regular expression in next rules
7266 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7267 no | yes | yes | yes
7268 Arguments :
7269 <search> is the regular expression applied to HTTP headers and to the
7270 request line. This is an extended regular expression. Parenthesis
7271 grouping is supported and no preliminary backslash is required.
7272 Any space or known delimiter must be escaped using a backslash
7273 ('\'). The pattern applies to a full line at a time. The
7274 "reqpass" keyword strictly matches case while "reqipass" ignores
7275 case.
7276
Willy Tarreau5321c422010-01-28 20:35:13 +01007277 <cond> is an optional matching condition built from ACLs. It makes it
7278 possible to ignore this rule when other conditions are not met.
7279
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01007280 A request containing any line which matches extended regular expression
7281 <search> will skip next rules, without assigning any deny or allow verdict.
7282 The test applies both to the request line and to request headers. Keep in
7283 mind that URLs in request line are case-sensitive while header names are not.
7284
7285 It is easier, faster and more powerful to use ACLs to write access policies.
7286 Reqdeny, reqallow and reqpass should be avoided in new designs.
7287
7288 Example :
7289 # refuse *.local, then allow www.*, but ignore "www.private.local"
7290 reqipass ^Host:\ www.private\.local
7291 reqideny ^Host:\ .*\.local
7292 reqiallow ^Host:\ www\.
7293
Ruoshan Huangeb5a3632015-12-08 21:00:23 +08007294 See also: "reqallow", "reqdeny", "block", "http-request", section 6 about
7295 HTTP header manipulation, and section 7 about ACLs.
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01007296
7297
Willy Tarreau5321c422010-01-28 20:35:13 +01007298reqrep <search> <string> [{if | unless} <cond>]
7299reqirep <search> <string> [{if | unless} <cond>] (ignore case)
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01007300 Replace a regular expression with a string in an HTTP request line
7301 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7302 no | yes | yes | yes
7303 Arguments :
7304 <search> is the regular expression applied to HTTP headers and to the
7305 request line. This is an extended regular expression. Parenthesis
7306 grouping is supported and no preliminary backslash is required.
7307 Any space or known delimiter must be escaped using a backslash
7308 ('\'). The pattern applies to a full line at a time. The "reqrep"
7309 keyword strictly matches case while "reqirep" ignores case.
7310
7311 <string> is the complete line to be added. Any space or known delimiter
7312 must be escaped using a backslash ('\'). References to matched
7313 pattern groups are possible using the common \N form, with N
7314 being a single digit between 0 and 9. Please refer to section
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02007315 6 about HTTP header manipulation for more information.
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01007316
Willy Tarreau5321c422010-01-28 20:35:13 +01007317 <cond> is an optional matching condition built from ACLs. It makes it
7318 possible to ignore this rule when other conditions are not met.
7319
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01007320 Any line matching extended regular expression <search> in the request (both
7321 the request line and header lines) will be completely replaced with <string>.
7322 Most common use of this is to rewrite URLs or domain names in "Host" headers.
7323
7324 Header transformations only apply to traffic which passes through HAProxy,
7325 and not to traffic generated by HAProxy, such as health-checks or error
7326 responses. Note that for increased readability, it is suggested to add enough
7327 spaces between the request and the response. Keep in mind that URLs in
7328 request line are case-sensitive while header names are not.
7329
7330 Example :
7331 # replace "/static/" with "/" at the beginning of any request path.
Dmitry Sivachenko7823de32012-05-16 14:00:26 +04007332 reqrep ^([^\ :]*)\ /static/(.*) \1\ /\2
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01007333 # replace "www.mydomain.com" with "www" in the host name.
7334 reqirep ^Host:\ www.mydomain.com Host:\ www
7335
Ruoshan Huangeb5a3632015-12-08 21:00:23 +08007336 See also: "reqadd", "reqdel", "rsprep", "tune.bufsize", "http-request",
7337 section 6 about HTTP header manipulation, and section 7 about ACLs.
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01007338
7339
Willy Tarreau5321c422010-01-28 20:35:13 +01007340reqtarpit <search> [{if | unless} <cond>]
7341reqitarpit <search> [{if | unless} <cond>] (ignore case)
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01007342 Tarpit an HTTP request containing a line matching a regular expression
7343 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7344 no | yes | yes | yes
7345 Arguments :
7346 <search> is the regular expression applied to HTTP headers and to the
7347 request line. This is an extended regular expression. Parenthesis
7348 grouping is supported and no preliminary backslash is required.
7349 Any space or known delimiter must be escaped using a backslash
7350 ('\'). The pattern applies to a full line at a time. The
7351 "reqtarpit" keyword strictly matches case while "reqitarpit"
7352 ignores case.
7353
Willy Tarreau5321c422010-01-28 20:35:13 +01007354 <cond> is an optional matching condition built from ACLs. It makes it
7355 possible to ignore this rule when other conditions are not met.
7356
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01007357 A request containing any line which matches extended regular expression
7358 <search> will be tarpitted, which means that it will connect to nowhere, will
Willy Tarreauced27012008-01-17 20:35:34 +01007359 be kept open for a pre-defined time, then will return an HTTP error 500 so
7360 that the attacker does not suspect it has been tarpitted. The status 500 will
7361 be reported in the logs, but the completion flags will indicate "PT". The
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01007362 delay is defined by "timeout tarpit", or "timeout connect" if the former is
7363 not set.
7364
7365 The goal of the tarpit is to slow down robots attacking servers with
7366 identifiable requests. Many robots limit their outgoing number of connections
7367 and stay connected waiting for a reply which can take several minutes to
7368 come. Depending on the environment and attack, it may be particularly
7369 efficient at reducing the load on the network and firewalls.
7370
Willy Tarreau5321c422010-01-28 20:35:13 +01007371 Examples :
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01007372 # ignore user-agents reporting any flavour of "Mozilla" or "MSIE", but
7373 # block all others.
7374 reqipass ^User-Agent:\.*(Mozilla|MSIE)
7375 reqitarpit ^User-Agent:
7376
Willy Tarreau5321c422010-01-28 20:35:13 +01007377 # block bad guys
7378 acl badguys src 10.1.0.3 172.16.13.20/28
7379 reqitarpit . if badguys
7380
Ruoshan Huangeb5a3632015-12-08 21:00:23 +08007381 See also: "reqallow", "reqdeny", "reqpass", "http-request", section 6
7382 about HTTP header manipulation, and section 7 about ACLs.
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01007383
7384
Willy Tarreaue5c5ce92008-06-20 17:27:19 +02007385retries <value>
7386 Set the number of retries to perform on a server after a connection failure
7387 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7388 yes | no | yes | yes
7389 Arguments :
7390 <value> is the number of times a connection attempt should be retried on
7391 a server when a connection either is refused or times out. The
7392 default value is 3.
7393
7394 It is important to understand that this value applies to the number of
7395 connection attempts, not full requests. When a connection has effectively
7396 been established to a server, there will be no more retry.
7397
7398 In order to avoid immediate reconnections to a server which is restarting,
Joseph Lynch726ab712015-05-11 23:25:34 -07007399 a turn-around timer of min("timeout connect", one second) is applied before
7400 a retry occurs.
Willy Tarreaue5c5ce92008-06-20 17:27:19 +02007401
7402 When "option redispatch" is set, the last retry may be performed on another
7403 server even if a cookie references a different server.
7404
7405 See also : "option redispatch"
7406
7407
Willy Tarreaufdb563c2010-01-31 15:43:27 +01007408rspadd <string> [{if | unless} <cond>]
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01007409 Add a header at the end of the HTTP response
7410 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7411 no | yes | yes | yes
7412 Arguments :
7413 <string> is the complete line to be added. Any space or known delimiter
7414 must be escaped using a backslash ('\'). Please refer to section
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02007415 6 about HTTP header manipulation for more information.
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01007416
Willy Tarreaufdb563c2010-01-31 15:43:27 +01007417 <cond> is an optional matching condition built from ACLs. It makes it
7418 possible to ignore this rule when other conditions are not met.
7419
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01007420 A new line consisting in <string> followed by a line feed will be added after
7421 the last header of an HTTP response.
7422
7423 Header transformations only apply to traffic which passes through HAProxy,
7424 and not to traffic generated by HAProxy, such as health-checks or error
7425 responses.
7426
Ruoshan Huangeb5a3632015-12-08 21:00:23 +08007427 See also: "rspdel" "reqadd", "http-response", section 6 about HTTP header
7428 manipulation, and section 7 about ACLs.
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01007429
7430
Willy Tarreaufdb563c2010-01-31 15:43:27 +01007431rspdel <search> [{if | unless} <cond>]
7432rspidel <search> [{if | unless} <cond>] (ignore case)
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01007433 Delete all headers matching a regular expression in an HTTP response
7434 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7435 no | yes | yes | yes
7436 Arguments :
7437 <search> is the regular expression applied to HTTP headers and to the
7438 response line. This is an extended regular expression, so
7439 parenthesis grouping is supported and no preliminary backslash
7440 is required. Any space or known delimiter must be escaped using
7441 a backslash ('\'). The pattern applies to a full line at a time.
7442 The "rspdel" keyword strictly matches case while "rspidel"
7443 ignores case.
7444
Willy Tarreaufdb563c2010-01-31 15:43:27 +01007445 <cond> is an optional matching condition built from ACLs. It makes it
7446 possible to ignore this rule when other conditions are not met.
7447
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01007448 Any header line matching extended regular expression <search> in the response
7449 will be completely deleted. Most common use of this is to remove unwanted
Willy Tarreau3c92c5f2011-08-28 09:45:47 +02007450 and/or sensitive headers or cookies from a response before passing it to the
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01007451 client.
7452
7453 Header transformations only apply to traffic which passes through HAProxy,
7454 and not to traffic generated by HAProxy, such as health-checks or error
7455 responses. Keep in mind that header names are not case-sensitive.
7456
7457 Example :
7458 # remove the Server header from responses
Willy Tarreau5e80e022013-05-25 08:31:25 +02007459 rspidel ^Server:.*
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01007460
Ruoshan Huangeb5a3632015-12-08 21:00:23 +08007461 See also: "rspadd", "rsprep", "reqdel", "http-response", section 6 about
7462 HTTP header manipulation, and section 7 about ACLs.
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01007463
7464
Willy Tarreaufdb563c2010-01-31 15:43:27 +01007465rspdeny <search> [{if | unless} <cond>]
7466rspideny <search> [{if | unless} <cond>] (ignore case)
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01007467 Block an HTTP response if a line matches a regular expression
7468 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7469 no | yes | yes | yes
7470 Arguments :
7471 <search> is the regular expression applied to HTTP headers and to the
7472 response line. This is an extended regular expression, so
7473 parenthesis grouping is supported and no preliminary backslash
7474 is required. Any space or known delimiter must be escaped using
7475 a backslash ('\'). The pattern applies to a full line at a time.
7476 The "rspdeny" keyword strictly matches case while "rspideny"
7477 ignores case.
7478
Willy Tarreaufdb563c2010-01-31 15:43:27 +01007479 <cond> is an optional matching condition built from ACLs. It makes it
7480 possible to ignore this rule when other conditions are not met.
7481
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01007482 A response containing any line which matches extended regular expression
7483 <search> will mark the request as denied. The test applies both to the
7484 response line and to response headers. Keep in mind that header names are not
7485 case-sensitive.
7486
7487 Main use of this keyword is to prevent sensitive information leak and to
Willy Tarreauced27012008-01-17 20:35:34 +01007488 block the response before it reaches the client. If a response is denied, it
7489 will be replaced with an HTTP 502 error so that the client never retrieves
7490 any sensitive data.
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01007491
7492 It is easier, faster and more powerful to use ACLs to write access policies.
7493 Rspdeny should be avoided in new designs.
7494
7495 Example :
7496 # Ensure that no content type matching ms-word will leak
7497 rspideny ^Content-type:\.*/ms-word
7498
Ruoshan Huangeb5a3632015-12-08 21:00:23 +08007499 See also: "reqdeny", "acl", "block", "http-response", section 6 about
7500 HTTP header manipulation and section 7 about ACLs.
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01007501
7502
Willy Tarreaufdb563c2010-01-31 15:43:27 +01007503rsprep <search> <string> [{if | unless} <cond>]
7504rspirep <search> <string> [{if | unless} <cond>] (ignore case)
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01007505 Replace a regular expression with a string in an HTTP response line
7506 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7507 no | yes | yes | yes
7508 Arguments :
7509 <search> is the regular expression applied to HTTP headers and to the
7510 response line. This is an extended regular expression, so
7511 parenthesis grouping is supported and no preliminary backslash
7512 is required. Any space or known delimiter must be escaped using
7513 a backslash ('\'). The pattern applies to a full line at a time.
7514 The "rsprep" keyword strictly matches case while "rspirep"
7515 ignores case.
7516
7517 <string> is the complete line to be added. Any space or known delimiter
7518 must be escaped using a backslash ('\'). References to matched
7519 pattern groups are possible using the common \N form, with N
7520 being a single digit between 0 and 9. Please refer to section
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02007521 6 about HTTP header manipulation for more information.
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01007522
Willy Tarreaufdb563c2010-01-31 15:43:27 +01007523 <cond> is an optional matching condition built from ACLs. It makes it
7524 possible to ignore this rule when other conditions are not met.
7525
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01007526 Any line matching extended regular expression <search> in the response (both
7527 the response line and header lines) will be completely replaced with
7528 <string>. Most common use of this is to rewrite Location headers.
7529
7530 Header transformations only apply to traffic which passes through HAProxy,
7531 and not to traffic generated by HAProxy, such as health-checks or error
7532 responses. Note that for increased readability, it is suggested to add enough
7533 spaces between the request and the response. Keep in mind that header names
7534 are not case-sensitive.
7535
7536 Example :
7537 # replace "Location: 127.0.0.1:8080" with "Location: www.mydomain.com"
7538 rspirep ^Location:\ 127.0.0.1:8080 Location:\ www.mydomain.com
7539
Ruoshan Huangeb5a3632015-12-08 21:00:23 +08007540 See also: "rspadd", "rspdel", "reqrep", "http-response", section 6 about
7541 HTTP header manipulation, and section 7 about ACLs.
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01007542
7543
David du Colombier486df472011-03-17 10:40:26 +01007544server <name> <address>[:[port]] [param*]
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01007545 Declare a server in a backend
7546 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7547 no | no | yes | yes
7548 Arguments :
7549 <name> is the internal name assigned to this server. This name will
Cyril Bonté941a0c62012-10-15 19:44:24 +02007550 appear in logs and alerts. If "http-send-name-header" is
Mark Lamourinec2247f02012-01-04 13:02:01 -05007551 set, it will be added to the request header sent to the server.
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01007552
David du Colombier486df472011-03-17 10:40:26 +01007553 <address> is the IPv4 or IPv6 address of the server. Alternatively, a
7554 resolvable hostname is supported, but this name will be resolved
7555 during start-up. Address "0.0.0.0" or "*" has a special meaning.
7556 It indicates that the connection will be forwarded to the same IP
Willy Tarreaud669a4f2010-07-13 14:49:50 +02007557 address as the one from the client connection. This is useful in
7558 transparent proxy architectures where the client's connection is
7559 intercepted and haproxy must forward to the original destination
7560 address. This is more or less what the "transparent" keyword does
7561 except that with a server it's possible to limit concurrency and
Willy Tarreau24709282013-03-10 21:32:12 +01007562 to report statistics. Optionally, an address family prefix may be
7563 used before the address to force the family regardless of the
7564 address format, which can be useful to specify a path to a unix
7565 socket with no slash ('/'). Currently supported prefixes are :
7566 - 'ipv4@' -> address is always IPv4
7567 - 'ipv6@' -> address is always IPv6
7568 - 'unix@' -> address is a path to a local unix socket
Willy Tarreauccfccef2014-05-10 01:49:15 +02007569 - 'abns@' -> address is in abstract namespace (Linux only)
William Lallemandb2f07452015-05-12 14:27:13 +02007570 You may want to reference some environment variables in the
7571 address parameter, see section 2.3 about environment
Willy Tarreau6a031d12016-11-07 19:42:35 +01007572 variables. The "init-addr" setting can be used to modify the way
7573 IP addresses should be resolved upon startup.
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01007574
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +02007575 <port> is an optional port specification. If set, all connections will
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01007576 be sent to this port. If unset, the same port the client
7577 connected to will be used. The port may also be prefixed by a "+"
7578 or a "-". In this case, the server's port will be determined by
7579 adding this value to the client's port.
7580
7581 <param*> is a list of parameters for this server. The "server" keywords
7582 accepts an important number of options and has a complete section
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02007583 dedicated to it. Please refer to section 5 for more details.
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01007584
7585 Examples :
7586 server first 10.1.1.1:1080 cookie first check inter 1000
7587 server second 10.1.1.2:1080 cookie second check inter 1000
Willy Tarreau24709282013-03-10 21:32:12 +01007588 server transp ipv4@
William Lallemandb2f07452015-05-12 14:27:13 +02007589 server backup "${SRV_BACKUP}:1080" backup
7590 server www1_dc1 "${LAN_DC1}.101:80"
7591 server www1_dc2 "${LAN_DC2}.101:80"
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01007592
Willy Tarreau55dcaf62015-09-27 15:03:15 +02007593 Note: regarding Linux's abstract namespace sockets, HAProxy uses the whole
7594 sun_path length is used for the address length. Some other programs
7595 such as socat use the string length only by default. Pass the option
7596 ",unix-tightsocklen=0" to any abstract socket definition in socat to
7597 make it compatible with HAProxy's.
7598
Mark Lamourinec2247f02012-01-04 13:02:01 -05007599 See also: "default-server", "http-send-name-header" and section 5 about
7600 server options
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01007601
Baptiste Assmann01c6cc32015-08-23 11:45:29 +02007602server-state-file-name [<file>]
7603 Set the server state file to read, load and apply to servers available in
7604 this backend. It only applies when the directive "load-server-state-from-file"
7605 is set to "local". When <file> is not provided or if this directive is not
7606 set, then backend name is used. If <file> starts with a slash '/', then it is
7607 considered as an absolute path. Otherwise, <file> is concatenated to the
7608 global directive "server-state-file-base".
7609
7610 Example: the minimal configuration below would make HAProxy look for the
7611 state server file '/etc/haproxy/states/bk':
7612
7613 global
7614 server-state-file-base /etc/haproxy/states
7615
7616 backend bk
7617 load-server-state-from-file
7618
7619 See also: "server-state-file-base", "load-server-state-from-file", and
7620 "show servers state"
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01007621
Frédéric Lécaillecb4502e2017-04-20 13:36:25 +02007622server-template <prefix> <num | range> <fqdn>[:<port>] [params*]
7623 Set a template to initialize servers with shared parameters.
7624 The names of these servers are built from <prefix> and <num | range> parameters.
7625 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7626 no | no | yes | yes
7627
7628 Arguments:
7629 <prefix> A prefix for the server names to be built.
7630
7631 <num | range>
7632 If <num> is provided, this template initializes <num> servers
7633 with 1 up to <num> as server name suffixes. A range of numbers
7634 <num_low>-<num_high> may also be used to use <num_low> up to
7635 <num_high> as server name suffixes.
7636
7637 <fqdn> A FQDN for all the servers this template initializes.
7638
7639 <port> Same meaning as "server" <port> argument (see "server" keyword).
7640
7641 <params*>
7642 Remaining server parameters among all those supported by "server"
7643 keyword.
7644
7645 Examples:
7646 # Initializes 3 servers with srv1, srv2 and srv3 as names,
7647 # google.com as FQDN, and health-check enabled.
7648 server-template srv 1-3 google.com:80 check
7649
7650 # or
7651 server-template srv 3 google.com:80 check
7652
7653 # would be equivalent to:
7654 server srv1 google.com:80 check
7655 server srv2 google.com:80 check
7656 server srv3 google.com:80 check
7657
7658
7659
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01007660source <addr>[:<port>] [usesrc { <addr2>[:<port2>] | client | clientip } ]
Willy Tarreaubce70882009-09-07 11:51:47 +02007661source <addr>[:<port>] [usesrc { <addr2>[:<port2>] | hdr_ip(<hdr>[,<occ>]) } ]
Willy Tarreaud53f96b2009-02-04 18:46:54 +01007662source <addr>[:<port>] [interface <name>]
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01007663 Set the source address for outgoing connections
7664 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7665 yes | no | yes | yes
7666 Arguments :
7667 <addr> is the IPv4 address HAProxy will bind to before connecting to a
7668 server. This address is also used as a source for health checks.
Willy Tarreau24709282013-03-10 21:32:12 +01007669
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01007670 The default value of 0.0.0.0 means that the system will select
Willy Tarreau24709282013-03-10 21:32:12 +01007671 the most appropriate address to reach its destination. Optionally
7672 an address family prefix may be used before the address to force
7673 the family regardless of the address format, which can be useful
7674 to specify a path to a unix socket with no slash ('/'). Currently
7675 supported prefixes are :
7676 - 'ipv4@' -> address is always IPv4
7677 - 'ipv6@' -> address is always IPv6
7678 - 'unix@' -> address is a path to a local unix socket
Willy Tarreauccfccef2014-05-10 01:49:15 +02007679 - 'abns@' -> address is in abstract namespace (Linux only)
Cyril Bonté307ee1e2015-09-28 23:16:06 +02007680 You may want to reference some environment variables in the
7681 address parameter, see section 2.3 about environment variables.
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01007682
7683 <port> is an optional port. It is normally not needed but may be useful
7684 in some very specific contexts. The default value of zero means
Willy Tarreauc6f4ce82009-06-10 11:09:37 +02007685 the system will select a free port. Note that port ranges are not
7686 supported in the backend. If you want to force port ranges, you
7687 have to specify them on each "server" line.
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01007688
7689 <addr2> is the IP address to present to the server when connections are
7690 forwarded in full transparent proxy mode. This is currently only
7691 supported on some patched Linux kernels. When this address is
7692 specified, clients connecting to the server will be presented
7693 with this address, while health checks will still use the address
7694 <addr>.
7695
7696 <port2> is the optional port to present to the server when connections
7697 are forwarded in full transparent proxy mode (see <addr2> above).
7698 The default value of zero means the system will select a free
7699 port.
7700
Willy Tarreaubce70882009-09-07 11:51:47 +02007701 <hdr> is the name of a HTTP header in which to fetch the IP to bind to.
7702 This is the name of a comma-separated header list which can
7703 contain multiple IP addresses. By default, the last occurrence is
7704 used. This is designed to work with the X-Forwarded-For header
Baptiste Assmannea3e73b2013-02-02 23:47:49 +01007705 and to automatically bind to the client's IP address as seen
Willy Tarreaubce70882009-09-07 11:51:47 +02007706 by previous proxy, typically Stunnel. In order to use another
7707 occurrence from the last one, please see the <occ> parameter
7708 below. When the header (or occurrence) is not found, no binding
7709 is performed so that the proxy's default IP address is used. Also
7710 keep in mind that the header name is case insensitive, as for any
7711 HTTP header.
7712
7713 <occ> is the occurrence number of a value to be used in a multi-value
7714 header. This is to be used in conjunction with "hdr_ip(<hdr>)",
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -04007715 in order to specify which occurrence to use for the source IP
Willy Tarreaubce70882009-09-07 11:51:47 +02007716 address. Positive values indicate a position from the first
7717 occurrence, 1 being the first one. Negative values indicate
7718 positions relative to the last one, -1 being the last one. This
7719 is helpful for situations where an X-Forwarded-For header is set
7720 at the entry point of an infrastructure and must be used several
7721 proxy layers away. When this value is not specified, -1 is
7722 assumed. Passing a zero here disables the feature.
7723
Willy Tarreaud53f96b2009-02-04 18:46:54 +01007724 <name> is an optional interface name to which to bind to for outgoing
7725 traffic. On systems supporting this features (currently, only
7726 Linux), this allows one to bind all traffic to the server to
7727 this interface even if it is not the one the system would select
7728 based on routing tables. This should be used with extreme care.
7729 Note that using this option requires root privileges.
7730
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01007731 The "source" keyword is useful in complex environments where a specific
7732 address only is allowed to connect to the servers. It may be needed when a
7733 private address must be used through a public gateway for instance, and it is
7734 known that the system cannot determine the adequate source address by itself.
7735
7736 An extension which is available on certain patched Linux kernels may be used
7737 through the "usesrc" optional keyword. It makes it possible to connect to the
7738 servers with an IP address which does not belong to the system itself. This
7739 is called "full transparent proxy mode". For this to work, the destination
7740 servers have to route their traffic back to this address through the machine
7741 running HAProxy, and IP forwarding must generally be enabled on this machine.
7742
7743 In this "full transparent proxy" mode, it is possible to force a specific IP
7744 address to be presented to the servers. This is not much used in fact. A more
7745 common use is to tell HAProxy to present the client's IP address. For this,
7746 there are two methods :
7747
7748 - present the client's IP and port addresses. This is the most transparent
7749 mode, but it can cause problems when IP connection tracking is enabled on
7750 the machine, because a same connection may be seen twice with different
7751 states. However, this solution presents the huge advantage of not
7752 limiting the system to the 64k outgoing address+port couples, because all
7753 of the client ranges may be used.
7754
7755 - present only the client's IP address and select a spare port. This
7756 solution is still quite elegant but slightly less transparent (downstream
7757 firewalls logs will not match upstream's). It also presents the downside
7758 of limiting the number of concurrent connections to the usual 64k ports.
7759 However, since the upstream and downstream ports are different, local IP
7760 connection tracking on the machine will not be upset by the reuse of the
7761 same session.
7762
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01007763 This option sets the default source for all servers in the backend. It may
7764 also be specified in a "defaults" section. Finer source address specification
7765 is possible at the server level using the "source" server option. Refer to
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02007766 section 5 for more information.
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01007767
Baptiste Assmann91bd3372015-07-17 21:59:42 +02007768 In order to work, "usesrc" requires root privileges.
7769
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01007770 Examples :
7771 backend private
7772 # Connect to the servers using our 192.168.1.200 source address
7773 source 192.168.1.200
7774
7775 backend transparent_ssl1
7776 # Connect to the SSL farm from the client's source address
7777 source 192.168.1.200 usesrc clientip
7778
7779 backend transparent_ssl2
7780 # Connect to the SSL farm from the client's source address and port
7781 # not recommended if IP conntrack is present on the local machine.
7782 source 192.168.1.200 usesrc client
7783
7784 backend transparent_ssl3
7785 # Connect to the SSL farm from the client's source address. It
7786 # is more conntrack-friendly.
7787 source 192.168.1.200 usesrc clientip
7788
7789 backend transparent_smtp
7790 # Connect to the SMTP farm from the client's source address/port
7791 # with Tproxy version 4.
7792 source 0.0.0.0 usesrc clientip
7793
Willy Tarreaubce70882009-09-07 11:51:47 +02007794 backend transparent_http
7795 # Connect to the servers using the client's IP as seen by previous
7796 # proxy.
7797 source 0.0.0.0 usesrc hdr_ip(x-forwarded-for,-1)
7798
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02007799 See also : the "source" server option in section 5, the Tproxy patches for
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01007800 the Linux kernel on www.balabit.com, the "bind" keyword.
7801
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki25b501a2008-01-06 16:36:16 +01007802
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01007803srvtimeout <timeout> (deprecated)
7804 Set the maximum inactivity time on the server side.
7805 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7806 yes | no | yes | yes
7807 Arguments :
7808 <timeout> is the timeout value specified in milliseconds by default, but
7809 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
7810 as explained at the top of this document.
7811
7812 The inactivity timeout applies when the server is expected to acknowledge or
7813 send data. In HTTP mode, this timeout is particularly important to consider
7814 during the first phase of the server's response, when it has to send the
7815 headers, as it directly represents the server's processing time for the
7816 request. To find out what value to put there, it's often good to start with
7817 what would be considered as unacceptable response times, then check the logs
7818 to observe the response time distribution, and adjust the value accordingly.
7819
7820 The value is specified in milliseconds by default, but can be in any other
7821 unit if the number is suffixed by the unit, as specified at the top of this
7822 document. In TCP mode (and to a lesser extent, in HTTP mode), it is highly
7823 recommended that the client timeout remains equal to the server timeout in
7824 order to avoid complex situations to debug. Whatever the expected server
Willy Tarreaud2a4aa22008-01-31 15:28:22 +01007825 response times, it is a good practice to cover at least one or several TCP
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01007826 packet losses by specifying timeouts that are slightly above multiples of 3
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +01007827 seconds (eg: 4 or 5 seconds minimum).
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01007828
7829 This parameter is specific to backends, but can be specified once for all in
7830 "defaults" sections. This is in fact one of the easiest solutions not to
7831 forget about it. An unspecified timeout results in an infinite timeout, which
7832 is not recommended. Such a usage is accepted and works but reports a warning
7833 during startup because it may results in accumulation of expired sessions in
7834 the system if the system's timeouts are not configured either.
7835
7836 This parameter is provided for compatibility but is currently deprecated.
7837 Please use "timeout server" instead.
7838
Willy Tarreauce887fd2012-05-12 12:50:00 +02007839 See also : "timeout server", "timeout tunnel", "timeout client" and
7840 "clitimeout".
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01007841
7842
Cyril Bonté66c327d2010-10-12 00:14:37 +02007843stats admin { if | unless } <cond>
7844 Enable statistics admin level if/unless a condition is matched
7845 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreaued2119c2014-04-24 22:10:39 +02007846 no | yes | yes | yes
Cyril Bonté66c327d2010-10-12 00:14:37 +02007847
7848 This statement enables the statistics admin level if/unless a condition is
7849 matched.
7850
7851 The admin level allows to enable/disable servers from the web interface. By
7852 default, statistics page is read-only for security reasons.
7853
Cyril Bonté02ff8ef2010-12-14 22:48:49 +01007854 Note : Consider not using this feature in multi-process mode (nbproc > 1)
7855 unless you know what you do : memory is not shared between the
7856 processes, which can result in random behaviours.
7857
Cyril Bonté23b39d92011-02-10 22:54:44 +01007858 Currently, the POST request is limited to the buffer size minus the reserved
7859 buffer space, which means that if the list of servers is too long, the
7860 request won't be processed. It is recommended to alter few servers at a
7861 time.
Cyril Bonté66c327d2010-10-12 00:14:37 +02007862
7863 Example :
7864 # statistics admin level only for localhost
7865 backend stats_localhost
7866 stats enable
7867 stats admin if LOCALHOST
7868
7869 Example :
7870 # statistics admin level always enabled because of the authentication
7871 backend stats_auth
7872 stats enable
7873 stats auth admin:AdMiN123
7874 stats admin if TRUE
7875
7876 Example :
7877 # statistics admin level depends on the authenticated user
7878 userlist stats-auth
7879 group admin users admin
7880 user admin insecure-password AdMiN123
7881 group readonly users haproxy
7882 user haproxy insecure-password haproxy
7883
7884 backend stats_auth
7885 stats enable
7886 acl AUTH http_auth(stats-auth)
7887 acl AUTH_ADMIN http_auth_group(stats-auth) admin
7888 stats http-request auth unless AUTH
7889 stats admin if AUTH_ADMIN
7890
Cyril Bonté02ff8ef2010-12-14 22:48:49 +01007891 See also : "stats enable", "stats auth", "stats http-request", "nbproc",
7892 "bind-process", section 3.4 about userlists and section 7 about
7893 ACL usage.
Cyril Bonté66c327d2010-10-12 00:14:37 +02007894
7895
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01007896stats auth <user>:<passwd>
7897 Enable statistics with authentication and grant access to an account
7898 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreaued2119c2014-04-24 22:10:39 +02007899 yes | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01007900 Arguments :
7901 <user> is a user name to grant access to
7902
7903 <passwd> is the cleartext password associated to this user
7904
7905 This statement enables statistics with default settings, and restricts access
7906 to declared users only. It may be repeated as many times as necessary to
7907 allow as many users as desired. When a user tries to access the statistics
7908 without a valid account, a "401 Forbidden" response will be returned so that
7909 the browser asks the user to provide a valid user and password. The real
7910 which will be returned to the browser is configurable using "stats realm".
7911
7912 Since the authentication method is HTTP Basic Authentication, the passwords
7913 circulate in cleartext on the network. Thus, it was decided that the
7914 configuration file would also use cleartext passwords to remind the users
Willy Tarreau3c92c5f2011-08-28 09:45:47 +02007915 that those ones should not be sensitive and not shared with any other account.
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01007916
7917 It is also possible to reduce the scope of the proxies which appear in the
7918 report using "stats scope".
7919
7920 Though this statement alone is enough to enable statistics reporting, it is
7921 recommended to set all other settings in order to avoid relying on default
7922 unobvious parameters.
7923
7924 Example :
7925 # public access (limited to this backend only)
7926 backend public_www
7927 server srv1 192.168.0.1:80
7928 stats enable
7929 stats hide-version
7930 stats scope .
7931 stats uri /admin?stats
7932 stats realm Haproxy\ Statistics
7933 stats auth admin1:AdMiN123
7934 stats auth admin2:AdMiN321
7935
7936 # internal monitoring access (unlimited)
7937 backend private_monitoring
7938 stats enable
7939 stats uri /admin?stats
7940 stats refresh 5s
7941
7942 See also : "stats enable", "stats realm", "stats scope", "stats uri"
7943
7944
7945stats enable
7946 Enable statistics reporting with default settings
7947 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreaued2119c2014-04-24 22:10:39 +02007948 yes | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01007949 Arguments : none
7950
7951 This statement enables statistics reporting with default settings defined
7952 at build time. Unless stated otherwise, these settings are used :
7953 - stats uri : /haproxy?stats
7954 - stats realm : "HAProxy Statistics"
7955 - stats auth : no authentication
7956 - stats scope : no restriction
7957
7958 Though this statement alone is enough to enable statistics reporting, it is
7959 recommended to set all other settings in order to avoid relying on default
7960 unobvious parameters.
7961
7962 Example :
7963 # public access (limited to this backend only)
7964 backend public_www
7965 server srv1 192.168.0.1:80
7966 stats enable
7967 stats hide-version
7968 stats scope .
7969 stats uri /admin?stats
7970 stats realm Haproxy\ Statistics
7971 stats auth admin1:AdMiN123
7972 stats auth admin2:AdMiN321
7973
7974 # internal monitoring access (unlimited)
7975 backend private_monitoring
7976 stats enable
7977 stats uri /admin?stats
7978 stats refresh 5s
7979
7980 See also : "stats auth", "stats realm", "stats uri"
7981
7982
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01007983stats hide-version
7984 Enable statistics and hide HAProxy version reporting
Willy Tarreau1d45b7c2009-08-16 10:29:18 +02007985 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreaued2119c2014-04-24 22:10:39 +02007986 yes | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01007987 Arguments : none
Willy Tarreau1d45b7c2009-08-16 10:29:18 +02007988
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01007989 By default, the stats page reports some useful status information along with
7990 the statistics. Among them is HAProxy's version. However, it is generally
7991 considered dangerous to report precise version to anyone, as it can help them
7992 target known weaknesses with specific attacks. The "stats hide-version"
7993 statement removes the version from the statistics report. This is recommended
7994 for public sites or any site with a weak login/password.
Willy Tarreau1d45b7c2009-08-16 10:29:18 +02007995
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki48cb2ae2009-10-02 22:51:14 +02007996 Though this statement alone is enough to enable statistics reporting, it is
7997 recommended to set all other settings in order to avoid relying on default
7998 unobvious parameters.
7999
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01008000 Example :
8001 # public access (limited to this backend only)
8002 backend public_www
8003 server srv1 192.168.0.1:80
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki48cb2ae2009-10-02 22:51:14 +02008004 stats enable
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01008005 stats hide-version
8006 stats scope .
8007 stats uri /admin?stats
8008 stats realm Haproxy\ Statistics
8009 stats auth admin1:AdMiN123
8010 stats auth admin2:AdMiN321
Willy Tarreau1d45b7c2009-08-16 10:29:18 +02008011
Willy Tarreau1d45b7c2009-08-16 10:29:18 +02008012 # internal monitoring access (unlimited)
8013 backend private_monitoring
8014 stats enable
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01008015 stats uri /admin?stats
8016 stats refresh 5s
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki15514c22010-01-04 16:03:09 +01008017
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01008018 See also : "stats auth", "stats enable", "stats realm", "stats uri"
Willy Tarreau1d45b7c2009-08-16 10:29:18 +02008019
Willy Tarreau983e01e2010-01-11 18:42:06 +01008020
Cyril Bonté2be1b3f2010-09-30 23:46:30 +02008021stats http-request { allow | deny | auth [realm <realm>] }
8022 [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
8023 Access control for statistics
8024
8025 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
8026 no | no | yes | yes
8027
8028 As "http-request", these set of options allow to fine control access to
8029 statistics. Each option may be followed by if/unless and acl.
8030 First option with matched condition (or option without condition) is final.
8031 For "deny" a 403 error will be returned, for "allow" normal processing is
8032 performed, for "auth" a 401/407 error code is returned so the client
8033 should be asked to enter a username and password.
8034
8035 There is no fixed limit to the number of http-request statements per
8036 instance.
8037
8038 See also : "http-request", section 3.4 about userlists and section 7
8039 about ACL usage.
8040
8041
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01008042stats realm <realm>
8043 Enable statistics and set authentication realm
8044 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreaued2119c2014-04-24 22:10:39 +02008045 yes | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01008046 Arguments :
8047 <realm> is the name of the HTTP Basic Authentication realm reported to
8048 the browser. The browser uses it to display it in the pop-up
8049 inviting the user to enter a valid username and password.
8050
8051 The realm is read as a single word, so any spaces in it should be escaped
8052 using a backslash ('\').
8053
8054 This statement is useful only in conjunction with "stats auth" since it is
8055 only related to authentication.
8056
8057 Though this statement alone is enough to enable statistics reporting, it is
8058 recommended to set all other settings in order to avoid relying on default
8059 unobvious parameters.
8060
8061 Example :
8062 # public access (limited to this backend only)
8063 backend public_www
8064 server srv1 192.168.0.1:80
8065 stats enable
8066 stats hide-version
8067 stats scope .
8068 stats uri /admin?stats
8069 stats realm Haproxy\ Statistics
8070 stats auth admin1:AdMiN123
8071 stats auth admin2:AdMiN321
8072
8073 # internal monitoring access (unlimited)
8074 backend private_monitoring
8075 stats enable
8076 stats uri /admin?stats
8077 stats refresh 5s
8078
8079 See also : "stats auth", "stats enable", "stats uri"
8080
8081
8082stats refresh <delay>
8083 Enable statistics with automatic refresh
8084 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreaued2119c2014-04-24 22:10:39 +02008085 yes | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01008086 Arguments :
8087 <delay> is the suggested refresh delay, specified in seconds, which will
8088 be returned to the browser consulting the report page. While the
8089 browser is free to apply any delay, it will generally respect it
8090 and refresh the page this every seconds. The refresh interval may
8091 be specified in any other non-default time unit, by suffixing the
8092 unit after the value, as explained at the top of this document.
8093
8094 This statement is useful on monitoring displays with a permanent page
8095 reporting the load balancer's activity. When set, the HTML report page will
8096 include a link "refresh"/"stop refresh" so that the user can select whether
8097 he wants automatic refresh of the page or not.
8098
8099 Though this statement alone is enough to enable statistics reporting, it is
8100 recommended to set all other settings in order to avoid relying on default
8101 unobvious parameters.
8102
8103 Example :
8104 # public access (limited to this backend only)
8105 backend public_www
8106 server srv1 192.168.0.1:80
8107 stats enable
8108 stats hide-version
8109 stats scope .
8110 stats uri /admin?stats
8111 stats realm Haproxy\ Statistics
8112 stats auth admin1:AdMiN123
8113 stats auth admin2:AdMiN321
8114
8115 # internal monitoring access (unlimited)
8116 backend private_monitoring
8117 stats enable
8118 stats uri /admin?stats
8119 stats refresh 5s
8120
8121 See also : "stats auth", "stats enable", "stats realm", "stats uri"
8122
8123
8124stats scope { <name> | "." }
8125 Enable statistics and limit access scope
8126 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreaued2119c2014-04-24 22:10:39 +02008127 yes | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01008128 Arguments :
8129 <name> is the name of a listen, frontend or backend section to be
8130 reported. The special name "." (a single dot) designates the
8131 section in which the statement appears.
8132
8133 When this statement is specified, only the sections enumerated with this
8134 statement will appear in the report. All other ones will be hidden. This
8135 statement may appear as many times as needed if multiple sections need to be
8136 reported. Please note that the name checking is performed as simple string
8137 comparisons, and that it is never checked that a give section name really
8138 exists.
8139
8140 Though this statement alone is enough to enable statistics reporting, it is
8141 recommended to set all other settings in order to avoid relying on default
8142 unobvious parameters.
8143
8144 Example :
8145 # public access (limited to this backend only)
8146 backend public_www
8147 server srv1 192.168.0.1:80
8148 stats enable
8149 stats hide-version
8150 stats scope .
8151 stats uri /admin?stats
8152 stats realm Haproxy\ Statistics
8153 stats auth admin1:AdMiN123
8154 stats auth admin2:AdMiN321
8155
8156 # internal monitoring access (unlimited)
8157 backend private_monitoring
8158 stats enable
8159 stats uri /admin?stats
8160 stats refresh 5s
8161
8162 See also : "stats auth", "stats enable", "stats realm", "stats uri"
8163
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01008164
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +02008165stats show-desc [ <desc> ]
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01008166 Enable reporting of a description on the statistics page.
8167 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreaued2119c2014-04-24 22:10:39 +02008168 yes | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01008169
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +02008170 <desc> is an optional description to be reported. If unspecified, the
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01008171 description from global section is automatically used instead.
8172
8173 This statement is useful for users that offer shared services to their
8174 customers, where node or description should be different for each customer.
8175
8176 Though this statement alone is enough to enable statistics reporting, it is
8177 recommended to set all other settings in order to avoid relying on default
Dmitry Sivachenko7823de32012-05-16 14:00:26 +04008178 unobvious parameters. By default description is not shown.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01008179
8180 Example :
8181 # internal monitoring access (unlimited)
8182 backend private_monitoring
8183 stats enable
8184 stats show-desc Master node for Europe, Asia, Africa
8185 stats uri /admin?stats
8186 stats refresh 5s
8187
8188 See also: "show-node", "stats enable", "stats uri" and "description" in
8189 global section.
8190
8191
8192stats show-legends
Willy Tarreaued2119c2014-04-24 22:10:39 +02008193 Enable reporting additional information on the statistics page
8194 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
8195 yes | yes | yes | yes
8196 Arguments : none
8197
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03008198 Enable reporting additional information on the statistics page :
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01008199 - cap: capabilities (proxy)
8200 - mode: one of tcp, http or health (proxy)
8201 - id: SNMP ID (proxy, socket, server)
8202 - IP (socket, server)
8203 - cookie (backend, server)
8204
8205 Though this statement alone is enough to enable statistics reporting, it is
8206 recommended to set all other settings in order to avoid relying on default
Dmitry Sivachenko7823de32012-05-16 14:00:26 +04008207 unobvious parameters. Default behaviour is not to show this information.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01008208
8209 See also: "stats enable", "stats uri".
8210
8211
8212stats show-node [ <name> ]
8213 Enable reporting of a host name on the statistics page.
8214 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreaued2119c2014-04-24 22:10:39 +02008215 yes | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01008216 Arguments:
8217 <name> is an optional name to be reported. If unspecified, the
8218 node name from global section is automatically used instead.
8219
8220 This statement is useful for users that offer shared services to their
8221 customers, where node or description might be different on a stats page
Dmitry Sivachenko7823de32012-05-16 14:00:26 +04008222 provided for each customer. Default behaviour is not to show host name.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01008223
8224 Though this statement alone is enough to enable statistics reporting, it is
8225 recommended to set all other settings in order to avoid relying on default
8226 unobvious parameters.
8227
8228 Example:
8229 # internal monitoring access (unlimited)
8230 backend private_monitoring
8231 stats enable
8232 stats show-node Europe-1
8233 stats uri /admin?stats
8234 stats refresh 5s
8235
8236 See also: "show-desc", "stats enable", "stats uri", and "node" in global
8237 section.
8238
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01008239
8240stats uri <prefix>
8241 Enable statistics and define the URI prefix to access them
8242 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreaued2119c2014-04-24 22:10:39 +02008243 yes | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01008244 Arguments :
8245 <prefix> is the prefix of any URI which will be redirected to stats. This
8246 prefix may contain a question mark ('?') to indicate part of a
8247 query string.
8248
8249 The statistics URI is intercepted on the relayed traffic, so it appears as a
8250 page within the normal application. It is strongly advised to ensure that the
8251 selected URI will never appear in the application, otherwise it will never be
8252 possible to reach it in the application.
8253
8254 The default URI compiled in haproxy is "/haproxy?stats", but this may be
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01008255 changed at build time, so it's better to always explicitly specify it here.
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01008256 It is generally a good idea to include a question mark in the URI so that
8257 intermediate proxies refrain from caching the results. Also, since any string
8258 beginning with the prefix will be accepted as a stats request, the question
8259 mark helps ensuring that no valid URI will begin with the same words.
8260
8261 It is sometimes very convenient to use "/" as the URI prefix, and put that
8262 statement in a "listen" instance of its own. That makes it easy to dedicate
8263 an address or a port to statistics only.
8264
8265 Though this statement alone is enough to enable statistics reporting, it is
8266 recommended to set all other settings in order to avoid relying on default
8267 unobvious parameters.
8268
8269 Example :
8270 # public access (limited to this backend only)
8271 backend public_www
8272 server srv1 192.168.0.1:80
8273 stats enable
8274 stats hide-version
8275 stats scope .
8276 stats uri /admin?stats
8277 stats realm Haproxy\ Statistics
8278 stats auth admin1:AdMiN123
8279 stats auth admin2:AdMiN321
8280
8281 # internal monitoring access (unlimited)
8282 backend private_monitoring
8283 stats enable
8284 stats uri /admin?stats
8285 stats refresh 5s
8286
8287 See also : "stats auth", "stats enable", "stats realm"
8288
8289
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01008290stick match <pattern> [table <table>] [{if | unless} <cond>]
8291 Define a request pattern matching condition to stick a user to a server
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01008292 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01008293 no | no | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01008294
8295 Arguments :
Willy Tarreaube722a22014-06-13 16:31:59 +02008296 <pattern> is a sample expression rule as described in section 7.3. It
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01008297 describes what elements of the incoming request or connection
8298 will be analysed in the hope to find a matching entry in a
8299 stickiness table. This rule is mandatory.
8300
8301 <table> is an optional stickiness table name. If unspecified, the same
8302 backend's table is used. A stickiness table is declared using
8303 the "stick-table" statement.
8304
8305 <cond> is an optional matching condition. It makes it possible to match
8306 on a certain criterion only when other conditions are met (or
8307 not met). For instance, it could be used to match on a source IP
8308 address except when a request passes through a known proxy, in
8309 which case we'd match on a header containing that IP address.
8310
8311 Some protocols or applications require complex stickiness rules and cannot
8312 always simply rely on cookies nor hashing. The "stick match" statement
8313 describes a rule to extract the stickiness criterion from an incoming request
8314 or connection. See section 7 for a complete list of possible patterns and
8315 transformation rules.
8316
8317 The table has to be declared using the "stick-table" statement. It must be of
8318 a type compatible with the pattern. By default it is the one which is present
8319 in the same backend. It is possible to share a table with other backends by
8320 referencing it using the "table" keyword. If another table is referenced,
8321 the server's ID inside the backends are used. By default, all server IDs
8322 start at 1 in each backend, so the server ordering is enough. But in case of
8323 doubt, it is highly recommended to force server IDs using their "id" setting.
8324
8325 It is possible to restrict the conditions where a "stick match" statement
8326 will apply, using "if" or "unless" followed by a condition. See section 7 for
8327 ACL based conditions.
8328
8329 There is no limit on the number of "stick match" statements. The first that
8330 applies and matches will cause the request to be directed to the same server
8331 as was used for the request which created the entry. That way, multiple
8332 matches can be used as fallbacks.
8333
8334 The stick rules are checked after the persistence cookies, so they will not
8335 affect stickiness if a cookie has already been used to select a server. That
8336 way, it becomes very easy to insert cookies and match on IP addresses in
8337 order to maintain stickiness between HTTP and HTTPS.
8338
Cyril Bonté02ff8ef2010-12-14 22:48:49 +01008339 Note : Consider not using this feature in multi-process mode (nbproc > 1)
8340 unless you know what you do : memory is not shared between the
8341 processes, which can result in random behaviours.
8342
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01008343 Example :
8344 # forward SMTP users to the same server they just used for POP in the
8345 # last 30 minutes
8346 backend pop
8347 mode tcp
8348 balance roundrobin
8349 stick store-request src
8350 stick-table type ip size 200k expire 30m
8351 server s1 192.168.1.1:110
8352 server s2 192.168.1.1:110
8353
8354 backend smtp
8355 mode tcp
8356 balance roundrobin
8357 stick match src table pop
8358 server s1 192.168.1.1:25
8359 server s2 192.168.1.1:25
8360
Cyril Bonté02ff8ef2010-12-14 22:48:49 +01008361 See also : "stick-table", "stick on", "nbproc", "bind-process" and section 7
Willy Tarreaube722a22014-06-13 16:31:59 +02008362 about ACLs and samples fetching.
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01008363
8364
8365stick on <pattern> [table <table>] [{if | unless} <condition>]
8366 Define a request pattern to associate a user to a server
8367 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
8368 no | no | yes | yes
8369
8370 Note : This form is exactly equivalent to "stick match" followed by
8371 "stick store-request", all with the same arguments. Please refer
8372 to both keywords for details. It is only provided as a convenience
8373 for writing more maintainable configurations.
8374
Cyril Bonté02ff8ef2010-12-14 22:48:49 +01008375 Note : Consider not using this feature in multi-process mode (nbproc > 1)
8376 unless you know what you do : memory is not shared between the
8377 processes, which can result in random behaviours.
8378
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01008379 Examples :
8380 # The following form ...
Willy Tarreauec579d82010-02-26 19:15:04 +01008381 stick on src table pop if !localhost
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01008382
8383 # ...is strictly equivalent to this one :
8384 stick match src table pop if !localhost
8385 stick store-request src table pop if !localhost
8386
8387
8388 # Use cookie persistence for HTTP, and stick on source address for HTTPS as
8389 # well as HTTP without cookie. Share the same table between both accesses.
8390 backend http
8391 mode http
8392 balance roundrobin
8393 stick on src table https
8394 cookie SRV insert indirect nocache
8395 server s1 192.168.1.1:80 cookie s1
8396 server s2 192.168.1.1:80 cookie s2
8397
8398 backend https
8399 mode tcp
8400 balance roundrobin
8401 stick-table type ip size 200k expire 30m
8402 stick on src
8403 server s1 192.168.1.1:443
8404 server s2 192.168.1.1:443
8405
Cyril Bonté02ff8ef2010-12-14 22:48:49 +01008406 See also : "stick match", "stick store-request", "nbproc" and "bind-process".
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01008407
8408
8409stick store-request <pattern> [table <table>] [{if | unless} <condition>]
8410 Define a request pattern used to create an entry in a stickiness table
8411 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
8412 no | no | yes | yes
8413
8414 Arguments :
Willy Tarreaube722a22014-06-13 16:31:59 +02008415 <pattern> is a sample expression rule as described in section 7.3. It
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01008416 describes what elements of the incoming request or connection
8417 will be analysed, extracted and stored in the table once a
8418 server is selected.
8419
8420 <table> is an optional stickiness table name. If unspecified, the same
8421 backend's table is used. A stickiness table is declared using
8422 the "stick-table" statement.
8423
8424 <cond> is an optional storage condition. It makes it possible to store
8425 certain criteria only when some conditions are met (or not met).
8426 For instance, it could be used to store the source IP address
8427 except when the request passes through a known proxy, in which
8428 case we'd store a converted form of a header containing that IP
8429 address.
8430
8431 Some protocols or applications require complex stickiness rules and cannot
8432 always simply rely on cookies nor hashing. The "stick store-request" statement
8433 describes a rule to decide what to extract from the request and when to do
8434 it, in order to store it into a stickiness table for further requests to
8435 match it using the "stick match" statement. Obviously the extracted part must
8436 make sense and have a chance to be matched in a further request. Storing a
8437 client's IP address for instance often makes sense. Storing an ID found in a
8438 URL parameter also makes sense. Storing a source port will almost never make
8439 any sense because it will be randomly matched. See section 7 for a complete
8440 list of possible patterns and transformation rules.
8441
8442 The table has to be declared using the "stick-table" statement. It must be of
8443 a type compatible with the pattern. By default it is the one which is present
8444 in the same backend. It is possible to share a table with other backends by
8445 referencing it using the "table" keyword. If another table is referenced,
8446 the server's ID inside the backends are used. By default, all server IDs
8447 start at 1 in each backend, so the server ordering is enough. But in case of
8448 doubt, it is highly recommended to force server IDs using their "id" setting.
8449
8450 It is possible to restrict the conditions where a "stick store-request"
8451 statement will apply, using "if" or "unless" followed by a condition. This
8452 condition will be evaluated while parsing the request, so any criteria can be
8453 used. See section 7 for ACL based conditions.
8454
8455 There is no limit on the number of "stick store-request" statements, but
8456 there is a limit of 8 simultaneous stores per request or response. This
8457 makes it possible to store up to 8 criteria, all extracted from either the
8458 request or the response, regardless of the number of rules. Only the 8 first
8459 ones which match will be kept. Using this, it is possible to feed multiple
8460 tables at once in the hope to increase the chance to recognize a user on
Willy Tarreau9667a802013-12-09 12:52:13 +01008461 another protocol or access method. Using multiple store-request rules with
8462 the same table is possible and may be used to find the best criterion to rely
8463 on, by arranging the rules by decreasing preference order. Only the first
8464 extracted criterion for a given table will be stored. All subsequent store-
8465 request rules referencing the same table will be skipped and their ACLs will
8466 not be evaluated.
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01008467
8468 The "store-request" rules are evaluated once the server connection has been
8469 established, so that the table will contain the real server that processed
8470 the request.
8471
Cyril Bonté02ff8ef2010-12-14 22:48:49 +01008472 Note : Consider not using this feature in multi-process mode (nbproc > 1)
8473 unless you know what you do : memory is not shared between the
8474 processes, which can result in random behaviours.
8475
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01008476 Example :
8477 # forward SMTP users to the same server they just used for POP in the
8478 # last 30 minutes
8479 backend pop
8480 mode tcp
8481 balance roundrobin
8482 stick store-request src
8483 stick-table type ip size 200k expire 30m
8484 server s1 192.168.1.1:110
8485 server s2 192.168.1.1:110
8486
8487 backend smtp
8488 mode tcp
8489 balance roundrobin
8490 stick match src table pop
8491 server s1 192.168.1.1:25
8492 server s2 192.168.1.1:25
8493
Cyril Bonté02ff8ef2010-12-14 22:48:49 +01008494 See also : "stick-table", "stick on", "nbproc", "bind-process" and section 7
Willy Tarreaube722a22014-06-13 16:31:59 +02008495 about ACLs and sample fetching.
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01008496
8497
Emeric Brun7c6b82e2010-09-24 16:34:28 +02008498stick-table type {ip | integer | string [len <length>] | binary [len <length>]}
Emeric Brunf099e792010-09-27 12:05:28 +02008499 size <size> [expire <expire>] [nopurge] [peers <peersect>]
8500 [store <data_type>]*
Godbach64cef792013-12-04 16:08:22 +08008501 Configure the stickiness table for the current section
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01008502 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreauc00cdc22010-06-06 16:48:26 +02008503 no | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01008504
8505 Arguments :
8506 ip a table declared with "type ip" will only store IPv4 addresses.
8507 This form is very compact (about 50 bytes per entry) and allows
8508 very fast entry lookup and stores with almost no overhead. This
8509 is mainly used to store client source IP addresses.
8510
David du Colombier9a6d3c92011-03-17 10:40:24 +01008511 ipv6 a table declared with "type ipv6" will only store IPv6 addresses.
8512 This form is very compact (about 60 bytes per entry) and allows
8513 very fast entry lookup and stores with almost no overhead. This
8514 is mainly used to store client source IP addresses.
8515
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01008516 integer a table declared with "type integer" will store 32bit integers
8517 which can represent a client identifier found in a request for
8518 instance.
8519
8520 string a table declared with "type string" will store substrings of up
8521 to <len> characters. If the string provided by the pattern
8522 extractor is larger than <len>, it will be truncated before
8523 being stored. During matching, at most <len> characters will be
8524 compared between the string in the table and the extracted
8525 pattern. When not specified, the string is automatically limited
Emeric Brun7c6b82e2010-09-24 16:34:28 +02008526 to 32 characters.
8527
8528 binary a table declared with "type binary" will store binary blocks
8529 of <len> bytes. If the block provided by the pattern
8530 extractor is larger than <len>, it will be truncated before
Willy Tarreaube722a22014-06-13 16:31:59 +02008531 being stored. If the block provided by the sample expression
Emeric Brun7c6b82e2010-09-24 16:34:28 +02008532 is shorter than <len>, it will be padded by 0. When not
8533 specified, the block is automatically limited to 32 bytes.
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01008534
8535 <length> is the maximum number of characters that will be stored in a
Emeric Brun7c6b82e2010-09-24 16:34:28 +02008536 "string" type table (See type "string" above). Or the number
8537 of bytes of the block in "binary" type table. Be careful when
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01008538 changing this parameter as memory usage will proportionally
8539 increase.
8540
8541 <size> is the maximum number of entries that can fit in the table. This
Cyril Bonté78caf842010-03-10 22:41:43 +01008542 value directly impacts memory usage. Count approximately
8543 50 bytes per entry, plus the size of a string if any. The size
8544 supports suffixes "k", "m", "g" for 2^10, 2^20 and 2^30 factors.
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01008545
8546 [nopurge] indicates that we refuse to purge older entries when the table
8547 is full. When not specified and the table is full when haproxy
8548 wants to store an entry in it, it will flush a few of the oldest
8549 entries in order to release some space for the new ones. This is
8550 most often the desired behaviour. In some specific cases, it
8551 be desirable to refuse new entries instead of purging the older
8552 ones. That may be the case when the amount of data to store is
8553 far above the hardware limits and we prefer not to offer access
8554 to new clients than to reject the ones already connected. When
8555 using this parameter, be sure to properly set the "expire"
8556 parameter (see below).
8557
Emeric Brunf099e792010-09-27 12:05:28 +02008558 <peersect> is the name of the peers section to use for replication. Entries
8559 which associate keys to server IDs are kept synchronized with
8560 the remote peers declared in this section. All entries are also
8561 automatically learned from the local peer (old process) during a
8562 soft restart.
8563
Willy Tarreau1abc6732015-05-01 19:21:02 +02008564 NOTE : each peers section may be referenced only by tables
8565 belonging to the same unique process.
Cyril Bonté02ff8ef2010-12-14 22:48:49 +01008566
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01008567 <expire> defines the maximum duration of an entry in the table since it
8568 was last created, refreshed or matched. The expiration delay is
8569 defined using the standard time format, similarly as the various
8570 timeouts. The maximum duration is slightly above 24 days. See
Jarno Huuskonene0ee0be2017-07-04 10:35:12 +03008571 section 2.4 for more information. If this delay is not specified,
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +02008572 the session won't automatically expire, but older entries will
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01008573 be removed once full. Be sure not to use the "nopurge" parameter
8574 if not expiration delay is specified.
8575
Willy Tarreau08d5f982010-06-06 13:34:54 +02008576 <data_type> is used to store additional information in the stick-table. This
8577 may be used by ACLs in order to control various criteria related
8578 to the activity of the client matching the stick-table. For each
8579 item specified here, the size of each entry will be inflated so
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +02008580 that the additional data can fit. Several data types may be
8581 stored with an entry. Multiple data types may be specified after
8582 the "store" keyword, as a comma-separated list. Alternatively,
8583 it is possible to repeat the "store" keyword followed by one or
8584 several data types. Except for the "server_id" type which is
8585 automatically detected and enabled, all data types must be
8586 explicitly declared to be stored. If an ACL references a data
8587 type which is not stored, the ACL will simply not match. Some
8588 data types require an argument which must be passed just after
8589 the type between parenthesis. See below for the supported data
8590 types and their arguments.
8591
8592 The data types that can be stored with an entry are the following :
8593 - server_id : this is an integer which holds the numeric ID of the server a
8594 request was assigned to. It is used by the "stick match", "stick store",
8595 and "stick on" rules. It is automatically enabled when referenced.
8596
8597 - gpc0 : first General Purpose Counter. It is a positive 32-bit integer
8598 integer which may be used for anything. Most of the time it will be used
8599 to put a special tag on some entries, for instance to note that a
8600 specific behaviour was detected and must be known for future matches.
8601
Willy Tarreauba2ffd12013-05-29 15:54:14 +02008602 - gpc0_rate(<period>) : increment rate of the first General Purpose Counter
8603 over a period. It is a positive 32-bit integer integer which may be used
8604 for anything. Just like <gpc0>, it counts events, but instead of keeping
8605 a cumulative count, it maintains the rate at which the counter is
8606 incremented. Most of the time it will be used to measure the frequency of
8607 occurrence of certain events (eg: requests to a specific URL).
8608
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +02008609 - conn_cnt : Connection Count. It is a positive 32-bit integer which counts
8610 the absolute number of connections received from clients which matched
8611 this entry. It does not mean the connections were accepted, just that
8612 they were received.
8613
8614 - conn_cur : Current Connections. It is a positive 32-bit integer which
8615 stores the concurrent connection counts for the entry. It is incremented
8616 once an incoming connection matches the entry, and decremented once the
8617 connection leaves. That way it is possible to know at any time the exact
8618 number of concurrent connections for an entry.
8619
8620 - conn_rate(<period>) : frequency counter (takes 12 bytes). It takes an
8621 integer parameter <period> which indicates in milliseconds the length
8622 of the period over which the average is measured. It reports the average
8623 incoming connection rate over that period, in connections per period. The
8624 result is an integer which can be matched using ACLs.
8625
8626 - sess_cnt : Session Count. It is a positive 32-bit integer which counts
8627 the absolute number of sessions received from clients which matched this
8628 entry. A session is a connection that was accepted by the layer 4 rules.
8629
8630 - sess_rate(<period>) : frequency counter (takes 12 bytes). It takes an
8631 integer parameter <period> which indicates in milliseconds the length
8632 of the period over which the average is measured. It reports the average
8633 incoming session rate over that period, in sessions per period. The
8634 result is an integer which can be matched using ACLs.
8635
8636 - http_req_cnt : HTTP request Count. It is a positive 32-bit integer which
8637 counts the absolute number of HTTP requests received from clients which
8638 matched this entry. It does not matter whether they are valid requests or
8639 not. Note that this is different from sessions when keep-alive is used on
8640 the client side.
8641
8642 - http_req_rate(<period>) : frequency counter (takes 12 bytes). It takes an
8643 integer parameter <period> which indicates in milliseconds the length
8644 of the period over which the average is measured. It reports the average
8645 HTTP request rate over that period, in requests per period. The result is
8646 an integer which can be matched using ACLs. It does not matter whether
8647 they are valid requests or not. Note that this is different from sessions
8648 when keep-alive is used on the client side.
8649
8650 - http_err_cnt : HTTP Error Count. It is a positive 32-bit integer which
8651 counts the absolute number of HTTP requests errors induced by clients
8652 which matched this entry. Errors are counted on invalid and truncated
8653 requests, as well as on denied or tarpitted requests, and on failed
8654 authentications. If the server responds with 4xx, then the request is
8655 also counted as an error since it's an error triggered by the client
8656 (eg: vulnerability scan).
8657
8658 - http_err_rate(<period>) : frequency counter (takes 12 bytes). It takes an
8659 integer parameter <period> which indicates in milliseconds the length
8660 of the period over which the average is measured. It reports the average
8661 HTTP request error rate over that period, in requests per period (see
8662 http_err_cnt above for what is accounted as an error). The result is an
8663 integer which can be matched using ACLs.
8664
8665 - bytes_in_cnt : client to server byte count. It is a positive 64-bit
8666 integer which counts the cumulated amount of bytes received from clients
8667 which matched this entry. Headers are included in the count. This may be
8668 used to limit abuse of upload features on photo or video servers.
8669
8670 - bytes_in_rate(<period>) : frequency counter (takes 12 bytes). It takes an
8671 integer parameter <period> which indicates in milliseconds the length
8672 of the period over which the average is measured. It reports the average
8673 incoming bytes rate over that period, in bytes per period. It may be used
8674 to detect users which upload too much and too fast. Warning: with large
8675 uploads, it is possible that the amount of uploaded data will be counted
8676 once upon termination, thus causing spikes in the average transfer speed
8677 instead of having a smooth one. This may partially be smoothed with
8678 "option contstats" though this is not perfect yet. Use of byte_in_cnt is
8679 recommended for better fairness.
8680
8681 - bytes_out_cnt : server to client byte count. It is a positive 64-bit
8682 integer which counts the cumulated amount of bytes sent to clients which
8683 matched this entry. Headers are included in the count. This may be used
8684 to limit abuse of bots sucking the whole site.
8685
8686 - bytes_out_rate(<period>) : frequency counter (takes 12 bytes). It takes
8687 an integer parameter <period> which indicates in milliseconds the length
8688 of the period over which the average is measured. It reports the average
8689 outgoing bytes rate over that period, in bytes per period. It may be used
8690 to detect users which download too much and too fast. Warning: with large
8691 transfers, it is possible that the amount of transferred data will be
8692 counted once upon termination, thus causing spikes in the average
8693 transfer speed instead of having a smooth one. This may partially be
8694 smoothed with "option contstats" though this is not perfect yet. Use of
8695 byte_out_cnt is recommended for better fairness.
Willy Tarreau08d5f982010-06-06 13:34:54 +02008696
Willy Tarreauc00cdc22010-06-06 16:48:26 +02008697 There is only one stick-table per proxy. At the moment of writing this doc,
8698 it does not seem useful to have multiple tables per proxy. If this happens
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01008699 to be required, simply create a dummy backend with a stick-table in it and
8700 reference it.
8701
8702 It is important to understand that stickiness based on learning information
8703 has some limitations, including the fact that all learned associations are
Baptiste Assmann123ff042016-03-06 23:29:28 +01008704 lost upon restart unless peers are properly configured to transfer such
8705 information upon restart (recommended). In general it can be good as a
8706 complement but not always as an exclusive stickiness.
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01008707
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +02008708 Last, memory requirements may be important when storing many data types.
8709 Indeed, storing all indicators above at once in each entry requires 116 bytes
8710 per entry, or 116 MB for a 1-million entries table. This is definitely not
8711 something that can be ignored.
8712
8713 Example:
8714 # Keep track of counters of up to 1 million IP addresses over 5 minutes
8715 # and store a general purpose counter and the average connection rate
8716 # computed over a sliding window of 30 seconds.
8717 stick-table type ip size 1m expire 5m store gpc0,conn_rate(30s)
8718
Jarno Huuskonene0ee0be2017-07-04 10:35:12 +03008719 See also : "stick match", "stick on", "stick store-request", section 2.4
David du Colombiera13d1b92011-03-17 10:40:22 +01008720 about time format and section 7 about ACLs.
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01008721
8722
Emeric Brun6a1cefa2010-09-24 18:15:17 +02008723stick store-response <pattern> [table <table>] [{if | unless} <condition>]
Baptiste Assmann2f2d2ec2016-03-06 23:27:24 +01008724 Define a response pattern used to create an entry in a stickiness table
Emeric Brun6a1cefa2010-09-24 18:15:17 +02008725 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
8726 no | no | yes | yes
8727
8728 Arguments :
Willy Tarreaube722a22014-06-13 16:31:59 +02008729 <pattern> is a sample expression rule as described in section 7.3. It
Emeric Brun6a1cefa2010-09-24 18:15:17 +02008730 describes what elements of the response or connection will
8731 be analysed, extracted and stored in the table once a
8732 server is selected.
8733
8734 <table> is an optional stickiness table name. If unspecified, the same
8735 backend's table is used. A stickiness table is declared using
8736 the "stick-table" statement.
8737
8738 <cond> is an optional storage condition. It makes it possible to store
8739 certain criteria only when some conditions are met (or not met).
8740 For instance, it could be used to store the SSL session ID only
8741 when the response is a SSL server hello.
8742
8743 Some protocols or applications require complex stickiness rules and cannot
8744 always simply rely on cookies nor hashing. The "stick store-response"
8745 statement describes a rule to decide what to extract from the response and
8746 when to do it, in order to store it into a stickiness table for further
8747 requests to match it using the "stick match" statement. Obviously the
8748 extracted part must make sense and have a chance to be matched in a further
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +02008749 request. Storing an ID found in a header of a response makes sense.
Emeric Brun6a1cefa2010-09-24 18:15:17 +02008750 See section 7 for a complete list of possible patterns and transformation
8751 rules.
8752
8753 The table has to be declared using the "stick-table" statement. It must be of
8754 a type compatible with the pattern. By default it is the one which is present
8755 in the same backend. It is possible to share a table with other backends by
8756 referencing it using the "table" keyword. If another table is referenced,
8757 the server's ID inside the backends are used. By default, all server IDs
8758 start at 1 in each backend, so the server ordering is enough. But in case of
8759 doubt, it is highly recommended to force server IDs using their "id" setting.
8760
8761 It is possible to restrict the conditions where a "stick store-response"
8762 statement will apply, using "if" or "unless" followed by a condition. This
8763 condition will be evaluated while parsing the response, so any criteria can
8764 be used. See section 7 for ACL based conditions.
8765
8766 There is no limit on the number of "stick store-response" statements, but
8767 there is a limit of 8 simultaneous stores per request or response. This
8768 makes it possible to store up to 8 criteria, all extracted from either the
8769 request or the response, regardless of the number of rules. Only the 8 first
8770 ones which match will be kept. Using this, it is possible to feed multiple
8771 tables at once in the hope to increase the chance to recognize a user on
Willy Tarreau9667a802013-12-09 12:52:13 +01008772 another protocol or access method. Using multiple store-response rules with
8773 the same table is possible and may be used to find the best criterion to rely
8774 on, by arranging the rules by decreasing preference order. Only the first
8775 extracted criterion for a given table will be stored. All subsequent store-
8776 response rules referencing the same table will be skipped and their ACLs will
8777 not be evaluated. However, even if a store-request rule references a table, a
8778 store-response rule may also use the same table. This means that each table
8779 may learn exactly one element from the request and one element from the
8780 response at once.
Emeric Brun6a1cefa2010-09-24 18:15:17 +02008781
8782 The table will contain the real server that processed the request.
8783
8784 Example :
8785 # Learn SSL session ID from both request and response and create affinity.
8786 backend https
8787 mode tcp
8788 balance roundrobin
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +02008789 # maximum SSL session ID length is 32 bytes.
Emeric Brun6a1cefa2010-09-24 18:15:17 +02008790 stick-table type binary len 32 size 30k expire 30m
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +02008791
Emeric Brun6a1cefa2010-09-24 18:15:17 +02008792 acl clienthello req_ssl_hello_type 1
8793 acl serverhello rep_ssl_hello_type 2
8794
8795 # use tcp content accepts to detects ssl client and server hello.
8796 tcp-request inspect-delay 5s
8797 tcp-request content accept if clienthello
8798
8799 # no timeout on response inspect delay by default.
8800 tcp-response content accept if serverhello
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +02008801
Emeric Brun6a1cefa2010-09-24 18:15:17 +02008802 # SSL session ID (SSLID) may be present on a client or server hello.
8803 # Its length is coded on 1 byte at offset 43 and its value starts
8804 # at offset 44.
8805
8806 # Match and learn on request if client hello.
8807 stick on payload_lv(43,1) if clienthello
8808
8809 # Learn on response if server hello.
8810 stick store-response payload_lv(43,1) if serverhello
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +02008811
Emeric Brun6a1cefa2010-09-24 18:15:17 +02008812 server s1 192.168.1.1:443
8813 server s2 192.168.1.1:443
8814
8815 See also : "stick-table", "stick on", and section 7 about ACLs and pattern
8816 extraction.
8817
8818
Willy Tarreau938c7fe2014-04-25 14:21:39 +02008819tcp-check connect [params*]
8820 Opens a new connection
8821 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
8822 no | no | yes | yes
8823
8824 When an application lies on more than a single TCP port or when HAProxy
8825 load-balance many services in a single backend, it makes sense to probe all
8826 the services individually before considering a server as operational.
8827
8828 When there are no TCP port configured on the server line neither server port
8829 directive, then the 'tcp-check connect port <port>' must be the first step
8830 of the sequence.
8831
8832 In a tcp-check ruleset a 'connect' is required, it is also mandatory to start
8833 the ruleset with a 'connect' rule. Purpose is to ensure admin know what they
8834 do.
8835
8836 Parameters :
8837 They are optional and can be used to describe how HAProxy should open and
8838 use the TCP connection.
8839
8840 port if not set, check port or server port is used.
8841 It tells HAProxy where to open the connection to.
8842 <port> must be a valid TCP port source integer, from 1 to 65535.
8843
8844 send-proxy send a PROXY protocol string
8845
8846 ssl opens a ciphered connection
8847
8848 Examples:
8849 # check HTTP and HTTPs services on a server.
8850 # first open port 80 thanks to server line port directive, then
8851 # tcp-check opens port 443, ciphered and run a request on it:
8852 option tcp-check
8853 tcp-check connect
8854 tcp-check send GET\ /\ HTTP/1.0\r\n
8855 tcp-check send Host:\ haproxy.1wt.eu\r\n
8856 tcp-check send \r\n
8857 tcp-check expect rstring (2..|3..)
8858 tcp-check connect port 443 ssl
8859 tcp-check send GET\ /\ HTTP/1.0\r\n
8860 tcp-check send Host:\ haproxy.1wt.eu\r\n
8861 tcp-check send \r\n
8862 tcp-check expect rstring (2..|3..)
8863 server www 10.0.0.1 check port 80
8864
8865 # check both POP and IMAP from a single server:
8866 option tcp-check
8867 tcp-check connect port 110
8868 tcp-check expect string +OK\ POP3\ ready
8869 tcp-check connect port 143
8870 tcp-check expect string *\ OK\ IMAP4\ ready
8871 server mail 10.0.0.1 check
8872
8873 See also : "option tcp-check", "tcp-check send", "tcp-check expect"
8874
8875
8876tcp-check expect [!] <match> <pattern>
8877 Specify data to be collected and analysed during a generic health check
8878 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
8879 no | no | yes | yes
8880
8881 Arguments :
8882 <match> is a keyword indicating how to look for a specific pattern in the
8883 response. The keyword may be one of "string", "rstring" or
8884 binary.
8885 The keyword may be preceded by an exclamation mark ("!") to negate
8886 the match. Spaces are allowed between the exclamation mark and the
8887 keyword. See below for more details on the supported keywords.
8888
8889 <pattern> is the pattern to look for. It may be a string or a regular
8890 expression. If the pattern contains spaces, they must be escaped
8891 with the usual backslash ('\').
8892 If the match is set to binary, then the pattern must be passed as
8893 a serie of hexadecimal digits in an even number. Each sequence of
8894 two digits will represent a byte. The hexadecimal digits may be
8895 used upper or lower case.
8896
8897
8898 The available matches are intentionally similar to their http-check cousins :
8899
8900 string <string> : test the exact string matches in the response buffer.
8901 A health check response will be considered valid if the
8902 response's buffer contains this exact string. If the
8903 "string" keyword is prefixed with "!", then the response
8904 will be considered invalid if the body contains this
8905 string. This can be used to look for a mandatory pattern
8906 in a protocol response, or to detect a failure when a
8907 specific error appears in a protocol banner.
8908
8909 rstring <regex> : test a regular expression on the response buffer.
8910 A health check response will be considered valid if the
8911 response's buffer matches this expression. If the
8912 "rstring" keyword is prefixed with "!", then the response
8913 will be considered invalid if the body matches the
8914 expression.
8915
8916 binary <hexstring> : test the exact string in its hexadecimal form matches
8917 in the response buffer. A health check response will
8918 be considered valid if the response's buffer contains
8919 this exact hexadecimal string.
8920 Purpose is to match data on binary protocols.
8921
8922 It is important to note that the responses will be limited to a certain size
8923 defined by the global "tune.chksize" option, which defaults to 16384 bytes.
8924 Thus, too large responses may not contain the mandatory pattern when using
8925 "string", "rstring" or binary. If a large response is absolutely required, it
8926 is possible to change the default max size by setting the global variable.
8927 However, it is worth keeping in mind that parsing very large responses can
8928 waste some CPU cycles, especially when regular expressions are used, and that
8929 it is always better to focus the checks on smaller resources. Also, in its
8930 current state, the check will not find any string nor regex past a null
8931 character in the response. Similarly it is not possible to request matching
8932 the null character.
8933
8934 Examples :
8935 # perform a POP check
8936 option tcp-check
8937 tcp-check expect string +OK\ POP3\ ready
8938
8939 # perform an IMAP check
8940 option tcp-check
8941 tcp-check expect string *\ OK\ IMAP4\ ready
8942
8943 # look for the redis master server
8944 option tcp-check
8945 tcp-check send PING\r\n
Baptiste Assmanna3322992015-08-04 10:12:18 +02008946 tcp-check expect string +PONG
Willy Tarreau938c7fe2014-04-25 14:21:39 +02008947 tcp-check send info\ replication\r\n
8948 tcp-check expect string role:master
8949 tcp-check send QUIT\r\n
8950 tcp-check expect string +OK
8951
8952
8953 See also : "option tcp-check", "tcp-check connect", "tcp-check send",
8954 "tcp-check send-binary", "http-check expect", tune.chksize
8955
8956
8957tcp-check send <data>
8958 Specify a string to be sent as a question during a generic health check
8959 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
8960 no | no | yes | yes
8961
8962 <data> : the data to be sent as a question during a generic health check
8963 session. For now, <data> must be a string.
8964
8965 Examples :
8966 # look for the redis master server
8967 option tcp-check
8968 tcp-check send info\ replication\r\n
8969 tcp-check expect string role:master
8970
8971 See also : "option tcp-check", "tcp-check connect", "tcp-check expect",
8972 "tcp-check send-binary", tune.chksize
8973
8974
8975tcp-check send-binary <hexastring>
8976 Specify an hexa digits string to be sent as a binary question during a raw
8977 tcp health check
8978 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
8979 no | no | yes | yes
8980
8981 <data> : the data to be sent as a question during a generic health check
8982 session. For now, <data> must be a string.
8983 <hexastring> : test the exact string in its hexadecimal form matches in the
8984 response buffer. A health check response will be considered
8985 valid if the response's buffer contains this exact
8986 hexadecimal string.
8987 Purpose is to send binary data to ask on binary protocols.
8988
8989 Examples :
8990 # redis check in binary
8991 option tcp-check
8992 tcp-check send-binary 50494e470d0a # PING\r\n
8993 tcp-check expect binary 2b504F4e47 # +PONG
8994
8995
8996 See also : "option tcp-check", "tcp-check connect", "tcp-check expect",
8997 "tcp-check send", tune.chksize
8998
8999
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02009000tcp-request connection <action> [{if | unless} <condition>]
9001 Perform an action on an incoming connection depending on a layer 4 condition
Willy Tarreau1a687942010-05-23 22:40:30 +02009002 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
9003 no | yes | yes | no
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02009004 Arguments :
Willy Tarreauc870bfd2015-09-28 18:47:38 +02009005 <action> defines the action to perform if the condition applies. See
9006 below.
Willy Tarreau1a687942010-05-23 22:40:30 +02009007
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02009008 <condition> is a standard layer4-only ACL-based condition (see section 7).
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +02009009
9010 Immediately after acceptance of a new incoming connection, it is possible to
9011 evaluate some conditions to decide whether this connection must be accepted
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02009012 or dropped or have its counters tracked. Those conditions cannot make use of
9013 any data contents because the connection has not been read from yet, and the
9014 buffers are not yet allocated. This is used to selectively and very quickly
9015 accept or drop connections from various sources with a very low overhead. If
9016 some contents need to be inspected in order to take the decision, the
9017 "tcp-request content" statements must be used instead.
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +02009018
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02009019 The "tcp-request connection" rules are evaluated in their exact declaration
9020 order. If no rule matches or if there is no rule, the default action is to
9021 accept the incoming connection. There is no specific limit to the number of
9022 rules which may be inserted.
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +02009023
Willy Tarreaua9083d02015-05-08 15:27:59 +02009024 Four types of actions are supported :
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02009025 - accept :
9026 accepts the connection if the condition is true (when used with "if")
9027 or false (when used with "unless"). The first such rule executed ends
9028 the rules evaluation.
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +02009029
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02009030 - reject :
9031 rejects the connection if the condition is true (when used with "if")
9032 or false (when used with "unless"). The first such rule executed ends
9033 the rules evaluation. Rejected connections do not even become a
9034 session, which is why they are accounted separately for in the stats,
9035 as "denied connections". They are not considered for the session
9036 rate-limit and are not logged either. The reason is that these rules
9037 should only be used to filter extremely high connection rates such as
9038 the ones encountered during a massive DDoS attack. Under these extreme
9039 conditions, the simple action of logging each event would make the
9040 system collapse and would considerably lower the filtering capacity. If
9041 logging is absolutely desired, then "tcp-request content" rules should
Willy Tarreau4f614292016-10-21 17:49:36 +02009042 be used instead, as "tcp-request session" rules will not log either.
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +02009043
Willy Tarreau4f0d9192013-06-11 20:40:55 +02009044 - expect-proxy layer4 :
9045 configures the client-facing connection to receive a PROXY protocol
9046 header before any byte is read from the socket. This is equivalent to
9047 having the "accept-proxy" keyword on the "bind" line, except that using
9048 the TCP rule allows the PROXY protocol to be accepted only for certain
9049 IP address ranges using an ACL. This is convenient when multiple layers
9050 of load balancers are passed through by traffic coming from public
9051 hosts.
9052
Bertrand Jacquin90759682016-06-06 15:35:39 +01009053 - expect-netscaler-cip layer4 :
9054 configures the client-facing connection to receive a NetScaler Client
9055 IP insertion protocol header before any byte is read from the socket.
9056 This is equivalent to having the "accept-netscaler-cip" keyword on the
9057 "bind" line, except that using the TCP rule allows the PROXY protocol
9058 to be accepted only for certain IP address ranges using an ACL. This
9059 is convenient when multiple layers of load balancers are passed
9060 through by traffic coming from public hosts.
9061
Willy Tarreau18bf01e2014-06-13 16:18:52 +02009062 - capture <sample> len <length> :
9063 This only applies to "tcp-request content" rules. It captures sample
9064 expression <sample> from the request buffer, and converts it to a
9065 string of at most <len> characters. The resulting string is stored into
9066 the next request "capture" slot, so it will possibly appear next to
9067 some captured HTTP headers. It will then automatically appear in the
9068 logs, and it will be possible to extract it using sample fetch rules to
9069 feed it into headers or anything. The length should be limited given
9070 that this size will be allocated for each capture during the whole
Willy Tarreaua9083d02015-05-08 15:27:59 +02009071 session life. Please check section 7.3 (Fetching samples) and "capture
9072 request header" for more information.
Willy Tarreau18bf01e2014-06-13 16:18:52 +02009073
Willy Tarreaube4a3ef2013-06-17 15:04:07 +02009074 - { track-sc0 | track-sc1 | track-sc2 } <key> [table <table>] :
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02009075 enables tracking of sticky counters from current connection. These
Willy Tarreau09448f72014-06-25 18:12:15 +02009076 rules do not stop evaluation and do not change default action. 3 sets
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02009077 of counters may be simultaneously tracked by the same connection. The
Willy Tarreaube4a3ef2013-06-17 15:04:07 +02009078 first "track-sc0" rule executed enables tracking of the counters of the
9079 specified table as the first set. The first "track-sc1" rule executed
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02009080 enables tracking of the counters of the specified table as the second
Willy Tarreaube4a3ef2013-06-17 15:04:07 +02009081 set. The first "track-sc2" rule executed enables tracking of the
9082 counters of the specified table as the third set. It is a recommended
9083 practice to use the first set of counters for the per-frontend counters
9084 and the second set for the per-backend ones. But this is just a
9085 guideline, all may be used everywhere.
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +02009086
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02009087 These actions take one or two arguments :
Willy Tarreaube722a22014-06-13 16:31:59 +02009088 <key> is mandatory, and is a sample expression rule as described
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +02009089 in section 7.3. It describes what elements of the incoming
Willy Tarreau5d5b5d82012-12-09 12:00:04 +01009090 request or connection will be analysed, extracted, combined,
9091 and used to select which table entry to update the counters.
9092 Note that "tcp-request connection" cannot use content-based
9093 fetches.
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +02009094
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02009095 <table> is an optional table to be used instead of the default one,
9096 which is the stick-table declared in the current proxy. All
9097 the counters for the matches and updates for the key will
9098 then be performed in that table until the session ends.
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +02009099
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02009100 Once a "track-sc*" rule is executed, the key is looked up in the table
9101 and if it is not found, an entry is allocated for it. Then a pointer to
9102 that entry is kept during all the session's life, and this entry's
9103 counters are updated as often as possible, every time the session's
9104 counters are updated, and also systematically when the session ends.
Willy Tarreau5d5b5d82012-12-09 12:00:04 +01009105 Counters are only updated for events that happen after the tracking has
9106 been started. For example, connection counters will not be updated when
9107 tracking layer 7 information, since the connection event happens before
9108 layer7 information is extracted.
9109
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02009110 If the entry tracks concurrent connection counters, one connection is
9111 counted for as long as the entry is tracked, and the entry will not
9112 expire during that time. Tracking counters also provides a performance
9113 advantage over just checking the keys, because only one table lookup is
9114 performed for all ACL checks that make use of it.
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +02009115
Thierry FOURNIERe0627bd2015-08-04 08:20:33 +02009116 - sc-inc-gpc0(<sc-id>):
9117 The "sc-inc-gpc0" increments the GPC0 counter according to the sticky
9118 counter designated by <sc-id>. If an error occurs, this action silently
9119 fails and the actions evaluation continues.
9120
Thierry FOURNIER236657b2015-08-19 08:25:14 +02009121 - sc-set-gpt0(<sc-id>) <int>:
9122 This action sets the GPT0 tag according to the sticky counter designated
9123 by <sc-id> and the value of <int>. The expected result is a boolean. If
9124 an error occurs, this action silently fails and the actions evaluation
9125 continues.
9126
William Lallemand2e785f22016-05-25 01:48:42 +02009127 - set-src <expr> :
9128 Is used to set the source IP address to the value of specified
9129 expression. Useful if you want to mask source IP for privacy.
9130 If you want to provide an IP from a HTTP header use "http-request
9131 set-src"
9132
9133 <expr> Is a standard HAProxy expression formed by a sample-fetch
9134 followed by some converters.
9135
9136 Example:
9137
9138 tcp-request connection set-src src,ipmask(24)
9139
Willy Tarreau0c630532016-10-21 17:52:58 +02009140 When possible, set-src preserves the original source port as long as the
9141 address family allows it, otherwise the source port is set to 0.
William Lallemand2e785f22016-05-25 01:48:42 +02009142
William Lallemand44be6402016-05-25 01:51:35 +02009143 - set-src-port <expr> :
9144 Is used to set the source port address to the value of specified
9145 expression.
9146
9147 <expr> Is a standard HAProxy expression formed by a sample-fetch
9148 followed by some converters.
9149
9150 Example:
9151
9152 tcp-request connection set-src-port int(4000)
9153
Willy Tarreau0c630532016-10-21 17:52:58 +02009154 When possible, set-src-port preserves the original source address as long
9155 as the address family supports a port, otherwise it forces the source
9156 address to IPv4 "0.0.0.0" before rewriting the port.
William Lallemand44be6402016-05-25 01:51:35 +02009157
William Lallemand13e9b0c2016-05-25 02:34:07 +02009158 - set-dst <expr> :
9159 Is used to set the destination IP address to the value of specified
9160 expression. Useful if you want to mask IP for privacy in log.
9161 If you want to provide an IP from a HTTP header use "http-request
9162 set-dst". If you want to connect to the new address/port, use
9163 '0.0.0.0:0' as a server address in the backend.
9164
9165 <expr> Is a standard HAProxy expression formed by a sample-fetch
9166 followed by some converters.
9167
9168 Example:
9169
9170 tcp-request connection set-dst dst,ipmask(24)
9171 tcp-request connection set-dst ipv4(10.0.0.1)
9172
Willy Tarreau0c630532016-10-21 17:52:58 +02009173 When possible, set-dst preserves the original destination port as long as
9174 the address family allows it, otherwise the destination port is set to 0.
9175
William Lallemand13e9b0c2016-05-25 02:34:07 +02009176 - set-dst-port <expr> :
9177 Is used to set the destination port address to the value of specified
9178 expression. If you want to connect to the new address/port, use
9179 '0.0.0.0:0' as a server address in the backend.
9180
9181
9182 <expr> Is a standard HAProxy expression formed by a sample-fetch
9183 followed by some converters.
9184
9185 Example:
9186
9187 tcp-request connection set-dst-port int(4000)
9188
Willy Tarreau0c630532016-10-21 17:52:58 +02009189 When possible, set-dst-port preserves the original destination address as
9190 long as the address family supports a port, otherwise it forces the
9191 destination address to IPv4 "0.0.0.0" before rewriting the port.
9192
Willy Tarreau2d392c22015-08-24 01:43:45 +02009193 - "silent-drop" :
9194 This stops the evaluation of the rules and makes the client-facing
9195 connection suddenly disappear using a system-dependant way that tries
9196 to prevent the client from being notified. The effect it then that the
9197 client still sees an established connection while there's none on
9198 HAProxy. The purpose is to achieve a comparable effect to "tarpit"
9199 except that it doesn't use any local resource at all on the machine
9200 running HAProxy. It can resist much higher loads than "tarpit", and
9201 slow down stronger attackers. It is important to undestand the impact
9202 of using this mechanism. All stateful equipments placed between the
9203 client and HAProxy (firewalls, proxies, load balancers) will also keep
9204 the established connection for a long time and may suffer from this
9205 action. On modern Linux systems running with enough privileges, the
9206 TCP_REPAIR socket option is used to block the emission of a TCP
9207 reset. On other systems, the socket's TTL is reduced to 1 so that the
9208 TCP reset doesn't pass the first router, though it's still delivered to
9209 local networks. Do not use it unless you fully understand how it works.
9210
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02009211 Note that the "if/unless" condition is optional. If no condition is set on
9212 the action, it is simply performed unconditionally. That can be useful for
9213 "track-sc*" actions as well as for changing the default action to a reject.
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +02009214
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02009215 Example: accept all connections from white-listed hosts, reject too fast
9216 connection without counting them, and track accepted connections.
9217 This results in connection rate being capped from abusive sources.
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +02009218
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02009219 tcp-request connection accept if { src -f /etc/haproxy/whitelist.lst }
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +02009220 tcp-request connection reject if { src_conn_rate gt 10 }
Willy Tarreaube4a3ef2013-06-17 15:04:07 +02009221 tcp-request connection track-sc0 src
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +02009222
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02009223 Example: accept all connections from white-listed hosts, count all other
9224 connections and reject too fast ones. This results in abusive ones
9225 being blocked as long as they don't slow down.
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +02009226
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02009227 tcp-request connection accept if { src -f /etc/haproxy/whitelist.lst }
Willy Tarreaube4a3ef2013-06-17 15:04:07 +02009228 tcp-request connection track-sc0 src
9229 tcp-request connection reject if { sc0_conn_rate gt 10 }
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +02009230
Willy Tarreau4f0d9192013-06-11 20:40:55 +02009231 Example: enable the PROXY protocol for traffic coming from all known proxies.
9232
9233 tcp-request connection expect-proxy layer4 if { src -f proxies.lst }
9234
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +02009235 See section 7 about ACL usage.
9236
Willy Tarreau4f614292016-10-21 17:49:36 +02009237 See also : "tcp-request session", "tcp-request content", "stick-table"
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +02009238
9239
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02009240tcp-request content <action> [{if | unless} <condition>]
9241 Perform an action on a new session depending on a layer 4-7 condition
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02009242 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreaufb356202010-08-03 14:02:05 +02009243 no | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02009244 Arguments :
Willy Tarreauc870bfd2015-09-28 18:47:38 +02009245 <action> defines the action to perform if the condition applies. See
9246 below.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02009247
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02009248 <condition> is a standard layer 4-7 ACL-based condition (see section 7).
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02009249
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02009250 A request's contents can be analysed at an early stage of request processing
9251 called "TCP content inspection". During this stage, ACL-based rules are
9252 evaluated every time the request contents are updated, until either an
9253 "accept" or a "reject" rule matches, or the TCP request inspection delay
9254 expires with no matching rule.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02009255
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02009256 The first difference between these rules and "tcp-request connection" rules
9257 is that "tcp-request content" rules can make use of contents to take a
9258 decision. Most often, these decisions will consider a protocol recognition or
9259 validity. The second difference is that content-based rules can be used in
Willy Tarreauf3338342014-01-28 21:40:28 +01009260 both frontends and backends. In case of HTTP keep-alive with the client, all
9261 tcp-request content rules are evaluated again, so haproxy keeps a record of
9262 what sticky counters were assigned by a "tcp-request connection" versus a
9263 "tcp-request content" rule, and flushes all the content-related ones after
9264 processing an HTTP request, so that they may be evaluated again by the rules
9265 being evaluated again for the next request. This is of particular importance
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03009266 when the rule tracks some L7 information or when it is conditioned by an
Willy Tarreauf3338342014-01-28 21:40:28 +01009267 L7-based ACL, since tracking may change between requests.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02009268
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02009269 Content-based rules are evaluated in their exact declaration order. If no
9270 rule matches or if there is no rule, the default action is to accept the
9271 contents. There is no specific limit to the number of rules which may be
9272 inserted.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02009273
Thierry FOURNIER236657b2015-08-19 08:25:14 +02009274 Several types of actions are supported :
Willy Tarreau18bf01e2014-06-13 16:18:52 +02009275 - accept : the request is accepted
9276 - reject : the request is rejected and the connection is closed
9277 - capture : the specified sample expression is captured
Willy Tarreaube4a3ef2013-06-17 15:04:07 +02009278 - { track-sc0 | track-sc1 | track-sc2 } <key> [table <table>]
Thierry FOURNIERe0627bd2015-08-04 08:20:33 +02009279 - sc-inc-gpc0(<sc-id>)
Thierry Fournierb9125672016-03-29 19:34:37 +02009280 - sc-set-gpt0(<sc-id>) <int>
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +02009281 - set-var(<var-name>) <expr>
Christopher Faulet85d79c92016-11-09 16:54:56 +01009282 - unset-var(<var-name>)
Willy Tarreau2d392c22015-08-24 01:43:45 +02009283 - silent-drop
Christopher Faulet76c09ef2017-09-21 11:03:52 +02009284 - send-spoe-group <engin-name> <group-name>
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02009285
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02009286 They have the same meaning as their counter-parts in "tcp-request connection"
9287 so please refer to that section for a complete description.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02009288
Willy Tarreauf3338342014-01-28 21:40:28 +01009289 While there is nothing mandatory about it, it is recommended to use the
9290 track-sc0 in "tcp-request connection" rules, track-sc1 for "tcp-request
9291 content" rules in the frontend, and track-sc2 for "tcp-request content"
9292 rules in the backend, because that makes the configuration more readable
9293 and easier to troubleshoot, but this is just a guideline and all counters
9294 may be used everywhere.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02009295
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01009296 Note that the "if/unless" condition is optional. If no condition is set on
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02009297 the action, it is simply performed unconditionally. That can be useful for
9298 "track-sc*" actions as well as for changing the default action to a reject.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02009299
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02009300 It is perfectly possible to match layer 7 contents with "tcp-request content"
Willy Tarreauc0239e02012-04-16 14:42:55 +02009301 rules, since HTTP-specific ACL matches are able to preliminarily parse the
9302 contents of a buffer before extracting the required data. If the buffered
9303 contents do not parse as a valid HTTP message, then the ACL does not match.
9304 The parser which is involved there is exactly the same as for all other HTTP
Willy Tarreauf3338342014-01-28 21:40:28 +01009305 processing, so there is no risk of parsing something differently. In an HTTP
9306 backend connected to from an HTTP frontend, it is guaranteed that HTTP
9307 contents will always be immediately present when the rule is evaluated first.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02009308
Willy Tarreau5d5b5d82012-12-09 12:00:04 +01009309 Tracking layer7 information is also possible provided that the information
Willy Tarreau4d54c7c2014-09-16 15:48:15 +02009310 are present when the rule is processed. The rule processing engine is able to
9311 wait until the inspect delay expires when the data to be tracked is not yet
9312 available.
Willy Tarreau5d5b5d82012-12-09 12:00:04 +01009313
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +02009314 The "set-var" is used to set the content of a variable. The variable is
Willy Tarreau4f614292016-10-21 17:49:36 +02009315 declared inline. For "tcp-request session" rules, only session-level
9316 variables can be used, without any layer7 contents.
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +02009317
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +01009318 <var-name> The name of the variable starts with an indication about
9319 its scope. The scopes allowed are:
Christopher Fauletff2613e2016-11-09 11:36:17 +01009320 "proc" : the variable is shared with the whole process
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +01009321 "sess" : the variable is shared with the whole session
9322 "txn" : the variable is shared with the transaction
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +02009323 (request and response)
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +01009324 "req" : the variable is shared only during request
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +02009325 processing
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +01009326 "res" : the variable is shared only during response
9327 processing
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +02009328 This prefix is followed by a name. The separator is a '.'.
Christopher Fauletb71557a2016-10-31 10:49:03 +01009329 The name may only contain characters 'a-z', 'A-Z', '0-9',
9330 '.' and '_'.
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +02009331
9332 <expr> Is a standard HAProxy expression formed by a sample-fetch
9333 followed by some converters.
9334
Christopher Faulet85d79c92016-11-09 16:54:56 +01009335 The "unset-var" is used to unset a variable. See above for details about
9336 <var-name>.
9337
Christopher Faulet76c09ef2017-09-21 11:03:52 +02009338 The "send-spoe-group" is used to trigger sending of a group of SPOE
9339 messages. To do so, the SPOE engine used to send messages must be defined, as
9340 well as the SPOE group to send. Of course, the SPOE engine must refer to an
9341 existing SPOE filter. If not engine name is provided on the SPOE filter line,
9342 the SPOE agent name must be used.
9343
9344 <engine-name> The SPOE engine name.
9345
9346 <group-name> The SPOE group name as specified in the engine configuration.
9347
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +02009348 Example:
9349
9350 tcp-request content set-var(sess.my_var) src
Christopher Faulet85d79c92016-11-09 16:54:56 +01009351 tcp-request content unset-var(sess.my_var2)
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +02009352
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02009353 Example:
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02009354 # Accept HTTP requests containing a Host header saying "example.com"
9355 # and reject everything else.
9356 acl is_host_com hdr(Host) -i example.com
9357 tcp-request inspect-delay 30s
Willy Tarreauc0239e02012-04-16 14:42:55 +02009358 tcp-request content accept if is_host_com
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02009359 tcp-request content reject
9360
9361 Example:
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02009362 # reject SMTP connection if client speaks first
9363 tcp-request inspect-delay 30s
9364 acl content_present req_len gt 0
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +02009365 tcp-request content reject if content_present
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02009366
9367 # Forward HTTPS connection only if client speaks
9368 tcp-request inspect-delay 30s
9369 acl content_present req_len gt 0
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +02009370 tcp-request content accept if content_present
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02009371 tcp-request content reject
9372
Willy Tarreau5d5b5d82012-12-09 12:00:04 +01009373 Example:
Jarno Huuskonene5ae7022017-04-03 14:36:21 +03009374 # Track the last IP(stick-table type string) from X-Forwarded-For
Willy Tarreau5d5b5d82012-12-09 12:00:04 +01009375 tcp-request inspect-delay 10s
Willy Tarreau4d54c7c2014-09-16 15:48:15 +02009376 tcp-request content track-sc0 hdr(x-forwarded-for,-1)
Jarno Huuskonene5ae7022017-04-03 14:36:21 +03009377 # Or track the last IP(stick-table type ip|ipv6) from X-Forwarded-For
9378 tcp-request content track-sc0 req.hdr_ip(x-forwarded-for,-1)
Willy Tarreau5d5b5d82012-12-09 12:00:04 +01009379
9380 Example:
9381 # track request counts per "base" (concatenation of Host+URL)
9382 tcp-request inspect-delay 10s
Willy Tarreau4d54c7c2014-09-16 15:48:15 +02009383 tcp-request content track-sc0 base table req-rate
Willy Tarreau5d5b5d82012-12-09 12:00:04 +01009384
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02009385 Example: track per-frontend and per-backend counters, block abusers at the
Jarno Huuskonene5ae7022017-04-03 14:36:21 +03009386 frontend when the backend detects abuse(and marks gpc0).
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02009387
9388 frontend http
Willy Tarreaube4a3ef2013-06-17 15:04:07 +02009389 # Use General Purpose Couter 0 in SC0 as a global abuse counter
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02009390 # protecting all our sites
9391 stick-table type ip size 1m expire 5m store gpc0
Willy Tarreaube4a3ef2013-06-17 15:04:07 +02009392 tcp-request connection track-sc0 src
9393 tcp-request connection reject if { sc0_get_gpc0 gt 0 }
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02009394 ...
9395 use_backend http_dynamic if { path_end .php }
9396
9397 backend http_dynamic
9398 # if a source makes too fast requests to this dynamic site (tracked
Willy Tarreaube4a3ef2013-06-17 15:04:07 +02009399 # by SC1), block it globally in the frontend.
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02009400 stick-table type ip size 1m expire 5m store http_req_rate(10s)
Willy Tarreaube4a3ef2013-06-17 15:04:07 +02009401 acl click_too_fast sc1_http_req_rate gt 10
Jarno Huuskonene5ae7022017-04-03 14:36:21 +03009402 acl mark_as_abuser sc0_inc_gpc0(http) gt 0
Willy Tarreaube4a3ef2013-06-17 15:04:07 +02009403 tcp-request content track-sc1 src
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02009404 tcp-request content reject if click_too_fast mark_as_abuser
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02009405
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02009406 See section 7 about ACL usage.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02009407
Jarno Huuskonen95b012b2017-04-06 13:59:14 +03009408 See also : "tcp-request connection", "tcp-request session",
9409 "tcp-request inspect-delay", and "http-request".
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02009410
9411
9412tcp-request inspect-delay <timeout>
9413 Set the maximum allowed time to wait for data during content inspection
9414 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreaufb356202010-08-03 14:02:05 +02009415 no | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02009416 Arguments :
9417 <timeout> is the timeout value specified in milliseconds by default, but
9418 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
9419 as explained at the top of this document.
9420
9421 People using haproxy primarily as a TCP relay are often worried about the
9422 risk of passing any type of protocol to a server without any analysis. In
9423 order to be able to analyze the request contents, we must first withhold
9424 the data then analyze them. This statement simply enables withholding of
9425 data for at most the specified amount of time.
9426
Willy Tarreaufb356202010-08-03 14:02:05 +02009427 TCP content inspection applies very early when a connection reaches a
9428 frontend, then very early when the connection is forwarded to a backend. This
9429 means that a connection may experience a first delay in the frontend and a
9430 second delay in the backend if both have tcp-request rules.
9431
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02009432 Note that when performing content inspection, haproxy will evaluate the whole
9433 rules for every new chunk which gets in, taking into account the fact that
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01009434 those data are partial. If no rule matches before the aforementioned delay,
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02009435 a last check is performed upon expiration, this time considering that the
Willy Tarreaud869b242009-03-15 14:43:58 +01009436 contents are definitive. If no delay is set, haproxy will not wait at all
9437 and will immediately apply a verdict based on the available information.
9438 Obviously this is unlikely to be very useful and might even be racy, so such
9439 setups are not recommended.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02009440
9441 As soon as a rule matches, the request is released and continues as usual. If
9442 the timeout is reached and no rule matches, the default policy will be to let
9443 it pass through unaffected.
9444
9445 For most protocols, it is enough to set it to a few seconds, as most clients
9446 send the full request immediately upon connection. Add 3 or more seconds to
9447 cover TCP retransmits but that's all. For some protocols, it may make sense
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +01009448 to use large values, for instance to ensure that the client never talks
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02009449 before the server (eg: SMTP), or to wait for a client to talk before passing
9450 data to the server (eg: SSL). Note that the client timeout must cover at
Willy Tarreaub824b002010-09-29 16:36:16 +02009451 least the inspection delay, otherwise it will expire first. If the client
9452 closes the connection or if the buffer is full, the delay immediately expires
9453 since the contents will not be able to change anymore.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02009454
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +02009455 See also : "tcp-request content accept", "tcp-request content reject",
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02009456 "timeout client".
9457
9458
Emeric Brun0a3b67f2010-09-24 15:34:53 +02009459tcp-response content <action> [{if | unless} <condition>]
9460 Perform an action on a session response depending on a layer 4-7 condition
9461 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
9462 no | no | yes | yes
9463 Arguments :
Willy Tarreauc870bfd2015-09-28 18:47:38 +02009464 <action> defines the action to perform if the condition applies. See
9465 below.
Emeric Brun0a3b67f2010-09-24 15:34:53 +02009466
9467 <condition> is a standard layer 4-7 ACL-based condition (see section 7).
9468
9469 Response contents can be analysed at an early stage of response processing
9470 called "TCP content inspection". During this stage, ACL-based rules are
9471 evaluated every time the response contents are updated, until either an
Willy Tarreaucc1e04b2013-09-11 23:20:29 +02009472 "accept", "close" or a "reject" rule matches, or a TCP response inspection
9473 delay is set and expires with no matching rule.
Emeric Brun0a3b67f2010-09-24 15:34:53 +02009474
9475 Most often, these decisions will consider a protocol recognition or validity.
9476
9477 Content-based rules are evaluated in their exact declaration order. If no
9478 rule matches or if there is no rule, the default action is to accept the
9479 contents. There is no specific limit to the number of rules which may be
9480 inserted.
9481
Thierry FOURNIER236657b2015-08-19 08:25:14 +02009482 Several types of actions are supported :
Emeric Brun0a3b67f2010-09-24 15:34:53 +02009483 - accept :
9484 accepts the response if the condition is true (when used with "if")
9485 or false (when used with "unless"). The first such rule executed ends
9486 the rules evaluation.
9487
Willy Tarreaucc1e04b2013-09-11 23:20:29 +02009488 - close :
9489 immediately closes the connection with the server if the condition is
9490 true (when used with "if"), or false (when used with "unless"). The
9491 first such rule executed ends the rules evaluation. The main purpose of
9492 this action is to force a connection to be finished between a client
9493 and a server after an exchange when the application protocol expects
9494 some long time outs to elapse first. The goal is to eliminate idle
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03009495 connections which take significant resources on servers with certain
Willy Tarreaucc1e04b2013-09-11 23:20:29 +02009496 protocols.
9497
Emeric Brun0a3b67f2010-09-24 15:34:53 +02009498 - reject :
9499 rejects the response if the condition is true (when used with "if")
9500 or false (when used with "unless"). The first such rule executed ends
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -04009501 the rules evaluation. Rejected session are immediately closed.
Emeric Brun0a3b67f2010-09-24 15:34:53 +02009502
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +02009503 - set-var(<var-name>) <expr>
9504 Sets a variable.
9505
Christopher Faulet85d79c92016-11-09 16:54:56 +01009506 - unset-var(<var-name>)
9507 Unsets a variable.
9508
Thierry FOURNIERe0627bd2015-08-04 08:20:33 +02009509 - sc-inc-gpc0(<sc-id>):
9510 This action increments the GPC0 counter according to the sticky
9511 counter designated by <sc-id>. If an error occurs, this action fails
9512 silently and the actions evaluation continues.
9513
Thierry FOURNIER236657b2015-08-19 08:25:14 +02009514 - sc-set-gpt0(<sc-id>) <int> :
9515 This action sets the GPT0 tag according to the sticky counter designated
9516 by <sc-id> and the value of <int>. The expected result is a boolean. If
9517 an error occurs, this action silently fails and the actions evaluation
9518 continues.
9519
Willy Tarreau2d392c22015-08-24 01:43:45 +02009520 - "silent-drop" :
9521 This stops the evaluation of the rules and makes the client-facing
9522 connection suddenly disappear using a system-dependant way that tries
9523 to prevent the client from being notified. The effect it then that the
9524 client still sees an established connection while there's none on
9525 HAProxy. The purpose is to achieve a comparable effect to "tarpit"
9526 except that it doesn't use any local resource at all on the machine
9527 running HAProxy. It can resist much higher loads than "tarpit", and
9528 slow down stronger attackers. It is important to undestand the impact
9529 of using this mechanism. All stateful equipments placed between the
9530 client and HAProxy (firewalls, proxies, load balancers) will also keep
9531 the established connection for a long time and may suffer from this
9532 action. On modern Linux systems running with enough privileges, the
9533 TCP_REPAIR socket option is used to block the emission of a TCP
9534 reset. On other systems, the socket's TTL is reduced to 1 so that the
9535 TCP reset doesn't pass the first router, though it's still delivered to
9536 local networks. Do not use it unless you fully understand how it works.
9537
Christopher Faulet76c09ef2017-09-21 11:03:52 +02009538 - send-spoe-group <engine-name> <group-name>
9539 Send a group of SPOE messages.
9540
Emeric Brun0a3b67f2010-09-24 15:34:53 +02009541 Note that the "if/unless" condition is optional. If no condition is set on
9542 the action, it is simply performed unconditionally. That can be useful for
9543 for changing the default action to a reject.
9544
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -04009545 It is perfectly possible to match layer 7 contents with "tcp-response
9546 content" rules, but then it is important to ensure that a full response has
9547 been buffered, otherwise no contents will match. In order to achieve this,
9548 the best solution involves detecting the HTTP protocol during the inspection
Emeric Brun0a3b67f2010-09-24 15:34:53 +02009549 period.
9550
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +02009551 The "set-var" is used to set the content of a variable. The variable is
9552 declared inline.
9553
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +01009554 <var-name> The name of the variable starts with an indication about
9555 its scope. The scopes allowed are:
Christopher Fauletff2613e2016-11-09 11:36:17 +01009556 "proc" : the variable is shared with the whole process
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +01009557 "sess" : the variable is shared with the whole session
9558 "txn" : the variable is shared with the transaction
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +02009559 (request and response)
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +01009560 "req" : the variable is shared only during request
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +02009561 processing
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +01009562 "res" : the variable is shared only during response
9563 processing
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +02009564 This prefix is followed by a name. The separator is a '.'.
Christopher Fauletb71557a2016-10-31 10:49:03 +01009565 The name may only contain characters 'a-z', 'A-Z', '0-9',
9566 '.' and '_'.
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +02009567
9568 <expr> Is a standard HAProxy expression formed by a sample-fetch
9569 followed by some converters.
9570
9571 Example:
9572
9573 tcp-request content set-var(sess.my_var) src
9574
Christopher Faulet85d79c92016-11-09 16:54:56 +01009575 The "unset-var" is used to unset a variable. See above for details about
9576 <var-name>.
9577
9578 Example:
9579
9580 tcp-request content unset-var(sess.my_var)
9581
Christopher Faulet76c09ef2017-09-21 11:03:52 +02009582 The "send-spoe-group" is used to trigger sending of a group of SPOE
9583 messages. To do so, the SPOE engine used to send messages must be defined, as
9584 well as the SPOE group to send. Of course, the SPOE engine must refer to an
9585 existing SPOE filter. If not engine name is provided on the SPOE filter line,
9586 the SPOE agent name must be used.
9587
9588 <engine-name> The SPOE engine name.
9589
9590 <group-name> The SPOE group name as specified in the engine configuration.
9591
Emeric Brun0a3b67f2010-09-24 15:34:53 +02009592 See section 7 about ACL usage.
9593
9594 See also : "tcp-request content", "tcp-response inspect-delay"
9595
9596
Willy Tarreau4f614292016-10-21 17:49:36 +02009597tcp-request session <action> [{if | unless} <condition>]
9598 Perform an action on a validated session depending on a layer 5 condition
9599 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
9600 no | yes | yes | no
9601 Arguments :
9602 <action> defines the action to perform if the condition applies. See
9603 below.
9604
9605 <condition> is a standard layer5-only ACL-based condition (see section 7).
9606
9607 Once a session is validated, (ie. after all handshakes have been completed),
9608 it is possible to evaluate some conditions to decide whether this session
9609 must be accepted or dropped or have its counters tracked. Those conditions
9610 cannot make use of any data contents because no buffers are allocated yet and
9611 the processing cannot wait at this stage. The main use case it to copy some
9612 early information into variables (since variables are accessible in the
9613 session), or to keep track of some information collected after the handshake,
9614 such as SSL-level elements (SNI, ciphers, client cert's CN) or information
9615 from the PROXY protocol header (eg: track a source forwarded this way). The
9616 extracted information can thus be copied to a variable or tracked using
9617 "track-sc" rules. Of course it is also possible to decide to accept/reject as
9618 with other rulesets. Most operations performed here could also be performed
9619 in "tcp-request content" rules, except that in HTTP these rules are evaluated
9620 for each new request, and that might not always be acceptable. For example a
9621 rule might increment a counter on each evaluation. It would also be possible
9622 that a country is resolved by geolocation from the source IP address,
9623 assigned to a session-wide variable, then the source address rewritten from
9624 an HTTP header for all requests. If some contents need to be inspected in
9625 order to take the decision, the "tcp-request content" statements must be used
9626 instead.
9627
9628 The "tcp-request session" rules are evaluated in their exact declaration
9629 order. If no rule matches or if there is no rule, the default action is to
9630 accept the incoming session. There is no specific limit to the number of
9631 rules which may be inserted.
9632
9633 Several types of actions are supported :
9634 - accept : the request is accepted
9635 - reject : the request is rejected and the connection is closed
9636 - { track-sc0 | track-sc1 | track-sc2 } <key> [table <table>]
9637 - sc-inc-gpc0(<sc-id>)
9638 - sc-set-gpt0(<sc-id>) <int>
9639 - set-var(<var-name>) <expr>
Christopher Faulet85d79c92016-11-09 16:54:56 +01009640 - unset-var(<var-name>)
Willy Tarreau4f614292016-10-21 17:49:36 +02009641 - silent-drop
9642
9643 These actions have the same meaning as their respective counter-parts in
9644 "tcp-request connection" and "tcp-request content", so please refer to these
9645 sections for a complete description.
9646
9647 Note that the "if/unless" condition is optional. If no condition is set on
9648 the action, it is simply performed unconditionally. That can be useful for
9649 "track-sc*" actions as well as for changing the default action to a reject.
9650
9651 Example: track the original source address by default, or the one advertised
9652 in the PROXY protocol header for connection coming from the local
9653 proxies. The first connection-level rule enables receipt of the
9654 PROXY protocol for these ones, the second rule tracks whatever
9655 address we decide to keep after optional decoding.
9656
9657 tcp-request connection expect-proxy layer4 if { src -f proxies.lst }
9658 tcp-request session track-sc0 src
9659
9660 Example: accept all sessions from white-listed hosts, reject too fast
9661 sessions without counting them, and track accepted sessions.
9662 This results in session rate being capped from abusive sources.
9663
9664 tcp-request session accept if { src -f /etc/haproxy/whitelist.lst }
9665 tcp-request session reject if { src_sess_rate gt 10 }
9666 tcp-request session track-sc0 src
9667
9668 Example: accept all sessions from white-listed hosts, count all other
9669 sessions and reject too fast ones. This results in abusive ones
9670 being blocked as long as they don't slow down.
9671
9672 tcp-request session accept if { src -f /etc/haproxy/whitelist.lst }
9673 tcp-request session track-sc0 src
9674 tcp-request session reject if { sc0_sess_rate gt 10 }
9675
9676 See section 7 about ACL usage.
9677
9678 See also : "tcp-request connection", "tcp-request content", "stick-table"
9679
9680
Emeric Brun0a3b67f2010-09-24 15:34:53 +02009681tcp-response inspect-delay <timeout>
9682 Set the maximum allowed time to wait for a response during content inspection
9683 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
9684 no | no | yes | yes
9685 Arguments :
9686 <timeout> is the timeout value specified in milliseconds by default, but
9687 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
9688 as explained at the top of this document.
9689
9690 See also : "tcp-response content", "tcp-request inspect-delay".
9691
9692
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki5259dfe2008-01-21 01:54:06 +01009693timeout check <timeout>
9694 Set additional check timeout, but only after a connection has been already
9695 established.
9696
9697 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
9698 yes | no | yes | yes
9699 Arguments:
9700 <timeout> is the timeout value specified in milliseconds by default, but
9701 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
9702 as explained at the top of this document.
9703
9704 If set, haproxy uses min("timeout connect", "inter") as a connect timeout
9705 for check and "timeout check" as an additional read timeout. The "min" is
9706 used so that people running with *very* long "timeout connect" (eg. those
9707 who needed this due to the queue or tarpit) do not slow down their checks.
Willy Tarreaud7550a22010-02-10 05:10:19 +01009708 (Please also note that there is no valid reason to have such long connect
9709 timeouts, because "timeout queue" and "timeout tarpit" can always be used to
9710 avoid that).
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki5259dfe2008-01-21 01:54:06 +01009711
9712 If "timeout check" is not set haproxy uses "inter" for complete check
9713 timeout (connect + read) exactly like all <1.3.15 version.
9714
9715 In most cases check request is much simpler and faster to handle than normal
9716 requests and people may want to kick out laggy servers so this timeout should
Willy Tarreau41a340d2008-01-22 12:25:31 +01009717 be smaller than "timeout server".
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki5259dfe2008-01-21 01:54:06 +01009718
9719 This parameter is specific to backends, but can be specified once for all in
9720 "defaults" sections. This is in fact one of the easiest solutions not to
9721 forget about it.
9722
Willy Tarreau41a340d2008-01-22 12:25:31 +01009723 See also: "timeout connect", "timeout queue", "timeout server",
9724 "timeout tarpit".
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki5259dfe2008-01-21 01:54:06 +01009725
9726
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01009727timeout client <timeout>
9728timeout clitimeout <timeout> (deprecated)
9729 Set the maximum inactivity time on the client side.
9730 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
9731 yes | yes | yes | no
9732 Arguments :
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01009733 <timeout> is the timeout value specified in milliseconds by default, but
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01009734 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
9735 as explained at the top of this document.
9736
9737 The inactivity timeout applies when the client is expected to acknowledge or
9738 send data. In HTTP mode, this timeout is particularly important to consider
9739 during the first phase, when the client sends the request, and during the
Baptiste Assmann2e1941e2016-03-06 23:24:12 +01009740 response while it is reading data sent by the server. That said, for the
9741 first phase, it is preferable to set the "timeout http-request" to better
9742 protect HAProxy from Slowloris like attacks. The value is specified in
9743 milliseconds by default, but can be in any other unit if the number is
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01009744 suffixed by the unit, as specified at the top of this document. In TCP mode
9745 (and to a lesser extent, in HTTP mode), it is highly recommended that the
9746 client timeout remains equal to the server timeout in order to avoid complex
Willy Tarreaud2a4aa22008-01-31 15:28:22 +01009747 situations to debug. It is a good practice to cover one or several TCP packet
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01009748 losses by specifying timeouts that are slightly above multiples of 3 seconds
Willy Tarreauce887fd2012-05-12 12:50:00 +02009749 (eg: 4 or 5 seconds). If some long-lived sessions are mixed with short-lived
9750 sessions (eg: WebSocket and HTTP), it's worth considering "timeout tunnel",
Willy Tarreau05cdd962014-05-10 14:30:07 +02009751 which overrides "timeout client" and "timeout server" for tunnels, as well as
9752 "timeout client-fin" for half-closed connections.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01009753
9754 This parameter is specific to frontends, but can be specified once for all in
9755 "defaults" sections. This is in fact one of the easiest solutions not to
9756 forget about it. An unspecified timeout results in an infinite timeout, which
9757 is not recommended. Such a usage is accepted and works but reports a warning
9758 during startup because it may results in accumulation of expired sessions in
9759 the system if the system's timeouts are not configured either.
9760
9761 This parameter replaces the old, deprecated "clitimeout". It is recommended
9762 to use it to write new configurations. The form "timeout clitimeout" is
9763 provided only by backwards compatibility but its use is strongly discouraged.
9764
Baptiste Assmann2e1941e2016-03-06 23:24:12 +01009765 See also : "clitimeout", "timeout server", "timeout tunnel",
9766 "timeout http-request".
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01009767
9768
Willy Tarreau05cdd962014-05-10 14:30:07 +02009769timeout client-fin <timeout>
9770 Set the inactivity timeout on the client side for half-closed connections.
9771 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
9772 yes | yes | yes | no
9773 Arguments :
9774 <timeout> is the timeout value specified in milliseconds by default, but
9775 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
9776 as explained at the top of this document.
9777
9778 The inactivity timeout applies when the client is expected to acknowledge or
9779 send data while one direction is already shut down. This timeout is different
9780 from "timeout client" in that it only applies to connections which are closed
9781 in one direction. This is particularly useful to avoid keeping connections in
9782 FIN_WAIT state for too long when clients do not disconnect cleanly. This
9783 problem is particularly common long connections such as RDP or WebSocket.
9784 Note that this timeout can override "timeout tunnel" when a connection shuts
9785 down in one direction.
9786
9787 This parameter is specific to frontends, but can be specified once for all in
9788 "defaults" sections. By default it is not set, so half-closed connections
9789 will use the other timeouts (timeout.client or timeout.tunnel).
9790
9791 See also : "timeout client", "timeout server-fin", and "timeout tunnel".
9792
9793
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01009794timeout connect <timeout>
9795timeout contimeout <timeout> (deprecated)
9796 Set the maximum time to wait for a connection attempt to a server to succeed.
9797 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
9798 yes | no | yes | yes
9799 Arguments :
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01009800 <timeout> is the timeout value specified in milliseconds by default, but
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01009801 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
9802 as explained at the top of this document.
9803
9804 If the server is located on the same LAN as haproxy, the connection should be
Willy Tarreaud2a4aa22008-01-31 15:28:22 +01009805 immediate (less than a few milliseconds). Anyway, it is a good practice to
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +01009806 cover one or several TCP packet losses by specifying timeouts that are
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01009807 slightly above multiples of 3 seconds (eg: 4 or 5 seconds). By default, the
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki5259dfe2008-01-21 01:54:06 +01009808 connect timeout also presets both queue and tarpit timeouts to the same value
9809 if these have not been specified.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01009810
9811 This parameter is specific to backends, but can be specified once for all in
9812 "defaults" sections. This is in fact one of the easiest solutions not to
9813 forget about it. An unspecified timeout results in an infinite timeout, which
9814 is not recommended. Such a usage is accepted and works but reports a warning
9815 during startup because it may results in accumulation of failed sessions in
9816 the system if the system's timeouts are not configured either.
9817
9818 This parameter replaces the old, deprecated "contimeout". It is recommended
9819 to use it to write new configurations. The form "timeout contimeout" is
9820 provided only by backwards compatibility but its use is strongly discouraged.
9821
Willy Tarreau41a340d2008-01-22 12:25:31 +01009822 See also: "timeout check", "timeout queue", "timeout server", "contimeout",
9823 "timeout tarpit".
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01009824
9825
Willy Tarreaub16a5742010-01-10 14:46:16 +01009826timeout http-keep-alive <timeout>
9827 Set the maximum allowed time to wait for a new HTTP request to appear
9828 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
9829 yes | yes | yes | yes
9830 Arguments :
9831 <timeout> is the timeout value specified in milliseconds by default, but
9832 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
9833 as explained at the top of this document.
9834
9835 By default, the time to wait for a new request in case of keep-alive is set
9836 by "timeout http-request". However this is not always convenient because some
9837 people want very short keep-alive timeouts in order to release connections
9838 faster, and others prefer to have larger ones but still have short timeouts
9839 once the request has started to present itself.
9840
9841 The "http-keep-alive" timeout covers these needs. It will define how long to
9842 wait for a new HTTP request to start coming after a response was sent. Once
9843 the first byte of request has been seen, the "http-request" timeout is used
9844 to wait for the complete request to come. Note that empty lines prior to a
9845 new request do not refresh the timeout and are not counted as a new request.
9846
9847 There is also another difference between the two timeouts : when a connection
9848 expires during timeout http-keep-alive, no error is returned, the connection
9849 just closes. If the connection expires in "http-request" while waiting for a
9850 connection to complete, a HTTP 408 error is returned.
9851
9852 In general it is optimal to set this value to a few tens to hundreds of
9853 milliseconds, to allow users to fetch all objects of a page at once but
9854 without waiting for further clicks. Also, if set to a very small value (eg:
9855 1 millisecond) it will probably only accept pipelined requests but not the
9856 non-pipelined ones. It may be a nice trade-off for very large sites running
Patrick Mézard2382ad62010-05-09 10:43:32 +02009857 with tens to hundreds of thousands of clients.
Willy Tarreaub16a5742010-01-10 14:46:16 +01009858
9859 If this parameter is not set, the "http-request" timeout applies, and if both
9860 are not set, "timeout client" still applies at the lower level. It should be
9861 set in the frontend to take effect, unless the frontend is in TCP mode, in
9862 which case the HTTP backend's timeout will be used.
9863
9864 See also : "timeout http-request", "timeout client".
9865
9866
Willy Tarreau036fae02008-01-06 13:24:40 +01009867timeout http-request <timeout>
9868 Set the maximum allowed time to wait for a complete HTTP request
9869 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreaucd7afc02009-07-12 10:03:17 +02009870 yes | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreau036fae02008-01-06 13:24:40 +01009871 Arguments :
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01009872 <timeout> is the timeout value specified in milliseconds by default, but
Willy Tarreau036fae02008-01-06 13:24:40 +01009873 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
9874 as explained at the top of this document.
9875
9876 In order to offer DoS protection, it may be required to lower the maximum
9877 accepted time to receive a complete HTTP request without affecting the client
9878 timeout. This helps protecting against established connections on which
9879 nothing is sent. The client timeout cannot offer a good protection against
9880 this abuse because it is an inactivity timeout, which means that if the
9881 attacker sends one character every now and then, the timeout will not
9882 trigger. With the HTTP request timeout, no matter what speed the client
Willy Tarreau2705a612014-05-23 17:38:34 +02009883 types, the request will be aborted if it does not complete in time. When the
9884 timeout expires, an HTTP 408 response is sent to the client to inform it
9885 about the problem, and the connection is closed. The logs will report
9886 termination codes "cR". Some recent browsers are having problems with this
9887 standard, well-documented behaviour, so it might be needed to hide the 408
Willy Tarreau0f228a02015-05-01 15:37:53 +02009888 code using "option http-ignore-probes" or "errorfile 408 /dev/null". See
9889 more details in the explanations of the "cR" termination code in section 8.5.
Willy Tarreau036fae02008-01-06 13:24:40 +01009890
Baptiste Assmanneccdf432015-10-28 13:49:01 +01009891 By default, this timeout only applies to the header part of the request,
9892 and not to any data. As soon as the empty line is received, this timeout is
9893 not used anymore. When combined with "option http-buffer-request", this
9894 timeout also applies to the body of the request..
9895 It is used again on keep-alive connections to wait for a second
Willy Tarreaub16a5742010-01-10 14:46:16 +01009896 request if "timeout http-keep-alive" is not set.
Willy Tarreau036fae02008-01-06 13:24:40 +01009897
9898 Generally it is enough to set it to a few seconds, as most clients send the
9899 full request immediately upon connection. Add 3 or more seconds to cover TCP
9900 retransmits but that's all. Setting it to very low values (eg: 50 ms) will
9901 generally work on local networks as long as there are no packet losses. This
9902 will prevent people from sending bare HTTP requests using telnet.
9903
9904 If this parameter is not set, the client timeout still applies between each
Willy Tarreaucd7afc02009-07-12 10:03:17 +02009905 chunk of the incoming request. It should be set in the frontend to take
9906 effect, unless the frontend is in TCP mode, in which case the HTTP backend's
9907 timeout will be used.
Willy Tarreau036fae02008-01-06 13:24:40 +01009908
Willy Tarreau0f228a02015-05-01 15:37:53 +02009909 See also : "errorfile", "http-ignore-probes", "timeout http-keep-alive", and
Baptiste Assmanneccdf432015-10-28 13:49:01 +01009910 "timeout client", "option http-buffer-request".
Willy Tarreau036fae02008-01-06 13:24:40 +01009911
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01009912
9913timeout queue <timeout>
9914 Set the maximum time to wait in the queue for a connection slot to be free
9915 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
9916 yes | no | yes | yes
9917 Arguments :
9918 <timeout> is the timeout value specified in milliseconds by default, but
9919 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
9920 as explained at the top of this document.
9921
9922 When a server's maxconn is reached, connections are left pending in a queue
9923 which may be server-specific or global to the backend. In order not to wait
9924 indefinitely, a timeout is applied to requests pending in the queue. If the
9925 timeout is reached, it is considered that the request will almost never be
9926 served, so it is dropped and a 503 error is returned to the client.
9927
9928 The "timeout queue" statement allows to fix the maximum time for a request to
9929 be left pending in a queue. If unspecified, the same value as the backend's
9930 connection timeout ("timeout connect") is used, for backwards compatibility
9931 with older versions with no "timeout queue" parameter.
9932
9933 See also : "timeout connect", "contimeout".
9934
9935
9936timeout server <timeout>
9937timeout srvtimeout <timeout> (deprecated)
9938 Set the maximum inactivity time on the server side.
9939 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
9940 yes | no | yes | yes
9941 Arguments :
9942 <timeout> is the timeout value specified in milliseconds by default, but
9943 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
9944 as explained at the top of this document.
9945
9946 The inactivity timeout applies when the server is expected to acknowledge or
9947 send data. In HTTP mode, this timeout is particularly important to consider
9948 during the first phase of the server's response, when it has to send the
9949 headers, as it directly represents the server's processing time for the
9950 request. To find out what value to put there, it's often good to start with
9951 what would be considered as unacceptable response times, then check the logs
9952 to observe the response time distribution, and adjust the value accordingly.
9953
9954 The value is specified in milliseconds by default, but can be in any other
9955 unit if the number is suffixed by the unit, as specified at the top of this
9956 document. In TCP mode (and to a lesser extent, in HTTP mode), it is highly
9957 recommended that the client timeout remains equal to the server timeout in
9958 order to avoid complex situations to debug. Whatever the expected server
Willy Tarreaud2a4aa22008-01-31 15:28:22 +01009959 response times, it is a good practice to cover at least one or several TCP
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01009960 packet losses by specifying timeouts that are slightly above multiples of 3
Willy Tarreauce887fd2012-05-12 12:50:00 +02009961 seconds (eg: 4 or 5 seconds minimum). If some long-lived sessions are mixed
9962 with short-lived sessions (eg: WebSocket and HTTP), it's worth considering
9963 "timeout tunnel", which overrides "timeout client" and "timeout server" for
9964 tunnels.
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01009965
9966 This parameter is specific to backends, but can be specified once for all in
9967 "defaults" sections. This is in fact one of the easiest solutions not to
9968 forget about it. An unspecified timeout results in an infinite timeout, which
9969 is not recommended. Such a usage is accepted and works but reports a warning
9970 during startup because it may results in accumulation of expired sessions in
9971 the system if the system's timeouts are not configured either.
9972
9973 This parameter replaces the old, deprecated "srvtimeout". It is recommended
9974 to use it to write new configurations. The form "timeout srvtimeout" is
9975 provided only by backwards compatibility but its use is strongly discouraged.
9976
Willy Tarreauce887fd2012-05-12 12:50:00 +02009977 See also : "srvtimeout", "timeout client" and "timeout tunnel".
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01009978
Willy Tarreau05cdd962014-05-10 14:30:07 +02009979
9980timeout server-fin <timeout>
9981 Set the inactivity timeout on the server side for half-closed connections.
9982 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
9983 yes | no | yes | yes
9984 Arguments :
9985 <timeout> is the timeout value specified in milliseconds by default, but
9986 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
9987 as explained at the top of this document.
9988
9989 The inactivity timeout applies when the server is expected to acknowledge or
9990 send data while one direction is already shut down. This timeout is different
9991 from "timeout server" in that it only applies to connections which are closed
9992 in one direction. This is particularly useful to avoid keeping connections in
9993 FIN_WAIT state for too long when a remote server does not disconnect cleanly.
9994 This problem is particularly common long connections such as RDP or WebSocket.
9995 Note that this timeout can override "timeout tunnel" when a connection shuts
9996 down in one direction. This setting was provided for completeness, but in most
9997 situations, it should not be needed.
9998
9999 This parameter is specific to backends, but can be specified once for all in
10000 "defaults" sections. By default it is not set, so half-closed connections
10001 will use the other timeouts (timeout.server or timeout.tunnel).
10002
10003 See also : "timeout client-fin", "timeout server", and "timeout tunnel".
10004
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010010005
10006timeout tarpit <timeout>
Cyril Bonté78caf842010-03-10 22:41:43 +010010007 Set the duration for which tarpitted connections will be maintained
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010010008 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
10009 yes | yes | yes | yes
10010 Arguments :
10011 <timeout> is the tarpit duration specified in milliseconds by default, but
10012 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
10013 as explained at the top of this document.
10014
Jarno Huuskonene5ae7022017-04-03 14:36:21 +030010015 When a connection is tarpitted using "http-request tarpit" or
10016 "reqtarpit", it is maintained open with no activity for a certain
10017 amount of time, then closed. "timeout tarpit" defines how long it will
10018 be maintained open.
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010010019
10020 The value is specified in milliseconds by default, but can be in any other
10021 unit if the number is suffixed by the unit, as specified at the top of this
10022 document. If unspecified, the same value as the backend's connection timeout
10023 ("timeout connect") is used, for backwards compatibility with older versions
Cyril Bonté78caf842010-03-10 22:41:43 +010010024 with no "timeout tarpit" parameter.
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010010025
10026 See also : "timeout connect", "contimeout".
10027
10028
Willy Tarreauce887fd2012-05-12 12:50:00 +020010029timeout tunnel <timeout>
10030 Set the maximum inactivity time on the client and server side for tunnels.
10031 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
10032 yes | no | yes | yes
10033 Arguments :
10034 <timeout> is the timeout value specified in milliseconds by default, but
10035 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
10036 as explained at the top of this document.
10037
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -040010038 The tunnel timeout applies when a bidirectional connection is established
Willy Tarreauce887fd2012-05-12 12:50:00 +020010039 between a client and a server, and the connection remains inactive in both
10040 directions. This timeout supersedes both the client and server timeouts once
10041 the connection becomes a tunnel. In TCP, this timeout is used as soon as no
10042 analyser remains attached to either connection (eg: tcp content rules are
10043 accepted). In HTTP, this timeout is used when a connection is upgraded (eg:
10044 when switching to the WebSocket protocol, or forwarding a CONNECT request
10045 to a proxy), or after the first response when no keepalive/close option is
10046 specified.
10047
Willy Tarreau05cdd962014-05-10 14:30:07 +020010048 Since this timeout is usually used in conjunction with long-lived connections,
10049 it usually is a good idea to also set "timeout client-fin" to handle the
10050 situation where a client suddenly disappears from the net and does not
10051 acknowledge a close, or sends a shutdown and does not acknowledge pending
10052 data anymore. This can happen in lossy networks where firewalls are present,
10053 and is detected by the presence of large amounts of sessions in a FIN_WAIT
10054 state.
10055
Willy Tarreauce887fd2012-05-12 12:50:00 +020010056 The value is specified in milliseconds by default, but can be in any other
10057 unit if the number is suffixed by the unit, as specified at the top of this
10058 document. Whatever the expected normal idle time, it is a good practice to
10059 cover at least one or several TCP packet losses by specifying timeouts that
10060 are slightly above multiples of 3 seconds (eg: 4 or 5 seconds minimum).
10061
10062 This parameter is specific to backends, but can be specified once for all in
10063 "defaults" sections. This is in fact one of the easiest solutions not to
10064 forget about it.
10065
10066 Example :
10067 defaults http
10068 option http-server-close
10069 timeout connect 5s
10070 timeout client 30s
Willy Tarreau05cdd962014-05-10 14:30:07 +020010071 timeout client-fin 30s
Willy Tarreauce887fd2012-05-12 12:50:00 +020010072 timeout server 30s
10073 timeout tunnel 1h # timeout to use with WebSocket and CONNECT
10074
Willy Tarreau05cdd962014-05-10 14:30:07 +020010075 See also : "timeout client", "timeout client-fin", "timeout server".
Willy Tarreauce887fd2012-05-12 12:50:00 +020010076
10077
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010010078transparent (deprecated)
10079 Enable client-side transparent proxying
10080 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreau4b1f8592008-12-23 23:13:55 +010010081 yes | no | yes | yes
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010010082 Arguments : none
10083
10084 This keyword was introduced in order to provide layer 7 persistence to layer
10085 3 load balancers. The idea is to use the OS's ability to redirect an incoming
10086 connection for a remote address to a local process (here HAProxy), and let
10087 this process know what address was initially requested. When this option is
10088 used, sessions without cookies will be forwarded to the original destination
10089 IP address of the incoming request (which should match that of another
10090 equipment), while requests with cookies will still be forwarded to the
10091 appropriate server.
10092
10093 The "transparent" keyword is deprecated, use "option transparent" instead.
10094
10095 Note that contrary to a common belief, this option does NOT make HAProxy
10096 present the client's IP to the server when establishing the connection.
10097
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010010098 See also: "option transparent"
10099
William Lallemanda73203e2012-03-12 12:48:57 +010010100unique-id-format <string>
10101 Generate a unique ID for each request.
10102 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
10103 yes | yes | yes | no
10104 Arguments :
10105 <string> is a log-format string.
10106
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +020010107 This keyword creates a ID for each request using the custom log format. A
10108 unique ID is useful to trace a request passing through many components of
10109 a complex infrastructure. The newly created ID may also be logged using the
10110 %ID tag the log-format string.
William Lallemanda73203e2012-03-12 12:48:57 +010010111
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +020010112 The format should be composed from elements that are guaranteed to be
10113 unique when combined together. For instance, if multiple haproxy instances
10114 are involved, it might be important to include the node name. It is often
10115 needed to log the incoming connection's source and destination addresses
10116 and ports. Note that since multiple requests may be performed over the same
10117 connection, including a request counter may help differentiate them.
10118 Similarly, a timestamp may protect against a rollover of the counter.
10119 Logging the process ID will avoid collisions after a service restart.
William Lallemanda73203e2012-03-12 12:48:57 +010010120
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +020010121 It is recommended to use hexadecimal notation for many fields since it
10122 makes them more compact and saves space in logs.
William Lallemanda73203e2012-03-12 12:48:57 +010010123
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +020010124 Example:
William Lallemanda73203e2012-03-12 12:48:57 +010010125
Julien Vehentf21be322014-03-07 08:27:34 -050010126 unique-id-format %{+X}o\ %ci:%cp_%fi:%fp_%Ts_%rt:%pid
William Lallemanda73203e2012-03-12 12:48:57 +010010127
10128 will generate:
10129
10130 7F000001:8296_7F00001E:1F90_4F7B0A69_0003:790A
10131
10132 See also: "unique-id-header"
10133
10134unique-id-header <name>
10135 Add a unique ID header in the HTTP request.
10136 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
10137 yes | yes | yes | no
10138 Arguments :
10139 <name> is the name of the header.
10140
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +020010141 Add a unique-id header in the HTTP request sent to the server, using the
10142 unique-id-format. It can't work if the unique-id-format doesn't exist.
William Lallemanda73203e2012-03-12 12:48:57 +010010143
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +020010144 Example:
William Lallemanda73203e2012-03-12 12:48:57 +010010145
Julien Vehentf21be322014-03-07 08:27:34 -050010146 unique-id-format %{+X}o\ %ci:%cp_%fi:%fp_%Ts_%rt:%pid
William Lallemanda73203e2012-03-12 12:48:57 +010010147 unique-id-header X-Unique-ID
10148
10149 will generate:
10150
10151 X-Unique-ID: 7F000001:8296_7F00001E:1F90_4F7B0A69_0003:790A
10152
10153 See also: "unique-id-format"
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010010154
Willy Tarreauf51658d2014-04-23 01:21:56 +020010155use_backend <backend> [{if | unless} <condition>]
Willy Tarreau1d0dfb12009-07-07 15:10:31 +020010156 Switch to a specific backend if/unless an ACL-based condition is matched.
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010010157 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
10158 no | yes | yes | no
10159 Arguments :
Bertrand Jacquin702d44f2013-11-19 11:43:06 +010010160 <backend> is the name of a valid backend or "listen" section, or a
10161 "log-format" string resolving to a backend name.
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010010162
Willy Tarreauf51658d2014-04-23 01:21:56 +020010163 <condition> is a condition composed of ACLs, as described in section 7. If
10164 it is omitted, the rule is unconditionally applied.
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010010165
10166 When doing content-switching, connections arrive on a frontend and are then
10167 dispatched to various backends depending on a number of conditions. The
10168 relation between the conditions and the backends is described with the
Willy Tarreau1d0dfb12009-07-07 15:10:31 +020010169 "use_backend" keyword. While it is normally used with HTTP processing, it can
10170 also be used in pure TCP, either without content using stateless ACLs (eg:
10171 source address validation) or combined with a "tcp-request" rule to wait for
10172 some payload.
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010010173
10174 There may be as many "use_backend" rules as desired. All of these rules are
10175 evaluated in their declaration order, and the first one which matches will
10176 assign the backend.
10177
10178 In the first form, the backend will be used if the condition is met. In the
10179 second form, the backend will be used if the condition is not met. If no
10180 condition is valid, the backend defined with "default_backend" will be used.
10181 If no default backend is defined, either the servers in the same section are
10182 used (in case of a "listen" section) or, in case of a frontend, no server is
10183 used and a 503 service unavailable response is returned.
10184
Willy Tarreau51aecc72009-07-12 09:47:04 +020010185 Note that it is possible to switch from a TCP frontend to an HTTP backend. In
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +010010186 this case, either the frontend has already checked that the protocol is HTTP,
Willy Tarreau51aecc72009-07-12 09:47:04 +020010187 and backend processing will immediately follow, or the backend will wait for
10188 a complete HTTP request to get in. This feature is useful when a frontend
10189 must decode several protocols on a unique port, one of them being HTTP.
10190
Bertrand Jacquin702d44f2013-11-19 11:43:06 +010010191 When <backend> is a simple name, it is resolved at configuration time, and an
10192 error is reported if the specified backend does not exist. If <backend> is
10193 a log-format string instead, no check may be done at configuration time, so
10194 the backend name is resolved dynamically at run time. If the resulting
10195 backend name does not correspond to any valid backend, no other rule is
10196 evaluated, and the default_backend directive is applied instead. Note that
10197 when using dynamic backend names, it is highly recommended to use a prefix
10198 that no other backend uses in order to ensure that an unauthorized backend
10199 cannot be forced from the request.
10200
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030010201 It is worth mentioning that "use_backend" rules with an explicit name are
Bertrand Jacquin702d44f2013-11-19 11:43:06 +010010202 used to detect the association between frontends and backends to compute the
10203 backend's "fullconn" setting. This cannot be done for dynamic names.
10204
10205 See also: "default_backend", "tcp-request", "fullconn", "log-format", and
10206 section 7 about ACLs.
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +010010207
Willy Tarreau036fae02008-01-06 13:24:40 +010010208
Willy Tarreau4a5cade2012-04-05 21:09:48 +020010209use-server <server> if <condition>
10210use-server <server> unless <condition>
10211 Only use a specific server if/unless an ACL-based condition is matched.
10212 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
10213 no | no | yes | yes
10214 Arguments :
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +020010215 <server> is the name of a valid server in the same backend section.
Willy Tarreau4a5cade2012-04-05 21:09:48 +020010216
10217 <condition> is a condition composed of ACLs, as described in section 7.
10218
10219 By default, connections which arrive to a backend are load-balanced across
10220 the available servers according to the configured algorithm, unless a
10221 persistence mechanism such as a cookie is used and found in the request.
10222
10223 Sometimes it is desirable to forward a particular request to a specific
10224 server without having to declare a dedicated backend for this server. This
10225 can be achieved using the "use-server" rules. These rules are evaluated after
10226 the "redirect" rules and before evaluating cookies, and they have precedence
10227 on them. There may be as many "use-server" rules as desired. All of these
10228 rules are evaluated in their declaration order, and the first one which
10229 matches will assign the server.
10230
10231 If a rule designates a server which is down, and "option persist" is not used
10232 and no force-persist rule was validated, it is ignored and evaluation goes on
10233 with the next rules until one matches.
10234
10235 In the first form, the server will be used if the condition is met. In the
10236 second form, the server will be used if the condition is not met. If no
10237 condition is valid, the processing continues and the server will be assigned
10238 according to other persistence mechanisms.
10239
10240 Note that even if a rule is matched, cookie processing is still performed but
10241 does not assign the server. This allows prefixed cookies to have their prefix
10242 stripped.
10243
10244 The "use-server" statement works both in HTTP and TCP mode. This makes it
10245 suitable for use with content-based inspection. For instance, a server could
10246 be selected in a farm according to the TLS SNI field. And if these servers
10247 have their weight set to zero, they will not be used for other traffic.
10248
10249 Example :
10250 # intercept incoming TLS requests based on the SNI field
10251 use-server www if { req_ssl_sni -i www.example.com }
10252 server www 192.168.0.1:443 weight 0
10253 use-server mail if { req_ssl_sni -i mail.example.com }
10254 server mail 192.168.0.1:587 weight 0
10255 use-server imap if { req_ssl_sni -i imap.example.com }
Lukas Tribus98a3e3f2017-03-26 12:55:35 +000010256 server imap 192.168.0.1:993 weight 0
Willy Tarreau4a5cade2012-04-05 21:09:48 +020010257 # all the rest is forwarded to this server
10258 server default 192.168.0.2:443 check
10259
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030010260 See also: "use_backend", section 5 about server and section 7 about ACLs.
Willy Tarreau4a5cade2012-04-05 21:09:48 +020010261
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020010262
102635. Bind and Server options
10264--------------------------
10265
10266The "bind", "server" and "default-server" keywords support a number of settings
10267depending on some build options and on the system HAProxy was built on. These
10268settings generally each consist in one word sometimes followed by a value,
10269written on the same line as the "bind" or "server" line. All these options are
10270described in this section.
10271
10272
102735.1. Bind options
10274-----------------
10275
10276The "bind" keyword supports a certain number of settings which are all passed
10277as arguments on the same line. The order in which those arguments appear makes
10278no importance, provided that they appear after the bind address. All of these
10279parameters are optional. Some of them consist in a single words (booleans),
10280while other ones expect a value after them. In this case, the value must be
10281provided immediately after the setting name.
10282
10283The currently supported settings are the following ones.
10284
Bertrand Jacquin93b227d2016-06-04 15:11:10 +010010285accept-netscaler-cip <magic number>
10286 Enforces the use of the NetScaler Client IP insertion protocol over any
10287 connection accepted by any of the TCP sockets declared on the same line. The
10288 NetScaler Client IP insertion protocol dictates the layer 3/4 addresses of
10289 the incoming connection to be used everywhere an address is used, with the
10290 only exception of "tcp-request connection" rules which will only see the
10291 real connection address. Logs will reflect the addresses indicated in the
10292 protocol, unless it is violated, in which case the real address will still
10293 be used. This keyword combined with support from external components can be
10294 used as an efficient and reliable alternative to the X-Forwarded-For
Bertrand Jacquin90759682016-06-06 15:35:39 +010010295 mechanism which is not always reliable and not even always usable. See also
10296 "tcp-request connection expect-netscaler-cip" for a finer-grained setting of
10297 which client is allowed to use the protocol.
Bertrand Jacquin93b227d2016-06-04 15:11:10 +010010298
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020010299accept-proxy
10300 Enforces the use of the PROXY protocol over any connection accepted by any of
Willy Tarreau77992672014-06-14 11:06:17 +020010301 the sockets declared on the same line. Versions 1 and 2 of the PROXY protocol
10302 are supported and correctly detected. The PROXY protocol dictates the layer
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020010303 3/4 addresses of the incoming connection to be used everywhere an address is
10304 used, with the only exception of "tcp-request connection" rules which will
10305 only see the real connection address. Logs will reflect the addresses
10306 indicated in the protocol, unless it is violated, in which case the real
10307 address will still be used. This keyword combined with support from external
10308 components can be used as an efficient and reliable alternative to the
10309 X-Forwarded-For mechanism which is not always reliable and not even always
Willy Tarreau4f0d9192013-06-11 20:40:55 +020010310 usable. See also "tcp-request connection expect-proxy" for a finer-grained
10311 setting of which client is allowed to use the protocol.
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020010312
Olivier Houchardc2aae742017-09-22 18:26:28 +020010313allow-0rtt
10314 Allow receiving early data when using TLS 1.3. This is disabled by default,
10315 due to security considerations.
10316
Willy Tarreauab861d32013-04-02 02:30:41 +020010317alpn <protocols>
10318 This enables the TLS ALPN extension and advertises the specified protocol
10319 list as supported on top of ALPN. The protocol list consists in a comma-
10320 delimited list of protocol names, for instance: "http/1.1,http/1.0" (without
10321 quotes). This requires that the SSL library is build with support for TLS
10322 extensions enabled (check with haproxy -vv). The ALPN extension replaces the
10323 initial NPN extension.
10324
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020010325backlog <backlog>
10326 Sets the socket's backlog to this value. If unspecified, the frontend's
10327 backlog is used instead, which generally defaults to the maxconn value.
10328
Emmanuel Hocdete7f2b732017-01-09 16:15:54 +010010329curves <curves>
10330 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It sets
10331 the string describing the list of elliptic curves algorithms ("curve suite")
10332 that are negotiated during the SSL/TLS handshake with ECDHE. The format of the
10333 string is a colon-delimited list of curve name.
10334 Example: "X25519:P-256" (without quote)
10335 When "curves" is set, "ecdhe" parameter is ignored.
10336
Emeric Brun7fb34422012-09-28 15:26:15 +020010337ecdhe <named curve>
10338 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It sets
Emeric Brun6924ef82013-03-06 14:08:53 +010010339 the named curve (RFC 4492) used to generate ECDH ephemeral keys. By default,
10340 used named curve is prime256v1.
Emeric Brun7fb34422012-09-28 15:26:15 +020010341
Emeric Brunfd33a262012-10-11 16:28:27 +020010342ca-file <cafile>
Emeric Brun1a073b42012-09-28 17:07:34 +020010343 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
10344 designates a PEM file from which to load CA certificates used to verify
10345 client's certificate.
10346
Emeric Brunb6dc9342012-09-28 17:55:37 +020010347ca-ignore-err [all|<errorID>,...]
10348 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in.
10349 Sets a comma separated list of errorIDs to ignore during verify at depth > 0.
10350 If set to 'all', all errors are ignored. SSL handshake is not aborted if an
10351 error is ignored.
10352
Christopher Faulet31af49d2015-06-09 17:29:50 +020010353ca-sign-file <cafile>
10354 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
10355 designates a PEM file containing both the CA certificate and the CA private
10356 key used to create and sign server's certificates. This is a mandatory
10357 setting when the dynamic generation of certificates is enabled. See
10358 'generate-certificates' for details.
10359
Bertrand Jacquind4d0a232016-11-13 16:37:12 +000010360ca-sign-pass <passphrase>
Christopher Faulet31af49d2015-06-09 17:29:50 +020010361 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It is
10362 the CA private key passphrase. This setting is optional and used only when
10363 the dynamic generation of certificates is enabled. See
10364 'generate-certificates' for details.
10365
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020010366ciphers <ciphers>
10367 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It sets
10368 the string describing the list of cipher algorithms ("cipher suite") that are
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030010369 negotiated during the SSL/TLS handshake. The format of the string is defined
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020010370 in "man 1 ciphers" from OpenSSL man pages, and can be for instance a string
10371 such as "AES:ALL:!aNULL:!eNULL:+RC4:@STRENGTH" (without quotes).
Daniel Schneller87e43022017-09-01 19:29:57 +020010372 Depending on the compatiblity and security requirements, the list of suitable
10373 ciphers depends on a variety of variables. For background information and
10374 recommendations see e. g. (https://wiki.mozilla.org/Security/Server_Side_TLS)
10375 and (https://mozilla.github.io/server-side-tls/ssl-config-generator/).
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020010376
Emeric Brunfd33a262012-10-11 16:28:27 +020010377crl-file <crlfile>
Emeric Brun1a073b42012-09-28 17:07:34 +020010378 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
10379 designates a PEM file from which to load certificate revocation list used
10380 to verify client's certificate.
10381
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020010382crt <cert>
Alex Davies0fbf0162013-03-02 16:04:50 +000010383 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
10384 designates a PEM file containing both the required certificates and any
10385 associated private keys. This file can be built by concatenating multiple
10386 PEM files into one (e.g. cat cert.pem key.pem > combined.pem). If your CA
10387 requires an intermediate certificate, this can also be concatenated into this
10388 file.
10389
10390 If the OpenSSL used supports Diffie-Hellman, parameters present in this file
10391 are loaded.
10392
10393 If a directory name is used instead of a PEM file, then all files found in
Cyril Bonté3180f7b2015-01-25 00:16:08 +010010394 that directory will be loaded in alphabetic order unless their name ends with
Janusz Dziemidowicz2c701b52015-03-07 23:03:59 +010010395 '.issuer', '.ocsp' or '.sctl' (reserved extensions). This directive may be
10396 specified multiple times in order to load certificates from multiple files or
10397 directories. The certificates will be presented to clients who provide a
10398 valid TLS Server Name Indication field matching one of their CN or alt
10399 subjects. Wildcards are supported, where a wildcard character '*' is used
10400 instead of the first hostname component (eg: *.example.org matches
10401 www.example.org but not www.sub.example.org).
Alex Davies0fbf0162013-03-02 16:04:50 +000010402
10403 If no SNI is provided by the client or if the SSL library does not support
10404 TLS extensions, or if the client provides an SNI hostname which does not
10405 match any certificate, then the first loaded certificate will be presented.
10406 This means that when loading certificates from a directory, it is highly
Cyril Bonté3180f7b2015-01-25 00:16:08 +010010407 recommended to load the default one first as a file or to ensure that it will
10408 always be the first one in the directory.
Alex Davies0fbf0162013-03-02 16:04:50 +000010409
Emeric Brune032bfa2012-09-28 13:01:45 +020010410 Note that the same cert may be loaded multiple times without side effects.
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020010411
Alex Davies0fbf0162013-03-02 16:04:50 +000010412 Some CAs (such as Godaddy) offer a drop down list of server types that do not
10413 include HAProxy when obtaining a certificate. If this happens be sure to
Godbach8bf60a12014-04-21 21:42:41 +080010414 choose a webserver that the CA believes requires an intermediate CA (for
Alex Davies0fbf0162013-03-02 16:04:50 +000010415 Godaddy, selection Apache Tomcat will get the correct bundle, but many
10416 others, e.g. nginx, result in a wrong bundle that will not work for some
10417 clients).
10418
Emeric Brun4147b2e2014-06-16 18:36:30 +020010419 For each PEM file, haproxy checks for the presence of file at the same path
10420 suffixed by ".ocsp". If such file is found, support for the TLS Certificate
10421 Status Request extension (also known as "OCSP stapling") is automatically
10422 enabled. The content of this file is optional. If not empty, it must contain
10423 a valid OCSP Response in DER format. In order to be valid an OCSP Response
10424 must comply with the following rules: it has to indicate a good status,
10425 it has to be a single response for the certificate of the PEM file, and it
10426 has to be valid at the moment of addition. If these rules are not respected
10427 the OCSP Response is ignored and a warning is emitted. In order to identify
10428 which certificate an OCSP Response applies to, the issuer's certificate is
10429 necessary. If the issuer's certificate is not found in the PEM file, it will
10430 be loaded from a file at the same path as the PEM file suffixed by ".issuer"
10431 if it exists otherwise it will fail with an error.
10432
Janusz Dziemidowicz2c701b52015-03-07 23:03:59 +010010433 For each PEM file, haproxy also checks for the presence of file at the same
10434 path suffixed by ".sctl". If such file is found, support for Certificate
10435 Transparency (RFC6962) TLS extension is enabled. The file must contain a
10436 valid Signed Certificate Timestamp List, as described in RFC. File is parsed
10437 to check basic syntax, but no signatures are verified.
10438
yanbzhu6c25e9e2016-01-05 12:52:02 -050010439 There are cases where it is desirable to support multiple key types, e.g. RSA
10440 and ECDSA in the cipher suites offered to the clients. This allows clients
10441 that support EC certificates to be able to use EC ciphers, while
10442 simultaneously supporting older, RSA only clients.
yanbzhud19630c2015-12-14 15:10:25 -050010443
10444 In order to provide this functionality, multiple PEM files, each with a
10445 different key type, are required. To associate these PEM files into a
10446 "cert bundle" that is recognized by haproxy, they must be named in the
10447 following way: All PEM files that are to be bundled must have the same base
10448 name, with a suffix indicating the key type. Currently, three suffixes are
10449 supported: rsa, dsa and ecdsa. For example, if www.example.com has two PEM
10450 files, an RSA file and an ECDSA file, they must be named: "example.pem.rsa"
10451 and "example.pem.ecdsa". The first part of the filename is arbitrary; only the
10452 suffix matters. To load this bundle into haproxy, specify the base name only:
10453
10454 Example : bind :8443 ssl crt example.pem
10455
yanbzhu6c25e9e2016-01-05 12:52:02 -050010456 Note that the suffix is not given to haproxy; this tells haproxy to look for
yanbzhud19630c2015-12-14 15:10:25 -050010457 a cert bundle.
10458
10459 Haproxy will load all PEM files in the bundle at the same time to try to
10460 support multiple key types. PEM files are combined based on Common Name
10461 (CN) and Subject Alternative Name (SAN) to support SNI lookups. This means
10462 that even if you give haproxy a cert bundle, if there are no shared CN/SAN
10463 entries in the certificates in that bundle, haproxy will not be able to
10464 provide multi-cert support.
10465
10466 Assuming bundle in the example above contained the following:
10467
10468 Filename | CN | SAN
10469 -------------------+-----------------+-------------------
10470 example.pem.rsa | www.example.com | rsa.example.com
yanbzhu6c25e9e2016-01-05 12:52:02 -050010471 -------------------+-----------------+-------------------
yanbzhud19630c2015-12-14 15:10:25 -050010472 example.pem.ecdsa | www.example.com | ecdsa.example.com
10473 -------------------+-----------------+-------------------
10474
10475 Users connecting with an SNI of "www.example.com" will be able
10476 to use both RSA and ECDSA cipher suites. Users connecting with an SNI of
10477 "rsa.example.com" will only be able to use RSA cipher suites, and users
10478 connecting with "ecdsa.example.com" will only be able to use ECDSA cipher
Emmanuel Hocdet84e417d2017-08-16 11:33:17 +020010479 suites. With BoringSSL and Openssl >= 1.1.1 multi-cert is natively supported,
10480 no need to bundle certificates. ECDSA certificate will be preferred if client
10481 support it.
yanbzhud19630c2015-12-14 15:10:25 -050010482
10483 If a directory name is given as the <cert> argument, haproxy will
10484 automatically search and load bundled files in that directory.
10485
10486 OSCP files (.ocsp) and issuer files (.issuer) are supported with multi-cert
10487 bundling. Each certificate can have its own .ocsp and .issuer file. At this
10488 time, sctl is not supported in multi-certificate bundling.
10489
Emeric Brunb6dc9342012-09-28 17:55:37 +020010490crt-ignore-err <errors>
Alex Davies0fbf0162013-03-02 16:04:50 +000010491 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. Sets a
10492 comma separated list of errorIDs to ignore during verify at depth == 0. If
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030010493 set to 'all', all errors are ignored. SSL handshake is not aborted if an error
Alex Davies0fbf0162013-03-02 16:04:50 +000010494 is ignored.
Emeric Brunb6dc9342012-09-28 17:55:37 +020010495
Emmanuel Hocdetfe616562013-01-22 15:31:15 +010010496crt-list <file>
10497 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
Emmanuel Hocdet98263292016-12-29 18:26:15 +010010498 designates a list of PEM file with an optional ssl configuration and a SNI
10499 filter per certificate, with the following format for each line :
Emmanuel Hocdetfe616562013-01-22 15:31:15 +010010500
Emmanuel Hocdet98263292016-12-29 18:26:15 +010010501 <crtfile> [\[<sslbindconf> ...\]] [[!]<snifilter> ...]
10502
Emmanuel Hocdet174dfe52017-07-28 15:01:05 +020010503 sslbindconf support "npn", "alpn", "verify", "ca-file", "no-ca-names",
10504 crl-file", "ecdhe", "curves", "ciphers" configuration. With BoringSSL
Emmanuel Hocdet84e417d2017-08-16 11:33:17 +020010505 and Openssl >= 1.1.1 "ssl-min-ver" and "ssl-max-ver" are also supported.
Emmanuel Hocdet98263292016-12-29 18:26:15 +010010506 It override the configuration set in bind line for the certificate.
Emmanuel Hocdetfe616562013-01-22 15:31:15 +010010507
Emmanuel Hocdet7c41a1b2013-05-07 20:20:06 +020010508 Wildcards are supported in the SNI filter. Negative filter are also supported,
10509 only useful in combination with a wildcard filter to exclude a particular SNI.
10510 The certificates will be presented to clients who provide a valid TLS Server
10511 Name Indication field matching one of the SNI filters. If no SNI filter is
10512 specified, the CN and alt subjects are used. This directive may be specified
10513 multiple times. See the "crt" option for more information. The default
10514 certificate is still needed to meet OpenSSL expectations. If it is not used,
10515 the 'strict-sni' option may be used.
Emmanuel Hocdetfe616562013-01-22 15:31:15 +010010516
yanbzhu6c25e9e2016-01-05 12:52:02 -050010517 Multi-cert bundling (see "crt") is supported with crt-list, as long as only
Emmanuel Hocdetd294aea2016-05-13 11:14:06 +020010518 the base name is given in the crt-list. SNI filter will do the same work on
Emmanuel Hocdet84e417d2017-08-16 11:33:17 +020010519 all bundled certificates. With BoringSSL and Openssl >= 1.1.1 multi-cert is
10520 natively supported, avoid multi-cert bundling. RSA and ECDSA certificates can
10521 be declared in a row, and set different ssl and filter parameter.
yanbzhud19630c2015-12-14 15:10:25 -050010522
Emmanuel Hocdet98263292016-12-29 18:26:15 +010010523 crt-list file example:
10524 cert1.pem
Emmanuel Hocdet05942112017-02-20 16:11:50 +010010525 cert2.pem [alpn h2,http/1.1]
Emmanuel Hocdet98263292016-12-29 18:26:15 +010010526 certW.pem *.domain.tld !secure.domain.tld
Emmanuel Hocdet05942112017-02-20 16:11:50 +010010527 certS.pem [curves X25519:P-256 ciphers ECDHE-ECDSA-AES256-GCM-SHA384] secure.domain.tld
Emmanuel Hocdet98263292016-12-29 18:26:15 +010010528
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020010529defer-accept
10530 Is an optional keyword which is supported only on certain Linux kernels. It
10531 states that a connection will only be accepted once some data arrive on it,
10532 or at worst after the first retransmit. This should be used only on protocols
10533 for which the client talks first (eg: HTTP). It can slightly improve
10534 performance by ensuring that most of the request is already available when
10535 the connection is accepted. On the other hand, it will not be able to detect
10536 connections which don't talk. It is important to note that this option is
10537 broken in all kernels up to 2.6.31, as the connection is never accepted until
10538 the client talks. This can cause issues with front firewalls which would see
10539 an established connection while the proxy will only see it in SYN_RECV. This
10540 option is only supported on TCPv4/TCPv6 sockets and ignored by other ones.
10541
William Lallemandf6975e92017-05-26 17:42:10 +020010542expose-fd listeners
10543 This option is only usable with the stats socket. It gives your stats socket
10544 the capability to pass listeners FD to another HAProxy process.
William Lallemande202b1e2017-06-01 17:38:56 +020010545 During a reload with the master-worker mode, the process is automatically
10546 reexecuted adding -x and one of the stats socket with this option.
William Lallemandf6975e92017-05-26 17:42:10 +020010547 See alors "-x" in the management guide.
10548
Emeric Brun2cb7ae52012-10-05 14:14:21 +020010549force-sslv3
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030010550 This option enforces use of SSLv3 only on SSL connections instantiated from
Emeric Brun2cb7ae52012-10-05 14:14:21 +020010551 this listener. SSLv3 is generally less expensive than the TLS counterparts
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +010010552 for high connection rates. This option is also available on global statement
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +020010553 "ssl-default-bind-options". See also "ssl-min-ver" and "ssl-max-ver".
Emeric Brun2cb7ae52012-10-05 14:14:21 +020010554
10555force-tlsv10
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030010556 This option enforces use of TLSv1.0 only on SSL connections instantiated from
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +010010557 this listener. This option is also available on global statement
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +020010558 "ssl-default-bind-options". See also "ssl-min-ver" and "ssl-max-ver".
Emeric Brun2cb7ae52012-10-05 14:14:21 +020010559
10560force-tlsv11
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030010561 This option enforces use of TLSv1.1 only on SSL connections instantiated from
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +010010562 this listener. This option is also available on global statement
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +020010563 "ssl-default-bind-options". See also "ssl-min-ver" and "ssl-max-ver".
Emeric Brun2cb7ae52012-10-05 14:14:21 +020010564
10565force-tlsv12
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030010566 This option enforces use of TLSv1.2 only on SSL connections instantiated from
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +010010567 this listener. This option is also available on global statement
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +020010568 "ssl-default-bind-options". See also "ssl-min-ver" and "ssl-max-ver".
Emeric Brun2cb7ae52012-10-05 14:14:21 +020010569
Emmanuel Hocdet42fb9802017-03-30 19:29:39 +020010570force-tlsv13
10571 This option enforces use of TLSv1.3 only on SSL connections instantiated from
10572 this listener. This option is also available on global statement
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +020010573 "ssl-default-bind-options". See also "ssl-min-ver" and "ssl-max-ver".
Emmanuel Hocdet42fb9802017-03-30 19:29:39 +020010574
Christopher Faulet31af49d2015-06-09 17:29:50 +020010575generate-certificates
10576 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
10577 enables the dynamic SSL certificates generation. A CA certificate and its
10578 private key are necessary (see 'ca-sign-file'). When HAProxy is configured as
10579 a transparent forward proxy, SSL requests generate errors because of a common
10580 name mismatch on the certificate presented to the client. With this option
10581 enabled, HAProxy will try to forge a certificate using the SNI hostname
10582 indicated by the client. This is done only if no certificate matches the SNI
10583 hostname (see 'crt-list'). If an error occurs, the default certificate is
10584 used, else the 'strict-sni' option is set.
10585 It can also be used when HAProxy is configured as a reverse proxy to ease the
10586 deployment of an architecture with many backends.
10587
10588 Creating a SSL certificate is an expensive operation, so a LRU cache is used
10589 to store forged certificates (see 'tune.ssl.ssl-ctx-cache-size'). It
10590 increases the HAProxy's memroy footprint to reduce latency when the same
10591 certificate is used many times.
10592
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020010593gid <gid>
10594 Sets the group of the UNIX sockets to the designated system gid. It can also
10595 be set by default in the global section's "unix-bind" statement. Note that
10596 some platforms simply ignore this. This setting is equivalent to the "group"
10597 setting except that the group ID is used instead of its name. This setting is
10598 ignored by non UNIX sockets.
10599
10600group <group>
10601 Sets the group of the UNIX sockets to the designated system group. It can
10602 also be set by default in the global section's "unix-bind" statement. Note
10603 that some platforms simply ignore this. This setting is equivalent to the
10604 "gid" setting except that the group name is used instead of its gid. This
10605 setting is ignored by non UNIX sockets.
10606
10607id <id>
10608 Fixes the socket ID. By default, socket IDs are automatically assigned, but
10609 sometimes it is more convenient to fix them to ease monitoring. This value
10610 must be strictly positive and unique within the listener/frontend. This
10611 option can only be used when defining only a single socket.
10612
10613interface <interface>
Lukas Tribusfce2e962013-02-12 22:13:19 +010010614 Restricts the socket to a specific interface. When specified, only packets
10615 received from that particular interface are processed by the socket. This is
10616 currently only supported on Linux. The interface must be a primary system
10617 interface, not an aliased interface. It is also possible to bind multiple
10618 frontends to the same address if they are bound to different interfaces. Note
10619 that binding to a network interface requires root privileges. This parameter
10620 is only compatible with TCPv4/TCPv6 sockets.
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020010621
Willy Tarreauabb175f2012-09-24 12:43:26 +020010622level <level>
10623 This setting is used with the stats sockets only to restrict the nature of
10624 the commands that can be issued on the socket. It is ignored by other
10625 sockets. <level> can be one of :
10626 - "user" is the least privileged level ; only non-sensitive stats can be
10627 read, and no change is allowed. It would make sense on systems where it
10628 is not easy to restrict access to the socket.
10629 - "operator" is the default level and fits most common uses. All data can
10630 be read, and only non-sensitive changes are permitted (eg: clear max
10631 counters).
10632 - "admin" should be used with care, as everything is permitted (eg: clear
10633 all counters).
10634
Andjelko Iharosc4df59e2017-07-20 11:59:48 +020010635severity-output <format>
10636 This setting is used with the stats sockets only to configure severity
10637 level output prepended to informational feedback messages. Severity
10638 level of messages can range between 0 and 7, conforming to syslog
10639 rfc5424. Valid and successful socket commands requesting data
10640 (i.e. "show map", "get acl foo" etc.) will never have a severity level
10641 prepended. It is ignored by other sockets. <format> can be one of :
10642 - "none" (default) no severity level is prepended to feedback messages.
10643 - "number" severity level is prepended as a number.
10644 - "string" severity level is prepended as a string following the
10645 rfc5424 convention.
10646
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020010647maxconn <maxconn>
10648 Limits the sockets to this number of concurrent connections. Extraneous
10649 connections will remain in the system's backlog until a connection is
10650 released. If unspecified, the limit will be the same as the frontend's
10651 maxconn. Note that in case of port ranges or multiple addresses, the same
10652 value will be applied to each socket. This setting enables different
10653 limitations on expensive sockets, for instance SSL entries which may easily
10654 eat all memory.
10655
10656mode <mode>
10657 Sets the octal mode used to define access permissions on the UNIX socket. It
10658 can also be set by default in the global section's "unix-bind" statement.
10659 Note that some platforms simply ignore this. This setting is ignored by non
10660 UNIX sockets.
10661
10662mss <maxseg>
10663 Sets the TCP Maximum Segment Size (MSS) value to be advertised on incoming
10664 connections. This can be used to force a lower MSS for certain specific
10665 ports, for instance for connections passing through a VPN. Note that this
10666 relies on a kernel feature which is theoretically supported under Linux but
10667 was buggy in all versions prior to 2.6.28. It may or may not work on other
10668 operating systems. It may also not change the advertised value but change the
10669 effective size of outgoing segments. The commonly advertised value for TCPv4
10670 over Ethernet networks is 1460 = 1500(MTU) - 40(IP+TCP). If this value is
10671 positive, it will be used as the advertised MSS. If it is negative, it will
10672 indicate by how much to reduce the incoming connection's advertised MSS for
10673 outgoing segments. This parameter is only compatible with TCP v4/v6 sockets.
10674
10675name <name>
10676 Sets an optional name for these sockets, which will be reported on the stats
10677 page.
10678
Willy Tarreaud72f0f32015-10-13 14:50:22 +020010679namespace <name>
10680 On Linux, it is possible to specify which network namespace a socket will
10681 belong to. This directive makes it possible to explicitly bind a listener to
10682 a namespace different from the default one. Please refer to your operating
10683 system's documentation to find more details about network namespaces.
10684
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020010685nice <nice>
10686 Sets the 'niceness' of connections initiated from the socket. Value must be
10687 in the range -1024..1024 inclusive, and defaults to zero. Positive values
10688 means that such connections are more friendly to others and easily offer
10689 their place in the scheduler. On the opposite, negative values mean that
10690 connections want to run with a higher priority than others. The difference
10691 only happens under high loads when the system is close to saturation.
10692 Negative values are appropriate for low-latency or administration services,
10693 and high values are generally recommended for CPU intensive tasks such as SSL
10694 processing or bulk transfers which are less sensible to latency. For example,
10695 it may make sense to use a positive value for an SMTP socket and a negative
10696 one for an RDP socket.
10697
Emmanuel Hocdet174dfe52017-07-28 15:01:05 +020010698no-ca-names
10699 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
10700 prevents from send CA names in server hello message when ca-file is used.
10701
Emeric Brun9b3009b2012-10-05 11:55:06 +020010702no-sslv3
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020010703 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030010704 disables support for SSLv3 on any sockets instantiated from the listener when
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020010705 SSL is supported. Note that SSLv2 is forced disabled in the code and cannot
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +010010706 be enabled using any configuration option. This option is also available on
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +020010707 global statement "ssl-default-bind-options". Use "ssl-min-ver" and
10708 "ssl-max-ver" instead.
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020010709
Emeric Brun90ad8722012-10-02 14:00:59 +020010710no-tls-tickets
10711 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
10712 disables the stateless session resumption (RFC 5077 TLS Ticket
10713 extension) and force to use stateful session resumption. Stateless
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +010010714 session resumption is more expensive in CPU usage. This option is also
10715 available on global statement "ssl-default-bind-options".
Emeric Brun90ad8722012-10-02 14:00:59 +020010716
Emeric Brun9b3009b2012-10-05 11:55:06 +020010717no-tlsv10
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020010718 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030010719 disables support for TLSv1.0 on any sockets instantiated from the listener
Emeric Brun2cb7ae52012-10-05 14:14:21 +020010720 when SSL is supported. Note that SSLv2 is forced disabled in the code and
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +010010721 cannot be enabled using any configuration option. This option is also
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +020010722 available on global statement "ssl-default-bind-options". Use "ssl-min-ver"
10723 and "ssl-max-ver" instead.
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020010724
Emeric Brun9b3009b2012-10-05 11:55:06 +020010725no-tlsv11
Emeric Brunf5da4932012-09-28 19:42:54 +020010726 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030010727 disables support for TLSv1.1 on any sockets instantiated from the listener
Emeric Brun2cb7ae52012-10-05 14:14:21 +020010728 when SSL is supported. Note that SSLv2 is forced disabled in the code and
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +010010729 cannot be enabled using any configuration option. This option is also
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +020010730 available on global statement "ssl-default-bind-options". Use "ssl-min-ver"
10731 and "ssl-max-ver" instead.
Emeric Brunf5da4932012-09-28 19:42:54 +020010732
Emeric Brun9b3009b2012-10-05 11:55:06 +020010733no-tlsv12
Emeric Brunf5da4932012-09-28 19:42:54 +020010734 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030010735 disables support for TLSv1.2 on any sockets instantiated from the listener
Emeric Brun2cb7ae52012-10-05 14:14:21 +020010736 when SSL is supported. Note that SSLv2 is forced disabled in the code and
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +010010737 cannot be enabled using any configuration option. This option is also
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +020010738 available on global statement "ssl-default-bind-options". Use "ssl-min-ver"
10739 and "ssl-max-ver" instead.
Emeric Brunf5da4932012-09-28 19:42:54 +020010740
Emmanuel Hocdet42fb9802017-03-30 19:29:39 +020010741no-tlsv13
10742 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
10743 disables support for TLSv1.3 on any sockets instantiated from the listener
10744 when SSL is supported. Note that SSLv2 is forced disabled in the code and
10745 cannot be enabled using any configuration option. This option is also
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +020010746 available on global statement "ssl-default-bind-options". Use "ssl-min-ver"
10747 and "ssl-max-ver" instead.
Emmanuel Hocdet42fb9802017-03-30 19:29:39 +020010748
Willy Tarreau6c9a3d52012-10-18 18:57:14 +020010749npn <protocols>
10750 This enables the NPN TLS extension and advertises the specified protocol list
10751 as supported on top of NPN. The protocol list consists in a comma-delimited
10752 list of protocol names, for instance: "http/1.1,http/1.0" (without quotes).
10753 This requires that the SSL library is build with support for TLS extensions
Willy Tarreauab861d32013-04-02 02:30:41 +020010754 enabled (check with haproxy -vv). Note that the NPN extension has been
10755 replaced with the ALPN extension (see the "alpn" keyword).
Willy Tarreau6c9a3d52012-10-18 18:57:14 +020010756
Lukas Tribus53ae85c2017-05-04 15:45:40 +000010757prefer-client-ciphers
10758 Use the client's preference when selecting the cipher suite, by default
10759 the server's preference is enforced. This option is also available on
10760 global statement "ssl-default-bind-options".
10761
Willy Tarreau6ae1ba62014-05-07 19:01:58 +020010762process [ all | odd | even | <number 1-64>[-<number 1-64>] ]
10763 This restricts the list of processes on which this listener is allowed to
10764 run. It does not enforce any process but eliminates those which do not match.
10765 If the frontend uses a "bind-process" setting, the intersection between the
10766 two is applied. If in the end the listener is not allowed to run on any
10767 remaining process, a warning is emitted, and the listener will either run on
10768 the first process of the listener if a single process was specified, or on
10769 all of its processes if multiple processes were specified. For the unlikely
Willy Tarreauae302532014-05-07 19:22:24 +020010770 case where several ranges are needed, this directive may be repeated. The
10771 main purpose of this directive is to be used with the stats sockets and have
10772 one different socket per process. The second purpose is to have multiple bind
10773 lines sharing the same IP:port but not the same process in a listener, so
10774 that the system can distribute the incoming connections into multiple queues
10775 and allow a smoother inter-process load balancing. Currently Linux 3.9 and
10776 above is known for supporting this. See also "bind-process" and "nbproc".
Willy Tarreau6ae1ba62014-05-07 19:01:58 +020010777
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020010778ssl
10779 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030010780 enables SSL deciphering on connections instantiated from this listener. A
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020010781 certificate is necessary (see "crt" above). All contents in the buffers will
10782 appear in clear text, so that ACLs and HTTP processing will only have access
Emmanuel Hocdetbd695fe2017-05-15 15:53:41 +020010783 to deciphered contents. SSLv3 is disabled per default, use "ssl-min-ver SSLv3"
10784 to enable it.
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020010785
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +020010786ssl-max-ver [ SSLv3 | TLSv1.0 | TLSv1.1 | TLSv1.2 | TLSv1.3 ]
10787 This option enforces use of <version> or lower on SSL connections instantiated
10788 from this listener. This option is also available on global statement
10789 "ssl-default-bind-options". See also "ssl-min-ver".
10790
10791ssl-min-ver [ SSLv3 | TLSv1.0 | TLSv1.1 | TLSv1.2 | TLSv1.3 ]
10792 This option enforces use of <version> or upper on SSL connections instantiated
10793 from this listener. This option is also available on global statement
10794 "ssl-default-bind-options". See also "ssl-max-ver".
10795
Emmanuel Hocdet65623372013-01-24 17:17:15 +010010796strict-sni
10797 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. The
10798 SSL/TLS negotiation is allow only if the client provided an SNI which match
10799 a certificate. The default certificate is not used.
10800 See the "crt" option for more information.
10801
Willy Tarreau2af207a2015-02-04 00:45:58 +010010802tcp-ut <delay>
Tim Düsterhus4896c442016-11-29 02:15:19 +010010803 Sets the TCP User Timeout for all incoming connections instantiated from this
Willy Tarreau2af207a2015-02-04 00:45:58 +010010804 listening socket. This option is available on Linux since version 2.6.37. It
10805 allows haproxy to configure a timeout for sockets which contain data not
Tim Düsterhus4896c442016-11-29 02:15:19 +010010806 receiving an acknowledgement for the configured delay. This is especially
Willy Tarreau2af207a2015-02-04 00:45:58 +010010807 useful on long-lived connections experiencing long idle periods such as
10808 remote terminals or database connection pools, where the client and server
10809 timeouts must remain high to allow a long period of idle, but where it is
10810 important to detect that the client has disappeared in order to release all
10811 resources associated with its connection (and the server's session). The
10812 argument is a delay expressed in milliseconds by default. This only works
10813 for regular TCP connections, and is ignored for other protocols.
10814
Willy Tarreau1c862c52012-10-05 16:21:00 +020010815tfo
Lukas Tribus0defb902013-02-13 23:35:39 +010010816 Is an optional keyword which is supported only on Linux kernels >= 3.7. It
Willy Tarreau1c862c52012-10-05 16:21:00 +020010817 enables TCP Fast Open on the listening socket, which means that clients which
10818 support this feature will be able to send a request and receive a response
10819 during the 3-way handshake starting from second connection, thus saving one
10820 round-trip after the first connection. This only makes sense with protocols
10821 that use high connection rates and where each round trip matters. This can
10822 possibly cause issues with many firewalls which do not accept data on SYN
10823 packets, so this option should only be enabled once well tested. This option
Lukas Tribus0999f762013-04-02 16:43:24 +020010824 is only supported on TCPv4/TCPv6 sockets and ignored by other ones. You may
10825 need to build HAProxy with USE_TFO=1 if your libc doesn't define
10826 TCP_FASTOPEN.
Willy Tarreau1c862c52012-10-05 16:21:00 +020010827
Nenad Merdanovic188ad3e2015-02-27 19:56:50 +010010828tls-ticket-keys <keyfile>
10829 Sets the TLS ticket keys file to load the keys from. The keys need to be 48
10830 bytes long, encoded with base64 (ex. openssl rand -base64 48). Number of keys
10831 is specified by the TLS_TICKETS_NO build option (default 3) and at least as
10832 many keys need to be present in the file. Last TLS_TICKETS_NO keys will be
10833 used for decryption and the penultimate one for encryption. This enables easy
10834 key rotation by just appending new key to the file and reloading the process.
10835 Keys must be periodically rotated (ex. every 12h) or Perfect Forward Secrecy
10836 is compromised. It is also a good idea to keep the keys off any permanent
10837 storage such as hard drives (hint: use tmpfs and don't swap those files).
10838 Lifetime hint can be changed using tune.ssl.timeout.
10839
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020010840transparent
10841 Is an optional keyword which is supported only on certain Linux kernels. It
10842 indicates that the addresses will be bound even if they do not belong to the
10843 local machine, and that packets targeting any of these addresses will be
10844 intercepted just as if the addresses were locally configured. This normally
10845 requires that IP forwarding is enabled. Caution! do not use this with the
10846 default address '*', as it would redirect any traffic for the specified port.
10847 This keyword is available only when HAProxy is built with USE_LINUX_TPROXY=1.
10848 This parameter is only compatible with TCPv4 and TCPv6 sockets, depending on
10849 kernel version. Some distribution kernels include backports of the feature,
10850 so check for support with your vendor.
10851
Willy Tarreau77e3af92012-11-24 15:07:23 +010010852v4v6
10853 Is an optional keyword which is supported only on most recent systems
10854 including Linux kernels >= 2.4.21. It is used to bind a socket to both IPv4
10855 and IPv6 when it uses the default address. Doing so is sometimes necessary
10856 on systems which bind to IPv6 only by default. It has no effect on non-IPv6
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030010857 sockets, and is overridden by the "v6only" option.
Willy Tarreau77e3af92012-11-24 15:07:23 +010010858
Willy Tarreau9b6700f2012-11-24 11:55:28 +010010859v6only
10860 Is an optional keyword which is supported only on most recent systems
10861 including Linux kernels >= 2.4.21. It is used to bind a socket to IPv6 only
10862 when it uses the default address. Doing so is sometimes preferred to doing it
Willy Tarreau77e3af92012-11-24 15:07:23 +010010863 system-wide as it is per-listener. It has no effect on non-IPv6 sockets and
10864 has precedence over the "v4v6" option.
Willy Tarreau9b6700f2012-11-24 11:55:28 +010010865
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020010866uid <uid>
10867 Sets the owner of the UNIX sockets to the designated system uid. It can also
10868 be set by default in the global section's "unix-bind" statement. Note that
10869 some platforms simply ignore this. This setting is equivalent to the "user"
10870 setting except that the user numeric ID is used instead of its name. This
10871 setting is ignored by non UNIX sockets.
10872
10873user <user>
10874 Sets the owner of the UNIX sockets to the designated system user. It can also
10875 be set by default in the global section's "unix-bind" statement. Note that
10876 some platforms simply ignore this. This setting is equivalent to the "uid"
10877 setting except that the user name is used instead of its uid. This setting is
10878 ignored by non UNIX sockets.
10879
Emeric Brun1a073b42012-09-28 17:07:34 +020010880verify [none|optional|required]
10881 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. If set
10882 to 'none', client certificate is not requested. This is the default. In other
10883 cases, a client certificate is requested. If the client does not provide a
10884 certificate after the request and if 'verify' is set to 'required', then the
10885 handshake is aborted, while it would have succeeded if set to 'optional'. The
Emeric Brunfd33a262012-10-11 16:28:27 +020010886 certificate provided by the client is always verified using CAs from
10887 'ca-file' and optional CRLs from 'crl-file'. On verify failure the handshake
10888 is aborted, regardless of the 'verify' option, unless the error code exactly
10889 matches one of those listed with 'ca-ignore-err' or 'crt-ignore-err'.
Willy Tarreau4a5cade2012-04-05 21:09:48 +020010890
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +0200108915.2. Server and default-server options
Cyril Bontéf0c60612010-02-06 14:44:47 +010010892------------------------------------
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020010893
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic6df0662010-01-05 16:38:49 +010010894The "server" and "default-server" keywords support a certain number of settings
10895which are all passed as arguments on the server line. The order in which those
10896arguments appear does not count, and they are all optional. Some of those
10897settings are single words (booleans) while others expect one or several values
10898after them. In this case, the values must immediately follow the setting name.
10899Except default-server, all those settings must be specified after the server's
10900address if they are used:
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020010901
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020010902 server <name> <address>[:port] [settings ...]
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic6df0662010-01-05 16:38:49 +010010903 default-server [settings ...]
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020010904
Frédéric Lécailled2376272017-03-21 18:52:12 +010010905Note that all these settings are supported both by "server" and "default-server"
10906keywords, except "id" which is only supported by "server".
10907
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +010010908The currently supported settings are the following ones.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010010909
Willy Tarreauceb4ac92012-04-28 00:41:46 +020010910addr <ipv4|ipv6>
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020010911 Using the "addr" parameter, it becomes possible to use a different IP address
Baptiste Assmann13f83532016-03-06 23:14:36 +010010912 to send health-checks or to probe the agent-check. On some servers, it may be
10913 desirable to dedicate an IP address to specific component able to perform
10914 complex tests which are more suitable to health-checks than the application.
10915 This parameter is ignored if the "check" parameter is not set. See also the
10916 "port" parameter.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020010917
Simon Hormand60d6912013-11-25 10:46:36 +090010918agent-check
10919 Enable an auxiliary agent check which is run independently of a regular
Willy Tarreau81f5d942013-12-09 20:51:51 +010010920 health check. An agent health check is performed by making a TCP connection
10921 to the port set by the "agent-port" parameter and reading an ASCII string.
10922 The string is made of a series of words delimited by spaces, tabs or commas
10923 in any order, optionally terminated by '\r' and/or '\n', each consisting of :
Simon Hormand60d6912013-11-25 10:46:36 +090010924
Willy Tarreau81f5d942013-12-09 20:51:51 +010010925 - An ASCII representation of a positive integer percentage, e.g. "75%".
Simon Hormand60d6912013-11-25 10:46:36 +090010926 Values in this format will set the weight proportional to the initial
Willy Tarreauc5af3a62014-10-07 15:27:33 +020010927 weight of a server as configured when haproxy starts. Note that a zero
10928 weight is reported on the stats page as "DRAIN" since it has the same
10929 effect on the server (it's removed from the LB farm).
Simon Hormand60d6912013-11-25 10:46:36 +090010930
Nenad Merdanovic174dd372016-04-24 23:10:06 +020010931 - The string "maxconn:" followed by an integer (no space between). Values in
10932 this format will set the maxconn of a server. The maximum number of
10933 connections advertised needs to be multipled by the number of load balancers
10934 and different backends that use this health check to get the total number
10935 of connections the server might receive. Example: maxconn:30
10936
Willy Tarreau81f5d942013-12-09 20:51:51 +010010937 - The word "ready". This will turn the server's administrative state to the
10938 READY mode, thus cancelling any DRAIN or MAINT state
Simon Hormand60d6912013-11-25 10:46:36 +090010939
Willy Tarreau81f5d942013-12-09 20:51:51 +010010940 - The word "drain". This will turn the server's administrative state to the
10941 DRAIN mode, thus it will not accept any new connections other than those
10942 that are accepted via persistence.
Simon Hormand60d6912013-11-25 10:46:36 +090010943
Willy Tarreau81f5d942013-12-09 20:51:51 +010010944 - The word "maint". This will turn the server's administrative state to the
10945 MAINT mode, thus it will not accept any new connections at all, and health
10946 checks will be stopped.
Simon Hormand60d6912013-11-25 10:46:36 +090010947
Willy Tarreau81f5d942013-12-09 20:51:51 +010010948 - The words "down", "failed", or "stopped", optionally followed by a
10949 description string after a sharp ('#'). All of these mark the server's
10950 operating state as DOWN, but since the word itself is reported on the stats
10951 page, the difference allows an administrator to know if the situation was
10952 expected or not : the service may intentionally be stopped, may appear up
10953 but fail some validity tests, or may be seen as down (eg: missing process,
10954 or port not responding).
Simon Hormand60d6912013-11-25 10:46:36 +090010955
Willy Tarreau81f5d942013-12-09 20:51:51 +010010956 - The word "up" sets back the server's operating state as UP if health checks
10957 also report that the service is accessible.
Simon Hormand60d6912013-11-25 10:46:36 +090010958
Willy Tarreau81f5d942013-12-09 20:51:51 +010010959 Parameters which are not advertised by the agent are not changed. For
10960 example, an agent might be designed to monitor CPU usage and only report a
10961 relative weight and never interact with the operating status. Similarly, an
10962 agent could be designed as an end-user interface with 3 radio buttons
10963 allowing an administrator to change only the administrative state. However,
10964 it is important to consider that only the agent may revert its own actions,
10965 so if a server is set to DRAIN mode or to DOWN state using the agent, the
10966 agent must implement the other equivalent actions to bring the service into
10967 operations again.
Simon Hormand60d6912013-11-25 10:46:36 +090010968
Simon Horman2f1f9552013-11-25 10:46:37 +090010969 Failure to connect to the agent is not considered an error as connectivity
10970 is tested by the regular health check which is enabled by the "check"
Willy Tarreau81f5d942013-12-09 20:51:51 +010010971 parameter. Warning though, it is not a good idea to stop an agent after it
10972 reports "down", since only an agent reporting "up" will be able to turn the
10973 server up again. Note that the CLI on the Unix stats socket is also able to
Willy Tarreau989222a2016-01-15 10:26:26 +010010974 force an agent's result in order to work around a bogus agent if needed.
Simon Horman2f1f9552013-11-25 10:46:37 +090010975
Willy Tarreau81f5d942013-12-09 20:51:51 +010010976 Requires the "agent-port" parameter to be set. See also the "agent-inter"
Frédéric Lécailled2376272017-03-21 18:52:12 +010010977 and "no-agent-check" parameters.
Simon Hormand60d6912013-11-25 10:46:36 +090010978
James Brown55f9ff12015-10-21 18:19:05 -070010979agent-send <string>
10980 If this option is specified, haproxy will send the given string (verbatim)
10981 to the agent server upon connection. You could, for example, encode
10982 the backend name into this string, which would enable your agent to send
10983 different responses based on the backend. Make sure to include a '\n' if
10984 you want to terminate your request with a newline.
10985
Simon Hormand60d6912013-11-25 10:46:36 +090010986agent-inter <delay>
10987 The "agent-inter" parameter sets the interval between two agent checks
10988 to <delay> milliseconds. If left unspecified, the delay defaults to 2000 ms.
10989
10990 Just as with every other time-based parameter, it may be entered in any
10991 other explicit unit among { us, ms, s, m, h, d }. The "agent-inter"
10992 parameter also serves as a timeout for agent checks "timeout check" is
10993 not set. In order to reduce "resonance" effects when multiple servers are
10994 hosted on the same hardware, the agent and health checks of all servers
10995 are started with a small time offset between them. It is also possible to
10996 add some random noise in the agent and health checks interval using the
10997 global "spread-checks" keyword. This makes sense for instance when a lot
10998 of backends use the same servers.
10999
11000 See also the "agent-check" and "agent-port" parameters.
11001
Misiek768d8602017-01-09 09:52:43 +010011002agent-addr <addr>
11003 The "agent-addr" parameter sets address for agent check.
11004
11005 You can offload agent-check to another target, so you can make single place
11006 managing status and weights of servers defined in haproxy in case you can't
11007 make self-aware and self-managing services. You can specify both IP or
11008 hostname, it will be resolved.
11009
Simon Hormand60d6912013-11-25 10:46:36 +090011010agent-port <port>
11011 The "agent-port" parameter sets the TCP port used for agent checks.
11012
11013 See also the "agent-check" and "agent-inter" parameters.
11014
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020011015backup
11016 When "backup" is present on a server line, the server is only used in load
11017 balancing when all other non-backup servers are unavailable. Requests coming
11018 with a persistence cookie referencing the server will always be served
11019 though. By default, only the first operational backup server is used, unless
Frédéric Lécailled2376272017-03-21 18:52:12 +010011020 the "allbackups" option is set in the backend. See also the "no-backup" and
11021 "allbackups" options.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +010011022
Emeric Brunef42d922012-10-11 16:11:36 +020011023ca-file <cafile>
11024 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
11025 designates a PEM file from which to load CA certificates used to verify
11026 server's certificate.
11027
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020011028check
11029 This option enables health checks on the server. By default, a server is
Patrick Mézardb7aeec62012-01-22 16:01:22 +010011030 always considered available. If "check" is set, the server is available when
11031 accepting periodic TCP connections, to ensure that it is really able to serve
11032 requests. The default address and port to send the tests to are those of the
11033 server, and the default source is the same as the one defined in the
11034 backend. It is possible to change the address using the "addr" parameter, the
11035 port using the "port" parameter, the source address using the "source"
11036 address, and the interval and timers using the "inter", "rise" and "fall"
Simon Hormanafc47ee2013-11-25 10:46:35 +090011037 parameters. The request method is define in the backend using the "httpchk",
11038 "smtpchk", "mysql-check", "pgsql-check" and "ssl-hello-chk" options. Please
Frédéric Lécailled2376272017-03-21 18:52:12 +010011039 refer to those options and parameters for more information. See also
11040 "no-check" option.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +010011041
Willy Tarreau6c16adc2012-10-05 00:04:16 +020011042check-send-proxy
11043 This option forces emission of a PROXY protocol line with outgoing health
11044 checks, regardless of whether the server uses send-proxy or not for the
11045 normal traffic. By default, the PROXY protocol is enabled for health checks
11046 if it is already enabled for normal traffic and if no "port" nor "addr"
11047 directive is present. However, if such a directive is present, the
11048 "check-send-proxy" option needs to be used to force the use of the
11049 protocol. See also the "send-proxy" option for more information.
11050
Olivier Houchard9130a962017-10-17 17:33:43 +020011051check-sni
11052 This option allows you to specify the SNI to be used when doing health checks
11053 over SSL.
11054
Willy Tarreau763a95b2012-10-04 23:15:39 +020011055check-ssl
11056 This option forces encryption of all health checks over SSL, regardless of
11057 whether the server uses SSL or not for the normal traffic. This is generally
11058 used when an explicit "port" or "addr" directive is specified and SSL health
11059 checks are not inherited. It is important to understand that this option
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030011060 inserts an SSL transport layer below the checks, so that a simple TCP connect
Willy Tarreau763a95b2012-10-04 23:15:39 +020011061 check becomes an SSL connect, which replaces the old ssl-hello-chk. The most
11062 common use is to send HTTPS checks by combining "httpchk" with SSL checks.
11063 All SSL settings are common to health checks and traffic (eg: ciphers).
Frédéric Lécailled2376272017-03-21 18:52:12 +010011064 See the "ssl" option for more information and "no-check-ssl" to disable
11065 this option.
Willy Tarreau763a95b2012-10-04 23:15:39 +020011066
Willy Tarreaua0ee1d02012-09-10 09:01:23 +020011067ciphers <ciphers>
11068 This option sets the string describing the list of cipher algorithms that is
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030011069 is negotiated during the SSL/TLS handshake with the server. The format of the
Willy Tarreaua0ee1d02012-09-10 09:01:23 +020011070 string is defined in "man 1 ciphers". When SSL is used to communicate with
11071 servers on the local network, it is common to see a weaker set of algorithms
11072 than what is used over the internet. Doing so reduces CPU usage on both the
11073 server and haproxy while still keeping it compatible with deployed software.
11074 Some algorithms such as RC4-SHA1 are reasonably cheap. If no security at all
11075 is needed and just connectivity, using DES can be appropriate.
11076
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020011077cookie <value>
11078 The "cookie" parameter sets the cookie value assigned to the server to
11079 <value>. This value will be checked in incoming requests, and the first
11080 operational server possessing the same value will be selected. In return, in
11081 cookie insertion or rewrite modes, this value will be assigned to the cookie
11082 sent to the client. There is nothing wrong in having several servers sharing
11083 the same cookie value, and it is in fact somewhat common between normal and
11084 backup servers. See also the "cookie" keyword in backend section.
11085
Emeric Brunef42d922012-10-11 16:11:36 +020011086crl-file <crlfile>
11087 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
11088 designates a PEM file from which to load certificate revocation list used
11089 to verify server's certificate.
11090
Emeric Bruna7aa3092012-10-26 12:58:00 +020011091crt <cert>
11092 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in.
11093 It designates a PEM file from which to load both a certificate and the
11094 associated private key. This file can be built by concatenating both PEM
11095 files into one. This certificate will be sent if the server send a client
11096 certificate request.
11097
Willy Tarreau96839092010-03-29 10:02:24 +020011098disabled
11099 The "disabled" keyword starts the server in the "disabled" state. That means
11100 that it is marked down in maintenance mode, and no connection other than the
11101 ones allowed by persist mode will reach it. It is very well suited to setup
11102 new servers, because normal traffic will never reach them, while it is still
11103 possible to test the service by making use of the force-persist mechanism.
Frédéric Lécailled2376272017-03-21 18:52:12 +010011104 See also "enabled" setting.
Willy Tarreau96839092010-03-29 10:02:24 +020011105
Frédéric Lécailled2376272017-03-21 18:52:12 +010011106enabled
11107 This option may be used as 'server' setting to reset any 'disabled'
11108 setting which would have been inherited from 'default-server' directive as
11109 default value.
11110 It may also be used as 'default-server' setting to reset any previous
11111 'default-server' 'disabled' setting.
Willy Tarreau96839092010-03-29 10:02:24 +020011112
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +010011113error-limit <count>
Willy Tarreau983e01e2010-01-11 18:42:06 +010011114 If health observing is enabled, the "error-limit" parameter specifies the
11115 number of consecutive errors that triggers event selected by the "on-error"
11116 option. By default it is set to 10 consecutive errors.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki97f07b82009-12-15 22:31:24 +010011117
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +010011118 See also the "check", "error-limit" and "on-error".
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki97f07b82009-12-15 22:31:24 +010011119
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +010011120fall <count>
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020011121 The "fall" parameter states that a server will be considered as dead after
11122 <count> consecutive unsuccessful health checks. This value defaults to 3 if
11123 unspecified. See also the "check", "inter" and "rise" parameters.
11124
Emeric Brun8694b9a2012-10-05 14:39:07 +020011125force-sslv3
11126 This option enforces use of SSLv3 only when SSL is used to communicate with
11127 the server. SSLv3 is generally less expensive than the TLS counterparts for
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +010011128 high connection rates. This option is also available on global statement
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +020011129 "ssl-default-server-options". See also "ssl-min-ver" and ssl-max-ver".
Emeric Brun8694b9a2012-10-05 14:39:07 +020011130
11131force-tlsv10
11132 This option enforces use of TLSv1.0 only when SSL is used to communicate with
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +010011133 the server. This option is also available on global statement
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +020011134 "ssl-default-server-options". See also "ssl-min-ver" and ssl-max-ver".
Emeric Brun8694b9a2012-10-05 14:39:07 +020011135
11136force-tlsv11
11137 This option enforces use of TLSv1.1 only when SSL is used to communicate with
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +010011138 the server. This option is also available on global statement
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +020011139 "ssl-default-server-options". See also "ssl-min-ver" and ssl-max-ver".
Emeric Brun8694b9a2012-10-05 14:39:07 +020011140
11141force-tlsv12
11142 This option enforces use of TLSv1.2 only when SSL is used to communicate with
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +010011143 the server. This option is also available on global statement
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +020011144 "ssl-default-server-options". See also "ssl-min-ver" and ssl-max-ver".
Emeric Brun8694b9a2012-10-05 14:39:07 +020011145
Emmanuel Hocdet42fb9802017-03-30 19:29:39 +020011146force-tlsv13
11147 This option enforces use of TLSv1.3 only when SSL is used to communicate with
11148 the server. This option is also available on global statement
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +020011149 "ssl-default-server-options". See also "ssl-min-ver" and ssl-max-ver".
Emmanuel Hocdet42fb9802017-03-30 19:29:39 +020011150
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020011151id <value>
Willy Tarreau53fb4ae2009-10-04 23:04:08 +020011152 Set a persistent ID for the server. This ID must be positive and unique for
11153 the proxy. An unused ID will automatically be assigned if unset. The first
11154 assigned value will be 1. This ID is currently only returned in statistics.
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020011155
Willy Tarreau6a031d12016-11-07 19:42:35 +010011156init-addr {last | libc | none | <ip>},[...]*
11157 Indicate in what order the server's address should be resolved upon startup
11158 if it uses an FQDN. Attempts are made to resolve the address by applying in
11159 turn each of the methods mentionned in the comma-delimited list. The first
11160 method which succeeds is used. If the end of the list is reached without
11161 finding a working method, an error is thrown. Method "last" suggests to pick
11162 the address which appears in the state file (see "server-state-file"). Method
11163 "libc" uses the libc's internal resolver (gethostbyname() or getaddrinfo()
11164 depending on the operating system and build options). Method "none"
11165 specifically indicates that the server should start without any valid IP
11166 address in a down state. It can be useful to ignore some DNS issues upon
11167 startup, waiting for the situation to get fixed later. Finally, an IP address
11168 (IPv4 or IPv6) may be provided. It can be the currently known address of the
11169 server (eg: filled by a configuration generator), or the address of a dummy
11170 server used to catch old sessions and present them with a decent error
11171 message for example. When the "first" load balancing algorithm is used, this
11172 IP address could point to a fake server used to trigger the creation of new
11173 instances on the fly. This option defaults to "last,libc" indicating that the
11174 previous address found in the state file (if any) is used first, otherwise
11175 the libc's resolver is used. This ensures continued compatibility with the
11176 historic behaviour.
11177
11178 Example:
11179 defaults
11180 # never fail on address resolution
11181 default-server init-addr last,libc,none
11182
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +010011183inter <delay>
11184fastinter <delay>
11185downinter <delay>
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020011186 The "inter" parameter sets the interval between two consecutive health checks
11187 to <delay> milliseconds. If left unspecified, the delay defaults to 2000 ms.
11188 It is also possible to use "fastinter" and "downinter" to optimize delays
11189 between checks depending on the server state :
11190
Pieter Baauw44fc9df2015-09-17 21:30:46 +020011191 Server state | Interval used
11192 ----------------------------------------+----------------------------------
11193 UP 100% (non-transitional) | "inter"
11194 ----------------------------------------+----------------------------------
11195 Transitionally UP (going down "fall"), | "fastinter" if set,
11196 Transitionally DOWN (going up "rise"), | "inter" otherwise.
11197 or yet unchecked. |
11198 ----------------------------------------+----------------------------------
11199 DOWN 100% (non-transitional) | "downinter" if set,
11200 | "inter" otherwise.
11201 ----------------------------------------+----------------------------------
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +010011202
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020011203 Just as with every other time-based parameter, they can be entered in any
11204 other explicit unit among { us, ms, s, m, h, d }. The "inter" parameter also
11205 serves as a timeout for health checks sent to servers if "timeout check" is
11206 not set. In order to reduce "resonance" effects when multiple servers are
Simon Hormand60d6912013-11-25 10:46:36 +090011207 hosted on the same hardware, the agent and health checks of all servers
11208 are started with a small time offset between them. It is also possible to
11209 add some random noise in the agent and health checks interval using the
11210 global "spread-checks" keyword. This makes sense for instance when a lot
11211 of backends use the same servers.
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020011212
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +010011213maxconn <maxconn>
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020011214 The "maxconn" parameter specifies the maximal number of concurrent
11215 connections that will be sent to this server. If the number of incoming
11216 concurrent requests goes higher than this value, they will be queued, waiting
11217 for a connection to be released. This parameter is very important as it can
11218 save fragile servers from going down under extreme loads. If a "minconn"
11219 parameter is specified, the limit becomes dynamic. The default value is "0"
11220 which means unlimited. See also the "minconn" and "maxqueue" parameters, and
11221 the backend's "fullconn" keyword.
11222
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +010011223maxqueue <maxqueue>
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020011224 The "maxqueue" parameter specifies the maximal number of connections which
11225 will wait in the queue for this server. If this limit is reached, next
11226 requests will be redispatched to other servers instead of indefinitely
11227 waiting to be served. This will break persistence but may allow people to
11228 quickly re-log in when the server they try to connect to is dying. The
11229 default value is "0" which means the queue is unlimited. See also the
11230 "maxconn" and "minconn" parameters.
11231
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +010011232minconn <minconn>
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020011233 When the "minconn" parameter is set, the maxconn limit becomes a dynamic
11234 limit following the backend's load. The server will always accept at least
11235 <minconn> connections, never more than <maxconn>, and the limit will be on
11236 the ramp between both values when the backend has less than <fullconn>
11237 concurrent connections. This makes it possible to limit the load on the
11238 server during normal loads, but push it further for important loads without
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +010011239 overloading the server during exceptional loads. See also the "maxconn"
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020011240 and "maxqueue" parameters, as well as the "fullconn" backend keyword.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki97f07b82009-12-15 22:31:24 +010011241
Willy Tarreaud72f0f32015-10-13 14:50:22 +020011242namespace <name>
11243 On Linux, it is possible to specify which network namespace a socket will
11244 belong to. This directive makes it possible to explicitly bind a server to
11245 a namespace different from the default one. Please refer to your operating
11246 system's documentation to find more details about network namespaces.
11247
Frédéric Lécailled2376272017-03-21 18:52:12 +010011248no-agent-check
11249 This option may be used as "server" setting to reset any "agent-check"
11250 setting which would have been inherited from "default-server" directive as
11251 default value.
11252 It may also be used as "default-server" setting to reset any previous
11253 "default-server" "agent-check" setting.
11254
11255no-backup
11256 This option may be used as "server" setting to reset any "backup"
11257 setting which would have been inherited from "default-server" directive as
11258 default value.
11259 It may also be used as "default-server" setting to reset any previous
11260 "default-server" "backup" setting.
11261
11262no-check
11263 This option may be used as "server" setting to reset any "check"
11264 setting which would have been inherited from "default-server" directive as
11265 default value.
11266 It may also be used as "default-server" setting to reset any previous
11267 "default-server" "check" setting.
11268
11269no-check-ssl
11270 This option may be used as "server" setting to reset any "check-ssl"
11271 setting which would have been inherited from "default-server" directive as
11272 default value.
11273 It may also be used as "default-server" setting to reset any previous
11274 "default-server" "check-ssl" setting.
11275
Frédéric Lécailled2376272017-03-21 18:52:12 +010011276no-send-proxy
11277 This option may be used as "server" setting to reset any "send-proxy"
11278 setting which would have been inherited from "default-server" directive as
11279 default value.
11280 It may also be used as "default-server" setting to reset any previous
11281 "default-server" "send-proxy" setting.
11282
11283no-send-proxy-v2
11284 This option may be used as "server" setting to reset any "send-proxy-v2"
11285 setting which would have been inherited from "default-server" directive as
11286 default value.
11287 It may also be used as "default-server" setting to reset any previous
11288 "default-server" "send-proxy-v2" setting.
11289
11290no-send-proxy-v2-ssl
11291 This option may be used as "server" setting to reset any "send-proxy-v2-ssl"
11292 setting which would have been inherited from "default-server" directive as
11293 default value.
11294 It may also be used as "default-server" setting to reset any previous
11295 "default-server" "send-proxy-v2-ssl" setting.
11296
11297no-send-proxy-v2-ssl-cn
11298 This option may be used as "server" setting to reset any "send-proxy-v2-ssl-cn"
11299 setting which would have been inherited from "default-server" directive as
11300 default value.
11301 It may also be used as "default-server" setting to reset any previous
11302 "default-server" "send-proxy-v2-ssl-cn" setting.
11303
11304no-ssl
11305 This option may be used as "server" setting to reset any "ssl"
11306 setting which would have been inherited from "default-server" directive as
11307 default value.
11308 It may also be used as "default-server" setting to reset any previous
11309 "default-server" "ssl" setting.
11310
Willy Tarreau2a3fb1c2015-02-05 16:47:07 +010011311no-ssl-reuse
11312 This option disables SSL session reuse when SSL is used to communicate with
11313 the server. It will force the server to perform a full handshake for every
11314 new connection. It's probably only useful for benchmarking, troubleshooting,
11315 and for paranoid users.
11316
Emeric Brun9b3009b2012-10-05 11:55:06 +020011317no-sslv3
Willy Tarreaua0ee1d02012-09-10 09:01:23 +020011318 This option disables support for SSLv3 when SSL is used to communicate with
11319 the server. Note that SSLv2 is disabled in the code and cannot be enabled
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +020011320 using any configuration option. Use "ssl-min-ver" and "ssl-max-ver" instead.
Willy Tarreaua0ee1d02012-09-10 09:01:23 +020011321
Emmanuel Hocdet6cb2d1e2017-03-30 14:43:31 +020011322 Supported in default-server: No
11323
Emeric Brunf9c5c472012-10-11 15:28:34 +020011324no-tls-tickets
11325 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
11326 disables the stateless session resumption (RFC 5077 TLS Ticket
11327 extension) and force to use stateful session resumption. Stateless
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +010011328 session resumption is more expensive in CPU usage for servers. This option
11329 is also available on global statement "ssl-default-server-options".
Frédéric Lécailled2376272017-03-21 18:52:12 +010011330 See also "tls-tickets".
Emeric Brunf9c5c472012-10-11 15:28:34 +020011331
Emeric Brun9b3009b2012-10-05 11:55:06 +020011332no-tlsv10
Emeric Brun8694b9a2012-10-05 14:39:07 +020011333 This option disables support for TLSv1.0 when SSL is used to communicate with
Emeric Brunf5da4932012-09-28 19:42:54 +020011334 the server. Note that SSLv2 is disabled in the code and cannot be enabled
11335 using any configuration option. TLSv1 is more expensive than SSLv3 so it
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +010011336 often makes sense to disable it when communicating with local servers. This
11337 option is also available on global statement "ssl-default-server-options".
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +020011338 Use "ssl-min-ver" and "ssl-max-ver" instead.
Willy Tarreau763a95b2012-10-04 23:15:39 +020011339
Emmanuel Hocdet6cb2d1e2017-03-30 14:43:31 +020011340 Supported in default-server: No
11341
Emeric Brun9b3009b2012-10-05 11:55:06 +020011342no-tlsv11
Emeric Brun8694b9a2012-10-05 14:39:07 +020011343 This option disables support for TLSv1.1 when SSL is used to communicate with
Emeric Brunf5da4932012-09-28 19:42:54 +020011344 the server. Note that SSLv2 is disabled in the code and cannot be enabled
11345 using any configuration option. TLSv1 is more expensive than SSLv3 so it
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +010011346 often makes sense to disable it when communicating with local servers. This
11347 option is also available on global statement "ssl-default-server-options".
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +020011348 Use "ssl-min-ver" and "ssl-max-ver" instead.
Willy Tarreau763a95b2012-10-04 23:15:39 +020011349
Emmanuel Hocdet6cb2d1e2017-03-30 14:43:31 +020011350 Supported in default-server: No
11351
Emeric Brun9b3009b2012-10-05 11:55:06 +020011352no-tlsv12
Emeric Brun8694b9a2012-10-05 14:39:07 +020011353 This option disables support for TLSv1.2 when SSL is used to communicate with
Willy Tarreaua0ee1d02012-09-10 09:01:23 +020011354 the server. Note that SSLv2 is disabled in the code and cannot be enabled
11355 using any configuration option. TLSv1 is more expensive than SSLv3 so it
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +010011356 often makes sense to disable it when communicating with local servers. This
11357 option is also available on global statement "ssl-default-server-options".
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +020011358 Use "ssl-min-ver" and "ssl-max-ver" instead.
Emmanuel Hocdet42fb9802017-03-30 19:29:39 +020011359
11360 Supported in default-server: No
11361
11362no-tlsv13
11363 This option disables support for TLSv1.3 when SSL is used to communicate with
11364 the server. Note that SSLv2 is disabled in the code and cannot be enabled
11365 using any configuration option. TLSv1 is more expensive than SSLv3 so it
11366 often makes sense to disable it when communicating with local servers. This
11367 option is also available on global statement "ssl-default-server-options".
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +020011368 Use "ssl-min-ver" and "ssl-max-ver" instead.
Willy Tarreaua0ee1d02012-09-10 09:01:23 +020011369
Emmanuel Hocdet6cb2d1e2017-03-30 14:43:31 +020011370 Supported in default-server: No
11371
Frédéric Lécailled2376272017-03-21 18:52:12 +010011372no-verifyhost
11373 This option may be used as "server" setting to reset any "verifyhost"
11374 setting which would have been inherited from "default-server" directive as
11375 default value.
11376 It may also be used as "default-server" setting to reset any previous
11377 "default-server" "verifyhost" setting.
Willy Tarreau763a95b2012-10-04 23:15:39 +020011378
Simon Hormanfa461682011-06-25 09:39:49 +090011379non-stick
11380 Never add connections allocated to this sever to a stick-table.
11381 This may be used in conjunction with backup to ensure that
11382 stick-table persistence is disabled for backup servers.
11383
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki97f07b82009-12-15 22:31:24 +010011384observe <mode>
11385 This option enables health adjusting based on observing communication with
11386 the server. By default this functionality is disabled and enabling it also
11387 requires to enable health checks. There are two supported modes: "layer4" and
11388 "layer7". In layer4 mode, only successful/unsuccessful tcp connections are
11389 significant. In layer7, which is only allowed for http proxies, responses
11390 received from server are verified, like valid/wrong http code, unparsable
Willy Tarreau150d1462012-03-10 08:19:02 +010011391 headers, a timeout, etc. Valid status codes include 100 to 499, 501 and 505.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki97f07b82009-12-15 22:31:24 +010011392
11393 See also the "check", "on-error" and "error-limit".
11394
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +010011395on-error <mode>
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki97f07b82009-12-15 22:31:24 +010011396 Select what should happen when enough consecutive errors are detected.
11397 Currently, four modes are available:
11398 - fastinter: force fastinter
11399 - fail-check: simulate a failed check, also forces fastinter (default)
11400 - sudden-death: simulate a pre-fatal failed health check, one more failed
11401 check will mark a server down, forces fastinter
11402 - mark-down: mark the server immediately down and force fastinter
11403
11404 See also the "check", "observe" and "error-limit".
11405
Simon Hormane0d1bfb2011-06-21 14:34:58 +090011406on-marked-down <action>
11407 Modify what occurs when a server is marked down.
11408 Currently one action is available:
Justin Karnegeseb2c24a2012-05-24 15:28:52 -070011409 - shutdown-sessions: Shutdown peer sessions. When this setting is enabled,
11410 all connections to the server are immediately terminated when the server
11411 goes down. It might be used if the health check detects more complex cases
11412 than a simple connection status, and long timeouts would cause the service
11413 to remain unresponsive for too long a time. For instance, a health check
11414 might detect that a database is stuck and that there's no chance to reuse
11415 existing connections anymore. Connections killed this way are logged with
11416 a 'D' termination code (for "Down").
Simon Hormane0d1bfb2011-06-21 14:34:58 +090011417
11418 Actions are disabled by default
11419
Justin Karnegeseb2c24a2012-05-24 15:28:52 -070011420on-marked-up <action>
11421 Modify what occurs when a server is marked up.
11422 Currently one action is available:
11423 - shutdown-backup-sessions: Shutdown sessions on all backup servers. This is
11424 done only if the server is not in backup state and if it is not disabled
11425 (it must have an effective weight > 0). This can be used sometimes to force
11426 an active server to take all the traffic back after recovery when dealing
11427 with long sessions (eg: LDAP, SQL, ...). Doing this can cause more trouble
11428 than it tries to solve (eg: incomplete transactions), so use this feature
11429 with extreme care. Sessions killed because a server comes up are logged
11430 with an 'U' termination code (for "Up").
11431
11432 Actions are disabled by default
11433
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +010011434port <port>
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020011435 Using the "port" parameter, it becomes possible to use a different port to
11436 send health-checks. On some servers, it may be desirable to dedicate a port
11437 to a specific component able to perform complex tests which are more suitable
11438 to health-checks than the application. It is common to run a simple script in
11439 inetd for instance. This parameter is ignored if the "check" parameter is not
11440 set. See also the "addr" parameter.
11441
11442redir <prefix>
11443 The "redir" parameter enables the redirection mode for all GET and HEAD
11444 requests addressing this server. This means that instead of having HAProxy
11445 forward the request to the server, it will send an "HTTP 302" response with
11446 the "Location" header composed of this prefix immediately followed by the
11447 requested URI beginning at the leading '/' of the path component. That means
11448 that no trailing slash should be used after <prefix>. All invalid requests
11449 will be rejected, and all non-GET or HEAD requests will be normally served by
11450 the server. Note that since the response is completely forged, no header
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +010011451 mangling nor cookie insertion is possible in the response. However, cookies in
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020011452 requests are still analysed, making this solution completely usable to direct
11453 users to a remote location in case of local disaster. Main use consists in
11454 increasing bandwidth for static servers by having the clients directly
11455 connect to them. Note: never use a relative location here, it would cause a
11456 loop between the client and HAProxy!
11457
11458 Example : server srv1 192.168.1.1:80 redir http://image1.mydomain.com check
11459
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +010011460rise <count>
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020011461 The "rise" parameter states that a server will be considered as operational
11462 after <count> consecutive successful health checks. This value defaults to 2
11463 if unspecified. See also the "check", "inter" and "fall" parameters.
11464
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020011465resolve-prefer <family>
11466 When DNS resolution is enabled for a server and multiple IP addresses from
11467 different families are returned, HAProxy will prefer using an IP address
11468 from the family mentioned in the "resolve-prefer" parameter.
11469 Available families: "ipv4" and "ipv6"
11470
Baptiste Assmannc4aabae2015-08-04 22:43:06 +020011471 Default value: ipv6
11472
Olivier Doucetaa1ea8a2016-08-05 17:15:20 +020011473 Example:
11474
11475 server s1 app1.domain.com:80 resolvers mydns resolve-prefer ipv6
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020011476
Thierry Fournierac88cfe2016-02-17 22:05:30 +010011477resolve-net <network>[,<network[,...]]
11478 This options prioritize th choice of an ip address matching a network. This is
11479 useful with clouds to prefer a local ip. In some cases, a cloud high
Tim Düsterhus4896c442016-11-29 02:15:19 +010011480 availability service can be announced with many ip addresses on many
Thierry Fournierac88cfe2016-02-17 22:05:30 +010011481 differents datacenters. The latency between datacenter is not negligible, so
11482 this patch permitsto prefers a local datacenter. If none address matchs the
11483 configured network, another address is selected.
11484
Olivier Doucetaa1ea8a2016-08-05 17:15:20 +020011485 Example:
11486
11487 server s1 app1.domain.com:80 resolvers mydns resolve-net 10.0.0.0/8
Thierry Fournierac88cfe2016-02-17 22:05:30 +010011488
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020011489resolvers <id>
11490 Points to an existing "resolvers" section to resolve current server's
11491 hostname.
11492
Olivier Doucetaa1ea8a2016-08-05 17:15:20 +020011493 Example:
11494
11495 server s1 app1.domain.com:80 check resolvers mydns
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020011496
Olivier Doucetaa1ea8a2016-08-05 17:15:20 +020011497 See also section 5.3
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020011498
Willy Tarreau5ab04ec2011-03-20 10:32:26 +010011499send-proxy
11500 The "send-proxy" parameter enforces use of the PROXY protocol over any
11501 connection established to this server. The PROXY protocol informs the other
11502 end about the layer 3/4 addresses of the incoming connection, so that it can
11503 know the client's address or the public address it accessed to, whatever the
Bertrand Jacquin93b227d2016-06-04 15:11:10 +010011504 upper layer protocol. For connections accepted by an "accept-proxy" or
11505 "accept-netscaler-cip" listener, the advertised address will be used. Only
11506 TCPv4 and TCPv6 address families are supported. Other families such as
11507 Unix sockets, will report an UNKNOWN family. Servers using this option can
11508 fully be chained to another instance of haproxy listening with an
11509 "accept-proxy" setting. This setting must not be used if the server isn't
11510 aware of the protocol. When health checks are sent to the server, the PROXY
11511 protocol is automatically used when this option is set, unless there is an
11512 explicit "port" or "addr" directive, in which case an explicit
11513 "check-send-proxy" directive would also be needed to use the PROXY protocol.
Frédéric Lécailled2376272017-03-21 18:52:12 +010011514 See also the "no-send-proxy" option of this section and "accept-proxy" and
11515 "accept-netscaler-cip" option of the "bind" keyword.
Willy Tarreau5ab04ec2011-03-20 10:32:26 +010011516
David Safb76832014-05-08 23:42:08 -040011517send-proxy-v2
11518 The "send-proxy-v2" parameter enforces use of the PROXY protocol version 2
11519 over any connection established to this server. The PROXY protocol informs
11520 the other end about the layer 3/4 addresses of the incoming connection, so
11521 that it can know the client's address or the public address it accessed to,
Emmanuel Hocdet404d9782017-10-24 10:55:14 +020011522 whatever the upper layer protocol. It also send ALPN information if an alpn
11523 have been negotiated. This setting must not be used if the server isn't aware
11524 of this version of the protocol. See also the "no-send-proxy-v2" option of
11525 this section and send-proxy" option of the "bind" keyword.
David Safb76832014-05-08 23:42:08 -040011526
11527send-proxy-v2-ssl
11528 The "send-proxy-v2-ssl" parameter enforces use of the PROXY protocol version
11529 2 over any connection established to this server. The PROXY protocol informs
11530 the other end about the layer 3/4 addresses of the incoming connection, so
11531 that it can know the client's address or the public address it accessed to,
11532 whatever the upper layer protocol. In addition, the SSL information extension
11533 of the PROXY protocol is added to the PROXY protocol header. This setting
11534 must not be used if the server isn't aware of this version of the protocol.
Frédéric Lécailled2376272017-03-21 18:52:12 +010011535 See also the "no-send-proxy-v2-ssl" option of this section and the
11536 "send-proxy-v2" option of the "bind" keyword.
David Safb76832014-05-08 23:42:08 -040011537
11538send-proxy-v2-ssl-cn
11539 The "send-proxy-v2-ssl" parameter enforces use of the PROXY protocol version
11540 2 over any connection established to this server. The PROXY protocol informs
11541 the other end about the layer 3/4 addresses of the incoming connection, so
11542 that it can know the client's address or the public address it accessed to,
11543 whatever the upper layer protocol. In addition, the SSL information extension
11544 of the PROXY protocol, along along with the Common Name from the subject of
11545 the client certificate (if any), is added to the PROXY protocol header. This
11546 setting must not be used if the server isn't aware of this version of the
Frédéric Lécailled2376272017-03-21 18:52:12 +010011547 protocol. See also the "no-send-proxy-v2-ssl-cn" option of this section and the
11548 "send-proxy-v2" option of the "bind" keyword.
David Safb76832014-05-08 23:42:08 -040011549
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +010011550slowstart <start_time_in_ms>
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020011551 The "slowstart" parameter for a server accepts a value in milliseconds which
11552 indicates after how long a server which has just come back up will run at
11553 full speed. Just as with every other time-based parameter, it can be entered
11554 in any other explicit unit among { us, ms, s, m, h, d }. The speed grows
11555 linearly from 0 to 100% during this time. The limitation applies to two
11556 parameters :
11557
11558 - maxconn: the number of connections accepted by the server will grow from 1
11559 to 100% of the usual dynamic limit defined by (minconn,maxconn,fullconn).
11560
11561 - weight: when the backend uses a dynamic weighted algorithm, the weight
11562 grows linearly from 1 to 100%. In this case, the weight is updated at every
11563 health-check. For this reason, it is important that the "inter" parameter
11564 is smaller than the "slowstart", in order to maximize the number of steps.
11565
11566 The slowstart never applies when haproxy starts, otherwise it would cause
11567 trouble to running servers. It only applies when a server has been previously
11568 seen as failed.
11569
Willy Tarreau732eac42015-07-09 11:40:25 +020011570sni <expression>
11571 The "sni" parameter evaluates the sample fetch expression, converts it to a
11572 string and uses the result as the host name sent in the SNI TLS extension to
11573 the server. A typical use case is to send the SNI received from the client in
11574 a bridged HTTPS scenario, using the "ssl_fc_sni" sample fetch for the
Willy Tarreau2ab88672017-07-05 18:23:03 +020011575 expression, though alternatives such as req.hdr(host) can also make sense. If
11576 "verify required" is set (which is the recommended setting), the resulting
Willy Tarreauad92a9a2017-07-28 11:38:41 +020011577 name will also be matched against the server certificate's names. See the
11578 "verify" directive for more details.
Willy Tarreau732eac42015-07-09 11:40:25 +020011579
Willy Tarreauc6f4ce82009-06-10 11:09:37 +020011580source <addr>[:<pl>[-<ph>]] [usesrc { <addr2>[:<port2>] | client | clientip } ]
Willy Tarreaubce70882009-09-07 11:51:47 +020011581source <addr>[:<port>] [usesrc { <addr2>[:<port2>] | hdr_ip(<hdr>[,<occ>]) } ]
Willy Tarreauc6f4ce82009-06-10 11:09:37 +020011582source <addr>[:<pl>[-<ph>]] [interface <name>] ...
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020011583 The "source" parameter sets the source address which will be used when
11584 connecting to the server. It follows the exact same parameters and principle
11585 as the backend "source" keyword, except that it only applies to the server
11586 referencing it. Please consult the "source" keyword for details.
11587
Willy Tarreauc6f4ce82009-06-10 11:09:37 +020011588 Additionally, the "source" statement on a server line allows one to specify a
11589 source port range by indicating the lower and higher bounds delimited by a
11590 dash ('-'). Some operating systems might require a valid IP address when a
11591 source port range is specified. It is permitted to have the same IP/range for
11592 several servers. Doing so makes it possible to bypass the maximum of 64k
11593 total concurrent connections. The limit will then reach 64k connections per
11594 server.
11595
Lukas Tribus7d56c6d2016-09-13 09:51:15 +000011596 Since Linux 4.2/libc 2.23 IP_BIND_ADDRESS_NO_PORT is set for connections
11597 specifying the source address without port(s).
11598
Willy Tarreaua0ee1d02012-09-10 09:01:23 +020011599ssl
Willy Tarreau44f65392013-06-25 07:56:20 +020011600 This option enables SSL ciphering on outgoing connections to the server. It
11601 is critical to verify server certificates using "verify" when using SSL to
11602 connect to servers, otherwise the communication is prone to trivial man in
11603 the-middle attacks rendering SSL useless. When this option is used, health
11604 checks are automatically sent in SSL too unless there is a "port" or an
11605 "addr" directive indicating the check should be sent to a different location.
Frédéric Lécailled2376272017-03-21 18:52:12 +010011606 See the "no-ssl" to disable "ssl" option and "check-ssl" option to force
11607 SSL health checks.
Willy Tarreau763a95b2012-10-04 23:15:39 +020011608
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +020011609ssl-max-ver [ SSLv3 | TLSv1.0 | TLSv1.1 | TLSv1.2 | TLSv1.3 ]
11610 This option enforces use of <version> or lower when SSL is used to communicate
11611 with the server. This option is also available on global statement
11612 "ssl-default-server-options". See also "ssl-min-ver".
11613
11614ssl-min-ver [ SSLv3 | TLSv1.0 | TLSv1.1 | TLSv1.2 | TLSv1.3 ]
11615 This option enforces use of <version> or upper when SSL is used to communicate
11616 with the server. This option is also available on global statement
11617 "ssl-default-server-options". See also "ssl-max-ver".
11618
Frédéric Lécailled2376272017-03-21 18:52:12 +010011619ssl-reuse
11620 This option may be used as "server" setting to reset any "no-ssl-reuse"
11621 setting which would have been inherited from "default-server" directive as
11622 default value.
11623 It may also be used as "default-server" setting to reset any previous
11624 "default-server" "no-ssl-reuse" setting.
11625
11626stick
11627 This option may be used as "server" setting to reset any "non-stick"
11628 setting which would have been inherited from "default-server" directive as
11629 default value.
11630 It may also be used as "default-server" setting to reset any previous
11631 "default-server" "non-stick" setting.
Willy Tarreaua0ee1d02012-09-10 09:01:23 +020011632
Willy Tarreau163d4622015-10-13 16:16:41 +020011633tcp-ut <delay>
11634 Sets the TCP User Timeout for all outgoing connections to this server. This
11635 option is available on Linux since version 2.6.37. It allows haproxy to
11636 configure a timeout for sockets which contain data not receiving an
Tim Düsterhus4896c442016-11-29 02:15:19 +010011637 acknowledgement for the configured delay. This is especially useful on
Willy Tarreau163d4622015-10-13 16:16:41 +020011638 long-lived connections experiencing long idle periods such as remote
11639 terminals or database connection pools, where the client and server timeouts
11640 must remain high to allow a long period of idle, but where it is important to
11641 detect that the server has disappeared in order to release all resources
11642 associated with its connection (and the client's session). One typical use
11643 case is also to force dead server connections to die when health checks are
11644 too slow or during a soft reload since health checks are then disabled. The
11645 argument is a delay expressed in milliseconds by default. This only works for
11646 regular TCP connections, and is ignored for other protocols.
11647
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020011648track [<proxy>/]<server>
Willy Tarreau32091232014-05-16 13:52:00 +020011649 This option enables ability to set the current state of the server by tracking
11650 another one. It is possible to track a server which itself tracks another
11651 server, provided that at the end of the chain, a server has health checks
11652 enabled. If <proxy> is omitted the current one is used. If disable-on-404 is
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020011653 used, it has to be enabled on both proxies.
11654
Frédéric Lécailled2376272017-03-21 18:52:12 +010011655tls-tickets
11656 This option may be used as "server" setting to reset any "no-tls-tickets"
11657 setting which would have been inherited from "default-server" directive as
11658 default value.
11659 It may also be used as "default-server" setting to reset any previous
11660 "default-server" "no-tlsv-tickets" setting.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +010011661
Emeric Brunef42d922012-10-11 16:11:36 +020011662verify [none|required]
11663 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. If set
Emeric Brun850efd52014-01-29 12:24:34 +010011664 to 'none', server certificate is not verified. In the other case, The
Willy Tarreauad92a9a2017-07-28 11:38:41 +020011665 certificate provided by the server is verified using CAs from 'ca-file' and
11666 optional CRLs from 'crl-file' after having checked that the names provided in
11667 the certificate's subject and subjectAlternateNames attributs match either
11668 the name passed using the "sni" directive, or if not provided, the static
11669 host name passed using the "verifyhost" directive. When no name is found, the
11670 certificate's names are ignored. For this reason, without SNI it's important
11671 to use "verifyhost". On verification failure the handshake is aborted. It is
11672 critically important to verify server certificates when using SSL to connect
11673 to servers, otherwise the communication is prone to trivial man-in-the-middle
11674 attacks rendering SSL totally useless. Unless "ssl_server_verify" appears in
11675 the global section, "verify" is set to "required" by default.
Emeric Brunef42d922012-10-11 16:11:36 +020011676
Evan Broderbe554312013-06-27 00:05:25 -070011677verifyhost <hostname>
11678 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in, and
Willy Tarreauad92a9a2017-07-28 11:38:41 +020011679 only takes effect if 'verify required' is also specified. This directive sets
11680 a default static hostname to check the server's certificate against when no
11681 SNI was used to connect to the server. If SNI is not used, this is the only
11682 way to enable hostname verification. This static hostname, when set, will
11683 also be used for health checks (which cannot provide an SNI value). If none
11684 of the hostnames in the certificate match the specified hostname, the
11685 handshake is aborted. The hostnames in the server-provided certificate may
11686 include wildcards. See also "verify", "sni" and "no-verifyhost" options.
Evan Broderbe554312013-06-27 00:05:25 -070011687
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +010011688weight <weight>
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020011689 The "weight" parameter is used to adjust the server's weight relative to
11690 other servers. All servers will receive a load proportional to their weight
11691 relative to the sum of all weights, so the higher the weight, the higher the
Willy Tarreau6704d672009-06-15 10:56:05 +020011692 load. The default weight is 1, and the maximal value is 256. A value of 0
11693 means the server will not participate in load-balancing but will still accept
11694 persistent connections. If this parameter is used to distribute the load
11695 according to server's capacity, it is recommended to start with values which
11696 can both grow and shrink, for instance between 10 and 100 to leave enough
11697 room above and below for later adjustments.
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020011698
11699
Cyril Bonté46175dd2015-07-02 22:45:32 +0200117005.3. Server IP address resolution using DNS
11701-------------------------------------------
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020011702
Baptiste Assmann62b75b42015-09-09 01:11:36 +020011703HAProxy allows using a host name on the server line to retrieve its IP address
11704using name servers. By default, HAProxy resolves the name when parsing the
11705configuration file, at startup and cache the result for the process' life.
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020011706This is not sufficient in some cases, such as in Amazon where a server's IP
11707can change after a reboot or an ELB Virtual IP can change based on current
11708workload.
11709This chapter describes how HAProxy can be configured to process server's name
11710resolution at run time.
11711Whether run time server name resolution has been enable or not, HAProxy will
11712carry on doing the first resolution when parsing the configuration.
11713
11714
Cyril Bonté46175dd2015-07-02 22:45:32 +0200117155.3.1. Global overview
11716----------------------
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020011717
11718As we've seen in introduction, name resolution in HAProxy occurs at two
11719different steps of the process life:
11720
11721 1. when starting up, HAProxy parses the server line definition and matches a
11722 host name. It uses libc functions to get the host name resolved. This
11723 resolution relies on /etc/resolv.conf file.
11724
Christopher Faulet67957bd2017-09-27 11:00:59 +020011725 2. at run time, HAProxy performs periodically name resolutions for servers
11726 requiring DNS resolutions.
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020011727
11728A few other events can trigger a name resolution at run time:
11729 - when a server's health check ends up in a connection timeout: this may be
11730 because the server has a new IP address. So we need to trigger a name
11731 resolution to know this new IP.
11732
Christopher Faulet67957bd2017-09-27 11:00:59 +020011733When using resolvers, the server name can either be a hostname, or a SRV label.
11734HAProxy considers anything that starts with an underscore as a SRV label. If a
11735SRV label is specified, then the corresponding SRV records will be retrieved
11736from the DNS server, and the provided hostnames will be used. The SRV label
11737will be checked periodically, and if any server are added or removed, haproxy
11738will automatically do the same.
Olivier Houchardecfa18d2017-08-07 17:30:03 +020011739
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020011740A few things important to notice:
11741 - all the name servers are queried in the mean time. HAProxy will process the
11742 first valid response.
11743
11744 - a resolution is considered as invalid (NX, timeout, refused), when all the
11745 servers return an error.
11746
11747
Cyril Bonté46175dd2015-07-02 22:45:32 +0200117485.3.2. The resolvers section
11749----------------------------
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020011750
11751This section is dedicated to host information related to name resolution in
Christopher Faulet67957bd2017-09-27 11:00:59 +020011752HAProxy. There can be as many as resolvers section as needed. Each section can
11753contain many name servers.
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020011754
Baptiste Assmann62b75b42015-09-09 01:11:36 +020011755When multiple name servers are configured in a resolvers section, then HAProxy
11756uses the first valid response. In case of invalid responses, only the last one
11757is treated. Purpose is to give the chance to a slow server to deliver a valid
11758answer after a fast faulty or outdated server.
11759
11760When each server returns a different error type, then only the last error is
Christopher Faulet67957bd2017-09-27 11:00:59 +020011761used by HAProxy. The following processing is applied on this error:
Baptiste Assmann62b75b42015-09-09 01:11:36 +020011762
Christopher Faulet67957bd2017-09-27 11:00:59 +020011763 1. HAProxy retries the same DNS query with a new query type. The A queries are
11764 switch to AAAA or the opposite. SRV queries are not concerned here. Timeout
11765 errors are also excluded.
Baptiste Assmann62b75b42015-09-09 01:11:36 +020011766
Christopher Faulet67957bd2017-09-27 11:00:59 +020011767 2. When the fallback on the query type was done (or not applicable), HAProxy
11768 retries the original DNS query, with the preferred query type.
Baptiste Assmann62b75b42015-09-09 01:11:36 +020011769
Christopher Faulet67957bd2017-09-27 11:00:59 +020011770 3. HAProxy retries previous steps <resolve_retires> times. If no valid
11771 response is received after that, it stops the DNS resolution and reports
11772 the error.
Baptiste Assmann62b75b42015-09-09 01:11:36 +020011773
Christopher Faulet67957bd2017-09-27 11:00:59 +020011774For example, with 2 name servers configured in a resolvers section, the
11775following scenarios are possible:
11776
11777 - First response is valid and is applied directly, second response is
11778 ignored
11779
11780 - First response is invalid and second one is valid, then second response is
11781 applied
11782
11783 - First response is a NX domain and second one a truncated response, then
11784 HAProxy retries the query with a new type
11785
11786 - First response is a NX domain and second one is a timeout, then HAProxy
11787 retries the query with a new type
11788
11789 - Query timed out for both name servers, then HAProxy retries it with the
11790 same query type
Baptiste Assmann62b75b42015-09-09 01:11:36 +020011791
Olivier Houcharda8c6db82017-07-06 18:46:47 +020011792As a DNS server may not answer all the IPs in one DNS request, haproxy keeps
11793a cache of previous answers, an answer will be considered obsolete after
Christopher Faulet67957bd2017-09-27 11:00:59 +020011794<hold obsolete> seconds without the IP returned.
Olivier Houcharda8c6db82017-07-06 18:46:47 +020011795
Baptiste Assmann62b75b42015-09-09 01:11:36 +020011796
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020011797resolvers <resolvers id>
11798 Creates a new name server list labelled <resolvers id>
11799
11800A resolvers section accept the following parameters:
11801
Baptiste Assmann2af08fe2017-08-14 00:13:01 +020011802accepted_payload_size <nb>
11803 Defines the maxium payload size accepted by HAProxy and announced to all the
Christopher Faulet67957bd2017-09-27 11:00:59 +020011804 name servers configured in this resolvers section.
Baptiste Assmann2af08fe2017-08-14 00:13:01 +020011805 <nb> is in bytes. If not set, HAProxy announces 512. (minimal value defined
11806 by RFC 6891)
11807
Baptiste Assmann9d8dbbc2017-08-18 23:35:08 +020011808 Note: to get bigger responses but still be sure that responses won't be
Baptiste Assmann2af08fe2017-08-14 00:13:01 +020011809 dropped on the wire, one can choose a value between 1280 and 1410.
11810
Baptiste Assmann9d8dbbc2017-08-18 23:35:08 +020011811 Note: the maximum allowed value is 8192.
11812
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020011813nameserver <id> <ip>:<port>
11814 DNS server description:
11815 <id> : label of the server, should be unique
11816 <ip> : IP address of the server
11817 <port> : port where the DNS service actually runs
11818
11819hold <status> <period>
11820 Defines <period> during which the last name resolution should be kept based
11821 on last resolution <status>
Baptiste Assmann987e16d2016-11-02 22:23:31 +010011822 <status> : last name resolution status. Acceptable values are "nx",
Olivier Houcharda8c6db82017-07-06 18:46:47 +020011823 "other", "refused", "timeout", "valid", "obsolete".
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020011824 <period> : interval between two successive name resolution when the last
11825 answer was in <status>. It follows the HAProxy time format.
11826 <period> is in milliseconds by default.
11827
Baptiste Assmann686408b2017-08-18 10:15:42 +020011828 Default value is 10s for "valid", 0s for "obsolete" and 30s for others.
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020011829
Christopher Faulet67957bd2017-09-27 11:00:59 +020011830resolution_pool_size <nb> (deprecated)
Baptiste Assmann201c07f2017-05-22 15:17:15 +020011831 Defines the number of resolutions available in the pool for this resolvers.
11832 If not defines, it defaults to 64. If your configuration requires more than
11833 <nb>, then HAProxy will return an error when parsing the configuration.
11834
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020011835resolve_retries <nb>
11836 Defines the number <nb> of queries to send to resolve a server name before
11837 giving up.
11838 Default value: 3
11839
Baptiste Assmann62b75b42015-09-09 01:11:36 +020011840 A retry occurs on name server timeout or when the full sequence of DNS query
11841 type failover is over and we need to start up from the default ANY query
11842 type.
11843
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020011844timeout <event> <time>
11845 Defines timeouts related to name resolution
11846 <event> : the event on which the <time> timeout period applies to.
11847 events available are:
Christopher Faulet67957bd2017-09-27 11:00:59 +020011848 - resolve : default time to trigger name resolutions when no
11849 other time applied.
11850 Default value: 1s
11851 - retry : time between two DNS queries, when no valid response
11852 have been received.
11853 Default value: 1s
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020011854 <time> : time related to the event. It follows the HAProxy time format.
11855 <time> is expressed in milliseconds.
11856
Olivier Doucetaa1ea8a2016-08-05 17:15:20 +020011857 Example:
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020011858
11859 resolvers mydns
11860 nameserver dns1 10.0.0.1:53
11861 nameserver dns2 10.0.0.2:53
11862 resolve_retries 3
Christopher Faulet67957bd2017-09-27 11:00:59 +020011863 timeout resolve 1s
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020011864 timeout retry 1s
Baptiste Assmann987e16d2016-11-02 22:23:31 +010011865 hold other 30s
11866 hold refused 30s
11867 hold nx 30s
11868 hold timeout 30s
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020011869 hold valid 10s
Olivier Houcharda8c6db82017-07-06 18:46:47 +020011870 hold obsolete 30s
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020011871
11872
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200118736. HTTP header manipulation
11874---------------------------
11875
11876In HTTP mode, it is possible to rewrite, add or delete some of the request and
11877response headers based on regular expressions. It is also possible to block a
11878request or a response if a particular header matches a regular expression,
11879which is enough to stop most elementary protocol attacks, and to protect
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +010011880against information leak from the internal network.
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020011881
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +010011882If HAProxy encounters an "Informational Response" (status code 1xx), it is able
11883to process all rsp* rules which can allow, deny, rewrite or delete a header,
11884but it will refuse to add a header to any such messages as this is not
11885HTTP-compliant. The reason for still processing headers in such responses is to
11886stop and/or fix any possible information leak which may happen, for instance
11887because another downstream equipment would unconditionally add a header, or if
11888a server name appears there. When such messages are seen, normal processing
11889still occurs on the next non-informational messages.
Willy Tarreau816b9792009-09-15 21:25:21 +020011890
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020011891This section covers common usage of the following keywords, described in detail
11892in section 4.2 :
11893
11894 - reqadd <string>
11895 - reqallow <search>
11896 - reqiallow <search>
11897 - reqdel <search>
11898 - reqidel <search>
11899 - reqdeny <search>
11900 - reqideny <search>
11901 - reqpass <search>
11902 - reqipass <search>
11903 - reqrep <search> <replace>
11904 - reqirep <search> <replace>
11905 - reqtarpit <search>
11906 - reqitarpit <search>
11907 - rspadd <string>
11908 - rspdel <search>
11909 - rspidel <search>
11910 - rspdeny <search>
11911 - rspideny <search>
11912 - rsprep <search> <replace>
11913 - rspirep <search> <replace>
11914
11915With all these keywords, the same conventions are used. The <search> parameter
11916is a POSIX extended regular expression (regex) which supports grouping through
11917parenthesis (without the backslash). Spaces and other delimiters must be
11918prefixed with a backslash ('\') to avoid confusion with a field delimiter.
11919Other characters may be prefixed with a backslash to change their meaning :
11920
11921 \t for a tab
11922 \r for a carriage return (CR)
11923 \n for a new line (LF)
11924 \ to mark a space and differentiate it from a delimiter
11925 \# to mark a sharp and differentiate it from a comment
11926 \\ to use a backslash in a regex
11927 \\\\ to use a backslash in the text (*2 for regex, *2 for haproxy)
11928 \xXX to write the ASCII hex code XX as in the C language
11929
11930The <replace> parameter contains the string to be used to replace the largest
11931portion of text matching the regex. It can make use of the special characters
11932above, and can reference a substring which is delimited by parenthesis in the
11933regex, by writing a backslash ('\') immediately followed by one digit from 0 to
119349 indicating the group position (0 designating the entire line). This practice
11935is very common to users of the "sed" program.
11936
11937The <string> parameter represents the string which will systematically be added
11938after the last header line. It can also use special character sequences above.
11939
11940Notes related to these keywords :
11941---------------------------------
11942 - these keywords are not always convenient to allow/deny based on header
11943 contents. It is strongly recommended to use ACLs with the "block" keyword
11944 instead, resulting in far more flexible and manageable rules.
11945
11946 - lines are always considered as a whole. It is not possible to reference
11947 a header name only or a value only. This is important because of the way
11948 headers are written (notably the number of spaces after the colon).
11949
11950 - the first line is always considered as a header, which makes it possible to
11951 rewrite or filter HTTP requests URIs or response codes, but in turn makes
11952 it harder to distinguish between headers and request line. The regex prefix
11953 ^[^\ \t]*[\ \t] matches any HTTP method followed by a space, and the prefix
11954 ^[^ \t:]*: matches any header name followed by a colon.
11955
11956 - for performances reasons, the number of characters added to a request or to
11957 a response is limited at build time to values between 1 and 4 kB. This
11958 should normally be far more than enough for most usages. If it is too short
11959 on occasional usages, it is possible to gain some space by removing some
11960 useless headers before adding new ones.
11961
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +010011962 - keywords beginning with "reqi" and "rspi" are the same as their counterpart
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020011963 without the 'i' letter except that they ignore case when matching patterns.
11964
11965 - when a request passes through a frontend then a backend, all req* rules
11966 from the frontend will be evaluated, then all req* rules from the backend
11967 will be evaluated. The reverse path is applied to responses.
11968
11969 - req* statements are applied after "block" statements, so that "block" is
11970 always the first one, but before "use_backend" in order to permit rewriting
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +010011971 before switching.
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020011972
11973
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +0200119747. Using ACLs and fetching samples
11975----------------------------------
11976
11977Haproxy is capable of extracting data from request or response streams, from
11978client or server information, from tables, environmental information etc...
11979The action of extracting such data is called fetching a sample. Once retrieved,
11980these samples may be used for various purposes such as a key to a stick-table,
11981but most common usages consist in matching them against predefined constant
11982data called patterns.
11983
11984
119857.1. ACL basics
11986---------------
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020011987
11988The use of Access Control Lists (ACL) provides a flexible solution to perform
11989content switching and generally to take decisions based on content extracted
11990from the request, the response or any environmental status. The principle is
11991simple :
11992
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011993 - extract a data sample from a stream, table or the environment
Willy Tarreaue6b11e42013-11-26 19:02:32 +010011994 - optionally apply some format conversion to the extracted sample
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011995 - apply one or multiple pattern matching methods on this sample
11996 - perform actions only when a pattern matches the sample
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020011997
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011998The actions generally consist in blocking a request, selecting a backend, or
11999adding a header.
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020012000
12001In order to define a test, the "acl" keyword is used. The syntax is :
12002
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012003 acl <aclname> <criterion> [flags] [operator] [<value>] ...
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020012004
12005This creates a new ACL <aclname> or completes an existing one with new tests.
12006Those tests apply to the portion of request/response specified in <criterion>
12007and may be adjusted with optional flags [flags]. Some criteria also support
Willy Tarreaue6b11e42013-11-26 19:02:32 +010012008an operator which may be specified before the set of values. Optionally some
12009conversion operators may be applied to the sample, and they will be specified
12010as a comma-delimited list of keywords just after the first keyword. The values
12011are of the type supported by the criterion, and are separated by spaces.
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020012012
12013ACL names must be formed from upper and lower case letters, digits, '-' (dash),
12014'_' (underscore) , '.' (dot) and ':' (colon). ACL names are case-sensitive,
12015which means that "my_acl" and "My_Acl" are two different ACLs.
12016
12017There is no enforced limit to the number of ACLs. The unused ones do not affect
12018performance, they just consume a small amount of memory.
12019
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012020The criterion generally is the name of a sample fetch method, or one of its ACL
12021specific declinations. The default test method is implied by the output type of
12022this sample fetch method. The ACL declinations can describe alternate matching
Willy Tarreaue6b11e42013-11-26 19:02:32 +010012023methods of a same sample fetch method. The sample fetch methods are the only
12024ones supporting a conversion.
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012025
12026Sample fetch methods return data which can be of the following types :
12027 - boolean
12028 - integer (signed or unsigned)
12029 - IPv4 or IPv6 address
12030 - string
12031 - data block
12032
Willy Tarreaue6b11e42013-11-26 19:02:32 +010012033Converters transform any of these data into any of these. For example, some
12034converters might convert a string to a lower-case string while other ones
12035would turn a string to an IPv4 address, or apply a netmask to an IP address.
12036The resulting sample is of the type of the last converter applied to the list,
12037which defaults to the type of the sample fetch method.
12038
Thierry FOURNIER2a06e392014-05-11 15:49:55 +020012039Each sample or converter returns data of a specific type, specified with its
12040keyword in this documentation. When an ACL is declared using a standard sample
12041fetch method, certain types automatically involved a default matching method
12042which are summarized in the table below :
12043
12044 +---------------------+-----------------+
12045 | Sample or converter | Default |
12046 | output type | matching method |
12047 +---------------------+-----------------+
12048 | boolean | bool |
12049 +---------------------+-----------------+
12050 | integer | int |
12051 +---------------------+-----------------+
12052 | ip | ip |
12053 +---------------------+-----------------+
12054 | string | str |
12055 +---------------------+-----------------+
12056 | binary | none, use "-m" |
12057 +---------------------+-----------------+
12058
12059Note that in order to match a binary samples, it is mandatory to specify a
12060matching method, see below.
12061
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012062The ACL engine can match these types against patterns of the following types :
12063 - boolean
12064 - integer or integer range
12065 - IP address / network
12066 - string (exact, substring, suffix, prefix, subdir, domain)
12067 - regular expression
12068 - hex block
12069
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020012070The following ACL flags are currently supported :
12071
Willy Tarreau2b5285d2010-05-09 23:45:24 +020012072 -i : ignore case during matching of all subsequent patterns.
12073 -f : load patterns from a file.
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012074 -m : use a specific pattern matching method
Thierry FOURNIERb7729c92014-02-11 16:24:41 +010012075 -n : forbid the DNS resolutions
Thierry FOURNIER9860c412014-01-29 14:23:29 +010012076 -M : load the file pointed by -f like a map file.
Thierry FOURNIER3534d882014-01-20 17:01:44 +010012077 -u : force the unique id of the ACL
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020012078 -- : force end of flags. Useful when a string looks like one of the flags.
12079
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012080The "-f" flag is followed by the name of a file from which all lines will be
12081read as individual values. It is even possible to pass multiple "-f" arguments
12082if the patterns are to be loaded from multiple files. Empty lines as well as
12083lines beginning with a sharp ('#') will be ignored. All leading spaces and tabs
12084will be stripped. If it is absolutely necessary to insert a valid pattern
12085beginning with a sharp, just prefix it with a space so that it is not taken for
12086a comment. Depending on the data type and match method, haproxy may load the
12087lines into a binary tree, allowing very fast lookups. This is true for IPv4 and
12088exact string matching. In this case, duplicates will automatically be removed.
12089
Thierry FOURNIER9860c412014-01-29 14:23:29 +010012090The "-M" flag allows an ACL to use a map file. If this flag is set, the file is
12091parsed as two column file. The first column contains the patterns used by the
12092ACL, and the second column contain the samples. The sample can be used later by
12093a map. This can be useful in some rare cases where an ACL would just be used to
12094check for the existence of a pattern in a map before a mapping is applied.
12095
Thierry FOURNIER3534d882014-01-20 17:01:44 +010012096The "-u" flag forces the unique id of the ACL. This unique id is used with the
12097socket interface to identify ACL and dynamically change its values. Note that a
12098file is always identified by its name even if an id is set.
12099
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012100Also, note that the "-i" flag applies to subsequent entries and not to entries
12101loaded from files preceding it. For instance :
12102
12103 acl valid-ua hdr(user-agent) -f exact-ua.lst -i -f generic-ua.lst test
12104
12105In this example, each line of "exact-ua.lst" will be exactly matched against
12106the "user-agent" header of the request. Then each line of "generic-ua" will be
12107case-insensitively matched. Then the word "test" will be insensitively matched
12108as well.
12109
12110The "-m" flag is used to select a specific pattern matching method on the input
12111sample. All ACL-specific criteria imply a pattern matching method and generally
12112do not need this flag. However, this flag is useful with generic sample fetch
12113methods to describe how they're going to be matched against the patterns. This
12114is required for sample fetches which return data type for which there is no
12115obvious matching method (eg: string or binary). When "-m" is specified and
12116followed by a pattern matching method name, this method is used instead of the
12117default one for the criterion. This makes it possible to match contents in ways
12118that were not initially planned, or with sample fetch methods which return a
12119string. The matching method also affects the way the patterns are parsed.
12120
Thierry FOURNIERb7729c92014-02-11 16:24:41 +010012121The "-n" flag forbids the dns resolutions. It is used with the load of ip files.
12122By default, if the parser cannot parse ip address it considers that the parsed
12123string is maybe a domain name and try dns resolution. The flag "-n" disable this
12124resolution. It is useful for detecting malformed ip lists. Note that if the DNS
12125server is not reachable, the haproxy configuration parsing may last many minutes
12126waiting fir the timeout. During this time no error messages are displayed. The
12127flag "-n" disable this behavior. Note also that during the runtime, this
12128function is disabled for the dynamic acl modifications.
12129
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012130There are some restrictions however. Not all methods can be used with all
12131sample fetch methods. Also, if "-m" is used in conjunction with "-f", it must
12132be placed first. The pattern matching method must be one of the following :
Willy Tarreau5adeda12013-03-31 22:13:34 +020012133
12134 - "found" : only check if the requested sample could be found in the stream,
12135 but do not compare it against any pattern. It is recommended not
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012136 to pass any pattern to avoid confusion. This matching method is
12137 particularly useful to detect presence of certain contents such
12138 as headers, cookies, etc... even if they are empty and without
12139 comparing them to anything nor counting them.
Willy Tarreau5adeda12013-03-31 22:13:34 +020012140
12141 - "bool" : check the value as a boolean. It can only be applied to fetches
12142 which return a boolean or integer value, and takes no pattern.
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012143 Value zero or false does not match, all other values do match.
Willy Tarreau5adeda12013-03-31 22:13:34 +020012144
12145 - "int" : match the value as an integer. It can be used with integer and
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012146 boolean samples. Boolean false is integer 0, true is integer 1.
Willy Tarreau5adeda12013-03-31 22:13:34 +020012147
12148 - "ip" : match the value as an IPv4 or IPv6 address. It is compatible
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012149 with IP address samples only, so it is implied and never needed.
Willy Tarreau5adeda12013-03-31 22:13:34 +020012150
12151 - "bin" : match the contents against an hexadecimal string representing a
12152 binary sequence. This may be used with binary or string samples.
12153
12154 - "len" : match the sample's length as an integer. This may be used with
12155 binary or string samples.
12156
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012157 - "str" : exact match : match the contents against a string. This may be
12158 used with binary or string samples.
Willy Tarreau5adeda12013-03-31 22:13:34 +020012159
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012160 - "sub" : substring match : check that the contents contain at least one of
12161 the provided string patterns. This may be used with binary or
12162 string samples.
Willy Tarreau5adeda12013-03-31 22:13:34 +020012163
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012164 - "reg" : regex match : match the contents against a list of regular
12165 expressions. This may be used with binary or string samples.
Willy Tarreau5adeda12013-03-31 22:13:34 +020012166
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012167 - "beg" : prefix match : check that the contents begin like the provided
12168 string patterns. This may be used with binary or string samples.
Willy Tarreau5adeda12013-03-31 22:13:34 +020012169
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012170 - "end" : suffix match : check that the contents end like the provided
12171 string patterns. This may be used with binary or string samples.
Willy Tarreau5adeda12013-03-31 22:13:34 +020012172
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012173 - "dir" : subdir match : check that a slash-delimited portion of the
12174 contents exactly matches one of the provided string patterns.
Willy Tarreau5adeda12013-03-31 22:13:34 +020012175 This may be used with binary or string samples.
12176
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012177 - "dom" : domain match : check that a dot-delimited portion of the contents
12178 exactly match one of the provided string patterns. This may be
12179 used with binary or string samples.
Willy Tarreau5adeda12013-03-31 22:13:34 +020012180
12181For example, to quickly detect the presence of cookie "JSESSIONID" in an HTTP
12182request, it is possible to do :
12183
12184 acl jsess_present cook(JSESSIONID) -m found
12185
12186In order to apply a regular expression on the 500 first bytes of data in the
12187buffer, one would use the following acl :
12188
12189 acl script_tag payload(0,500) -m reg -i <script>
12190
Willy Tarreaue6b11e42013-11-26 19:02:32 +010012191On systems where the regex library is much slower when using "-i", it is
12192possible to convert the sample to lowercase before matching, like this :
12193
12194 acl script_tag payload(0,500),lower -m reg <script>
12195
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012196All ACL-specific criteria imply a default matching method. Most often, these
12197criteria are composed by concatenating the name of the original sample fetch
12198method and the matching method. For example, "hdr_beg" applies the "beg" match
12199to samples retrieved using the "hdr" fetch method. Since all ACL-specific
12200criteria rely on a sample fetch method, it is always possible instead to use
12201the original sample fetch method and the explicit matching method using "-m".
Willy Tarreau2b5285d2010-05-09 23:45:24 +020012202
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012203If an alternate match is specified using "-m" on an ACL-specific criterion,
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030012204the matching method is simply applied to the underlying sample fetch method.
12205For example, all ACLs below are exact equivalent :
Willy Tarreau2b5285d2010-05-09 23:45:24 +020012206
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012207 acl short_form hdr_beg(host) www.
12208 acl alternate1 hdr_beg(host) -m beg www.
12209 acl alternate2 hdr_dom(host) -m beg www.
12210 acl alternate3 hdr(host) -m beg www.
Willy Tarreau2b5285d2010-05-09 23:45:24 +020012211
Willy Tarreau2b5285d2010-05-09 23:45:24 +020012212
Thierry FOURNIER2a06e392014-05-11 15:49:55 +020012213The table below summarizes the compatibility matrix between sample or converter
12214types and the pattern types to fetch against. It indicates for each compatible
12215combination the name of the matching method to be used, surrounded with angle
12216brackets ">" and "<" when the method is the default one and will work by
12217default without "-m".
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010012218
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012219 +-------------------------------------------------+
12220 | Input sample type |
12221 +----------------------+---------+---------+---------+---------+---------+
Thierry FOURNIER2a06e392014-05-11 15:49:55 +020012222 | pattern type | boolean | integer | ip | string | binary |
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012223 +----------------------+---------+---------+---------+---------+---------+
12224 | none (presence only) | found | found | found | found | found |
12225 +----------------------+---------+---------+---------+---------+---------+
Thierry FOURNIER2a06e392014-05-11 15:49:55 +020012226 | none (boolean value) |> bool <| bool | | bool | |
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012227 +----------------------+---------+---------+---------+---------+---------+
Thierry FOURNIER2a06e392014-05-11 15:49:55 +020012228 | integer (value) | int |> int <| int | int | |
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012229 +----------------------+---------+---------+---------+---------+---------+
Thierry FOURNIERe3ded592013-12-06 15:36:54 +010012230 | integer (length) | len | len | len | len | len |
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012231 +----------------------+---------+---------+---------+---------+---------+
Thierry FOURNIER2a06e392014-05-11 15:49:55 +020012232 | IP address | | |> ip <| ip | ip |
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012233 +----------------------+---------+---------+---------+---------+---------+
Thierry FOURNIER2a06e392014-05-11 15:49:55 +020012234 | exact string | str | str | str |> str <| str |
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012235 +----------------------+---------+---------+---------+---------+---------+
Thierry FOURNIERe3ded592013-12-06 15:36:54 +010012236 | prefix | beg | beg | beg | beg | beg |
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012237 +----------------------+---------+---------+---------+---------+---------+
Thierry FOURNIERe3ded592013-12-06 15:36:54 +010012238 | suffix | end | end | end | end | end |
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012239 +----------------------+---------+---------+---------+---------+---------+
Thierry FOURNIERe3ded592013-12-06 15:36:54 +010012240 | substring | sub | sub | sub | sub | sub |
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012241 +----------------------+---------+---------+---------+---------+---------+
Thierry FOURNIERe3ded592013-12-06 15:36:54 +010012242 | subdir | dir | dir | dir | dir | dir |
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012243 +----------------------+---------+---------+---------+---------+---------+
Thierry FOURNIERe3ded592013-12-06 15:36:54 +010012244 | domain | dom | dom | dom | dom | dom |
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012245 +----------------------+---------+---------+---------+---------+---------+
Thierry FOURNIERe3ded592013-12-06 15:36:54 +010012246 | regex | reg | reg | reg | reg | reg |
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012247 +----------------------+---------+---------+---------+---------+---------+
12248 | hex block | | | | bin | bin |
12249 +----------------------+---------+---------+---------+---------+---------+
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020012250
12251
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +0200122527.1.1. Matching booleans
12253------------------------
12254
12255In order to match a boolean, no value is needed and all values are ignored.
12256Boolean matching is used by default for all fetch methods of type "boolean".
12257When boolean matching is used, the fetched value is returned as-is, which means
12258that a boolean "true" will always match and a boolean "false" will never match.
12259
12260Boolean matching may also be enforced using "-m bool" on fetch methods which
12261return an integer value. Then, integer value 0 is converted to the boolean
12262"false" and all other values are converted to "true".
12263
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020012264
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +0200122657.1.2. Matching integers
12266------------------------
12267
12268Integer matching applies by default to integer fetch methods. It can also be
12269enforced on boolean fetches using "-m int". In this case, "false" is converted
12270to the integer 0, and "true" is converted to the integer 1.
12271
12272Integer matching also supports integer ranges and operators. Note that integer
12273matching only applies to positive values. A range is a value expressed with a
12274lower and an upper bound separated with a colon, both of which may be omitted.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020012275
12276For instance, "1024:65535" is a valid range to represent a range of
12277unprivileged ports, and "1024:" would also work. "0:1023" is a valid
12278representation of privileged ports, and ":1023" would also work.
12279
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020012280As a special case, some ACL functions support decimal numbers which are in fact
12281two integers separated by a dot. This is used with some version checks for
12282instance. All integer properties apply to those decimal numbers, including
12283ranges and operators.
12284
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020012285For an easier usage, comparison operators are also supported. Note that using
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010012286operators with ranges does not make much sense and is strongly discouraged.
12287Similarly, it does not make much sense to perform order comparisons with a set
12288of values.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020012289
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010012290Available operators for integer matching are :
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020012291
12292 eq : true if the tested value equals at least one value
12293 ge : true if the tested value is greater than or equal to at least one value
12294 gt : true if the tested value is greater than at least one value
12295 le : true if the tested value is less than or equal to at least one value
12296 lt : true if the tested value is less than at least one value
12297
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010012298For instance, the following ACL matches any negative Content-Length header :
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020012299
12300 acl negative-length hdr_val(content-length) lt 0
12301
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020012302This one matches SSL versions between 3.0 and 3.1 (inclusive) :
12303
12304 acl sslv3 req_ssl_ver 3:3.1
12305
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020012306
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +0200123077.1.3. Matching strings
12308-----------------------
12309
12310String matching applies to string or binary fetch methods, and exists in 6
12311different forms :
12312
12313 - exact match (-m str) : the extracted string must exactly match the
12314 patterns ;
12315
12316 - substring match (-m sub) : the patterns are looked up inside the
12317 extracted string, and the ACL matches if any of them is found inside ;
12318
12319 - prefix match (-m beg) : the patterns are compared with the beginning of
12320 the extracted string, and the ACL matches if any of them matches.
12321
12322 - suffix match (-m end) : the patterns are compared with the end of the
12323 extracted string, and the ACL matches if any of them matches.
12324
Baptiste Assmann33db6002016-03-06 23:32:10 +010012325 - subdir match (-m dir) : the patterns are looked up inside the extracted
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012326 string, delimited with slashes ("/"), and the ACL matches if any of them
12327 matches.
12328
12329 - domain match (-m dom) : the patterns are looked up inside the extracted
12330 string, delimited with dots ("."), and the ACL matches if any of them
12331 matches.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020012332
12333String matching applies to verbatim strings as they are passed, with the
12334exception of the backslash ("\") which makes it possible to escape some
12335characters such as the space. If the "-i" flag is passed before the first
12336string, then the matching will be performed ignoring the case. In order
12337to match the string "-i", either set it second, or pass the "--" flag
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010012338before the first string. Same applies of course to match the string "--".
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020012339
12340
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +0200123417.1.4. Matching regular expressions (regexes)
12342---------------------------------------------
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020012343
12344Just like with string matching, regex matching applies to verbatim strings as
12345they are passed, with the exception of the backslash ("\") which makes it
12346possible to escape some characters such as the space. If the "-i" flag is
12347passed before the first regex, then the matching will be performed ignoring
12348the case. In order to match the string "-i", either set it second, or pass
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010012349the "--" flag before the first string. Same principle applies of course to
12350match the string "--".
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020012351
12352
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +0200123537.1.5. Matching arbitrary data blocks
12354-------------------------------------
12355
12356It is possible to match some extracted samples against a binary block which may
12357not safely be represented as a string. For this, the patterns must be passed as
12358a series of hexadecimal digits in an even number, when the match method is set
12359to binary. Each sequence of two digits will represent a byte. The hexadecimal
12360digits may be used upper or lower case.
12361
12362Example :
12363 # match "Hello\n" in the input stream (\x48 \x65 \x6c \x6c \x6f \x0a)
12364 acl hello payload(0,6) -m bin 48656c6c6f0a
12365
12366
123677.1.6. Matching IPv4 and IPv6 addresses
12368---------------------------------------
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020012369
12370IPv4 addresses values can be specified either as plain addresses or with a
12371netmask appended, in which case the IPv4 address matches whenever it is
12372within the network. Plain addresses may also be replaced with a resolvable
Willy Tarreaud2a4aa22008-01-31 15:28:22 +010012373host name, but this practice is generally discouraged as it makes it more
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010012374difficult to read and debug configurations. If hostnames are used, you should
12375at least ensure that they are present in /etc/hosts so that the configuration
12376does not depend on any random DNS match at the moment the configuration is
12377parsed.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020012378
Daniel Schnellereba56342016-04-13 00:26:52 +020012379The dotted IPv4 address notation is supported in both regular as well as the
12380abbreviated form with all-0-octets omitted:
12381
12382 +------------------+------------------+------------------+
12383 | Example 1 | Example 2 | Example 3 |
12384 +------------------+------------------+------------------+
12385 | 192.168.0.1 | 10.0.0.12 | 127.0.0.1 |
12386 | 192.168.1 | 10.12 | 127.1 |
12387 | 192.168.0.1/22 | 10.0.0.12/8 | 127.0.0.1/8 |
12388 | 192.168.1/22 | 10.12/8 | 127.1/8 |
12389 +------------------+------------------+------------------+
12390
12391Notice that this is different from RFC 4632 CIDR address notation in which
12392192.168.42/24 would be equivalent to 192.168.42.0/24.
12393
Willy Tarreauceb4ac92012-04-28 00:41:46 +020012394IPv6 may be entered in their usual form, with or without a netmask appended.
12395Only bit counts are accepted for IPv6 netmasks. In order to avoid any risk of
12396trouble with randomly resolved IP addresses, host names are never allowed in
12397IPv6 patterns.
12398
12399HAProxy is also able to match IPv4 addresses with IPv6 addresses in the
12400following situations :
12401 - tested address is IPv4, pattern address is IPv4, the match applies
12402 in IPv4 using the supplied mask if any.
12403 - tested address is IPv6, pattern address is IPv6, the match applies
12404 in IPv6 using the supplied mask if any.
12405 - tested address is IPv6, pattern address is IPv4, the match applies in IPv4
12406 using the pattern's mask if the IPv6 address matches with 2002:IPV4::,
12407 ::IPV4 or ::ffff:IPV4, otherwise it fails.
12408 - tested address is IPv4, pattern address is IPv6, the IPv4 address is first
12409 converted to IPv6 by prefixing ::ffff: in front of it, then the match is
12410 applied in IPv6 using the supplied IPv6 mask.
12411
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012412
124137.2. Using ACLs to form conditions
12414----------------------------------
12415
12416Some actions are only performed upon a valid condition. A condition is a
12417combination of ACLs with operators. 3 operators are supported :
12418
12419 - AND (implicit)
12420 - OR (explicit with the "or" keyword or the "||" operator)
12421 - Negation with the exclamation mark ("!")
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020012422
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012423A condition is formed as a disjunctive form:
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020012424
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012425 [!]acl1 [!]acl2 ... [!]acln { or [!]acl1 [!]acl2 ... [!]acln } ...
Willy Tarreaubef91e72013-03-31 23:14:46 +020012426
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012427Such conditions are generally used after an "if" or "unless" statement,
12428indicating when the condition will trigger the action.
Willy Tarreaubef91e72013-03-31 23:14:46 +020012429
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012430For instance, to block HTTP requests to the "*" URL with methods other than
12431"OPTIONS", as well as POST requests without content-length, and GET or HEAD
12432requests with a content-length greater than 0, and finally every request which
12433is not either GET/HEAD/POST/OPTIONS !
12434
12435 acl missing_cl hdr_cnt(Content-length) eq 0
Jarno Huuskonen84c51ec2017-04-03 14:20:34 +030012436 http-request deny if HTTP_URL_STAR !METH_OPTIONS || METH_POST missing_cl
12437 http-request deny if METH_GET HTTP_CONTENT
12438 http-request deny unless METH_GET or METH_POST or METH_OPTIONS
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012439
12440To select a different backend for requests to static contents on the "www" site
12441and to every request on the "img", "video", "download" and "ftp" hosts :
12442
12443 acl url_static path_beg /static /images /img /css
12444 acl url_static path_end .gif .png .jpg .css .js
12445 acl host_www hdr_beg(host) -i www
12446 acl host_static hdr_beg(host) -i img. video. download. ftp.
12447
12448 # now use backend "static" for all static-only hosts, and for static urls
12449 # of host "www". Use backend "www" for the rest.
12450 use_backend static if host_static or host_www url_static
12451 use_backend www if host_www
12452
12453It is also possible to form rules using "anonymous ACLs". Those are unnamed ACL
12454expressions that are built on the fly without needing to be declared. They must
12455be enclosed between braces, with a space before and after each brace (because
12456the braces must be seen as independent words). Example :
12457
12458 The following rule :
12459
12460 acl missing_cl hdr_cnt(Content-length) eq 0
Jarno Huuskonen84c51ec2017-04-03 14:20:34 +030012461 http-request deny if METH_POST missing_cl
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012462
12463 Can also be written that way :
12464
Jarno Huuskonen84c51ec2017-04-03 14:20:34 +030012465 http-request deny if METH_POST { hdr_cnt(Content-length) eq 0 }
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012466
12467It is generally not recommended to use this construct because it's a lot easier
12468to leave errors in the configuration when written that way. However, for very
12469simple rules matching only one source IP address for instance, it can make more
12470sense to use them than to declare ACLs with random names. Another example of
12471good use is the following :
12472
12473 With named ACLs :
12474
12475 acl site_dead nbsrv(dynamic) lt 2
12476 acl site_dead nbsrv(static) lt 2
12477 monitor fail if site_dead
12478
12479 With anonymous ACLs :
12480
12481 monitor fail if { nbsrv(dynamic) lt 2 } || { nbsrv(static) lt 2 }
12482
Jarno Huuskonen84c51ec2017-04-03 14:20:34 +030012483See section 4.2 for detailed help on the "http-request deny" and "use_backend"
12484keywords.
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012485
12486
124877.3. Fetching samples
12488---------------------
12489
12490Historically, sample fetch methods were only used to retrieve data to match
12491against patterns using ACLs. With the arrival of stick-tables, a new class of
12492sample fetch methods was created, most often sharing the same syntax as their
12493ACL counterpart. These sample fetch methods are also known as "fetches". As
12494of now, ACLs and fetches have converged. All ACL fetch methods have been made
12495available as fetch methods, and ACLs may use any sample fetch method as well.
12496
12497This section details all available sample fetch methods and their output type.
12498Some sample fetch methods have deprecated aliases that are used to maintain
12499compatibility with existing configurations. They are then explicitly marked as
12500deprecated and should not be used in new setups.
12501
12502The ACL derivatives are also indicated when available, with their respective
12503matching methods. These ones all have a well defined default pattern matching
12504method, so it is never necessary (though allowed) to pass the "-m" option to
12505indicate how the sample will be matched using ACLs.
12506
12507As indicated in the sample type versus matching compatibility matrix above,
12508when using a generic sample fetch method in an ACL, the "-m" option is
12509mandatory unless the sample type is one of boolean, integer, IPv4 or IPv6. When
12510the same keyword exists as an ACL keyword and as a standard fetch method, the
12511ACL engine will automatically pick the ACL-only one by default.
12512
12513Some of these keywords support one or multiple mandatory arguments, and one or
12514multiple optional arguments. These arguments are strongly typed and are checked
12515when the configuration is parsed so that there is no risk of running with an
12516incorrect argument (eg: an unresolved backend name). Fetch function arguments
12517are passed between parenthesis and are delimited by commas. When an argument
12518is optional, it will be indicated below between square brackets ('[ ]'). When
12519all arguments are optional, the parenthesis may be omitted.
12520
12521Thus, the syntax of a standard sample fetch method is one of the following :
12522 - name
12523 - name(arg1)
12524 - name(arg1,arg2)
12525
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +020012526
125277.3.1. Converters
12528-----------------
12529
Willy Tarreaue6b11e42013-11-26 19:02:32 +010012530Sample fetch methods may be combined with transformations to be applied on top
12531of the fetched sample (also called "converters"). These combinations form what
12532is called "sample expressions" and the result is a "sample". Initially this
12533was only supported by "stick on" and "stick store-request" directives but this
12534has now be extended to all places where samples may be used (acls, log-format,
12535unique-id-format, add-header, ...).
12536
12537These transformations are enumerated as a series of specific keywords after the
12538sample fetch method. These keywords may equally be appended immediately after
12539the fetch keyword's argument, delimited by a comma. These keywords can also
12540support some arguments (eg: a netmask) which must be passed in parenthesis.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010012541
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010012542A certain category of converters are bitwise and arithmetic operators which
12543support performing basic operations on integers. Some bitwise operations are
12544supported (and, or, xor, cpl) and some arithmetic operations are supported
12545(add, sub, mul, div, mod, neg). Some comparators are provided (odd, even, not,
12546bool) which make it possible to report a match without having to write an ACL.
12547
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012548The currently available list of transformation keywords include :
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010012549
Ben Shillitof25e8e52016-12-02 14:25:37 +00001255051d.single(<prop>[,<prop>*])
12551 Returns values for the properties requested as a string, where values are
12552 separated by the delimiter specified with "51degrees-property-separator".
12553 The device is identified using the User-Agent header passed to the
12554 converter. The function can be passed up to five property names, and if a
12555 property name can't be found, the value "NoData" is returned.
12556
12557 Example :
12558 # Here the header "X-51D-DeviceTypeMobileTablet" is added to the request
12559 # containg values for the three properties requested by using the
12560 # User-Agent passed to the converter.
12561 frontend http-in
12562 bind *:8081
12563 default_backend servers
12564 http-request set-header X-51D-DeviceTypeMobileTablet \
12565 %[req.fhdr(User-Agent),51d.single(DeviceType,IsMobile,IsTablet)]
12566
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010012567add(<value>)
Thierry FOURNIER07ee64e2015-07-06 23:43:03 +020012568 Adds <value> to the input value of type signed integer, and returns the
Thierry FOURNIER5d86fae2015-07-07 21:10:16 +020012569 result as a signed integer. <value> can be a numeric value or a variable
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010012570 name. The name of the variable starts with an indication about its scope. The
12571 scopes allowed are:
Christopher Fauletff2613e2016-11-09 11:36:17 +010012572 "proc" : the variable is shared with the whole process
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010012573 "sess" : the variable is shared with the whole session
12574 "txn" : the variable is shared with the transaction (request and response)
12575 "req" : the variable is shared only during request processing
12576 "res" : the variable is shared only during response processing
12577 This prefix is followed by a name. The separator is a '.'. The name may only
Christopher Fauletb71557a2016-10-31 10:49:03 +010012578 contain characters 'a-z', 'A-Z', '0-9', '.' and '_'.
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010012579
12580and(<value>)
Thierry FOURNIER07ee64e2015-07-06 23:43:03 +020012581 Performs a bitwise "AND" between <value> and the input value of type signed
Thierry FOURNIER5d86fae2015-07-07 21:10:16 +020012582 integer, and returns the result as an signed integer. <value> can be a
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010012583 numeric value or a variable name. The name of the variable starts with an
12584 indication about its scope. The scopes allowed are:
Christopher Fauletff2613e2016-11-09 11:36:17 +010012585 "proc" : the variable is shared with the whole process
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010012586 "sess" : the variable is shared with the whole session
12587 "txn" : the variable is shared with the transaction (request and response)
12588 "req" : the variable is shared only during request processing
12589 "res" : the variable is shared only during response processing
12590 This prefix is followed by a name. The separator is a '.'. The name may only
Christopher Fauletb71557a2016-10-31 10:49:03 +010012591 contain characters 'a-z', 'A-Z', '0-9', '.' and '_'.
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010012592
Holger Just1bfc24b2017-05-06 00:56:53 +020012593b64dec
12594 Converts (decodes) a base64 encoded input string to its binary
12595 representation. It performs the inverse operation of base64().
12596
Emeric Brun53d1a982014-04-30 18:21:37 +020012597base64
12598 Converts a binary input sample to a base64 string. It is used to log or
12599 transfer binary content in a way that can be reliably transferred (eg:
12600 an SSL ID can be copied in a header).
12601
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010012602bool
Thierry FOURNIER07ee64e2015-07-06 23:43:03 +020012603 Returns a boolean TRUE if the input value of type signed integer is
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010012604 non-null, otherwise returns FALSE. Used in conjunction with and(), it can be
12605 used to report true/false for bit testing on input values (eg: verify the
12606 presence of a flag).
12607
Emeric Brun54c4ac82014-11-03 15:32:43 +010012608bytes(<offset>[,<length>])
12609 Extracts some bytes from an input binary sample. The result is a binary
12610 sample starting at an offset (in bytes) of the original sample and
Tim Düsterhus4896c442016-11-29 02:15:19 +010012611 optionally truncated at the given length.
Emeric Brun54c4ac82014-11-03 15:32:43 +010012612
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010012613cpl
Thierry FOURNIER07ee64e2015-07-06 23:43:03 +020012614 Takes the input value of type signed integer, applies a ones-complement
12615 (flips all bits) and returns the result as an signed integer.
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010012616
Willy Tarreau80599772015-01-20 19:35:24 +010012617crc32([<avalanche>])
12618 Hashes a binary input sample into an unsigned 32-bit quantity using the CRC32
12619 hash function. Optionally, it is possible to apply a full avalanche hash
12620 function to the output if the optional <avalanche> argument equals 1. This
12621 converter uses the same functions as used by the various hash-based load
12622 balancing algorithms, so it will provide exactly the same results. It is
12623 provided for compatibility with other software which want a CRC32 to be
12624 computed on some input keys, so it follows the most common implementation as
12625 found in Ethernet, Gzip, PNG, etc... It is slower than the other algorithms
12626 but may provide a better or at least less predictable distribution. It must
12627 not be used for security purposes as a 32-bit hash is trivial to break. See
12628 also "djb2", "sdbm", "wt6" and the "hash-type" directive.
12629
David Carlier29b3ca32015-09-25 14:09:21 +010012630da-csv-conv(<prop>[,<prop>*])
David Carlier4542b102015-06-01 13:54:29 +020012631 Asks the DeviceAtlas converter to identify the User Agent string passed on
12632 input, and to emit a string made of the concatenation of the properties
12633 enumerated in argument, delimited by the separator defined by the global
12634 keyword "deviceatlas-property-separator", or by default the pipe character
David Carlier840b0242016-03-16 10:09:55 +000012635 ('|'). There's a limit of 12 different properties imposed by the haproxy
David Carlier4542b102015-06-01 13:54:29 +020012636 configuration language.
12637
12638 Example:
12639 frontend www
Cyril Bonté307ee1e2015-09-28 23:16:06 +020012640 bind *:8881
12641 default_backend servers
David Carlier840b0242016-03-16 10:09:55 +000012642 http-request set-header X-DeviceAtlas-Data %[req.fhdr(User-Agent),da-csv(primaryHardwareType,osName,osVersion,browserName,browserVersion,browserRenderingEngine)]
David Carlier4542b102015-06-01 13:54:29 +020012643
Thierry FOURNIER9687c772015-05-07 15:46:29 +020012644debug
12645 This converter is used as debug tool. It dumps on screen the content and the
12646 type of the input sample. The sample is returned as is on its output. This
12647 converter only exists when haproxy was built with debugging enabled.
12648
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010012649div(<value>)
Thierry FOURNIER07ee64e2015-07-06 23:43:03 +020012650 Divides the input value of type signed integer by <value>, and returns the
12651 result as an signed integer. If <value> is null, the largest unsigned
Thierry FOURNIER5d86fae2015-07-07 21:10:16 +020012652 integer is returned (typically 2^63-1). <value> can be a numeric value or a
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010012653 variable name. The name of the variable starts with an indication about its
12654 scope. The scopes allowed are:
Christopher Fauletff2613e2016-11-09 11:36:17 +010012655 "proc" : the variable is shared with the whole process
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010012656 "sess" : the variable is shared with the whole session
12657 "txn" : the variable is shared with the transaction (request and response)
12658 "req" : the variable is shared only during request processing
12659 "res" : the variable is shared only during response processing
12660 This prefix is followed by a name. The separator is a '.'. The name may only
Christopher Fauletb71557a2016-10-31 10:49:03 +010012661 contain characters 'a-z', 'A-Z', '0-9', '.' and '_'.
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010012662
Willy Tarreau23ec4ca2014-07-15 20:15:37 +020012663djb2([<avalanche>])
12664 Hashes a binary input sample into an unsigned 32-bit quantity using the DJB2
12665 hash function. Optionally, it is possible to apply a full avalanche hash
12666 function to the output if the optional <avalanche> argument equals 1. This
12667 converter uses the same functions as used by the various hash-based load
12668 balancing algorithms, so it will provide exactly the same results. It is
12669 mostly intended for debugging, but can be used as a stick-table entry to
12670 collect rough statistics. It must not be used for security purposes as a
Willy Tarreau80599772015-01-20 19:35:24 +010012671 32-bit hash is trivial to break. See also "crc32", "sdbm", "wt6" and the
12672 "hash-type" directive.
Willy Tarreau23ec4ca2014-07-15 20:15:37 +020012673
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010012674even
Thierry FOURNIER07ee64e2015-07-06 23:43:03 +020012675 Returns a boolean TRUE if the input value of type signed integer is even
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010012676 otherwise returns FALSE. It is functionally equivalent to "not,and(1),bool".
12677
Emeric Brunf399b0d2014-11-03 17:07:03 +010012678field(<index>,<delimiters>)
12679 Extracts the substring at the given index considering given delimiters from
12680 an input string. Indexes start at 1 and delimiters are a string formatted
12681 list of chars.
12682
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +020012683hex
12684 Converts a binary input sample to an hex string containing two hex digits per
12685 input byte. It is used to log or transfer hex dumps of some binary input data
12686 in a way that can be reliably transferred (eg: an SSL ID can be copied in a
12687 header).
Thierry FOURNIER2f49d6d2014-03-12 15:01:52 +010012688
Dragan Dosen3f957b22017-10-24 09:27:34 +020012689hex2i
12690 Converts a hex string containing two hex digits per input byte to an
12691 integer. If the input value can not be converted, then zero is returned.
12692
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +020012693http_date([<offset>])
12694 Converts an integer supposed to contain a date since epoch to a string
12695 representing this date in a format suitable for use in HTTP header fields. If
12696 an offset value is specified, then it is a number of seconds that is added to
12697 the date before the conversion is operated. This is particularly useful to
12698 emit Date header fields, Expires values in responses when combined with a
12699 positive offset, or Last-Modified values when the offset is negative.
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012700
Willy Tarreaud9f316a2014-07-10 14:03:38 +020012701in_table(<table>)
12702 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
12703 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, a boolean false
12704 is returned. Otherwise a boolean true is returned. This can be used to verify
12705 the presence of a certain key in a table tracking some elements (eg: whether
12706 or not a source IP address or an Authorization header was already seen).
12707
Willy Tarreauffcb2e42014-07-10 16:29:08 +020012708ipmask(<mask>)
12709 Apply a mask to an IPv4 address, and use the result for lookups and storage.
12710 This can be used to make all hosts within a certain mask to share the same
12711 table entries and as such use the same server. The mask can be passed in
12712 dotted form (eg: 255.255.255.0) or in CIDR form (eg: 24).
12713
Thierry FOURNIER317e1c42014-08-12 10:20:47 +020012714json([<input-code>])
12715 Escapes the input string and produces an ASCII ouput string ready to use as a
12716 JSON string. The converter tries to decode the input string according to the
Herve COMMOWICK8dfe8632016-08-05 12:01:20 +020012717 <input-code> parameter. It can be "ascii", "utf8", "utf8s", "utf8p" or
Thierry FOURNIER317e1c42014-08-12 10:20:47 +020012718 "utf8ps". The "ascii" decoder never fails. The "utf8" decoder detects 3 types
12719 of errors:
12720 - bad UTF-8 sequence (lone continuation byte, bad number of continuation
12721 bytes, ...)
12722 - invalid range (the decoded value is within a UTF-8 prohibited range),
12723 - code overlong (the value is encoded with more bytes than necessary).
12724
12725 The UTF-8 JSON encoding can produce a "too long value" error when the UTF-8
12726 character is greater than 0xffff because the JSON string escape specification
12727 only authorizes 4 hex digits for the value encoding. The UTF-8 decoder exists
12728 in 4 variants designated by a combination of two suffix letters : "p" for
12729 "permissive" and "s" for "silently ignore". The behaviors of the decoders
12730 are :
12731 - "ascii" : never fails ;
12732 - "utf8" : fails on any detected errors ;
12733 - "utf8s" : never fails, but removes characters corresponding to errors ;
12734 - "utf8p" : accepts and fixes the overlong errors, but fails on any other
12735 error ;
12736 - "utf8ps" : never fails, accepts and fixes the overlong errors, but removes
12737 characters corresponding to the other errors.
12738
12739 This converter is particularly useful for building properly escaped JSON for
12740 logging to servers which consume JSON-formated traffic logs.
12741
12742 Example:
Thierry FOURNIER317e1c42014-08-12 10:20:47 +020012743 capture request header Host len 15
Herve COMMOWICK8dfe8632016-08-05 12:01:20 +020012744 capture request header user-agent len 150
12745 log-format '{"ip":"%[src]","user-agent":"%[capture.req.hdr(1),json(utf8s)]"}'
Thierry FOURNIER317e1c42014-08-12 10:20:47 +020012746
12747 Input request from client 127.0.0.1:
12748 GET / HTTP/1.0
12749 User-Agent: Very "Ugly" UA 1/2
12750
12751 Output log:
12752 {"ip":"127.0.0.1","user-agent":"Very \"Ugly\" UA 1\/2"}
12753
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +020012754language(<value>[,<default>])
12755 Returns the value with the highest q-factor from a list as extracted from the
12756 "accept-language" header using "req.fhdr". Values with no q-factor have a
12757 q-factor of 1. Values with a q-factor of 0 are dropped. Only values which
12758 belong to the list of semi-colon delimited <values> will be considered. The
12759 argument <value> syntax is "lang[;lang[;lang[;...]]]". If no value matches the
12760 given list and a default value is provided, it is returned. Note that language
12761 names may have a variant after a dash ('-'). If this variant is present in the
12762 list, it will be matched, but if it is not, only the base language is checked.
12763 The match is case-sensitive, and the output string is always one of those
12764 provided in arguments. The ordering of arguments is meaningless, only the
12765 ordering of the values in the request counts, as the first value among
12766 multiple sharing the same q-factor is used.
Thierry FOURNIERad903512014-04-11 17:51:01 +020012767
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +020012768 Example :
Thierry FOURNIERad903512014-04-11 17:51:01 +020012769
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +020012770 # this configuration switches to the backend matching a
12771 # given language based on the request :
Thierry FOURNIERad903512014-04-11 17:51:01 +020012772
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +020012773 acl es req.fhdr(accept-language),language(es;fr;en) -m str es
12774 acl fr req.fhdr(accept-language),language(es;fr;en) -m str fr
12775 acl en req.fhdr(accept-language),language(es;fr;en) -m str en
12776 use_backend spanish if es
12777 use_backend french if fr
12778 use_backend english if en
12779 default_backend choose_your_language
Thierry FOURNIERad903512014-04-11 17:51:01 +020012780
Willy Tarreauffcb2e42014-07-10 16:29:08 +020012781lower
12782 Convert a string sample to lower case. This can only be placed after a string
12783 sample fetch function or after a transformation keyword returning a string
12784 type. The result is of type string.
12785
Willy Tarreau0dbfdba2014-07-10 16:37:47 +020012786ltime(<format>[,<offset>])
12787 Converts an integer supposed to contain a date since epoch to a string
12788 representing this date in local time using a format defined by the <format>
12789 string using strftime(3). The purpose is to allow any date format to be used
12790 in logs. An optional <offset> in seconds may be applied to the input date
12791 (positive or negative). See the strftime() man page for the format supported
12792 by your operating system. See also the utime converter.
12793
12794 Example :
12795
12796 # Emit two colons, one with the local time and another with ip:port
12797 # Eg: 20140710162350 127.0.0.1:57325
12798 log-format %[date,ltime(%Y%m%d%H%M%S)]\ %ci:%cp
12799
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +020012800map(<map_file>[,<default_value>])
12801map_<match_type>(<map_file>[,<default_value>])
12802map_<match_type>_<output_type>(<map_file>[,<default_value>])
12803 Search the input value from <map_file> using the <match_type> matching method,
12804 and return the associated value converted to the type <output_type>. If the
12805 input value cannot be found in the <map_file>, the converter returns the
12806 <default_value>. If the <default_value> is not set, the converter fails and
12807 acts as if no input value could be fetched. If the <match_type> is not set, it
12808 defaults to "str". Likewise, if the <output_type> is not set, it defaults to
12809 "str". For convenience, the "map" keyword is an alias for "map_str" and maps a
12810 string to another string.
Thierry FOURNIERd5f624d2013-11-26 11:52:33 +010012811
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +020012812 It is important to avoid overlapping between the keys : IP addresses and
12813 strings are stored in trees, so the first of the finest match will be used.
12814 Other keys are stored in lists, so the first matching occurrence will be used.
Thierry FOURNIERd5f624d2013-11-26 11:52:33 +010012815
Tim Düsterhus4896c442016-11-29 02:15:19 +010012816 The following array contains the list of all map functions available sorted by
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +020012817 input type, match type and output type.
Thierry FOURNIERd5f624d2013-11-26 11:52:33 +010012818
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +020012819 input type | match method | output type str | output type int | output type ip
12820 -----------+--------------+-----------------+-----------------+---------------
12821 str | str | map_str | map_str_int | map_str_ip
12822 -----------+--------------+-----------------+-----------------+---------------
Willy Tarreau787a4c02014-05-10 07:55:30 +020012823 str | beg | map_beg | map_beg_int | map_end_ip
12824 -----------+--------------+-----------------+-----------------+---------------
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +020012825 str | sub | map_sub | map_sub_int | map_sub_ip
12826 -----------+--------------+-----------------+-----------------+---------------
12827 str | dir | map_dir | map_dir_int | map_dir_ip
12828 -----------+--------------+-----------------+-----------------+---------------
12829 str | dom | map_dom | map_dom_int | map_dom_ip
12830 -----------+--------------+-----------------+-----------------+---------------
12831 str | end | map_end | map_end_int | map_end_ip
12832 -----------+--------------+-----------------+-----------------+---------------
Ruoshan Huang3c5e3742016-12-02 16:25:31 +080012833 str | reg | map_reg | map_reg_int | map_reg_ip
12834 -----------+--------------+-----------------+-----------------+---------------
12835 str | reg | map_regm | map_reg_int | map_reg_ip
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +020012836 -----------+--------------+-----------------+-----------------+---------------
12837 int | int | map_int | map_int_int | map_int_ip
12838 -----------+--------------+-----------------+-----------------+---------------
12839 ip | ip | map_ip | map_ip_int | map_ip_ip
12840 -----------+--------------+-----------------+-----------------+---------------
Thierry FOURNIERd5f624d2013-11-26 11:52:33 +010012841
Thierry Fournier8feaa662016-02-10 22:55:20 +010012842 The special map called "map_regm" expect matching zone in the regular
12843 expression and modify the output replacing back reference (like "\1") by
12844 the corresponding match text.
12845
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +020012846 The file contains one key + value per line. Lines which start with '#' are
12847 ignored, just like empty lines. Leading tabs and spaces are stripped. The key
12848 is then the first "word" (series of non-space/tabs characters), and the value
12849 is what follows this series of space/tab till the end of the line excluding
12850 trailing spaces/tabs.
Thierry FOURNIERd5f624d2013-11-26 11:52:33 +010012851
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +020012852 Example :
12853
12854 # this is a comment and is ignored
12855 2.22.246.0/23 United Kingdom \n
12856 <-><-----------><--><------------><---->
12857 | | | | `- trailing spaces ignored
12858 | | | `---------- value
12859 | | `-------------------- middle spaces ignored
12860 | `---------------------------- key
12861 `------------------------------------ leading spaces ignored
12862
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010012863mod(<value>)
Thierry FOURNIER07ee64e2015-07-06 23:43:03 +020012864 Divides the input value of type signed integer by <value>, and returns the
12865 remainder as an signed integer. If <value> is null, then zero is returned.
Thierry FOURNIER5d86fae2015-07-07 21:10:16 +020012866 <value> can be a numeric value or a variable name. The name of the variable
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010012867 starts with an indication about its scope. The scopes allowed are:
Christopher Fauletff2613e2016-11-09 11:36:17 +010012868 "proc" : the variable is shared with the whole process
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010012869 "sess" : the variable is shared with the whole session
12870 "txn" : the variable is shared with the transaction (request and response)
12871 "req" : the variable is shared only during request processing
12872 "res" : the variable is shared only during response processing
12873 This prefix is followed by a name. The separator is a '.'. The name may only
Christopher Fauletb71557a2016-10-31 10:49:03 +010012874 contain characters 'a-z', 'A-Z', '0-9', '.' and '_'.
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010012875
12876mul(<value>)
Thierry FOURNIER07ee64e2015-07-06 23:43:03 +020012877 Multiplies the input value of type signed integer by <value>, and returns
Thierry FOURNIER00c005c2015-07-08 01:10:21 +020012878 the product as an signed integer. In case of overflow, the largest possible
12879 value for the sign is returned so that the operation doesn't wrap around.
Thierry FOURNIER5d86fae2015-07-07 21:10:16 +020012880 <value> can be a numeric value or a variable name. The name of the variable
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010012881 starts with an indication about its scope. The scopes allowed are:
Christopher Fauletff2613e2016-11-09 11:36:17 +010012882 "proc" : the variable is shared with the whole process
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010012883 "sess" : the variable is shared with the whole session
12884 "txn" : the variable is shared with the transaction (request and response)
12885 "req" : the variable is shared only during request processing
12886 "res" : the variable is shared only during response processing
12887 This prefix is followed by a name. The separator is a '.'. The name may only
Christopher Fauletb71557a2016-10-31 10:49:03 +010012888 contain characters 'a-z', 'A-Z', '0-9', '.' and '_'.
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010012889
Nenad Merdanovicb7e7c472017-03-12 21:56:55 +010012890nbsrv
12891 Takes an input value of type string, interprets it as a backend name and
12892 returns the number of usable servers in that backend. Can be used in places
12893 where we want to look up a backend from a dynamic name, like a result of a
12894 map lookup.
12895
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010012896neg
Thierry FOURNIER07ee64e2015-07-06 23:43:03 +020012897 Takes the input value of type signed integer, computes the opposite value,
12898 and returns the remainder as an signed integer. 0 is identity. This operator
12899 is provided for reversed subtracts : in order to subtract the input from a
12900 constant, simply perform a "neg,add(value)".
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010012901
12902not
Thierry FOURNIER07ee64e2015-07-06 23:43:03 +020012903 Returns a boolean FALSE if the input value of type signed integer is
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010012904 non-null, otherwise returns TRUE. Used in conjunction with and(), it can be
12905 used to report true/false for bit testing on input values (eg: verify the
12906 absence of a flag).
12907
12908odd
Thierry FOURNIER07ee64e2015-07-06 23:43:03 +020012909 Returns a boolean TRUE if the input value of type signed integer is odd
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010012910 otherwise returns FALSE. It is functionally equivalent to "and(1),bool".
12911
12912or(<value>)
Thierry FOURNIER07ee64e2015-07-06 23:43:03 +020012913 Performs a bitwise "OR" between <value> and the input value of type signed
Thierry FOURNIER5d86fae2015-07-07 21:10:16 +020012914 integer, and returns the result as an signed integer. <value> can be a
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010012915 numeric value or a variable name. The name of the variable starts with an
12916 indication about its scope. The scopes allowed are:
Christopher Fauletff2613e2016-11-09 11:36:17 +010012917 "proc" : the variable is shared with the whole process
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010012918 "sess" : the variable is shared with the whole session
12919 "txn" : the variable is shared with the transaction (request and response)
12920 "req" : the variable is shared only during request processing
12921 "res" : the variable is shared only during response processing
12922 This prefix is followed by a name. The separator is a '.'. The name may only
Christopher Fauletb71557a2016-10-31 10:49:03 +010012923 contain characters 'a-z', 'A-Z', '0-9', '.' and '_'.
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010012924
Willy Tarreauc4dc3502015-01-23 20:39:28 +010012925regsub(<regex>,<subst>[,<flags>])
Willy Tarreau7eda8492015-01-20 19:47:06 +010012926 Applies a regex-based substitution to the input string. It does the same
12927 operation as the well-known "sed" utility with "s/<regex>/<subst>/". By
12928 default it will replace in the input string the first occurrence of the
12929 largest part matching the regular expression <regex> with the substitution
12930 string <subst>. It is possible to replace all occurrences instead by adding
12931 the flag "g" in the third argument <flags>. It is also possible to make the
12932 regex case insensitive by adding the flag "i" in <flags>. Since <flags> is a
12933 string, it is made up from the concatenation of all desired flags. Thus if
12934 both "i" and "g" are desired, using "gi" or "ig" will have the same effect.
12935 It is important to note that due to the current limitations of the
Baptiste Assmann66025d82016-03-06 23:36:48 +010012936 configuration parser, some characters such as closing parenthesis, closing
12937 square brackets or comma are not possible to use in the arguments. The first
12938 use of this converter is to replace certain characters or sequence of
12939 characters with other ones.
Willy Tarreau7eda8492015-01-20 19:47:06 +010012940
12941 Example :
12942
12943 # de-duplicate "/" in header "x-path".
12944 # input: x-path: /////a///b/c/xzxyz/
12945 # output: x-path: /a/b/c/xzxyz/
12946 http-request set-header x-path %[hdr(x-path),regsub(/+,/,g)]
12947
Thierry FOURNIER35ab2752015-05-28 13:22:03 +020012948capture-req(<id>)
12949 Capture the string entry in the request slot <id> and returns the entry as
12950 is. If the slot doesn't exist, the capture fails silently.
12951
12952 See also: "declare capture", "http-request capture",
Baptiste Assmann5ac425c2015-10-21 23:13:46 +020012953 "http-response capture", "capture.req.hdr" and
12954 "capture.res.hdr" (sample fetches).
Thierry FOURNIER35ab2752015-05-28 13:22:03 +020012955
12956capture-res(<id>)
12957 Capture the string entry in the response slot <id> and returns the entry as
12958 is. If the slot doesn't exist, the capture fails silently.
12959
12960 See also: "declare capture", "http-request capture",
Baptiste Assmann5ac425c2015-10-21 23:13:46 +020012961 "http-response capture", "capture.req.hdr" and
12962 "capture.res.hdr" (sample fetches).
Thierry FOURNIER35ab2752015-05-28 13:22:03 +020012963
Willy Tarreau23ec4ca2014-07-15 20:15:37 +020012964sdbm([<avalanche>])
12965 Hashes a binary input sample into an unsigned 32-bit quantity using the SDBM
12966 hash function. Optionally, it is possible to apply a full avalanche hash
12967 function to the output if the optional <avalanche> argument equals 1. This
12968 converter uses the same functions as used by the various hash-based load
12969 balancing algorithms, so it will provide exactly the same results. It is
12970 mostly intended for debugging, but can be used as a stick-table entry to
12971 collect rough statistics. It must not be used for security purposes as a
Willy Tarreau80599772015-01-20 19:35:24 +010012972 32-bit hash is trivial to break. See also "crc32", "djb2", "wt6" and the
12973 "hash-type" directive.
Willy Tarreau23ec4ca2014-07-15 20:15:37 +020012974
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +020012975set-var(<var name>)
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010012976 Sets a variable with the input content and returns the content on the output as
12977 is. The variable keeps the value and the associated input type. The name of the
12978 variable starts with an indication about its scope. The scopes allowed are:
Christopher Fauletff2613e2016-11-09 11:36:17 +010012979 "proc" : the variable is shared with the whole process
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010012980 "sess" : the variable is shared with the whole session
12981 "txn" : the variable is shared with the transaction (request and
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +020012982 response),
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010012983 "req" : the variable is shared only during request processing,
12984 "res" : the variable is shared only during response processing.
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +020012985 This prefix is followed by a name. The separator is a '.'. The name may only
Christopher Fauletb71557a2016-10-31 10:49:03 +010012986 contain characters 'a-z', 'A-Z', '0-9', '.' and '_'.
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +020012987
Dragan Dosen6e5a9ca2017-10-24 09:18:23 +020012988sha1
12989 Converts a binary input sample to a SHA1 digest. The result is a binary
12990 sample with length of 20 bytes.
12991
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010012992sub(<value>)
Thierry FOURNIER07ee64e2015-07-06 23:43:03 +020012993 Subtracts <value> from the input value of type signed integer, and returns
12994 the result as an signed integer. Note: in order to subtract the input from
Thierry FOURNIER5d86fae2015-07-07 21:10:16 +020012995 a constant, simply perform a "neg,add(value)". <value> can be a numeric value
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010012996 or a variable name. The name of the variable starts with an indication about
12997 its scope. The scopes allowed are:
Christopher Fauletff2613e2016-11-09 11:36:17 +010012998 "proc" : the variable is shared with the whole process
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010012999 "sess" : the variable is shared with the whole session
13000 "txn" : the variable is shared with the transaction (request and
Thierry FOURNIER5d86fae2015-07-07 21:10:16 +020013001 response),
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010013002 "req" : the variable is shared only during request processing,
13003 "res" : the variable is shared only during response processing.
Thierry FOURNIER5d86fae2015-07-07 21:10:16 +020013004 This prefix is followed by a name. The separator is a '.'. The name may only
Christopher Fauletb71557a2016-10-31 10:49:03 +010013005 contain characters 'a-z', 'A-Z', '0-9', '.' and '_'.
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010013006
Willy Tarreaud9f316a2014-07-10 14:03:38 +020013007table_bytes_in_rate(<table>)
13008 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
13009 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
13010 is returned. Otherwise the converter returns the average client-to-server
13011 bytes rate associated with the input sample in the designated table, measured
13012 in amount of bytes over the period configured in the table. See also the
13013 sc_bytes_in_rate sample fetch keyword.
13014
13015
13016table_bytes_out_rate(<table>)
13017 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
13018 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
13019 is returned. Otherwise the converter returns the average server-to-client
13020 bytes rate associated with the input sample in the designated table, measured
13021 in amount of bytes over the period configured in the table. See also the
13022 sc_bytes_out_rate sample fetch keyword.
13023
13024table_conn_cnt(<table>)
13025 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
13026 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
13027 is returned. Otherwise the converter returns the cumulated amount of incoming
13028 connections associated with the input sample in the designated table. See
13029 also the sc_conn_cnt sample fetch keyword.
13030
13031table_conn_cur(<table>)
13032 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
13033 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
13034 is returned. Otherwise the converter returns the current amount of concurrent
13035 tracked connections associated with the input sample in the designated table.
13036 See also the sc_conn_cur sample fetch keyword.
13037
13038table_conn_rate(<table>)
13039 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
13040 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
13041 is returned. Otherwise the converter returns the average incoming connection
13042 rate associated with the input sample in the designated table. See also the
13043 sc_conn_rate sample fetch keyword.
13044
Thierry FOURNIER236657b2015-08-19 08:25:14 +020013045table_gpt0(<table>)
13046 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
13047 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, boolean value zero
13048 is returned. Otherwise the converter returns the current value of the first
13049 general purpose tag associated with the input sample in the designated table.
13050 See also the sc_get_gpt0 sample fetch keyword.
13051
Willy Tarreaud9f316a2014-07-10 14:03:38 +020013052table_gpc0(<table>)
13053 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
13054 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
13055 is returned. Otherwise the converter returns the current value of the first
13056 general purpose counter associated with the input sample in the designated
13057 table. See also the sc_get_gpc0 sample fetch keyword.
13058
13059table_gpc0_rate(<table>)
13060 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
13061 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
13062 is returned. Otherwise the converter returns the frequency which the gpc0
13063 counter was incremented over the configured period in the table, associated
13064 with the input sample in the designated table. See also the sc_get_gpc0_rate
13065 sample fetch keyword.
13066
13067table_http_err_cnt(<table>)
13068 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
13069 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
13070 is returned. Otherwise the converter returns the cumulated amount of HTTP
13071 errors associated with the input sample in the designated table. See also the
13072 sc_http_err_cnt sample fetch keyword.
13073
13074table_http_err_rate(<table>)
13075 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
13076 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
13077 is returned. Otherwise the average rate of HTTP errors associated with the
13078 input sample in the designated table, measured in amount of errors over the
13079 period configured in the table. See also the sc_http_err_rate sample fetch
13080 keyword.
13081
13082table_http_req_cnt(<table>)
13083 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
13084 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
13085 is returned. Otherwise the converter returns the cumulated amount of HTTP
13086 requests associated with the input sample in the designated table. See also
13087 the sc_http_req_cnt sample fetch keyword.
13088
13089table_http_req_rate(<table>)
13090 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
13091 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
13092 is returned. Otherwise the average rate of HTTP requests associated with the
13093 input sample in the designated table, measured in amount of requests over the
13094 period configured in the table. See also the sc_http_req_rate sample fetch
13095 keyword.
13096
13097table_kbytes_in(<table>)
13098 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
13099 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
13100 is returned. Otherwise the converter returns the cumulated amount of client-
13101 to-server data associated with the input sample in the designated table,
13102 measured in kilobytes. The test is currently performed on 32-bit integers,
13103 which limits values to 4 terabytes. See also the sc_kbytes_in sample fetch
13104 keyword.
13105
13106table_kbytes_out(<table>)
13107 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
13108 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
13109 is returned. Otherwise the converter returns the cumulated amount of server-
13110 to-client data associated with the input sample in the designated table,
13111 measured in kilobytes. The test is currently performed on 32-bit integers,
13112 which limits values to 4 terabytes. See also the sc_kbytes_out sample fetch
13113 keyword.
13114
13115table_server_id(<table>)
13116 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
13117 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
13118 is returned. Otherwise the converter returns the server ID associated with
13119 the input sample in the designated table. A server ID is associated to a
13120 sample by a "stick" rule when a connection to a server succeeds. A server ID
13121 zero means that no server is associated with this key.
13122
13123table_sess_cnt(<table>)
13124 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
13125 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
13126 is returned. Otherwise the converter returns the cumulated amount of incoming
13127 sessions associated with the input sample in the designated table. Note that
13128 a session here refers to an incoming connection being accepted by the
13129 "tcp-request connection" rulesets. See also the sc_sess_cnt sample fetch
13130 keyword.
13131
13132table_sess_rate(<table>)
13133 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
13134 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
13135 is returned. Otherwise the converter returns the average incoming session
13136 rate associated with the input sample in the designated table. Note that a
13137 session here refers to an incoming connection being accepted by the
13138 "tcp-request connection" rulesets. See also the sc_sess_rate sample fetch
13139 keyword.
13140
13141table_trackers(<table>)
13142 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
13143 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
13144 is returned. Otherwise the converter returns the current amount of concurrent
13145 connections tracking the same key as the input sample in the designated
13146 table. It differs from table_conn_cur in that it does not rely on any stored
13147 information but on the table's reference count (the "use" value which is
13148 returned by "show table" on the CLI). This may sometimes be more suited for
13149 layer7 tracking. It can be used to tell a server how many concurrent
13150 connections there are from a given address for example. See also the
13151 sc_trackers sample fetch keyword.
13152
Willy Tarreauffcb2e42014-07-10 16:29:08 +020013153upper
13154 Convert a string sample to upper case. This can only be placed after a string
13155 sample fetch function or after a transformation keyword returning a string
13156 type. The result is of type string.
13157
Thierry FOURNIER82ff3c92015-05-07 15:46:20 +020013158url_dec
13159 Takes an url-encoded string provided as input and returns the decoded
13160 version as output. The input and the output are of type string.
13161
Christopher Faulet85d79c92016-11-09 16:54:56 +010013162unset-var(<var name>)
13163 Unsets a variable if the input content is defined. The name of the variable
13164 starts with an indication about its scope. The scopes allowed are:
13165 "proc" : the variable is shared with the whole process
13166 "sess" : the variable is shared with the whole session
13167 "txn" : the variable is shared with the transaction (request and
13168 response),
13169 "req" : the variable is shared only during request processing,
13170 "res" : the variable is shared only during response processing.
13171 This prefix is followed by a name. The separator is a '.'. The name may only
13172 contain characters 'a-z', 'A-Z', '0-9', '.' and '_'.
13173
Willy Tarreau0dbfdba2014-07-10 16:37:47 +020013174utime(<format>[,<offset>])
13175 Converts an integer supposed to contain a date since epoch to a string
13176 representing this date in UTC time using a format defined by the <format>
13177 string using strftime(3). The purpose is to allow any date format to be used
13178 in logs. An optional <offset> in seconds may be applied to the input date
13179 (positive or negative). See the strftime() man page for the format supported
13180 by your operating system. See also the ltime converter.
13181
13182 Example :
13183
13184 # Emit two colons, one with the UTC time and another with ip:port
13185 # Eg: 20140710162350 127.0.0.1:57325
13186 log-format %[date,utime(%Y%m%d%H%M%S)]\ %ci:%cp
13187
Emeric Brunc9a0f6d2014-11-25 14:09:01 +010013188word(<index>,<delimiters>)
13189 Extracts the nth word considering given delimiters from an input string.
13190 Indexes start at 1 and delimiters are a string formatted list of chars.
13191
Willy Tarreau23ec4ca2014-07-15 20:15:37 +020013192wt6([<avalanche>])
13193 Hashes a binary input sample into an unsigned 32-bit quantity using the WT6
13194 hash function. Optionally, it is possible to apply a full avalanche hash
13195 function to the output if the optional <avalanche> argument equals 1. This
13196 converter uses the same functions as used by the various hash-based load
13197 balancing algorithms, so it will provide exactly the same results. It is
13198 mostly intended for debugging, but can be used as a stick-table entry to
13199 collect rough statistics. It must not be used for security purposes as a
Willy Tarreau80599772015-01-20 19:35:24 +010013200 32-bit hash is trivial to break. See also "crc32", "djb2", "sdbm", and the
13201 "hash-type" directive.
Willy Tarreau23ec4ca2014-07-15 20:15:37 +020013202
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010013203xor(<value>)
13204 Performs a bitwise "XOR" (exclusive OR) between <value> and the input value
Thierry FOURNIER07ee64e2015-07-06 23:43:03 +020013205 of type signed integer, and returns the result as an signed integer.
Thierry FOURNIER5d86fae2015-07-07 21:10:16 +020013206 <value> can be a numeric value or a variable name. The name of the variable
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010013207 starts with an indication about its scope. The scopes allowed are:
Christopher Fauletff2613e2016-11-09 11:36:17 +010013208 "proc" : the variable is shared with the whole process
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010013209 "sess" : the variable is shared with the whole session
13210 "txn" : the variable is shared with the transaction (request and
Thierry FOURNIER5d86fae2015-07-07 21:10:16 +020013211 response),
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010013212 "req" : the variable is shared only during request processing,
13213 "res" : the variable is shared only during response processing.
Thierry FOURNIER5d86fae2015-07-07 21:10:16 +020013214 This prefix is followed by a name. The separator is a '.'. The name may only
Christopher Fauletb71557a2016-10-31 10:49:03 +010013215 contain characters 'a-z', 'A-Z', '0-9', '.' and '_'.
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010013216
Thierry FOURNIER01e09742016-12-26 11:46:11 +010013217xxh32([<seed>])
13218 Hashes a binary input sample into an unsigned 32-bit quantity using the 32-bit
13219 variant of the XXHash hash function. This hash supports a seed which defaults
13220 to zero but a different value maybe passed as the <seed> argument. This hash
13221 is known to be very good and very fast so it can be used to hash URLs and/or
13222 URL parameters for use as stick-table keys to collect statistics with a low
13223 collision rate, though care must be taken as the algorithm is not considered
13224 as cryptographically secure.
13225
13226xxh64([<seed>])
13227 Hashes a binary input sample into a signed 64-bit quantity using the 64-bit
13228 variant of the XXHash hash function. This hash supports a seed which defaults
13229 to zero but a different value maybe passed as the <seed> argument. This hash
13230 is known to be very good and very fast so it can be used to hash URLs and/or
13231 URL parameters for use as stick-table keys to collect statistics with a low
13232 collision rate, though care must be taken as the algorithm is not considered
13233 as cryptographically secure.
13234
Thierry FOURNIERd5f624d2013-11-26 11:52:33 +010013235
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +0200132367.3.2. Fetching samples from internal states
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013237--------------------------------------------
13238
13239A first set of sample fetch methods applies to internal information which does
13240not even relate to any client information. These ones are sometimes used with
13241"monitor-fail" directives to report an internal status to external watchers.
13242The sample fetch methods described in this section are usable anywhere.
13243
13244always_false : boolean
13245 Always returns the boolean "false" value. It may be used with ACLs as a
13246 temporary replacement for another one when adjusting configurations.
13247
13248always_true : boolean
13249 Always returns the boolean "true" value. It may be used with ACLs as a
13250 temporary replacement for another one when adjusting configurations.
13251
13252avg_queue([<backend>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010013253 Returns the total number of queued connections of the designated backend
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013254 divided by the number of active servers. The current backend is used if no
13255 backend is specified. This is very similar to "queue" except that the size of
13256 the farm is considered, in order to give a more accurate measurement of the
13257 time it may take for a new connection to be processed. The main usage is with
13258 ACL to return a sorry page to new users when it becomes certain they will get
13259 a degraded service, or to pass to the backend servers in a header so that
13260 they decide to work in degraded mode or to disable some functions to speed up
13261 the processing a bit. Note that in the event there would not be any active
13262 server anymore, twice the number of queued connections would be considered as
13263 the measured value. This is a fair estimate, as we expect one server to get
13264 back soon anyway, but we still prefer to send new traffic to another backend
13265 if in better shape. See also the "queue", "be_conn", and "be_sess_rate"
13266 sample fetches.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki346f76d2010-01-12 21:59:30 +010013267
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013268be_conn([<backend>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaua36af912009-10-10 12:02:45 +020013269 Applies to the number of currently established connections on the backend,
13270 possibly including the connection being evaluated. If no backend name is
13271 specified, the current one is used. But it is also possible to check another
13272 backend. It can be used to use a specific farm when the nominal one is full.
13273 See also the "fe_conn", "queue" and "be_sess_rate" criteria.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020013274
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013275be_sess_rate([<backend>]) : integer
13276 Returns an integer value corresponding to the sessions creation rate on the
13277 backend, in number of new sessions per second. This is used with ACLs to
13278 switch to an alternate backend when an expensive or fragile one reaches too
13279 high a session rate, or to limit abuse of service (eg. prevent sucking of an
13280 online dictionary). It can also be useful to add this element to logs using a
13281 log-format directive.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010013282
13283 Example :
13284 # Redirect to an error page if the dictionary is requested too often
13285 backend dynamic
13286 mode http
13287 acl being_scanned be_sess_rate gt 100
13288 redirect location /denied.html if being_scanned
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010013289
Thierry FOURNIERcc103292015-06-06 19:30:17 +020013290bin(<hexa>) : bin
13291 Returns a binary chain. The input is the hexadecimal representation
13292 of the string.
13293
13294bool(<bool>) : bool
13295 Returns a boolean value. <bool> can be 'true', 'false', '1' or '0'.
13296 'false' and '0' are the same. 'true' and '1' are the same.
13297
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013298connslots([<backend>]) : integer
13299 Returns an integer value corresponding to the number of connection slots
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030013300 still available in the backend, by totaling the maximum amount of
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013301 connections on all servers and the maximum queue size. This is probably only
13302 used with ACLs.
Tait Clarridge7896d522012-12-05 21:39:31 -050013303
Jeffrey 'jf' Lim5051d7b2008-09-04 01:03:03 +080013304 The basic idea here is to be able to measure the number of connection "slots"
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +020013305 still available (connection + queue), so that anything beyond that (intended
Jeffrey 'jf' Lim5051d7b2008-09-04 01:03:03 +080013306 usage; see "use_backend" keyword) can be redirected to a different backend.
13307
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +020013308 'connslots' = number of available server connection slots, + number of
13309 available server queue slots.
Jeffrey 'jf' Lim5051d7b2008-09-04 01:03:03 +080013310
Willy Tarreaua36af912009-10-10 12:02:45 +020013311 Note that while "fe_conn" may be used, "connslots" comes in especially
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +020013312 useful when you have a case of traffic going to one single ip, splitting into
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013313 multiple backends (perhaps using ACLs to do name-based load balancing) and
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +020013314 you want to be able to differentiate between different backends, and their
13315 available "connslots". Also, whereas "nbsrv" only measures servers that are
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013316 actually *down*, this fetch is more fine-grained and looks into the number of
Willy Tarreaua36af912009-10-10 12:02:45 +020013317 available connection slots as well. See also "queue" and "avg_queue".
Jeffrey 'jf' Lim5051d7b2008-09-04 01:03:03 +080013318
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +020013319 OTHER CAVEATS AND NOTES: at this point in time, the code does not take care
13320 of dynamic connections. Also, if any of the server maxconn, or maxqueue is 0,
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013321 then this fetch clearly does not make sense, in which case the value returned
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +020013322 will be -1.
Jeffrey 'jf' Lim5051d7b2008-09-04 01:03:03 +080013323
Willy Tarreau6236d3a2013-07-25 14:28:25 +020013324date([<offset>]) : integer
13325 Returns the current date as the epoch (number of seconds since 01/01/1970).
13326 If an offset value is specified, then it is a number of seconds that is added
13327 to the current date before returning the value. This is particularly useful
13328 to compute relative dates, as both positive and negative offsets are allowed.
Willy Tarreau276fae92013-07-25 14:36:01 +020013329 It is useful combined with the http_date converter.
13330
13331 Example :
13332
13333 # set an expires header to now+1 hour in every response
13334 http-response set-header Expires %[date(3600),http_date]
Willy Tarreau6236d3a2013-07-25 14:28:25 +020013335
Willy Tarreaud716f9b2017-10-13 11:03:15 +020013336distcc_body(<token>[,<occ>]) : binary
13337 Parses a distcc message and returns the body associated to occurrence #<occ>
13338 of the token <token>. Occurrences start at 1, and when unspecified, any may
13339 match though in practice only the first one is checked for now. This can be
13340 used to extract file names or arguments in files built using distcc through
13341 haproxy. Please refer to distcc's protocol documentation for the complete
13342 list of supported tokens.
13343
13344distcc_param(<token>[,<occ>]) : integer
13345 Parses a distcc message and returns the parameter associated to occurrence
13346 #<occ> of the token <token>. Occurrences start at 1, and when unspecified,
13347 any may match though in practice only the first one is checked for now. This
13348 can be used to extract certain information such as the protocol version, the
13349 file size or the argument in files built using distcc through haproxy.
13350 Another use case consists in waiting for the start of the preprocessed file
13351 contents before connecting to the server to avoid keeping idle connections.
13352 Please refer to distcc's protocol documentation for the complete list of
13353 supported tokens.
13354
13355 Example :
13356 # wait up to 20s for the pre-processed file to be uploaded
13357 tcp-request inspect-delay 20s
13358 tcp-request content accept if { distcc_param(DOTI) -m found }
13359 # send large files to the big farm
13360 use_backend big_farm if { distcc_param(DOTI) gt 1000000 }
13361
Willy Tarreau595ec542013-06-12 21:34:28 +020013362env(<name>) : string
13363 Returns a string containing the value of environment variable <name>. As a
13364 reminder, environment variables are per-process and are sampled when the
13365 process starts. This can be useful to pass some information to a next hop
13366 server, or with ACLs to take specific action when the process is started a
13367 certain way.
13368
13369 Examples :
13370 # Pass the Via header to next hop with the local hostname in it
13371 http-request add-header Via 1.1\ %[env(HOSTNAME)]
13372
13373 # reject cookie-less requests when the STOP environment variable is set
13374 http-request deny if !{ cook(SESSIONID) -m found } { env(STOP) -m found }
13375
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013376fe_conn([<frontend>]) : integer
13377 Returns the number of currently established connections on the frontend,
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010013378 possibly including the connection being evaluated. If no frontend name is
13379 specified, the current one is used. But it is also possible to check another
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013380 frontend. It can be used to return a sorry page before hard-blocking, or to
13381 use a specific backend to drain new requests when the farm is considered
13382 full. This is mostly used with ACLs but can also be used to pass some
13383 statistics to servers in HTTP headers. See also the "dst_conn", "be_conn",
13384 "fe_sess_rate" fetches.
Willy Tarreaua36af912009-10-10 12:02:45 +020013385
Nenad Merdanovicad9a7e92016-10-03 04:57:37 +020013386fe_req_rate([<frontend>]) : integer
13387 Returns an integer value corresponding to the number of HTTP requests per
13388 second sent to a frontend. This number can differ from "fe_sess_rate" in
13389 situations where client-side keep-alive is enabled.
13390
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013391fe_sess_rate([<frontend>]) : integer
13392 Returns an integer value corresponding to the sessions creation rate on the
13393 frontend, in number of new sessions per second. This is used with ACLs to
13394 limit the incoming session rate to an acceptable range in order to prevent
13395 abuse of service at the earliest moment, for example when combined with other
13396 layer 4 ACLs in order to force the clients to wait a bit for the rate to go
13397 down below the limit. It can also be useful to add this element to logs using
13398 a log-format directive. See also the "rate-limit sessions" directive for use
13399 in frontends.
Willy Tarreau079ff0a2009-03-05 21:34:28 +010013400
13401 Example :
13402 # This frontend limits incoming mails to 10/s with a max of 100
13403 # concurrent connections. We accept any connection below 10/s, and
13404 # force excess clients to wait for 100 ms. Since clients are limited to
13405 # 100 max, there cannot be more than 10 incoming mails per second.
13406 frontend mail
13407 bind :25
13408 mode tcp
13409 maxconn 100
13410 acl too_fast fe_sess_rate ge 10
13411 tcp-request inspect-delay 100ms
13412 tcp-request content accept if ! too_fast
13413 tcp-request content accept if WAIT_END
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +010013414
Nenad Merdanovic807a6e72017-03-12 22:00:00 +010013415hostname : string
13416 Returns the system hostname.
13417
Thierry FOURNIER07ee64e2015-07-06 23:43:03 +020013418int(<integer>) : signed integer
13419 Returns a signed integer.
13420
Thierry FOURNIERcc103292015-06-06 19:30:17 +020013421ipv4(<ipv4>) : ipv4
13422 Returns an ipv4.
13423
13424ipv6(<ipv6>) : ipv6
13425 Returns an ipv6.
13426
13427meth(<method>) : method
13428 Returns a method.
13429
Willy Tarreau0f30d262014-11-24 16:02:05 +010013430nbproc : integer
13431 Returns an integer value corresponding to the number of processes that were
13432 started (it equals the global "nbproc" setting). This is useful for logging
13433 and debugging purposes.
13434
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013435nbsrv([<backend>]) : integer
13436 Returns an integer value corresponding to the number of usable servers of
13437 either the current backend or the named backend. This is mostly used with
13438 ACLs but can also be useful when added to logs. This is normally used to
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010013439 switch to an alternate backend when the number of servers is too low to
13440 to handle some load. It is useful to report a failure when combined with
13441 "monitor fail".
Willy Tarreau079ff0a2009-03-05 21:34:28 +010013442
Willy Tarreau0f30d262014-11-24 16:02:05 +010013443proc : integer
13444 Returns an integer value corresponding to the position of the process calling
13445 the function, between 1 and global.nbproc. This is useful for logging and
13446 debugging purposes.
13447
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013448queue([<backend>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010013449 Returns the total number of queued connections of the designated backend,
13450 including all the connections in server queues. If no backend name is
13451 specified, the current one is used, but it is also possible to check another
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013452 one. This is useful with ACLs or to pass statistics to backend servers. This
13453 can be used to take actions when queuing goes above a known level, generally
13454 indicating a surge of traffic or a massive slowdown on the servers. One
13455 possible action could be to reject new users but still accept old ones. See
13456 also the "avg_queue", "be_conn", and "be_sess_rate" fetches.
13457
Willy Tarreau84310e22014-02-14 11:59:04 +010013458rand([<range>]) : integer
13459 Returns a random integer value within a range of <range> possible values,
13460 starting at zero. If the range is not specified, it defaults to 2^32, which
13461 gives numbers between 0 and 4294967295. It can be useful to pass some values
13462 needed to take some routing decisions for example, or just for debugging
13463 purposes. This random must not be used for security purposes.
13464
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013465srv_conn([<backend>/]<server>) : integer
13466 Returns an integer value corresponding to the number of currently established
13467 connections on the designated server, possibly including the connection being
13468 evaluated. If <backend> is omitted, then the server is looked up in the
13469 current backend. It can be used to use a specific farm when one server is
13470 full, or to inform the server about our view of the number of active
13471 connections with it. See also the "fe_conn", "be_conn" and "queue" fetch
13472 methods.
13473
13474srv_is_up([<backend>/]<server>) : boolean
13475 Returns true when the designated server is UP, and false when it is either
13476 DOWN or in maintenance mode. If <backend> is omitted, then the server is
13477 looked up in the current backend. It is mainly used to take action based on
13478 an external status reported via a health check (eg: a geographical site's
13479 availability). Another possible use which is more of a hack consists in
13480 using dummy servers as boolean variables that can be enabled or disabled from
13481 the CLI, so that rules depending on those ACLs can be tweaked in realtime.
13482
Willy Tarreauff2b7af2017-10-13 11:46:26 +020013483srv_queue([<backend>/]<server>) : integer
13484 Returns an integer value corresponding to the number of connections currently
13485 pending in the designated server's queue. If <backend> is omitted, then the
13486 server is looked up in the current backend. It can sometimes be used together
13487 with the "use-server" directive to force to use a known faster server when it
13488 is not much loaded. See also the "srv_conn", "avg_queue" and "queue" sample
13489 fetch methods.
13490
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013491srv_sess_rate([<backend>/]<server>) : integer
13492 Returns an integer corresponding to the sessions creation rate on the
13493 designated server, in number of new sessions per second. If <backend> is
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030013494 omitted, then the server is looked up in the current backend. This is mostly
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013495 used with ACLs but can make sense with logs too. This is used to switch to an
13496 alternate backend when an expensive or fragile one reaches too high a session
13497 rate, or to limit abuse of service (eg. prevent latent requests from
13498 overloading servers).
13499
13500 Example :
13501 # Redirect to a separate back
13502 acl srv1_full srv_sess_rate(be1/srv1) gt 50
13503 acl srv2_full srv_sess_rate(be1/srv2) gt 50
13504 use_backend be2 if srv1_full or srv2_full
13505
Willy Tarreau0f30d262014-11-24 16:02:05 +010013506stopping : boolean
13507 Returns TRUE if the process calling the function is currently stopping. This
13508 can be useful for logging, or for relaxing certain checks or helping close
13509 certain connections upon graceful shutdown.
13510
Thierry FOURNIERcc103292015-06-06 19:30:17 +020013511str(<string>) : string
13512 Returns a string.
13513
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013514table_avl([<table>]) : integer
13515 Returns the total number of available entries in the current proxy's
13516 stick-table or in the designated stick-table. See also table_cnt.
13517
13518table_cnt([<table>]) : integer
13519 Returns the total number of entries currently in use in the current proxy's
13520 stick-table or in the designated stick-table. See also src_conn_cnt and
13521 table_avl for other entry counting methods.
13522
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +020013523var(<var-name>) : undefined
13524 Returns a variable with the stored type. If the variable is not set, the
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010013525 sample fetch fails. The name of the variable starts with an indication
13526 about its scope. The scopes allowed are:
Christopher Fauletff2613e2016-11-09 11:36:17 +010013527 "proc" : the variable is shared with the whole process
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010013528 "sess" : the variable is shared with the whole session
13529 "txn" : the variable is shared with the transaction (request and
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +020013530 response),
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010013531 "req" : the variable is shared only during request processing,
13532 "res" : the variable is shared only during response processing.
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +020013533 This prefix is followed by a name. The separator is a '.'. The name may only
Christopher Fauletb71557a2016-10-31 10:49:03 +010013534 contain characters 'a-z', 'A-Z', '0-9', '.' and '_'.
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +020013535
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +0200135367.3.3. Fetching samples at Layer 4
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013537----------------------------------
13538
13539The layer 4 usually describes just the transport layer which in haproxy is
13540closest to the connection, where no content is yet made available. The fetch
13541methods described here are usable as low as the "tcp-request connection" rule
13542sets unless they require some future information. Those generally include
13543TCP/IP addresses and ports, as well as elements from stick-tables related to
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +020013544the incoming connection. For retrieving a value from a sticky counters, the
13545counter number can be explicitly set as 0, 1, or 2 using the pre-defined
13546"sc0_", "sc1_", or "sc2_" prefix, or it can be specified as the first integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020013547argument when using the "sc_" prefix. An optional table may be specified with
13548the "sc*" form, in which case the currently tracked key will be looked up into
13549this alternate table instead of the table currently being tracked.
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013550
13551be_id : integer
13552 Returns an integer containing the current backend's id. It can be used in
13553 frontends with responses to check which backend processed the request.
13554
Marcin Deranekd2471c22016-12-12 14:08:05 +010013555be_name : string
13556 Returns a string containing the current backend's name. It can be used in
13557 frontends with responses to check which backend processed the request.
13558
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013559dst : ip
13560 This is the destination IPv4 address of the connection on the client side,
13561 which is the address the client connected to. It can be useful when running
13562 in transparent mode. It is of type IP and works on both IPv4 and IPv6 tables.
13563 On IPv6 tables, IPv4 address is mapped to its IPv6 equivalent, according to
13564 RFC 4291.
13565
13566dst_conn : integer
13567 Returns an integer value corresponding to the number of currently established
13568 connections on the same socket including the one being evaluated. It is
13569 normally used with ACLs but can as well be used to pass the information to
13570 servers in an HTTP header or in logs. It can be used to either return a sorry
13571 page before hard-blocking, or to use a specific backend to drain new requests
13572 when the socket is considered saturated. This offers the ability to assign
13573 different limits to different listening ports or addresses. See also the
13574 "fe_conn" and "be_conn" fetches.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010013575
Willy Tarreau16e01562016-08-09 16:46:18 +020013576dst_is_local : boolean
13577 Returns true if the destination address of the incoming connection is local
13578 to the system, or false if the address doesn't exist on the system, meaning
13579 that it was intercepted in transparent mode. It can be useful to apply
13580 certain rules by default to forwarded traffic and other rules to the traffic
13581 targetting the real address of the machine. For example the stats page could
13582 be delivered only on this address, or SSH access could be locally redirected.
13583 Please note that the check involves a few system calls, so it's better to do
13584 it only once per connection.
13585
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013586dst_port : integer
13587 Returns an integer value corresponding to the destination TCP port of the
13588 connection on the client side, which is the port the client connected to.
13589 This might be used when running in transparent mode, when assigning dynamic
13590 ports to some clients for a whole application session, to stick all users to
13591 a same server, or to pass the destination port information to a server using
13592 an HTTP header.
13593
Willy Tarreau60ca10a2017-08-18 15:26:54 +020013594fc_http_major : integer
13595 Reports the front connection's HTTP major version encoding, which may be 1
13596 for HTTP/0.9 to HTTP/1.1 or 2 for HTTP/2. Note, this is based on the on-wire
13597 encoding and not on the version present in the request header.
13598
Emeric Brun4f603012017-01-05 15:11:44 +010013599fc_rcvd_proxy : boolean
13600 Returns true if the client initiated the connection with a PROXY protocol
13601 header.
13602
Thierry Fournier / OZON.IO6310bef2016-07-24 20:16:50 +020013603fc_rtt(<unit>) : integer
13604 Returns the Round Trip Time (RTT) measured by the kernel for the client
13605 connection. <unit> is facultative, by default the unit is milliseconds. <unit>
13606 can be set to "ms" for milliseconds or "us" for microseconds. If the server
13607 connection is not established, if the connection is not TCP or if the
13608 operating system does not support TCP_INFO, for example Linux kernels before
13609 2.4, the sample fetch fails.
13610
13611fc_rttvar(<unit>) : integer
13612 Returns the Round Trip Time (RTT) variance measured by the kernel for the
13613 client connection. <unit> is facultative, by default the unit is milliseconds.
13614 <unit> can be set to "ms" for milliseconds or "us" for microseconds. If the
13615 server connection is not established, if the connection is not TCP or if the
13616 operating system does not support TCP_INFO, for example Linux kernels before
13617 2.4, the sample fetch fails.
13618
Joe Williams30fcd392016-08-10 07:06:44 -070013619fc_unacked(<unit>) : integer
13620 Returns the unacked counter measured by the kernel for the client connection.
13621 If the server connection is not established, if the connection is not TCP or
13622 if the operating system does not support TCP_INFO, for example Linux kernels
13623 before 2.4, the sample fetch fails.
13624
13625fc_sacked(<unit>) : integer
13626 Returns the sacked counter measured by the kernel for the client connection.
13627 If the server connection is not established, if the connection is not TCP or
13628 if the operating system does not support TCP_INFO, for example Linux kernels
13629 before 2.4, the sample fetch fails.
13630
13631fc_retrans(<unit>) : integer
13632 Returns the retransmits counter measured by the kernel for the client
13633 connection. If the server connection is not established, if the connection is
13634 not TCP or if the operating system does not support TCP_INFO, for example
13635 Linux kernels before 2.4, the sample fetch fails.
13636
13637fc_fackets(<unit>) : integer
13638 Returns the fack counter measured by the kernel for the client
13639 connection. If the server connection is not established, if the connection is
13640 not TCP or if the operating system does not support TCP_INFO, for example
13641 Linux kernels before 2.4, the sample fetch fails.
13642
13643fc_lost(<unit>) : integer
13644 Returns the lost counter measured by the kernel for the client
13645 connection. If the server connection is not established, if the connection is
13646 not TCP or if the operating system does not support TCP_INFO, for example
13647 Linux kernels before 2.4, the sample fetch fails.
13648
13649fc_reordering(<unit>) : integer
13650 Returns the reordering counter measured by the kernel for the client
13651 connection. If the server connection is not established, if the connection is
13652 not TCP or if the operating system does not support TCP_INFO, for example
13653 Linux kernels before 2.4, the sample fetch fails.
13654
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013655fe_id : integer
13656 Returns an integer containing the current frontend's id. It can be used in
Marcin Deranek6e413ed2016-12-13 12:40:01 +010013657 backends to check from which frontend it was called, or to stick all users
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013658 coming via a same frontend to the same server.
13659
Marcin Deranekd2471c22016-12-12 14:08:05 +010013660fe_name : string
13661 Returns a string containing the current frontend's name. It can be used in
13662 backends to check from which frontend it was called, or to stick all users
13663 coming via a same frontend to the same server.
13664
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020013665sc_bytes_in_rate(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020013666sc0_bytes_in_rate([<table>]) : integer
13667sc1_bytes_in_rate([<table>]) : integer
13668sc2_bytes_in_rate([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020013669 Returns the average client-to-server bytes rate from the currently tracked
13670 counters, measured in amount of bytes over the period configured in the
13671 table. See also src_bytes_in_rate.
13672
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020013673sc_bytes_out_rate(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020013674sc0_bytes_out_rate([<table>]) : integer
13675sc1_bytes_out_rate([<table>]) : integer
13676sc2_bytes_out_rate([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020013677 Returns the average server-to-client bytes rate from the currently tracked
13678 counters, measured in amount of bytes over the period configured in the
13679 table. See also src_bytes_out_rate.
13680
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020013681sc_clr_gpc0(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020013682sc0_clr_gpc0([<table>]) : integer
13683sc1_clr_gpc0([<table>]) : integer
13684sc2_clr_gpc0([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreauf73cd112011-08-13 01:45:16 +020013685 Clears the first General Purpose Counter associated to the currently tracked
13686 counters, and returns its previous value. Before the first invocation, the
Willy Tarreau869948b2013-01-04 14:14:57 +010013687 stored value is zero, so first invocation will always return zero. This is
13688 typically used as a second ACL in an expression in order to mark a connection
13689 when a first ACL was verified :
Willy Tarreauf73cd112011-08-13 01:45:16 +020013690
Jarno Huuskonen676f6222017-03-30 09:19:45 +030013691 Example:
Willy Tarreauf73cd112011-08-13 01:45:16 +020013692 # block if 5 consecutive requests continue to come faster than 10 sess
13693 # per second, and reset the counter as soon as the traffic slows down.
Willy Tarreaube4a3ef2013-06-17 15:04:07 +020013694 acl abuse sc0_http_req_rate gt 10
13695 acl kill sc0_inc_gpc0 gt 5
13696 acl save sc0_clr_gpc0 ge 0
Willy Tarreauf73cd112011-08-13 01:45:16 +020013697 tcp-request connection accept if !abuse save
13698 tcp-request connection reject if abuse kill
13699
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020013700sc_conn_cnt(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020013701sc0_conn_cnt([<table>]) : integer
13702sc1_conn_cnt([<table>]) : integer
13703sc2_conn_cnt([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020013704 Returns the cumulated number of incoming connections from currently tracked
13705 counters. See also src_conn_cnt.
13706
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020013707sc_conn_cur(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020013708sc0_conn_cur([<table>]) : integer
13709sc1_conn_cur([<table>]) : integer
13710sc2_conn_cur([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020013711 Returns the current amount of concurrent connections tracking the same
13712 tracked counters. This number is automatically incremented when tracking
13713 begins and decremented when tracking stops. See also src_conn_cur.
13714
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020013715sc_conn_rate(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020013716sc0_conn_rate([<table>]) : integer
13717sc1_conn_rate([<table>]) : integer
13718sc2_conn_rate([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020013719 Returns the average connection rate from the currently tracked counters,
13720 measured in amount of connections over the period configured in the table.
13721 See also src_conn_rate.
13722
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020013723sc_get_gpc0(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020013724sc0_get_gpc0([<table>]) : integer
13725sc1_get_gpc0([<table>]) : integer
13726sc2_get_gpc0([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020013727 Returns the value of the first General Purpose Counter associated to the
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +020013728 currently tracked counters. See also src_get_gpc0 and sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_inc_gpc0.
Willy Tarreauba2ffd12013-05-29 15:54:14 +020013729
Thierry FOURNIER236657b2015-08-19 08:25:14 +020013730sc_get_gpt0(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
13731sc0_get_gpt0([<table>]) : integer
13732sc1_get_gpt0([<table>]) : integer
13733sc2_get_gpt0([<table>]) : integer
13734 Returns the value of the first General Purpose Tag associated to the
13735 currently tracked counters. See also src_get_gpt0.
13736
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020013737sc_gpc0_rate(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020013738sc0_gpc0_rate([<table>]) : integer
13739sc1_gpc0_rate([<table>]) : integer
13740sc2_gpc0_rate([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreauba2ffd12013-05-29 15:54:14 +020013741 Returns the average increment rate of the first General Purpose Counter
13742 associated to the currently tracked counters. It reports the frequency
13743 which the gpc0 counter was incremented over the configured period. See also
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +020013744 src_gpc0_rate, sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_get_gpc0, and sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_inc_gpc0. Note
13745 that the "gpc0_rate" counter must be stored in the stick-table for a value to
13746 be returned, as "gpc0" only holds the event count.
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020013747
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020013748sc_http_err_cnt(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020013749sc0_http_err_cnt([<table>]) : integer
13750sc1_http_err_cnt([<table>]) : integer
13751sc2_http_err_cnt([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020013752 Returns the cumulated number of HTTP errors from the currently tracked
13753 counters. This includes the both request errors and 4xx error responses.
13754 See also src_http_err_cnt.
13755
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020013756sc_http_err_rate(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020013757sc0_http_err_rate([<table>]) : integer
13758sc1_http_err_rate([<table>]) : integer
13759sc2_http_err_rate([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020013760 Returns the average rate of HTTP errors from the currently tracked counters,
13761 measured in amount of errors over the period configured in the table. This
13762 includes the both request errors and 4xx error responses. See also
13763 src_http_err_rate.
13764
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020013765sc_http_req_cnt(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020013766sc0_http_req_cnt([<table>]) : integer
13767sc1_http_req_cnt([<table>]) : integer
13768sc2_http_req_cnt([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020013769 Returns the cumulated number of HTTP requests from the currently tracked
13770 counters. This includes every started request, valid or not. See also
13771 src_http_req_cnt.
13772
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020013773sc_http_req_rate(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020013774sc0_http_req_rate([<table>]) : integer
13775sc1_http_req_rate([<table>]) : integer
13776sc2_http_req_rate([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020013777 Returns the average rate of HTTP requests from the currently tracked
13778 counters, measured in amount of requests over the period configured in
13779 the table. This includes every started request, valid or not. See also
13780 src_http_req_rate.
13781
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020013782sc_inc_gpc0(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020013783sc0_inc_gpc0([<table>]) : integer
13784sc1_inc_gpc0([<table>]) : integer
13785sc2_inc_gpc0([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020013786 Increments the first General Purpose Counter associated to the currently
Willy Tarreau869948b2013-01-04 14:14:57 +010013787 tracked counters, and returns its new value. Before the first invocation,
13788 the stored value is zero, so first invocation will increase it to 1 and will
13789 return 1. This is typically used as a second ACL in an expression in order
13790 to mark a connection when a first ACL was verified :
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020013791
Jarno Huuskonen676f6222017-03-30 09:19:45 +030013792 Example:
Willy Tarreaube4a3ef2013-06-17 15:04:07 +020013793 acl abuse sc0_http_req_rate gt 10
13794 acl kill sc0_inc_gpc0 gt 0
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020013795 tcp-request connection reject if abuse kill
13796
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020013797sc_kbytes_in(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020013798sc0_kbytes_in([<table>]) : integer
13799sc1_kbytes_in([<table>]) : integer
13800sc2_kbytes_in([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaua01b9742014-07-10 15:29:24 +020013801 Returns the total amount of client-to-server data from the currently tracked
13802 counters, measured in kilobytes. The test is currently performed on 32-bit
13803 integers, which limits values to 4 terabytes. See also src_kbytes_in.
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020013804
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020013805sc_kbytes_out(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020013806sc0_kbytes_out([<table>]) : integer
13807sc1_kbytes_out([<table>]) : integer
13808sc2_kbytes_out([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaua01b9742014-07-10 15:29:24 +020013809 Returns the total amount of server-to-client data from the currently tracked
13810 counters, measured in kilobytes. The test is currently performed on 32-bit
13811 integers, which limits values to 4 terabytes. See also src_kbytes_out.
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020013812
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020013813sc_sess_cnt(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020013814sc0_sess_cnt([<table>]) : integer
13815sc1_sess_cnt([<table>]) : integer
13816sc2_sess_cnt([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020013817 Returns the cumulated number of incoming connections that were transformed
13818 into sessions, which means that they were accepted by a "tcp-request
13819 connection" rule, from the currently tracked counters. A backend may count
13820 more sessions than connections because each connection could result in many
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -040013821 backend sessions if some HTTP keep-alive is performed over the connection
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020013822 with the client. See also src_sess_cnt.
13823
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020013824sc_sess_rate(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020013825sc0_sess_rate([<table>]) : integer
13826sc1_sess_rate([<table>]) : integer
13827sc2_sess_rate([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020013828 Returns the average session rate from the currently tracked counters,
13829 measured in amount of sessions over the period configured in the table. A
13830 session is a connection that got past the early "tcp-request connection"
13831 rules. A backend may count more sessions than connections because each
13832 connection could result in many backend sessions if some HTTP keep-alive is
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -040013833 performed over the connection with the client. See also src_sess_rate.
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020013834
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020013835sc_tracked(<ctr>[,<table>]) : boolean
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020013836sc0_tracked([<table>]) : boolean
13837sc1_tracked([<table>]) : boolean
13838sc2_tracked([<table>]) : boolean
Willy Tarreau6f1615f2013-06-03 15:15:22 +020013839 Returns true if the designated session counter is currently being tracked by
13840 the current session. This can be useful when deciding whether or not we want
13841 to set some values in a header passed to the server.
13842
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020013843sc_trackers(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020013844sc0_trackers([<table>]) : integer
13845sc1_trackers([<table>]) : integer
13846sc2_trackers([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau2406db42012-12-09 12:16:43 +010013847 Returns the current amount of concurrent connections tracking the same
13848 tracked counters. This number is automatically incremented when tracking
Willy Tarreaube4a3ef2013-06-17 15:04:07 +020013849 begins and decremented when tracking stops. It differs from sc0_conn_cur in
Willy Tarreau2406db42012-12-09 12:16:43 +010013850 that it does not rely on any stored information but on the table's reference
13851 count (the "use" value which is returned by "show table" on the CLI). This
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013852 may sometimes be more suited for layer7 tracking. It can be used to tell a
13853 server how many concurrent connections there are from a given address for
13854 example.
Willy Tarreau2406db42012-12-09 12:16:43 +010013855
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013856so_id : integer
13857 Returns an integer containing the current listening socket's id. It is useful
13858 in frontends involving many "bind" lines, or to stick all users coming via a
13859 same socket to the same server.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010013860
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013861src : ip
13862 This is the source IPv4 address of the client of the session. It is of type
13863 IP and works on both IPv4 and IPv6 tables. On IPv6 tables, IPv4 addresses are
13864 mapped to their IPv6 equivalent, according to RFC 4291. Note that it is the
13865 TCP-level source address which is used, and not the address of a client
Bertrand Jacquin93b227d2016-06-04 15:11:10 +010013866 behind a proxy. However if the "accept-proxy" or "accept-netscaler-cip" bind
13867 directive is used, it can be the address of a client behind another
13868 PROXY-protocol compatible component for all rule sets except
13869 "tcp-request connection" which sees the real address.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010013870
Thierry FOURNIERd5f624d2013-11-26 11:52:33 +010013871 Example:
13872 # add an HTTP header in requests with the originating address' country
13873 http-request set-header X-Country %[src,map_ip(geoip.lst)]
13874
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013875src_bytes_in_rate([<table>]) : integer
13876 Returns the average bytes rate from the incoming connection's source address
13877 in the current proxy's stick-table or in the designated stick-table, measured
13878 in amount of bytes over the period configured in the table. If the address is
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +020013879 not found, zero is returned. See also sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_bytes_in_rate.
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020013880
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013881src_bytes_out_rate([<table>]) : integer
13882 Returns the average bytes rate to the incoming connection's source address in
13883 the current proxy's stick-table or in the designated stick-table, measured in
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020013884 amount of bytes over the period configured in the table. If the address is
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +020013885 not found, zero is returned. See also sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_bytes_out_rate.
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020013886
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013887src_clr_gpc0([<table>]) : integer
13888 Clears the first General Purpose Counter associated to the incoming
13889 connection's source address in the current proxy's stick-table or in the
13890 designated stick-table, and returns its previous value. If the address is not
13891 found, an entry is created and 0 is returned. This is typically used as a
13892 second ACL in an expression in order to mark a connection when a first ACL
13893 was verified :
Willy Tarreauf73cd112011-08-13 01:45:16 +020013894
Jarno Huuskonen676f6222017-03-30 09:19:45 +030013895 Example:
Willy Tarreauf73cd112011-08-13 01:45:16 +020013896 # block if 5 consecutive requests continue to come faster than 10 sess
13897 # per second, and reset the counter as soon as the traffic slows down.
13898 acl abuse src_http_req_rate gt 10
13899 acl kill src_inc_gpc0 gt 5
Willy Tarreau869948b2013-01-04 14:14:57 +010013900 acl save src_clr_gpc0 ge 0
Willy Tarreauf73cd112011-08-13 01:45:16 +020013901 tcp-request connection accept if !abuse save
13902 tcp-request connection reject if abuse kill
13903
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013904src_conn_cnt([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020013905 Returns the cumulated number of connections initiated from the current
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013906 incoming connection's source address in the current proxy's stick-table or in
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020013907 the designated stick-table. If the address is not found, zero is returned.
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +020013908 See also sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_conn_cnt.
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020013909
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013910src_conn_cur([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020013911 Returns the current amount of concurrent connections initiated from the
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013912 current incoming connection's source address in the current proxy's
13913 stick-table or in the designated stick-table. If the address is not found,
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +020013914 zero is returned. See also sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_conn_cur.
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020013915
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013916src_conn_rate([<table>]) : integer
13917 Returns the average connection rate from the incoming connection's source
13918 address in the current proxy's stick-table or in the designated stick-table,
13919 measured in amount of connections over the period configured in the table. If
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +020013920 the address is not found, zero is returned. See also sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_conn_rate.
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020013921
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013922src_get_gpc0([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020013923 Returns the value of the first General Purpose Counter associated to the
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013924 incoming connection's source address in the current proxy's stick-table or in
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020013925 the designated stick-table. If the address is not found, zero is returned.
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +020013926 See also sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_get_gpc0 and src_inc_gpc0.
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020013927
Thierry FOURNIER236657b2015-08-19 08:25:14 +020013928src_get_gpt0([<table>]) : integer
13929 Returns the value of the first General Purpose Tag associated to the
13930 incoming connection's source address in the current proxy's stick-table or in
13931 the designated stick-table. If the address is not found, zero is returned.
13932 See also sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_get_gpt0.
13933
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013934src_gpc0_rate([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreauba2ffd12013-05-29 15:54:14 +020013935 Returns the average increment rate of the first General Purpose Counter
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013936 associated to the incoming connection's source address in the current proxy's
Willy Tarreauba2ffd12013-05-29 15:54:14 +020013937 stick-table or in the designated stick-table. It reports the frequency
13938 which the gpc0 counter was incremented over the configured period. See also
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +020013939 sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_gpc0_rate, src_get_gpc0, and sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_inc_gpc0. Note
13940 that the "gpc0_rate" counter must be stored in the stick-table for a value to
13941 be returned, as "gpc0" only holds the event count.
Willy Tarreauba2ffd12013-05-29 15:54:14 +020013942
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013943src_http_err_cnt([<table>]) : integer
13944 Returns the cumulated number of HTTP errors from the incoming connection's
13945 source address in the current proxy's stick-table or in the designated
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020013946 stick-table. This includes the both request errors and 4xx error responses.
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +020013947 See also sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_http_err_cnt. If the address is not found, zero is
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013948 returned.
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020013949
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013950src_http_err_rate([<table>]) : integer
13951 Returns the average rate of HTTP errors from the incoming connection's source
13952 address in the current proxy's stick-table or in the designated stick-table,
13953 measured in amount of errors over the period configured in the table. This
13954 includes the both request errors and 4xx error responses. If the address is
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +020013955 not found, zero is returned. See also sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_http_err_rate.
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020013956
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013957src_http_req_cnt([<table>]) : integer
13958 Returns the cumulated number of HTTP requests from the incoming connection's
13959 source address in the current proxy's stick-table or in the designated stick-
13960 table. This includes every started request, valid or not. If the address is
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +020013961 not found, zero is returned. See also sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_http_req_cnt.
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020013962
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013963src_http_req_rate([<table>]) : integer
13964 Returns the average rate of HTTP requests from the incoming connection's
13965 source address in the current proxy's stick-table or in the designated stick-
13966 table, measured in amount of requests over the period configured in the
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020013967 table. This includes every started request, valid or not. If the address is
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +020013968 not found, zero is returned. See also sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_http_req_rate.
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020013969
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013970src_inc_gpc0([<table>]) : integer
13971 Increments the first General Purpose Counter associated to the incoming
13972 connection's source address in the current proxy's stick-table or in the
13973 designated stick-table, and returns its new value. If the address is not
Willy Tarreaube4a3ef2013-06-17 15:04:07 +020013974 found, an entry is created and 1 is returned. See also sc0/sc2/sc2_inc_gpc0.
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013975 This is typically used as a second ACL in an expression in order to mark a
13976 connection when a first ACL was verified :
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020013977
Jarno Huuskonen676f6222017-03-30 09:19:45 +030013978 Example:
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020013979 acl abuse src_http_req_rate gt 10
Willy Tarreau869948b2013-01-04 14:14:57 +010013980 acl kill src_inc_gpc0 gt 0
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020013981 tcp-request connection reject if abuse kill
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020013982
Willy Tarreau16e01562016-08-09 16:46:18 +020013983src_is_local : boolean
13984 Returns true if the source address of the incoming connection is local to the
13985 system, or false if the address doesn't exist on the system, meaning that it
13986 comes from a remote machine. Note that UNIX addresses are considered local.
13987 It can be useful to apply certain access restrictions based on where the
13988 client comes from (eg: require auth or https for remote machines). Please
13989 note that the check involves a few system calls, so it's better to do it only
13990 once per connection.
13991
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013992src_kbytes_in([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaua01b9742014-07-10 15:29:24 +020013993 Returns the total amount of data received from the incoming connection's
13994 source address in the current proxy's stick-table or in the designated
13995 stick-table, measured in kilobytes. If the address is not found, zero is
13996 returned. The test is currently performed on 32-bit integers, which limits
13997 values to 4 terabytes. See also sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_kbytes_in.
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020013998
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013999src_kbytes_out([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaua01b9742014-07-10 15:29:24 +020014000 Returns the total amount of data sent to the incoming connection's source
14001 address in the current proxy's stick-table or in the designated stick-table,
14002 measured in kilobytes. If the address is not found, zero is returned. The
14003 test is currently performed on 32-bit integers, which limits values to 4
14004 terabytes. See also sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_kbytes_out.
Willy Tarreaua975b8f2010-06-05 19:13:27 +020014005
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014006src_port : integer
14007 Returns an integer value corresponding to the TCP source port of the
14008 connection on the client side, which is the port the client connected from.
14009 Usage of this function is very limited as modern protocols do not care much
14010 about source ports nowadays.
Willy Tarreau079ff0a2009-03-05 21:34:28 +010014011
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014012src_sess_cnt([<table>]) : integer
14013 Returns the cumulated number of connections initiated from the incoming
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020014014 connection's source IPv4 address in the current proxy's stick-table or in the
14015 designated stick-table, that were transformed into sessions, which means that
14016 they were accepted by "tcp-request" rules. If the address is not found, zero
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +020014017 is returned. See also sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_sess_cnt.
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020014018
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014019src_sess_rate([<table>]) : integer
14020 Returns the average session rate from the incoming connection's source
14021 address in the current proxy's stick-table or in the designated stick-table,
14022 measured in amount of sessions over the period configured in the table. A
14023 session is a connection that went past the early "tcp-request" rules. If the
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +020014024 address is not found, zero is returned. See also sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_sess_rate.
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020014025
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014026src_updt_conn_cnt([<table>]) : integer
14027 Creates or updates the entry associated to the incoming connection's source
14028 address in the current proxy's stick-table or in the designated stick-table.
14029 This table must be configured to store the "conn_cnt" data type, otherwise
14030 the match will be ignored. The current count is incremented by one, and the
14031 expiration timer refreshed. The updated count is returned, so this match
14032 can't return zero. This was used to reject service abusers based on their
14033 source address. Note: it is recommended to use the more complete "track-sc*"
14034 actions in "tcp-request" rules instead.
Willy Tarreaua975b8f2010-06-05 19:13:27 +020014035
14036 Example :
14037 # This frontend limits incoming SSH connections to 3 per 10 second for
14038 # each source address, and rejects excess connections until a 10 second
14039 # silence is observed. At most 20 addresses are tracked.
14040 listen ssh
14041 bind :22
14042 mode tcp
14043 maxconn 100
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020014044 stick-table type ip size 20 expire 10s store conn_cnt
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014045 tcp-request content reject if { src_updt_conn_cnt gt 3 }
Willy Tarreaua975b8f2010-06-05 19:13:27 +020014046 server local 127.0.0.1:22
14047
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014048srv_id : integer
14049 Returns an integer containing the server's id when processing the response.
14050 While it's almost only used with ACLs, it may be used for logging or
14051 debugging.
Hervé COMMOWICKdaa824e2011-08-05 12:09:44 +020014052
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +0200140537.3.4. Fetching samples at Layer 5
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014054----------------------------------
Willy Tarreau0b1cd942010-05-16 22:18:27 +020014055
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014056The layer 5 usually describes just the session layer which in haproxy is
14057closest to the session once all the connection handshakes are finished, but
14058when no content is yet made available. The fetch methods described here are
14059usable as low as the "tcp-request content" rule sets unless they require some
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030014060future information. Those generally include the results of SSL negotiations.
Willy Tarreauc735a072011-03-29 00:57:02 +020014061
Ben Shillitof25e8e52016-12-02 14:25:37 +00001406251d.all(<prop>[,<prop>*]) : string
14063 Returns values for the properties requested as a string, where values are
14064 separated by the delimiter specified with "51degrees-property-separator".
14065 The device is identified using all the important HTTP headers from the
14066 request. The function can be passed up to five property names, and if a
14067 property name can't be found, the value "NoData" is returned.
14068
14069 Example :
14070 # Here the header "X-51D-DeviceTypeMobileTablet" is added to the request
14071 # containing the three properties requested using all relevant headers from
14072 # the request.
14073 frontend http-in
14074 bind *:8081
14075 default_backend servers
14076 http-request set-header X-51D-DeviceTypeMobileTablet \
14077 %[51d.all(DeviceType,IsMobile,IsTablet)]
14078
Emeric Brun645ae792014-04-30 14:21:06 +020014079ssl_bc : boolean
14080 Returns true when the back connection was made via an SSL/TLS transport
14081 layer and is locally deciphered. This means the outgoing connection was made
14082 other a server with the "ssl" option.
14083
14084ssl_bc_alg_keysize : integer
14085 Returns the symmetric cipher key size supported in bits when the outgoing
14086 connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer.
14087
14088ssl_bc_cipher : string
14089 Returns the name of the used cipher when the outgoing connection was made
14090 over an SSL/TLS transport layer.
14091
14092ssl_bc_protocol : string
14093 Returns the name of the used protocol when the outgoing connection was made
14094 over an SSL/TLS transport layer.
14095
Emeric Brunb73a9b02014-04-30 18:49:19 +020014096ssl_bc_unique_id : binary
Emeric Brun645ae792014-04-30 14:21:06 +020014097 When the outgoing connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer,
Emeric Brunb73a9b02014-04-30 18:49:19 +020014098 returns the TLS unique ID as defined in RFC5929 section 3. The unique id
14099 can be encoded to base64 using the converter: "ssl_bc_unique_id,base64".
Emeric Brun645ae792014-04-30 14:21:06 +020014100
14101ssl_bc_session_id : binary
14102 Returns the SSL ID of the back connection when the outgoing connection was
14103 made over an SSL/TLS transport layer. It is useful to log if we want to know
14104 if session was reused or not.
14105
14106ssl_bc_use_keysize : integer
14107 Returns the symmetric cipher key size used in bits when the outgoing
14108 connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer.
14109
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014110ssl_c_ca_err : integer
14111 When the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer,
14112 returns the ID of the first error detected during verification of the client
14113 certificate at depth > 0, or 0 if no error was encountered during this
14114 verification process. Please refer to your SSL library's documentation to
14115 find the exhaustive list of error codes.
Willy Tarreauc735a072011-03-29 00:57:02 +020014116
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014117ssl_c_ca_err_depth : integer
14118 When the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer,
14119 returns the depth in the CA chain of the first error detected during the
14120 verification of the client certificate. If no error is encountered, 0 is
14121 returned.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010014122
Emeric Brun43e79582014-10-29 19:03:26 +010014123ssl_c_der : binary
14124 Returns the DER formatted certificate presented by the client when the
14125 incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer. When used for
14126 an ACL, the value(s) to match against can be passed in hexadecimal form.
14127
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014128ssl_c_err : integer
14129 When the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer,
14130 returns the ID of the first error detected during verification at depth 0, or
14131 0 if no error was encountered during this verification process. Please refer
14132 to your SSL library's documentation to find the exhaustive list of error
14133 codes.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020014134
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014135ssl_c_i_dn([<entry>[,<occ>]]) : string
14136 When the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer,
14137 returns the full distinguished name of the issuer of the certificate
14138 presented by the client when no <entry> is specified, or the value of the
14139 first given entry found from the beginning of the DN. If a positive/negative
14140 occurrence number is specified as the optional second argument, it returns
14141 the value of the nth given entry value from the beginning/end of the DN.
14142 For instance, "ssl_c_i_dn(OU,2)" the second organization unit, and
14143 "ssl_c_i_dn(CN)" retrieves the common name.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020014144
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014145ssl_c_key_alg : string
14146 Returns the name of the algorithm used to generate the key of the certificate
14147 presented by the client when the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS
14148 transport layer.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020014149
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014150ssl_c_notafter : string
14151 Returns the end date presented by the client as a formatted string
14152 YYMMDDhhmmss[Z] when the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS
14153 transport layer.
Emeric Brunbede3d02009-06-30 17:54:00 +020014154
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014155ssl_c_notbefore : string
14156 Returns the start date presented by the client as a formatted string
14157 YYMMDDhhmmss[Z] when the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS
14158 transport layer.
Willy Tarreaub6672b52011-12-12 17:23:41 +010014159
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014160ssl_c_s_dn([<entry>[,<occ>]]) : string
14161 When the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer,
14162 returns the full distinguished name of the subject of the certificate
14163 presented by the client when no <entry> is specified, or the value of the
14164 first given entry found from the beginning of the DN. If a positive/negative
14165 occurrence number is specified as the optional second argument, it returns
14166 the value of the nth given entry value from the beginning/end of the DN.
14167 For instance, "ssl_c_s_dn(OU,2)" the second organization unit, and
14168 "ssl_c_s_dn(CN)" retrieves the common name.
Willy Tarreaub6672b52011-12-12 17:23:41 +010014169
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014170ssl_c_serial : binary
14171 Returns the serial of the certificate presented by the client when the
14172 incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer. When used for
14173 an ACL, the value(s) to match against can be passed in hexadecimal form.
Emeric Brun2525b6b2012-10-18 15:59:43 +020014174
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014175ssl_c_sha1 : binary
14176 Returns the SHA-1 fingerprint of the certificate presented by the client when
14177 the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer. This can be
14178 used to stick a client to a server, or to pass this information to a server.
Willy Tarreau2d0caa32014-07-02 19:01:22 +020014179 Note that the output is binary, so if you want to pass that signature to the
14180 server, you need to encode it in hex or base64, such as in the example below:
14181
Jarno Huuskonen676f6222017-03-30 09:19:45 +030014182 Example:
Willy Tarreau2d0caa32014-07-02 19:01:22 +020014183 http-request set-header X-SSL-Client-SHA1 %[ssl_c_sha1,hex]
Emeric Brun2525b6b2012-10-18 15:59:43 +020014184
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014185ssl_c_sig_alg : string
14186 Returns the name of the algorithm used to sign the certificate presented by
14187 the client when the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport
14188 layer.
Emeric Brun87855892012-10-17 17:39:35 +020014189
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014190ssl_c_used : boolean
14191 Returns true if current SSL session uses a client certificate even if current
14192 connection uses SSL session resumption. See also "ssl_fc_has_crt".
Emeric Brun7f56e742012-10-19 18:15:40 +020014193
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014194ssl_c_verify : integer
14195 Returns the verify result error ID when the incoming connection was made over
14196 an SSL/TLS transport layer, otherwise zero if no error is encountered. Please
14197 refer to your SSL library's documentation for an exhaustive list of error
14198 codes.
Emeric Brunce5ad802012-10-22 14:11:22 +020014199
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014200ssl_c_version : integer
14201 Returns the version of the certificate presented by the client when the
14202 incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer.
Emeric Brunce5ad802012-10-22 14:11:22 +020014203
Emeric Brun43e79582014-10-29 19:03:26 +010014204ssl_f_der : binary
14205 Returns the DER formatted certificate presented by the frontend when the
14206 incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer. When used for
14207 an ACL, the value(s) to match against can be passed in hexadecimal form.
14208
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014209ssl_f_i_dn([<entry>[,<occ>]]) : string
14210 When the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer,
14211 returns the full distinguished name of the issuer of the certificate
14212 presented by the frontend when no <entry> is specified, or the value of the
14213 first given entry found from the beginning of the DN. If a positive/negative
Emeric Brun87855892012-10-17 17:39:35 +020014214 occurrence number is specified as the optional second argument, it returns
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014215 the value of the nth given entry value from the beginning/end of the DN.
14216 For instance, "ssl_f_i_dn(OU,2)" the second organization unit, and
14217 "ssl_f_i_dn(CN)" retrieves the common name.
Emeric Brun87855892012-10-17 17:39:35 +020014218
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014219ssl_f_key_alg : string
14220 Returns the name of the algorithm used to generate the key of the certificate
14221 presented by the frontend when the incoming connection was made over an
14222 SSL/TLS transport layer.
Emeric Brun7f56e742012-10-19 18:15:40 +020014223
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014224ssl_f_notafter : string
14225 Returns the end date presented by the frontend as a formatted string
14226 YYMMDDhhmmss[Z] when the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS
14227 transport layer.
Emeric Brun2525b6b2012-10-18 15:59:43 +020014228
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014229ssl_f_notbefore : string
14230 Returns the start date presented by the frontend as a formatted string
14231 YYMMDDhhmmss[Z] when the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS
14232 transport layer.
Emeric Brun87855892012-10-17 17:39:35 +020014233
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014234ssl_f_s_dn([<entry>[,<occ>]]) : string
14235 When the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer,
14236 returns the full distinguished name of the subject of the certificate
14237 presented by the frontend when no <entry> is specified, or the value of the
14238 first given entry found from the beginning of the DN. If a positive/negative
14239 occurrence number is specified as the optional second argument, it returns
14240 the value of the nth given entry value from the beginning/end of the DN.
14241 For instance, "ssl_f_s_dn(OU,2)" the second organization unit, and
14242 "ssl_f_s_dn(CN)" retrieves the common name.
Emeric Brunce5ad802012-10-22 14:11:22 +020014243
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014244ssl_f_serial : binary
14245 Returns the serial of the certificate presented by the frontend when the
14246 incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer. When used for
14247 an ACL, the value(s) to match against can be passed in hexadecimal form.
Emeric Brun87855892012-10-17 17:39:35 +020014248
Emeric Brun55f4fa82014-04-30 17:11:25 +020014249ssl_f_sha1 : binary
14250 Returns the SHA-1 fingerprint of the certificate presented by the frontend
14251 when the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer. This
14252 can be used to know which certificate was chosen using SNI.
14253
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014254ssl_f_sig_alg : string
14255 Returns the name of the algorithm used to sign the certificate presented by
14256 the frontend when the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport
14257 layer.
Emeric Brun7f56e742012-10-19 18:15:40 +020014258
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014259ssl_f_version : integer
14260 Returns the version of the certificate presented by the frontend when the
14261 incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer.
14262
14263ssl_fc : boolean
Emeric Brun2525b6b2012-10-18 15:59:43 +020014264 Returns true when the front connection was made via an SSL/TLS transport
14265 layer and is locally deciphered. This means it has matched a socket declared
14266 with a "bind" line having the "ssl" option.
14267
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014268 Example :
14269 # This passes "X-Proto: https" to servers when client connects over SSL
14270 listen http-https
14271 bind :80
14272 bind :443 ssl crt /etc/haproxy.pem
14273 http-request add-header X-Proto https if { ssl_fc }
14274
14275ssl_fc_alg_keysize : integer
14276 Returns the symmetric cipher key size supported in bits when the incoming
14277 connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer.
14278
14279ssl_fc_alpn : string
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030014280 This extracts the Application Layer Protocol Negotiation field from an
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014281 incoming connection made via a TLS transport layer and locally deciphered by
14282 haproxy. The result is a string containing the protocol name advertised by
14283 the client. The SSL library must have been built with support for TLS
14284 extensions enabled (check haproxy -vv). Note that the TLS ALPN extension is
14285 not advertised unless the "alpn" keyword on the "bind" line specifies a
14286 protocol list. Also, nothing forces the client to pick a protocol from this
14287 list, any other one may be requested. The TLS ALPN extension is meant to
14288 replace the TLS NPN extension. See also "ssl_fc_npn".
14289
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014290ssl_fc_cipher : string
14291 Returns the name of the used cipher when the incoming connection was made
14292 over an SSL/TLS transport layer.
Willy Tarreauab861d32013-04-02 02:30:41 +020014293
Thierry FOURNIER5bf77322017-02-25 12:45:22 +010014294ssl_fc_cipherlist_bin : binary
14295 Returns the binary form of the client hello cipher list. The maximum returned
14296 value length is according with the value of
Emmanuel Hocdetaaee7502017-03-07 18:34:58 +010014297 "tune.ssl.capture-cipherlist-size".
Thierry FOURNIER5bf77322017-02-25 12:45:22 +010014298
14299ssl_fc_cipherlist_hex : string
14300 Returns the binary form of the client hello cipher list encoded as
14301 hexadecimal. The maximum returned value length is according with the value of
Emmanuel Hocdetaaee7502017-03-07 18:34:58 +010014302 "tune.ssl.capture-cipherlist-size".
Thierry FOURNIER5bf77322017-02-25 12:45:22 +010014303
14304ssl_fc_cipherlist_str : string
14305 Returns the decoded text form of the client hello cipher list. The maximum
14306 number of ciphers returned is according with the value of
14307 "tune.ssl.capture-cipherlist-size". Note that this sample-fetch is only
Emmanuel Hocdetddcde192017-09-01 17:32:08 +020014308 avaible with OpenSSL >= 1.0.2. If the function is not enabled, this
14309 sample-fetch returns the hash like "ssl_fc_cipherlist_xxh".
Thierry FOURNIER5bf77322017-02-25 12:45:22 +010014310
14311ssl_fc_cipherlist_xxh : integer
14312 Returns a xxh64 of the cipher list. This hash can be return only is the value
14313 "tune.ssl.capture-cipherlist-size" is set greater than 0, however the hash
Emmanuel Hocdetaaee7502017-03-07 18:34:58 +010014314 take in account all the data of the cipher list.
Thierry FOURNIER5bf77322017-02-25 12:45:22 +010014315
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014316ssl_fc_has_crt : boolean
Emeric Brun2525b6b2012-10-18 15:59:43 +020014317 Returns true if a client certificate is present in an incoming connection over
14318 SSL/TLS transport layer. Useful if 'verify' statement is set to 'optional'.
Emeric Brun9143d372012-12-20 15:44:16 +010014319 Note: on SSL session resumption with Session ID or TLS ticket, client
14320 certificate is not present in the current connection but may be retrieved
14321 from the cache or the ticket. So prefer "ssl_c_used" if you want to check if
14322 current SSL session uses a client certificate.
Emeric Brun2525b6b2012-10-18 15:59:43 +020014323
Olivier Houchardccaa7de2017-10-02 11:51:03 +020014324ssl_fc_has_early : boolean
14325 Returns true if early data were sent, and the handshake didn't happen yet. As
14326 it has security implications, it is useful to be able to refuse those, or
14327 wait until the handshake happened.
14328
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014329ssl_fc_has_sni : boolean
14330 This checks for the presence of a Server Name Indication TLS extension (SNI)
Willy Tarreauf7bc57c2012-10-03 00:19:48 +020014331 in an incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer. Returns
14332 true when the incoming connection presents a TLS SNI field. This requires
14333 that the SSL library is build with support for TLS extensions enabled (check
14334 haproxy -vv).
Willy Tarreau7875d092012-09-10 08:20:03 +020014335
Nenad Merdanovic1516fe32016-05-17 03:31:21 +020014336ssl_fc_is_resumed : boolean
Nenad Merdanovic26ea8222015-05-18 02:28:57 +020014337 Returns true if the SSL/TLS session has been resumed through the use of
14338 SSL session cache or TLS tickets.
14339
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014340ssl_fc_npn : string
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030014341 This extracts the Next Protocol Negotiation field from an incoming connection
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014342 made via a TLS transport layer and locally deciphered by haproxy. The result
14343 is a string containing the protocol name advertised by the client. The SSL
14344 library must have been built with support for TLS extensions enabled (check
14345 haproxy -vv). Note that the TLS NPN extension is not advertised unless the
14346 "npn" keyword on the "bind" line specifies a protocol list. Also, nothing
14347 forces the client to pick a protocol from this list, any other one may be
14348 requested. Please note that the TLS NPN extension was replaced with ALPN.
Willy Tarreaua33c6542012-10-15 13:19:06 +020014349
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014350ssl_fc_protocol : string
14351 Returns the name of the used protocol when the incoming connection was made
14352 over an SSL/TLS transport layer.
Willy Tarreau7875d092012-09-10 08:20:03 +020014353
Emeric Brunb73a9b02014-04-30 18:49:19 +020014354ssl_fc_unique_id : binary
David Sc1ad52e2014-04-08 18:48:47 -040014355 When the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer,
Emeric Brunb73a9b02014-04-30 18:49:19 +020014356 returns the TLS unique ID as defined in RFC5929 section 3. The unique id
14357 can be encoded to base64 using the converter: "ssl_bc_unique_id,base64".
David Sc1ad52e2014-04-08 18:48:47 -040014358
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014359ssl_fc_session_id : binary
14360 Returns the SSL ID of the front connection when the incoming connection was
14361 made over an SSL/TLS transport layer. It is useful to stick a given client to
14362 a server. It is important to note that some browsers refresh their session ID
14363 every few minutes.
Willy Tarreau7875d092012-09-10 08:20:03 +020014364
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014365ssl_fc_sni : string
14366 This extracts the Server Name Indication TLS extension (SNI) field from an
14367 incoming connection made via an SSL/TLS transport layer and locally
14368 deciphered by haproxy. The result (when present) typically is a string
14369 matching the HTTPS host name (253 chars or less). The SSL library must have
14370 been built with support for TLS extensions enabled (check haproxy -vv).
14371
14372 This fetch is different from "req_ssl_sni" above in that it applies to the
14373 connection being deciphered by haproxy and not to SSL contents being blindly
14374 forwarded. See also "ssl_fc_sni_end" and "ssl_fc_sni_reg" below. This
Cyril Bonté9c1eb1e2012-10-09 22:45:34 +020014375 requires that the SSL library is build with support for TLS extensions
14376 enabled (check haproxy -vv).
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020014377
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014378 ACL derivatives :
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014379 ssl_fc_sni_end : suffix match
14380 ssl_fc_sni_reg : regex match
Emeric Brun589fcad2012-10-16 14:13:26 +020014381
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014382ssl_fc_use_keysize : integer
14383 Returns the symmetric cipher key size used in bits when the incoming
14384 connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer.
Willy Tarreaub6fb4202008-07-20 11:18:28 +020014385
Willy Tarreaub6fb4202008-07-20 11:18:28 +020014386
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +0200143877.3.5. Fetching samples from buffer contents (Layer 6)
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014388------------------------------------------------------
Willy Tarreaub6fb4202008-07-20 11:18:28 +020014389
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014390Fetching samples from buffer contents is a bit different from the previous
14391sample fetches above because the sampled data are ephemeral. These data can
14392only be used when they're available and will be lost when they're forwarded.
14393For this reason, samples fetched from buffer contents during a request cannot
14394be used in a response for example. Even while the data are being fetched, they
14395can change. Sometimes it is necessary to set some delays or combine multiple
14396sample fetch methods to ensure that the expected data are complete and usable,
14397for example through TCP request content inspection. Please see the "tcp-request
14398content" keyword for more detailed information on the subject.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020014399
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014400payload(<offset>,<length>) : binary (deprecated)
14401 This is an alias for "req.payload" when used in the context of a request (eg:
14402 "stick on", "stick match"), and for "res.payload" when used in the context of
14403 a response such as in "stick store response".
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010014404
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014405payload_lv(<offset1>,<length>[,<offset2>]) : binary (deprecated)
14406 This is an alias for "req.payload_lv" when used in the context of a request
14407 (eg: "stick on", "stick match"), and for "res.payload_lv" when used in the
14408 context of a response such as in "stick store response".
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010014409
Thierry FOURNIERd7d88812017-04-19 15:15:14 +020014410req.hdrs : string
14411 Returns the current request headers as string including the last empty line
14412 separating headers from the request body. The last empty line can be used to
14413 detect a truncated header block. This sample fetch is useful for some SPOE
14414 headers analyzers and for advanced logging.
14415
Thierry FOURNIER5617dce2017-04-09 05:38:19 +020014416req.hdrs_bin : binary
14417 Returns the current request headers contained in preparsed binary form. This
14418 is useful for offloading some processing with SPOE. Each string is described
14419 by a length followed by the number of bytes indicated in the length. The
14420 length is represented using the variable integer encoding detailed in the
14421 SPOE documentation. The end of the list is marked by a couple of empty header
14422 names and values (length of 0 for both).
14423
14424 *(<str:header-name><str:header-value>)<empty string><empty string>
14425
14426 int: refer to the SPOE documentation for the encoding
14427 str: <int:length><bytes>
14428
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014429req.len : integer
14430req_len : integer (deprecated)
14431 Returns an integer value corresponding to the number of bytes present in the
14432 request buffer. This is mostly used in ACL. It is important to understand
14433 that this test does not return false as long as the buffer is changing. This
14434 means that a check with equality to zero will almost always immediately match
14435 at the beginning of the session, while a test for more data will wait for
14436 that data to come in and return false only when haproxy is certain that no
14437 more data will come in. This test was designed to be used with TCP request
14438 content inspection.
Willy Tarreaua7ad50c2012-04-29 15:39:40 +020014439
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014440req.payload(<offset>,<length>) : binary
14441 This extracts a binary block of <length> bytes and starting at byte <offset>
Willy Tarreau00f00842013-08-02 11:07:32 +020014442 in the request buffer. As a special case, if the <length> argument is zero,
14443 the the whole buffer from <offset> to the end is extracted. This can be used
14444 with ACLs in order to check for the presence of some content in a buffer at
14445 any location.
Willy Tarreaua7ad50c2012-04-29 15:39:40 +020014446
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014447 ACL alternatives :
14448 payload(<offset>,<length>) : hex binary match
Willy Tarreaua7ad50c2012-04-29 15:39:40 +020014449
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014450req.payload_lv(<offset1>,<length>[,<offset2>]) : binary
14451 This extracts a binary block whose size is specified at <offset1> for <length>
14452 bytes, and which starts at <offset2> if specified or just after the length in
14453 the request buffer. The <offset2> parameter also supports relative offsets if
14454 prepended with a '+' or '-' sign.
Willy Tarreaua7ad50c2012-04-29 15:39:40 +020014455
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014456 ACL alternatives :
14457 payload_lv(<offset1>,<length>[,<offset2>]) : hex binary match
Willy Tarreaua7ad50c2012-04-29 15:39:40 +020014458
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014459 Example : please consult the example from the "stick store-response" keyword.
Willy Tarreaua7ad50c2012-04-29 15:39:40 +020014460
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014461req.proto_http : boolean
14462req_proto_http : boolean (deprecated)
14463 Returns true when data in the request buffer look like HTTP and correctly
14464 parses as such. It is the same parser as the common HTTP request parser which
14465 is used so there should be no surprises. The test does not match until the
14466 request is complete, failed or timed out. This test may be used to report the
14467 protocol in TCP logs, but the biggest use is to block TCP request analysis
14468 until a complete HTTP request is present in the buffer, for example to track
14469 a header.
Willy Tarreaua7ad50c2012-04-29 15:39:40 +020014470
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014471 Example:
14472 # track request counts per "base" (concatenation of Host+URL)
14473 tcp-request inspect-delay 10s
14474 tcp-request content reject if !HTTP
Willy Tarreaube4a3ef2013-06-17 15:04:07 +020014475 tcp-request content track-sc0 base table req-rate
Willy Tarreaua7ad50c2012-04-29 15:39:40 +020014476
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014477req.rdp_cookie([<name>]) : string
14478rdp_cookie([<name>]) : string (deprecated)
14479 When the request buffer looks like the RDP protocol, extracts the RDP cookie
14480 <name>, or any cookie if unspecified. The parser only checks for the first
14481 cookie, as illustrated in the RDP protocol specification. The cookie name is
14482 case insensitive. Generally the "MSTS" cookie name will be used, as it can
14483 contain the user name of the client connecting to the server if properly
14484 configured on the client. The "MSTSHASH" cookie is often used as well for
14485 session stickiness to servers.
Willy Tarreau04aa6a92012-04-06 18:57:55 +020014486
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014487 This differs from "balance rdp-cookie" in that any balancing algorithm may be
14488 used and thus the distribution of clients to backend servers is not linked to
14489 a hash of the RDP cookie. It is envisaged that using a balancing algorithm
14490 such as "balance roundrobin" or "balance leastconn" will lead to a more even
14491 distribution of clients to backend servers than the hash used by "balance
14492 rdp-cookie".
Willy Tarreau04aa6a92012-04-06 18:57:55 +020014493
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014494 ACL derivatives :
14495 req_rdp_cookie([<name>]) : exact string match
Willy Tarreau04aa6a92012-04-06 18:57:55 +020014496
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014497 Example :
14498 listen tse-farm
14499 bind 0.0.0.0:3389
14500 # wait up to 5s for an RDP cookie in the request
14501 tcp-request inspect-delay 5s
14502 tcp-request content accept if RDP_COOKIE
14503 # apply RDP cookie persistence
14504 persist rdp-cookie
14505 # Persist based on the mstshash cookie
14506 # This is only useful makes sense if
14507 # balance rdp-cookie is not used
14508 stick-table type string size 204800
14509 stick on req.rdp_cookie(mstshash)
14510 server srv1 1.1.1.1:3389
14511 server srv1 1.1.1.2:3389
Willy Tarreau04aa6a92012-04-06 18:57:55 +020014512
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014513 See also : "balance rdp-cookie", "persist rdp-cookie", "tcp-request" and the
14514 "req_rdp_cookie" ACL.
Willy Tarreau04aa6a92012-04-06 18:57:55 +020014515
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014516req.rdp_cookie_cnt([name]) : integer
14517rdp_cookie_cnt([name]) : integer (deprecated)
14518 Tries to parse the request buffer as RDP protocol, then returns an integer
14519 corresponding to the number of RDP cookies found. If an optional cookie name
14520 is passed, only cookies matching this name are considered. This is mostly
14521 used in ACL.
Willy Tarreau04aa6a92012-04-06 18:57:55 +020014522
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014523 ACL derivatives :
14524 req_rdp_cookie_cnt([<name>]) : integer match
Willy Tarreau04aa6a92012-04-06 18:57:55 +020014525
Nenad Merdanovic5fc7d7e2015-07-07 22:00:17 +020014526req.ssl_ec_ext : boolean
14527 Returns a boolean identifying if client sent the Supported Elliptic Curves
14528 Extension as defined in RFC4492, section 5.1. within the SSL ClientHello
Cyril Bonté307ee1e2015-09-28 23:16:06 +020014529 message. This can be used to present ECC compatible clients with EC
14530 certificate and to use RSA for all others, on the same IP address. Note that
14531 this only applies to raw contents found in the request buffer and not to
14532 contents deciphered via an SSL data layer, so this will not work with "bind"
14533 lines having the "ssl" option.
Nenad Merdanovic5fc7d7e2015-07-07 22:00:17 +020014534
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014535req.ssl_hello_type : integer
14536req_ssl_hello_type : integer (deprecated)
14537 Returns an integer value containing the type of the SSL hello message found
14538 in the request buffer if the buffer contains data that parse as a complete
14539 SSL (v3 or superior) client hello message. Note that this only applies to raw
14540 contents found in the request buffer and not to contents deciphered via an
14541 SSL data layer, so this will not work with "bind" lines having the "ssl"
14542 option. This is mostly used in ACL to detect presence of an SSL hello message
14543 that is supposed to contain an SSL session ID usable for stickiness.
Willy Tarreau04aa6a92012-04-06 18:57:55 +020014544
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014545req.ssl_sni : string
14546req_ssl_sni : string (deprecated)
14547 Returns a string containing the value of the Server Name TLS extension sent
14548 by a client in a TLS stream passing through the request buffer if the buffer
14549 contains data that parse as a complete SSL (v3 or superior) client hello
14550 message. Note that this only applies to raw contents found in the request
14551 buffer and not to contents deciphered via an SSL data layer, so this will not
14552 work with "bind" lines having the "ssl" option. SNI normally contains the
14553 name of the host the client tries to connect to (for recent browsers). SNI is
14554 useful for allowing or denying access to certain hosts when SSL/TLS is used
14555 by the client. This test was designed to be used with TCP request content
14556 inspection. If content switching is needed, it is recommended to first wait
14557 for a complete client hello (type 1), like in the example below. See also
14558 "ssl_fc_sni".
Willy Tarreau04aa6a92012-04-06 18:57:55 +020014559
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014560 ACL derivatives :
14561 req_ssl_sni : exact string match
Willy Tarreau04aa6a92012-04-06 18:57:55 +020014562
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014563 Examples :
14564 # Wait for a client hello for at most 5 seconds
14565 tcp-request inspect-delay 5s
14566 tcp-request content accept if { req_ssl_hello_type 1 }
14567 use_backend bk_allow if { req_ssl_sni -f allowed_sites }
14568 default_backend bk_sorry_page
Willy Tarreau04aa6a92012-04-06 18:57:55 +020014569
Pradeep Jindalbb2acf52015-09-29 10:12:57 +053014570req.ssl_st_ext : integer
14571 Returns 0 if the client didn't send a SessionTicket TLS Extension (RFC5077)
14572 Returns 1 if the client sent SessionTicket TLS Extension
14573 Returns 2 if the client also sent non-zero length TLS SessionTicket
14574 Note that this only applies to raw contents found in the request buffer and
14575 not to contents deciphered via an SSL data layer, so this will not work with
14576 "bind" lines having the "ssl" option. This can for example be used to detect
14577 whether the client sent a SessionTicket or not and stick it accordingly, if
14578 no SessionTicket then stick on SessionID or don't stick as there's no server
14579 side state is there when SessionTickets are in use.
14580
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014581req.ssl_ver : integer
14582req_ssl_ver : integer (deprecated)
14583 Returns an integer value containing the version of the SSL/TLS protocol of a
14584 stream present in the request buffer. Both SSLv2 hello messages and SSLv3
14585 messages are supported. TLSv1 is announced as SSL version 3.1. The value is
14586 composed of the major version multiplied by 65536, added to the minor
14587 version. Note that this only applies to raw contents found in the request
14588 buffer and not to contents deciphered via an SSL data layer, so this will not
14589 work with "bind" lines having the "ssl" option. The ACL version of the test
14590 matches against a decimal notation in the form MAJOR.MINOR (eg: 3.1). This
14591 fetch is mostly used in ACL.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010014592
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014593 ACL derivatives :
14594 req_ssl_ver : decimal match
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010014595
Willy Tarreau47e8eba2013-09-11 23:28:46 +020014596res.len : integer
14597 Returns an integer value corresponding to the number of bytes present in the
14598 response buffer. This is mostly used in ACL. It is important to understand
14599 that this test does not return false as long as the buffer is changing. This
14600 means that a check with equality to zero will almost always immediately match
14601 at the beginning of the session, while a test for more data will wait for
14602 that data to come in and return false only when haproxy is certain that no
14603 more data will come in. This test was designed to be used with TCP response
14604 content inspection.
14605
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014606res.payload(<offset>,<length>) : binary
14607 This extracts a binary block of <length> bytes and starting at byte <offset>
Willy Tarreau00f00842013-08-02 11:07:32 +020014608 in the response buffer. As a special case, if the <length> argument is zero,
14609 the the whole buffer from <offset> to the end is extracted. This can be used
14610 with ACLs in order to check for the presence of some content in a buffer at
14611 any location.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010014612
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014613res.payload_lv(<offset1>,<length>[,<offset2>]) : binary
14614 This extracts a binary block whose size is specified at <offset1> for <length>
14615 bytes, and which starts at <offset2> if specified or just after the length in
14616 the response buffer. The <offset2> parameter also supports relative offsets
14617 if prepended with a '+' or '-' sign.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010014618
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014619 Example : please consult the example from the "stick store-response" keyword.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010014620
Willy Tarreau971f7b62015-09-29 14:06:59 +020014621res.ssl_hello_type : integer
14622rep_ssl_hello_type : integer (deprecated)
14623 Returns an integer value containing the type of the SSL hello message found
14624 in the response buffer if the buffer contains data that parses as a complete
14625 SSL (v3 or superior) hello message. Note that this only applies to raw
14626 contents found in the response buffer and not to contents deciphered via an
14627 SSL data layer, so this will not work with "server" lines having the "ssl"
14628 option. This is mostly used in ACL to detect presence of an SSL hello message
14629 that is supposed to contain an SSL session ID usable for stickiness.
14630
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014631wait_end : boolean
14632 This fetch either returns true when the inspection period is over, or does
14633 not fetch. It is only used in ACLs, in conjunction with content analysis to
14634 avoid returning a wrong verdict early. It may also be used to delay some
14635 actions, such as a delayed reject for some special addresses. Since it either
14636 stops the rules evaluation or immediately returns true, it is recommended to
14637 use this acl as the last one in a rule. Please note that the default ACL
14638 "WAIT_END" is always usable without prior declaration. This test was designed
14639 to be used with TCP request content inspection.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010014640
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014641 Examples :
14642 # delay every incoming request by 2 seconds
14643 tcp-request inspect-delay 2s
14644 tcp-request content accept if WAIT_END
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010014645
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014646 # don't immediately tell bad guys they are rejected
14647 tcp-request inspect-delay 10s
14648 acl goodguys src 10.0.0.0/24
14649 acl badguys src 10.0.1.0/24
14650 tcp-request content accept if goodguys
14651 tcp-request content reject if badguys WAIT_END
14652 tcp-request content reject
14653
14654
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +0200146557.3.6. Fetching HTTP samples (Layer 7)
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014656--------------------------------------
14657
14658It is possible to fetch samples from HTTP contents, requests and responses.
14659This application layer is also called layer 7. It is only possible to fetch the
14660data in this section when a full HTTP request or response has been parsed from
14661its respective request or response buffer. This is always the case with all
14662HTTP specific rules and for sections running with "mode http". When using TCP
14663content inspection, it may be necessary to support an inspection delay in order
14664to let the request or response come in first. These fetches may require a bit
14665more CPU resources than the layer 4 ones, but not much since the request and
14666response are indexed.
14667
14668base : string
14669 This returns the concatenation of the first Host header and the path part of
14670 the request, which starts at the first slash and ends before the question
14671 mark. It can be useful in virtual hosted environments to detect URL abuses as
14672 well as to improve shared caches efficiency. Using this with a limited size
14673 stick table also allows one to collect statistics about most commonly
14674 requested objects by host/path. With ACLs it can allow simple content
14675 switching rules involving the host and the path at the same time, such as
14676 "www.example.com/favicon.ico". See also "path" and "uri".
14677
14678 ACL derivatives :
14679 base : exact string match
14680 base_beg : prefix match
14681 base_dir : subdir match
14682 base_dom : domain match
14683 base_end : suffix match
14684 base_len : length match
14685 base_reg : regex match
14686 base_sub : substring match
14687
14688base32 : integer
14689 This returns a 32-bit hash of the value returned by the "base" fetch method
14690 above. This is useful to track per-URL activity on high traffic sites without
14691 having to store all URLs. Instead a shorter hash is stored, saving a lot of
Willy Tarreau23ec4ca2014-07-15 20:15:37 +020014692 memory. The output type is an unsigned integer. The hash function used is
14693 SDBM with full avalanche on the output. Technically, base32 is exactly equal
14694 to "base,sdbm(1)".
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014695
14696base32+src : binary
14697 This returns the concatenation of the base32 fetch above and the src fetch
14698 below. The resulting type is of type binary, with a size of 8 or 20 bytes
14699 depending on the source address family. This can be used to track per-IP,
14700 per-URL counters.
14701
William Lallemand65ad6e12014-01-31 15:08:02 +010014702capture.req.hdr(<idx>) : string
14703 This extracts the content of the header captured by the "capture request
14704 header", idx is the position of the capture keyword in the configuration.
14705 The first entry is an index of 0. See also: "capture request header".
14706
14707capture.req.method : string
14708 This extracts the METHOD of an HTTP request. It can be used in both request
14709 and response. Unlike "method", it can be used in both request and response
14710 because it's allocated.
14711
14712capture.req.uri : string
14713 This extracts the request's URI, which starts at the first slash and ends
14714 before the first space in the request (without the host part). Unlike "path"
14715 and "url", it can be used in both request and response because it's
14716 allocated.
14717
Willy Tarreau3c1b5ec2014-04-24 23:41:57 +020014718capture.req.ver : string
14719 This extracts the request's HTTP version and returns either "HTTP/1.0" or
14720 "HTTP/1.1". Unlike "req.ver", it can be used in both request, response, and
14721 logs because it relies on a persistent flag.
14722
William Lallemand65ad6e12014-01-31 15:08:02 +010014723capture.res.hdr(<idx>) : string
14724 This extracts the content of the header captured by the "capture response
14725 header", idx is the position of the capture keyword in the configuration.
14726 The first entry is an index of 0.
14727 See also: "capture response header"
14728
Willy Tarreau3c1b5ec2014-04-24 23:41:57 +020014729capture.res.ver : string
14730 This extracts the response's HTTP version and returns either "HTTP/1.0" or
14731 "HTTP/1.1". Unlike "res.ver", it can be used in logs because it relies on a
14732 persistent flag.
14733
Willy Tarreaua5910cc2015-05-02 00:46:08 +020014734req.body : binary
14735 This returns the HTTP request's available body as a block of data. It
14736 requires that the request body has been buffered made available using
14737 "option http-buffer-request". In case of chunked-encoded body, currently only
14738 the first chunk is analyzed.
14739
Thierry FOURNIER9826c772015-05-20 15:50:54 +020014740req.body_param([<name>) : string
14741 This fetch assumes that the body of the POST request is url-encoded. The user
14742 can check if the "content-type" contains the value
14743 "application/x-www-form-urlencoded". This extracts the first occurrence of the
14744 parameter <name> in the body, which ends before '&'. The parameter name is
14745 case-sensitive. If no name is given, any parameter will match, and the first
14746 one will be returned. The result is a string corresponding to the value of the
14747 parameter <name> as presented in the request body (no URL decoding is
14748 performed). Note that the ACL version of this fetch iterates over multiple
14749 parameters and will iteratively report all parameters values if no name is
14750 given.
14751
Willy Tarreaua5910cc2015-05-02 00:46:08 +020014752req.body_len : integer
14753 This returns the length of the HTTP request's available body in bytes. It may
14754 be lower than the advertised length if the body is larger than the buffer. It
14755 requires that the request body has been buffered made available using
14756 "option http-buffer-request".
14757
14758req.body_size : integer
14759 This returns the advertised length of the HTTP request's body in bytes. It
14760 will represent the advertised Content-Length header, or the size of the first
14761 chunk in case of chunked encoding. In order to parse the chunks, it requires
14762 that the request body has been buffered made available using
14763 "option http-buffer-request".
14764
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014765req.cook([<name>]) : string
14766cook([<name>]) : string (deprecated)
14767 This extracts the last occurrence of the cookie name <name> on a "Cookie"
14768 header line from the request, and returns its value as string. If no name is
14769 specified, the first cookie value is returned. When used with ACLs, all
14770 matching cookies are evaluated. Spaces around the name and the value are
14771 ignored as requested by the Cookie header specification (RFC6265). The cookie
14772 name is case-sensitive. Empty cookies are valid, so an empty cookie may very
14773 well return an empty value if it is present. Use the "found" match to detect
14774 presence. Use the res.cook() variant for response cookies sent by the server.
14775
14776 ACL derivatives :
14777 cook([<name>]) : exact string match
14778 cook_beg([<name>]) : prefix match
14779 cook_dir([<name>]) : subdir match
14780 cook_dom([<name>]) : domain match
14781 cook_end([<name>]) : suffix match
14782 cook_len([<name>]) : length match
14783 cook_reg([<name>]) : regex match
14784 cook_sub([<name>]) : substring match
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010014785
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014786req.cook_cnt([<name>]) : integer
14787cook_cnt([<name>]) : integer (deprecated)
14788 Returns an integer value representing the number of occurrences of the cookie
14789 <name> in the request, or all cookies if <name> is not specified.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010014790
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014791req.cook_val([<name>]) : integer
14792cook_val([<name>]) : integer (deprecated)
14793 This extracts the last occurrence of the cookie name <name> on a "Cookie"
14794 header line from the request, and converts its value to an integer which is
14795 returned. If no name is specified, the first cookie value is returned. When
14796 used in ACLs, all matching names are iterated over until a value matches.
Willy Tarreau0e698542011-09-16 08:32:32 +020014797
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014798cookie([<name>]) : string (deprecated)
14799 This extracts the last occurrence of the cookie name <name> on a "Cookie"
14800 header line from the request, or a "Set-Cookie" header from the response, and
14801 returns its value as a string. A typical use is to get multiple clients
14802 sharing a same profile use the same server. This can be similar to what
Willy Tarreau294d0f02015-08-10 19:40:12 +020014803 "appsession" did with the "request-learn" statement, but with support for
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014804 multi-peer synchronization and state keeping across restarts. If no name is
14805 specified, the first cookie value is returned. This fetch should not be used
14806 anymore and should be replaced by req.cook() or res.cook() instead as it
14807 ambiguously uses the direction based on the context where it is used.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010014808
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014809hdr([<name>[,<occ>]]) : string
14810 This is equivalent to req.hdr() when used on requests, and to res.hdr() when
14811 used on responses. Please refer to these respective fetches for more details.
14812 In case of doubt about the fetch direction, please use the explicit ones.
14813 Note that contrary to the hdr() sample fetch method, the hdr_* ACL keywords
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030014814 unambiguously apply to the request headers.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010014815
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014816req.fhdr(<name>[,<occ>]) : string
14817 This extracts the last occurrence of header <name> in an HTTP request. When
14818 used from an ACL, all occurrences are iterated over until a match is found.
14819 Optionally, a specific occurrence might be specified as a position number.
14820 Positive values indicate a position from the first occurrence, with 1 being
14821 the first one. Negative values indicate positions relative to the last one,
14822 with -1 being the last one. It differs from req.hdr() in that any commas
14823 present in the value are returned and are not used as delimiters. This is
14824 sometimes useful with headers such as User-Agent.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010014825
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014826req.fhdr_cnt([<name>]) : integer
14827 Returns an integer value representing the number of occurrences of request
14828 header field name <name>, or the total number of header fields if <name> is
14829 not specified. Contrary to its req.hdr_cnt() cousin, this function returns
14830 the number of full line headers and does not stop on commas.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010014831
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014832req.hdr([<name>[,<occ>]]) : string
14833 This extracts the last occurrence of header <name> in an HTTP request. When
14834 used from an ACL, all occurrences are iterated over until a match is found.
14835 Optionally, a specific occurrence might be specified as a position number.
14836 Positive values indicate a position from the first occurrence, with 1 being
14837 the first one. Negative values indicate positions relative to the last one,
14838 with -1 being the last one. A typical use is with the X-Forwarded-For header
14839 once converted to IP, associated with an IP stick-table. The function
14840 considers any comma as a delimiter for distinct values. If full-line headers
Lukas Tribus23953682017-04-28 13:24:30 +000014841 are desired instead, use req.fhdr(). Please carefully check RFC7231 to know
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014842 how certain headers are supposed to be parsed. Also, some of them are case
14843 insensitive (eg: Connection).
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010014844
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014845 ACL derivatives :
14846 hdr([<name>[,<occ>]]) : exact string match
14847 hdr_beg([<name>[,<occ>]]) : prefix match
14848 hdr_dir([<name>[,<occ>]]) : subdir match
14849 hdr_dom([<name>[,<occ>]]) : domain match
14850 hdr_end([<name>[,<occ>]]) : suffix match
14851 hdr_len([<name>[,<occ>]]) : length match
14852 hdr_reg([<name>[,<occ>]]) : regex match
14853 hdr_sub([<name>[,<occ>]]) : substring match
14854
14855req.hdr_cnt([<name>]) : integer
14856hdr_cnt([<header>]) : integer (deprecated)
14857 Returns an integer value representing the number of occurrences of request
14858 header field name <name>, or the total number of header field values if
14859 <name> is not specified. It is important to remember that one header line may
14860 count as several headers if it has several values. The function considers any
14861 comma as a delimiter for distinct values. If full-line headers are desired
14862 instead, req.fhdr_cnt() should be used instead. With ACLs, it can be used to
14863 detect presence, absence or abuse of a specific header, as well as to block
14864 request smuggling attacks by rejecting requests which contain more than one
14865 of certain headers. See "req.hdr" for more information on header matching.
14866
14867req.hdr_ip([<name>[,<occ>]]) : ip
14868hdr_ip([<name>[,<occ>]]) : ip (deprecated)
14869 This extracts the last occurrence of header <name> in an HTTP request,
14870 converts it to an IPv4 or IPv6 address and returns this address. When used
14871 with ACLs, all occurrences are checked, and if <name> is omitted, every value
14872 of every header is checked. Optionally, a specific occurrence might be
14873 specified as a position number. Positive values indicate a position from the
14874 first occurrence, with 1 being the first one. Negative values indicate
14875 positions relative to the last one, with -1 being the last one. A typical use
14876 is with the X-Forwarded-For and X-Client-IP headers.
14877
14878req.hdr_val([<name>[,<occ>]]) : integer
14879hdr_val([<name>[,<occ>]]) : integer (deprecated)
14880 This extracts the last occurrence of header <name> in an HTTP request, and
14881 converts it to an integer value. When used with ACLs, all occurrences are
14882 checked, and if <name> is omitted, every value of every header is checked.
14883 Optionally, a specific occurrence might be specified as a position number.
14884 Positive values indicate a position from the first occurrence, with 1 being
14885 the first one. Negative values indicate positions relative to the last one,
14886 with -1 being the last one. A typical use is with the X-Forwarded-For header.
14887
14888http_auth(<userlist>) : boolean
14889 Returns a boolean indicating whether the authentication data received from
14890 the client match a username & password stored in the specified userlist. This
14891 fetch function is not really useful outside of ACLs. Currently only http
14892 basic auth is supported.
14893
Thierry FOURNIER9eec0a62014-01-22 18:38:02 +010014894http_auth_group(<userlist>) : string
14895 Returns a string corresponding to the user name found in the authentication
14896 data received from the client if both the user name and password are valid
14897 according to the specified userlist. The main purpose is to use it in ACLs
14898 where it is then checked whether the user belongs to any group within a list.
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014899 This fetch function is not really useful outside of ACLs. Currently only http
14900 basic auth is supported.
14901
14902 ACL derivatives :
Thierry FOURNIER9eec0a62014-01-22 18:38:02 +010014903 http_auth_group(<userlist>) : group ...
14904 Returns true when the user extracted from the request and whose password is
14905 valid according to the specified userlist belongs to at least one of the
14906 groups.
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014907
14908http_first_req : boolean
Willy Tarreau7f18e522010-10-22 20:04:13 +020014909 Returns true when the request being processed is the first one of the
14910 connection. This can be used to add or remove headers that may be missing
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014911 from some requests when a request is not the first one, or to help grouping
14912 requests in the logs.
Willy Tarreau7f18e522010-10-22 20:04:13 +020014913
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014914method : integer + string
14915 Returns an integer value corresponding to the method in the HTTP request. For
14916 example, "GET" equals 1 (check sources to establish the matching). Value 9
14917 means "other method" and may be converted to a string extracted from the
14918 stream. This should not be used directly as a sample, this is only meant to
14919 be used from ACLs, which transparently convert methods from patterns to these
14920 integer + string values. Some predefined ACL already check for most common
14921 methods.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020014922
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014923 ACL derivatives :
14924 method : case insensitive method match
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020014925
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014926 Example :
14927 # only accept GET and HEAD requests
14928 acl valid_method method GET HEAD
14929 http-request deny if ! valid_method
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020014930
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014931path : string
14932 This extracts the request's URL path, which starts at the first slash and
14933 ends before the question mark (without the host part). A typical use is with
14934 prefetch-capable caches, and with portals which need to aggregate multiple
14935 information from databases and keep them in caches. Note that with outgoing
14936 caches, it would be wiser to use "url" instead. With ACLs, it's typically
14937 used to match exact file names (eg: "/login.php"), or directory parts using
14938 the derivative forms. See also the "url" and "base" fetch methods.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020014939
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014940 ACL derivatives :
14941 path : exact string match
14942 path_beg : prefix match
14943 path_dir : subdir match
14944 path_dom : domain match
14945 path_end : suffix match
14946 path_len : length match
14947 path_reg : regex match
14948 path_sub : substring match
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020014949
Willy Tarreau49ad95c2015-01-19 15:06:26 +010014950query : string
14951 This extracts the request's query string, which starts after the first
14952 question mark. If no question mark is present, this fetch returns nothing. If
14953 a question mark is present but nothing follows, it returns an empty string.
14954 This means it's possible to easily know whether a query string is present
Tim Düsterhus4896c442016-11-29 02:15:19 +010014955 using the "found" matching method. This fetch is the complement of "path"
Willy Tarreau49ad95c2015-01-19 15:06:26 +010014956 which stops before the question mark.
14957
Willy Tarreaueb27ec72015-02-20 13:55:29 +010014958req.hdr_names([<delim>]) : string
14959 This builds a string made from the concatenation of all header names as they
14960 appear in the request when the rule is evaluated. The default delimiter is
14961 the comma (',') but it may be overridden as an optional argument <delim>. In
14962 this case, only the first character of <delim> is considered.
14963
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014964req.ver : string
14965req_ver : string (deprecated)
14966 Returns the version string from the HTTP request, for example "1.1". This can
14967 be useful for logs, but is mostly there for ACL. Some predefined ACL already
14968 check for versions 1.0 and 1.1.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010014969
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014970 ACL derivatives :
14971 req_ver : exact string match
Willy Tarreau0e698542011-09-16 08:32:32 +020014972
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014973res.comp : boolean
14974 Returns the boolean "true" value if the response has been compressed by
14975 HAProxy, otherwise returns boolean "false". This may be used to add
14976 information in the logs.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020014977
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014978res.comp_algo : string
14979 Returns a string containing the name of the algorithm used if the response
14980 was compressed by HAProxy, for example : "deflate". This may be used to add
14981 some information in the logs.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010014982
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014983res.cook([<name>]) : string
14984scook([<name>]) : string (deprecated)
14985 This extracts the last occurrence of the cookie name <name> on a "Set-Cookie"
14986 header line from the response, and returns its value as string. If no name is
14987 specified, the first cookie value is returned.
Willy Tarreau0ce3aa02012-04-25 18:46:33 +020014988
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014989 ACL derivatives :
14990 scook([<name>] : exact string match
Willy Tarreau0ce3aa02012-04-25 18:46:33 +020014991
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014992res.cook_cnt([<name>]) : integer
14993scook_cnt([<name>]) : integer (deprecated)
14994 Returns an integer value representing the number of occurrences of the cookie
14995 <name> in the response, or all cookies if <name> is not specified. This is
14996 mostly useful when combined with ACLs to detect suspicious responses.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010014997
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014998res.cook_val([<name>]) : integer
14999scook_val([<name>]) : integer (deprecated)
15000 This extracts the last occurrence of the cookie name <name> on a "Set-Cookie"
15001 header line from the response, and converts its value to an integer which is
15002 returned. If no name is specified, the first cookie value is returned.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010015003
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015004res.fhdr([<name>[,<occ>]]) : string
15005 This extracts the last occurrence of header <name> in an HTTP response, or of
15006 the last header if no <name> is specified. Optionally, a specific occurrence
15007 might be specified as a position number. Positive values indicate a position
15008 from the first occurrence, with 1 being the first one. Negative values
15009 indicate positions relative to the last one, with -1 being the last one. It
15010 differs from res.hdr() in that any commas present in the value are returned
15011 and are not used as delimiters. If this is not desired, the res.hdr() fetch
15012 should be used instead. This is sometimes useful with headers such as Date or
15013 Expires.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020015014
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015015res.fhdr_cnt([<name>]) : integer
15016 Returns an integer value representing the number of occurrences of response
15017 header field name <name>, or the total number of header fields if <name> is
15018 not specified. Contrary to its res.hdr_cnt() cousin, this function returns
15019 the number of full line headers and does not stop on commas. If this is not
15020 desired, the res.hdr_cnt() fetch should be used instead.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020015021
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015022res.hdr([<name>[,<occ>]]) : string
15023shdr([<name>[,<occ>]]) : string (deprecated)
15024 This extracts the last occurrence of header <name> in an HTTP response, or of
15025 the last header if no <name> is specified. Optionally, a specific occurrence
15026 might be specified as a position number. Positive values indicate a position
15027 from the first occurrence, with 1 being the first one. Negative values
15028 indicate positions relative to the last one, with -1 being the last one. This
15029 can be useful to learn some data into a stick-table. The function considers
15030 any comma as a delimiter for distinct values. If this is not desired, the
15031 res.fhdr() fetch should be used instead.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020015032
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015033 ACL derivatives :
15034 shdr([<name>[,<occ>]]) : exact string match
15035 shdr_beg([<name>[,<occ>]]) : prefix match
15036 shdr_dir([<name>[,<occ>]]) : subdir match
15037 shdr_dom([<name>[,<occ>]]) : domain match
15038 shdr_end([<name>[,<occ>]]) : suffix match
15039 shdr_len([<name>[,<occ>]]) : length match
15040 shdr_reg([<name>[,<occ>]]) : regex match
15041 shdr_sub([<name>[,<occ>]]) : substring match
15042
15043res.hdr_cnt([<name>]) : integer
15044shdr_cnt([<name>]) : integer (deprecated)
15045 Returns an integer value representing the number of occurrences of response
15046 header field name <name>, or the total number of header fields if <name> is
15047 not specified. The function considers any comma as a delimiter for distinct
15048 values. If this is not desired, the res.fhdr_cnt() fetch should be used
15049 instead.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020015050
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015051res.hdr_ip([<name>[,<occ>]]) : ip
15052shdr_ip([<name>[,<occ>]]) : ip (deprecated)
15053 This extracts the last occurrence of header <name> in an HTTP response,
15054 convert it to an IPv4 or IPv6 address and returns this address. Optionally, a
15055 specific occurrence might be specified as a position number. Positive values
15056 indicate a position from the first occurrence, with 1 being the first one.
15057 Negative values indicate positions relative to the last one, with -1 being
15058 the last one. This can be useful to learn some data into a stick table.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020015059
Willy Tarreaueb27ec72015-02-20 13:55:29 +010015060res.hdr_names([<delim>]) : string
15061 This builds a string made from the concatenation of all header names as they
15062 appear in the response when the rule is evaluated. The default delimiter is
15063 the comma (',') but it may be overridden as an optional argument <delim>. In
15064 this case, only the first character of <delim> is considered.
15065
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015066res.hdr_val([<name>[,<occ>]]) : integer
15067shdr_val([<name>[,<occ>]]) : integer (deprecated)
15068 This extracts the last occurrence of header <name> in an HTTP response, and
15069 converts it to an integer value. Optionally, a specific occurrence might be
15070 specified as a position number. Positive values indicate a position from the
15071 first occurrence, with 1 being the first one. Negative values indicate
15072 positions relative to the last one, with -1 being the last one. This can be
15073 useful to learn some data into a stick table.
Alexandre Cassen5eb1a902007-11-29 15:43:32 +010015074
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015075res.ver : string
15076resp_ver : string (deprecated)
15077 Returns the version string from the HTTP response, for example "1.1". This
15078 can be useful for logs, but is mostly there for ACL.
Willy Tarreau0e698542011-09-16 08:32:32 +020015079
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015080 ACL derivatives :
15081 resp_ver : exact string match
Alexandre Cassen5eb1a902007-11-29 15:43:32 +010015082
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015083set-cookie([<name>]) : string (deprecated)
15084 This extracts the last occurrence of the cookie name <name> on a "Set-Cookie"
15085 header line from the response and uses the corresponding value to match. This
Willy Tarreau294d0f02015-08-10 19:40:12 +020015086 can be comparable to what "appsession" did with default options, but with
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015087 support for multi-peer synchronization and state keeping across restarts.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +010015088
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015089 This fetch function is deprecated and has been superseded by the "res.cook"
15090 fetch. This keyword will disappear soon.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +010015091
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015092status : integer
15093 Returns an integer containing the HTTP status code in the HTTP response, for
15094 example, 302. It is mostly used within ACLs and integer ranges, for example,
15095 to remove any Location header if the response is not a 3xx.
Willy Tarreau25c1ebc2012-04-25 16:21:44 +020015096
Thierry Fournier0e00dca2016-04-07 15:47:40 +020015097unique-id : string
15098 Returns the unique-id attached to the request. The directive
15099 "unique-id-format" must be set. If it is not set, the unique-id sample fetch
15100 fails. Note that the unique-id is usually used with HTTP requests, however this
15101 sample fetch can be used with other protocols. Obviously, if it is used with
15102 other protocols than HTTP, the unique-id-format directive must not contain
15103 HTTP parts. See: unique-id-format and unique-id-header
15104
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015105url : string
15106 This extracts the request's URL as presented in the request. A typical use is
15107 with prefetch-capable caches, and with portals which need to aggregate
15108 multiple information from databases and keep them in caches. With ACLs, using
15109 "path" is preferred over using "url", because clients may send a full URL as
15110 is normally done with proxies. The only real use is to match "*" which does
15111 not match in "path", and for which there is already a predefined ACL. See
15112 also "path" and "base".
Willy Tarreau25c1ebc2012-04-25 16:21:44 +020015113
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015114 ACL derivatives :
15115 url : exact string match
15116 url_beg : prefix match
15117 url_dir : subdir match
15118 url_dom : domain match
15119 url_end : suffix match
15120 url_len : length match
15121 url_reg : regex match
15122 url_sub : substring match
Willy Tarreau25c1ebc2012-04-25 16:21:44 +020015123
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015124url_ip : ip
15125 This extracts the IP address from the request's URL when the host part is
15126 presented as an IP address. Its use is very limited. For instance, a
15127 monitoring system might use this field as an alternative for the source IP in
15128 order to test what path a given source address would follow, or to force an
15129 entry in a table for a given source address. With ACLs it can be used to
15130 restrict access to certain systems through a proxy, for example when combined
15131 with option "http_proxy".
Willy Tarreau25c1ebc2012-04-25 16:21:44 +020015132
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015133url_port : integer
15134 This extracts the port part from the request's URL. Note that if the port is
15135 not specified in the request, port 80 is assumed. With ACLs it can be used to
15136 restrict access to certain systems through a proxy, for example when combined
15137 with option "http_proxy".
Willy Tarreau25c1ebc2012-04-25 16:21:44 +020015138
Willy Tarreau1ede1da2015-05-07 16:06:18 +020015139urlp([<name>[,<delim>]]) : string
15140url_param([<name>[,<delim>]]) : string
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015141 This extracts the first occurrence of the parameter <name> in the query
15142 string, which begins after either '?' or <delim>, and which ends before '&',
Willy Tarreau1ede1da2015-05-07 16:06:18 +020015143 ';' or <delim>. The parameter name is case-sensitive. If no name is given,
15144 any parameter will match, and the first one will be returned. The result is
15145 a string corresponding to the value of the parameter <name> as presented in
15146 the request (no URL decoding is performed). This can be used for session
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015147 stickiness based on a client ID, to extract an application cookie passed as a
15148 URL parameter, or in ACLs to apply some checks. Note that the ACL version of
Willy Tarreau1ede1da2015-05-07 16:06:18 +020015149 this fetch iterates over multiple parameters and will iteratively report all
15150 parameters values if no name is given
Willy Tarreau25c1ebc2012-04-25 16:21:44 +020015151
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015152 ACL derivatives :
15153 urlp(<name>[,<delim>]) : exact string match
15154 urlp_beg(<name>[,<delim>]) : prefix match
15155 urlp_dir(<name>[,<delim>]) : subdir match
15156 urlp_dom(<name>[,<delim>]) : domain match
15157 urlp_end(<name>[,<delim>]) : suffix match
15158 urlp_len(<name>[,<delim>]) : length match
15159 urlp_reg(<name>[,<delim>]) : regex match
15160 urlp_sub(<name>[,<delim>]) : substring match
Willy Tarreau25c1ebc2012-04-25 16:21:44 +020015161
Willy Tarreau25c1ebc2012-04-25 16:21:44 +020015162
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015163 Example :
15164 # match http://example.com/foo?PHPSESSIONID=some_id
15165 stick on urlp(PHPSESSIONID)
15166 # match http://example.com/foo;JSESSIONID=some_id
15167 stick on urlp(JSESSIONID,;)
Willy Tarreau25c1ebc2012-04-25 16:21:44 +020015168
Jarno Huuskonen676f6222017-03-30 09:19:45 +030015169urlp_val([<name>[,<delim>]]) : integer
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015170 See "urlp" above. This one extracts the URL parameter <name> in the request
15171 and converts it to an integer value. This can be used for session stickiness
15172 based on a user ID for example, or with ACLs to match a page number or price.
Willy Tarreaua9fddca2012-07-31 07:51:48 +020015173
Dragan Dosen0070cd52016-06-16 12:19:49 +020015174url32 : integer
15175 This returns a 32-bit hash of the value obtained by concatenating the first
15176 Host header and the whole URL including parameters (not only the path part of
15177 the request, as in the "base32" fetch above). This is useful to track per-URL
15178 activity. A shorter hash is stored, saving a lot of memory. The output type
15179 is an unsigned integer.
15180
15181url32+src : binary
15182 This returns the concatenation of the "url32" fetch and the "src" fetch. The
15183 resulting type is of type binary, with a size of 8 or 20 bytes depending on
15184 the source address family. This can be used to track per-IP, per-URL counters.
15185
Willy Tarreau198a7442008-01-17 12:05:32 +010015186
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +0200151877.4. Pre-defined ACLs
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020015188---------------------
Willy Tarreauced27012008-01-17 20:35:34 +010015189
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020015190Some predefined ACLs are hard-coded so that they do not have to be declared in
15191every frontend which needs them. They all have their names in upper case in
Patrick Mézard2382ad62010-05-09 10:43:32 +020015192order to avoid confusion. Their equivalence is provided below.
Willy Tarreauced27012008-01-17 20:35:34 +010015193
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020015194ACL name Equivalent to Usage
15195---------------+-----------------------------+---------------------------------
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020015196FALSE always_false never match
Willy Tarreau2492d5b2009-07-11 00:06:00 +020015197HTTP req_proto_http match if protocol is valid HTTP
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020015198HTTP_1.0 req_ver 1.0 match HTTP version 1.0
15199HTTP_1.1 req_ver 1.1 match HTTP version 1.1
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010015200HTTP_CONTENT hdr_val(content-length) gt 0 match an existing content-length
15201HTTP_URL_ABS url_reg ^[^/:]*:// match absolute URL with scheme
15202HTTP_URL_SLASH url_beg / match URL beginning with "/"
15203HTTP_URL_STAR url * match URL equal to "*"
15204LOCALHOST src 127.0.0.1/8 match connection from local host
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020015205METH_CONNECT method CONNECT match HTTP CONNECT method
Daniel Schneller9ff96c72016-04-11 17:45:29 +020015206METH_DELETE method DELETE match HTTP DELETE method
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020015207METH_GET method GET HEAD match HTTP GET or HEAD method
15208METH_HEAD method HEAD match HTTP HEAD method
15209METH_OPTIONS method OPTIONS match HTTP OPTIONS method
15210METH_POST method POST match HTTP POST method
Daniel Schneller9ff96c72016-04-11 17:45:29 +020015211METH_PUT method PUT match HTTP PUT method
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020015212METH_TRACE method TRACE match HTTP TRACE method
Emeric Brunbede3d02009-06-30 17:54:00 +020015213RDP_COOKIE req_rdp_cookie_cnt gt 0 match presence of an RDP cookie
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020015214REQ_CONTENT req_len gt 0 match data in the request buffer
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010015215TRUE always_true always match
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020015216WAIT_END wait_end wait for end of content analysis
15217---------------+-----------------------------+---------------------------------
Willy Tarreauced27012008-01-17 20:35:34 +010015218
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +010015219
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200152208. Logging
15221----------
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010015222
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010015223One of HAProxy's strong points certainly lies is its precise logs. It probably
15224provides the finest level of information available for such a product, which is
15225very important for troubleshooting complex environments. Standard information
15226provided in logs include client ports, TCP/HTTP state timers, precise session
15227state at termination and precise termination cause, information about decisions
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +010015228to direct traffic to a server, and of course the ability to capture arbitrary
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010015229headers.
15230
15231In order to improve administrators reactivity, it offers a great transparency
15232about encountered problems, both internal and external, and it is possible to
15233send logs to different sources at the same time with different level filters :
15234
15235 - global process-level logs (system errors, start/stop, etc..)
15236 - per-instance system and internal errors (lack of resource, bugs, ...)
15237 - per-instance external troubles (servers up/down, max connections)
15238 - per-instance activity (client connections), either at the establishment or
15239 at the termination.
Jim Freeman9e8714b2015-05-26 09:16:34 -060015240 - per-request control of log-level, eg:
15241 http-request set-log-level silent if sensitive_request
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010015242
15243The ability to distribute different levels of logs to different log servers
15244allow several production teams to interact and to fix their problems as soon
15245as possible. For example, the system team might monitor system-wide errors,
15246while the application team might be monitoring the up/down for their servers in
15247real time, and the security team might analyze the activity logs with one hour
15248delay.
15249
15250
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200152518.1. Log levels
15252---------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010015253
Simon Hormandf791f52011-05-29 15:01:10 +090015254TCP and HTTP connections can be logged with information such as the date, time,
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010015255source IP address, destination address, connection duration, response times,
Simon Hormandf791f52011-05-29 15:01:10 +090015256HTTP request, HTTP return code, number of bytes transmitted, conditions
15257in which the session ended, and even exchanged cookies values. For example
15258track a particular user's problems. All messages may be sent to up to two
15259syslog servers. Check the "log" keyword in section 4.2 for more information
15260about log facilities.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010015261
15262
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200152638.2. Log formats
15264----------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010015265
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +010015266HAProxy supports 5 log formats. Several fields are common between these formats
Simon Hormandf791f52011-05-29 15:01:10 +090015267and will be detailed in the following sections. A few of them may vary
15268slightly with the configuration, due to indicators specific to certain
15269options. The supported formats are as follows :
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010015270
15271 - the default format, which is very basic and very rarely used. It only
15272 provides very basic information about the incoming connection at the moment
15273 it is accepted : source IP:port, destination IP:port, and frontend-name.
15274 This mode will eventually disappear so it will not be described to great
15275 extents.
15276
15277 - the TCP format, which is more advanced. This format is enabled when "option
15278 tcplog" is set on the frontend. HAProxy will then usually wait for the
15279 connection to terminate before logging. This format provides much richer
15280 information, such as timers, connection counts, queue size, etc... This
15281 format is recommended for pure TCP proxies.
15282
15283 - the HTTP format, which is the most advanced for HTTP proxying. This format
15284 is enabled when "option httplog" is set on the frontend. It provides the
15285 same information as the TCP format with some HTTP-specific fields such as
15286 the request, the status code, and captures of headers and cookies. This
15287 format is recommended for HTTP proxies.
15288
Emeric Brun3a058f32009-06-30 18:26:00 +020015289 - the CLF HTTP format, which is equivalent to the HTTP format, but with the
15290 fields arranged in the same order as the CLF format. In this mode, all
15291 timers, captures, flags, etc... appear one per field after the end of the
15292 common fields, in the same order they appear in the standard HTTP format.
15293
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +010015294 - the custom log format, allows you to make your own log line.
15295
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010015296Next sections will go deeper into details for each of these formats. Format
15297specification will be performed on a "field" basis. Unless stated otherwise, a
15298field is a portion of text delimited by any number of spaces. Since syslog
15299servers are susceptible of inserting fields at the beginning of a line, it is
15300always assumed that the first field is the one containing the process name and
15301identifier.
15302
15303Note : Since log lines may be quite long, the log examples in sections below
15304 might be broken into multiple lines. The example log lines will be
15305 prefixed with 3 closing angle brackets ('>>>') and each time a log is
15306 broken into multiple lines, each non-final line will end with a
15307 backslash ('\') and the next line will start indented by two characters.
15308
15309
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200153108.2.1. Default log format
15311-------------------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010015312
15313This format is used when no specific option is set. The log is emitted as soon
15314as the connection is accepted. One should note that this currently is the only
15315format which logs the request's destination IP and ports.
15316
15317 Example :
15318 listen www
15319 mode http
15320 log global
15321 server srv1 127.0.0.1:8000
15322
15323 >>> Feb 6 12:12:09 localhost \
15324 haproxy[14385]: Connect from 10.0.1.2:33312 to 10.0.3.31:8012 \
15325 (www/HTTP)
15326
15327 Field Format Extract from the example above
15328 1 process_name '[' pid ']:' haproxy[14385]:
15329 2 'Connect from' Connect from
15330 3 source_ip ':' source_port 10.0.1.2:33312
15331 4 'to' to
15332 5 destination_ip ':' destination_port 10.0.3.31:8012
15333 6 '(' frontend_name '/' mode ')' (www/HTTP)
15334
15335Detailed fields description :
15336 - "source_ip" is the IP address of the client which initiated the connection.
15337 - "source_port" is the TCP port of the client which initiated the connection.
15338 - "destination_ip" is the IP address the client connected to.
15339 - "destination_port" is the TCP port the client connected to.
15340 - "frontend_name" is the name of the frontend (or listener) which received
15341 and processed the connection.
15342 - "mode is the mode the frontend is operating (TCP or HTTP).
15343
Willy Tarreauceb24bc2010-11-09 12:46:41 +010015344In case of a UNIX socket, the source and destination addresses are marked as
15345"unix:" and the ports reflect the internal ID of the socket which accepted the
15346connection (the same ID as reported in the stats).
15347
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010015348It is advised not to use this deprecated format for newer installations as it
15349will eventually disappear.
15350
15351
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200153528.2.2. TCP log format
15353---------------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010015354
15355The TCP format is used when "option tcplog" is specified in the frontend, and
15356is the recommended format for pure TCP proxies. It provides a lot of precious
15357information for troubleshooting. Since this format includes timers and byte
15358counts, the log is normally emitted at the end of the session. It can be
15359emitted earlier if "option logasap" is specified, which makes sense in most
15360environments with long sessions such as remote terminals. Sessions which match
15361the "monitor" rules are never logged. It is also possible not to emit logs for
15362sessions for which no data were exchanged between the client and the server, by
Willy Tarreauc9bd0cc2009-05-10 11:57:02 +020015363specifying "option dontlognull" in the frontend. Successful connections will
15364not be logged if "option dontlog-normal" is specified in the frontend. A few
15365fields may slightly vary depending on some configuration options, those are
15366marked with a star ('*') after the field name below.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010015367
15368 Example :
15369 frontend fnt
15370 mode tcp
15371 option tcplog
15372 log global
15373 default_backend bck
15374
15375 backend bck
15376 server srv1 127.0.0.1:8000
15377
15378 >>> Feb 6 12:12:56 localhost \
15379 haproxy[14387]: 10.0.1.2:33313 [06/Feb/2009:12:12:51.443] fnt \
15380 bck/srv1 0/0/5007 212 -- 0/0/0/0/3 0/0
15381
15382 Field Format Extract from the example above
15383 1 process_name '[' pid ']:' haproxy[14387]:
15384 2 client_ip ':' client_port 10.0.1.2:33313
15385 3 '[' accept_date ']' [06/Feb/2009:12:12:51.443]
15386 4 frontend_name fnt
15387 5 backend_name '/' server_name bck/srv1
15388 6 Tw '/' Tc '/' Tt* 0/0/5007
15389 7 bytes_read* 212
15390 8 termination_state --
15391 9 actconn '/' feconn '/' beconn '/' srv_conn '/' retries* 0/0/0/0/3
15392 10 srv_queue '/' backend_queue 0/0
15393
15394Detailed fields description :
15395 - "client_ip" is the IP address of the client which initiated the TCP
Willy Tarreauceb24bc2010-11-09 12:46:41 +010015396 connection to haproxy. If the connection was accepted on a UNIX socket
15397 instead, the IP address would be replaced with the word "unix". Note that
15398 when the connection is accepted on a socket configured with "accept-proxy"
Bertrand Jacquin93b227d2016-06-04 15:11:10 +010015399 and the PROXY protocol is correctly used, or with a "accept-netscaler-cip"
15400 and the NetScaler Client IP insetion protocol is correctly used, then the
15401 logs will reflect the forwarded connection's information.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010015402
15403 - "client_port" is the TCP port of the client which initiated the connection.
Willy Tarreauceb24bc2010-11-09 12:46:41 +010015404 If the connection was accepted on a UNIX socket instead, the port would be
15405 replaced with the ID of the accepting socket, which is also reported in the
15406 stats interface.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010015407
15408 - "accept_date" is the exact date when the connection was received by haproxy
15409 (which might be very slightly different from the date observed on the
15410 network if there was some queuing in the system's backlog). This is usually
15411 the same date which may appear in any upstream firewall's log.
15412
15413 - "frontend_name" is the name of the frontend (or listener) which received
15414 and processed the connection.
15415
15416 - "backend_name" is the name of the backend (or listener) which was selected
15417 to manage the connection to the server. This will be the same as the
15418 frontend if no switching rule has been applied, which is common for TCP
15419 applications.
15420
15421 - "server_name" is the name of the last server to which the connection was
15422 sent, which might differ from the first one if there were connection errors
15423 and a redispatch occurred. Note that this server belongs to the backend
15424 which processed the request. If the connection was aborted before reaching
15425 a server, "<NOSRV>" is indicated instead of a server name.
15426
15427 - "Tw" is the total time in milliseconds spent waiting in the various queues.
15428 It can be "-1" if the connection was aborted before reaching the queue.
15429 See "Timers" below for more details.
15430
15431 - "Tc" is the total time in milliseconds spent waiting for the connection to
15432 establish to the final server, including retries. It can be "-1" if the
15433 connection was aborted before a connection could be established. See
15434 "Timers" below for more details.
15435
15436 - "Tt" is the total time in milliseconds elapsed between the accept and the
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030015437 last close. It covers all possible processing. There is one exception, if
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010015438 "option logasap" was specified, then the time counting stops at the moment
15439 the log is emitted. In this case, a '+' sign is prepended before the value,
15440 indicating that the final one will be larger. See "Timers" below for more
15441 details.
15442
15443 - "bytes_read" is the total number of bytes transmitted from the server to
15444 the client when the log is emitted. If "option logasap" is specified, the
15445 this value will be prefixed with a '+' sign indicating that the final one
15446 may be larger. Please note that this value is a 64-bit counter, so log
15447 analysis tools must be able to handle it without overflowing.
15448
15449 - "termination_state" is the condition the session was in when the session
15450 ended. This indicates the session state, which side caused the end of
15451 session to happen, and for what reason (timeout, error, ...). The normal
15452 flags should be "--", indicating the session was closed by either end with
15453 no data remaining in buffers. See below "Session state at disconnection"
15454 for more details.
15455
15456 - "actconn" is the total number of concurrent connections on the process when
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -040015457 the session was logged. It is useful to detect when some per-process system
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010015458 limits have been reached. For instance, if actconn is close to 512 when
15459 multiple connection errors occur, chances are high that the system limits
15460 the process to use a maximum of 1024 file descriptors and that all of them
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020015461 are used. See section 3 "Global parameters" to find how to tune the system.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010015462
15463 - "feconn" is the total number of concurrent connections on the frontend when
15464 the session was logged. It is useful to estimate the amount of resource
15465 required to sustain high loads, and to detect when the frontend's "maxconn"
15466 has been reached. Most often when this value increases by huge jumps, it is
15467 because there is congestion on the backend servers, but sometimes it can be
15468 caused by a denial of service attack.
15469
15470 - "beconn" is the total number of concurrent connections handled by the
15471 backend when the session was logged. It includes the total number of
15472 concurrent connections active on servers as well as the number of
15473 connections pending in queues. It is useful to estimate the amount of
15474 additional servers needed to support high loads for a given application.
15475 Most often when this value increases by huge jumps, it is because there is
15476 congestion on the backend servers, but sometimes it can be caused by a
15477 denial of service attack.
15478
15479 - "srv_conn" is the total number of concurrent connections still active on
15480 the server when the session was logged. It can never exceed the server's
15481 configured "maxconn" parameter. If this value is very often close or equal
15482 to the server's "maxconn", it means that traffic regulation is involved a
15483 lot, meaning that either the server's maxconn value is too low, or that
15484 there aren't enough servers to process the load with an optimal response
15485 time. When only one of the server's "srv_conn" is high, it usually means
15486 that this server has some trouble causing the connections to take longer to
15487 be processed than on other servers.
15488
15489 - "retries" is the number of connection retries experienced by this session
15490 when trying to connect to the server. It must normally be zero, unless a
15491 server is being stopped at the same moment the connection was attempted.
15492 Frequent retries generally indicate either a network problem between
15493 haproxy and the server, or a misconfigured system backlog on the server
15494 preventing new connections from being queued. This field may optionally be
15495 prefixed with a '+' sign, indicating that the session has experienced a
15496 redispatch after the maximal retry count has been reached on the initial
15497 server. In this case, the server name appearing in the log is the one the
15498 connection was redispatched to, and not the first one, though both may
15499 sometimes be the same in case of hashing for instance. So as a general rule
15500 of thumb, when a '+' is present in front of the retry count, this count
15501 should not be attributed to the logged server.
15502
15503 - "srv_queue" is the total number of requests which were processed before
15504 this one in the server queue. It is zero when the request has not gone
15505 through the server queue. It makes it possible to estimate the approximate
15506 server's response time by dividing the time spent in queue by the number of
15507 requests in the queue. It is worth noting that if a session experiences a
15508 redispatch and passes through two server queues, their positions will be
15509 cumulated. A request should not pass through both the server queue and the
15510 backend queue unless a redispatch occurs.
15511
15512 - "backend_queue" is the total number of requests which were processed before
15513 this one in the backend's global queue. It is zero when the request has not
15514 gone through the global queue. It makes it possible to estimate the average
15515 queue length, which easily translates into a number of missing servers when
15516 divided by a server's "maxconn" parameter. It is worth noting that if a
15517 session experiences a redispatch, it may pass twice in the backend's queue,
15518 and then both positions will be cumulated. A request should not pass
15519 through both the server queue and the backend queue unless a redispatch
15520 occurs.
15521
15522
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200155238.2.3. HTTP log format
15524----------------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010015525
15526The HTTP format is the most complete and the best suited for HTTP proxies. It
15527is enabled by when "option httplog" is specified in the frontend. It provides
15528the same level of information as the TCP format with additional features which
15529are specific to the HTTP protocol. Just like the TCP format, the log is usually
15530emitted at the end of the session, unless "option logasap" is specified, which
15531generally only makes sense for download sites. A session which matches the
15532"monitor" rules will never logged. It is also possible not to log sessions for
15533which no data were sent by the client by specifying "option dontlognull" in the
Willy Tarreauc9bd0cc2009-05-10 11:57:02 +020015534frontend. Successful connections will not be logged if "option dontlog-normal"
15535is specified in the frontend.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010015536
15537Most fields are shared with the TCP log, some being different. A few fields may
15538slightly vary depending on some configuration options. Those ones are marked
15539with a star ('*') after the field name below.
15540
15541 Example :
15542 frontend http-in
15543 mode http
15544 option httplog
15545 log global
15546 default_backend bck
15547
15548 backend static
15549 server srv1 127.0.0.1:8000
15550
15551 >>> Feb 6 12:14:14 localhost \
15552 haproxy[14389]: 10.0.1.2:33317 [06/Feb/2009:12:14:14.655] http-in \
15553 static/srv1 10/0/30/69/109 200 2750 - - ---- 1/1/1/1/0 0/0 {1wt.eu} \
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +010015554 {} "GET /index.html HTTP/1.1"
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010015555
15556 Field Format Extract from the example above
15557 1 process_name '[' pid ']:' haproxy[14389]:
15558 2 client_ip ':' client_port 10.0.1.2:33317
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020015559 3 '[' request_date ']' [06/Feb/2009:12:14:14.655]
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010015560 4 frontend_name http-in
15561 5 backend_name '/' server_name static/srv1
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020015562 6 TR '/' Tw '/' Tc '/' Tr '/' Ta* 10/0/30/69/109
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010015563 7 status_code 200
15564 8 bytes_read* 2750
15565 9 captured_request_cookie -
15566 10 captured_response_cookie -
15567 11 termination_state ----
15568 12 actconn '/' feconn '/' beconn '/' srv_conn '/' retries* 1/1/1/1/0
15569 13 srv_queue '/' backend_queue 0/0
15570 14 '{' captured_request_headers* '}' {haproxy.1wt.eu}
15571 15 '{' captured_response_headers* '}' {}
15572 16 '"' http_request '"' "GET /index.html HTTP/1.1"
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +010015573
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010015574Detailed fields description :
15575 - "client_ip" is the IP address of the client which initiated the TCP
Willy Tarreauceb24bc2010-11-09 12:46:41 +010015576 connection to haproxy. If the connection was accepted on a UNIX socket
15577 instead, the IP address would be replaced with the word "unix". Note that
15578 when the connection is accepted on a socket configured with "accept-proxy"
Bertrand Jacquin93b227d2016-06-04 15:11:10 +010015579 and the PROXY protocol is correctly used, or with a "accept-netscaler-cip"
15580 and the NetScaler Client IP insetion protocol is correctly used, then the
15581 logs will reflect the forwarded connection's information.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010015582
15583 - "client_port" is the TCP port of the client which initiated the connection.
Willy Tarreauceb24bc2010-11-09 12:46:41 +010015584 If the connection was accepted on a UNIX socket instead, the port would be
15585 replaced with the ID of the accepting socket, which is also reported in the
15586 stats interface.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010015587
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020015588 - "request_date" is the exact date when the first byte of the HTTP request
15589 was received by haproxy (log field %tr).
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010015590
15591 - "frontend_name" is the name of the frontend (or listener) which received
15592 and processed the connection.
15593
15594 - "backend_name" is the name of the backend (or listener) which was selected
15595 to manage the connection to the server. This will be the same as the
15596 frontend if no switching rule has been applied.
15597
15598 - "server_name" is the name of the last server to which the connection was
15599 sent, which might differ from the first one if there were connection errors
15600 and a redispatch occurred. Note that this server belongs to the backend
15601 which processed the request. If the request was aborted before reaching a
15602 server, "<NOSRV>" is indicated instead of a server name. If the request was
15603 intercepted by the stats subsystem, "<STATS>" is indicated instead.
15604
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020015605 - "TR" is the total time in milliseconds spent waiting for a full HTTP
15606 request from the client (not counting body) after the first byte was
15607 received. It can be "-1" if the connection was aborted before a complete
15608 request could be received or the a bad request was received. It should
15609 always be very small because a request generally fits in one single packet.
15610 Large times here generally indicate network issues between the client and
15611 haproxy or requests being typed by hand. See "Timers" below for more details.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010015612
15613 - "Tw" is the total time in milliseconds spent waiting in the various queues.
15614 It can be "-1" if the connection was aborted before reaching the queue.
15615 See "Timers" below for more details.
15616
15617 - "Tc" is the total time in milliseconds spent waiting for the connection to
15618 establish to the final server, including retries. It can be "-1" if the
15619 request was aborted before a connection could be established. See "Timers"
15620 below for more details.
15621
15622 - "Tr" is the total time in milliseconds spent waiting for the server to send
15623 a full HTTP response, not counting data. It can be "-1" if the request was
15624 aborted before a complete response could be received. It generally matches
15625 the server's processing time for the request, though it may be altered by
15626 the amount of data sent by the client to the server. Large times here on
15627 "GET" requests generally indicate an overloaded server. See "Timers" below
15628 for more details.
15629
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020015630 - "Ta" is the time the request remained active in haproxy, which is the total
15631 time in milliseconds elapsed between the first byte of the request was
15632 received and the last byte of response was sent. It covers all possible
15633 processing except the handshake (see Th) and idle time (see Ti). There is
15634 one exception, if "option logasap" was specified, then the time counting
15635 stops at the moment the log is emitted. In this case, a '+' sign is
15636 prepended before the value, indicating that the final one will be larger.
15637 See "Timers" below for more details.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010015638
15639 - "status_code" is the HTTP status code returned to the client. This status
15640 is generally set by the server, but it might also be set by haproxy when
15641 the server cannot be reached or when its response is blocked by haproxy.
15642
15643 - "bytes_read" is the total number of bytes transmitted to the client when
15644 the log is emitted. This does include HTTP headers. If "option logasap" is
15645 specified, the this value will be prefixed with a '+' sign indicating that
15646 the final one may be larger. Please note that this value is a 64-bit
15647 counter, so log analysis tools must be able to handle it without
15648 overflowing.
15649
15650 - "captured_request_cookie" is an optional "name=value" entry indicating that
15651 the client had this cookie in the request. The cookie name and its maximum
15652 length are defined by the "capture cookie" statement in the frontend
15653 configuration. The field is a single dash ('-') when the option is not
15654 set. Only one cookie may be captured, it is generally used to track session
15655 ID exchanges between a client and a server to detect session crossing
15656 between clients due to application bugs. For more details, please consult
15657 the section "Capturing HTTP headers and cookies" below.
15658
15659 - "captured_response_cookie" is an optional "name=value" entry indicating
15660 that the server has returned a cookie with its response. The cookie name
15661 and its maximum length are defined by the "capture cookie" statement in the
15662 frontend configuration. The field is a single dash ('-') when the option is
15663 not set. Only one cookie may be captured, it is generally used to track
15664 session ID exchanges between a client and a server to detect session
15665 crossing between clients due to application bugs. For more details, please
15666 consult the section "Capturing HTTP headers and cookies" below.
15667
15668 - "termination_state" is the condition the session was in when the session
15669 ended. This indicates the session state, which side caused the end of
15670 session to happen, for what reason (timeout, error, ...), just like in TCP
15671 logs, and information about persistence operations on cookies in the last
15672 two characters. The normal flags should begin with "--", indicating the
15673 session was closed by either end with no data remaining in buffers. See
15674 below "Session state at disconnection" for more details.
15675
15676 - "actconn" is the total number of concurrent connections on the process when
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -040015677 the session was logged. It is useful to detect when some per-process system
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010015678 limits have been reached. For instance, if actconn is close to 512 or 1024
15679 when multiple connection errors occur, chances are high that the system
15680 limits the process to use a maximum of 1024 file descriptors and that all
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020015681 of them are used. See section 3 "Global parameters" to find how to tune the
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010015682 system.
15683
15684 - "feconn" is the total number of concurrent connections on the frontend when
15685 the session was logged. It is useful to estimate the amount of resource
15686 required to sustain high loads, and to detect when the frontend's "maxconn"
15687 has been reached. Most often when this value increases by huge jumps, it is
15688 because there is congestion on the backend servers, but sometimes it can be
15689 caused by a denial of service attack.
15690
15691 - "beconn" is the total number of concurrent connections handled by the
15692 backend when the session was logged. It includes the total number of
15693 concurrent connections active on servers as well as the number of
15694 connections pending in queues. It is useful to estimate the amount of
15695 additional servers needed to support high loads for a given application.
15696 Most often when this value increases by huge jumps, it is because there is
15697 congestion on the backend servers, but sometimes it can be caused by a
15698 denial of service attack.
15699
15700 - "srv_conn" is the total number of concurrent connections still active on
15701 the server when the session was logged. It can never exceed the server's
15702 configured "maxconn" parameter. If this value is very often close or equal
15703 to the server's "maxconn", it means that traffic regulation is involved a
15704 lot, meaning that either the server's maxconn value is too low, or that
15705 there aren't enough servers to process the load with an optimal response
15706 time. When only one of the server's "srv_conn" is high, it usually means
15707 that this server has some trouble causing the requests to take longer to be
15708 processed than on other servers.
15709
15710 - "retries" is the number of connection retries experienced by this session
15711 when trying to connect to the server. It must normally be zero, unless a
15712 server is being stopped at the same moment the connection was attempted.
15713 Frequent retries generally indicate either a network problem between
15714 haproxy and the server, or a misconfigured system backlog on the server
15715 preventing new connections from being queued. This field may optionally be
15716 prefixed with a '+' sign, indicating that the session has experienced a
15717 redispatch after the maximal retry count has been reached on the initial
15718 server. In this case, the server name appearing in the log is the one the
15719 connection was redispatched to, and not the first one, though both may
15720 sometimes be the same in case of hashing for instance. So as a general rule
15721 of thumb, when a '+' is present in front of the retry count, this count
15722 should not be attributed to the logged server.
15723
15724 - "srv_queue" is the total number of requests which were processed before
15725 this one in the server queue. It is zero when the request has not gone
15726 through the server queue. It makes it possible to estimate the approximate
15727 server's response time by dividing the time spent in queue by the number of
15728 requests in the queue. It is worth noting that if a session experiences a
15729 redispatch and passes through two server queues, their positions will be
15730 cumulated. A request should not pass through both the server queue and the
15731 backend queue unless a redispatch occurs.
15732
15733 - "backend_queue" is the total number of requests which were processed before
15734 this one in the backend's global queue. It is zero when the request has not
15735 gone through the global queue. It makes it possible to estimate the average
15736 queue length, which easily translates into a number of missing servers when
15737 divided by a server's "maxconn" parameter. It is worth noting that if a
15738 session experiences a redispatch, it may pass twice in the backend's queue,
15739 and then both positions will be cumulated. A request should not pass
15740 through both the server queue and the backend queue unless a redispatch
15741 occurs.
15742
15743 - "captured_request_headers" is a list of headers captured in the request due
15744 to the presence of the "capture request header" statement in the frontend.
15745 Multiple headers can be captured, they will be delimited by a vertical bar
15746 ('|'). When no capture is enabled, the braces do not appear, causing a
15747 shift of remaining fields. It is important to note that this field may
15748 contain spaces, and that using it requires a smarter log parser than when
15749 it's not used. Please consult the section "Capturing HTTP headers and
15750 cookies" below for more details.
15751
15752 - "captured_response_headers" is a list of headers captured in the response
15753 due to the presence of the "capture response header" statement in the
15754 frontend. Multiple headers can be captured, they will be delimited by a
15755 vertical bar ('|'). When no capture is enabled, the braces do not appear,
15756 causing a shift of remaining fields. It is important to note that this
15757 field may contain spaces, and that using it requires a smarter log parser
15758 than when it's not used. Please consult the section "Capturing HTTP headers
15759 and cookies" below for more details.
15760
15761 - "http_request" is the complete HTTP request line, including the method,
15762 request and HTTP version string. Non-printable characters are encoded (see
15763 below the section "Non-printable characters"). This is always the last
15764 field, and it is always delimited by quotes and is the only one which can
15765 contain quotes. If new fields are added to the log format, they will be
15766 added before this field. This field might be truncated if the request is
15767 huge and does not fit in the standard syslog buffer (1024 characters). This
15768 is the reason why this field must always remain the last one.
15769
15770
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +0200157718.2.4. Custom log format
15772------------------------
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +010015773
Willy Tarreau2beef582012-12-20 17:22:52 +010015774The directive log-format allows you to customize the logs in http mode and tcp
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010015775mode. It takes a string as argument.
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +010015776
15777HAproxy understands some log format variables. % precedes log format variables.
15778Variables can take arguments using braces ('{}'), and multiple arguments are
15779separated by commas within the braces. Flags may be added or removed by
15780prefixing them with a '+' or '-' sign.
15781
15782Special variable "%o" may be used to propagate its flags to all other
15783variables on the same format string. This is particularly handy with quoted
Dragan Dosen835b9212016-02-12 13:23:03 +010015784("Q") and escaped ("E") string formats.
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +010015785
Willy Tarreauc8368452012-12-21 00:09:23 +010015786If a variable is named between square brackets ('[' .. ']') then it is used
Willy Tarreaube722a22014-06-13 16:31:59 +020015787as a sample expression rule (see section 7.3). This it useful to add some
Willy Tarreauc8368452012-12-21 00:09:23 +010015788less common information such as the client's SSL certificate's DN, or to log
15789the key that would be used to store an entry into a stick table.
15790
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +010015791Note: spaces must be escaped. A space character is considered as a separator.
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030015792In order to emit a verbatim '%', it must be preceded by another '%' resulting
Willy Tarreau06d97f92013-12-02 17:45:48 +010015793in '%%'. HAProxy will automatically merge consecutive separators.
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +010015794
Dragan Dosen835b9212016-02-12 13:23:03 +010015795Note: when using the RFC5424 syslog message format, the characters '"',
15796'\' and ']' inside PARAM-VALUE should be escaped with '\' as prefix (see
15797https://tools.ietf.org/html/rfc5424#section-6.3.3 for more details). In
15798such cases, the use of the flag "E" should be considered.
15799
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +010015800Flags are :
15801 * Q: quote a string
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -040015802 * X: hexadecimal representation (IPs, Ports, %Ts, %rt, %pid)
Dragan Dosen835b9212016-02-12 13:23:03 +010015803 * E: escape characters '"', '\' and ']' in a string with '\' as prefix
15804 (intended purpose is for the RFC5424 structured-data log formats)
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +010015805
15806 Example:
15807
15808 log-format %T\ %t\ Some\ Text
15809 log-format %{+Q}o\ %t\ %s\ %{-Q}r
15810
Dragan Dosen835b9212016-02-12 13:23:03 +010015811 log-format-sd %{+Q,+E}o\ [exampleSDID@1234\ header=%[capture.req.hdr(0)]]
15812
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +010015813At the moment, the default HTTP format is defined this way :
15814
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020015815 log-format "%ci:%cp [%tr] %ft %b/%s %TR/%Tw/%Tc/%Tr/%Ta %ST %B %CC \
15816 %CS %tsc %ac/%fc/%bc/%sc/%rc %sq/%bq %hr %hs %{+Q}r"
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +010015817
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010015818the default CLF format is defined this way :
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +010015819
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020015820 log-format "%{+Q}o %{-Q}ci - - [%trg] %r %ST %B \"\" \"\" %cp \
15821 %ms %ft %b %s %TR %Tw %Tc %Tr %Ta %tsc %ac %fc \
15822 %bc %sc %rc %sq %bq %CC %CS %hrl %hsl"
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +010015823
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010015824and the default TCP format is defined this way :
15825
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020015826 log-format "%ci:%cp [%t] %ft %b/%s %Tw/%Tc/%Tt %B %ts \
15827 %ac/%fc/%bc/%sc/%rc %sq/%bq"
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010015828
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +010015829Please refer to the table below for currently defined variables :
15830
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010015831 +---+------+-----------------------------------------------+-------------+
Willy Tarreauffc3fcd2012-10-12 20:17:54 +020015832 | R | var | field name (8.2.2 and 8.2.3 for description) | type |
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010015833 +---+------+-----------------------------------------------+-------------+
15834 | | %o | special variable, apply flags on all next var | |
15835 +---+------+-----------------------------------------------+-------------+
Willy Tarreau2beef582012-12-20 17:22:52 +010015836 | | %B | bytes_read (from server to client) | numeric |
15837 | H | %CC | captured_request_cookie | string |
15838 | H | %CS | captured_response_cookie | string |
William Lallemand5f232402012-04-05 18:02:55 +020015839 | | %H | hostname | string |
Andrew Hayworth0ebc55f2015-04-27 21:37:03 +000015840 | H | %HM | HTTP method (ex: POST) | string |
15841 | H | %HP | HTTP request URI without query string (path) | string |
Andrew Hayworthe63ac872015-07-31 16:14:16 +000015842 | H | %HQ | HTTP request URI query string (ex: ?bar=baz) | string |
Andrew Hayworth0ebc55f2015-04-27 21:37:03 +000015843 | H | %HU | HTTP request URI (ex: /foo?bar=baz) | string |
15844 | H | %HV | HTTP version (ex: HTTP/1.0) | string |
William Lallemanda73203e2012-03-12 12:48:57 +010015845 | | %ID | unique-id | string |
Willy Tarreau4bf99632014-06-13 12:21:40 +020015846 | | %ST | status_code | numeric |
William Lallemand5f232402012-04-05 18:02:55 +020015847 | | %T | gmt_date_time | date |
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020015848 | | %Ta | Active time of the request (from TR to end) | numeric |
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010015849 | | %Tc | Tc | numeric |
Willy Tarreau27b639d2016-05-17 17:55:27 +020015850 | | %Td | Td = Tt - (Tq + Tw + Tc + Tr) | numeric |
Yuxans Yao4e25b012012-10-19 10:36:09 +080015851 | | %Tl | local_date_time | date |
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020015852 | | %Th | connection handshake time (SSL, PROXY proto) | numeric |
15853 | H | %Ti | idle time before the HTTP request | numeric |
15854 | H | %Tq | Th + Ti + TR | numeric |
15855 | H | %TR | time to receive the full request from 1st byte| numeric |
15856 | H | %Tr | Tr (response time) | numeric |
William Lallemand5f232402012-04-05 18:02:55 +020015857 | | %Ts | timestamp | numeric |
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010015858 | | %Tt | Tt | numeric |
15859 | | %Tw | Tw | numeric |
Willy Tarreau2beef582012-12-20 17:22:52 +010015860 | | %U | bytes_uploaded (from client to server) | numeric |
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010015861 | | %ac | actconn | numeric |
15862 | | %b | backend_name | string |
Willy Tarreau2beef582012-12-20 17:22:52 +010015863 | | %bc | beconn (backend concurrent connections) | numeric |
15864 | | %bi | backend_source_ip (connecting address) | IP |
15865 | | %bp | backend_source_port (connecting address) | numeric |
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010015866 | | %bq | backend_queue | numeric |
Willy Tarreau2beef582012-12-20 17:22:52 +010015867 | | %ci | client_ip (accepted address) | IP |
15868 | | %cp | client_port (accepted address) | numeric |
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010015869 | | %f | frontend_name | string |
Willy Tarreau2beef582012-12-20 17:22:52 +010015870 | | %fc | feconn (frontend concurrent connections) | numeric |
15871 | | %fi | frontend_ip (accepting address) | IP |
15872 | | %fp | frontend_port (accepting address) | numeric |
Willy Tarreau773d65f2012-10-12 14:56:11 +020015873 | | %ft | frontend_name_transport ('~' suffix for SSL) | string |
Willy Tarreau7346acb2014-08-28 15:03:15 +020015874 | | %lc | frontend_log_counter | numeric |
Willy Tarreaud9ed3d22014-06-13 12:23:06 +020015875 | | %hr | captured_request_headers default style | string |
15876 | | %hrl | captured_request_headers CLF style | string list |
15877 | | %hs | captured_response_headers default style | string |
15878 | | %hsl | captured_response_headers CLF style | string list |
Willy Tarreau812c88e2015-08-09 10:56:35 +020015879 | | %ms | accept date milliseconds (left-padded with 0) | numeric |
William Lallemand5f232402012-04-05 18:02:55 +020015880 | | %pid | PID | numeric |
Willy Tarreauffc3fcd2012-10-12 20:17:54 +020015881 | H | %r | http_request | string |
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010015882 | | %rc | retries | numeric |
Willy Tarreau1f0da242014-01-25 11:01:50 +010015883 | | %rt | request_counter (HTTP req or TCP session) | numeric |
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010015884 | | %s | server_name | string |
Willy Tarreau2beef582012-12-20 17:22:52 +010015885 | | %sc | srv_conn (server concurrent connections) | numeric |
15886 | | %si | server_IP (target address) | IP |
15887 | | %sp | server_port (target address) | numeric |
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010015888 | | %sq | srv_queue | numeric |
Willy Tarreauffc3fcd2012-10-12 20:17:54 +020015889 | S | %sslc| ssl_ciphers (ex: AES-SHA) | string |
15890 | S | %sslv| ssl_version (ex: TLSv1) | string |
Willy Tarreau2beef582012-12-20 17:22:52 +010015891 | | %t | date_time (with millisecond resolution) | date |
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020015892 | H | %tr | date_time of HTTP request | date |
15893 | H | %trg | gmt_date_time of start of HTTP request | date |
15894 | H | %trl | locla_date_time of start of HTTP request | date |
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010015895 | | %ts | termination_state | string |
Willy Tarreauffc3fcd2012-10-12 20:17:54 +020015896 | H | %tsc | termination_state with cookie status | string |
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010015897 +---+------+-----------------------------------------------+-------------+
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +010015898
Willy Tarreauffc3fcd2012-10-12 20:17:54 +020015899 R = Restrictions : H = mode http only ; S = SSL only
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +010015900
Willy Tarreau5f51e1a2012-12-03 18:40:10 +010015901
159028.2.5. Error log format
15903-----------------------
15904
15905When an incoming connection fails due to an SSL handshake or an invalid PROXY
15906protocol header, haproxy will log the event using a shorter, fixed line format.
15907By default, logs are emitted at the LOG_INFO level, unless the option
15908"log-separate-errors" is set in the backend, in which case the LOG_ERR level
15909will be used. Connections on which no data are exchanged (eg: probes) are not
15910logged if the "dontlognull" option is set.
15911
15912The format looks like this :
15913
15914 >>> Dec 3 18:27:14 localhost \
15915 haproxy[6103]: 127.0.0.1:56059 [03/Dec/2012:17:35:10.380] frt/f1: \
15916 Connection error during SSL handshake
15917
15918 Field Format Extract from the example above
15919 1 process_name '[' pid ']:' haproxy[6103]:
15920 2 client_ip ':' client_port 127.0.0.1:56059
15921 3 '[' accept_date ']' [03/Dec/2012:17:35:10.380]
15922 4 frontend_name "/" bind_name ":" frt/f1:
15923 5 message Connection error during SSL handshake
15924
15925These fields just provide minimal information to help debugging connection
15926failures.
15927
15928
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200159298.3. Advanced logging options
15930-----------------------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010015931
15932Some advanced logging options are often looked for but are not easy to find out
15933just by looking at the various options. Here is an entry point for the few
15934options which can enable better logging. Please refer to the keywords reference
15935for more information about their usage.
15936
15937
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200159388.3.1. Disabling logging of external tests
15939------------------------------------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010015940
15941It is quite common to have some monitoring tools perform health checks on
15942haproxy. Sometimes it will be a layer 3 load-balancer such as LVS or any
15943commercial load-balancer, and sometimes it will simply be a more complete
15944monitoring system such as Nagios. When the tests are very frequent, users often
15945ask how to disable logging for those checks. There are three possibilities :
15946
15947 - if connections come from everywhere and are just TCP probes, it is often
15948 desired to simply disable logging of connections without data exchange, by
15949 setting "option dontlognull" in the frontend. It also disables logging of
15950 port scans, which may or may not be desired.
15951
15952 - if the connection come from a known source network, use "monitor-net" to
15953 declare this network as monitoring only. Any host in this network will then
15954 only be able to perform health checks, and their requests will not be
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030015955 logged. This is generally appropriate to designate a list of equipment
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010015956 such as other load-balancers.
15957
15958 - if the tests are performed on a known URI, use "monitor-uri" to declare
15959 this URI as dedicated to monitoring. Any host sending this request will
15960 only get the result of a health-check, and the request will not be logged.
15961
15962
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200159638.3.2. Logging before waiting for the session to terminate
15964----------------------------------------------------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010015965
15966The problem with logging at end of connection is that you have no clue about
15967what is happening during very long sessions, such as remote terminal sessions
15968or large file downloads. This problem can be worked around by specifying
15969"option logasap" in the frontend. Haproxy will then log as soon as possible,
15970just before data transfer begins. This means that in case of TCP, it will still
15971log the connection status to the server, and in case of HTTP, it will log just
15972after processing the server headers. In this case, the number of bytes reported
15973is the number of header bytes sent to the client. In order to avoid confusion
15974with normal logs, the total time field and the number of bytes are prefixed
15975with a '+' sign which means that real numbers are certainly larger.
15976
15977
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200159788.3.3. Raising log level upon errors
15979------------------------------------
Willy Tarreauc9bd0cc2009-05-10 11:57:02 +020015980
15981Sometimes it is more convenient to separate normal traffic from errors logs,
15982for instance in order to ease error monitoring from log files. When the option
15983"log-separate-errors" is used, connections which experience errors, timeouts,
15984retries, redispatches or HTTP status codes 5xx will see their syslog level
15985raised from "info" to "err". This will help a syslog daemon store the log in
15986a separate file. It is very important to keep the errors in the normal traffic
15987file too, so that log ordering is not altered. You should also be careful if
15988you already have configured your syslog daemon to store all logs higher than
15989"notice" in an "admin" file, because the "err" level is higher than "notice".
15990
15991
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200159928.3.4. Disabling logging of successful connections
15993--------------------------------------------------
Willy Tarreauc9bd0cc2009-05-10 11:57:02 +020015994
15995Although this may sound strange at first, some large sites have to deal with
15996multiple thousands of logs per second and are experiencing difficulties keeping
15997them intact for a long time or detecting errors within them. If the option
15998"dontlog-normal" is set on the frontend, all normal connections will not be
15999logged. In this regard, a normal connection is defined as one without any
16000error, timeout, retry nor redispatch. In HTTP, the status code is checked too,
16001and a response with a status 5xx is not considered normal and will be logged
16002too. Of course, doing is is really discouraged as it will remove most of the
16003useful information from the logs. Do this only if you have no other
16004alternative.
16005
16006
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200160078.4. Timing events
16008------------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010016009
16010Timers provide a great help in troubleshooting network problems. All values are
16011reported in milliseconds (ms). These timers should be used in conjunction with
16012the session termination flags. In TCP mode with "option tcplog" set on the
16013frontend, 3 control points are reported under the form "Tw/Tc/Tt", and in HTTP
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020016014mode, 5 control points are reported under the form "TR/Tw/Tc/Tr/Ta". In
16015addition, three other measures are provided, "Th", "Ti", and "Tq".
16016
Guillaume de Lafondf27cddc2016-12-23 17:32:43 +010016017Timings events in HTTP mode:
16018
16019 first request 2nd request
16020 |<-------------------------------->|<-------------- ...
16021 t tr t tr ...
16022 ---|----|----|----|----|----|----|----|----|--
16023 : Th Ti TR Tw Tc Tr Td : Ti ...
16024 :<---- Tq ---->: :
16025 :<-------------- Tt -------------->:
16026 :<--------- Ta --------->:
16027
16028Timings events in TCP mode:
16029
16030 TCP session
16031 |<----------------->|
16032 t t
16033 ---|----|----|----|----|---
16034 | Th Tw Tc Td |
16035 |<------ Tt ------->|
16036
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020016037 - Th: total time to accept tcp connection and execute handshakes for low level
16038 protocols. Currently, these protocoles are proxy-protocol and SSL. This may
16039 only happen once during the whole connection's lifetime. A large time here
16040 may indicate that the client only pre-established the connection without
16041 speaking, that it is experiencing network issues preventing it from
16042 completing a handshake in a reasonable time (eg: MTU issues), or that an
16043 SSL handshake was very expensive to compute.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010016044
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020016045 - Ti: is the idle time before the HTTP request (HTTP mode only). This timer
16046 counts between the end of the handshakes and the first byte of the HTTP
16047 request. When dealing with a second request in keep-alive mode, it starts
16048 to count after the end of the transmission the previous response. Some
16049 browsers pre-establish connections to a server in order to reduce the
16050 latency of a future request, and keep them pending until they need it. This
16051 delay will be reported as the idle time. A value of -1 indicates that
16052 nothing was received on the connection.
16053
16054 - TR: total time to get the client request (HTTP mode only). It's the time
16055 elapsed between the first bytes received and the moment the proxy received
16056 the empty line marking the end of the HTTP headers. The value "-1"
16057 indicates that the end of headers has never been seen. This happens when
16058 the client closes prematurely or times out. This time is usually very short
16059 since most requests fit in a single packet. A large time may indicate a
16060 request typed by hand during a test.
16061
16062 - Tq: total time to get the client request from the accept date or since the
16063 emission of the last byte of the previous response (HTTP mode only). It's
16064 exactly equalt to Th + Ti + TR unless any of them is -1, in which case it
16065 returns -1 as well. This timer used to be very useful before the arrival of
16066 HTTP keep-alive and browsers' pre-connect feature. It's recommended to drop
16067 it in favor of TR nowadays, as the idle time adds a lot of noise to the
16068 reports.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010016069
16070 - Tw: total time spent in the queues waiting for a connection slot. It
16071 accounts for backend queue as well as the server queues, and depends on the
16072 queue size, and the time needed for the server to complete previous
16073 requests. The value "-1" means that the request was killed before reaching
16074 the queue, which is generally what happens with invalid or denied requests.
16075
16076 - Tc: total time to establish the TCP connection to the server. It's the time
16077 elapsed between the moment the proxy sent the connection request, and the
16078 moment it was acknowledged by the server, or between the TCP SYN packet and
16079 the matching SYN/ACK packet in return. The value "-1" means that the
16080 connection never established.
16081
16082 - Tr: server response time (HTTP mode only). It's the time elapsed between
16083 the moment the TCP connection was established to the server and the moment
16084 the server sent its complete response headers. It purely shows its request
16085 processing time, without the network overhead due to the data transmission.
16086 It is worth noting that when the client has data to send to the server, for
16087 instance during a POST request, the time already runs, and this can distort
16088 apparent response time. For this reason, it's generally wise not to trust
16089 too much this field for POST requests initiated from clients behind an
16090 untrusted network. A value of "-1" here means that the last the response
16091 header (empty line) was never seen, most likely because the server timeout
16092 stroke before the server managed to process the request.
16093
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020016094 - Ta: total active time for the HTTP request, between the moment the proxy
16095 received the first byte of the request header and the emission of the last
16096 byte of the response body. The exception is when the "logasap" option is
16097 specified. In this case, it only equals (TR+Tw+Tc+Tr), and is prefixed with
16098 a '+' sign. From this field, we can deduce "Td", the data transmission time,
16099 by subtracting other timers when valid :
16100
16101 Td = Ta - (TR + Tw + Tc + Tr)
16102
16103 Timers with "-1" values have to be excluded from this equation. Note that
16104 "Ta" can never be negative.
16105
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010016106 - Tt: total session duration time, between the moment the proxy accepted it
16107 and the moment both ends were closed. The exception is when the "logasap"
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020016108 option is specified. In this case, it only equals (Th+Ti+TR+Tw+Tc+Tr), and
16109 is prefixed with a '+' sign. From this field, we can deduce "Td", the data
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030016110 transmission time, by subtracting other timers when valid :
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010016111
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020016112 Td = Tt - (Th + Ti + TR + Tw + Tc + Tr)
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010016113
16114 Timers with "-1" values have to be excluded from this equation. In TCP
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020016115 mode, "Ti", "Tq" and "Tr" have to be excluded too. Note that "Tt" can never
16116 be negative and that for HTTP, Tt is simply equal to (Th+Ti+Ta).
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010016117
16118These timers provide precious indications on trouble causes. Since the TCP
16119protocol defines retransmit delays of 3, 6, 12... seconds, we know for sure
16120that timers close to multiples of 3s are nearly always related to lost packets
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020016121due to network problems (wires, negotiation, congestion). Moreover, if "Ta" or
16122"Tt" is close to a timeout value specified in the configuration, it often means
16123that a session has been aborted on timeout.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010016124
16125Most common cases :
16126
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020016127 - If "Th" or "Ti" are close to 3000, a packet has probably been lost between
16128 the client and the proxy. This is very rare on local networks but might
16129 happen when clients are on far remote networks and send large requests. It
16130 may happen that values larger than usual appear here without any network
16131 cause. Sometimes, during an attack or just after a resource starvation has
16132 ended, haproxy may accept thousands of connections in a few milliseconds.
16133 The time spent accepting these connections will inevitably slightly delay
16134 processing of other connections, and it can happen that request times in the
16135 order of a few tens of milliseconds are measured after a few thousands of
16136 new connections have been accepted at once. Using one of the keep-alive
16137 modes may display larger idle times since "Ti" measures the time spent
Patrick Mezard105faca2010-06-12 17:02:46 +020016138 waiting for additional requests.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010016139
16140 - If "Tc" is close to 3000, a packet has probably been lost between the
16141 server and the proxy during the server connection phase. This value should
16142 always be very low, such as 1 ms on local networks and less than a few tens
16143 of ms on remote networks.
16144
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +020016145 - If "Tr" is nearly always lower than 3000 except some rare values which seem
16146 to be the average majored by 3000, there are probably some packets lost
16147 between the proxy and the server.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010016148
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020016149 - If "Ta" is large even for small byte counts, it generally is because
16150 neither the client nor the server decides to close the connection while
16151 haproxy is running in tunnel mode and both have agreed on a keep-alive
16152 connection mode. In order to solve this issue, it will be needed to specify
16153 one of the HTTP options to manipulate keep-alive or close options on either
16154 the frontend or the backend. Having the smallest possible 'Ta' or 'Tt' is
16155 important when connection regulation is used with the "maxconn" option on
16156 the servers, since no new connection will be sent to the server until
16157 another one is released.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010016158
16159Other noticeable HTTP log cases ('xx' means any value to be ignored) :
16160
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020016161 TR/Tw/Tc/Tr/+Ta The "option logasap" is present on the frontend and the log
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010016162 was emitted before the data phase. All the timers are valid
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020016163 except "Ta" which is shorter than reality.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010016164
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020016165 -1/xx/xx/xx/Ta The client was not able to send a complete request in time
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010016166 or it aborted too early. Check the session termination flags
16167 then "timeout http-request" and "timeout client" settings.
16168
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020016169 TR/-1/xx/xx/Ta It was not possible to process the request, maybe because
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010016170 servers were out of order, because the request was invalid
16171 or forbidden by ACL rules. Check the session termination
16172 flags.
16173
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020016174 TR/Tw/-1/xx/Ta The connection could not establish on the server. Either it
16175 actively refused it or it timed out after Ta-(TR+Tw) ms.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010016176 Check the session termination flags, then check the
16177 "timeout connect" setting. Note that the tarpit action might
16178 return similar-looking patterns, with "Tw" equal to the time
16179 the client connection was maintained open.
16180
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020016181 TR/Tw/Tc/-1/Ta The server has accepted the connection but did not return
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030016182 a complete response in time, or it closed its connection
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020016183 unexpectedly after Ta-(TR+Tw+Tc) ms. Check the session
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010016184 termination flags, then check the "timeout server" setting.
16185
16186
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200161878.5. Session state at disconnection
16188-----------------------------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010016189
16190TCP and HTTP logs provide a session termination indicator in the
16191"termination_state" field, just before the number of active connections. It is
161922-characters long in TCP mode, and is extended to 4 characters in HTTP mode,
16193each of which has a special meaning :
16194
16195 - On the first character, a code reporting the first event which caused the
16196 session to terminate :
16197
16198 C : the TCP session was unexpectedly aborted by the client.
16199
16200 S : the TCP session was unexpectedly aborted by the server, or the
16201 server explicitly refused it.
16202
16203 P : the session was prematurely aborted by the proxy, because of a
16204 connection limit enforcement, because a DENY filter was matched,
16205 because of a security check which detected and blocked a dangerous
16206 error in server response which might have caused information leak
Willy Tarreau570f2212013-06-10 16:42:09 +020016207 (eg: cacheable cookie).
16208
16209 L : the session was locally processed by haproxy and was not passed to
16210 a server. This is what happens for stats and redirects.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010016211
16212 R : a resource on the proxy has been exhausted (memory, sockets, source
16213 ports, ...). Usually, this appears during the connection phase, and
16214 system logs should contain a copy of the precise error. If this
16215 happens, it must be considered as a very serious anomaly which
16216 should be fixed as soon as possible by any means.
16217
16218 I : an internal error was identified by the proxy during a self-check.
16219 This should NEVER happen, and you are encouraged to report any log
16220 containing this, because this would almost certainly be a bug. It
16221 would be wise to preventively restart the process after such an
16222 event too, in case it would be caused by memory corruption.
16223
Simon Horman752dc4a2011-06-21 14:34:59 +090016224 D : the session was killed by haproxy because the server was detected
16225 as down and was configured to kill all connections when going down.
16226
Justin Karnegeseb2c24a2012-05-24 15:28:52 -070016227 U : the session was killed by haproxy on this backup server because an
16228 active server was detected as up and was configured to kill all
16229 backup connections when going up.
16230
Willy Tarreaua2a64e92011-09-07 23:01:56 +020016231 K : the session was actively killed by an admin operating on haproxy.
16232
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010016233 c : the client-side timeout expired while waiting for the client to
16234 send or receive data.
16235
16236 s : the server-side timeout expired while waiting for the server to
16237 send or receive data.
16238
16239 - : normal session completion, both the client and the server closed
16240 with nothing left in the buffers.
16241
16242 - on the second character, the TCP or HTTP session state when it was closed :
16243
Willy Tarreauf7b30a92010-12-06 22:59:17 +010016244 R : the proxy was waiting for a complete, valid REQUEST from the client
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010016245 (HTTP mode only). Nothing was sent to any server.
16246
16247 Q : the proxy was waiting in the QUEUE for a connection slot. This can
16248 only happen when servers have a 'maxconn' parameter set. It can
16249 also happen in the global queue after a redispatch consecutive to
16250 a failed attempt to connect to a dying server. If no redispatch is
16251 reported, then no connection attempt was made to any server.
16252
16253 C : the proxy was waiting for the CONNECTION to establish on the
16254 server. The server might at most have noticed a connection attempt.
16255
16256 H : the proxy was waiting for complete, valid response HEADERS from the
16257 server (HTTP only).
16258
16259 D : the session was in the DATA phase.
16260
16261 L : the proxy was still transmitting LAST data to the client while the
16262 server had already finished. This one is very rare as it can only
16263 happen when the client dies while receiving the last packets.
16264
16265 T : the request was tarpitted. It has been held open with the client
16266 during the whole "timeout tarpit" duration or until the client
16267 closed, both of which will be reported in the "Tw" timer.
16268
16269 - : normal session completion after end of data transfer.
16270
16271 - the third character tells whether the persistence cookie was provided by
16272 the client (only in HTTP mode) :
16273
16274 N : the client provided NO cookie. This is usually the case for new
16275 visitors, so counting the number of occurrences of this flag in the
16276 logs generally indicate a valid trend for the site frequentation.
16277
16278 I : the client provided an INVALID cookie matching no known server.
16279 This might be caused by a recent configuration change, mixed
Cyril Bontéa8e7bbc2010-04-25 22:29:29 +020016280 cookies between HTTP/HTTPS sites, persistence conditionally
16281 ignored, or an attack.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010016282
16283 D : the client provided a cookie designating a server which was DOWN,
16284 so either "option persist" was used and the client was sent to
16285 this server, or it was not set and the client was redispatched to
16286 another server.
16287
Willy Tarreau996a92c2010-10-13 19:30:47 +020016288 V : the client provided a VALID cookie, and was sent to the associated
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010016289 server.
16290
Willy Tarreau996a92c2010-10-13 19:30:47 +020016291 E : the client provided a valid cookie, but with a last date which was
16292 older than what is allowed by the "maxidle" cookie parameter, so
16293 the cookie is consider EXPIRED and is ignored. The request will be
16294 redispatched just as if there was no cookie.
16295
16296 O : the client provided a valid cookie, but with a first date which was
16297 older than what is allowed by the "maxlife" cookie parameter, so
16298 the cookie is consider too OLD and is ignored. The request will be
16299 redispatched just as if there was no cookie.
16300
Willy Tarreauc89ccb62012-04-05 21:18:22 +020016301 U : a cookie was present but was not used to select the server because
16302 some other server selection mechanism was used instead (typically a
16303 "use-server" rule).
16304
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010016305 - : does not apply (no cookie set in configuration).
16306
16307 - the last character reports what operations were performed on the persistence
16308 cookie returned by the server (only in HTTP mode) :
16309
16310 N : NO cookie was provided by the server, and none was inserted either.
16311
16312 I : no cookie was provided by the server, and the proxy INSERTED one.
16313 Note that in "cookie insert" mode, if the server provides a cookie,
16314 it will still be overwritten and reported as "I" here.
16315
Willy Tarreau996a92c2010-10-13 19:30:47 +020016316 U : the proxy UPDATED the last date in the cookie that was presented by
16317 the client. This can only happen in insert mode with "maxidle". It
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030016318 happens every time there is activity at a different date than the
Willy Tarreau996a92c2010-10-13 19:30:47 +020016319 date indicated in the cookie. If any other change happens, such as
16320 a redispatch, then the cookie will be marked as inserted instead.
16321
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010016322 P : a cookie was PROVIDED by the server and transmitted as-is.
16323
16324 R : the cookie provided by the server was REWRITTEN by the proxy, which
16325 happens in "cookie rewrite" or "cookie prefix" modes.
16326
16327 D : the cookie provided by the server was DELETED by the proxy.
16328
16329 - : does not apply (no cookie set in configuration).
16330
Willy Tarreau996a92c2010-10-13 19:30:47 +020016331The combination of the two first flags gives a lot of information about what
16332was happening when the session terminated, and why it did terminate. It can be
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010016333helpful to detect server saturation, network troubles, local system resource
16334starvation, attacks, etc...
16335
16336The most common termination flags combinations are indicated below. They are
16337alphabetically sorted, with the lowercase set just after the upper case for
16338easier finding and understanding.
16339
16340 Flags Reason
16341
16342 -- Normal termination.
16343
16344 CC The client aborted before the connection could be established to the
16345 server. This can happen when haproxy tries to connect to a recently
16346 dead (or unchecked) server, and the client aborts while haproxy is
16347 waiting for the server to respond or for "timeout connect" to expire.
16348
16349 CD The client unexpectedly aborted during data transfer. This can be
16350 caused by a browser crash, by an intermediate equipment between the
16351 client and haproxy which decided to actively break the connection,
16352 by network routing issues between the client and haproxy, or by a
16353 keep-alive session between the server and the client terminated first
16354 by the client.
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +010016355
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010016356 cD The client did not send nor acknowledge any data for as long as the
16357 "timeout client" delay. This is often caused by network failures on
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +020016358 the client side, or the client simply leaving the net uncleanly.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010016359
16360 CH The client aborted while waiting for the server to start responding.
16361 It might be the server taking too long to respond or the client
16362 clicking the 'Stop' button too fast.
16363
16364 cH The "timeout client" stroke while waiting for client data during a
16365 POST request. This is sometimes caused by too large TCP MSS values
16366 for PPPoE networks which cannot transport full-sized packets. It can
16367 also happen when client timeout is smaller than server timeout and
16368 the server takes too long to respond.
16369
16370 CQ The client aborted while its session was queued, waiting for a server
16371 with enough empty slots to accept it. It might be that either all the
16372 servers were saturated or that the assigned server was taking too
16373 long a time to respond.
16374
16375 CR The client aborted before sending a full HTTP request. Most likely
16376 the request was typed by hand using a telnet client, and aborted
16377 too early. The HTTP status code is likely a 400 here. Sometimes this
16378 might also be caused by an IDS killing the connection between haproxy
Willy Tarreau0f228a02015-05-01 15:37:53 +020016379 and the client. "option http-ignore-probes" can be used to ignore
16380 connections without any data transfer.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010016381
16382 cR The "timeout http-request" stroke before the client sent a full HTTP
16383 request. This is sometimes caused by too large TCP MSS values on the
16384 client side for PPPoE networks which cannot transport full-sized
16385 packets, or by clients sending requests by hand and not typing fast
16386 enough, or forgetting to enter the empty line at the end of the
Willy Tarreau2705a612014-05-23 17:38:34 +020016387 request. The HTTP status code is likely a 408 here. Note: recently,
Willy Tarreau0f228a02015-05-01 15:37:53 +020016388 some browsers started to implement a "pre-connect" feature consisting
16389 in speculatively connecting to some recently visited web sites just
16390 in case the user would like to visit them. This results in many
16391 connections being established to web sites, which end up in 408
16392 Request Timeout if the timeout strikes first, or 400 Bad Request when
16393 the browser decides to close them first. These ones pollute the log
16394 and feed the error counters. Some versions of some browsers have even
16395 been reported to display the error code. It is possible to work
16396 around the undesirable effects of this behaviour by adding "option
16397 http-ignore-probes" in the frontend, resulting in connections with
16398 zero data transfer to be totally ignored. This will definitely hide
16399 the errors of people experiencing connectivity issues though.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010016400
16401 CT The client aborted while its session was tarpitted. It is important to
16402 check if this happens on valid requests, in order to be sure that no
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +020016403 wrong tarpit rules have been written. If a lot of them happen, it
16404 might make sense to lower the "timeout tarpit" value to something
16405 closer to the average reported "Tw" timer, in order not to consume
16406 resources for just a few attackers.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010016407
Willy Tarreau570f2212013-06-10 16:42:09 +020016408 LR The request was intercepted and locally handled by haproxy. Generally
16409 it means that this was a redirect or a stats request.
16410
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +010016411 SC The server or an equipment between it and haproxy explicitly refused
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010016412 the TCP connection (the proxy received a TCP RST or an ICMP message
16413 in return). Under some circumstances, it can also be the network
16414 stack telling the proxy that the server is unreachable (eg: no route,
16415 or no ARP response on local network). When this happens in HTTP mode,
16416 the status code is likely a 502 or 503 here.
16417
16418 sC The "timeout connect" stroke before a connection to the server could
16419 complete. When this happens in HTTP mode, the status code is likely a
16420 503 or 504 here.
16421
16422 SD The connection to the server died with an error during the data
16423 transfer. This usually means that haproxy has received an RST from
16424 the server or an ICMP message from an intermediate equipment while
16425 exchanging data with the server. This can be caused by a server crash
16426 or by a network issue on an intermediate equipment.
16427
16428 sD The server did not send nor acknowledge any data for as long as the
16429 "timeout server" setting during the data phase. This is often caused
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +010016430 by too short timeouts on L4 equipments before the server (firewalls,
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010016431 load-balancers, ...), as well as keep-alive sessions maintained
16432 between the client and the server expiring first on haproxy.
16433
16434 SH The server aborted before sending its full HTTP response headers, or
16435 it crashed while processing the request. Since a server aborting at
16436 this moment is very rare, it would be wise to inspect its logs to
16437 control whether it crashed and why. The logged request may indicate a
16438 small set of faulty requests, demonstrating bugs in the application.
16439 Sometimes this might also be caused by an IDS killing the connection
16440 between haproxy and the server.
16441
16442 sH The "timeout server" stroke before the server could return its
16443 response headers. This is the most common anomaly, indicating too
16444 long transactions, probably caused by server or database saturation.
16445 The immediate workaround consists in increasing the "timeout server"
16446 setting, but it is important to keep in mind that the user experience
16447 will suffer from these long response times. The only long term
16448 solution is to fix the application.
16449
16450 sQ The session spent too much time in queue and has been expired. See
16451 the "timeout queue" and "timeout connect" settings to find out how to
16452 fix this if it happens too often. If it often happens massively in
16453 short periods, it may indicate general problems on the affected
16454 servers due to I/O or database congestion, or saturation caused by
16455 external attacks.
16456
16457 PC The proxy refused to establish a connection to the server because the
16458 process' socket limit has been reached while attempting to connect.
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +020016459 The global "maxconn" parameter may be increased in the configuration
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010016460 so that it does not happen anymore. This status is very rare and
16461 might happen when the global "ulimit-n" parameter is forced by hand.
16462
Willy Tarreaued2fd2d2010-12-29 11:23:27 +010016463 PD The proxy blocked an incorrectly formatted chunked encoded message in
16464 a request or a response, after the server has emitted its headers. In
16465 most cases, this will indicate an invalid message from the server to
Willy Tarreauf3a3e132013-08-31 08:16:26 +020016466 the client. Haproxy supports chunk sizes of up to 2GB - 1 (2147483647
16467 bytes). Any larger size will be considered as an error.
Willy Tarreaued2fd2d2010-12-29 11:23:27 +010016468
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010016469 PH The proxy blocked the server's response, because it was invalid,
16470 incomplete, dangerous (cache control), or matched a security filter.
16471 In any case, an HTTP 502 error is sent to the client. One possible
16472 cause for this error is an invalid syntax in an HTTP header name
Willy Tarreaued2fd2d2010-12-29 11:23:27 +010016473 containing unauthorized characters. It is also possible but quite
16474 rare, that the proxy blocked a chunked-encoding request from the
16475 client due to an invalid syntax, before the server responded. In this
16476 case, an HTTP 400 error is sent to the client and reported in the
16477 logs.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010016478
16479 PR The proxy blocked the client's HTTP request, either because of an
16480 invalid HTTP syntax, in which case it returned an HTTP 400 error to
16481 the client, or because a deny filter matched, in which case it
16482 returned an HTTP 403 error.
16483
16484 PT The proxy blocked the client's request and has tarpitted its
16485 connection before returning it a 500 server error. Nothing was sent
16486 to the server. The connection was maintained open for as long as
16487 reported by the "Tw" timer field.
16488
16489 RC A local resource has been exhausted (memory, sockets, source ports)
16490 preventing the connection to the server from establishing. The error
16491 logs will tell precisely what was missing. This is very rare and can
16492 only be solved by proper system tuning.
16493
Willy Tarreau996a92c2010-10-13 19:30:47 +020016494The combination of the two last flags gives a lot of information about how
16495persistence was handled by the client, the server and by haproxy. This is very
16496important to troubleshoot disconnections, when users complain they have to
16497re-authenticate. The commonly encountered flags are :
16498
16499 -- Persistence cookie is not enabled.
16500
16501 NN No cookie was provided by the client, none was inserted in the
16502 response. For instance, this can be in insert mode with "postonly"
16503 set on a GET request.
16504
16505 II A cookie designating an invalid server was provided by the client,
16506 a valid one was inserted in the response. This typically happens when
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -040016507 a "server" entry is removed from the configuration, since its cookie
Willy Tarreau996a92c2010-10-13 19:30:47 +020016508 value can be presented by a client when no other server knows it.
16509
16510 NI No cookie was provided by the client, one was inserted in the
16511 response. This typically happens for first requests from every user
16512 in "insert" mode, which makes it an easy way to count real users.
16513
16514 VN A cookie was provided by the client, none was inserted in the
16515 response. This happens for most responses for which the client has
16516 already got a cookie.
16517
16518 VU A cookie was provided by the client, with a last visit date which is
16519 not completely up-to-date, so an updated cookie was provided in
16520 response. This can also happen if there was no date at all, or if
16521 there was a date but the "maxidle" parameter was not set, so that the
16522 cookie can be switched to unlimited time.
16523
16524 EI A cookie was provided by the client, with a last visit date which is
16525 too old for the "maxidle" parameter, so the cookie was ignored and a
16526 new cookie was inserted in the response.
16527
16528 OI A cookie was provided by the client, with a first visit date which is
16529 too old for the "maxlife" parameter, so the cookie was ignored and a
16530 new cookie was inserted in the response.
16531
16532 DI The server designated by the cookie was down, a new server was
16533 selected and a new cookie was emitted in the response.
16534
16535 VI The server designated by the cookie was not marked dead but could not
16536 be reached. A redispatch happened and selected another one, which was
16537 then advertised in the response.
16538
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010016539
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200165408.6. Non-printable characters
16541-----------------------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010016542
16543In order not to cause trouble to log analysis tools or terminals during log
16544consulting, non-printable characters are not sent as-is into log files, but are
16545converted to the two-digits hexadecimal representation of their ASCII code,
16546prefixed by the character '#'. The only characters that can be logged without
16547being escaped are comprised between 32 and 126 (inclusive). Obviously, the
16548escape character '#' itself is also encoded to avoid any ambiguity ("#23"). It
16549is the same for the character '"' which becomes "#22", as well as '{', '|' and
16550'}' when logging headers.
16551
16552Note that the space character (' ') is not encoded in headers, which can cause
16553issues for tools relying on space count to locate fields. A typical header
16554containing spaces is "User-Agent".
16555
16556Last, it has been observed that some syslog daemons such as syslog-ng escape
16557the quote ('"') with a backslash ('\'). The reverse operation can safely be
16558performed since no quote may appear anywhere else in the logs.
16559
16560
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200165618.7. Capturing HTTP cookies
16562---------------------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010016563
16564Cookie capture simplifies the tracking a complete user session. This can be
16565achieved using the "capture cookie" statement in the frontend. Please refer to
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020016566section 4.2 for more details. Only one cookie can be captured, and the same
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010016567cookie will simultaneously be checked in the request ("Cookie:" header) and in
16568the response ("Set-Cookie:" header). The respective values will be reported in
16569the HTTP logs at the "captured_request_cookie" and "captured_response_cookie"
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020016570locations (see section 8.2.3 about HTTP log format). When either cookie is
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010016571not seen, a dash ('-') replaces the value. This way, it's easy to detect when a
16572user switches to a new session for example, because the server will reassign it
16573a new cookie. It is also possible to detect if a server unexpectedly sets a
16574wrong cookie to a client, leading to session crossing.
16575
16576 Examples :
16577 # capture the first cookie whose name starts with "ASPSESSION"
16578 capture cookie ASPSESSION len 32
16579
16580 # capture the first cookie whose name is exactly "vgnvisitor"
16581 capture cookie vgnvisitor= len 32
16582
16583
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200165848.8. Capturing HTTP headers
16585---------------------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010016586
16587Header captures are useful to track unique request identifiers set by an upper
16588proxy, virtual host names, user-agents, POST content-length, referrers, etc. In
16589the response, one can search for information about the response length, how the
16590server asked the cache to behave, or an object location during a redirection.
16591
16592Header captures are performed using the "capture request header" and "capture
16593response header" statements in the frontend. Please consult their definition in
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020016594section 4.2 for more details.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010016595
16596It is possible to include both request headers and response headers at the same
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +010016597time. Non-existent headers are logged as empty strings, and if one header
16598appears more than once, only its last occurrence will be logged. Request headers
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010016599are grouped within braces '{' and '}' in the same order as they were declared,
16600and delimited with a vertical bar '|' without any space. Response headers
16601follow the same representation, but are displayed after a space following the
16602request headers block. These blocks are displayed just before the HTTP request
16603in the logs.
16604
Willy Tarreaud9ed3d22014-06-13 12:23:06 +020016605As a special case, it is possible to specify an HTTP header capture in a TCP
16606frontend. The purpose is to enable logging of headers which will be parsed in
16607an HTTP backend if the request is then switched to this HTTP backend.
16608
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010016609 Example :
16610 # This instance chains to the outgoing proxy
16611 listen proxy-out
16612 mode http
16613 option httplog
16614 option logasap
16615 log global
16616 server cache1 192.168.1.1:3128
16617
16618 # log the name of the virtual server
16619 capture request header Host len 20
16620
16621 # log the amount of data uploaded during a POST
16622 capture request header Content-Length len 10
16623
16624 # log the beginning of the referrer
16625 capture request header Referer len 20
16626
16627 # server name (useful for outgoing proxies only)
16628 capture response header Server len 20
16629
16630 # logging the content-length is useful with "option logasap"
16631 capture response header Content-Length len 10
16632
16633 # log the expected cache behaviour on the response
16634 capture response header Cache-Control len 8
16635
16636 # the Via header will report the next proxy's name
16637 capture response header Via len 20
16638
16639 # log the URL location during a redirection
16640 capture response header Location len 20
16641
16642 >>> Aug 9 20:26:09 localhost \
16643 haproxy[2022]: 127.0.0.1:34014 [09/Aug/2004:20:26:09] proxy-out \
16644 proxy-out/cache1 0/0/0/162/+162 200 +350 - - ---- 0/0/0/0/0 0/0 \
16645 {fr.adserver.yahoo.co||http://fr.f416.mail.} {|864|private||} \
16646 "GET http://fr.adserver.yahoo.com/"
16647
16648 >>> Aug 9 20:30:46 localhost \
16649 haproxy[2022]: 127.0.0.1:34020 [09/Aug/2004:20:30:46] proxy-out \
16650 proxy-out/cache1 0/0/0/182/+182 200 +279 - - ---- 0/0/0/0/0 0/0 \
16651 {w.ods.org||} {Formilux/0.1.8|3495|||} \
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +010016652 "GET http://trafic.1wt.eu/ HTTP/1.1"
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010016653
16654 >>> Aug 9 20:30:46 localhost \
16655 haproxy[2022]: 127.0.0.1:34028 [09/Aug/2004:20:30:46] proxy-out \
16656 proxy-out/cache1 0/0/2/126/+128 301 +223 - - ---- 0/0/0/0/0 0/0 \
16657 {www.sytadin.equipement.gouv.fr||http://trafic.1wt.eu/} \
16658 {Apache|230|||http://www.sytadin.} \
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +010016659 "GET http://www.sytadin.equipement.gouv.fr/ HTTP/1.1"
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010016660
16661
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200166628.9. Examples of logs
16663---------------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010016664
16665These are real-world examples of logs accompanied with an explanation. Some of
16666them have been made up by hand. The syslog part has been removed for better
16667reading. Their sole purpose is to explain how to decipher them.
16668
16669 >>> haproxy[674]: 127.0.0.1:33318 [15/Oct/2003:08:31:57.130] px-http \
16670 px-http/srv1 6559/0/7/147/6723 200 243 - - ---- 5/3/3/1/0 0/0 \
16671 "HEAD / HTTP/1.0"
16672
16673 => long request (6.5s) entered by hand through 'telnet'. The server replied
16674 in 147 ms, and the session ended normally ('----')
16675
16676 >>> haproxy[674]: 127.0.0.1:33319 [15/Oct/2003:08:31:57.149] px-http \
16677 px-http/srv1 6559/1230/7/147/6870 200 243 - - ---- 324/239/239/99/0 \
16678 0/9 "HEAD / HTTP/1.0"
16679
16680 => Idem, but the request was queued in the global queue behind 9 other
16681 requests, and waited there for 1230 ms.
16682
16683 >>> haproxy[674]: 127.0.0.1:33320 [15/Oct/2003:08:32:17.654] px-http \
16684 px-http/srv1 9/0/7/14/+30 200 +243 - - ---- 3/3/3/1/0 0/0 \
16685 "GET /image.iso HTTP/1.0"
16686
16687 => request for a long data transfer. The "logasap" option was specified, so
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +010016688 the log was produced just before transferring data. The server replied in
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010016689 14 ms, 243 bytes of headers were sent to the client, and total time from
16690 accept to first data byte is 30 ms.
16691
16692 >>> haproxy[674]: 127.0.0.1:33320 [15/Oct/2003:08:32:17.925] px-http \
16693 px-http/srv1 9/0/7/14/30 502 243 - - PH-- 3/2/2/0/0 0/0 \
16694 "GET /cgi-bin/bug.cgi? HTTP/1.0"
16695
16696 => the proxy blocked a server response either because of an "rspdeny" or
16697 "rspideny" filter, or because the response was improperly formatted and
Willy Tarreau3c92c5f2011-08-28 09:45:47 +020016698 not HTTP-compliant, or because it blocked sensitive information which
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010016699 risked being cached. In this case, the response is replaced with a "502
16700 bad gateway". The flags ("PH--") tell us that it was haproxy who decided
16701 to return the 502 and not the server.
16702
16703 >>> haproxy[18113]: 127.0.0.1:34548 [15/Oct/2003:15:18:55.798] px-http \
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +010016704 px-http/<NOSRV> -1/-1/-1/-1/8490 -1 0 - - CR-- 2/2/2/0/0 0/0 ""
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010016705
16706 => the client never completed its request and aborted itself ("C---") after
16707 8.5s, while the proxy was waiting for the request headers ("-R--").
16708 Nothing was sent to any server.
16709
16710 >>> haproxy[18113]: 127.0.0.1:34549 [15/Oct/2003:15:19:06.103] px-http \
16711 px-http/<NOSRV> -1/-1/-1/-1/50001 408 0 - - cR-- 2/2/2/0/0 0/0 ""
16712
16713 => The client never completed its request, which was aborted by the
16714 time-out ("c---") after 50s, while the proxy was waiting for the request
16715 headers ("-R--"). Nothing was sent to any server, but the proxy could
16716 send a 408 return code to the client.
16717
16718 >>> haproxy[18989]: 127.0.0.1:34550 [15/Oct/2003:15:24:28.312] px-tcp \
16719 px-tcp/srv1 0/0/5007 0 cD 0/0/0/0/0 0/0
16720
16721 => This log was produced with "option tcplog". The client timed out after
16722 5 seconds ("c----").
16723
16724 >>> haproxy[18989]: 10.0.0.1:34552 [15/Oct/2003:15:26:31.462] px-http \
16725 px-http/srv1 3183/-1/-1/-1/11215 503 0 - - SC-- 205/202/202/115/3 \
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +010016726 0/0 "HEAD / HTTP/1.0"
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010016727
16728 => The request took 3s to complete (probably a network problem), and the
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020016729 connection to the server failed ('SC--') after 4 attempts of 2 seconds
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010016730 (config says 'retries 3'), and no redispatch (otherwise we would have
16731 seen "/+3"). Status code 503 was returned to the client. There were 115
16732 connections on this server, 202 connections on this proxy, and 205 on
16733 the global process. It is possible that the server refused the
16734 connection because of too many already established.
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010016735
Willy Tarreau52b2d222011-09-07 23:48:48 +020016736
Christopher Fauletc3fe5332016-04-07 15:30:10 +0200167379. Supported filters
16738--------------------
16739
16740Here are listed officially supported filters with the list of parameters they
16741accept. Depending on compile options, some of these filters might be
16742unavailable. The list of available filters is reported in haproxy -vv.
16743
16744See also : "filter"
16745
167469.1. Trace
16747----------
16748
Christopher Faulet31bfe1f2016-12-09 17:42:38 +010016749filter trace [name <name>] [random-parsing] [random-forwarding] [hexdump]
Christopher Fauletc3fe5332016-04-07 15:30:10 +020016750
16751 Arguments:
16752 <name> is an arbitrary name that will be reported in
16753 messages. If no name is provided, "TRACE" is used.
16754
16755 <random-parsing> enables the random parsing of data exchanged between
16756 the client and the server. By default, this filter
16757 parses all available data. With this parameter, it
16758 only parses a random amount of the available data.
16759
16760 <random-forwarding> enables the random forwading of parsed data. By
16761 default, this filter forwards all previously parsed
16762 data. With this parameter, it only forwards a random
16763 amount of the parsed data.
16764
Christopher Faulet31bfe1f2016-12-09 17:42:38 +010016765 <hexump> dumps all forwarded data to the server and the client.
16766
Christopher Fauletc3fe5332016-04-07 15:30:10 +020016767This filter can be used as a base to develop new filters. It defines all
16768callbacks and print a message on the standard error stream (stderr) with useful
16769information for all of them. It may be useful to debug the activity of other
16770filters or, quite simply, HAProxy's activity.
16771
16772Using <random-parsing> and/or <random-forwarding> parameters is a good way to
16773tests the behavior of a filter that parses data exchanged between a client and
16774a server by adding some latencies in the processing.
16775
16776
167779.2. HTTP compression
16778---------------------
16779
16780filter compression
16781
16782The HTTP compression has been moved in a filter in HAProxy 1.7. "compression"
16783keyword must still be used to enable and configure the HTTP compression. And
16784when no other filter is used, it is enough. But it is mandatory to explicitly
16785use a filter line to enable the HTTP compression when two or more filters are
16786used for the same listener/frontend/backend. This is important to know the
16787filters evaluation order.
16788
16789See also : "compression"
16790
16791
Christopher Fauletf7e4e7e2016-10-27 22:29:49 +0200167929.3. Stream Processing Offload Engine (SPOE)
16793--------------------------------------------
16794
16795filter spoe [engine <name>] config <file>
16796
16797 Arguments :
16798
16799 <name> is the engine name that will be used to find the right scope in
16800 the configuration file. If not provided, all the file will be
16801 parsed.
16802
16803 <file> is the path of the engine configuration file. This file can
16804 contain configuration of several engines. In this case, each
16805 part must be placed in its own scope.
16806
16807The Stream Processing Offload Engine (SPOE) is a filter communicating with
16808external components. It allows the offload of some specifics processing on the
16809streams in tierce applications. These external components and information
16810exchanged with them are configured in dedicated files, for the main part. It
16811also requires dedicated backends, defined in HAProxy configuration.
16812
16813SPOE communicates with external components using an in-house binary protocol,
16814the Stream Processing Offload Protocol (SPOP).
16815
Tim Düsterhus4896c442016-11-29 02:15:19 +010016816For all information about the SPOE configuration and the SPOP specification, see
Christopher Fauletf7e4e7e2016-10-27 22:29:49 +020016817"doc/SPOE.txt".
16818
16819Important note:
16820 The SPOE filter is highly experimental for now and was not heavily
16821 tested. It is really not production ready. So use it carefully.
16822
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010016823/*
16824 * Local variables:
16825 * fill-column: 79
16826 * End:
16827 */